in malaysia - School of Graduate Studies
Transcription
in malaysia - School of Graduate Studies
IEPS2014 International Education Postgraduate Seminar 2014 23-24 December 2014 Universiti Teknologi Malaysia, Johor Bahru, Johor Malaysia PROCEEDINGS VOLUME 3 INNOVATION, ISSUES AND CHALLENGES FOR EDUCATIONAL SUSTAINABILITY FACULTY OF EDUCATION UNIVERSITI TEKNOLOGI MALAYSIA 2014 Published by: FACULTY OF EDUCATION, UNIVERSITI TEKNOLOGI MALAYSIA Faculty of Education Universiti Teknologi Malaysia 81310 Skudai, Johor, Johor Bahru Malaysia @ Faculty of Education, Universiti Teknologi Malaysia All reserved. None of the publication of this proceeding can be republished or transferred in any means, electronically or mechanically such as copying, recording or storing for reproduction or accessed without the written consent from the holders of the rights. All the papers in this proceeding are presented at the International Education Postgraduate Seminar 2014, 23 - 24 December 2014 at Universiti Teknologi Malaysia, Johor Bahru, Johor, Malaysia. Perpustakaan Negara Malaysia Cataloguing-in – Publication Data International Education Postgraduate Seminar (2014 : Johor Bahru, Johor) IEPS2014 International Education Postgraduate Seminar 2014: PROCEEDINGS INNOVATION, ISSUES AND CHALLENGES FOR EDUCATIONAL SUSTAINABILITY, VOLUME III, 23 – 24 December 2014, Universiti Teknologi Malaysia, Johor Bahru, Johor Malaysia / Edited by: Lokman Mohd Tahir, Aede Hatib Musta’amal, Azlina Mohd Kosnin, Halijah Ibrahim, Mohd Safarin Nordin, Sarimah Ismail, Najua Syuhada Ahmad Alhassora, Ana Haziqah A Rashid, Farhana Diana Deris, Mohd Rustam Mohd Rameli, Norhafizah Sulaiman, Nor Farhah Saidin. ISBN 978-967-12174-6-7 1. Education, Higher—Malaysia—Congresses. 2. Educational change—Malaysia—Congresses. I. Lokman Mohd Tahir,. II. Aede Hatib Musta’amal. III. Azlina Mohd Kosnin. IV. Halijah Ibrahim. V. Mohd Safarin Nordin. VI. Sarimah Ismail. VII. Najua Syuhada Ahmad Alhassora. VIII. Ana Haziqah A Rashid. IX. Farhana Diana Deris. X. Mohd Rustam Mohd Rameli. XI. Norhafizah Sulaiman. XII. Nor Farhah Saidin. XIII. Tittle. 378.595 Designed by: Graphic Unit, Faculty of Education, UTM Proofreaders: Najua Syuhada Ahmad Alhassora Ana Haziqah A Rashid Edited by: Lokman Mohd Tahir Aede Hatib Musta’amal Azlina Mohd Kosnin Halijah Ibrahim Mohd Safarin Nordin Sarimah Ismail Najua Syuhada Ahmad Alhassora Ana Haziqah A Rashid Farhana Diana Deris Mohd Rustam Mohd Rameli Norhafizah Sulaiman Nor Farhah Saidin Message from the Patron PROF. DR BAHARUDDIN ARIS Assalamualaikum greetings! Wrt Wbt and warmest In consonance with Universiti Teknologi Malaysia’s aspiration to be recognised as a world class centre of academic and technological excellence through its commitment in enhancing innovative education and developing cutting-edge research while perfecting the technical and professional workforce of the nation, I am pleased that the Faculty of Education with strong support from its Postgraduate Student Society (PGSSFP) is organising the first International Education Postgraduate Seminar (IEPS2014). One of the basic aims of research is to make human lives better, including the researchers themselves. To achieve this, researchers need to go beyond producing good dissertations. Research findings must be disseminated to become part of international literature to allow a more robust and condensed understanding of different phenomena in theoretical and practical avenues. Sharing research findings and future objectives of exploration via presentations and publications is essential in helping researchers enhance self-development, expand intellectual horizon, and acquaint with the publishing and sharing practices. Research cannot and should not be done in isolation; I hope this seminar will not only provide young and budding researchers a glimpse of the world of research that all academicians need to embrace but also foster connections and collaborations between researchers. Seeing this seminar taking place gives me great pleasure. I applaud the concentrated efforts between lecturers, support staff and postgraduates at the Faculty. I am also very proud of all the presenters and participants who are part of the community of this first IEPS2014. This is indeed a great step forward for everyone! Congratulations! Message from the General Chair DR AZLINA MOHD KOSNIN Assalamualaikum Wrt Wbt and warmest greetings! It gives me great pleasure to welcome everyone to the International Education Postgraduate Seminar (IEPS2014). With the aim to transform all of research activities of the education postgraduates into an event of sharing and communication, IEPS2014 provides excellent opportunities for students to share initial findings and research directions and to receive helpful critique that will guide them towards better practices. This event will not only be helpful in informing research practices but will also be a contributor in developing students as future researchers and academicians. The theme of this seminar, “Innovation, Issues and Challenges for Educational Sustainability” is most accurate to be brought forward because this theme signals the important shift in education. Be it in curriculum development, assessment, leadership, science education, vocational education, psychology, counseling, or multimedia education, the aims of research in education must be geared towards achieving educational sustainability. To IEPS2014 Advisory and Organising Committee, I congratulate you for spearheading this FIRST International Education Postgraduate Seminar (IEPS2014). I would also like to express my sincere gratitude to the School of Graduate Studies for the generous grant, support and contribution. This appreciation also goes to everyone who have contributed in one way or another. Thank you for seeing the potentials of our postgraduates, for investing in their future, to inspire and to foster successful community. To all delegates, presenters, and participants, this seminar is now all yours. I hope everyone will find the seminar inspiring and enriching, through discussions and networking with new acquaintances and colleagues. Message from the Organising Chairperson FARHANA DIANA DERIS Assalamualaikum Wrt Wbt and warmest greetings! Welcome to the FIRST International Education Postgraduate Seminar! In promoting educational sustainability, we need to take into account the context in which we live in, and the ways in which the world is interrelated; the society today lives in a world that is decisively supported and interconnected by technology. Embracing this monumental advancement, educational institutions need to produce world-class human capital with competent skills and intellectual capacity, commendable traits, values and attributes that are pertinent in the present and future context and necessary in thriving in this social and technological context. This indeed highlights the importance of deliberation and exchange of ideas, experience and opinions in the pursuit of improving the different fields of education. Thus, this seminar, aptly themed, “innovation, issues and challenges for educational sustainability”, is very timely. This seminar also captures the overarching role of multiple perspectives in informing practices, revolutionising the way teaching and learning are conceptualised, and inspiring new methodologies. Therefore, I hope this two-day seminar not only will enrich participants with research-related experiences but will also pave the way for fruitful dialogues and insightful deliberations towards achieving educational sustainability. I would also like to take this opportunity to express my sincerest gratitude and appreciation to everyone who have contributed in one way or another to the success of this seminar, especially to the organising committee, the Postgraduate Student Society, Faculty of Education (PGSSFP). To all invited speakers, presenters and participants, thank you for your participation and support, without which this seminar would not have been possible. See you again at the SECOND International Education Postgraduate Seminar! IEPS2014 COMMITTEE Prof. Dr Baharuddin Aris Patron Assoc. Prof. Dr Muhammad Sukri Saud Advisor Dr Azlina Mohd Kosnin General Chair Dr Aede Hatib Musta’amal @ Jamal Vice Chair ADVISORY COMMITTEE Dr Nor Fadila Mohd Amin Secretary I Dr Halijah Ibrahim Secretary II Dr Nor Hasniza Ibrahim Treasurer & PGSSFP Advisor Pn Mulenawati Munawi Assistant Treasurer Assoc. Prof. Dr Lokman Tahir Papers and Publication Dr Mohd Safarin Nordin Papers and Publication Dr Sarimah Ismail Papers and Publication Assoc. Prof. Dr Noraffandy Yahaya Technical, Equipment, and Broadcasting Dr M Al-Muz-Zamil Yasin Technical, Equipment, and Broadcasting Dr Yusri Kamin Logistics and Venue Dr Abdul Halim Abdullah Logistics and Venue Dr Mahani Mokhtar Protocol and Event Management Dr Adibah Abdul Latif Certificate, Token and Honorariums Dr Noor Dayana Abdul Halim Publicity, Graphic and Montage Pn Siti Noraini Mohd Zali Publicity, Graphic and Montage Dr Norazrena Abu Samah Website and Communication Dr Hasnah Mohamed Website and Communication Dr Megat Aman Zahiri Megat Zakaria Website and Communication Website and Communication Website and Communication ORGANISING COMMITTEE Farhana Diana Deris Suraiya Haji Muhamad Fatimah Sarah Yaacob Crystal Joan Peter Kho Pui Wun Nur ‘Aqilah Mohd Norain Norhafizah Sulaiman Noor Izzati Ariff Organising Chairperson Organising Vice Chairperson Secretary III Vice Secretary (Department of Technical and Engineering Education) Vice Secretary (Department of Educational Science, Mathematics and Creative Multimedia) Vice Secretary (Department of Educational Foundation and Social Science) Treasurer II Vice Treasurer Sponsorship & Exhibition Mohd Rustam Mohd Rameli Nurul Sa’dah Saipuldin Nor Farhah Saidin Papers and Publication Najua Syuhada Ahmad Alhassora Ana Haziqah A. Rashid Mohd Nur Al Sufi Romele Publicity, Graphic and Montage Nur Jannah Jamil Logistics and Venue Uzailun Nafais Zainal Abidin Technical, Equipment, and Broadcasting Sashendran A/L Vanarajan Secretariat Suhaimi Zakaria @ Othman Latifah Abdul Raub Protocol and Event Management Muhammad Umar Khan Norulbiah Ngah Nurul Farhana Jumaat Noor Azaref Naim Rosidah Abdullah Sani Zurina Hamid Samira Nikian Hazlin Haron Miller Yong Norashuha Tajuddin Faridah Mat Nor Siti Rahimah Mohd Yusop Norhayati Ahmad Rafaquat Ali Ahmad Firdaus Abd Hadi Siti Khadijah Lokman Hafzan Ibrahim Noriadah Abdul Karim Diyana Zulaika Abdul Ghani TABLE OF CONTENTS ID NO. TITLE PAGE 2 Predicting Model of Academic Buoyancy: The Roles of Achievement Goals and SelfRegulation Mohd Rustam Mohd Rameli, Azlina Mohd Kosnin 1 5 Pengaruh Kompetensi Keusahawanan Terhadap Tingkahlaku Inovatif Mohd. Asri Ispal, Mohd. Khata Jabor, Asnul Dahar Minghat 14 19 A Myopic Comparative Review Between Five-Factor Model And Hexaco Model Of Human Personality Mahtab Ghadimi, Mohd Tajudin Ninggal Mohd Tajudin Ninggal 27 23 Holistic Approach For Correctional Education In TVET: Hatching The Hace In Prison Education Muhamad Afzamiman Aripin, Rohana Hamzah, Ros Eliana Ahmad Zuki, Akhmal Annas Hasmori 38 24 Designing Educational Simulation For Impact Test Machine Ahmed Hadi Hatif Shubber, Amirmudin Bin Udin, Asnul Bin Minghat 49 29 Perlaksanaan Amalan Kepimpinan 'Turnaround' Dalam Kalangan Pengetua Sekolah Menengah Di Negeri Sabah Irene Branda Macus, Khadijah Bt Daud 63 32 Internet Usage Among Undergraduate Students In A Public University In Malasia Lu Xi, Yeo Kee Jiar 76 33 Meeting Supervisors' Expectations of Undergraduates Final Year Project Reports Salawati Ahmad, Masputeriah Bte Hamzah 83 35 KeberkesananModulNilaiKelestarianDalam TopikDayaTingkatanEmpat MohdFadhliZakaria, FatinAliahPhang 94 37 Construction On Molee Career Instrument (Mci) As Selection Tool In Allied Health Courses Gooh Mo Lee, Syed Mohamed Shafeq Bin Syed Mansor, Yeo Kee Jiar, Yahya Buntat 112 40 The Need For Problem-Based Learning In Nigerian Secondary Schools Chemistry Lessons Abubakar Abbas Babayi, Mohammad YusofArshad 121 41 Cadangan Pembinaan Model Penghujahan Saintifik Dalam Kimia Chuzairy Hanri, Mohammad Yusof Arshad 132 44 ESL Learners’ English Learning Attitudes In Chinese Independent High Schools Khei 146 Yok Man @ Khei Yok Lee, Noor Zainab Bt Abdul Razak 50 Investigating The Existing Literary Text In School: Students Perception About The Need Of Criteria In Text Selection Aryanti Ishak, Zaidah Zainal 156 51 The Corelation Between Psychological Needs And Social Network Activities Shima Mashayekhi, Mohd Tajudin Md. Ningal 166 60 Pengetahuan Teknologi Guru Cemerlang Fizik ZarirahAbdul Hamid, FatinAliahPhang 178 62 Persepsi Majikan Terhadap Pekerja Bagi Industri Pembuatan Chua Siew Lian, Yusri Kamin 189 63 Pembentukan Item Instrumen Sistem Kepercayaan Yang Salah: Suatu Kajian Kualitatif Mohd Nur Al Sufi Romele, Syed Mohammed Shafeq Syed Mansor 202 64 Inculcation Of Values To Overcome Disciplinary Problems In Skill-Based Educational Institutions Nor Aishah Abdul Aziz, Mohd Zolkifli Abd Hamid 218 65 Generic Employability Skills Integration In Technical And Vocational Education Curriculum: A Requirement For The 232 Preparation Of The 21st Century Workforce Azlan Abdul Latip, Muhammad Inti 66 Komitmen Kerja Pengetua Dalam Melaksanakan Tugas Pada Sekolah Menengah Pertama (Smp) Negeri Di Bandar Padang Syahril, Khadijah Binti Daud Daud 243 67 Assessment Practices And Epistemological Beliefs Lee Ween Shin, Fatin Aliah Phang Physics 252 72 Penerapan Strategi Pengutaraan Masalah Untuk Meningkatkan Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi MuniandyVinogharri, JohariSurif 265 74 Patterns Of Teaching Approach Adopted By Preservice Teachers In Teaching Writing Sarala @ Thulasi Palpanadan, Fauziah Ismail, Abdul Rahim 291 80 Stail Pembelajaran Guru Pelatih Dalam Praktikum Latihan Mengajar Nur’Ain Baharin, Mohd Zolkifli Abd Hamid, DayanaFarzeeha Ali 304 84 The Socratic Method Online To Improve Critical And High Order Thinking Among Students Salihuddin Md. Suhadi, Hasnah Mohammed, Norasykin Mohd.Zaid, Zaleha Abdullah, Baharuddin Aris 319 87 Difficulties 325 Of Implementing Communicative Language Teaching (Clt) In Malaysia Samira Nikian, Faizah Mohamad Nor 92 A Framework Of Scenario-Epistemic Game For Proffesional Skills And Higher Order Thinking Skills Kho Pui Wun, Jamalludin Harun 340 96 Conceptual Framework Of Video Learning Based On Popbl Cbe Khairul Anuar Abdul Rahman, Muhammad Sukri Saud, Yusri Kamin, Norazrena Abu Samah 355 100 Persepsi Pelajar Sekolah Berasrama Penuh (Sbp) Terhadap Mata PelajaranFizik NurHazwaniZakaria, Mohamad Bilal Ali 370 102 Mengenal pasti Kesan Pendidikan Keusahawanan Pada Pelajar Kejuruteraan Ahmad Firdaus Abd Hadi, Khata Jabor, DayanaF arzeha Ali 385 106 Personality Traits And Life Satisfaction: A Study Among Students In A Public University Seyedeh Maryam Geramian, Mohd Tajudin Ninggal 397 107 Task Induced Involvement:The Issue Of Reactivity On The Development Of Vocabulary: A Review Paper Halah Abdulelah Mohammed, Norazman Abdul Majid, Tina Abdllah 408 109 The Study Of Argumentative Knowledge Construction In Web 2.0 Learning Environment Towards Students’ Critical Thinking Skills Siti Nur Khadijah Aishah Ibrahim, Jamalludin Harun 415 114 Pendidikan Teknikal Dan Latihan Vokasional Ke Arah Pemupukan Kemahiran Generik Hijau Nadia Hartini Mohd Adzmi, Mohd Zolkifli Abd Hamid, Yusri Kamin 435 121 Employing Written Corrective Feedback In Teaching Writing Ng Siew Fong, Wan Fara Adlina Wan Mansor, Abdul Rahim Haji Salam 446 122 Amalan Kepimpinan Tranformasi Guru Besar Dan Impaknya Terhadap Komitmen Guru Sekolah Rendah Di Negeri Sabah Faridah Mat Noor, Khadijah Bt Daud 451 124 Pendekatan Konteks Pengguna Dalam Rekabentuk Persekitaran Pembelajaran Secara Talian Terus Nur Syamimi Mohd Razali, Noraffandy Yahaya 470 125 Kompetensi Pengetua Dan Pengurusan Perubahan Di Sekolah Kalithasan Muniandy, M.Al-Muzzammil Yasin 474 126 Mengkaji Kemahiran Berfikir Kritis Dan Pencapaian Pelajar Menerusi Persekitaran 490 Pembelajaran Kolaboratif Berbantukan Komputer Bagi Subjek Bahasa Pengaturcaraan Siti Mastura Baharudin, Jamalludin Harun 129 Fostering Problem Solving In Chemistry: The Importance, Difficulties And The Needs Of Scientific Creativity SitiSalbiah Omar, Noor Dayana Abdul Halim, JohariSurif, JamalludinHarun 507 131 Penghasilan Video Interaktif Bagi Pengujian Ketangkasan Reaktif Khusus Untuk Permainan Bola Jaring NurEzzainiMohd Nor, Halijah Ibrahim 520 142 RobotikDalamPendidikan Di Malaysia Hafzan Ibrahim, Mohamad Bilal Ali, FatinAliahPhang, Norazrena Abu Samah 530 145 Conceptual Changes In Scientific Argumentation Through Guided Group Settings Heng Lee Ling, Johari Surif,Seng Cher Hau 539 146 Concept Map As an Alternative Assessment in Laboratory Activities Intan Baizura A Ghani, Noraffandy Yahaya, Nor Hasniza Ibrahim, Mohamed Noor Hassan 550 149 Quantitative Research on Education For Sustainable Development (Esd) Practices Among Malaysian Polytechnics Crystal Joan Peter, Wilfredo Libunao 561 152 Parental Monitoring On The Adolescence Development Normalis Bazid, Zainudin Abu Bakar 577 154 Kerangka Konseptual Kesediaan Guru Dalam Melaksanakan Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah (PBS) Di Sekolah Menengah Semenanjung Malaysia SivakkumarBalakrishnan, Muhammad Sukri Saud 591 156 Tinjauan Masalah Pengurusan Proses PBS Dan Ciri-Ciri Elemen Pentaksiran Yang Perlu Ada Dalam Satu Sistem Pengurusan Eportfolio PBS Suhaizal Hashim, Jamalludin Harun 605 162 Pendekatan Pembelajaran Berasaskan Konteks Untuk Memupuk Literasi Sains dalam Bilik Darjah Latifah Abdul Raub, Muhammad Yusof Arshad, Nurbiha A.Shukor 619 168 Chemical Problem-Solving Competency Of Open-Ended Problems Aiming To Improve Higher Order Thinking Skills(HOTS): Authentic Practice Suraiya Muhamad, Jamalludin Harun, Johari Surif, Noor Dayana Abdul Halim 632 171 Menggalakkan Kemahiran Pemodelan Pelajar Dalam Kimia Menggunakan Process Oriented Guided Inquiry Learning (Pogil) Siti Zubaidah Omar, Muhammad Yusof Arshad, Mohd Shafie Rosli, Nurbiha A.Shukor 646 173 Impak Personaliti Pengetua Terhadap Prestasi Sekolah Di Smp Sulawesi Selatan Indonesia Usman Baharuddin, Khadijah Binti Daud 656 174 E-Learning Environment For Deaf Students In Learning Science: A Theoretical Framework Mohd Hisyamuddin Mohd Hashim, Zaidatun Tasir 666 176 Pelaksanaan Pembelajaran Berasaskan Projek (PjBL) Di Politeknik Malaysia. Satu Kajian Awal Mohd Noramdzan Mohd Yusof, Aede Hatib Musta’amal, Nor Salwa Ismail 677 180 Factors Causing Secondary Involved In Loitering Gan Lui Nam, Yeo Kee Jiar Students 688 184 Kesan Pengurusan Pengetahuan Dan Mediator Budaya Sekolah Ke Atas Keberkesanan Pengurusan Sekolah Tee Bee Tin, Dr. Khadijah binti Daud 695 185 Kaedah Pengajaran Pendidikan Keusahawanan: Suatu Kajian Literatur Roziati Sumin, Yahya Buntat, Siti Suhaila Samian, Normala Rahmat 708 191 The Impact Of Teaching Strategies And Chinese Language Learning In National School Ng Sar Ee, Yeo Kee Jiar 720 192 Pengaruh Amalan Nilai Kendiri Pengetua Terhadap Sikap Kerja Dan Disiplin Kerja Muhammad Asri, Lokman Mohd Tahir 728 193 The Level And Causes Of Stress Intention To Resign Working Among Geography Teachers In A District In Malaysia Shahrudin Jemaat, Irkhaniza Md Rahim, Syed Mohamed Syafeq Mansor 739 195 Pembelajaran Berasaskan Projek (PBP) Dan Pendidikan Abad Ke-21 Mazlan Setapa, Mohamad Bilal Ali, Fatin Aliah Phang, Abd Khamim, Ismail 754 197 Psikospiritual Islam Dan Kesan Aplikasinya Dalam Kehidupan Manusia Nur Afzan Muhamad, Azlina Mohd Kosnin 767 202 Modul Pengajaran Sains Topik “Nutrisi” Berteraskan Model Konstruktivis Bersepadu Zainab binti Jelani jelani, Johari bin Surif Surif 778 207 Pengaruh Kepimpinan Instruksional Guru Besar Dan Efikasi Kolektif Guru Terhadap Komitmen Organisasi Guru Khadijah Daud, Hafizuddin Md Shakhih 795 215 Kriteria Pengajaran Dan Pembelajaran Kursus Pendidikan Vokasional Yang Dapat Membangunkan Pemikiran Aras Tinggi Pelajar Nurzalina Hashim, Muhammad Sukri Saud 814 218 Strategi Pengajaran Sains Berasaskan Epistemologi Saintifik Mohamad Faqih Junus, Fatin Aliah Phang 823 219 Epistemology, Scientific Epistemology, Epistemology Move: A Review Muhammad Hidayat Ishak, Fatin Aliah Phang 842 221 Transformasi Psikologi Diri Pensyarah IPG Menerusi Aplikasi Profil Personaliti Tajma Hasbullah Abukassim, Mohd Tajudin Ninggal Mohd Tajudin Ninggal 852 225 Pembelajaran Berasaskan Masalah Dalam Sains:Satu Meta Analisis Mohd Mokhzani Ibrahim, Mohammad Yusof Arshad, Nurbiha A.Shukor, Mohd Shafie Rosli 862 227 Perbandingan Kurikulum Sains (KBSM) Dengan Pendidikan Saintis Muslim Zaman Kegemilangan Islam Nurhasyimah Ismail, Norhasniza Ibrahim 876 234 Floating Facilitation in Malaysian Chemistry Pbl Lesson Tan Yin Peen, Mohammad Yusof Arshad 891 237 Teknik Pembelajaran Tilawah Al-Qur’an Di Era ICT Noor Azaref Naim, Jamalludin Harun 907 238 Chemistry Teachers' Understanding Of Models Of Teaching And Learning In Practical Work 922 Oi Lee Jenny Cheng, Mohammad Yusof Arshad, 242 Cognitive Ability And Academic Achievement Of Undergraduates In Universiti Teknologi Malaysia Chong Yi Long, Yeo Kee Jiar 935 245 Investigation of Efl Adults Motivation toward Using Commercial Computer Games to Learn English Language Elham Mahmoudi, Adlina Bt Samad 950 247 Criteria For Selecting Bulding Technology Students For Creative Thinking Skill Acquisition In Nigeria Technical Colleges Jonathan Ojo Oke, Aede Hatib Musta’amal 965 252 Development Of Matter Concept Submicroscopic Level Across Ages Nurdiana Abdullah, Johari Bin Surif 979 On 1 PREDICTING MODEL OF ACADEMIC BUOYANCY: THE ROLES OF ACHIEVEMENT GOALS AND SELF-REGULATION Mohd Rustam Mohd Rameli & Azlina Mohd Kosnin ABSTRACT The existence of challenges in learning Mathematics is an undeniable reality. The challenges come from various sources and each of the sources can affect students’ learning progress in certain ways. To ensure students are able to pursue their academic goals, it is important to identify students’ ability to overcome the academic challenges that they face. Students’ capacity to overcome their daily academic challenges is known as academic buoyancy. Academic buoyancy acts as a protective element to make students persist in the learning process. This paper suggests a model of academic buoyancy in Mathematics where achievement goal orientations and self-regulation are the two individual characteristics postulated as the predictors. The Bigg’s 3P model of effective learning is used as the basis of the model. The 3P model involves two main phases (presage and process) which will determine students’ learning outcomes. In the model proposed in this paper, achievement goal orientation presages students’ selfregulation process which will then influence students’ academic buoyancy in Mathematics. The suggested model can become a guideline for teachers, parents and academic practitioners in 2 assisting students in facing daily academic challenges in the Mathematics. Keywords: Challenges, Capacity, Academic Achievement Goal Orientations, Self-Regulation Buoyancy, STUDENTS WELLBEING AND ACADEMIC BUOYANCY Students’ wellbeing which is referred as students’ survival in daily schooling life is given much attention in the education system. This is due to the belief that wellbeing is a significant element that is related to positive learning outcomes. Besides, this variable is a social construct emphasized by teachers, psychologists, counselors, parents and educational researchers in assessing student selfdevelopment (Miller, Connolly and Maguire, 2013). Measuring students’ academic buoyancy is one of the effective methods to understand and conceptualize students’ wellbeing or survival in the education context (Martin and Marsh, 2006, 2008). Academic buoyancy is a significant element in assisting students to manage and face academic risks especially the risks which frequently and continuously occur in daily life (Martin and Marsh, 2009). These risks include the possibility of getting bad marks in evaluation or failed to submit assignment before the deadline. It is important for academic practitioners to give emphasis to the elements of academic buoyancy in assisting students to face academic difficulties. OVERVIEW OF ACADEMIC BUOYANCY Adversities and difficulties in learning are the challenges in daily schooling life (Finn and Rock, 1997; Martin and Marsh, 2006, 2009). Recent research showed that student’s capacity to face the challenges is a significant element in determining their academic progress. This capacity is referred to academic buoyancy which is 3 related to the question on how good a student is able to face academic difficulties (Martin and Marsh, 2009). Students who are highly buoyant will have great ability to overcome daily schooling challenges. This is because academic buoyancy acts as a protective element and can also be the activator of calmness in oneself (Martin and Marsh, 2008). Academic buoyancy actually is a variable originated from the literature of academic resiliency. However, academic buoyancy does have its differences from the constructs of resiliency, everyday hassles or overcome strategies. Specifically, buoyancy is more related with daily resilience and focusing on individual response towards daily challenges faced by most people and not towards the continuous and critical challenges faced by a relatively small number of people (Martin and Marsh, 2008, 2009). Previous researches indicate that academic buoyancy can be predicted by motivational beliefs (Martin, Colmar, Davey and Marsh, 2010; Martin and Marsh, 2006) and also acts as a predictor of students’ academic outcomes (Marsh, 2007). For example, selfefficacy, planning, persistence in doing task, monitoring and low level of anxiety are the predictors of academic buoyancy (Martin, Colmar, Davey, and Marsh, 2010). At the same time, academic buoyancy has also been shown to predict student’s engagement, student’s achievement and stress level of students (Marsh, 2007; Putwain, Connors, Symes and Douglas-Osborn, 2012). However, the selection process for the predicting variables is somewhat ad hoc without having strong theoretical framework. Therefore the framework of predicting academic buoyancy in Mathematics need to be considered. STUDENTS’ ACHIEVEMENT GOAL ORIENTATION AND ACADEMIC BUOYANCY Nowadays, Mathematics is no longer passively learnt by students (Dilworth, 1996). The focus of Mathematics education has shifted from development of Mathemtics competencies to prepare students 4 who are fully functioning and able to continue the academic goals (Pajares, 2001). Knowing how a student adopts specific achievement goal orientation is significant in monitoring their learning progress since achievement orientation is a mediator of students learning process. Besides, different achievement goal orientation will affect the different way of students’ engagement and response in a certain achievement situation (Pintrich and Schunk, 1996). Previous studies has showed that students with different profile of achievement goal orientation will differ in their subjective wellwellbeing (Tuominen-Soini, Salmela-Aro, Niemivirta, 2008). For example, student with success-oriented profile is reported to have negative emotional effect such as stress and anxiety. Align with that, it is relevant to explore how the construct of wellbeing which is buoyancy in the context of education in order to find out students capacity in facing academic challenges and difficulties. Specifically in the Mathematics education context, studies reported that the nature of Mathematics tasks, classrooms norm and also the nature of techers practices are very much influence the students’ goals and intention to learn Mathematics (Meyer and Turner, 2002; Pape, Bell and Yetkin, 2003; Turner, , Midgley, Meyer, Gheen and Anderman, 2002). In addition, many educational psychologist have conducted research related to motivation in the context of Mathematics classroom. The significance of conducting the studies is due to the situation that most of Mathematics classrooms induce the negative effect on students’ motivation (Ryan and Patrick, 2001). For instance, many teachers tend to teach in the way they are being taught traditionally which much related to performance-approach goal orientation (Brown and Smith, 1997) and contribute to the nature of competition among students (Anderman, Maehr, Midgley, 1999). The nature of classroom setting that affect student motivation is also a strong basis to the exploration of students’ academic buoyancy. 5 STUDENTS’ BUOYANCY SELF-REGULATION AND ACADEMIC In the last decade, the main aim for education has shifted from producing students who are receiving knowledge in certain domain to the enhancement of their autonomy and reflection (Dochy, 2001). Therefore, students nowadays are expected to enhance their autonomy and learning competencies in depth to adopt the lifelong learning and facing unexpected situation (Poldner, Simons, Wijngaards and van der Schaaf, 2012). Self-regulation is one of the important variables in determining academic progress since it is one of the essential competencies to be build up especially in the transition period from secondary schooling to tertiary education (Torenbeek, Jansen and Hofman, 2010) despite of to ensure the success in university learning process (Heikkilaa and Lonka, 2006; Pintrich, 2004). Many students was reported to have low ability in regulate their learning. This is because learning regulation is high level skill (Perry, Phillips amd Dowler, 2004; Pintrich, 2004; Winne, 2005; Zimmerman, 2002) and also the degree of effectivness in using self-regulation strategy is differ among students (Annevirta and Vauras, 2006; Hong and Peng, 2008; Veenman, van Hout-Wolters and Afflerbach, 2006). Moreover, enhancement of regulated learning skill is becoming more important during the period of transition from primary school to secondary school. This is because the learning process in primary school is monitored closely by the teacher but independent learning (schedule arrangement, completion of homework, carrry out different tasks given by different teacher) is practiced more in the secondary school life (Butler, 2002; Cleary and Zimmerman, 2004). In order to ensure that students are able to be independent in their learning, acuquistion of regulation skills is very much important. Unfortunately, previous studies showed that students in their transition to the secondary school build up negative motivation belief such as low self-efficacy towards ability in regulating their learning (Corpus, McClintic- Gilbert and Hayenga, 6 2009; Usher and Pajares, 2008). This situation happen because students lack of motivation and confidence in planning strategy and academic practice which eventually feel difficult to face academik needs. Align with the delivery of contemporary science education that emphasize on acquisition of higher order thinking (focus on learning process and skills to acquire new knowledge) rather than only acquisition of basic skills and facts (Resnick, 1987; Zohar, 2004) has shifted the educators pedagogical model in the 21st century which emphasize on the enhancement of selfregulatd learning (Duschl and Grandy, 2008; PISA, 2006). PREDICTING MODEL OF ACADEMIC BUOYANCY Academic buoyancy is related with all students in school which establishing and validate a model in predicting students’ academic buoyancy is a significant effort. For the purpose of this study, two predictors of academic buoyancy which are achievement goal orientation and self-regulation are choosen based on three main reasons. Firstly, the suggested model is based on the Biggs’ 3P effective learning Model. According to Bigss (1993), three elements which are presage, process and product need to be taken into account in learning process. All the three P’s are related with each other in determining learning outcomes. Align with the suggested model, the achievement goal orientation is a presage phase which is followed by the process of self-regulation and its lead to learning outcome which is academic buoyancy in Mathematic. Secondly, selection of achievement goal orientation and selfregulation is because the focus of this study on the individual characteristic. This is based on the research findings on academic resilience which showed that individual characteristic model is one of the significant models in determining students’ resilience as compared to effective school model, school resources model or peers group model (Borman and Rachuba, 2001). Lastly, the positive relationship between achievement goal orientation and 7 self-regulation with other academic variables is used as the basis to establish their relationship wth academic buoyancy. Different achievement goal was given attention in the research on achievement motivation (Wigfield and Cambria, 2010). One of the focus is on the relationship between achievement orientations and academic performance. A lot of studies reported the significant relationship between achievement orientation with academic achievement in school and university setting (Murayama and Elliot, 2009; Steinmayr and Spinath, 2009). Eventhough much studies has indicated the importance of achievement orientation in the academic context but its relationship with other predictor of academic achievement still not much has been explored Beside that, personal ability to be independent and resilient is much related with academic achievement and academic adjustment. The success adjustment can be seen through students’ learning behavior and their academic achievement. Eventhough cognitive ability is related with academic success however recent research reported that ability to regulate learning has a huge influence on academic performance rather than their IQ (Duckworth and Seligman, 2005). Previous research has been conducted by focusing the influence of self-regulation towards academic achievement but its relationship with academic buoyancy still scarce. SUMMARY In going through the life as a students in school, the challenges, adversities and difficulties are cannot be avoided to be faced. (Martin dan Marsh, 2009). Specific in learning Mathemtics, the nature of the subjects itself and also the negative perception towards the subjects are the big challenges exist among students (Gomez-Chacon, 2000). Moreover, the assessment pressure and feeling of anxiety are another adversities need to be faced by the students throughout their learning process in Mathematics (Arem, 2003; Marzita, 2002). Therefore, exploration on students’ 8 academic buoyancy which related to their capacity to face those challenges is very essential in order to ensure the students are able to achieve the academic goals and persist in their Mathematics learning. Establishing a valid model in predicting academic buoyancy is needed since not much model has existed or validated in previous studies. Therefore the academic buoyancy model as suggested in this study is very relevant. The strong basis of Biggs’ 3P effective learning Model and also the significant of individual characteristic model give a significant value to the proposed model. REFERENCES Anderman, E. M., & Wolters, C. A. (2006). Goals, values, and affect: Influences on student motivation. In P. Alexander & P. Winne (Eds.), Handbook of educational psychology (2nd ed., pp. 369–389). Mahwah, NJ: Erlbaum. Anderman, E. M., Maehr, M. L., & Midgley, C. (1999). Declining motivation after the transition to middle school: Schools can make a difference. Journal of Research and Development in Education, 32, 131-147. Annevirta, T., & Vauras, M. (2006). Developmental changes of metacognitive skill in elementary school children. The Journal of Experimental Education, 74, 197–225. Arem, C. (2003). Conquering Math Anxiety (2nd ed.). USA: Brooks/Cole Baker, L. (2005). Developmental differences in metacognition: implications for metacognitively oriented reading instruction. In S. E. Israel, C. C. Block, K. L. Bauserman, & K. Kinnucan-Welsch (Eds.), Metacognition in literacy learning: Theory, assessment, instruction, and professional development (pp. 61-79). Mahwah, N.J.: L. Erlbaum Associates. Bembenutty, H. (2011). Self-regulated learning: New directions for teaching and learning. Hoboken: John Wiley & Sons. Biggs, J. (2003). Teaching for quality learning at university (2nd ed.). Berkshire, UK: Open University Press. Brown, C. A., & Smith, M. S. (1997). Supporting the development of mathematical pedagogy. The Mathematics Teacher, 9 90(2), 138-143. Butler, D. L. (2002a). Individualizing instruction in self-regulated learning. Theory Into Practice, 41, 81–92. Cleary, T. J., & Zimmerman, B. J. (2004). Self-regulation empowerment program: A schoolbased program to enhance self-regulated and self-motivated cycles of student learning. Psychology in the Schools, 41, 537–550. Corpus, J. H., McClintic-Gilbert, M. S., & Hayenga, A. O. (2009). Within-year changes in children’s intrinsic and extrinsic motivational orientations: Contextual predictors and academic outcomes. Contemporary Educational Psychology, 34, 154–166. Dilworth, R. P. (1966).The Role of Problems in Mathematical Education. In The role of axioms and problem solving in mathematics (pp. 91-97). Washington, DC: The Conference Board of the Mathematics Sciences. Dochy, F. (2001). A new assessment era: Different needs new challenges. Learning and Instruction, 10, 11–20. Duckworth, A. L., & Seligman, M. E. P. (2005). Self-discipline outdoes IQ in predicting academic performance of adolescents. Psychological Science, 16(12), 939–944. Duschl, R., & Grandy, R. (Eds.), (2008). Teaching scientific inquiry: Recommendations for research and implementation. Rotterdam, Netherlands: Sense. Elliot, A. (1999). Approach and avoidance motivation and achievement goals. Educational Psychologist, 34, 169–189. Elliot, A. J. (2005). A conceptual history of the achievement goal construct. In A. J. Elliot & C. S. Dweck (Eds.), Handbook of competence and motivation (pp. 52–72). New York: The Guilford Press. Elliot, A. J., & McGregor, H. A. (2001). A 2 2 achievement goal framework. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 80, 501–519. Elliot, A. J., & Murayama, K. (2008). On the measurement of achievement goals: Critique, illustration, and application. Journal of Educational Psychology, 100, 613–628. Finn, J. D., & Rock, D. A. (1997). Academic success among students at risk for school failure. The Journal of Applied Psychology, 82, 221–234. 10 Gomez Chacon, I. M. (2000). Emotional literacy education mathematics policy: Attitudes, emotions and beliefs. One, 13, 7-22. Heikkila¨ and Lonka, K. (2006). Studying in higher education: Students’ approaches to learning, self-regulation, and cognitive strategies. Studies in Higher Education, 31, 99–117 Hong, E., & Peng, Y. (2008). Do Chinese students’ perceptions of test value affect test performance? Mediating role of motivational and metacognitive regulation in test preparation. Learning and Instruction, 18, 499–512. Maehr, M. L., & Zusho, A. (2009). Achievement goal theory: The past, present, and future. In K. R. Wentzel & A. Wigfield (Eds.), Handbook of motivation at school (pp. 77–104). New York: Taylor Francis. Marsh, H. W. (2007). Self-concept theory, measurement and research into practice: The role of self-concept in educational psychology. Leicester, UK: British Psychological Society. Martin, A. J., & Marsh, H. W. (2006). Academic resilience and its psychological and educational correlates: A construct validity approach. Psychology in the Schools, 43, 267– 281. Martin, A. J., & Marsh, H. W. (2008). Academic buoyancy: Towards an understanding of students' everyday academic resilience. Journal of School Psychology, 46, 53–83. Martin, A. J., & Marsh, H. W. (2009). Academic resilience and academic buoyancy: Multidimensional and hierarchical conceptual framing of causes, correlates and cognate constructs. Oxford Review of Education, 35, 353–370. Martin, A. J., Colmar, S. H., Davey, L. A., & Marsh, H. W. (2010). Longitudinal modeling of academic buoyancy andmotivation: Do the 5Cs hold up over time? The British Journal of Educational Psychology, 80, 473–496. Marzita, P. (2002). Factors Associated with Mathematics Anxiety. Kuala Lumpur: Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Mayer, R. E. (2002). Rote versus meaningful learning. Theory Into Practice, 41, 226-232. Meyer, D. K., & Turner, J. C. (2002). Using instructional discourse analysis to study the scaffolding of student self-regulation. Educational Psychologist, 37(1), 17-25. Miller, S., Connolly, P., & Maguire, L. K. (2013). Wellbeing, academic 11 buoyancy and educational achievement in primary school students. International Jounral of Educational Research, 62, 239-248. Murayama, K., & Elliot, A. J. (2009). The joint influence of personal achievement goals and classroom goal structures on achievement-relevant outcomes. Journal of Educational Psychology, 101, 432−447. Pajares, F. (2001). Toward a positive psychology of academic motivation. The Journal of Educational Research, 95(1), 27-35. Pape, S. J., Bell, C.V., & Yetkin, I. E. (2003). Developing mathematical thinking and selfregulated learning: A teaching experiment in a seventhgrade mathematics classroom. Educational Studies in Mathematics, 53, 179-202. Pintrich, P. R. (2000). Multiple goals, multiple pathways: the role of goal orientation in learning and achievement. Journal of Educational Psychology, 92, 544-555. Pintrich, P. R. (2004). A conceptual framework for assessing motivation and self-regulated learning in college students. Educational Psychology Review, 16, 385–407. Pintrich, P. R., & Schunk, D. (1996). Motivation in education: Theory, research, and applications. Engelwood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall. Pintrich, P. R., & Zusho, A. (2002). The development of academic selfregulation: the role of cognitive and motivational factors. In A. Wigfield, & J. S. Eccles (Eds.), Development of achievement motivation (pp. 249-284). San Diego: Academic Press. PISA Program for International Student Assessment. (2006). Science competencies for tomorrow’s world. Paris: Author. Poldner, E., Simons, P. R. J., Wijngaards, G., & van der Schaaf, M. F. (2012). Quantitative content analysis procedures to analyse students’ reflective essays: A methodological review of psychometric and edumetric aspects. Educational Research Review, 7(1). Putwain, D. W., Connors, L., Symes, W., & Douglas-Osborn, E. (2012). Is academic buoyancy anything more than adaptive coping? Anxiety, Stress & Coping: An International Journal, 25, 349– 358. Rajabi, S. (2012). Towards self-regulated learning in school curriculum. 12 Procedia Social and Behavioral Sciences, 47, 344-350. Resnick, L. (1987). Education and learning to think. Washington DC: National Academy Press. Ryan, A. M., & Patrick, H. (2001). The classroom social environment and changes in adolescents’ motivation and engagement during middle school. American Educational Research Journal, 38, 437-460. Schraw, G. (1998). Promoting general metacognitive awareness. Instructional Science, 26, 113-125 Schraw, G., Crippen, K. J., & Hartley, K. (2006). Promoting selfregulation in science education: metacognition as part of a broader perspective on learning. Research in Science Education, 36, 111-139. Steinmayr, R., & Spinath, B. (2009). The importance of motivation as a predictor of school achievement. Learning and Individual Differences, 19, 80−90. Torenbeek, M., Jansen, E., & Hofman, A. (2010). The effect of the fit between secondary and university education on first-year student achievement. Studies in Higher Education, 35(6), 659– 675. Tuominen-Soini, H., Salmela-Aro, K., & Niemivirta, M. (2008). Achievement goal orientations and subjective well-being: A person-centred analysis. Learning and Instruction, 18, 251–266. Turner, J. C, Midgley, C, Meyer, D.K., Gheen, M., Anderman, E. M., Kang, Y. (2002). The classroom environment and students’ reports of avoidance strategies in mathematics: a multi-method study. Journal of Educational Psychology, 94, 88-106. Usher, E. R., & Pajares, F. (2008). Self-efficacy for self-regulated learning: A validation study. Educational and Psychological Measurement, 68, 443–463. Young, J. W. (2007). Predicting college grades: The value of achievement goals in supplementing ability measures. Assessment in Education, 14, 233–249. Wigfield, A., & Cambria, J. (2010). Students' achievement values, goal orientations, and interest: Definitions, development, and relations to achievement outcomes. Developmental Review, 30, 1−35. Winne, P. H. (2005). A perspective on state-of-the-art research on self- 13 regulated learning. Instructional Science, 33, 559–565. Wolters, C. A. (2004). Advancing achievement goal theory: Using goal structures and goal orientations to predict student’s motivation, cognition, and achievement. Journal of Educational Psychology, 96, 236–250. Zimmerman, B. J. (2002). Becoming a self-regulated learner: An overview. Theory into Practice, 41, 64–70. Zimmerman, B. J. (2008). Investigating self-regulation and motivation: historical background, methodological developments, and future prospects. American Educational Research Journal, 45(1), 166-183. Zimmerman, B. J. (2008a). Investigating self-regulation and motivation: historical background, methodological developments, and future prospects. American Educational Research Journal, 45(1), 166-183. Zohar, A. (2004). Higher order thinking in science classrooms: Students’ learning and teacher’ professional development. The Netherlands: Kluwer Academic Press. 14 PENGARUH KOMPETENSI KEUSAHAWANAN TERHADAP TINGKAHLAKU INOVATIF Mohd. Asri Ispal, Mohd Khata Jabor & Asnul Dahar Minghat ABSTRAK Kajian ini bertujuan untuk mengenalpasti hubungan di antara kompetensi keusahawanan terhadap tingkahlaku inovatif. Responden yang terlibat dalam kajian ini ialah guru praperkhidmatan (pelajar) yang sedang mengikuti pengajian Program Ijazah Sarjana Muda Perguruan (PISMP) di Institut Pendidikan Guru Malaysia (IPG). Seramai 413 orang pelajar PISMP telah dipilih daripada beberapa buah IPG di seluruh Malaysia. Instrumen soal selidik digunakan untuk mendapatkan maklumbalas responden terhadap konstruk-konstruk yang dikaji. Instrumen untuk mengukur konstruk kompetensi keusahawanan telah dibangunkan sendiri oleh pengkaji. Instrumen untuk mengukur tingkahlaku inovatif adalah ubahsuai daripada Messmann & Mulder (2012). Analisis pengesahan faktor peringkat kedua (second order confirmatory factor analysis) digunakan untuk mendapatkan indeks padanan model hipotesis dengan data kajian. Modifikasi model dilakukan untuk mendapatkan nilai indeks padanan yang baik (good fit) dalam menentusahkan model pengukuran konstruk kompetensi keusahawanan dan tingkahlaku inovatif. Semua model pengukuran digabungkan untuk membentuk model persamaan struktural. Dapatan kajian menunjukkan kompetensi keusahawanan 15 mempunyai hubungan langsung yang positif dengan tingkahlaku inovatif. Beberapa implikasi kajian dikemukakan dalam penyelidikan ini khususnya dalam penyediaan bakal guru yang inovatif. Kata kunci: Kompetensi Keusahawanan, Tingkahlaku Inovatif, Pendidikan Guru PENGENALAN Kajian lepas telah membuktikan tingkahlaku inovatif merupakan penyumbang kepada peningkatan prestasi (Chan & Amran, 2014; Bjornali & Storen, 2012; Messmann & Mulder, 2012; Nik Azida et al, 2010). Walau bagaimanapun, dalam konteks pendidikan, kajian terhadap aktiviti yang menjurus kepada tingkahlaku inovatif, penyertaan guru dalam proses dan pembangunan inovasi masih kurang (Messman et al., 2010). Selain itu, guru menghadapi beberapa kekangan untuk meletakkan tingkahlaku inovatif sebagai pencetus kreativiti dan inovasi dalam pengajaran dan pembelajaran di bilik darjah. Nemeržitski et al., (2013) menyatakan bahawa faktor yang menjadi penghalang kepada guru mempamerkan tingkahlaku inovatif ialah persepsi terhadap keyakinan mereka cenderung untuk tidak inovatif. Tujuan kajian ini ialah untuk mengenalpasti pengaruh kompetensi keusahawanan terhadap tingkah laku inovatif. Kajian untuk mengenalpasti kesan kompetensi keusahawanan terhadap tingkah laku inovatif dalam organisasi di semua peringkat amat sedikit dan sukar ditemui dalam literatur (Bjornali & Storen, 2012; Mitchelmore & Rowley, 2010). Berikut ialah kerangka konsep kajian yang dikemukakan: Kompetensi Keusahawanan Rajah 1 : Model hipotesis kajian TIngkahlaku Inovatif 16 KOMPETENSI KEUSAHAWANAN Secara umumnya, kompetensi merupakan piawaian untuk melaksanakan sesuatu tugas dengan spesifik. Konsep kompetensi menggabungkan elemen pengetahuan, kemahiran dan ciri-ciri tertentu yang harus dimiliki oleh seseorang individu untuk melaksanakan tugas yang diarahkan dengan berkesan (Rao, 1997). Kompetensi yang dimiliki oleh seseorang mempunyai hubungan secara langsung dengna prestasi kerja (Rao, 1997; Spencer & Spencer, 1993). Sekiranya seseorang pekerja memiliki kompetensi yang tinggi, maka prestasi kerja yang dihasilkan juga adalah tinggi. Dalam kajian lepas, kompetensi mempunyai banyak definisi (Hayton & McEvoy, 2006; Hoffman, 1999). Istilah “kemahiran”, “kepakaran”, “kepintaran” dan “kecekapan” adalah saling berkaitan dan kerap kali istilah silih berganti (Mitchelmore & Rowley, 2009; Smith & Morse, 2005). Istilah kompetensi asalnya digunakan dalam bidang pendidikan untuk menjelaskan tingkahlaku guru pelatih (Mitchelmore & Rowley, 2009). Istilah itu digunakan secara meluas dan banyak dibincangkan dalam bidang pengurusan terutamanya di Amerika Syarikat (Boyatzis, 1982). Kompetensi tidak dilihat sebagai senarai tugas yang perlu dilaksanakan tetapi lebih kepada kebolehan seseorang dalam melaksanakan tugas yang diberikan. Boyatzis (1982) membangunkan model kompetensi dengan melibatkan dua ribu pengurus dan telah mengenalpasti lebih 100 ciri kompetensi untuk pengurus. Dam et al. (2010) menjelaskan kompetensi sebagai ciriciri peribadi individu yang akan menyumbang kepada prestasi kerja. Dam et al. (2010) mengkelaskan kompetensi keusahawanan kepada tiga dimensi, iaitu pengetahuan, sikap dan kemahiran. Kombinasi ketiga-tiga dimensi kompetensi tersebut diperlukan untuk menghasilkan pencapaian yang cemerlang sebagai usahawan yang berjaya. Walau bagaimanapun, sehingga kini belum ada senarai kompetensi keusahawanan yang boleh digunakan secara sejagat (Man dan Lau, 2000). Terdapat beberapa kajian terdahulu yang mengaitkan keusahawanan dengan pendidikan guru (Norasmah dan Rasmuna, 17 2012; Zaidatol Akmaliah dan Bagheri, 2011; Zaidatol Akmaliah dan Bagheri, 2010; Sarimah et al., 2010; Dam et al., 2010). Kemahiran keusahawanan dalam kalangan warga pendidik adalah mustahak kerana menjanjikan potensi besar dalam membentuk modal insan yang inovatif khususnya apabila berhadapan dengan cabaran pendidikan semasa (Zaidatol Akmaliah dan Bagheri, 2011; Dam et al., 2010). Abd. Rahim et al. (2001) menjelaskan, antara kompetensi keusahawanan yang perlu dibentuk melalui pendidikan keusahawanan ialah keperluan untuk pencapaian, kepimpinan, kreatif, berkeyakinan, mempunyai hubung jalin, berinisiatif, mengambil risiko, berimaginasi dan berkeupayaan menganalisa. Dam et al. (2010) menjelaskan, kompetensi keusahawanan yang releven dengan pendidikan guru untuk membentuk tingkahlaku keusahawanan ialah pengetahuan keusahawanan, efikasi kendiri, pemikiran kreatif, kerja berpasukan, kebolehsuaian dan kemahiran jaringan. Kepentingan penguasaan kompetensi keusahawanan semakin dirasai keperluannya apabila wujud masalah penggangguran yang semakin meruncing (Norasmah dan Rasmuna, 2012). Menurut mereka lagi, pendedahan kompetensi keusahawanan melalui pendidikan memberi peluang yang terbaik kepada pelajar melengkapkan diri dengan pengetahuan dan kemahiran keusahawanan sebelum memasuki pasaran kerjaya. Dalam kajian ini, konstruk kompetensi keusahawanan adalah menggunakan model pendidikan keusahawanan yang dibangunkan oleh Dam et. al. (2010) dan telah diubahsuai berdasarkan konteks pendidikan guru di Malaysia. Konstruk yang dikaji ialah pengetahuan asas keusahawanan, pemikiran kreatif, kebolehsuaian, kemahiran jaringan dan komunikasi. Kombinasi kompetensi tersebut diperlukan oleh seseorang guru dalam usaha untuk membentuk intelektual, emosi, sosial dan semangat pelajar (Ali et al., 2012). Penyelidik telah membangunkan item-item soal selidik untuk mengukur setiap konstruk tersebut. 18 TINGKAHLAKU INOVATIF Tingkahlaku inovatif didefinisikan sebagai aktiviti yang dilakukan oleh seseorang sepanjang proses inovasi (Messmann et al., 2010). Menurut Janssen (2000), tingkahlaku inovatif merupakan perlakuan seseorang untuk melakukan sesuatu kreativiti dan inovasi yang melangkaui jangkaan termasuklah penerimaan, penghasilan dan pelaksanaan idea-idea baharu. Kanter (1988) mendakwa bahawa langkah pertama setiap proses inovasi ialah mengenalpasti peluang dalam konteks yang pelbagai merangkumi rakan-rakan, penyelia, pelanggan, peraturan, sumber, kemudahan, peralatan dan kewangan. Oleh itu, ruang lingkup peluang merangkumi daripada bahagian yang kecil sehinggalah keseluruhan organisasi. Peluang wujud apabila terdapat keinginan untuk membangunkan sesuatu perkara. Dalam konteks pendidikan, Messmann et al. (2010) menjelaskan bahawa tingkahlaku inovatif merangkumi aktiviti luar dan dalam bilik darjah yang berkaitan dengan inovasi iaitu penerokaan peluang, penjanaan idea, promosi idea, dan merealisasikan idea. Tingkah laku inovatif boleh jadi kaedah pengajaran baharu, perubahan dalam proses kerja seorang guru dan pelajar, kolaborasi dalam kalangan guru ataupun tugas baharu guru. Tingkah laku inovatif tidak hanya berlaku semasa aktiviti pengajaran dan pembelajaran di dalam bilik darjah sahaja tetapi merangkumi konteks yang luas iaitu juga di luar bilik darjah (Tuomi, 2007). Aktiviti-aktiviti tersebut adalah mengenalpasti idea-idea baru untuk menangani cabaran dan menghadapi masalah di sekolah sebagai fungsi utama. Interaksi dalam kalangan pelajar dalam saling menyokong antara satu dengan yang lain sangat mempengaruhi dalam merealisasikan idea (Jong & Hartog, 2010; Janssen et al., 2004; Kleysen & Street, 2001; Scott & Bruce, 1994). 19 METODOLOGI Sampel Kajian Seramai 413 orang pelajar PISMP semester 6 telah dipilih di enam IPG di seluruh Malaysia. Instrumen Kajian Instrumen soal selidik digunakan untuk mendapatkan maklumbalas responden terhadap konstruk-konstruk yang dikaji. Instrumen untuk mengukur konstruk kompetensi keusahawanan telah dibangunkan sendiri oleh pengkaji, manakala instrumen tingkahlaku inovatif ubahsuai daripada Messmann & Mulder (2012). Analisis Kajian Analisis pengesahan faktor peringkat kedua (second order confirmatory factor analysis) digunakan untuk mendapatkan indeks padanan model hipotesis dengan data kajian. Modifikasi model dilakukan untuk mendapatkan nilai indeks padanan yang baik (good fit) dalam menentusahkan model pengukuran konstruk kompetensi keusahawanan, tingkahlaku inovatif dan seterusnya membentuk model persamaan struktural (SEM). Semua model pengukuran digabungkan dalam analisis SEM untuk menentusahkan padanan model akhir dengan data kajian. DAPATAN KAJIAN Analisis diskriptif Bilangan sampel kajian ialah 413 orang pelajar PISMP semester 7 di enam IPG seluruh Malaysia. Daripada jumlah tersebut, 162 orang (39.2%) lelaki dan 251 orang (60.8%) perempuan. Bilangan 20 pelajar yang mengkhusus dalam bidang Reka Bentuk dan Teknologi (RBT) ialah 124 orang (30%). Manakala pelajar yang mengkhusus dalam bidang selain RBT ialah 289 orang ataupun 70%. Model Pengukuran Konstruk Kompetensi Keusahawanan *kr – pemikiran kreatif; kp – kerja berpasuka; nt – jaringan; ad – kebolehsuaian; pn - pengetahuan Rajah 1 : Model PengukuranKompetensi Keusahawanan Rajah 1 menunjukkan model pengukuran bagi konstruk kompetensi keusahawanan setelah melalui modifikasi untuk mendapatkan nilai padanan. Petunjuk padana ialah Chi Square/df = 2.373, RMSEA = 0.058, CFI = 0.945, TLI = 0.938, dan GFI = 0.904 menunjukkan padanan yang baik model modifikasi dengan data kajian. 21 Model Pengukuran Konstruk Tingkahlaku Inovatif *MPeluang – mengenalpasti peluang; MjIdea – menjana idea;MrIdea – merealisasikan idea Rajah 2 : Model Pengukuran Tingkahlaku Inovatif Rajah 2 menunjukkan model pengukuran bagi konstruk tingkahlaku inovatif setelah melalui modifikasi untuk mendapatkan nilai padanan. Petunjuk padana ialah Chi Square/df = 1.260, RMSEA = 0.025, CFI = 0.935, TLI = 0.922, dan GFI = 0.965 menunjukkan padanan yang baik model modifikasi dengan data kajian. Setelah modifikasi model dilakukan, dimensi mempromosikan idea telah digugurkan kerana mempunyai nilai multikolineariti yang tinggi dengan dimensi lain. Dimensi yang dikekalkan untuk analisis seterusnya ialah mengenalpasti peluang, menjana idea dan merealisasikan idea. 22 Analisis Persamaan Struktur Rajah 3 menunjukkan model persamaan struktur setelah melalui proses modifikasi. Nilai petunjuk padanan model akhir ialah, Chi Square/df = 2.637, RMSEA = 0.063, CFI = 0.988, TLI = 0.978, dan GFI = 0.982 menunjukkan padanan yang baik model modifikasi dengan data kajian. Nilai R2 = 0.67 menunjukkan bahawa 67% varians tingkahlaku inovatif pelajar PISMP dapat dijelaskan oleh kompetensi keusahawanan. Nilai β = 0.82 untuk analisis kesan langsung Kompetensi Keusahawanan terhadap Tingkahlaku Inovatif. Dimensi (sub-konstruk) tingkahlaku inovatif dalam model asal terdiri daripada mengenalpasti peluang, menjana idea, mempromosi idea, dan merealisasikan idea. Dimensi menjana idea digugurkan setelah modifikasi model untuk mendapatkan nilai padanan yang baik (good fit). Dimensi untuk konstruk kompetensi keusahawanan kekal seperti model asal. Rajah 3: Model Akhir 23 PERBINCANGAN DAN KESIMPULAN Tujuan kajian ini dilakukan ialah untuk mengenalpasti hubungan kompetensi keusahawanan dan efikasi kendiri dengan tingkahlaku inovatif. Secara umumnya, keputusan daripada analisis kajian menunjukkan bahawa kompetensi keusahawanan dan efikasi kendiri mempunyai hubungan secara langsung yang positif. Dapatan daripada analisis ini mengesahkan dapatan kajian terdahulu iaitu kompetensi keusahawanan yang terdiri daripada pengetahuan, kemahiran dan sikap keusahawanan (Allen & van der Velden, 2011; Mitchelmore & Rowley, 2010) akan menyumbang kepada pembentukan tingkah laku inovatif (Bjornali & Storen, 2012). Individu yang memiliki kompetensi keusahawanan sentiasa kreatif dalam meneroka dan membangunkan idea inovatif dan mengenalpasti peluang-peluang keusahawanan (Shook et al., 2003) mempunyai potensi untuk beroleh kejayaan melalui pengeksploitasian produk, perkhidmatan dan proses yang baru (Zahra et al., 1999). Kajian ini memberi implikasi dalam penyediaan pelajar PISMP khususnya untuk melahirkan bakal guru yang kompeten dan inovatif. Elemen pendidikan keusahawanan untuk membentuk kompetensi keusahawanan perlu diterapkan sama ada secara formal ataupun tidak formal. Pelajar yang tidak berpeluang mengkhusus dalam mata pelajaran RBT sebagai major dicadangkan mengambil kursus keusahawanan sebagai mata pelajaran elektif. Selain itu, penyertaan dalam aktiviti kokurikulum yang menjurus kepada aktiviti keusahawanan perlu juga diberi penekanan. Kesimpulannya, pendidikan keusahawanan perlu diterapkan dalam kurikulum pendidikan guru kerana mempunyai kesan langsung terhadap pembentukan pelajar yang memiliki tingkah laku inovatif. 24 RUJUKAN Abd. Rahim Bakar, Zaidatol akmaliah Lope Pihie, Mohd. Majid Konting & Genevieve Klang Angking. (2001). The Perceived Entrepreneurial Characteristics of Malaysian Living Skill Teachers: Implication for Teacher Preparation Programme. Pertanica J. Soc. Sci. & Hum. 9(2) pp 123-129 Ali K., Zohreh, S., & Nia R.G. (2012). The indoor school professional development project and teachers professional competency. Procedia-Social and Behavioral Sciences. 46, pp 998-1001. Bjornali, E.S. & Storen, L.A. (2012). Examining competence factors that encourage innovative behaviour by European higher education graduate professionals. Journal of Small Business and Enterprise Development. Vol 19 No 3 pp 403-423. Boyatzis, R. (1982). The competent manager:A Model for Effective Performance. New York:Wiley. Chan, T.L. & Amran Rasli. (2014). The relationship between innovative work behaviour on work role performance: an empirical study. Social and Behavioral Sciences, 129, pp 592-600. Dam, K.V., Schipper, M., & Runhaar, P. (2010). Developing a competency-based framework for teachers’ entrepreneurial behavior. Teaching and Teacher Education. 26. pp 965-971. Hayton, J.C. & McEvoy, M. (2006). Guest editor’s note. Human Resource Management. 45(3), pp 291-294. Hoffman, T (1999). The meaning of competency. Journal of European Industrial Training. 23(6). pp 275-285. Janssen, O. (2000). Job demands, perceptions of effort-reward fairness and innovative behaviour. Journal of Occupational and Organisational Psychology, 73, pp 287-302. Janssen, O., Van de Vliert, E., & West, M. (2004). The bright and dark sides of individual and group innovation: A special issue introduction. Journal of Organisational Behavior, 25, pp 129145. Jong, J.E., & Hartog, D. (2010). Measuring innovative work behaviour. Creativity and Innovation Management. 19(1), pp 23-36. Kanter, R.M. (1988). When a thousand flowers bloom: structural, collective and social conditions for innovation in organizations. Research in Organizational Behaviour, 10, pp 169-211. Kleysen, R. B & Street, C.T. (2001). Toward a multi-dimensional 25 measure of individual innovative behaviour. Journal of Intellectual Capital. 2(3), pp 284-296. Man, T.W.Y. & Lau, T. (2000), Entrepreneurial competencies of SME owner/managers in the Hong Kong services sector: a qualitative analysis, Journal of Enterprising Culture, 8()3, pp. 235-54. Messmann, G. & Mulder, R.H. (2012). Development of a measurement instrument for innovative work behaviour as a dynamic and context-bound construct. Human Resource Development International. 15(1), pp 43-59. Messmann, G., Mulder, R.H., & Gruber, H. (2010). Relations between vocational teachers’ characteristics of professionalism and their innovative work behavior. Emperical Research in Vocational Education and Training. 2(1), pp 21-40. Mitchelmore, S. & Rowley, J. (2009). Entrepreneurial competencies: a literature review and development agenda. International Journal of Entrepreneurial Behaviour & Research. 16(2), pp 92-111. Nemeržitski, S., Loogma, K., Heinla, E., & Eisenschmidt. (2013). Constructing model of teachers’ innovative behaviour in school environment. Teachers and Teaching: Theory and Practice. 19(4), pp 398-418. Nik Azida Abd Ghani, Tengku Ahmad Badrul Raja Hussin & Kamaruzaman Jusoff. (2009). The impact of psychological empowerment on lecturers’ innovative behaviour in Malaysian private higher education institutions. Canadian Social Science. 5(4), pp 54-62 Norasmah Othman & Rasmuna Hussain. (2012). Evaluation of the implementation of the Module Basic of Entrepreneurship in College Community Ministry of Higher Education. 2nd International Conference on Economics, Trade and Development IPEDR. 36. pp 96-100. Rao, M.S. (1997). The entrepreneurial competency index: an assessment tools for financial institutions. Journal of Entrepreneurship, 6(197), pp 197-208. Reuvers, M., Van Engen, M.L., Vinkenburg, C.J., & Wilson-Evered, E. (2008). Transformational leadership and innovative work behaviour: exploring the relevance of gender differences. Creativity and Innovation Management, 17(3), pp 227-244. 26 Sarimah Che Hassan, Norlizah Che Hassan & Nor Aisyah Buang. (2010). Penguasaan kemahiran insaniah (kemahiran keusahawanan) dalam kalangan guru sekolah di Malaysia. Proceedings of the 4th International Conference on Teacher Education: Join Conference UPI & UPSI, Bandung, Indonesi, 810 Nov. 2010. Scott, S.G., & Bruce, R.A. (1994). Determinations of innovative behavior: a path model of individual innovation in the workplace. Academy of Management Journal. 37, pp 580-607. Smith, B. & Morse, E. (2005). Entrepreneurial Competencies: A Literatur Review and Best Practices. Small Business Policy Branch, Industry Canada, Ottawa. Shook, C.L., Priem, R.L. & McGee, J.E. (2003). Venture creation and the enterprising individual: A review and synthesis. Journal of Management. 29 (3), pp 379-399. Spencer, L. & Spencer, S. (1993). Competence at work: Model for Superior Performance. Wiley, New York. Tuomi, I. (2007). Learning in the age of networked intelligence. European Journal of Education. 42, pp 235-254 Zaidatol Akmaliah Lope Pilie & Bagheri, A. (2010). Entrepreneurial Attitude and Entrepreneurial Efficacy of technical secondary school students.Journal of Vocational Education & Training, 62(3), pp 351-366. Zaidatol Akmaliah Lope Pilie & Bagheri, A. (2011). Teachers’ and students’ entrepreneurial self-efficacy: Implication for effective teaching practice. Procedia-Social and Behavioral Sciences. 29. pp 1071-1080 27 A MYOPIC COMPARATIVE REVIEW BETWEEN FIVEFACTOR MODEL AND HEXACO MODEL OF HUMAN PERSONALITY Mahtab Ghadimi & Mohd Tajudin Ninggal ABSTRACT The HEXACO model of personality has been suggested as an alternative to the Five-Factor Model. Results indicated that although the sixth factor of HEXACO model, Honesty-Humility was largely dissimilar to domains of the Big Five, it was significantly correlated with the Agreeableness factor of the FiveFactor model. However, the advantage of HEXACO model in predicting the personality traits over the Five-Factor model is still under the discussion by researchers. Therefore, this comparative review was aimed to investigate whether the benefits of HEXACO model are better than the Five-Factor Model? The conclusion indicates although the Honesty-Humility factor is more correlated with the normal human personality traits, there are strong correlations between the factors of both models. There is still the requirement to further studies which focus more on the FFM and HEXACO model. Keywords: FFM, NEO-PI-R, HEXACO model 28 INTRODUCTION The Five Factor Model (FFM) is based on the classic Big Five in psychology to study the normal human personality. However, both the FFM and Big Five are not identical (Weiner et al., 2012). Classic Big Five and FFM structures are different in the content of Agreeableness factor (Veselka et al., 2011). There has been some confusion among researchers that equate the FFM and Big Five in their studies. Several studies have been carried out to compare the advantages of new models with the Big Five in relation to understanding the personality traits. For example, the comparative studies of HEXACO model with the Big Five found that HEXACO model has more advantages in predicting personality traits (Lee et al., 2005). The difference between the Big Five and FFM models raises the question of whether the achieved results from previous studies on the HEXACO and the Big Five would be same with the studies of the HEXACO and FFM? Furthermore, another reason that makes this issue most unclear is the Agreeableness factor of the FFM. The Agreeableness factor of the FFM is more likely to be correlated to the additional factor of the HEXACO model; “Honesty-Humility.” Accordingly, there are many unclear issues on the HEXACO advantages over the FFM specifically on the Honesty-Humility factor that should be addressed. FFM and NEO-PI-R By 1980, when the groundbreaking researches in the area of personality structure by Tupes and Christal (1961), and also Warren Norman (1963) were extremely forgotten, Lewis Goldberg started an English language lexically-based investigation of the personality factors. Through the study, five dimensions of personality which are known as the Big five were discovered once again (Goldberg, 1990). The Big Five factors are as follows: Extraversion, Agreeableness, Conscientiousness, Neuroticism, and 29 Openness to Experience. In the meanwhile, Costa and McCrae (1985) created a theory based on the Big Five and called it Five Factor Model (FFM). Since the Big Five and FFM were empirical models and were not the results of a personality theory or clinical experience, study on the human personality variation and its structure was continued in the area concerning usefulness of Big Five as assessing instruments of normal personality traits for clinical evaluation. Finally, the study of Paul Costa and Robert McCrae who had strongly emphasized on practicality of the Big Five and FFM measures in clinical issues gained popularity among other researches (Costa and McCrae, 1992). In particular when they introduced both the term and concept of “facet” as a feature of a broader personality trait for only three traits out of five including Neuroticism, Extraversion, and Openness To Experience (i.e. NEO Personality Inventory; NEO-PI). They expanded the study on “facet scales” for an additional seven years to elaborate such facet scales for other two traits, Agreeableness and Conscientiousness within the Revised NEO-PI that is known as NEO-PI-R (Costa and McCrae, 1992). The NEO-PI-R is a measuring instrument comprising five major domains, which are broken up into six facets that describe each domain as mentioned in Table 1. Even though the FFM was itself an inventory to predict the personality traits, it was too difficult to bring them in a single definition of a specific trait since the factors were too broad. In addition, since the factors were descriptive, they cannot be evaluated by a detailed trait. Hence, Costa and McCrae measured the FFM by NEO-PI-R to facilitate the psychological understanding of the personality. Consequently, the FFM and NEO-PI-R are the same measuring instruments as far as the personality traits are concerned. It is worth to note that the NEO-PI-R is an international gold standard for assessing the personality. Costa and McCrae not only developed the “facet scales” for the Big Five factors, but also McCrae (1992) expressed three specific and illustrative objects why such measures are in clinical attention: i. Three important factors of human behavior; interpersonal, 30 emotional and motivational styles are under the assessing of personality by the FFM factors that are relevant in detection of broad range of other disorders. ii. A comprehensive image of each person can be obtained by the FFM that cannot be gained by other instruments that are concern with the clinical issues. iii. Some supplementary information, which is important in choosing an appropriate treatment and in predicting the circulation of therapy, can be delivered by five factors. Table 1. NEO-PI-R Factors of Personality Neuroticism Extraversion Openness Agreeableness Conscientiousness Anxiety Warmth Fantasy Trust Competence Angry Hostility Gregariousness Aesthetics Straightforwardness Order Depression Assertiveness Feelings Altruism Dutifulness SelfConsciousness Activity Actions Compliance Achievement Striving Impulsiveness ExcitementSeeking Ideas Modesty Self-Discipline Although, the FFM and NEO Personality Inventory became very popular among psychology researchers in 1990s, the gap of personality models structure (whether or not the FFM can be recover within other language communities) was still under discussion by cross-cultural lexically-based researches through several language communities. Eventually, some achieved findings indicated that the domain of the FFM is not expanded as wide as the space of personality structure (Ashton and Lee, 2005; Ashton and Lee, 2008). Accordingly, Ashton developed the six-factor model that was the result of cross-language investigation. 31 HEXACO Model In 2004, the six dimensional model known as HEXACO model was emerged to the aim of developing personality models (Ashton and Lee, 2005). The HEXACO is an acronym name taken from the basis of the number and names of six factors including HonestyHumility, Emotionality, Extraversion, Agreeableness, Conscientiousness, and Openness to Experience. Each of the domains includes four subordinate dimensions, which contains items that measure both trait and opposite of it as shown in Table 2. Table 2. HEXACO factors of personality Honesty– Humility Emotionality Extraversion Agreeable ness Conscientiou sness Sincerity Fearfulness Expressiveness Forgiveness Organization Anxiety Social boldness Gentleness Fairness Greed– Avoidance Dependence Sociability Flexibility Modesty Sentimentality Liveliness Patience Diligence Perfectionism Prudence Openness to Experience Aesthetic appreciation Inquisitiveness Creativity Unconventionality As it can be seen, the three factors of HEXACO model (Extraversion, Conscientiousness, and Openness to Experience) are very similar to the same three factors of FFM/NEO-PI-R. Three other factors of the cross-language model have some complex relations with the FFM dimensions. The HEXACO Agreeableness includes the element of Gentleness the same facet of FFM Agreeableness as well as the elements of Anger-related traits that are facets of FFM Neuroticism. Whereas, the HEXACO Emotionality shares the common factor of Anxiety with FFM Neuroticism, it is the lack of Anger-related traits of Neuroticism. Moreover, it comprises the content related to Sentimentality that typically defines the FFM Agreeableness. The sixth and additional factor is Honesty-Humility that contains Modesty and Sincerity the same facets with the FFM Agreeableness. In general, this factor is not clearly represented in the FFM/NEO-PI-R (Lee et al., 2005). 32 According to the above mentioned differences between the FFM/NEO-PI-R and HEXACO model, and also the achieved results of some comparative studies of the Big Five and HEXACO models which had concluded the HEXACO model is more predictive than the Big Five, it is expected that studies on different variables by HEXACO model deliver more relations with the normal personality traits than studies of the FFM/NEO-PI-R (Lee et al., 2005; Ashton and Lee, 2008; Veselka et al., 2011; Lee and Ashton, 2014). As a result, This review aims to discuss about the aforementioned expectation. Honesty-Humility Factor Honesty-Humility factor is the main reason for the predictive advantages of the HEXACO as a theoretical interpretation of human personality variation (Bourdage et al., 2007; de Vries et al., 2008). The Honesty-Humility factor of the HEXACO model assesses individual personality differences through four subscale traits refer to Table 2. This factor has been developed to predict some traits such as failure to perform a duty in workplace, creativity, risk-taking behaviour, desire for revenge, and some other behaviour of life outcomes that are out of the Big Five prediction. This factor defined by Sincerity (i.e. measuring a person’s tendency to be honest or dishonest in his/her dealing with others), Lack of Greed (i.e. measuring a person’s tendency to obtain wealth), Fairness (i.e. measuring a person’s tendency to use deceit on somebody or cheating), and Modesty (i.e. measuring a person’s beliefs about her/his behaviour in communications). Consequently, however there is a negligible correlation between Honesty-Humility factor and classic Big Five, the correlation between the sixth factor of the HEXACO model and the Agreeableness factor of FFM/NEO-PI-R is higher (Lee et al., 2013). In fact, the Straightforwardness and the Modesty facets of NEO-PI-R Agreeableness are the chief reason of this correlation. Regarding these diverse correlations that are arisen by the 33 effect of Honesty-Humility factor, it is reasonable to expect that the results of comparative studies on the HEXACO model and Big Five can be different from studies on the HEXACO model and FFM/NEO-PI-R. Due to this reason and other the reasons mentioned in the previous sections, the following review just focused on the studies that never mentioned the Big Five as the same model with FFM. Thus, through the present study, only surveys are reviewed that compared the predictive advantages of the HEXACO model over the FFM as well as the NEO-PI-R. RELATED STUDIES The research summarized above demonstrates the brief explanation of the similarities and differences of the FFM with two other models including classic Big Five and HEXACO. The FFM Agreeableness construct is the much broader scope of the Big Five Agreeableness domain as well as the NEO-PI-R is strongly correlated with Honesty-Humility factor of HEXACO model in two facets including Straightforwardness and Modesty. It represents the NEO-PI-R is a combination of the classic Big Five Agreeableness and of the HEXACO Honesty-Humility factor. Therefor, according to these noteworthy points it is inferred that the FFM in predicting variables of personality operates identical or more similar to the HEXACO model. Accordingly, applying the HEXACO, as a replacement model of the FFM, cannot produce more advantages over the FFM/NEO-PI-R. Furthermore, the HEXACO Honesty-Humility factor can be omitted. Consequently, some few related studies have undertaken. Ashton and Lee (2005) compared the Agreeableness factor of FFM/NEO-PI-R and the Honesty-Humility of HEXACO model with two personality variables including the Self-Monitoring scale (Snyder, 1974) and the Social Adroitness scale (Jackson, 1970). The results for both models indicated the correlation number (r) 0.46 and 0.26 for Honesty-Humility and Agreeableness factor, respectively. On the other hand, the more association with the 34 composite of the Self-Monitoring and Social Adroitness is obtained by the combination of the Straightforwardness and Modesty facets of NEO-PI-R Agreeableness (r = 0.44). It indicates that the Straightforwardness and Modesty facets of the NEO-PI-R Agreeableness factor might be applied instead of Honesty– Humility factor of HEXACO model. There is another study that assessed the Egoism personality trait through three studies by both of three scales and of three measures including DPQ Egoism, SPI Egotism, and Egoism Scale, and HEXACO, BIG FIVE, NEO-PIR, respectively (de Vries et al., 2009). The results of the survey indicate that the Honesty-Humility factor of HEXACO has more association with prediction of Egoism. Especially, in last study in which the NEO-PI-R is applied, the HEXACO model shows (41%) variance in Egoism that is more than variance of NEO-PI-R (32%) in Egoism. With regard to the results, the Honesty-Humility is more related to Egoism than other factors of HEXACO and NEOPI-R. Additionally, It is worth to note that this research revealed strong correlation between the NEO-PI-R and HEXACO factors: Conscientiousness (r = 0.82), Extraversion (r = 0.80), Openness to Experience (r = 0.75), and the strong relation between NEO-PI-R Agreeableness with both the HEXACO Honesty–Humility (r = 0.53) and Agreeableness (r = 0.57). Correspondingly, the strong correlation is found between Neuroticism of NEO-PI-R with HEXACO Emotionality (r = 0.64), and Extraversion (r = 0.55) and Agreeableness (r = 0.36). Ashton and Lee (2008) investigated a study to find that whether the achieved outcomes of comparative studies on the Big Five and HEXACO model would be same as results from study on the HEXACO and FFM? The predictive advantages for HEXACO model over the Big Five are concluded by many studies, but it is not too clear yet in the area concerning of the FFM. Ashton and Lee investigated three samples of undergraduate students by the FFM and HEXACO personality variables with various criteria. Generally, the FFM predictors gained lower multiple correlations with the various criteria than the HEXACO predictors with values ranging from 0.31 to 0.53 for the first model and from 0.39 to 0.71 for the second one. The authors 35 claimed that the Honesty-Humility factor is the main reason of the privilege of HEXACO model. They have also investigated another study with Bourdage in 2007 to examine the relations of the sexuality variables with personality dimensions of the FFM and HEXACO model. The outcomes of the study show similar level of correlations for both personality models with the sexuality variables. However, there are some predictive advantages of HEXACO model in Sexual Attractiveness, Relationship Exclusivity, and Sociosexuality. CONCLUSIONS The purpose of this paper was to compare two common personality models comprising the Five Factor Model and Six Factor Model (HEXACO) to clarify some misconceptions regarding Big Five and FFM. In this area, there are many studies in which the Big Five and the FFM were assumed identical then they have been compared with the HEXACO model. Consequently, they assumed that the results are identical for both the Big Five and FFM. While, the FFM is a theory of classic Big Five that is measured by NEOPI-R. Since such studies cannot transfer reliable outcomes, further comparative investigations on the FFM and HEXACO model are required. Apart from that the advantages of the sixth factor of the HEXACO over the FFM factors are still unclear. The results of related studies indicated that all factors of FFM and HEXACO as well as the Honesty-Humility factor are correlated. So, are there any predictive advantages of the Honesty-Humility factor over the five factors of FFM? With regards to the related comparative studies, results are partially similar in multiple correlations of two models with variables under the investigation. On the other hand, some outcomes in the same studies show high advantages for both the Honesty-Humility factor and the rest factors of HEXACO model. In conclusion, there is still a need to further studies which focus more on the FFM and HEXACO model than the Big Five. 36 REFERENCES Ashton, M. C. and Lee, K. (2005). Honesty-Humility, the Big Five, and the Five-Factor Model. Journal of Personality, 73(5): 13211354. Ashton, M. C. and Lee, K. (2008). The prediction of Honesty–Humilityrelated criteria by the HEXACO and Five-Factor Models of personality. Journal of Research in Personality, 42(5): 12161228. Bourdage, J. S., Lee, K., Ashton, M. C. and Perry, A. (2007). Big Five and HEXACO model personality correlates of sexuality. Personality and Individual Differences, 43(6): 1506-1516. Costa, P. T. and McCrae, R. R. (1992). Revised NEO Personality Inventory. de Vries, R. E., de Vries, A., de Hoogh, A. and Feij, J. (2009). More than the Big Five: Egoism and the HEXACO model of personality. European Journal of Personality, 23(8): 635-654. de Vries, R. E., Lee, K. and Ashton, M. C. (2008). The Dutch HEXACO Personality Inventory: Psychometric Properties, Self–Other Agreement, and Relations With Psychopathy Among Low and High Acquaintanceship Dyads. Journal of Personality Assessment, 90(2): 142-151. Goldberg, L. R. (1990). An Alternative "Description of Personality": The Big-Five Factor Structure. Journal of Personality and Social Psychologs, 59(6): 1216-1229. Lee, K. and Ashton, M. C. (2014). The Dark Triad, the Big Five, and the HEXACO model. Personality and Individual Differences, 67(0): 2-5. Lee, K., Ashton, M. C., Wiltshire, J., Bourdage, J. S., Visser, B. A. and Gallucci, A. (2013). Sex, power, and money: Prediction from the Dark Triad and Honesty–Humility. European Journal of Personality, 27(2): 169-184. Lee, K., Ogunfowora, B. and Ashton, M. C. (2005). Personality Traits Beyond the Big Five: Are They Within the HEXACO Space? Journal of Personality, 73(5): 1437-1463. Veselka, L., Schermer, J. A. and Vernon, P. A. (2011). Beyond the Big Five: The Dark Triad and the Supernumerary Personality Inventory. Twin Research and Human Genetics, 14(02): 158168. 37 Weiner, I. B., Tennen, H. A. and Suls, J. M. (2012). Handbook of Psychology, Personality and Social Psychology. Wiley. 38 HOLISTIC APPROACH FOR CORRECTIONAL EDUCATION IN TVET: HATCHING THE HACE IN PRISON EDUCATION Muhamad Afzamiman Aripin, Rohana Hamzah, Ros Eliana Ahmad Zuki & Akhmal Annas Hasmori ABSTRACT Our nation efforts towards developed country and maintain the sustainability of economy requires a very good preparation from every single aspect. It should be considering every level in our society including those who have been detained in prison. This article discuss about Holistic Approach in Correctional Education (HACE) module that will be developed for Technical and Vocational Education and Training (TVET) instructors in prison. The discussion of this paper try to figure out the importance of improving instructors professionalism in prison education, suggesting possible solution, proposing elements for improvement, methodology of evaluation and research expectation. It is a big hope that HACE module will help instructors to merge the acquired knowledge and spiritual growth in a single lesson and thus assist in increasing self-quality among detainees under Malaysian Prison Department (JPM) supervision. Keywords: Holistic Approach, Correctional Education, TVET, 39 Prison Education. INTRODUCTION Prison correctional education is an important agenda in our nation as to ensure our human capitals to be saved, protected, utilised and not wasted. In the Theory of Development by Ibnu Khaldun, human capitals were seen as an important resource to guarantee the sustainability of a nation development. They should be inculcated with a strong values and high morality in order to create a peace environment and strong economic growth for a long run (Syed Omar, 2008). Due to that responsibility, the role of cultivating values and morality should be done by everyone under correctional system including the vocational instructors. In Malaysia, research on prison TVET instructors is relatively new. Their roles under the correctional program should not be denied as they are the people that trained the prisoners and occupied them with vocational knowledge and skills to be applied once released. However teaching skills are not enough for those who are dealing with prisoners. Gehring and Puffer (2006) assert that the instructors need to be occupied with other knowledge as well, especially on how to develop the self-quality of prisoners and thus could reduce recidivism cases. UNDERSTANDING MALAYSIAN CONTEXT Prison in Malaysia is under management of Malaysia Prison Department (JPM). Meanwhile, the instructors in JPM were known as Vocational Training Assistance Officer (PPLV) and assisted by Trade Warder. In general, the job scope for PPLV is to teach the detainees with vocational skills based on National Occupational Skills Standard (NOSS), doing some maintenance and management works, checking the quality standard of products, and perform continuous assessment and evaluation (JPM, 2014). It shows that the existing correctional programme with vocational 40 orientation merely concern on skills, teaching, management, maintenance and just to support the prison needs. Therefore, this finding support Gehring and Puffer (2006) concern on lacking of focus on self-quality development under prison correctional programme. Without denying the importance of current PPLV job scope, it is believe that their professionalism could be increased by adding them with a proper knowledge based on their context and challenging nature of work. Preliminary study discovered that, PPLV and Trade Warder have a qualification and knowledge of vocational content and provided with standard operational procedure (SOP) while giving instruction and delivering the skills. In term of teaching ability, they were trained under CIAST (Centre for Instructor and Advance Skill Training), a government institution that trained Vocational Training Officer all over Malaysia. This is an indicator that the vocational instructors in prison are having the same knowledge as instructors from other institutions while they are actually dealing with a more challenging task of developing skills as well as the self-quality of detainees. Research by Fauziah et al. (2013) revealed that there is an urgent call to support the development of self-quality among prisoners in term of religious knowledge, spiritual wellness, physical and emotional stability. This is to ensure that the correctional system is successful in achieving their objectives. Therefore JPM requires vocational instructors who are exposed and understand the purpose of correctional education and enable to connect skills ability, social and religious responsibility in their teaching. Current system has put emphasis on spiritual, physical and emotional development with a lot of improvement from back then. Unfortunately, there is still a need to improve the self-quality of detainees in our prison. It is essential to understand that selfquality could be expanded in many ways. However, there is an opportunity to cover the element by improving vocational instructors’ ability by exposing them to the holistic approach and special education needs for prisoners. Therefore this paper will try 41 to figure out the elements of Holistic Approach for Correctional Education (HACE) in TVET to suit the prison context and thus help instructors to merge acquired knowledge and the spiritual growth in a single lesson. POSSIBLE SOLUTION Effort on integrating acquired knowledge and revealed knowledge holistically has been done by many educational researchers from all over the world. It is often immerged in Muslim scholars’ philosophy in the East. While in Western country, people tend to see these as integrating the spiritual values into education. Nevertheless, there is no doubt that human spirituality which is often found in religion, is a great driven factor to develop one’s self (Miller, 2008). Integration theories of spiritual values in modern Western civilisation can be traced in the works of Ken Wilber and Miller. For example Wilber postulates that religion and science could be integrated through his proposed AQAL (All Quadrants All Level) model. However, it is very subjective to explain how the integration work since science and religion were seen in different perspectives for every individual (Clayton and Simpson, 2006). In correctional education field, Puffer and Gehring (2006) have re-introduced AQAL model to be applied in the whole prison correctional system including for the instructors. The proposed model emphasised on how the internal factors and spirituality of an instructor could affect external elements in a system such as the objectives of teaching and learning, the system sociology, and culturing a professional thinking. 42 Figure 1 AQAL model for prison’s instructors (Gehring and Puffer, 2006) At the very beginning, an instructor in prison needs to have a strong motivation to carry out his or her task. It is about managing the internal part or spirituality which is very abstract like emotions, feelings, thoughts and thinking. These are often known as selfawareness (Gehring and Puffer, 2006). It is believe that by having a good self-awareness, one will be able to teach and deliver the knowledge in any circumstances, able to use appropriate strategies in teaching activity to meet prison’s correctional objectives, able to manage resources in the system, and link the correctional themes in the every single lesson. However, there is no elaborate discussion on how to ignite the self-awareness. Does religion could supply this? How will it look like when we put it into Malaysian context? HATCHING THE HACE FROM AQAL MODEL Holistic approach and concern on spirituality from West is to embrace the morale issues immerged in today’s society. Some were taken from Christianity, Buddhism, Hinduism and Islam. Spirituality and religious practices help a lot in integrating the body, mind and spirit and benefits the physiology and 43 psychological needs (Idler, 2008). In addition, we cannot deny that religions play an important role to guide humanity and carry wisdom since at the early beginning of human civilisation from Adam (Khalif, 2013). However, sometimes the wisdom became unguided or deviated from the right path due to certain circumstances, tend to be very general and even try to escape from religion. AQAL model for prison instructors that has been discussed is one of the examples of a general formula to cure the society. With a few adjustments, it will be suitable to get align with the objective of JPM which is; to execute a correctional programme through vocational activities, spiritual and mental development, becoming productive citizens and cultivating good values (JPM, 2013). The adjustment will be called HACE (Holistic Approach for Correctional Education), an approach or guidelines that could be used by vocational instructors under JPM while delivering their knowledge. The concern on how to develop self-awareness or selfquality will be based on local perspectives by Malaysian prominent scholars like Syed Muhammad Naquib al-Attas, Rohana Hamzah, Ros Eliana, Hamdan, Najmuddin,and many others. A good education system that contributes to humanity is one of the essential concepts in holistic approach (Grasso and Burkins, 2010). Therefore, the development of HACE module will be based on the basic concept of education from Islamic perspectives. Revealed knowledge from God through his Messenger (pbuh), is an important source that could assist humankind in worshiping Him, behaving accordingly and guide them to deal with their environment. However, the importance of revealed knowledge does not refute the capacity of human brain (Maimun et al., 2009; Hamdan and Najmuddin, 2013). Indeed in Islamic traditions, it is crucial to maximised the brain capacity to know God, perform good deeds, and differentiate between good and bad, to think of the creations and their purposes as well as solving the issues and problems for universal benefits (Hamdan and Najmuddin, 2013). Learning skills, went to work, serving people and nation are some examples that could be considered as good deeds in Islam. 44 However these activities should orbit on the right intention and to achieve redha or pleased God. There are three basic elements in doing any activities to achieve redha. First is ‘ubudiah which is to believe and serve Allah. Second is mas’uliyah, or to consider that every single action will be questioned on the Day of Judgment, so that one will always watch on their responsibility and accountability while working. The third is itqan or to do work with quality, commitment, focus and far from any fraud (Hamdan and Najmuddin, 2013). ‘Ubudiah, mas’uliyah and itqan will only exist if there is a pure believes in the existence of God and a strong motivation to carry out His command (Nor Aisyah et al., 2011 and Rohana et.al, 2013). It is the core that will be guiding the development of HACE module. A good understanding by practicing and transferring the same concept to the prisoners will be very useful in helping JPM to achieve the correctional objective and thus could help in reducing recidivism cases. Below are the possible elements of HACE module. Figure 2 Possible elements of HACE module 45 HACE MODULE; EFFECTIVENESS? HOW TO MEASURE THE Elements for HACE need to be verified by experts. Once the process done and the final elements finalised, researcher may proceed with drafting the module. The evaluations on this module will be divided into three phases as suggested by Sidek and Jamaludin (2005). DRAFT OF MODULE FIRST ASSESSMENT Validity Reliability SECOND ASSESSMENT Experimental Research to test module effectiveness in laboratory setting THIRD ASSESSMENT Experimental Research to test module effectiveness in real setting Figure 3 Phases in evaluating HACE module In this first assessment, module validity for HACE will be based on elements suggested by Rusell (1974). There are five elements involve which are; Module suit the right population, satisfy with the method of implementation, sufficient time to deliver the messages, manage to increase achievement and able to change the attitudes to the better. Using these elements, a Likert Scale questionnaire based on what have been proposed by Sidek and Jamaludin (2008) will be implemented and calculated using 46 this formula. Expert Score (x) x100% = Level of content validity Maximum Score (25) Total scores were obtained from an expert will be presented by (x) and will be divided by maximum score of 25. The results will be multiplied by 100 to get the percentage of content validity value. Referring to Abu Bakar (1995) in Jamaludin (2002), value of 70% would be considered as having a high validity and have met the criteria of a good module. The reliability for the module will be done by developing another questionnaire. According to Sidek and Jamaludin (2005), there are two ways in measuring reliability for module. It is either based on the objective of the module or based on every step in the module activities. A group of instructors from one of JPM institution will be selected for this purpose. Experimental on the effectiveness of module by laboratory setting will be done together with reliability test for module content. Once the positive result obtained, researcher will proceed with the real experimental test. EXPECTATIONS AND CONCLUSION TVET is seen as one of the means of furthering resocialisation and acquisition of the skills that may help inmates to build a better future for them after release. Therefore, it is a big hope that HACE module will help instructors to merge the acquired knowledge and spiritual growth in a single lesson and thus assist in increasing selfquality among detainees under JPM supervision. 47 Figure 4 Expectation from HACE module REFERENCES Alavi, K., Ibrahim, F., Mohamad, M. S., & Wan, W. S. (2013). Tahap Pengetahuan Agama Dalam Kalangan Banduan Parol: Ke Arah Pembentukan Akhlak Sejahtera. Journal of Social Sciences and Humanities, 8(2), 1–10. Domenico Graso and Melody Brown Burkins (eds.) (2010). Holistic Engineering Education (Beyond Technology). Springer. USA. Ellen Idler (2008). The Psychological and Physical Benefits of Spiritual/Religious Practices. Journal: Spirituality in Higher Education Newsletter. Volume 4(2), 1-5 Hayati (2009). Self/ (Ego) Consciosness in Muslim Scholars Notability in Bediuzzaman Said Nursi. Journal: Studies in Islam and the Midle East. Volume 6, no.1 Jamaludin Ahmad (2002). Kesahan, Kebolehpercayaan Dan Keberkesanan Modul Program Maju Diri Ke Atas Motivasi Pencapaian Di Kalangan Pelajar-Pelajar Sekolah Menengah Negeri Selangor. UPM:PhD Thesis Khalif Muammar (2013). Islam dan Pluralisme Agama. Centre for Advanced Studies on Islam, Science and Civilisation (CASIS), 48 UTM. Kuala Lumpur Miller, J.P (2007). The Holistic Curriculum (2nd edition). OISE Press. London. Nor Aishah Abdul Aziz, Mohd Zolkifli Abd Hamid, Nur’ain Baharin and Ismail Saliyan (2011). Profesionalisme Pendidik:Ke Arah Membentuk Peribadi Pendidik Yang Unggul. Prosiding Seminar Majlis Dekan-dekan Pendidikan IPTA 2011. Penerbit UTM Press. Portal Rasmi Jabatan Penjara Malaysia (2013). Aktiviti Pemulihan di Jabatan Penjara Malaysia. Retrieved at www.prison.gov.my. Rohana Hamzah, Tengku Norzaini Tengku Ibrahim, Sarimah Ismail dan Ros Eliana Mohd Zuki (2013). Pembangunan Jiwa Pendidik dalam Kalangan Bakal Pendidik. Jurnal Teknologi, 61 (1), 27-31 Rusell, J.D (1974). Modular Instruction: A Guide to the Design, Selection, Utilization and Evaluation of Modular Materials. New York Publishing Company. The United States Sidek Mohd Noh and Jamaludin Ahmad (2005). Pembinaan Modul. Bagaimana Membina Modul Latihan dan Modul Akademik. Penerbit Universiti Putra Malaysia. Serdang Syed Muhammad Naquib al-Attas (1990). The Nature of Man and the Psychological of the Huaman Soul. Abrief outline and a framework for an Islamic Psychology and Epistimology. International Institute of Islamic Thought and Civilisation. IIUM Syed Omar (2008), The Muqaddimah of Ibnu Khaldun- Religion, Human Nature and Economics. Kolej Universiti Islam Antarabangsa Selangor (KUIS). Selangor. Thom Gehring and Margaret Puffer (2006). Integral Correctional Education. AQAL. Journal of Integral Theory and Practice. 1 (1), 183 – 212 49 DESIGNING EDUCATIONAL SIMULATION FOR IMPACT TEST MACHINE Ahmed Hadi Shubber, Amirmudin Bin Udin & Asnul Bin Minghat ABSTRACT We report the simulation models for enhanceing the metacognitive skills. Mechanical Engineering students of Babylon Institute in Iraq are chosen for case study. The design of model and Impact Test Simulations (ITS) for Metallurgy subject are addressed. The silulation software developed using Microsoft Studio 2010 includes tutorials to explain all necessary theoretical background and formulas. Step-by-step computerized procedures and numerical examples are rendered in a simple user-friendly, visual and interactive environment to enhance metacognitive skills and students' learning. Before starting the design process, objectives and the salient features of simulation are clearly identified. Subsequently, real laboratory experiments are conducted for collecting data and coding them in computer language. Despite the existence of numerous module embedded graphical simulation, the developed software package is expected to provide valuable tool for both students and instructors. Furthermore, the same package in the form of a bi-product can also be used as a "research tool" together with the application for engineering education. Keywords: ITS, Education Simulation, Impact Test, Metallurgy 50 INTRODUCTION Modelling and simulation go hand in hand. Definitely, model building is a well recognised way towards the understanding of the real world. Truly, it is a simplification of some complex structure or a system. Conversely, it may be for prediction, a substitute for experiential learning or simply for entertainment. The major difference between simulation and experimentation must be mentioned. In simulation, one experiments with a model and not with a phenomenon. The use of simulations represents the natural way of “learn by doing”. Alike students’ role playing we use computer simulations to understand intricate systems, real situation or dynamic processes. Computer simulations allow us to mimic situations or processes that would be difficult, impossible, dangerous, too long or to expensive to perform in reality (Stančić et al. 2007). Undoubtedly, the purpose of an educational simulation is to motivate the learner to engage in problem solving, hypothesis testing, experiential learning, scheme construction and development of mental models (Winn 2003; Duffy & Cunningham 1996). Lately, this new information technology tools is changing the learning environment in engineering education from primarily teacher-centric to student-centric. Unfettered access to web-based or computer educational materials are highly useful (Donovan & Bransford 1999). In order to meet the growing demand for engineers those wellversed with computer tools for problem solving and metacognitive skills, engineering educators are increasingly incorporating in curricula information technology-based learning tools. Consequently, web-based multimedia modules, virtual collaborative environments, virtual laboratories, software for simulation and visualization of engineering phenomena etc. (Chaturvedi & Akan 2006) are developed. The two-fold objective of this ongoing transformation is: (i) to improve the quality of instruction with innovative course materials that cater to the learning styles of present generation students, and (ii) to provide 51 students exposure to computer problem solving tools so as to facilitate their transition from academia to industry (Bourne et al. 1996). In this research we attempt to design a simulation model for impact test machine to enhance the metacognitive skills of mtallurgy lesson for mechanical engineering students of Iraq. The model is tested, implemented, analyzed and the results are compared and understood. THEORETICAL BACKGROUND In the past, overall education in Iraq has suffered from severe deterioration due to the decrease in spending, lack of supplies, collapse of infrastructure and overcrowded schools. These are compounded by the continuing prevalence of classical teaching methods that focus on lectures and memorization. The stress analysis and deductive skills, the spirit of initiative and creativity are all failed to optimally encourage student engagement. Much educational necessities such as libraries, laboratories, modern teaching techniques, smart-boards, roving laboratories, electronic library, computers and their accessories to a considerable percentage of schools and institutions of higher education are already rendered. Despite many efforts since 2003 to develop courses for all levels of education, there is still a need to develop study courses and provide additional supports to maintain international standards (Ministry of Higher Education & Scientific of Iraq 2012; Ministry of Planning Republic of Iraq 2010; United Nations Human Settlements -UNHABITAT 2009). Metallurgy is considered as one of the most important branches of engineering materials. The emergence of various various metal industries enforced the students teaching more significant for their work. Particularly, technicians in factories producing various types of engineering materials require knowledge of integrated types of metallic materials. In addition to their knowledge on physical, thermal, chemical and properties they must be aware of the 52 conditions for the manufacturing process (FTE 2010). Metallurgy is always considered as one of the hardest lessons taught in the Department of Mechanics in Iraq because many students fail to succed in the first attempt (Al-Mosawi 2013). Consequently, Metallurgy is proven as a difficult subject for many students (Black & Harrison 2004). The present research aims to find ways that may transform the engineering curriculum of Department of Mechanics in Babylon Technical Institute into simulation enhanced engineering curricula. It emphasizes on the incorporation of simulation based interactive modules to enhance student learning. The pedagogy of “learningby-doing in virtual environments” is being employed in the development of modules. In fact, one of the practical and efficient ways engineers can learn is through hands-on activities in computer laboratories. The Impact Test module being a part of the Metallurgy lesson is expected to complement student learning achieved through computer laboratories and conventional classroom instruction. However, our emphasis is not directed towards distance learning. It is rather focused for on-campus classes in enhancing the quality of student learning by embedding computer simulation in conventional mode of teaching and learning processes. IMPACT TEST Impact test: A standardized high strain-rate test which determines the amount of energy absorbed by a material during fracture. This is used to define the resistance of a material towards sudden applied loads. Toughness: In materials science and metallurgy, toughness is the ability of a material to absorb energy and plastically deform without fracturing. This is the amount of energy per unit volume that a material can absorb before rupturing. A property that determines the capacity of a material to resist fracture, (crack 53 propagation), when subjected to impact. The machine measures the amount of energy (in Joule) absorbed by the specimen for the rupture unit. The amount of energy absorbed often indicates the toughness of the materials and classify them as brittle or ductile materials. Pendulum Impact Test: This is a standardized high strain-rate test which determines the amount of energy absorbed by a material during fracture. In this test the specimen is positioned across the lowest point in the path of a striker mounted at the end of a pendulum as shown in Figure 1. The striker, having been initially lifted to a initial specific height (ho) and then released, swings against the specimen and breaks it. The striker continues its swing to the other side of the specimen to a final height (hf). Clearly, the difference between the two heights multiplied by the weight of the striker corresponds to the amount of energy that is absorbed during fracture. The purpose of the test being the determination of the amount of energy absorbed by a material during impact/fracture often results, 1Quantitative (impact energy readings can be used to obtain toughness and yield strength properties of the materials) 2Qualitative (fracture face can be analyzed to provide insight on the ductile/brittle properties of materials). METHODOLOGY OBJECTIVES The identification of goals for the construction of lesson is considered as the important standard to determine their contents, nature, activities and exercises accompanying the methods. Furthermore, the modes of using particular teaching methods and the goals for lessons are categorized into general and specific one. General goals primarily focus to enhance Engineering Education 54 and improve the metacognitive skills in the metallurgy lesson. Conversely, special goals intend to administer students having following perspectives: a. Students identify when, where and how to use Impact Test. b. Students identify how to tests’ specimen designing. c. Students identify the parts and components of an Impact Test. d. Students identify sequence of steps involved in Impact Test. e. Students identify advantages and disadvantages of Impact Test f. They identify how to safely use machines. g. They identify how to measure machine toughness correctly. SIMULATION DEVELOPMENT The simulation process is developed for ITS models in the metallurgy lesson as described hereunder. Simulation Development Process The development processes of ITS are illustrated in Fig. 1 (Scheinman 2009; Heath et al. 2009). The computer language Microsoft Studio 2010 is used to design and develop the ITS model. An evaluation of the proposed model is carred out to identify their strengths and weaknesses through pilot test. A group of experts with mechanical engineering and teaching methods background are chosen to get their consensus and confirm the content validity. 55 Figure 1 Block diagram for the simulation development processes ITS development involves the underlined steps: 1. Identification of general and special goal of the model. 2. Use of metals group such as stainless steel, mild steel, steel, brass and aluminum in conducting the real test. 3. Manufacturing specimens from these metals by machines turning and milling, wire cutting and polishing suitable for the apparatus specified in the research. 4. Conducting the test on real apparatus. In addition to the registration of the real data and results during the test, capturing pictures of each step, movement and reading of apparatus are also considered. 5. Modification and calibration of pictures for the measurements are performed with the real equipment and specimen using a set of computer programs such as Photoshop and other image processors. 6. Designing a computer program using Microsoft Studio 2010 to simulate the model and conversion of data and images to the software codes. Devising the computer 56 interfaces representing the real test steps. 7. Acquiring data from the program alike a real machine when running the simulation or executing the program. The user is responsible for checking the statement true or false with the possibility of re-trying it several times, data collection, and storage in specific places to be audited. Simulation Characteristics Yilmaz et al. 2008; Stančić et al. 2007 have identified the main characteristics of simulation which are fit for engineering education. The following attributes of simulation are considered in the entire process of designing the model: 1Simulation program offers a series of clear events to the students allowing them the opportunity to participate actively in the program. 2It offers the learner many suitable choices. 3It helps the students to learn by using the sound, images and animation drawing. 4It directs the students by using the proper guidance to the study depending on their control in the learning environment. 5It provides a large base of information to the learner useful in understanding the subject matter under consideration. 6The simulation program assists the learner to understand the reality, thought, and emotions. 7It allows the learner to commit mistakes without affecting the results adversely. 8It permits the learner to achieve great freedom in the learning process. 9It proffers a new style to the learner which is very different from traditional approaches. 10It grants a chance to the learner to apply some of the learned skills. 11It generally creates appropriate conditions for learning and skills training with the computer which are very similar for 57 the real world. SIMULATION DESIGN The ITS designed by Chang 2008; Heath et al. 2009; Scheinman 2009 is performed using the following stages: A. Design of Screen 1 as depicted in Fig. 2-a is comprised of the following options: 1. ABOUT IMPACT TEST: Review the information related to the Impact Test. 2. ABOUT SIMULATION: Review the information relating how can you use the simulation? 3. TEST STEPS: Review the information related of test step. 4. SIMULATION TEST: Move to the next screen to use simulation for Impact Test. 5. EXIT: End of program. B. Design of Screen 2 as shown in Fig. 2-b includes the following options: 1. Aluminum Al: Use Aluminum specimen and next screen. 2. Steel: Use Steel specimen and move to the next screen. 3. Brass: Use Brass specimen and move to the next screen. 4. S-Steel: Use Stainless Steel specimen and move to the next screen. 5. EXIT: End of program. 6. Back: Back to the previous screen. C. Design of Screen 3 as illustrated in Fig. 2-c to -f contains the following choices: 1. Horizontal Scroll Bar: To latch the hammer (Pendulum). 2. Vertical Scroll Bar: To raise the hammer (Pendulum). 3. EXIT: End of program. 4. Back: Back to the previous screen. 5. Animation Image: To touch friction pointer with hammer pointer 6. Image: The test specimen 58 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. Image: To show specimen place. Key (Start Test): to show the test video Video: To show real test video Other View: To show real test from other view Image :To explain the amount of absorbed striking energy (Joule) Input Text (amount of absorbed energy ):To Input the absorbed striking energy value (Joule) Key (Enter): To show value the absorbed energy and impact resistance are true or false Label: To explain the impact resistance equation. Label: To explain the specimen area on fracture surface in (mm2). Label: To explain value of impact resistance. Label: To explain if true or false answer. ITS PROCEDURES 1. 2. 3. a. b. c. d. e. f. g. In the screen 1, click on (SIMULATION TEST (4)) to move to the next screen to use simulation for Tensile Test. In the screen 2, click on one of options (Aluminum Al(1), Steel(2), Brass(3), S-Steel(4)) to choose material and move to the next screen. In the screen 3, follow the following options: Use horizontal scrollbar (1) to latch the hammer (Pendulum). Use vertical scrollbar (2) to raise the hammer (Pendulum). Wait few times to show automatically touch friction pointer with a hammer pointer (5). Drag and Drop the test specimen (6) from its location to the anvil location. Click on (Start Test (8)) to show the real test video (9). Click on (Other View (10)) to show real test from other view (9). Read Friction pointer (amount of absorbed striking energy 59 h. i. (Joule) (11)). Input the reading of absorbed striking energy (Joule) in textbox (12). Click on (Enter (13)) to show the absorbed energy and impact resistance are true or false. CONCLUSIONS The influences of Impact Test Machine Simulation in achieving enhanced metacognitive skills are inspected. The researcher designed ITS relying on established approaches are clearly able to identify striking simulation characteristics. Researchers are expected to employ the simulation design to evaluate the increased reliability and validity of the study instrument in identifying the presence of possible deficiencies during actual implementation (Cooper & Schindler 2000; Hair et al. 2006). The simulation is executed to determine the effectiveness of metacognitive skills on mechanical engineering students of Iraq as test sample. Simulation design suggests that the developed model may serve as a research tool for both students and instructors in metallurgy lesson to improve their metacognitive skills. Laboratory experiments are carried out, data are collected and computer algorithms are developed using Microsoft Studio 2010. Relevant theoretical background and formulas related to the ITS are designed via userfriendly approach. The simulation model contains meticulously executed steps including the generation of metacognitive tasks, its goals and effective tools that promote overall ability and efficiency in education. It is hoped that the capability of students’ in understanding metallurgy lesson will improve via the acquisition of metacognitive skills. It may also enable learners in controlling their cognition, emotion, and motivation in addition to solve complex problems in mechanical engineering. The present model simulation is highly instructive for successful process of cognition and learning. This simulation will definitely enhance the susceptibility of students to understand and solve multifaceted 60 problems in metallurgy. Finally, it may be applied to students of technical institutes in Iraq to know the influences on the enhanced metacognitive skills in engineering education. Figure 2 (a-f) Schematic diagram displaying the design of screens for simulating Impact Test machine. REFERENCES Al-Mosawi, A., 2013. Learning difficulties in metallurgy lesson: a case study in Technical Institute of Babylon. Educational Research International, 2(1), pp.116–119. Black, P. & Harrison, C., 2004. Science inside the black box: Assessment for learning in the science classroom, London: NFER Nelson. Bourne, J.R. et al., 1996. A Model for On-Line Learning Networks in Engineering Education. Journal of Engineering Education, 85(3), pp.253–262. Available at: http://doi.wiley.com/10.1002/j.2168- 61 9830.1996.tb00241.x. Chang, G.C., 2008. Strategic planning in education: some concepts and methods. In DIRECTIONS IN EDUCATIONAL PLANNING: SYMPOSIUM TO HONOUR THE WORK OF FRANÇOISE CAILLODS. Chaturvedi, S.K. & Akan, O., 2006. Simulation and Visualization Enhanced Engineering Education. In International Mechanical Engineering Education. China: ASME and CMES, pp. 1–8. Cooper, D.R. & Schindler, P.S., 2000. Business research method 7th ed., New York: McGraw- Hill. Donovan, M.S. & Bransford, J.D., 1999. How People Learn: Bridging Research and Practice. National Academy of Sciences, p.88. Available at: http://www.nap.edu/catalog/9457.html. Duffy, T. & Cunningham, D., 1996. Constructivism: Implications for the Design and Delivery of Instruction. In D. & Jonassen, eds. Handbook of research on educational communications and technology. New York: Simon & Schuster. FTE, 2010. Metallurgy Curriculum, Mechanics Depart Iraq., Foundation of Technical Education. Hair, J.F.J. et al., 2006. Multivariate Data Analysis 6th ed., Upper Saddle River, NJ: Pearson Prentice Hall. Heath, B., Hill, R. & Ciarallo, F., 2009. A survey of agent-based modeling practices (January 1998 to July 2008). Journal of Artificial Societies and Social Simulation, 12(4), p.9. Ministry of Higher Education & Scientific of Iraq, 2012. The strategic framework and the general policies of Technical and Vocational Education in Iraq. In Third International Congress on Technical and Vocational Education and Training. China, pp. 2–12. Available at: www.tvetoman.net/PDF/PDF_AR_7.pdf? Ministry of Planning Republic of Iraq, 2010. National Development Plan 2010-2014, Baghdad. Available at: http://www.mop.gov.iq/mop. Scheinman, D.E., 2009. Discrete event simulation and production system design for Rockwell hardness test blocks. California. Stančić, H. et al., 2007. Simulation Models in Education. In Međunarodna znanstvena konferencija The Future of Information Sciences, (Digital Information and Heritage (1; 2007)). United Nations Human Settlements -UNHABITAT, 2009. Country Programme Document 2009-2011 :Iraq, Iraq. 62 Winn, W., 2003. COGNITIVE PERSPECTIVES IN PSYCHOLOGY. In D. Jonassen, ed. Handbook of research on educational communications and technology. Routledge/Taylor & Francis Group, pp. 79–112. Yilmaz, L. et al., 2008. What Makes Good Research in Modeling and Simulation (M&S): Sustaining the Growth and Vitality of the M&S Discipline. In Winter Simulation Conference 2008. IEEE/ACM, pp. 671–676. 63 Perlaksanaan Amalan Kepimpinan ‘Turnaround’ Dalam Kalangan Pengetua Sekolah Menengah Di Negeri Sabah. Irene Branda Anak Macus & Khadijah Daud ABSTRAK Kajian ini dijalankan oleh penyelidik bertujuan untuk mengenalpasti perlaksanaan amalan kepimpinan ‘turnaround’dalam kalangan pengetua di empat buah sekolah di pantai Barat Negeri Sabah. Kajian ini adalah berdasarkan model yang diasaskan oleh Micheal Fullan (2006). Sebanyak sepuluh elemen yang terdapat dalam kepimpinan ‘turnaround’ iaitu Merapatkan jurang antara prestasi rendah dan prestasi tinggi, mengutamkan tiga asas utama, memastikan guru terbaik melaksanakan tugas,merangka strategi berorientasikan tindakan dan sosial, membina kapasiti beterusan, mengamalkan kepimpinan berunsurkan kemanusiaan,memberikan tekanan positif kepada guru dan membina akautabiliti dalam menjurus kepada akauntabiliti luar. Seramai 360 responden guru dan empat orang pengetua daripada empat buah sekolah menengah luar Bandar terlibat dalam kajian ini. Kajian ini akan mengabungkan kaedah gabungan iaitu kualitatif dan kuantitatif. Kata Kunci : Kepimpinan “Turnaraound”, Pengetua 64 PENGENALAN Kajian tentang kepimpinan pendidikan membuktikan bahawa kepimpinan memainkan peranan yang amat penting untuk menjadikan sesebuah sekolah itu berjaya dan mencapai prestasi tinggi ( Jo et al, 2010; Simone & Uchiyama, 2003). Pemimpin sekolah adalah pemacu yang amat penting dalam pendidikan bagi pencapaian murid. Kajian dijalankan di Tennesee, Amerika Syarikat pada pertengahan tahun 1990-an telah menunjukkan bahawa secara relatifnya, Pengetua yang berprestasi cemerlang yang menumpukan kepada kepimpinan instruksional berbanding pentadbiran dapat meningkatkan pencapaian murid sehingga 20 %. Oleh itu, Pengetua merupakan fokus kepada reformasi kepada tranformasi sebuah sekolah yang berpencapain rendah dan sekolah yang gagal mencapai sasaran berdasarkan SKPM iaitu Standard Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia yang telah ditetapkan oleh Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia Kepentingan peranan pemimpin berkesan sememangnya tidak dinafikan terutamanya dalam usaha menghasilkan sekolah-sekolah yang berjaya dan berprestasi cemerlang. Kebanyakkan pengkaji setuju bahawa dalam jangka masa proses sekolah ‘turnaround’, ia berlaku dalam jangka masa yang drastik tetapi tidak berlaku pemulihan yang pantas ( Stoll & Myers,1998) dan adalah menjadi kefahaman bahawa dengan mengambil kira tempoh masa perubahan pencapaian sekolah yang berterusan sekolah tersebut mencapai keputusan yang baik berdasarkan perubahan yang pantas dan usaha yang beterusan maka proses ini dikenali sebagai ‘turnaround’. Secara kesimpulannya, memandangkan kualiti pendidikan tinggi berkorelasi terus berkait rapat dengan pertumbuhan ekonomi negara dalam jangka masa yang panjang maka adalah penting untuk meneruskan usaha untuk melonjakkan standard pendidikan ke tahap yang lebih tinggi agar Malaysia tidak akan berhadapan dengan risiko ketinggalan dalam pendidikan pada masa ini dan kurang berdaya saing pada masa hadapan maka dalam hal ini, pentadbiran dan pengurusan di peringkat sekolah iaitu pengetua dan guru besar memainkan peranan penting jatuh bangun sekolah 65 tersebut kerana sesebuah sekolah bertunjangkan kepada pucuk pimpinan pengetua ( Ibrahim Ahmad Bajunid 2000). PERNYATAAN MASALAH Dalam usaha merialisasikan hasrat kerajaan untuk melaksanakan tranformasi yang berani, bersungguh-sungguh dan drastik negara memerlukan penjawat awam seperti seperti pengetua atau pemimpin sekolah yang memiliki memainkan peranan yang lebih drastik. walau bagaimanapun isu yang berkaitan dengan ketidak mampuan pengetua serta kelemahan pegetua dalam usaha menjadikan sekolah yang berpencapaian rendah kepada sekolah yang berkesan bukanlah satu isu yang baharu Fullan (2001) Kajian yang dilakukan oleh Deal dan Peterson telah mendedahkan terdapatnya kelemahan pengetua dalam pengurusan sekolah secara berfungsi dan berkesan berdasarkan garis panduan seperti yang ditetapkan . Cabaran untuk mencari dan menemui pemimpin yang memiliki kemahiran dalam usaha memulih dan ‘turnaround’ sekolah yang berpencapaian rendah di peringkat kebangsaan masih berada di tahap yang agak jauh, kerana atas beberapa sebab Kepimpinan ‘turnaround’ merupakan satu konsep yang agak baharu dalam bidang pendidikan di Malaysia. Walau bagaimanapun kajian ‘turnaround’ telah berlaku di Negara barat dan hasil kajian dari sekolah mampu melakukan perubahan dan berjaya dan kejayaan ini didukung oleh stail kepimpinan dan kemahiran yang ada . Cabaran ini masih merupakan cabaran untuk mencari pemimpin yang benar-benar mempunyai ciri kepimpinan ‘turnaround’ dalam usaha menaikkan sekolah berpencapaian rendah kepada sekolah cemerlang. OBJEKTIF KAJIAN Objektif –objektif yang ingin dicapai melalui kajian ini ialah : 66 1. Mengenal pasti amalan kepimpinan ‘turnaround’yang paling dominan diamalkan oleh pengetua di sekolah dalam strateginya untuk meningkatkan pencapaian akademik sekolah berpencapaian rendah kepada sekolah cemerlang. 2. Mengenal pasti kepimpinan empat dimensi yang ditetapkan oleh Standard Kualiti Pendidikan Malaysia paling dominan diamalkan oleh pengetua di sekolah dalam strateginya untuk menaikkan pencapaian akademik sekolah berpencapaian rendah kepada sekolah cemerlang. 3. Mengenal pasti ciri sekolah berpencapaian tinggi yang digariskan oleh KPM yang paling dominan diamalkan oleh pengetua dari sekolah berpencapaian rendah kepada sekolah cemerlang. 4. Mengkaji hubungan diantara kepimpinan ‘turnaround’ dengan kepimpinan empat dimensi yang ditetapkan oleh Standard Kualiti Pendidikan Malaysia yang diamalkan oleh pengetua sekolah berpencapaian rendah kepada sekolah cemerlang. 5. Mengenal pasti amalan kepimpinan ‘turnaround’ dan empat dimensi yang ditetapkan oleh Standard Kualiti Pendidikan Malaysia yang paling menyumbang kepada ciri sekolah berkesan atau sekolah cemerlang yang ditetapkan oleh Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia. 6. Mengenal pasti cabaran yang dihadapi pengetua dalam usaha mencapai sekolah berkesan atau sekolah cemerlang menggunakan kepimpinan ‘turnaround’ dan kepimpinan yang berdasarkan empat dimensi yang ditetapkan oleh Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia. REKABENTUK KAJIAN Oleh itu kajian ini berbentuk kajian gabungan yang akan melibatkan kaedah Kuantitatif dan kaedah kualitatitif iaitu Kajian Kaedah Campuran (Mixed Method Research) merupakan kombinasi kaedah, falsafah, dan haluan 67 rekabentuk penyelidikan (Creswell and Clark, 2011),yang merangkumi mengumpul data kualitatif dan kuantitatif secara lebih terperinci dan menyakinkan. kaedah gabungan iaitu kaedah kuantitatif dan kualitatif merupakan satu kaedah yang mempunyai kekuatan sinergi yang wujud untuk pemahaman sesuatu fenomena dengan lebih terperinci jika dibandingkan dengan penggunaan kaedah kuantitatif sahaja atau kualitatif sahaja, .Gay (2006). dan Mohd Najib , (1999) menyatakan bahawa untuk penyelidikan secara mendalam adalah disarankan menggabungkan kedua-dua ciri kaedah kajian tersebut memandangkan memiliki kekuatan tersendiri. Kaedah kuantitatif juga digunakan oleh pengkaji dalam kajian. Menurut Mohd Najib (1999) menyatakan pendekatan kuantitatif digunakan bagi mendapatkan data melalui pengukuran objektif dan dapat digeneralisasikan kepada dunia luar. Menurut Cohen dan Manion (1985) kajian kuantitatif juga disebut sebagai jenis eksperimen, sainstifik, objektif, reduksi dan preskriptif atau dikelaskan sebagai normatif yang mampu menyelesaikan masalah di peringkat makro (besar). Bagi kaedah kuantitatif, kaedah persampelan rawak mudah kerana persampelan rawak mudah mengkhendaki setiap individu mempunyai peluang dan ruang yang sama untuk dijadikan sampel dan persampelan rawak dipilih kerana populasi yang hendak dikaji mempunyai ciri-ciri yang seragam, soal selidik akan diedarkan untuk mendapatkan data. Manakala kaedah kualitatif digunakan dalam kajian ini dengan menggunakan kaedah temubual dan refleksi peserta yang terlibat. Menurut Silversetein (2003) kajian kualitatif merupakan kaedah yang paling baik untuk mendapatkan jawapan daripada persoalan dan pengetahuan serta pembelajaran secara terperinci selain itu pendekatan kualitatif akan memberikan maklumat kepada pengkaji untuk melaporkan pengalaman pengetua setelah amalan ‘turnaround’ dilakukan dan sebelum amalan dilakukan secara padat berdasarkan suara, pendapat, luahan hati dan pengalaman pengetua. Malah dalam kajian Bogdan & Bilken (1988), Creswell( 2003), Moustakas (1994) menyatakan bahawa kaedah ini sesuai untuk mengkaji fenomena kepelbagaian kes iaitu untuk 68 mendapatkan maklumat bagaimana untuk menjalankan proses kutipan data yang berkaitan dengan pengalaman peserta dan corak analisis data dan hubungannya. Sementara menurut Mohd Najib (1999) menyatakan bahawa kaedah kualitatif menerangkan secara holistik keadaan sebenar sesuatu peristiwa yang berlaku tanpa sebarang manipulasi oleh pengkaji. Menggunakan kaedah gabungan adalah lebih menyeluruh, ini disebabkan persoalan kajian dapat dijawab dengan lebih komprehensif jika menggabungkan kedua-dua kajian kuantitatif dan kualitatif. Selain itu, pengkaji mampu mengintepretasi dapatan kajian dari pelbagai perspektif walaupun kajian ini mengambil masa yang lebih lama berbanding penggunaan satu kaedah kajian kuantitif sahaja SAMPEL DAN TEMPAT KAJIAN Penyelidikan bertujuan untuk mengkaji amalan kepimpinan ‘turnaround’ dalam kalangan pengetua sekolah di negeri Sabah. Oleh itu penyelidik memilih sekolah yang telah dikenalpasti mampu melonjakkan prestasi secara drastik dalam tempoh satu hingga lima tahun. Penyelidik akan memilih guru yang bertugas di empat buah sekolah tersebut seramai 360 puluh responden iaitu guru sebagai sampel kajian dan empat orang pengetua dan akan menilai berkaitan dengan amalan kepimpinan ‘turnaround’ melalui soal selidik dan kaedah temubual yang akan diedarkan dan akan dilaksanakan. Instrumen Kajian Instrumen kajian adalah alat yang akan digunakan di dalam kajian untuk menguji sesuatu persoalan. Dalam kajian yang menggunakan kaedah gabungan iaitu Kajian Kaedah Campuran (Mixed Method Research) merupakan kombinasi kaedah kerana ia sesuai untuk kajian yang akan dilaksanakan kaedah gabungan iaitu 69 kaedah kuantitatif dan kualitatif merupakan satu kaedah yang mempunyai kekuatan sinergi yang wujud untuk pemahaman sesuatu fenomena dengan lebih terperinci jika dibandingkan dengan penggunaan kaedah kuantitatif sahaja atau kualitatif sahaja, .Gay (2006). dan Mohd Najib , (1999) menyatakan bahawa untuk penyelidikan secara mendalam adalah disarankan menggabungkan kedua-dua ciri kaedah kajian tersebut memandangkan memiliki kekuatan tersendiri Kaedah Kuantitatif akan menggunakan soal selidik kerana ia bersesuaian dengan kaedah kajian untuk menguji satu persoalan disamping menjimatkan kos penyelidikan,dapat memperoleh data dengan tepat , responden dapat memberikan maklum balas dengan cepat, malah penyelidik dapat berhubung atau bekerjasama dengan responden dengan lebih mudah. Mengikut Oppenheim (1996) di dalam Mohamad Najib (1999), soal selidik digunakan untuk mengukur konsep yang berkaitan dengan sikap,persepsi dan pandangan selain latar belakang. Manakala kaedah kualitatif digunakan dalam kajian ini dengan menggunakan kaedah temubual dan refleksi peserta yang terlibat. Menurut Silversetein (2003) kajian kualitatif merupakan kaedah yang paling baik untuk mendapatkan jawapan daripada persoalan dan pengetahuan serta pembelajaran secara terperinci selain itu pendekatan kualitatif akan memberikan maklumat kepada pengkaji untuk melaporkan pengalaman berdasarkan suara, pendapat, luahan hati responden yang dikaji. Malah dalam kajian Bogdan & Bilken (1988), Creswell( 2003), Moustakas (1994) menyatakan bahawa kaedah ini sesuai untuk mengkaji fenomena kepelbagaian kes iaitu untuk mendapatkan maklumat bagaimana untuk menjalankan proses kutipan data yang berkaitan dengan pengalaman peserta dan corak analisis data dan hubungannya. Sementara menurut Mohd Najib (1999) menyatakan bahawa kaedah kualitatif menerangkan secara holistik keadaan sebenar sesuatu peristiwa yang berlaku tanpa sebarang manipulasi oleh pengkaji Walau bagaimanapun kaedah gabungan adalah lebih menyeluruh, ini disebabkan persoalan kajian dapat dijawab dengan 70 lebih komprehensif jika menggabungkan kedua-dua kajian kuantitatif dan kualitatif. Selain itu, pengkaji mampu mengintepretasi dapatan kajian dari pelbagai perspektif walaupun kajian ini mengambil masa yang lebih lama berbanding penggunaan satu kaedah kajian kuantitif sahaja. i) Bahagian A : Terdiri daripada maklumat latar belakang responden dan maklumat guru yang perlu diisi oleh responden tersebut iaitu maklumat jantina, kaum,kelayakan akademik dan tempoh bertugas sebagai guru. ii) Bahagian B ( Lampiran 1) Terdiri daripada 60 item soalan berkaitan persoalan kajian telah ditetapkan itemitem ini terbahagi kepada sepuluh elemen yang terdapat dalam kepimpinan ‘turnaround’ iaitu Merapatkan jurang antara prestasi rendah dan prestasi tinggi,mengutamkan tiga asas utama, memastikan guru terbaik melaksanakan tugas,merangka strategi berorientasikan tindakan dan sosial, membina kapasiti beterusan, mengamalkan kepimpinan berunsurkan kemanusiaan,memberikan tekanan positif kepada guru dan membina akautabiliti dalam menjurus kepada akauntabiliti luar. ( Lampiran 2) Terdiri daripada 68 item soalan berkaitan dengan persoalan kajian telah ditetapkan item-item utama yang terdapat dalam instrument SKPM (standard kualiti pelajaran Malaysia) yang terbahagi kepada empat dimensi utama iaitu : Dimensi 1 : Kepimpinan dan hala tuju, dimensi 2 : pengurusan organisasi, dimensi 3:Pengurusan Ko kurikulum, sukan dan hal ehwal murid dan kemenjadian murid. Bahgaian ini juga perlu dijawap oleh guru sebagai responden untuk menilai sejauh m hubungan diantara kepimpinan ‘turnaround’ dengan kepimpinan empat dimensi yang ditetapkan oleh Standard Kualiti Pendidikan Malaysia yang diamalkan oleh pengetua sekolah berpencapaian rendah kepada sekolah cemerlang. Pilihan jawapan 71 kepada responden adalah menggunakan skala lima mata, menurut Mohamad Najib (1999) menyatakan reponden dikehendaki menandakan jawapan tentang sesuatu kenyataan berdasarkan satu skala dari satu extreme yang lain .Contohnya : jadual 1 di bawah menunjukkan skala lima mata tersebut. Jadual 1 (a) : Skor bagi skala Likert lima mata ( dipetik dari Mohd Najib Ghafar , 1999) Skor 1 2 3 4 Tahap Sangat Tidak Tidak Setuju Aplikasi tidak setuju Pasti 5 Sangat setuju setuju Manakala jadual 2 (b) dibawah menunjukkan taburan dan jumlah item bagi setiap amalan kepimpinan’turnaround’ pada soal selidik di bahgian B , lampiran 1. Jadual 2 (a) Taburan dan jumlah item dalam soal selidik AMALAN NOMBOR ITEM KEPIMPINAN ‘TURNAROUND Merapatkan jurang 1,2,3,4,5,6,7 prestasi antara prestasi rendah dan prestasi cemerlang Mengutamakan Tiga 16,17,49 asas utama Mewujudkan budaya 27,38 menghormati JUMLAH ITEM 7 3 72 Memastikan guru terbaik melaksanakan dasar 19,20,21,22,23, 5 Merangka Strategi yang Berorientasikan Tindakan dan Sosial Membina kapasiti secara berterusan 28,29,30,31,32, 33,34,35 8 8,13,18,36,37,40,4 1,42,43,47 10 Mengamalkan kepemimpinan berunsurkan kemanusiaan 9,10,15,24,25,26,3 9,4 8 Memberikan tekanan yang positif kepada guru 14,47,44,45,46,48 6 Jumlah keseluruhan item Membina akauntabiliti dalam menjurus kepada akauntabiliti luaran membina masyarakat 60 11,12,50,51,52,53 keyakinan 54,55,56,57,58 Jumlah item keseluruhan 60 Manakala jadual 2 (b) dibawah menunjukkan taburan dan jumlah item bagi setiap dimensi yang terdapat pada instrumen SKPM (Standard Kualiti Pendidikan Malaysia) pada soal selidik di bahagian B , lampiran 2. 73 Jadual 2(b) Taburan dan jumlah item dalam soal selidik DIMENSI Kepimpinan dan hala tuju Pengurusan organisasi ITEM SOALAN 1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9,1 0,11,12,13,14,15 16,17,18,19,20,21, NO SOALAN 5 24 22,23,24,25,26, 27,28,29,30,31,32, 33,34,35,36,37, 38,39. 40,41,42,43,44,45, Pengurusan ko kurikulum sukan dan hal 46,47,48,49,50 ehwal murid 51,52,53,54,55,56, 57,58,59,60 Kemenjadia 61,62,63,64,65,66, n murid 67,68 Jumlah keseluruhan item 21 8 68 Item –item soalan bagi kajian soal selidik dibina dengan merujuk kepada soal selidik daripada tesis asal daripada tesis iaitu Angela Antuanette Brown (2012), iaitu’ Turnaround school practice used by Nationally Recognised Principals to improve student Achievement In High Proverty SchooL iaitu Leithwood & Strauss (2009) dan sebagai tambahan dalam kajian ini pengkaji juga menggunakan instrumen SKPM iaitu standard Kualiti Pendidikan Malaysia bagi memenuhi persoalan dalam kajian . Manakala untuk kaedah kualitatif pula, pengkaji menggunakan soalan temuduga yang dibangunkan oleh Leitwood & Strauss iaitu dalam kajian Ontario. 74 Namun begitu, item-item di dalam soal selidik tersebut telah diubahsuai kesesuaian berdasarkan model Micheal Fullan bagi mengikut kajian dan responden yang terlibat. Soal selidik mempunyai 128 item dan sebanyak 9 soalan temuduga yang berkaitan dengan proses dan amalan ‘turnaround’. RUJUKAN Angela Antuantte Brown, 2012. Turnaround school : practices Used By Nationall Recognised Principals to Improve Students Achievement In High Poverty School Bill Barker . 2011. Turnaround Leadership How Three successful Leaders . Turned Around Their Schools TurnaroundPrincipal Christopher Corallo, Deborah H.McDonald ,2002 What works with Low Performing school Dana Brinson and Lucy Steiner, (2012). Building Family and Community Demand for District Leader.Dramatic change in school. Glen P. Watkins, 2013. The Federal Turnaround Model : Is There A Difference When the Principal of School Chang. Glenda Copeland dan Ann Neeley,2012. Identifying Competencies and Actions of Effectice Action of Effective Turnaround Principal. Kathleen M Hickey, 2010. Leadership Practices and Process In Turnaround Schools A Phenomenological Multi Case. Kenneth Leitwood, 2010. Turning Around Underperforming School Systems Guideline For Disctric Leader. Kennethe Leithwood dan Tiuss Strauss, 2008. Turnaround schools And Leadership They Required. Lokman Mohd Tahir dan Aimi Kaman , 2011. Kepimpinan situasi Dalam Kalangan Guru Besar Di Daerah Johor Bahru. Mary Lorelei Olsen, 2013. Leadership For School Turnaround for School Turnarounds.National Center Education Statistics Program For International Students Assessment ( PISA) Sharil @ Charii Bin Hj . Marzuki . Pembentukan Kerangka Teori Sekolah Cemerlang. Xavier C.Butler, 2012. In What In Ways Do Principal Impact School Climate inTurnaround Sucessful High PovertyMiddle School Yassin, Sanitah Mohd Yusof, 2008. Analisis Kepemimpinan Pengetua Sekolah . 75 LAMPIRAN AMALAN KEPIMPINAN ‘TURNAROUND’ Merapatkan jurang prestasi antara prestasi rendah dan prestasi cemerlang Mengutamakan Tiga asas utama NOMBOR ITEM 1,2,3,4,5,6,7 Mewujudkan budaya menghormati 27,38 Memastikan guru terbaik melaksanakan dasar Merangka Strategi yang Berorientasikan Tindakan dan Sosial Membina kapasiti secara berterusan 19,20,21,22,23, 5 28,29,30,31,32, 33,34,35 8,13,18,36,37,4 0,41,42,43,47 8 Mengamalkan kepemimpinan berunsurkan kemanusiaan 9,10,15,24,2 5,26,39,4 8 Memberikan tekanan yang positif kepada guru 14,47,44,45, 46,48 6 Membina akauntabiliti dalam menjurus kepada akauntabiliti luaran membina keyakinan masyarakat 11,12,50,51, 52,53,54,55,56, 57,58 16,17,49 Jumlah keseluruhan item JUMLAH ITEM 7 3 10 60 76 INTERNET USAGE AMONG UNDERGRADUATE STUDENTS IN A PUBLIC UNIVERSITY IN MALASIA Lu Xi & Kee Jiar-Yeo ABSTRACT This study aimed to investigate the Internet use among undergraduate students in Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. A questionnaire comprised by items of demographic information and Internet use information was used to collect the data. A total of 1389 students (21.13 ± 1.68 years old) answered the questionnaire, which found that 97.4% of students owned a personal computer. The sample of this study spent 6.60 (SD=4.93) hours per day and had more than seven years of Internet use experience. Three Internet activities were found to be more popular including SNS (e.g. Facebook), search/googling and instant message. The significant gender difference was identified that male spend much more time on MMORPG, female spent much more time on email, search/googling, shopping, and instant message. Keywords: Internet Use, Undergraduate Students, Internet Activities 77 INTRODUCTION Internet as the new technology affects society and people of different walks of life in various perspectives such as social interaction, leisure time, and how people communicate, study, work, doing business, and shopping. It provides a global data communication system between computers which bring many advantages such as faster communication, information resources, entertainment, social networking, and making life convenient and efficient. There are approximately 2.27 billion Internet users all over the world in 2011. The growth rate is 528.1% from 2000 to 2011. Asia takes the biggest population, more than one billion, followed by Europe and North America (Internet World Stats, 2011). The rapid increasing number of Internet use is also found in Malaysia from 3.70 million in 2000 to 17.72 million in 2010 (International Telecommunication Union, 2010). It has been widely used in higher education of various fields and permeated student’s study and life (Edmunds, Thorpe & Conole, 2010; Tella, 2007). Internet plays a prominent role among young people (Chan and Fang, 2007), which indicated that the majority of people spent one to three hours a day on the Internet. The Internet was the preferred media choice for information-driven activities, listening to music and for fun. A study in Malaysia reported that the university students spent 13.31 hours per week online and started using computers at the age of 14 on average (Guan,Isa, Hashim, Pillai & Singh, 2012). Among 11 Internet activities, three of them were selected as the favorite choice including SNS (e.g. Facebook), downloading, and instant message (Kim, LaRose, & Peng, 2009). The adverse effects of long time Internet use were stressed in many previous researches, such as Internet addiction or pathological Internet use (PIU) (Gencer and Koc, 2012; Katerelos, Tsekeris, Lavdas & Dimitriou, 2011; Frangos, Frangos, & Kiohos, 2010). A European study pointed that PIU was significantly related to the average hours online. The highest-ranked online activities were watching 78 videos, frequenting chat rooms and social networking (Durkee, Kaess, Carli, Parzer, Wasserman, Floderus, Apter, Balazs, Barzilay, Bobes, Brunner, Corcoran,Cosman, Cotter, Despalins, Graber, Guillemin, Haring, Kahn, Mandelli, Marusic, Mészáros, Musa, Postuvan, Resch, Saiz, Sisask, Varnik, Sarchiapone, Hoven & Wasserman, 2012). METHOD A total of 1389 undergraduate students in the age of 21.13 ± 1.68 from Universiti Teknologi Malaysia (UTM) responded on a pencil-paper questionnaire related to their Internet use. The sample was randomly selected from each faculty in UTM. Table 1 showed the sample composition, which revealed that the number of students in each year of programme was equivalent, about 25%, but the huge discrepancy was found in major field and race. As there are half of faculties, six out of 12 in UTM related to engineering field, the engineering respondents contributed almost half of the research samples (47.7%), followed were science (32.1%), art, humanity and social science (13.2%), and others (6.9%). While, the sample composition on race is quite similar with the ethnic composition of the whole population in Malaysia, which Malay contributed more than half of the samples (66.4%), followed by Chinese (26.6%), others (4.8%), Indian (2.2%). . The questionnaire comprises items of demographic information, Internet usage (e.g. have a personal computer, time spent on MMORPG, SNS, email, search, simple game, shopping, browsing with no specific purpose, media viewing, instant message), perception of influence from Internet use on study and physical health. 79 Table 1 Sample comprisal Major Gender Race Programme Frequency (n) Art, humanity and social science 184 science 446 engineering 663 others 96 male 788 female 601 Malay 922 Chinese 369 Indian 31 others 67 1st year undergraduate 336 2nd year undergraduate 345 3rd year undergraduate 366 4th year undergraduate 342 Percent (%) 13.2 32.1 47.7 6.9 56.7 43.3 66.4 26.6 2.2 4.8 24.2 24.8 26.3 24.6 RESULT AND FINGDINGS This simple investigation on Internet usage of undergraduate students in UTM found that majority of students (97.4%) owned at least one personal computer and their average Internet use experiences was 7.60 ±3.10 years with minimum of one year and maximum of 20 years. They averagely spent 6.60 (SD=4.93) hours on daily base which was much longer than the medical students (Guan,Isa, Hashim, Pillai & Singh, 2012). As shown in Table 2, these undergraduate students spent much longer time (more than three hours) on three Internet activities, SNS (e.g. Facebook), search/googling and instant message. The next activities was online media viewing (2.56 ± 2.37 h). Exactly as previous research findings, SNS were much more popular than other activities, which built a virtual social networking with others and provided various services and functions (Durkee et al., 2012; Kim, LaRose, & Peng, 2009). 80 Table 2 Time spent on Internet activities Mean (h) SD MMORPG 1.26 2.18 SNS 4.34 2.76 email 1.82 1.95 search 3.65 2.57 simple game 1.06 1.79 shopping 1.19 1.93 browsing with no specific purpose 1.90 2.25 media viewing 2.56 2.37 instant message 3.47 3.02 Internet activities MANOVA was conducted to test the gender difference on time spend in various Internet activates (Table 3), which indicated that there was significant difference between male and female students on some of Internet activities, such as MMORPG, shopping. Female students were found to spend much more time on email, search/googling, shopping, and instant message compared to the male ones, while male students tended to spend much more time on MMORPG. The finding of these Malaysian students was quite similar as students in Europe that female preferred watching video, social networking, and chatting, while males would like playing massive online multi-user games (Durkee et al., 2012). Table 3 Gender difference on Internet activities Internet activities male female Between-Subjects Effects M SD M SD F Sig. MMORPG 1.78 2.46 0.58 1.50 111.34 0.00 SNS 4.19 2.80 4.55 2.71 5.82 0.16 email 1.66 1.81 2.03 2.12 12.15 0.00 search 3.26 2.47 4.16 2.61 41.74 0.00 81 simple game 1.05 1.74 1.06 1.86 0.02 0.89 shopping browsing with no specific purpose 0.87 1.68 1.61 2.16 52.13 0.00 1.87 2.25 1.93 2.26 0.26 0.61 media viewing 2.51 2.35 2.63 2.40 0.91 0.34 instant message Multivariate Test 3.08 2.82 3.98 3.20 30.86 0.00 Pillai's Trace 0.76 Sig. 0.00 CONCLUSION This study examined the Internet use among undergraduate students in UTM, found that these students averagely spent a quarter of a normal day time of 24 hours, which was much longer than other previous studies. Among nine Internet activities, SNS was the most popular one, followed by search/googling, instant message, and online media viewing. The significant gender distinction was identified on five activities, MMORPG, email, search/googling, shopping, and instant message. REFERENCES Chan, K. & Fang, W. 2007. Use of the internet and traditional media among young people. Young Consumers 8(4): 244-256. Durkee, T., Kaess, M., Carli, V., Parzer, P., Wasserman, C., Floderus, B., Apter, A., Balazs, J., Barzilay, S., Bobes, J., Brunner, R., Corcoran, P., Cosman, D., Cotter, P., Despalins, R., Graber, N., Guillemin, F., Haring, C., Kahn, J.P., Mandelli, L., Marusic, D., Mészáros, G., Musa, G.J., Postuvan, V., Resch, F., Saiz, P.A., Sisask, M., Varnik, A., Sarchiapone, M., Hoven, C.W. & Wasserman, D. 2012. Prevalence of pathological internet use 82 among adolescents in Europe: demographic and social factors. Addiction. 107(12), 2210–2222. doi:10.1111/j.13600443.2012.03946.x Edmunds, R., Thorpe, M., & Conole, G. 2010. Student attitudes towards and use of ICT in course study, work and social activity: A technology acceptance model approach, British Journal of Educational Technology. 43(1), 71-84. Frangos, C. C., Frangos, C. C., & Kiohos, A. P. 2010. Internet addiction among Greek university students: Demographic associations with the phenomenon, using the Greek version of Young’s internet addiction test. International Journal of Economic Sciences and Applied Research, 3(1), 49–74. Gencer, S. L., & Koc, M. 2012. Internet Abuse among Teenagers and Its Relations to Internet Usage Patterns andDemographics. Educational Technology & Society, 15 (2), 25–36. Guan, N. C. Isa, S. M. Hashim, A. H. Pillai, S. K. & Singh, M. K. H. 2012. Validity of the Malay Version of the Internet Addiction Test: A Study on a Group of Medical Students in Malaysia. Asia-Pacific Journal of Public Health. DOI: 10.1177/1010539512447808 Internet Usage World Stats- The Big Picture- Population Statistics 2011. Available http://www.internetworldstats.com/stats.htm Katerelos, I. Tsekeris, C., Lavdas, M. & Dimitriou, K. 2011. A Psychosocial Approach to the Use of the Internet and Massive Online Role Playing Games. Philosophy, Sociology, Psychology and History. 10 (1), 73-88. Kim, J. LaRose, R & Peng, W. 2009. Loneliness as the Cause and the Effect of Problematic Internet Use: The Relationship between Internet Use and Psychological Well-being. CyberPsychology & Behavior. 12(4), 451-455. DOI: 10.1089=cpb.2008.0327 Malaysian Communications and Multimedia Commission. 2010. Household use of the Internet survey 2009. Cyberjaya: Suruhanjaya Komunikasi dan Multimedia Malaysia Tella, A. 2007. University of Botswana Undergraduates Uses of the Internet: Implications on Academic Performance. Journal of Educational Media and Library Sciences, 45(2), 161–185. 83 MEETING SUPERVISORS’ EXPECTATIONS IN UNDERGRADUATE FINAL YEAR PROJECT REPORT Salawati Ahmad & Masputeriah Hamzah INTRODUCTION In most tertiary institutions around the world, including Malaysia, the final milestone for engineering undergraduate programmes is the final year project (FYP). Typically, the FYP involves design or research, or both, and runs over two semesters or a full year. While completing the project, the undergraduates also write a report, known as final year project report (FYPR). This report, which is sometimes referred to as ‘thesis writing’, is regarded as an important genre of academic writing in the engineering programmes, where students need to apply and integrate their theoretical knowledge and skills to solve a given task in two academic semesters. The FYPR is counted as a part of the fulfilment for graduation, hence, its importance to the undergraduates (Dahari et al. 2012; Ku & Goh 2010). For the undergraduate students, both tasks of conducting the project and writing the report is their new experience which always becomes challenging to complete (Bitchener et al. 2010). Nonetheless, students attempt to meet the faculty’s requirement and submit the project report for assessment and graduation purpose. In order to 84 guide the undergraduates in carrying out the projects as well as writing the reports, supervisors are assigned for each of them. They are the academic tutors of the faculty themselves. The project supervisors who are responsible to guide these students have their own expectations and beliefs about the way the report should be written. These expectations are driven from supervisors’ own experience, faculty’s requirement, and rubric for the report assessment. Supervisors have had experience in academic writing, for instance, dissertation or thesis, research articles, and also project reports. However, a more experienced supervisor and a rather novice supervisor may have different expectation and belief toward the undergraduates and the reports they are writing (Jones 2003). Faculty’s requirement of a certain academic writing like FYPR is usually reflected in the rubrics of the assessment. The rubric serves as the guidelines for what a FYPR must contain. It also tells a certain level of knowledge in subject matter to which the undergraduate writer must meet and demonstrate in the report (Dahari et al. 2012; Webster et al. 2000). It is these expectations and beliefs which are important for students to know and understand in order to write the report effectively, thus, meeting their supervisors’ and the other faculty members’ requirement of good report writing. Despite supervisors’ good intention to ensure that the undergraduates are successful in writing the FYPR, question remains as to what exactly they want to see from the report. What, to them, makes a good report? Since writing FYPR is new to the undergraduates, what difficulties or challenges that supervisors think the students are facing? What about students’ use of language in report writing where they write in English? Therefore, this small scale study was conducted to unfold the answers to the questions so that many undergraduates will benefit and understand of what they are expected to do. To answer these questions, a semistructured interview was administered. The main objectives of the interviews were first, to explore supervisors’ thought and expectations of undergraduates FYPR; second, to find out their perceptions about difficulties students face in writing the report; 85 and third is to identify the language needs for academic writing among students of engineering programme. LITERATURE REVIEW Previous studies on supervisors’ expectation of students’ thesis writing provide some insights into what students should do in order to meet the requirement of good writing. For example, research conducted by Jones (2003) shows that supervisors for final year project do have some expectations such as students need to be creative and able to make decision when delivering the project. However, the supervisors did not provide clear explanation or checklist for students so that they could follow or try to meet what is expected of them and their writing. This has led to frustration among students especially if writing the report is their first time experience. Other than that, research conducted by Gassman et al. (2013) reveal that some faculties provide academic writing workshops for students who are at the stage of thesis writing. This workshop is a platform for the students to have discussion with their supervisors. Through discussions, supervisors respond according to what students need to know, hence, making it less difficult to write the report. In addition to the studies mentioned above, a number of previous studies have also been conducted to investigate perceived difficulties that students face when writing thesis. For instance, Bitchener & Basturkmen (2006) study post-graduates’ difficulties in writing discussion sections of the thesis. In this study, the perception of difficulties was taken from the point of view of students instead of the supervisors. Dong (1998) and Hill (2012) have also investigated graduate students who have difficulties in writing their thesis.. There are also some research that study students’ difficulties in writing from the point of view of the supervisor. For example, Bitchener et al. (2010) report that supervisors found students have difficulties in two aspects, namely, the structure and the organisation of the thesis, and the language 86 element at sentence and paragraph levels. From language aspect, it seems that students whose English is not their first language (L2) face with much more difficulties then those whose English is their first language (L1) (Bitchener & Basturkmen 2006; Liming 2009; Bitchener et al. 2010; Lee & Casal 2014). In those examples, focus was given to post graduate students experience in thesis writing rather than undergraduates’ final year project writing. While it is beneficial for undergraduates to learn the information given at post graduate level, it is also important for them to know what is expected of them as new writers who have no or less experience in writing academic reports. Therefore, this study is conducted to explore such issues so that it could provide meaningful insights for undergraduates, thus help them to better understand the expectations. RESEARCH SETTING This study involves participants from the Faculty of Mechanical and Manufacturing Engineering (FKMP), at one of the technical universities in Malaysia. The faculty is one of the major engineering faculties in the university and it is selected because there is very little information available in the literature about undergraduate’s final year project report writing for mechanical engineering field. Five final year project report supervisors were selected according to purposeful sampling procedure (Patton 2002). They have a minimum of five years teaching experience to undergraduates. The year of experience is crucial as supervisors have gone through teaching and supervising different group of students for many years. This provides important insights into what they expect from students when writing the final year project reports. All supervisors who participated in this research have graduated their doctoral degree from universities in the United Kingdom and Australia. They have a range of between five to fifteen years of teaching at university, and have written a number of research articles throughout their career as academicians. 87 Interview is chosen as the instrument because it intends to understand the participants’ views about a certain issue and the experience they live through. It is a ‘professional conversation’ where ‘knowledge is constructed in the inter-action between the interviewer and interviewee… an inter-change of views between two persons conversing about a theme of mutual interest’ (Kvale & Brinkmann 2009:2). A set of questions was prepared that served as a guide for the interview. Since this was a semi-structured interview, the session allowed further probing questions for explanation or elaboration of certain unclear answer. By doing this, it gives further understanding of the phenomena being investigated. Each interview session lasted between thirty to fortyfive minutes depending on the participants’ responses and explanation to the questions presented to them. The session was audio-recorded for the purpose of transcription and analysis. The analysis stage involved decision making based on the purposes of the interview and the topic being investigated outlined prior to the session. Kvale (2007) presents two modes of interview analysis which are analysis focusing on meaning and analysis focusing on language. For this study, analysis that focused on meaning was adopted because the purposes of the interview were to investigate the perceptions and expectations, not language matters. Meaning coding is one of the focuses which involves ‘attaching one or more keywords to a text segment in order to permit later identification of a statement’ (ibid:105). From this, participants’ answers were identified and given codes for further analysis. FINDINGS AND DISCUSSIONS The interview questions from Bitchener & Basturkmen (2006) were adapted and interview questions were formulated in order to discover responses that will provide answers to the objectives of the study. The questions are as the following: 1. What do you think of FYPR writing? Which part do you think 88 is the most difficult, and which part is the most important for engineering undergraduates to deal with? Why? What do you emphasise on for the writing of the final year project report? 2. What do you and other members of the academic community (faculty members/other supervisors/panels of examiners) expect of the students in their FYPR writing? What do you think are the main problems for your students to fulfill those expectations? 3. How do you generally assist the students to address the problem? What do you think students should do to improvise the way they write the FYPR? 4. What could be the role of English language teacher to assist students in writing academic genre in English? Supervisors’ thought and expectation of FYPR writing In the interview, supervisors were asked what they think about final year project report and also what they expect from students’ work of FYPR. All supervisors agreed that FYPR is important to undergraduates. Final year project is a structured comprehensive way of doing scientific research because they experience how research is done, and this is where they apply knowledge they have gained throughout years of study in the programme. Since FYPR is compulsory for all undergraduates, they have no option but to conduct and do it well. It is where all the knowledge comes together which include how to present things, how to speak, and how to convince people. In addition, supervisors believe that students should learn from references available in the library or resource room. From there, they should be able to make concise summaries and give ideas and opinion about what they have read. When students do this, it will help in their writing because they have seen some samples which act as a ‘model’ for the FYPR. Besides that, it should be noted that there are several different types of project that students can do. For example, the project can be of simulation, experiment, and design 89 types. The way the report is written differs according to type of project that the student chooses to do. From the answers given by the supervisors, it could be understood that they expect students to read a lot from various sources. By doing so, students will be able to ‘analyse’ different examples of reports, looking at the structure, the way content is organized, and identify different types of writing. This way, students have actually done ‘genre analysis’ as suggested by Hyland (2004). When the supervisors highlighted that each type of project has different way of writing the report, they explained that the design-type-project may contain less wording but consists of more photos or diagrams. Whereas for experiment and simulation, the reports consist of lots of explanation. It is therefore important for students to become aware of the differences so that they will know what to write in their reports (Johns 2008; Ross 2012). In terms of the emphasis of the FYPR, all supervisors agreed that content is the most important element of the report. In Johari et al. (2002), they claim that the graduates who will become engineer must possess strong scientific knowledge so they will be able to function effectively in the global arena. One way to show this strength is through delivering the project in report writing. In the report, there is a standard format that needs to be followed. The standard structure contains Introduction, literature review, methodology, findings and discussion, and finally, conclusion and recommendation. Undergraduates are expected to write sufficient information in each part of the report and they should ensure that what is written shows some interconnectedness. For example, review of related literature serves as the basis of the project whereby students look for area to be improved from previous research. In methodology, they have to explain in detail how the project is carried out. This include the setting up of experiment, instrumentation, and data collection procedure. However, it must be noted that language use is also important. Supervisors believe that accurate language use is important in order to deliver the content of the project, in particular the data and findings and how to write about it. If the project produces lots of 90 data but the student does not know how to write about it, then it will be at disadvantage as the important information could not be explained. Supervisors’ perceptions of undergraduates’ difficulties in writing FYPR After several years of supervising undergraduates doing project and writing the reports, the supervisors have identified the challenges and difficulties that students face especially in writing the report. Among the obvious difficulties that students face are two aspects. First, they don’t know what and how to write. In particular, when they obtain findings from the experiment, they find it difficult to write about it. They also do not know how to connect the findings with the previous research that they have reviewed prior to the project writing itself. The difficulties that the supervisors have mentioned are concerned with students’ lack of knowledge in writing itself. This is understandable since FYPR is the first lengthy academic paper that students have to write in throughout the degree programme. Specifically, the difficulty is obvious when students face with uncertainty in writing the discussion of the results for the report. When supervisors were asked about what content that should be included in the discussion, they gave various answers. Everyone agreed that it should begin with the results, then followed by explanation of the results. Results could be explained by identifying logical reasons, linking ideas with previous studies, and comparing with other studies that have different results. From close supervision, it could be said that some students manage to write the discussion correctly, however, many are still unsure on how to write. Second, students have difficulty in using English language when writing. Since FYPR is written in English language and most students at the faculty are L2, some of them find it difficult to deliver information effectively. 91 Language needs for academic writing in engineering programme While it is important to emphasise on the content of the report, use of good language is also important in writing the report. However, this aspect does not receive equal emphasis if compared to the content of the FYPR. It has been accepted at the faculty that examiners emphasise on the content of the report rather than language use. Language serves as a tool to deliver or communicate the content. Students should show mastery of language or writing skill. Furthermore, they have learnt English in the first three or four semesters of the programme. They should be able to make use of what they have learnt and apply in the report writing. Even so, the supervisors have identified certain aspects of language that the students are still lacking in, such as in terms of complex sentence construction, choice of either active or passive statement, and use of tenses at appropriate place. Supervisor also said that undergraduates must know how to write the report because when they become an engineer, they will have to write a lot of reports at workplace. When asked about how supervisors assist students in grammar or language use, their responses differ. One supervisor was kind enough to correct the grammar and show the students the acceptable way of sentence construction for the report. Another supervisor normally asks students to read a lot of books on basic writing skill or techniques instead of reading a more advanced writing book. This, to her, is to give students a wider sense of how writing should be done effectively, which is appropriate with their level of understanding. The rest of the supervisors simply ask students to send their FYPR(s) to language teachers for proofreading. To them, correcting sentences and paragraphs, and to check for grammatical accuracy is the task of a language teacher. CONCLUSION Responses obtained from this small scale study that involved 92 interviewing five supervisors of final year project report, could be used to inform the undergraduates in understanding what are expected of them when writing the report. Supervisors’ perception of the importance of FYPR implies that students must undertake the writing task seriously and they must make sure the report written meets not only supervisors’ but also examiners’ expectations. Furthermore, students with difficulties in writing must find ways to improve their writing skills. This could be done by reading and understanding more examples of reports, and having discussions with project supervisors. In terms of difficulties in using English language to write the reports, students may also refer to language teachers for advice. There are certain language elements that students are particularly weak at, such as sentence construction and use of active-passive voice. This weakness may risk the effectiveness of a report. To sum up, supervisors’ expectations should be made known clearly to undergraduates so that the latter are aware of the FYPR genre and understand how it should be written. REFERENCES Bitchener, J. & Basturkmen, H., 2006. Perceptions of the difficulties of postgraduate L2 thesis students writing the discussion section. Journal of English for Academic Purposes, 5, pp.4–18. Bitchener, J., Basturkmen, H. & East, M., 2010. The Focus of Supervisor Written Feedback to Thesis/Dissertation Students. International Journal of English Studies, 10(2), pp.79–97. Dahari, Z., Ngah, U.K. & Mohamad, N., 2012. Continuous Quality Improvement ( CQI ) Implementation in Electrical & Electronic Engineering Final Year Projects. In 4th International Congress of Engineering Education Proceedings. Dong, Y.R., 1998. Non-native Graduate Students’ Thesis/Dissertation Writing in Science: Self-reports by Students and Their Advisors from Two U.S. Institutions. English for Specific Purposes, 17(4), pp.369–390. Gassman, S.L., Maher, M.A. & Timmerman, B.E., 2013. Supporting 93 Students ’ Disciplinary Writing in Engineering Education. International Journal of Engineering Education, 29(5), pp.1270– 1280. Hill, H., 2012. Telling What They Know ; Performing What They Say : Genre Awareness and the Transferability of Writing. University of Washington. Hyland, K., 2004. Genre and Second Language Writing, Michigan: The University of Michigan Press. Johari, M.M.N.M. et al., 2002. A New Engineering Education Model for Malaysia. International Journal of Engineering Education, 18(1), pp.8–16. Johns, A.M., 2008. Genre awareness for the novice academic student: An ongoing quest. Language Teaching, 41(02), pp.237–252. Jones, T.L., 2003. Instructor Expectations in a Project-based Undergraduate Mechanical Engineering Classroom. The University of Texas at Austin. Ku, H. & Goh, S., 2010. Final year engineering projects in Australia and Europe. European Journal of Engineering, 35(2), pp.161–173. Kvale, S., 2007. Doing interviews U. Flick, ed., Los Angeles: SAGE Publications. Kvale, S. & Brinkmann, S., 2009. Interviews: Learning the craft of qualitative research interviewing 2nd ed., Los Angeles: SAGE Publications. Lee, J.J. & Casal, J.E., 2014. Metadiscourse in results and discussion chapters: A cross-linguistic analysis of English and Spanish thesis writers in engineering. System, 46, pp.39–54. Liming, D., 2009. A genre-based investigation of the discussion and conclusion sections of L2 Chinese Social Science Doctoral Theses. Hong Kong: City University of Hong Kong. Patton, M.Q., 2002. Qualitative Research and Evaluation Methods 3 rd., London: SAGE Publications. Ross, K.G., 2012. Genre at work: an analysis of first-year writing assignments. University of Colorado Denver. Webster, F., Pepper, D. & Jenkins, A., 2000. Assessing the Undergraduate Dissertation. Assessment & Evaluation in Higher Education, 25(1), pp.71–80. 94 KEBERKESANAN MODUL NILAI KELESTARIAN DALAM TOPIK DAYA TINGKATAN 4 Mohd Fadhli Zakaria & Fatin Aliah Phang ABSTRAK Education for sustainable development (ESD) is an initiative done by UNESCO to increase the awareness about sustainable development starting from early school education. Nearly most of the research done in this field mainly focusing on the level of knowledge and awareness that students and teachers have in Malaysia regarding sustainable development . Current research done on the integration of ESD in formal education is still less compared to those done for environmental education. This research is done to find out how far ESD can be integrated into formal education particularly in Physics KBSM and enhance the teaching of higher order thinking skills (HOTS). In order to answer the research questions, a teaching and learning module is set up to integrate ESD and HOTS into the topic Forces. Four schools were selected to use the module to see how the teachers implement the ESD values and HOTS questions to their students. A pre-post test was conducted on the students to know their achievements. The research findings were analysed using inferential statistics ANCOVA and MANOVA to find significant difference between the mean of the pretest and post test. Findings from the ANCOVA analysis shows that there is no significant difference between the 95 mean scores among the schools for the concept of Forces with F(3,116) = 1.917, p >.05, eta squared = .047 but a significant difference between the mean scores among the school for the mastery of HOTS questions with F(3,116) = 7.337, p <.05, eta squared = .159. Findings from the MANOVA analysis shows that there is a significant difference between students answering lower order thinking skill (LOTS) questions and HOTS questions, F(18, 317.269) = 2.057, p = .007, Wilk’s Lambda = .732, partial eta squared = .099. Further analysis shows that students were capable in answering questions involving understanding and analysing a problem better than the other cognitive levels. This shows that students with the help of the module were able to increase their knowledge in Forces and develop their thinking skills more towards analysing problems and understanding them. These two qualities are important to develop the skills needed for ESD to be integrated into formal education. Keywords: Physics, HOTS, Sustainable Development PENGENALAN Dasar Pendidikan Kebangsaan melalui Pelan Induk Pembangunan Pendidikan 2001-2010 telah mensasarkan untuk menyediakan peluang pendidikan kepada rakyat selama 11 tahun untuk mengembangkan potensi individu secara holistik dan bersepadu untuk menghasilkan individu yang seimbang dari segi jasmani, emosi, rohani dan intelek; mampu untuk berfikiran kritis dan kreatif serta berinovasi tinggi; seterusnya memacu budaya pembelajaran dan menggalakkan pembelajaran yang berterusan di kalangan masyarakat (KPM, 2001). Menurut Mariani (2008), cabaran pada alaf baru adalah untuk mengharung prinsip-prinsip pembangunan lestari yang sudah direka kepada dasar-dasar yang boleh dicapai yang akan menghasilkan perubahan-perubahan yang nyata. Di sini dapat dilihat bahawa pendidikan di Malaysia memberi peluang kepada perubahan yang positif yang perlu 96 diterapkan kepada generasi muda untuk memastikan pendidikan yang diperoleh adalah berterusan dan lestari. Cabang ilmu Fizik secara umumnya telah memberikan sumbangan yang banyak kepada pembangunan dunia. Ilmu Fizik yang luas meliputi pelbagai aspek kehidupan seperti kesihatan, ekonomi, kebajikan masyarakat dan negara. Contohnya, seperti perkembangan bidang bioteknologi dan nanoteknologi yang merupakan pintu kepada kemajuan yang dikecapi pada masa kini. Satu persidangan telah dibuat oleh World Conference on Physics and Sustainable Development (WCPSD) pada tahun 2005 berkenaan penglibatan ilmu Fizik dalam memberi manfaat yang terbaik untuk masyarakat yang pelbagai. Kebanyakan negara membangun kini sedang mencari model pembangunan alternatif untuk menyaingi negara lain di pasaran ekonomi global (WCPSD, 2005). Jika ilmu Fizik dikatakan memberi manfaat kepada masyarakat dari pelbagai segi, maka perlunya pendedahan pengajian ilmu Fizik yang berkualiti kepada masyarakat di kawasan bandar dan luar bandar supaya dapat melahirkan masyarakat yang progresif dan berdaya saing serta mempunyai fikrah pembangunan lestari. LATAR BELAKANG MASALAH Menurut Arba’at Hassan (2006), tahap pengetahuan guru terhadap permasalahan alam sekitar merupakan antara cabaran utama yang menghalang guru mengintegrasikan pendidikan alam sekitar dengan matapelajaran yang di ajar. Ini jelas apabila penyampaian pendidikan alam sekitar di peringkat sekolah rendah tidak berkesan kerana guru kurang kemahiran untuk menangani proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran tajuk tertentu. Selain itu, Menurut Lee (2013), guru Fizik lebih cenderung untuk mengajar berdasarkan pengalaman yang diperoleh sewaktu pembelajaran mereka dahulu. Ini menunjukkan jika guru tiada pendedahan berkenaan isu alam sekitar ketika zaman persekolahan mahupun di universiti dahulu, mereka tidak mampu untuk mengaitkan isu 97 tersebut dengan topik yang akan diajar apatah lagi menerapkan nilai kelestarian. Selain tahap pengetahuan, kesedaran guru terhadap isu alam sekitar juga dapat menunjukkan minat dan sikap guru tersebut untuk mengintegrasikan isu alam sekitar ke dalam pengajaran. Kajian Azizi et al. (2011) yang dijalankan terhadap pengetua sekolah menunjukkan tahap kesedaran untuk memelihara alam sekitar di kawasan sekolah adalah tinggi walaupun tahap pengetahuan mereka rendah. Selain itu, faktor kekangan masa dan keperluan untuk mengejar silibus peperiksaan awam membuatkan guru lebih cenderung untuk mengajar menggunakan kaedah konvensional iaitu Chalk and Talk yang dapat menjimatkan masa dan tidak memerlukan guru melakukan persediaan yang lama dan rumit berbanding kaedah lain (Hand, 2004). Huraian sukatan pelajaran untuk matapelajaran Fizik KBSM telah diterbitkan sejak tahun 1989 dan disemak semula pada tahun 2000 dan sehingga kini tidak mengalami perubahan yang banyak (Abu Hassan, 2001). Walaupun di dalam Huraian Sukatan Pelajaran ada menyatakan berkenaan nilai-nilai murni dan saintifik yang perlu diterapkan kepada pelajar namun guru masih tidak dapat sepenuhnya mengarap nilai dalam matapelajaran Fizik dan mempraktikkannya kepada pelajar. Ini adalah kerana bagi menerapkan nilai tersebut, guru perlu melakukan aktiviti bersama pelajar bagi memastikan maksud nilai diserap oleh pelajar (Norazizah et al.,2001). Namun dengan kesibukan mengejar masa dan silibus, aktiviti penerapan nilai seringkali diabaikan oleh guru (Abdul Rahim, 2009). PENYATAAN MASALAH Penyelidik mendapati bahawa sebuah modul perlu dibangunkan bagi membantu guru untuk menjelaskan konsep Fizik dengan lebih mudah dan pada masa yang sama dapat menerapkan unsur kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi dalam pengajaran mereka untuk menggalakkan pemikiran ke arah pembangunan lestari. 98 OBJEKTIF KAJIAN Secara khususnya objektif kajian ini ialah untuk: i. membangunkan modul pengajaran dan pembelajaran Fizik KBSM yang dapat membantu guru menerapkan nilai kelestarian ke dalam pengajarannya untuk topik Daya. ii. mengenal pasti keberkesanan modul dalam pengajaran konsep Daya dalam kalangan pelajar Fizik iii. mengenal pasti keberkesanan modul dalam mengamalkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi (KBAT) dalam pengajaran dan pembelajaran Fizik. iv. mengenal pasti masalah yang dihadapi oleh guru dalam menerapkan nilai kelestarian dan KBAT dalam pengajaran dan pembelajaran. PERSOALAN KAJIAN Berdasarkan objektif kajian di atas, soalan-soalan kajian seperti berikut telah dibentuk: i. Apakah tahap penguasaan pelajar terhadap topik Daya pelajar sebelum menggunakan modul pembelajaran? ii. Apakah tahap penguasaan topik Daya pelajar selepas menggunakan modul pembelajaran? iii. Adakah terdapat perbezaan yang signifikan dalam tahap penguasaan pelajar terhadap penguasaan topik Daya pelajar sebelum dan selepas menggunakan modul pembelajaran? iv. Apakah tahap penguasaan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi (KBAT) untuk topik Daya pelajar sebelum menggunakan modul pembelajaran? v. Apakah tahap penguasaan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi (KBAT) untuk topik Daya pelajar selepas menggunakan modul pembelajaran? vi. Adakah terdapat perbezaan yang signifikan dalam tahap penguasaan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi (KBAT) untuk topik Daya pelajar? 99 vii. Apakah masalah yang dihadapi oleh guru dalam menerapkan KBAT dalam pengajaran dan pembelajaran? KERANGKA KAJIAN Persediaan yang rapi akan menyebabkan pengajaran seseorang menjadi sistematik, teratur dan terarah. Namun, dalam pelaksanaan pengajaran di makmal, penerapan nilai sebenar kepada pelajar oleh guru mungkin berubah mengikut keadaan semasa di dalam makmal. Antara faktor yang dilihat mempengaruhi penerapan nilai adalah sikap pelajar sewaktu pembelajaran, tindakan dan arahan dari pentadbir sekolah berkaitan nilai, silibus kurikulum yang perlu dihabiskan dan penggunaan buku teks oleh guru semasa penerangan di buat (Zohir et al., 2007). Kajian ini menerapkan konsep pendidikan nilai kelestarian yang diolah daripada konsep pendidikan alam sekitar Palmer et al., (1996) di mana guru dapat memupuk nilai kelestarian dengan lebih terarah dan sistematik. Konsep ini dijadikan teras kepada pembinaan modul pengajaran dan pembelajaran bagi membantu guru menerapkan nilai kelestarian bersama dengan unsur persoalan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi (KBAT). Rajah 1.1: Kerangka Kajian 100 METODOLOGI REKA BENTUK KAJIAN Reka bentuk kajian ini adalah berbentuk kuantitatif. Penyelidik memilih untuk melakukan kajian dengan menggunakan kaedah reka bentuk kuasi eksperimen bagi mengenal pasti keberkesanan modul untuk meningkatkan pencapaian pelajar dalam pemahaman topik Daya dan penguasaan konsep KBAT. Dapatan maklumat dilakukan dengan melakukan ujian pra dan ujian pasca bagi mengenal pasti jika terdapatnya perbezaan yang signifikan antara tahap penguasaan pelajar dalam topik berkenaan merentas sekolah sebelum diberikan rawatan menggunakan modul pengajaran dan pembelajaran topik Daya dan selepas diberikan rawatan. INSTRUMEN Instrumen kajian adalah ujian yang terdiri daripada dua bahagian di mana Bahagian A mengemukakan soalan yang menguji konsep dan kefahaman pelajar terhadap topik Daya (Ujian Konsep Daya, UKD dan Bahagian B adalah soalan esei yang diubahsuai daripada soalan KBAT yang dikeluarkan oleh pihak Lembaga Peperiksaan untuk menguji tahap penguasaan KBAT pelajar (Ujian konsep KBAT). Selain itu, pemerhatian juga dilakukan untuk mengenalpasti masalah guru dalam pengajaran nilai kelestarian dan pengamalan KBAT di dalam kelas dilakukan dengan menggunakan instrumen senarai semak. Penyelidik akan menggunakan Senarai Semak Pemerhatian yang dibentuk melalui pengubahsuaian senarai semak pemerhatian berstruktur dan skedul rakaman peristiwa berdasarkan blok masa (BPDPP, 2008). 101 ANALISIS KAJIAN Data ujian pra dan pasca bagi kedua-dua ujian dianalisa dengan menggunakan analisis statistik inferensi ANCOVA untuk mencari perbezaan peningkatan skor min yang signifikan merentas sekolah dengan mengawal skor min ujian pra. Analisis kolerasi Pearson dilakukan untuk melihat hubungan antara skor min kedua-dua ujian antara satu sama lain. Seterusnya, analisis statistik inferensi MANOVA digunakan untuk mencari tahap perbezaan signifikan antara skor min item KBAR dan KBAT dalam ujian UKD. Seterusnya, analisis regresi dilakukan ke atas data ujian UKD untuk mencari item yang paling banyak dijawab oleh pelajar dengan betul. ANALISIS DATA ISI KANDUNGAN MODUL Menurut temubual yang telah dilakukan dengan guru dan pelajar yang terlibat dengan kajian, penyelidik mendapati bahawa modul membantu guru dalam menerangkan konsep serta menaikkan minat pelajar untuk mempelajari topik. Modul juga membantu pelajar untuk belajar mengenai topik. Seterusnya apabila ditanya mengenai bahan yang terdapat dalam modul membantu menjawab soalan beraras tinggi, tiga daripada empat guru menyatakan modul masih kurang membincangkan bahan untuk menjawab soalan beraras tinggi dan tidak menekankan soalan jenis mengaplikasi, menganalisis, menilai dan mencipta. Namun seorang guru berpendapat bahawa modul mampu menbantu pelajarnya menjawab soalan beraras tinggi. Beliau menyatakan bahawa pelajarnya lebih yakin menjawab soalan setelah menggunakan modul. 102 UJIAN PENGETAHUAN KONSEP DAYA (UKD) Analisis ANCOVA dijalankan kepada data UKDpos bagi sekolahsekolah responden dengan menjadikan data UKDpra sebagai kovariat dan diukur sebelum semua sekolah diberikan modul pengajaran. Setelah mengawal skor UKDpra, maka analisis statistik menunjukkan terdapat perbezaan yang tidak signifikan ke atas skor UKDpos antara sekolah-sekolah, F(3,116) = 1.917, p >.05, eta squared = .047. Analisis menunjukkan terdapat perkaitan yang sangat rendah (r = .051) dan signifikan antara skor UKDpra sebelum modul diberikan kepada pelajar dan skor UKDpos selepas pengajaran dengan modul. UJIAN PENGETAHUAN KONSEP DAYA (UKD) Analisis ANCOVA dijalankan kepada data UKDpos bagi sekolahsekolah responden dengan menjadikan data UKDpra sebagai kovariat dan diukur sebelum semua sekolah diberikan modul pengajaran. Setelah mengawal skor UKDpra, maka analisis statistik menunjukkan terdapat perbezaan yang tidak signifikan ke atas skor UKDpos antara sekolah-sekolah, F(3,116) = 1.917, p >.05, eta squared = .047. Analisis menunjukkan terdapat perkaitan yang sangat rendah (r = .051) dan signifikan antara skor UKDpra sebelum modul diberikan kepada pelajar dan skor UKDpos selepas pengajaran dengan modul. ANALISIS KOLERASI UKD & KBAT Analisis kolerasi Pearson dilakukan bagi mencari hubungan antara skor min UKD dan skor min KBAT merentas sekolah. Terdapat hubungan yang signifikan p<.01 antara skor min UKDpos dan skor min KBATpos. Nilai kolerasi antara kedua-dua ujian juga menunjukkan hubungan yang kuat r = .587 103 ANALISIS MANOVA ITEM KBAR & KBAT Analisis MANOVA dijalankan bagi melihat perbezaan yang signifikan dalam capaian skor item KBAR dan KBAT dalam ujian UKD. Enam pemboleh ubah bersandar digunakan iaitu skor Ingatpos, Fahampos, Aplikasipos, Analisispos, Nilaipos dan Ciptapos. Pemboleh ubah tidak bersandar adalah sekolah. Keputusan analisis menunjukkan terdapat perbezaan yang signifikan antara item KBAR dan KBAT dalam ujian UKD, F(18, 317.269) = 2.057, p = .007, Wilk’s Lambda = .732, partial eta squared = .099. Apabila keputusan bagi setiap satu pemboleh ubah bersandar diasingkan, hanya pemboleh ubah bersandar skor Fahampos, F(3,117) = 3.540, p = .017, partial eta squared = .083 dan Analisispos, F(3,117) = 3.552, p = .017, partial eta squared = .083 sahaja yang berbeza secara signifikan antara sekolah pada tahap signifikan p<.05. Walaupun begitu, apabila item dianalisis menggunakan Bonferroni adjustment, nilai signifikan adalah pada tahap p = .008. Analisis menunjukkan tiada item yang signifikan pada nilai signifikan tersebut. Analisis ANOVA sehala dijalankan bagi mengenalpasti sekolah yang mempunyai perbezaan yang signifikan antara satu sama lain untuk item Fahampos dan Analisispos. Keputusan analisis post-hoc mendapati skor min item Fahampos bagi pelajar dari SMK Taman Mount Austin (M = 1.53, SD = 1.082) berbeza secara signifikan dengan pelajar dari SMK Taman Daya 2 (M = .90, SD = .799) manakala skor min item Analisispos bagi pelajar dari SMK Taman Daya (M = 2.33, SD = 1.265) berbeza secara signifikan dengan pelajar dari SMK Taman Mount Austin (M = 1.44, SD = 1.054). ANALISIS REGRESI ITEM KBAR DAN KBAT Keputusan analisis regresi menunjukkan keseluruhan enam item KBAR dan KBAT mempunyai hubungan yang signifikan dengan dapatan markah ujian UKD, R Square = .634, F(6,114) = 32.926, p 104 = .000. Analisis kolerasi koefisi pelbagai adalah .796, ini bermakna 63.4% varian ujian UKD dapat diterangkan oleh kombinasi linear pengukuran dalam skor item KBAR dan KBAT. Item yang paling signifikan menyumbang kepada peningkatan markah adalah item Fahampos yang berjaya menyumbang sebanyak 36.5% varian ke atas markah ujian UKD. Lain-lain item bertindak sebagai penyumbang tambahan sebanyak 26.9% daripada keseluruhan peningkatan markah ujian. MASALAH YANG DIHADAPI GURU Menurut temubual yang telah dilakukan dengan guru dan pelajar yang terlibat dengan kajian, guru-guru yang menggunakan modul menyatakan bahawa mereka tidak mempunyai masalah yang besar apabila menggunakan modul dalam pengajaran dan pembelajaran. Masalah yang timbul apabila menggunakan modul adalah lebih kepada pengurusan masa, kurang soalan aplikasi dan keperluan kepada guru untuk mengolah soalan kepada aras yang lebih tinggi bagi menguji pelajar yang bijak. PERBINCANGAN, CADANGAN DAN RUMUSAN KANDUNGAN MODUL Pembetulan yang dilakukan ke atas kelemahan modul dapat menjadikan modul lebih mesra pengguna dan menerapkan nilai kelestarian pada masa yang sama memberikan pemahaman kepada pelajardalam topik Daya dan soalan KBAT. Antara pembetulan yang dibuat adalah berkenaan peta minda I-think, gambar alam sekitar, latihan aplikasi nota, hubungkait antara subtopik, informasi alam sekitar dan nota KBAT. Dapatan juga menunjukkan bahawa berlakunya peningkatan dalam pemahaman pelajar dalam topik Daya selari dengan nilai kelestarian dan keyakinan pelajar untuk menjawab soalan KBAT setelah menggunakan modul yang dibina. 105 TAHAP PENGETAHUAN KONSEP DAYA Analisis ANCOVA yang dilakukan ke atas data ujian UKD menunjukkan terdapat peningkatan skor min antara UKDpra dan UKDpos, tetapi tidak terdapat perbezaan yang signifikan ke atas skor UKDpos antara sekolah-sekolah apabila skor UKDpra dikawal. Analisis juga menunjukkan ujian UKDpra yang dikawal menyumbang sebanyak 5.1% sahaja kepada skor UKDpos. Ini menunjukkan peningkatan skor UKDpos disumbang oleh modul yang digunakan sebanyak 94.9%. Analisis perbezaan antara min kumpulan bagi sekolah-sekolah yang terlibat untuk UKDpos menunjukkan SMK Taman Daya memperoleh skor min sebanyak 45.585 lebih tinggi berbanding dengan skor yang dicapai oleh SMK Taman Daya 3 iaitu 37.229. Perbezaan ini dilihat signifikan kerana jumlah skor min berbeza lebih daripada 8 mata skala. Kajian juga mendapati SMK Taman Daya 3 hanya menggunakan sebahagian daripada modul yang disediakan berbanding SMK Taman Daya yang menggunakan modul sepenuhnya. Kemungkinan ini merupakan faktor penyumbang kepada peningkatan min markah yang signifikan. Namun, responden dari kedua-dua sekolah masih tidak dapat menjawab sepenuhnya dengan betul. Ini juga mungkin kerana mereka masih belum menguasai sepenuhnya topik Daya. Menurut Nor Aida et al. (2013), kajian yang dilakukan untuk menguji tahap kefahaman keseluruhan pelajar tahun akhir program pendidikan Fizik UTM menunjukkan keputusan ujian berada pada tahap yang lemah dan terdapat perbezaan min yang signifikan terhadap kefahaman konsep daya dan gerakan di antara pelajar lelaki dan perempuan. Penyelidik melihat potensi modul untuk meningkatkan tahap penguasaan pelajar dalam topik Daya berkesan kepada sesetengah pelajar dalam meningkatkan pemahaman seterusnya markah ujian mereka. 106 TAHAP PENGUASAAN KBAT Dapatan kajian konsep KBAT melalui analisi ANCOVA pula menunjukkan terdapat perbezaan peningkatan yang signifikan ke atas skor KBATpos antara sekolah apabila skor KBATpra dikawal (p<.05). Walaupun begitu, pelajar masih kurang berjaya menguasai soalan esei KBAT yang disediakan. Kemungkinan yang berlaku ialah pelajar tidak mencuba untuk menjawab soalan esei berkenaan ataupun pelajar tidak mempunyai idea dan teknik untuk menjawab soalan seperti ini. Selain pergantungan pelajar kepada nota dan soalan latihan yang terdapat dalam modul, pelajar juga mendapat latihan untuk menjawab soalan KBAT melalui soalan yang dikemukan oleh guru di dalam kelas. Kajian mendapati guru berasa lebih selesa untuk bertanyakan soalan KBAT apabila mempunyai panduan seperti yang disediakan dalam modul. Menurut Wilen (1999), pemikiran yang produktif dapat dijana melalui penyoalan guru yang berkesan semasa pengajaran dan pembelajaran di dalam bilik darjah. S.Supramani (2006) mendapati terdapat hubungan yang signifikan antara teknik penyoalan guru dengan respons pelajar. Jika guru bertanyakan soalan aras tinggi, respons pelajar juga pada aras yang tinggi. Analisis pemerhatian berstruktur yang dijalankan dalam kelas Fizik dengan menggunakan modul mendapati 63% daripada jumlah soalan yang ditanya merupakan soalan KBAR dan baki 37% adalah soalan KBAT. Selain itu, menurut analisis rakaman peristiwa menunjukkan bahawa guru kerap bertanyakan soalan KBAR pada lima belas minit awal dan akhir sesi kelas. Soalan KBAT pula dilihat banyak ditanya di pertengahan sesi antara minit ke dua puluh lima dan minit empat puluh lima pembelajaran dimana guru menggunakan modul video untuk memberi stimuli kepada pelajar. Penyelidik mendapati pelajar mampu untuk menguasai soalan KBAT jika diberikan latihan yang sesuai dan kondisi pembelajaran yang menggalakkan pemikiran beraras tinggi dilakukan. Pelajar yang banyak melakukan diskusi dan perbincangan yang terarah dengan bantuan guru akan lebih yakin untuk menjawab soalan KBAT. 107 HUBUNGAN ANTARA UKD DAN KBAT Analisis kolerasi Pearson menunjukkan terdapat perkaitan yang signifikan antara skor UKD dan skor KBAT. Dapat kajian ini menunjukkan bahawa pelajar yang menguasai konsep Daya dapat meningkatkan penguasaan mereka untuk menjawab soalan KBAT dengan betul. Maka pemahaman tentang konsep adalah sangat penting untuk pelajar menguasai kemahiran menjawab soalan KBAT. Penyelidik melihat hubungan yang wujud antara penguasaan konsep Daya dan konsep KBAT adalah berkadar terus dimana lebih tinggi penguasaan pelajar dalam topik Daya, lebih berminat untuk pelajar menjawab soalan KBAT. MASALAH YANG DIHADAPI GURU MENGGUNAKAN MODUL Berdasarkan analisis yang telah dibuat, guru tidak menghadapi masalah yang besar ketika menggunakan modul tetapi beberapa penambahbaikan perlu dilakukan untuk memurnikan lagi modul. Kekangan masa untuk menghabiskan silibus merupakan masalah yang diutarakan oleh semua responden yang terlibat dengan kajian. Namun, jika silibus dapat diubah untuk memberikan guru lebih masa untuk mengadakan perbincangan dengan pelajar serta mendedahkan mereka kepada permasalahan yang dihadapi kini, penyelidik merasakan aktiviti seperti itu akan lebih menarik minat pelajar untuk menguasai ilmu sains khususnya Fizik. Kekangan masa juga merupakan masalah yang sering diutarakan oleh penyelidik-penyelidik lain contohnya seperti kajian oleh Tajulashikin et al. (2013), Abdullah et al. (2003), Abdul Rahim (2002) dan Azizi Yahya et al. (2003). Kebanyakkan kajian lepas mengaitkan kekangan masa dan bahan mengajar sebagai punca tekanan kerja kepada guru disekolah. Namun permasalahan ini boleh diatasi dengan kemahiran guru mengawal masa dan memberikan tumpuan kepada objektif pembelajaran yang perlu dilaksanakan pada hari tersebut. 108 Kemahiran ini juga diberi penekanan oleh beberapa penyelidik lain seperti Mohd Yusri et al. (2014), Hasfarina (2012) dan Donald (2010). Dapatan kajian mendapati masalah penggunaan modul terletak pada guru yang menggunakannya. Latihan penggunaan modul juga perlu bagi memastikan guru dapat memaksimumkan penggunaan modul sehingga pelajar dapat menggarap nilai kelestarian serta soalan KBAT dalam pembelajaran topik Daya sepertimana yang dilakukan oleh guru dari SMK Taman Daya dan hasilnya dapat dilihat apabila pelajar lebih yakin menjawab soalan KBAT. IMPLIKASI KAJIAN Melalui kajian ini, kita dapat lihat salah satu kemungkinan punca keputusan TIMSS dan PISA yang rendah adalah disebabkan oleh sikap pelajar terhadap soalan ujian tersebut. Jika pelajar buat tidak endah untuk menjawab soalan KBAT yang ada di dalam ujian TIMSS dan PISA, maka keputusan yang diperoleh menjadi yang paling minima seperti yang berlaku sewaktu kajian dijalankan. Nilai purata markah yang diperoleh antara sekolah-sekolah adalah sebanyak 43%. Maka sesuatu perlu dilakukan terhadap silibus dan nota yang diberikan kepada pelajar untuk meningkatkan semula minat mereka terhadap sains disamping memantapkan pengetahuan asas terhadap perkara yang berlaku di sekeliling mereka iaitu pada alam sekitar. Selain itu, sikap pelajar juga dilihat punca kepada markah min yang rendah apabila sesetengah pelajar tidak memberikan kerjasama yang sepenuhnya untuk menjawab soalan oleh kerana markah ujian tidak berkait dengan peperiksaan sekolah dan gred mereka. Kerjasama yang diperlukan daripada pelajar ini dilihat penting juga dalam ujian TIMSS dan PISA, apabila pelajar tidak memberikan sepenuh perhatian kepada soalan, maka markah min untuk keseluruhan sekolah akan menurun. Guru Fizik sebagai fasilitator juga merupakan implikasi yang dapat dilihat dalam kajian ini dimana guru bukan lagi mengajar pelajar sepenuhnya 109 tetapi lebih kepada memberi panduan dan bimbingan kepada pelajar untuk mendalami ilmu pengetahuan yang mereka ada. Guru membantu pelajar pada awalnya untuk mendapatkan pengetahuan asas pelajar, seterusnya pelajar bersoalan jawab dengan guru dan akhir sekali guru memfokuskan pengajaran dengan membantu pelajar mengisi ruang jawapan yang sebenarnya boleh dilakukan sendiri oleh para pelajar. Jelas sekali kini, guru perlu memberikan lebih banyak ruang kepada pelajar untuk mengembangkan idea mereka sendiri supaya pelajar dapat berdikari untuk mencari jawapan kepada persoalan yang perlu mereka hadapi dalam peperiksaan. Guru dapat membimbing pelajar sehingga pelajar terdedah dengan pelbagai jenis soalan yang pelbagai aras pembelajaran semasa sesi pengajaran dan pembelajaran. CADANGAN Cadangan yang ingin diutarakan oleh penyelidik melalui kajian ini adalah latihan teknik penyoalan soalan aras tinggi perlu diberikan kepada guru-guru terutamanya guru novis bagi membolehkan suasana pembelajaran yang lebih aktif diwujudkan dalam makmal. Guru yang diberikan pendedahan kepada teknik penyoalan aras tinggi dilihat mampu untuk terus mengolah sendiri soalan beraras tinggi walaupun tiada bantuan video atau modul. Namun, teknik penyoalan serta kaedah pedagogi guru berkembang berdasarkan pengalaman dan pendedahan yang diperoleh guru dalam tempoh perkhidamatan mereka. Kajian Khalid Johari (2009) menyatakan bahawa guru yang lebih berpengalaman mempunyai kelebihan dari sudut penyoalan berbanding guru novis. Tuntasnya, guru dan pelajar perlu diberikan ruang untuk membolehkan mereka mengembangkan idea berkenaan suatu topik melalui aktiviti yang dapat menjana kreativiti dalam masa yang sama membina nilai murni dalam diri mereka. Selain itu, guru juga harus sentiasa memperbaharui kaedah penyoalan mereka supaya mereka dapat menjana soalan beraras tinggi bagi mewujudkan 110 suasana KBAT dalam makmal. CADANGAN KAJIAN LANJUTAN Kajian lanjutan yang boleh dilakukan adalah dengan menguji modul serta ujian UKD di sekolah-sekolah daerah lain bagi mengenalpasti keberkesanan modul dalam meningkatkan kefahaman pelajar terhadap konsep Daya dan konsep KBAT. Seterusnya, kajian mengenai silibus berasaskan tema juga boleh dilakukan bagi menyokong dapatan kajian ini dimana perlunya perubahan dalam silibus supaya persoalan KBAT dapat diperluaskan dalam pengajaran dan pembelajaran di makmal. Selain itu, kajian berkenaan Model Integrasi Kurikulum Lestari boleh dikembangkan dengan mengkaji keberkesanan model kepada pelajar di sekolah-sekolah lain melalui kaedah pengajaran yang berbeza. Selain daripada menghasilkan modul yang dapat digunakan oleh pelajar, penyelidik merasakan kajian ini boleh dimajukan lagi dengan menghasilkan bahan interaktif secara atas talian dimana guru dan pelajar dapat mengkaji sesuatu topik dengan lebih mendalam serta berinteraksi melalui komputer. Akhir sekali, kajian mengenai kaedah penyoalan guru di dalam kelas sains juga perlu diberikan perhatian supaya dapat dicari pola persamaan dari segi pertanyaan guru kepada pelajar terutamanya soalan-soalan yang beraras tinggi. RUMUSAN Hasil dapatan kajian mendapati terdapat beberapa pemurnian yang perlu dilakukan kepada modul bagi mencapai impak yang lebih bagus berbanding yang telah diperoleh. Seterusnya, hasil kajian juga mendapati terdpat hubungan yang berkadar terus antara penguasaan konsep pelajar dalam topik Daya dengan keyakinan pelajar untuk menjawab soalan KBAT. Juga terdapat hubungan yang berkadar terus antara kedah penyoalan guru dengan 111 keyakinan pelajar untuk menjawab soalan KBAT. RUJUKAN Bahagian Pendidikan Guru (2013). Program Latihan Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi (KBAT) dalam pembelajaran dan pengajaran Sains Sekolah Menengah 2013. Putrajaya: Bahagian Pendidikan Guru. Mariani Hambug (2008). Kesedaran Pembangunan Lestari di Peringkat Awal Umur Kanak-kanak. Thesis Sarjana tidak diterbitkan. Skudai : Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Mohammad Zohir Ahmad & Nordin Abdul Razak, (2007). Pendidikan Alam Sekitar di Sekolah: Komitmen Guru. Jurnal Pendidikan Lestari, 2(7), 74-81. Mohd Najib Abdul Ghafar (1999). Penyelidikan Pendidikan. Skudai: Penerbitan Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Rajendran Nagappan, 2002. Bahasa Melayu: Penyumbang Ke Arah Penguasaan Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi. Kertas kerja Persidangan Antarabangsa Pengajian Melayu Kedua. Beijing. China. Samsulkamal Sumiri, (2008). Public Participation on Sustainable Development: Investigation of the Level of Sustainable Environmental Deleopment Understanding and Awareness. Thesis Sarjana tidak diterbitkan. Skudai : Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. 112 CONSTRUCTION ON MOLEE CAREER INSTRUMENT (MCI) AS SELECTION TOOL IN ALLIED HEALTH COURSES Gooh Mo Lee, Syed Mohamed Shafeq, Yeo Kee Jiar & Yahya Buntat, ABSTRACT This paper is going to discuss about construction on Molee Career Instrument (MCI) as selection tool in allied health courses. Students who are interested in allied health courses will use SelfDirected Search - Revised (SDS;Holland,1990) to identify the three-letter Holland code for the college majors. However, students are having problem in making their selection in allied health courses due to incompatible instrument (SDS) which was not match with the Asian cultures and norms. There are very few studies on the use of the Self-Directed Search (SDS) among students who are keen pursuing their studies in allied health courses. The purpose of the current study is to construct an instrument based on Malaysia norms and culture, otherwise known as Molee Career Instrument (MCI) as selection tool in allied health courses. It is postulated that MCI will be able to enhance students’ awareness about valid and effective criteria for selection their courses. The allied health courses are pharmacist, dietician and nutritionist, medical assistant, laboratory technician, nursing, radiographer and medical imaging, physiotherapy, environmental 113 health and healthcare service. The mixed method study will use a Exploratory Sequential Design to explore the characteristic in allied health courses among those who are in their final year at government and private colleges in Malaysia. Semi-structured interview will be use as the method of data collection for the qualitative and the Delphi technique for the quantitative research design. First pilot test was conducted with 100 items among 30 students in Segi University, Kuala Lumpur. Analysis of pilot data showed the reliability was .99 >.5. This showed the reliability of 30 respondents with 100 items in these constructs was very high to measure MCI. Next, second pilot study was conducted among 45 students in Masterskill University, Kuala Lumpur. The value of person reliability is .95 and item reliability is .73 which is acceptable (more than .5). Keywords: Allied Health, Selection, Characteristic, College INTRODUCTION In Malaysia, many school counselors are using Self-Directed Search - Revised (SDS;Holland,1990) to show any number of occupations consistent with the three-letter code. The instrument has been modified to Self- Directed Search (SPS-P) by Amla (1984; 1987) and was back translated as suggested by Brislin (1980). School counselors also use Occupational Finder (Holland, 1996) or the Dictionary of Holland Occupational Codes (DHOC; Gottfredson & Holland, 1996). For instance, if a client's threeletter code was IRE (Investigate, Realistic, Enterprising), then counselor would show them specific IRE occupational titles such as chemist, physicist or dentist (along with other occupations).However, Holland's three-letter code groups do not match with Asian cultures and global cultures. Bobye & Fabris (1992); Khan & Alvi (1991); and Rounds & Tracey (1996) emphasized that Holland's SDS test is not across cultures other than North American. According to Stead & Watson (1998), 114 Holland's SDS test is more inclined towards U.S. values of individualism, independent decision making, and immediatefamily structure. In addition, some researchers have criticized the involvement of Holland’s theory and doubt its applicability to nonmajority U.S. citizens and the 21st century worker in a global economy (Brown, 2002). In light of these different viewpoints, there is a need to construct SDS across cultures and settings. However, there are limited studies on the use of the Self-Directed Search (SDS) with students who are keen in allied health courses (America Board of Medical Specialists, 1986). The purpose of the current study is to construct an instrument based on Malaysia norms and culture, otherwise known as Molee Career Instrument (MCI) as selection tool in allied health courses. It is postulated that MCI will be able to enhance students’ awareness about valid and effective criteria for selection their courses. BACKGROUND OF STUDY Due to the existence of some instruments deemed as incompatible (SDS, VPI and career interest test) which is not cross culture and irrelevant, 'The Occupational Finder' and/or students may probably enter the wrong program. There have been instances of those keen on pursuing medicine and allied health courses eventually dropping out of their course because they were afraid or felt uncomfortable at the sight of blood (The Star, 20 July 2014). They may not be able to become accustomed to or to feel comfortable with their study and eventually leave the program or change their mind about health career (Simpson and Budd, 1996). Such decision may be regarded as a good move for the wellbeing of the students, but on the other hand, withdrawal from a program may result in losses or wastages in terms of time, work and money to the college and the students. Against this backdrop, the current research aims to construct a valid and high reliability instruments for allied health courses. The allied health courses are pharmacist, dietician and nutritionist, medical assistant, laboratory technician, 115 nursing OBJECTIVE OF STUDY The main objectives of this research is to construct a valid instrument with high reliability for allied heath courses in Malaysia. SIGNIFICANT OF STUDY The instrument developed in this study, called as MCI (Molee Career Instrument) will benefit school counselors and researchers in Asian countries. It may appear that most of the measures associated with career development theories were based on the US cultural, social, and occupational characteristics. Leung (2002) in his study demonstrated that cross-cultural researchers have to make a choice between developing their own measures from scratch, or to adapt existing measures developed in the West. Moreover, the MCI instrument on allied health diploma courses can be a source of reference by school counselor and researcher in Asian country based on Malaysia society and not the Western society. This research will enable career counselors assist students to explore, pursue and attain their career goals. Career counseling basically consists of four elements: (a) helping individuals to gain greater self-awareness in areas such as interests, values, abilities, and personality style, (b) connecting students to resources so that they can become more knowledgeable about jobs and occupations, (c) engaging students in the decision-making process in order that they can choose a career path that is well suited to their own interests, values, abilities and personality style, and (d) assisting individuals to be active managers of their career paths (including managing career transitions and balancing various life roles). The MCI instrument is very important in the field of counseling. School career counselors played a key role in career development 116 interventions to provide information and guidance to students regarding personal, academic and career options. Students in school are greatly in need of early assistance in dealing with career development task and exposed oneself to career related information. The findings will enable school career counselors to implement a intensive personal and career exploration program for individual student such as individual career map, career related assignment/project, career poster, career scrap book and workbased learning project. RELATED THEORY For the purpose of this study, the researcher utilized a combination of Holland Theory, Social Cognitive Career Theory and Item Response Theory (IRT) in order to drive the research questions. IRT is fundamental of Rasch measurement analysis for constructing MCI. Thus, by combining these theories, the researcher will be able to construct a valid and a high reliability instrument for allied health courses based on Malaysia norms. RESEARCH DESIGN The mixed method study will use a Exploratory Sequential Design to explore the characteristic in allied health courses among those who are in their final year at government and private colleges in Malaysia. Semi-structured interview will be use as the method of data collection for the qualitative and the Delphi technique for the quantitative research design. RESEARCH LOCATION This study will be carried out in four private universities in Malaysia. These universities are Masha University, Segi 117 University, Masterskill University and Kuala Lumpur Metropolitan. These universities are chosen randomly among all private universities in Malaysia. Every university is given a chance to be chosen. There are many allied health courses are available at these universities. Therefore, getting access to respondents will be easy. QUALITATIVE INTERVIEW) METHOD (SEMI-STRUCTURED Semi-structured interview was used as the method of data collection for the qualitative phase of this study. This kind of interview helped the researcher to gain the list of issues with reported frankly by participants. The responses were facts, opinions, and attitudes. The interviews were recorded by the interviewer. The researcher conducted the interviews and recorded the nuance of the respondents’ behavior. These gave important clues about how they feel about the discussed topics (Thomas, 2009). In order to carry out the interview for this research, sample in field of allied health from four private universiti (Masha University, Segi University, Masterskill University and Kuala Lumpur Metropolitan) in Malaysia were selected purposively. SAMPLING METHOD OF QUALITATIVE STAGE Participants of interview were employed through purposeful criterion sampling procedures (Creswell, 2009). The criterion was that students who were studying in allied health courses at private colleges in Malaysia. QUANTITATIVE METHOD (DELPHI METHOD) The Delphi technique or Expert Opinion Assessment (EOA) is a group process used to survey and collect the opinions of practiced 118 on a particular subject (Yousuf, 2007). The Delphi technique, by definition, is a group process involving an interaction between the researcher and a group of identified experts on a specified topic, usually in several rounds. Yousuf (2007), identified the Delphi method as a method for gaining judgments on complex matters where precise information is unavailable. Therefore, it is an assessment tool which assesses new or less discussed issues. Yousuf (2007), suggests this method is a widely approach in science, technology, and education, but it is not limited to them. Skulmoski, Hatman, & Krahn (2007) also supported that Delphi method is flexible in method and sample size. More ever, it has been used to develop, identify, estimate and to validate information in diversity of research areas. DEVELOP QUESTIONNAIRE First, the items (criteria) were found based on the interview and then the appropriate items were extracted by using Delphi method. Pilot test will be conducted before developing the final format of the questionnaire to find the reliability and validity of the items. PILOT TESTS For constructing MCI instrument pilot test was conducted. Pilot test was conducted among 100 students from Segi University Table 1 shows summarizing two pilot test conducted in this study based on item and person reliability, dimensionality, misfit and misfit person. Table 1.1 Summarizing of Two Pilot Tests Pilot Test Number of item Number of person Item reliability Person reliability Dimensionality Misfit item Misfit person 119 First (Segi) Second (Master skill) 30 .99>.5 1>.5 40%>38% - - 45 .73>.5 .95>.5 40%>39% 29 - 100 100 RESULTS AND DISCUSSION First pilot test was conducted with 100 items among 30 students in Segi University, Kuala Lumpur. Table 1 shows that value of person reliability was very high (1>.5). Rasch model suggests that a good reliability should be more than .5 (Fisher, 2007). Analysis of pilot data showed the reliability was .99>.5. This showed the reliability of 30 respondents with 100 items in these constructs was very high to measure MCI.Next, second pilot study was conducted among 45 students in Masterskill University, Kuala Lumpur. The value of person reliability is .95 and item reliability is .73 which is acceptable (more than .5). CONCLUSION A valid and high reliability instruments was developed for allied health courses based on Asian particularly Malaysia cultural, social, and occupational characteristics . REFERENCES America Board of Medical Specialists (1986). Which medical specialist for you? Evanston, III: Author. Amla H. M. Salleh (1984). An investigation of the reliability, validity and translation of Holland’s Self-Directed Search for utilization by a Malaysian Population.Unpublished master dissertation, Western Michigan University, USA. Boyle, G.J., & Fabris, S. (1992). Confirmatory and Congeneric factor analysis of Holland's Self- directed search Personality and 120 Individual Differences 13, 1077-1084. Brislin, R.W. (1980). Translation and content analysis of oral and written materials. In H.C. Triandis & J.W. Berry (Eds), Handbook of cross-cultural psychology: Methodology. pp.89-102). Boston: Allyn and Bacon.Brown, D. (2002).Status of theories of career choice and development. In D. Brown & Associates (Eds.), Career choice and development, (4th ed., pp. 510-515). San Francisco: Jossey-Bass. Fischer, G. H. (2007). Rasch models. In C. R. Rao & S. Sinharay (Eds.), Psychometrics: Handbook of statistics (Vol. 26). Amsterdam: Elsevier, 515–585 Gottfredson, G. D., & Holland, J.L., (1996). Dictionary of Holland occupational codes (3rd ed.). Odess, FL: Psychological Assessment Resources. Holland, J. L. (1990). The Self-Directed Search: Professional manual. FL: Psychological Assessment Resources. Khan, S.B., & Alvi, S.A. (1991). Holland's typology: A study in non -western culture. Journal of cross-cultural Psychology, 22, 283-292. Leung, S. A., & Hou, Z. J. (2005). The structure of vocational interest among Chinese students. Journal of Career Development, 32, 74–90. Rounds, J., & Tracey, T.J. (1996). Cross - cultural structural equivalence of RIASEC models and measures. Journal of Counseling Psychology, 43, 310-329. Sekaran, U., & Bougie, R,(2010). Research Methods for Buidling Approach: John Wiley & Sons. Simpson KH, Budd K (1996). Medical student attrition: a 10-year survey in one medical school. Med Educ , 30(3):172–178. Stead, G. B., & Watson, M. B. (1998). Career research in South Africa: Challenges for the future. Journal of Vocational Behavior, 52, 289-299. Yousuf, M. I. (2007). Using Experts’ Opinions through Delphi Technique. practical Assessment research & Evaluation, 12(4). 121 THE NEED FOR PROBLEMBASED LEARNING IN NIGERIAN SECONDARY SCHOOL CHEMISTRY LESSONS Abbas Babayi Abu bakar & Mohammad Yusof Arshad ABSTRACT Education is a vital instrument for human capital development. Chemistry is one of the basic sciences responsible for development of any nation. Chemistry students are expected to be equipped with 21 century competences and skills. The purpose of this article is to stress the need for implementation of PBL in Nigerian secondary school chemistry lessons. Teaching and learning in Nigeria does not produce students with the required skills and competencies, because of traditional instructions by teachers, bad learning environment and inadequate facilities. PBL is a process in which students develop problem solving skills and flexible knowledge through collaborative and self-directed learning under teachers guide. The process also facilitates the learning of three levels of chemical representations and the students’ alternative conceptions in chemistry. PBL was pioneered for medical students in the 60s, to relate the knowledge acquired in the university to students future professional practice. It was letter extended to other sciences. PBL has its theoretical bases from Cognitivists and Constructivists psychologists. In conclusion, the authors suggested for 122 implementation of PBL in Nigerian secondary schools. Therefore they will investigate how the process of its implementation in chemistry lessons with the aim of developing a suitable PBL Model for Nigeria. Keywords: Problem-Based Learning; Chemistry; Needs & Secondary schools. INTRODUCTION In a competitive knowledge based economy society, human resource development is vital for economic survival. Today employees are expected to be well equipped with new 21stcentury competencies and skills, which include: problem solving skills, communication skills, collaboration skills, critical thinking, entrepreneurship, creativity and innovativeness (Aminu, 2007). Nigeria needs quality education to meet the expectations of employers in the work places. Quality education is one that satisfies the basic learning needs and enriches the lives of learners and their overall experience of learning. It is acquired through creation of good learning environment, production of effective teachers who can produce motivated and interested students with the skills required in modern society (Adeyemi, 1990). Nigeria needs to adapt active learning strategies for students to have greater accountability toward their learning. Chemistry teachers should work as facilitators of the learning process and designers of learning environment rather than purveyor of knowledge (Tan,Oon Seng 2003). The teachers are required to put more effort into lesson preparation. They should be trained for facilitation skills and should have a belief that Problem-based learning (PBL) is a better strategy and committed to its implementation for transition from traditional approach to PBL approach be successful. Pedagogical practices in line with the challenges / needs of the 21 century education are adapted in most developed countries, for Nigeria to achieve the status of a 123 developed country in 2020, a change in pedagogical practice is necessary to create fully equipped manpower to face the challenges of modern civilization(Tan Pin Yeen and Mohammad Yusof Arshad,2011). There is a need for problem-based learning in Nigerian secondary schools education despites current issues in teaching and learning. CURRENT ISSUES IN TEACHING AND LEARNING IN NIGERIAN SECONDARY SCHOOLS. Teaching and learning in Nigerian secondary schools does not develop or produce student with the higher order thinking skills, problem solving skills and other competencies that are demanded from 21 century educational institutions (Das, 2009). Chemistry teachers still practice expository methods where students are not free to ask questions because of the teachers’ autocracy. Most teachers perceive their main roles as sole dispenser of knowledge and the commander in-chief of the class (Abdullahi,1982). Teachers’ inability to adapt active learning strategies could be associated with poor learning environment, inadequate learning facilities, poor teachers’ welfare and lack of recognition for teachers compared to other professionals such as accountants, doctors and engineers in the same civil service. These had adverse effects on the quality of learning and products of secondary schools in Nigeria (Ibidapo-Obe,2007). Addition to that, no adequate laboratory practical work for students, teachers focus only on basic verifications of laws without emphasize on investigative approaches, students scientific innovations are not rewarded. Science teachers either discuss experiments verbally as alternative to practical work or demonstrate it for student to see without opportunity to manipulate equipment for skill (Ajaja, 2005). Therefore, there is a need for science teachers to adapt active learning methodology such as problem-based learning that requires students to solve authentic chemistry problems that are related to their experiences and future 124 professional life. The authors will investigate the implementation process of PBL in Nigerian secondary school chemistry lessons and try to develop a model of PBL that is suitable for Nigerian environment. WHAT IS PROBLEM-BASED LEARNING? Problem-based learning is a student-centered pedagogy in which students learn through problem solving. The goals of PBL help students to develop flexible knowledge, effective Problem solving skills, intrinsic motivation, collaborative and self-directed learning (Barrows and Tamblyn,1980a). PBL is an active learning method in which students work in groups, identify what they already know, what they need to know, how and where to access new information about the problem. Students generate hypotheses, identify learning objectives, seek sources of knowledge / learning material, evaluate information obtained, reflect, integrate new knowledge and synthesize solutions to problems. Teacher facilitates learning by supporting, guiding student to focus on learning objectives, creating suitable learning environment and monitoring the learning process. PBL represents a paradigm shift from traditional teaching, to student-centered approach to learning in which students experience a problem as the stimulator and motivator for learning. The differences between the traditional and the PBL approaches to learning can be represented by the three loci of preoccupation as shown in figure 2.2 (Tan Oon Seng,2003; Muhammad-Yusof ;Ahmad ;Hassan, & Tasir, 2009). Fig.1 Differences between traditional and PBL approaches. 125 PBL is an inductive learning method, a better alternative strategy in teaching either at secondary schools or higher educational institutions, hence a major focus for educational researchers in the 21st century (Johari Surif; Nor Hassan Ibrahim and Mohani Mokhtar, 2013). Including authors of this article. THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK OF PBL. PBL was pioneered in the medical School in McMaster University, Canada in the late 1960s. The main factors that necessitated introduction of the PBL in the medical education at the University includes: The dissatisfaction of the learners with the traditional education, the irrelevance of the content knowledge to the learners future professional practice and the learners’ inability to reason and apply what they have learned to solve problems at the work places(Barrows,1996). Problem-based learning was eventually expanded to include education in the areas of sciences, engineering and other disciplines (Barrows and Tamblyn,1980; MacDonald and Isaacs, 2001; Knowles,1975 and Zimmerman, 1990). Although research revealed that PBL was practiced in America since 1993 and Asia, particularly in some tertiary institutions in Malaysia (Tan Pin Yeen and Mohammad Yusof Arshad, 2014) there is no element of PBL in Nigerian secondary schools (Nwamno and Izuagba, 2010). The authors will investigate the implementation process of the PBL in Nigerian secondary schools. Learning is derived from learners’ interactions with real problems and the learning environment; The process of inquiry creates cognitive dissonance that stimulates learning; Knowledge emerged from the collaborative processes of social negotiation and evaluation of learners point of views (Dewey, 1963). PBL is not only about introducing problems into the classroom, but it is also about creating opportunities for learners to construct knowledge through interactions and inquiry (Norman and Schmidt 1993; Popper, 1992). Therefore, it is based on the constructivists’ theory of learning (Schmidt, 1993; Savery &Duffy, 1995; Hendry 126 &Murphy 1995). The goal of education is to help students develop problem-solving skills and creative thinking. A knowledgeable person is a problem solver, one who interacts with the environment in testing hypotheses, developing generalizations and engaging in learning to arrive at solution to problems (Bruner, 1960). Understandings, perception, cognitive dissonance, problem solving and insight are important aspects of learning in cognitive psychology. It is clear that these developments in cognitive theory of learning also support the use of problems in learning. In PBL, learners refine and restructure their prior knowledge and experiences to construct new knowledge, through collaborative and self-directed learning to solve real world problems (Wood, 1987). PBL is also in accordance with Cognitive Psychologists(Mayer, 1983; Chi & Glaser, 1985). PROBLEM-BASED LEARNING IN CHEMISTRY CLASSES. Chemistry is a study of nature, composition and properties of matter. Therefore it deals with the study of the entire environment (Ababio, 2005). It is a complex subject with many branches and abstract concepts. Secondary school students often have difficulty to conceptualize it. They do not understand the principle underlying chemistry, because of their inadequate reasoning skills. Hence they are unable to establish relationship between the learning that occurs in the classrooms and their real-life situation. Learning chemistry requires the understanding of three levels of chemical representations: Macroscopic, Microscopic and Symbolic levels. Macroscopic level is the phenomena that can be seen with naked eyes (Boiling of water, heating of sulphur); Microscopic level is the representation of atomic particles that cannot be seen with naked eyes (protons, neutrons and electrons); Symbolic level such as chemical formulae and equations are represented using signs, symbols, coefficients and formulae (Gabel,1998; Johnstone, 1991:Gkitzia, Salta and Tzougraki, 2011). Learning chemistry becomes also difficult to secondary students 127 due to alternative conceptions. Alternative conception is the view and meaning of the world acquired by children before they are formally introduced to science. This is developed as children attempt to make sense of the world in terms of their experiences. The misconceptions held by students are different from scientist views because children have difficulties with abstract reasoning, their interest in particular explanation of scientific events and the use of everyday language of the society. Alternative conception hinders student learning (Gilbert & Treagust, 2009, Osborne, Bell & Gilbert, 1983). The characteristics and processes of the PBL will take care of these triple levels of chemical representations by explanations of the microscopic level that is instrumental to the understanding of the macroscopic and symbolic levels. These allow student to transfer knowledge from one level to another easily through collaborative and self-directed learning. Similarly, the students’ alternative conceptions can also be identify and corrected by teacher facilitation process to foster conceptual understanding of chemistry without hindrance to learning (Delisle, 1997; Gabel, 1999). CONCLUSION PBL is a significant innovation in education, which have real life problems as focal points, teachers as mediating guides, learners as active problem solvers through collaborative and self-directed learning. The learning process produces students with adequate problem solving skills and flexible knowledge base. Learning paradigm has shifted towards attainment of the desired goal of a knowledge-based economy society from the 21st century education. However, despites the paradigm shift to PBL approach that produces students with higher-order thinking skills and other required competences, the traditional lecture method, bad learning environment, inadequate facilities as mentioned earlier are very common in Nigerian secondary schools. The situation is different 128 from western countries where PBL originated and fully implemented. Therefore the authors will investigate the process of implementation of PBL in Nigerian secondary schools chemistry lessons that are suitable and appropriate for Nigerian school context. REFERENCES Ababio, O.Y. (2005) New School Chemistry for Senior Secondary Schools. Onitsha: African First Publishers Ltd. Abdullahi, A. (1982) Science Teaching in Nigeria. Ilorin: Atoto Press Ltd. Adeyemi, M.A (1990) Cognitive Style: A Variable in Process Skill Development in Science. Nigeria Journal of Education Psychology 5 (1):45-56. Ajaja, O. P. (2005). Comparison of the Effectiveness of Three Instructional Methods (Advance Organizer, Discovery and Invention) on Exhibition of Acceptable Laboratory Behaviors. Journal of Vocational Science and Educational Development, 6(2):16-44. Aminu, D.M. (2007) Application of Science and Technology for Sustainable National Development. A paper Presented at a National Conference of Science Teachers Association of Nigeria (STAN). Sokoto, 21-26, August. Barrows, H. S. and Tamblyn, R. M.(1980a). Problem-Based Learning: An Approach to Medical Education. New York : Springer Publishing Company. Barrows, H. S. and Tamblyn, R. M.(1980b). Problem-Based Learning: An Approach to Medical Education. New York : Springer Publishing Company. Barrows, H. S. (1996). Problem-Based Learning in Medicine and Beyond: A brief Overview. In L. Wilkerson & H. Gilselaers (eds.), Bringing problem-Based Learning to Higher Education: Theory and Practice. San Franscisco, CA: Jossey-Bass. Brunner, J. (1960). Process of Education. Cambridge. M.A: Harvard University press. Chi, M.T.H. and Glaser R. (1985). Problem Solving Ability. In R.J. Sternberg(Eds.), Human Ability; An Information Processing 129 Approach . New York: Freeman. Das R.C.(2009) Science Teaching in Schools. New Delhi: Sterling Publishers private Limited. Delisle, R. (1997). How to Use Problem-Based Learning in the Classroom. Alexandria, Virginia USA: Association for Supervision and Curriculum Development. Dewey, J. (1963). Experience and Education. New York: Simon & Schuster. Gabel, D. (1998). The Complexity of Chemistry and Implication for Teaching. In B.J. fraser and K. G. Tobin (Eds.) International Hand Book of Science Education. 233-248. London: Kluwer Academic Publishers. Gabel, D.(1999). Improving Teaching and Learning through Chemistry Education Research: A look to the Future. Journal of Chemical Education,76 (4):548.552. Gilbert, J.K. and Treagust D, F.(2009).Multiple Representations in chemical education. Berlin: Springer Verlag. Gkitzia,V. Salta, K. and Tzougraki, C.(2011). Development and Application of Suitable Criteria for the Evaluation of Chemical Representation in Schools Text Books. Chemistry Education Research and Practice,12(1) :5-14 Hendry, G.D. & Morphy, L.B.(1995) Constructivism and Problem-Based Learning. In P. Little, M. Ostwald G. Ryan (Eds.), Research and Development in Problem-Based Learning 3; Assessment and Evaluation; New Castle: Australian Problem-Based Learning Network. Ibidapo-Obe, O.(2007). The Challenges of Teacher Education in Nigeria: The University of Lagos Experience. Paper Presented at the Second Regional Research Seminar for Africa. Organized by UNESCO Forum on Higher Education, Research and Knowledge. Accra.22-24, March. Johari Surif, Nor Hasniza Ibrahim, and Mahani Mokhtar (2013). Implementation of Problem-Based Learning in Higher Education Institutions and its Impact on Students Learning. Proceedings of the 4th International Research Symposium on Problem-Based Learning. UTM, Kuala-Lumpur: 66-73. Johnstone, A. H. (1991) Why is Science Difficult to Learn? Things are Seldom What They Seem. Journal of Computer Assisted Learning,7(2):75-83. 130 Knowles, M. (1975). Self-Directed Learning: A Guide for Learners and Teachers. New York: The Adult Education Company. MacDonald, D. and Isaacs, G. (2001). Developing a Professional Identity Through Problem-Based learning. Teaching Education. 1(2): 315333. Mayer, R.E.(1983). Thinking, Problem Solving and Cognition. New York: Freeman. Muhammad-Yusof, K. Ahmad, S. Hassan, H. S. & Tasir, Z.(2009). Inducting First Year Engineering Students into problem-Based Learning What are we Learning About Learning? Paper presented at the International PBL symposium, Singapore, 10-12 June. Norman, G.R. and H.G. Schmidt (1993). Where is the Learning in Problem-Based learning? Pedagogue, 4, (2): 4-6. Nwamno, P. and Izuagba, A. (2010). Teacher Education and Challenges of the Millennium Development Goals. European Journal of Social Sciences.1(7):91-95. Osborne, R. J. Bell., B. F. and Gilbert, J.K.(1983). Science Teaching and Childrens Views of the world. Journal of Science Education.5(4):1-14. Popper, K. R.(1992). Unended Quest. London: Routledge. Savery, J. R. and Duffy, T.M. (1995).Problem-Based Learning: Instructional Model and its Constructivists framework. Educational Technology.3: (5)31-37. Schmidt, H.G. (1993).Foundation of Problem-Based Learning; Some Explanatory Notes: Medical Education.2(7):22-32. Tan, Oon Seng.(2003). Problem-Based Learning Innovation: Using Problems to Power Learning in the 21st Century. Singapore: Thomson Learning. Tan Yin Peen. and Mohammad Yusof Arshad, (2011).Problem-Based Learning: Implementation Issues in Malaysia Secondary School Science Classroom. A paper presented at the 4th International Conference by Science and Mathematics Education. on 15-17, November. Tan Yin Peen. and Mohammad Yusof Arshad,(2014).Teacher and Student Questions: A Case Study of Malaysia Secondary School Problem-Based Learning. Asian Social Science: .10, ( 4): 174182. Woods, D.R. (1987) How Might I Teach Problem Solving? in J. E. Stice (ed.) Developing Critical Thinking and Problem-solving 131 Abilities, San Francisco. Jossey-Bass. Zimmerman, B.J. (1990). Self-regulated Learning and Academic Achievement: An Overview. Educational Psychologist 25(3)1-7. 132 CADANGAN PEMBINAAN MODEL PENGHUJAHAN SAINTIFIK DALAM KIMIA Chuzairy Hanri & Muhammad Yusof Arshad ABSTRAK Sistem pendidikan pada masa sekarang perlu menerapkan elemen kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi. Namun begitu, sistem pendidikan di Malaysia masih kurang menerapkannya kerana segelintir guru masih mengamalkan pengajaran secara tradisional. Kesannya kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi pelajar iaitu kemahiran menaakul masih rendah berdasarkan kepda penilaian TIMSS. Salah satu kaedah yang boleh digunakan adalah penghujahan saintifik. Penghujahan saintifik memberikan banyak kelebihan sekiranya diamalkan di dalam kelas sains. Oleh itu, banyak kajian telah dijalankan bagi membangunkan kaedah pengajaran yang mengamalkan penghujahan saintifik. Namun begitu, masih kurang kajian yang dijalankan untuk memahami proses penghujahan saintifik. Bagi memahami proses penghujahan saintifik dengan mendalam, satu model bagi menilai proses penghujahan saintifik yang mantap diperlukan. Model penghujahan saintifik Walker & Sampson merupakan model yang terkini, lengkap, jelas dan mudah digunakan. Namun model ini digunakan dalam suasana kelas yang aktif dan bertentangan dengan suasana kelas di Malaysia. Selain itu, model ini tidak menitik beratkan elemen tiga aras perwakilan kimia. Oleh itu, model ini perlu diubahsuai agar sesuai dengan pendidikan kimia dan konteks pendidikan di Malaysia. Satu kajian 133 akan dijalankan untuk menguji keberkesanan model ini. Kata Kunci: Penghujahan Saintifik, Model Penghujahan Saintifik Dalam Kimia, Tiga Aras Perwakilan Kimia, Isu Pelaksanaan Penghujahan Saintifik Di Malaysia PENGENALAN Kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi terutama kemahiran menaakul perlu dikuasai pelajar untuk menempuh alam pekerjaan yang semakin mencabar. Malangnya, pencapaian pelajar Malaysia dalam penilaian Trends in Mathematics and Science Study (TIMSS) bagi item menaakul tidak mencapai penanda aras antarabangsa iaitu hanya 5% pelajar Malaysia berjaya menjawab soalan tersebut dengan betul sedangkan penanda aras antarabangsa adalah pada 18% (Martin et al., 2012). Keadaan ini disebabkan oleh kebanyakan guru masih mengamalkan pengajaran secara tradisional. Kebanyakan masa pembelajaran digunakan oleh guru untuk memberi penerangan kepada pelajar iaitu aktiviti kuliah (Winnie Sim Siew Li & Mohammad Yusof Arshad, 2014a; Chuzairy Hanri & Mohammad Yusof Arshad, 2013). Pengajaran secara kuliah tidak menggalakkan kemahiran menaakul pelajar kerana pelajar hanya bertindak sebagai pendengar yang pasif di dalam kelas (Kenneth, 2009). Satu kaedah yang boleh digunakan untuk menggalakkan kemahiran menaakul pelajar adalah dengan mengamalkan penghujahan saintifik. PENGHUJAHAN SAINTIFIK DALAM KELAS SAINS Penghujahan saintifik didefinisikan sebagai dakwaan atau kesimpulan yang dibina dan disokong dengan hujah-hujah yang rasional (Sampson & Clark, 2009; Erduran, Simon, & Osborne, 2004). Hujah yang menyokong kesimpulan tersebut termasuk 134 bukti-bukti yang diperolehi daripada eksperimen atau daripada sumber rujukan yang lain dan dikukuhkan lagi dengan justifikasi hubungan antara kesimpulan dan bukti yang dikemukakan. Banyak kelebihan yang diperolehi sekiranya penghujahan saintifik diamalkan di dalam kelas kimia. Antara kelebihan menjalankan penghujahan saintifik adalah melahirkan pelajar yang berliterasi saintifik (Braaten & Windschitl, 2011; Cavagnetto, 2010), memupuk perubahan konsep pelajar dan mengukuhkan kefahaman pelajar (Cetin, 2014; Nussbaum, 2011; Sadler, 20004), menggalakkan pemikiran aras tinggi pelajar (Eskin & Berkiroglu, 2008; Yalcinoglu, 2007) dan meningkatkan kemahiran komunikasi pelajar (Nussbaum, 2011). Malangnya, penghujahan saintifik masih kurang diamalkan di dalam kelas sains. Keadaan ini bukan hanya berlaku di luar negara (Newton, Driver & Osborne, 1999) malah turut berlaku di dalam Malaysia (Lee Ling Heng & Johari Surif, 2013a; Martin et. al., 2004). Ini mungkin disebabkan oleh guru yang kurang mahir dalam menilai dan menggalakkan penghujahan saintifik. Satu kaedah pengajaran berasaskan kepada model yang mantap perlu dibangunkan bagi membantu guru mengamalkan penghujahan saintifik yang berkualiti. Menyedari akan hakikat tersebut, pelbagai kaedah telah dibangunkan dalam kajian lepas bagi membantu guru menggalakkan penghujahan santifik di dalam kelas. Tiga kaedah utama yang dibangunkan adalah melalui teknologi (lihat Clark & Sampson, 2007; Sandoval & Reiser, 2004) penyoalan (Nussbaum, 2011; Chin, 2010) dan inkuiri (Walker & Sampson, 2013). Kesemua kaedah yang telah dibangunkan ternyata memberikan kesan positif kepada kualiti penghujahan saintifik pelajar. Namun begitu, kajian yang mengkaji proses penghujahan saintifik secara terperinci masih kurang dijalankan. Bagi mengkaji proses penghujahan saintifik dengan terperinci, satu model penghujahan saintifik diperlukan untuk dijadikan sebagai panduan dalam menilai proses penghujahan saintifik yang berlaku. Apakah model penghujahan saintifik yang paling sesuai digunakan? Adakah model tersebut sesuai digunakan dalam 135 konteks pendidikan di Malaysia? MODEL PENGHUJAHAN SAINTIFIK Antara model penghujahan saintifik yang terawal adalah model Toulmin. Terdapat lima elemen dalam penghujahan saintifik iaitu dakwaan, data, pengwajaran, sokongan dan percanggahan (Toulmin, 1958). Model ini banyak digunapakai dalam kajiankajian lepas seperti dalam kajian Chin (2010) memandangkan ia mudah digunakan. Namun begitu, model ini sukar digunakan untuk menilai kualiti hujah kerana model tersebut tidak begitu jelas (Erduran, Simon & Osborne, 2004; Zohar & Nemet, 2002). Disebabkan oleh kekaburan ini, Model Toulmin telah dipermudahkan oleh Erduran, Simon & Osborne (2004) dan juga Stegmann, Weinberger & Fischer (2007). Model Toulmin telah diringkaskan kepada hanya tiga komponen iaitu (a) dakwaan atau kesimpulan yang diperolehi hasil daripada penghujahan (b) data yang berkaitan dan menyokong dakwaan yang dibuat (c) pengwajaran yang menghubungkan antara data dengan dakwaan yang dibuat. Bagi McNeil & Krajcik (2009), mereka mengkonsepkan ketiga-tiga komponen ini sebagai dakwaan, bukti dan perwajaran kepada sesuatu dakwaan. Namun begitu, masih terdapat kekeliruan dalam menilai kualiti hujah pelajar terutama dalam menilai sama ada hujah mengandungi elemen data atau bukti (Walker & Sampson, 2013, Nussbaum, 2011). Kekeliruan ini dirungkai dengan model penghujahan saintifik yang terkini daripada Walker & Sampson (2013) seperti dalam Rajah 1. Terdapat tiga elemen dalam model ini iaitu (a) dakwaan/kesimpulan meliputi tekaan, kesimpulan, penerangan atau jawapan kepada persoalan kajian; (b) bukti termasuklah data (daripada eksperimen atau kajian lain), analisis data dan interpretasi analisis data (c) justifikasi yang memerlukan pelajar membuat penerangan mengenai bukti yang dikemukakan berdasarkan kepada konsep dan teori saintifik. Selain itu, model ini juga menerangkan mengenai penilaian kualiti hujah melalui dua aspek iaitu kriteria 136 empirikal dan teoritikal. Kriteria empirikal adalah penilaian bagaimana data dikumpul dan dianalisis serta adakah bukti yang dikemukakan sesuai dengan dakwaan yang dibuat. Kriteria teoritikal pula menilai sama ada dakwaan yang dibuat selari dengan pengetahuan saintifik dan adakah interpretasi data dilakukan dengan betul. Model Walker & Sampson berkesan dalam membantu pelajar membina hujah memandangkan ia dijalankan dalam suasana kelas yang aktif. Namun begitu, wujud persoalan adakah ianya sesuai digunakan dalam subjek kimia memandangkan pembelajaran kimia memerlukan pelajar menguasai tiga aras perwakilan kimia dan adakah ia sesuai digunakan dalam konteks pendidikan di Malaysia kerana didapati proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran di Malaysia dijalankan dalam keadaan yang pasif. Kedua-dua isu ini dibincangkan dalam subtopik seterusnya. ISU PELAKSANAAN PENGHUJAHAN SAINTIFIK MALAYSIA DI Pendidikan secara global telah beralih arah kepada aktiviti penggalakkan penghujahan saintifik di dalam kelas. Keadaan ini telah berlaku di Amerika Syarikat, United Kingdom, Afrika Selatan dan negara-negara lain (Next Generation Science Standard, NGSS, 2013; Qualification and Curriculum Authority, 2007; JimenezAleixandre & Erduran, 2007). Pendidikan Malaysia juga perlu mengubah arah pendidikan sains agar kita mampu berdiri sama tinggi dan duduk sama rendah dengan negara maju yang lain. 137 Dakwaan Tekaan, kesimpulan, penerangan, pernyataan deskriptif, jawapan persoalan kajian Sesuai dengan Menyokonn g Bukti Data (numerik, pemerhatian, dapat kajian lain), analisis data, interpretasi data Disokong dengan Menerangka n Justifikasi Pembinaan dan penilaian hujah berdasarkan kepada: Teori saintifik yang telah dibina oleh saintis Kaedah kajian yang diterima oleh saintis Bukti yang dikemukakan sama standard dengan saintis Kaedah komunikasi sama dengan saintis Penerangan tekaan, konsep atau teori yang mendokong analisis data, interpretasi data Kualiti hujah dinilai berdasarkan kepada: Kriteria Empirikal Dakwaan sesuai dengan bukti Bukti yang dikemukakan mencukupi Kaedah kajian yang sesuai Kaedah analisis data sesuai Kritteria Teoritikal Dakwaan menyumbang kepada kefahaman dunia sains Dakwaan selari dengan teori saintifik analisis data selari dengansaintifik teori RajahIntrepretasi 1: Model penghujahan saintifik Bagi mengamalkan penghujahan saintifik sebagai salah satu kaedah pengajaran terbaru di dalam kelas kimia di Malaysia, beberapa isu perlu diberi perhatian. Dua isu utama yang perlu diberi perhatian adalah kewujudan pelbagai aras dalam kimia dan aktiviti pengajaran secara tradisional dan fungsi guru dan pelajar di dalam kelas kimia. Isu ini perlu diberi perhatian agar model penghujahan yang akan dibina sesuai untuk digunakan dalam konteks pendidikan kimia di Malaysia. 138 KEWUJUDAN PELBAGAI ARAS DALAM KIMIA Dalam memahami subjek kimia pelajar perlu menguasai ketiga-tiga aras perwakilan kimia yang wujud iaitu aras makroskopik, mikroskopik dan simbolik. Disebabkan oleh aras perwakilan ini, subjek kimia dianggap sebagai mata pelajaran yangsukar oleh pelajar (Johnstone, 2000; Tsaparlis, Koliulis & Pappa, 2010). Seringkali miskonsepsi berlaku dan pelajar tidak memahami konsep kimia secara menyeluruh disebabkan oleh kegagalan pelajar untuk menguasai ketiga-tiga aras perwakilan kimia ini (Jaber & Bou Jaoude, 2012). Pelajar tidak memahami konsep kimia secara menyeluruh juga disebabkan oleh kelemahan pelajar dalam mengintegrasikan ketiga-tiga aras ini (Treagust, Chittleborough & Mamaila, 2003). Kebanyakan pelajar boleh menguasai dengan baik pada aras makroskopik seperti menerangkan proses pencairan ais dimana perubahan keadaan fizikal daripada pepejal kepada cecair. Namun begitu, pelajar mengalami kesukaran dalam menerangkan konsep tersebut pada aras mikroskopik dan simbolik iaitu susunan zarah semasa proses pencairan berlaku (aras mikroskopik) dan persamaan kimia yang berlaku (aras simbolik). Ini disebabkan oleh pada aras tersebut ianya berbentuk abstrak (Barke, Al-Hazari & Yitbarek, 2009). Kesukaran ini wujud disebabkan oleh guru kurang peka dan tidak mengambil berat aras mikroskopik dan simbolik semasa mengajar di dalam kelas. Guru kurang menghubungkait antara ketiga-tiga aras tersebut (deJong & Taber, 2007). Ini terbukti seperti dalam kajian Winnie Sim Siew Li & Mohammad Yusof Arshad (2014b) yang mendapati guru hanya memfokuskan kepada aras makroskopik dan mengabaikan aras simbolik dan mikroskopik. Oleh itu ketiga-tiga aras ini perlu disertakan sekali di dalam penghujahan saintifik mereka. Pengintegrasian ini akan membantu pelajar memahami konsep kimia dengan lebih mendalam serta menghasilkan hujah yang lebih berkualiti. 139 AKTIVITI PENGAJARAN SECARA TRADISIONAL DAN FUNGSI GURU DAN PELAJAR DI DALAM KELAS Pusat perkembangan kurikulum telah mencadangkan agar pengajaran secara inkuiri dijalankan di dalam kelas sains. Namun begitu, kajian lepas membuktikan bahawa guru masih menjalankan proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran secara tradisional (Chuzairy Hanri & Muhammad Yusof Arshad, 2013; Lim, 2007; Abu Hassan, 2003). Pengajaran masih dijalankan secara berpusatkan guru. Aktiviti utama di dalam bilik darjah adalah kuliah/penerangan guru (Chuzairy Hanri & Mohammad Yusof Arshad, 2013; Martin et. al., 2004). Terdapat guru yang menjalankan pengajaran secara inkuiri namun tidak dijalankan dengan baik dan berbeza dengan teori pengajaran inkuiri (Winnie Sim Siew Li & Mohammad Yusof Arshad, 2014a; Tay, 2010). Berdasarkan kajian Winnie Sim Siew Li & Mohammad Yusof Arshad (2014a) guru yang mendakwa mereka menjalankan pengajaran secara inkuiri tidak menjalankan inkuiri dengan betul. Guru lebih banyak bercakap dan memberi penerangan berbanding bertanya soalan dan pelajar bercakap. Guru beranggapan bahawa fungsi mereka di dalam kelas adalah penyampai maklumat dan memberi arahan (Abu Hassan, 2003). Guru juga beranggapan bahawa dia yang mengawal pembelajaran pelajar. Pelajar hanya bertindak sebagai pendengar yang pasif dan menyalin nota sekiranya perlu (Chuzairy, 2013). Bagi mengubah pengajaran secara tradisional kepada penghujahan saintifik, guru perlu memahami tugas mereka hanya sebagai fasilitator yang membimbing murid dan bukan sebagai pemberi maklumat. Pelajar sepatutnya bertindak sebagai penghasil maklumat dan bukan pendengar yang pasif (Jiminez-Aleixandre & Erduran, 2007). Oleh itu, model penghujahan saintifik yang baru perlu dibina dengan mengambil kira konteks pendidikan Malaysia yang bersifat pasif dan tradisional. Pengajaran secara tradisional ini perlu diadaptasikan agar penghujahan saintifik dapat dijalankan di dalam kelas sains di Malaysia. 140 CADANGAN PENGUBAHSUAIAN PENGHUJAHAN SAINTIFIK DALAM KIMIA MODEL Bagi memahami penghujahan saintifik di Malaysia, model penghujahan saintifik sedia ada yang dijalankan dalam suasana kelas yang aktif perlu diubahsuai agar ianya sesuai dengan konteks pendidikan kimia di Malaysia. Dua elemen pengubahsuaian yang dicadangkan adalah memasukkan elemen tiga aras perwakilan kimia dan adaptasi aktiviti pengajaran sedia ada di Malaysia seperti dalam Rajah 2. Elemen tiga aras perwakilan kimia dimasukkan ke dalam model penghujahan saintifik dalam kimia bagi meningkatkan lagi kualiti hujah pelajar. Pengintegrasian ini perlu dimasukkan ke dalam elemen penghujahan pada bukti (aras makroskopik) dan justifikasi (aras mikroskopik dan simbolik). Selain itu, penambahan pada penilaian kualiti hujah yang dibina perlu dibuat terutama pada kriteria teoritikal dimana dakwaan yang dibuat perlu selari dengan teori saintifik yang terkini pada aras mikroskopik dan simbolik. Ketepatan interpretasi data juga dinilai pada aras mikroskopik dan simbolik. Akhir sekali ubahsuai perlu dilakukan pada panduan dalam membina penghujahan saintifik dimana hujah yang dibina patut mengintegrasikan tiga aras perwakilan kimia. Selain itu, keadaan kelas sains di Malaysia pada masa sekarang juga perlu diambil kira dalam membina model. Ini untuk memastikan penghujahan saintifik boleh dijalankan dalam konteks pendidikan di Malaysia. Fungsi guru dan ciri aktiviti yang sesuai perlu dimasukkan ke dalam model untuk dijadikan panduan oleh guru. 141 Dakwaan Tekaan, kesimpulan, penerangan, pernyataan deskriptif, jawapan persoalan kajian Sesuai dengan Panduan pembinaan dan penilaian hujah Menyokong Bukti Panduan menilai kualiti hujah berdasarkan kepada kriteria empirical dan teoritikal Data (numerik, pemerhatian, dapat kajian lain), analisis data, interpretasi data Disokong pada aras mikroskopik dan simbolik dengan Makroskopik Mikroskopik Simbolik Menerangkan pada aras mikroskopik dan simbolik Cadangan kriteria aktiviti dalam konteks pendidikan di Malaysia Justifikasi Penerangan tekaan, konsep atau teori yang mendokong analisis data, interpretasi data Fungsi gurupelajar dalam konteks pendidikan di Malaysia Rajah 2: Cadangan ubahsuai model penghujahan saintifik kimia KESIMPULAN Banyak kelebihan yang dapat diperolehi sekiranya penghujahan saintifik diamalakan di dalam kelas. Banyak kajian lepas yang telah dijalankan untuk membina model penghujahan saintifik dalam suasana pembelajaran yang aktif dan digunakan dalam subjek sains secara umum. Model ini tidak sesuai digunakan di Malaysia memandangkan di Malaysia pembelajaran masih dijalankan secara 142 pasif. Selain itu, kewujudan tiga aras perwakilan kimia juga perlu diberi perhatian. Oleh itu, model sedia ada perlu diubahsuai agar ia sesuai digunakan dalam konteks pendidikan kimia di Malaysia. Satu kajian akan dijalankan bagi mengkaji keberkesanan model yang dicadangkan dalam konteks pendidikan di Malaysia RUJUKAN Barke, H-D., Al-Hazari & Yitbarek, S. (2009). Misconception in Chemistry. New York: Springer. Braaten, M. & Windschitl, M. (2011). Working toward a stronger conceptualization of scientific explanation for science education. Science Education, 95(4): 639-669. Cavagnetto, A. R. (2010). Argument to foster scientific literacy: A review of argument interventions in K–12 science contexts. Review of Educational Research, 80(3): 336-371. Cetin, P. S. (2014). Explicit argumentation instruction to facilitate conceptual understanding and argumentation skills. Research in Science & Technological Education, 32(1), 1-20. Chin, C. & Osborne, J. (2010a). Supporting argumentation through students' questions: Case studies in science classrooms. Journal of the Learning Sciences, 19(2), 230-284. Chuzairy Hanri (2013). Modul Pengajaran Kimia Berdasarkan Model Inkuiri-Kreativiti. Universiti Teknologi Malaysia: Tesis Sarjana. Chuzairy Hanri, & Mohammad Yusof Arshad. (2013). Ke arah pendidikan yang lebih berkualiti: Pengamalan pengajaran guru kimia dalam menggalakkan kreativiti. Paper presented at the International Seminar on Quality and Affordable Education, Johor Bahru. Clark, D. B. & Sampson, V. D. (2007). Personally‐Seeded Discussions to Scaffold Online Argumentation. International Journal of Science Education, 29(3), 253-277. deJong, O. & Taber, K. S. (2007) Teaching and learning the many faces of chemistry. In Abell, S. K. & Lederman, N. G., Handbook of Research on Science Education, Lawrence Erlbaum Associates, pp.631-652 . Erduran, S., Simon, S. & Osborne, J. (2004). TAPping into argumentation: Developments in the application of Toulmin's 143 Argument Pattern for studying science discourse. Science Education, 88(6), 915-933. Eskin, H. & Berkiroglu, F. O. (2008). Investigation of A Pattern Between Students’ Engagement in Argumentation and Their Science Content Knowledge: A case Study. Eurasia Journal of Mathematics, Science & Technology Education, 5(1), 63-70. Jaber, L. D. & S. BouJaoude. (2012). A Macro–Micro–Symbolic Teaching to Promote Relational Understanding of Chemical Reactions. International Journal of Science Education, 34(7), 973–998. Jiménez-Aleixandre, M. P. & Erduran, S. (2007). Argumentation in Science Education: An Overview. In S. Erduran & M. P. Jiménez-Aleixandre (Eds.), Argumentation in Science Education: Perspectives from Classroom-Based Research. New York: Springer. Johnstone, A. H. (2000). Teaching of chemistry–Logical or Psychological? Chemistry Education Research and Practice in Europe, 1(1), 9–15. Kenneth D. M. (2009). Effective instructional strategies: From theory to practice. New York: Sage Publication. Lee Ling Heng, & Johari Surif. (2013a). Penghujahan saintifik: Memahami perlaksanaannya dalam proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran kimia. Jurnal Teknologi Malaysia, 65(1), 1-8. Lee Ling Heng, & Johari Surif. (2013b). Penghujahan saintifik: Penguasaan pelajar dalam konsep asid dan bes secara individu dan kumpulan Paper presented at the 2nd International Seminar on Quality and Affordable Education, Johor Bahru. Martin M. O., Mullis, V. S., Gonzalez, E. J. & Chrostowski, S.J. (2004). TIMSS 2003 International science report. Boston College: TIMSS & PIRLS International Study Center, Lynch School of Education. Martin, M. O., Mullis, I. V. S., Foy, P. & Stanco, G. M. (2012). TIMSS 2011 International Results in Science. Boston College: TIMSS & PIRLS International Study Center, Lynch School of Education. McNeill, K. L. & Krajcik, J. (2009). Synergy between teacher practices and curricular scaffolds to support students in using domainspecific and domain-general knowledge in writing arguments to explain phenomena. The Journal Of The Learning Science, 18, 416-460. 144 Newton, P., Driver, R. & Osborne, J. (1999). The place of argumentation in the pedagogy of school science. International Journal of Science Education, 21(5), 553-576. Next Generation Science Standard (2013). Next generation standards. Diakses pada 10 September 2014. http://www.nextgenscience.org/next-generation-sciencestandards. Nussbaum, E. M. (2011). Argumentation, Dialogue Theory, and Probability Modeling: Alternative Frameworks for Argumentation Research in Education. Educational Psychologist, 46(2), 84-106. Qualifications and Curriculum Authority (2007). How science works. Diakses pada 23 September 2014. www.qca.org.uk. Sadler, T. D. (2004). Informal Reasoning Regarding Socioscientific Issues: A Critical Review of Research. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 41(5): 513-536. Sampson, V. & Clark, D. (2009). The effect of collaboration on the outcomes of argumentation. Science Education, 93(3), 448–484. Sandoval, W. A. & Reiser, B. J. (2004). Explanation-driven inquiry: Integrating conceptual and epistemic scaffolds for scientific inquiry. Science Education, 88(3), 345-372. Stegmann, K., Weinberger, A. & Fischer, F. (2007). Facilitating argumentative knowledge construction with computer-supported collaboration scripts. International Journal of ComputerSupported Collaborative Learning, 2(4), 421-447. Tay, C. S. (2010). Amalan Konstruktivis Guru Sains Sekolah Rendah Melalui Interaksi Verbal Bilik Darjah. Universiti Teknologi Malaysia: Tesis Doktor Falsafah Toulmin, S. (1958). The uses of argument. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Treagust, D. F., Chittleborough, G. D. & T. L. Mamiala. (2003). The Role of Submicroscopic and Symbolic Representations in Chemical Explanations. International Journal of Science Education, 25(11), 1353–1369. Tsaparlis, G., Kolioulis, D. & E. Pappa. (2010). Lower-Secondary Introductory Chemistry Course: A Novel Approach Based on Science-Education Theories with Emphasis on the Macroscopic Approach, and the Delayed Meaningful Teaching of the Concepts of Molecule and Atom. Chemistry Education Research and 145 Practice, 11(2), 107–117. Walker, J. P. & Sampson, V. (2013). Learning to Argue and Arguing to Learn: Argument-Driven Inquiry as a Way to Help Undergraduate Chemistry Students Learn How to Construct Arguments and Engage in Argumentation During a Laboratory Course. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 50(5), 561-596. Winnie Sim Siew Li & Mohammad Yusof Arshad. (2014a). Verbal interaction in chemistry secondary school classrooms. Jurnal Teknologi Malaysia, 66(1), 21-26. Winnie Sim Siew Li & Mohammad Yusof Arshad. (2014b). Chemistry Teacher’s Questions at Multiple Representation Levels in Inquiry-Based Chemistry Lessons. Sains Humanika, 1(1), 31-36. Yalcinoglu, P. (2007). Evolution as Represented through Argumentation: A Qualitative Study on Reasoning and Argumentation in High School Biology Teaching Practices. The Ohio State University: Tesis Doktor Falsafah. Zohar, A. & Nemet, F. (2002). Fostering students’ knowledge and argumentation skills through dilemmas in human genetics. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 39(1), 35–62. 146 ESL LEARNERS’ ENGLISH LEARNING ATTITUDES IN CHINESE INDEPENDENT HIGH SCHOOLS Khei Yok Man @ Khei Yok Lee ABSTRACT This study examines the language attitudes of English as a Second Language learners in five Chinese independent high schools located in three southern states of peninsular Malaysia, namely Negeri Sembilan, Melaka and Johor. A total of 150 Form Four (Senior One) students who had sat for PMR the previous year (2013) were administered in this investigation. Quantitative and qualitative data were collected for analysis in this study via questionnaire, classroom observations and interviews. Findings show that there is significant difference between learners’ English Attitude and Subscription of English Magazine at Home as well as English Speaking Family. In addition, significant difference is also identified between learners’ PMR English Score and Subscription of English Magazine at Home including English Proficiency. Findings further confirm that there is no significant difference between learners’ Gender and Language Attitude including Anxiety which corroborated with research done elsewhere. 91.33 percent of the students (N=137) show interest and perceive learning English as a joy and pride. Only 19.33 percent of the 147 students (N=29) believe good language learners are more intelligent and a meager 8 percent (N=12) will give up learning English while 92 percent (N=138) will try other means, such as going for tuition or surfing online for assistance when their English teacher is not a good one. Pearson Chi-square analysis also concludes that there is no correlation between learners’ PMR English Score and Gender as well as School. Keywords: English as a Second Language; Language Attitudes, Belief in Learning, Physical Environment of the Classroom, Anxiety; Chinese Independent High School, Dong Zong INTRODUCTION Previous findings pointed out that a learner’s attitudes play a significant role in language learning, viz., towards the target language and the teacher. Rodriguez-Brown et al. (1987) further found that a learner’s attitudes towards the target language play a more important role in second language learning than previously described. Inspired by this, this paper investigates the English learning attitudes of students in the Malaysian context in general and Chinese independent high school in particular, hoping to see the relevance between attitudes and the respondents’ learning process revealed by variables such as Gender, English Speaking Family, Subscription of English Magazine, English Proficiency, Belief in Learning, Anxiety and Physical Environment of the Classroom. It is anticipated that by closely examining learner’s attitudes in English learning as this investigation attempts might inform learners and teachers how the findings could be adapted to develop a more effective model. It is also believed that by understanding the complexities of English language learners and background knowledge of the language acquisition process can be beneficial for educators, parents, and learners in educational reform efforts for English. 148 Rationale of the Study In Malaysia, English made an entry in the mid-18th century. When Malaysia declared independence in 1957 after 150 years of British colonization, Bahasa Malaysia became her national language. In 1970, year one students in schools across Malaysia underwent the new English as a Second Language programme where English was taught as a subject with the introduction of the Education Bill which officially accorded English the status of a second language (Asmah Omar, 1979:23). Since English is the second language of Malaysia, it is widely used by many people everywhere and one cannot deny the need to command it to fulfill the demands of the challenging world ahead in various aspects. It is further thought that there are some gaps which point to the need of a context dependent and qualitative study. These gaps are (1) As a high school teacher, to the researcher’s knowledge, not much research on English learning attitudes had been done in Chinese independent high schools, (2) Respondents are scarcely asked to make comments on their English learning attitudes, and (3) The existence of Chinese independent high schools is in itself unique and they emphasized English learning though employing Chinese Mandarin as medium of instruction for most subjects, hence a probe into their learners’ attitudes towards English in learning will be insightful to all concerned. The purpose of this research is to identify the English language attitudes of learners in Chinese independent high schools and their relevance with variables since English learning is prioritised in their syllabuses, as seven periods (280 minutes) of English is taught on a weekly basis for both junior and senior levels (Dong Zong, 2010). OBJECTIVES OF THE STUDY The objectives of this study are to identify the attitudes of Chinese 149 high schools’ learners towards English and their correlation with PMR English Score, Gender, School, Family Background, English Proficiency, Subscription of English Magazine, Teacher-fronted Time, Student-student Interaction and the Physical Environment of the Classroom. LITERATURE REVIEW The conclusions from the research done worldwide which are documented below point out that researchers, ESL teachers and administrators need to consider the fact that they need to have keys for knowing their students' attitudes and preferences towards learning English for motivation purposes. Findings were as follows: Hong Kong Chinese respondents show a strong bias against English speakers and regarded it as the language of power (Lyczak et al.,1976); high school students hold a negative attitude towards the use of English though they expressed a positive value towards English at the same time (Pierson et al.,1980); university students of Hong Kong adopted positive affective, pragmatic and socio-political attitudes towards the English language (Littlewood and Liu, 1996); English was the target language needed for students at secondary and tertiary level in their career and personal growth in Hong Kong (Yan and Lau, 2003); Singapore Chinese and Indian children’s attitudes towards English on both attitudinal dimensions were found to be lower than their attitudes towards their mother tongue and code-switching, while the Malay children expressed no significant difference (Bokhorst-Heng et al., 2009). METHODOLOGY This study focuses on the English learning attitudes of learners in Chinese independent high schools. Five Chinese independent high schools’ students from three states in the southern region of Malaysia (Two in Negeri Sembilan, one in Melaka and Two in Johore) were chosen using Cluster Sampling for the purpose of 150 data collection. It was administered among Senior One (Form Four) students in five Chinese independent high schools. 150 respondents (88 boys and 62 girls) were involved in the investigation. Quantitative as well as qualitative data were collected via questionnaires, interviews, observations, oral reports and stimulated reflection, if any, for not only interpretations and analysis but also triangulation. The significant difference and correlation between the respondents’ attitudes identified to be important in language learning was sought after from questionnaires and classroom observations. For measurement of reliability and validity of the data collected, Analysis of Variance (ANOVA), Two Sample T-test and Pearson Chi-square packages were utilized to identify the significant difference and correlation between the variables. FINDINGS AND DISCUSSION According to the descriptive statistics for learners derived from the questionnaire data, the variables Anxiety and Belief in Learning top the highest scores which translate all the learners’ anxiety scale is the highest (67.033) among other variables in English learning but they have strong positive belief in English learning (58.560). Analysis suggests that there is no significant difference between learners’ Gender and Language Attitude as well as Anxiety as can be seen from Table 1 and 2 below: Table 1: T-test for Gender versus Language Attitude Gender N Mean StDev SE Mean Boy 88 46.83 5.18 0.55 Girl 62 46.79 4.92 0.62 P-Value = 0.963 P < 0.05 The table above indicates that of the 150 respondents, 88 are boys and 62 are girls. Their average score (Mean) in Language 151 Attitude are 46.83 and 46.79 respectively. The standard deviations (StDev) are 5.18 and 4.92. Since the P-Value is above 0.05, meaning, there is no significant difference found between the variables Gender and Language Attitude. Likewise, the table below also indicates that there is no significant difference between Gender and Anxiety figuratively: Table 2: T-test for Gender versus Anxiety Gender N Mean StDev SE Mean Boy 88 66.91 8.34 0.89 Girl 62 67.21 8.22 1.0 P-Value = 0.8 P < 0.05 But there is significant difference found between learners’ English Attitude and Subscription of English Magazine at Home including English Speaking Family as indicated in Table 3 and 4 and between PMR English Score and Subscription of English Magazine at Home as well as English Proficiency as evidenced in Table 5 and 6: Table 3: T-test for English attitude and Subscription of English Magazine at Home EngSubs N Mean StDev SE Mean Yes 18 49.33 4.19 0.99 No 132 46.47 5.08 0.44 P-Value = 0.024 P < 0.05 As clearly shown in Table 3 above, only 18 students subscribed English magazine at home and the average scores (Mean) are 49.33 for subscribers and 46.47 for non subscribers. The standard deviations are 4.19 and 5.08 respectively. The P-Value obtained from T-test is 0.024, which shows there is significant difference between the variables. In other words, students who subscribed English magazine will score differently in their PMR English subject. Similar indication is also evidenced between English Attitude and English Speaking Family below (Table 4) though the 152 P-Value is 0.08. It shows the obtained P-Value has only a difference of 0.03 compared to 0.05 and there is possibility of errors in the process of data collection and thus it is considered as significant difference. Table 4: T-test for English Attitude and English Speaking Family EngFami N Mean StDev SE Mean Boy 28 48.32 4.70 0.89 Girl 122 46.47 5.09 0.46 P-Value = 0.080 (weak difference depends on errors) P < 0.05 The P-Value of Table 5 and 6 below confirm the significant difference and correlation between the variables as well since they are below 0.05: Table 5: T-test for PMR English Score versus Subscription of English Magazine at Home EngSubs N Mean StDev SE Mean Yes 18 1.83 1.15 0.27 No 132 2.89 1.31 0.11 P-Value = 0.001 P < 0.05 Table 6: ANOVA for PMR, using adjusted Students on PMR Score Source DF Seq SS Adj SS Adj MS F P EngPro 2 116.322 116.322 58.161 57.37 0.000 Error 147 149.038 149.038 1.014 Total 149 265.360 P-Value = 0.000 P < 0.05 In addition, Pearson Chi-square analysis also concludes that there is no correlation between learners’ PMR English Score and Gender as well as School. On the other hand, of all the 150 students from five schools, 91.33 percent of them (N=137) showed interest and perceived learning English as a joy and pride from personal interview as they 153 were convinced English as an international language is a must for communication and possibly will secure a well paid job. There are 17.33 percent of the students (N=16) who do not think that by mastering English will secure well paid and good job though. Only 19.33 percent of the students (N=29) believe good language learners are more intelligent and a meager 8 percent (N=12) will give up learning English while 92 percent (N=138) will try other means when their English teacher is not a good one. Data also suggests that as high as 48.67 percent (N=73) of the 150 students feel panic when asked to answer questions in English class. Notwithstanding this outstanding figure, in personal interviews, these students (89.33 percent, N=134) are not afraid of being corrected in terms of English errors made in public by their teacher though they are mostly reluctant to answer English questions posted by teacher voluntarily. Finally, Students believe that in English teaching, teaching aids employed by teachers such as eye-catching and interesting textbooks, records, videos play central role. From classroom observations, which were recorded on an Observation Guide Form, chalk (marker) and talk was noted for nine out of ten teachers while doing grammar translation. Hardly any interactions between students and teachers were spotted the same went with student to student interactions. Students answered questions only when they were called upon to. The size of the classes ranged from 30 and above but below 50. As for the physical environment of the classroom, computers and projectors were found installed in the classrooms. The classroom settings were identical: desks and chairs arranged in straight rows facing the board where the teacher usually stood in teaching practices. CONCLUSION In a nutshell, data suggests that there is significant difference between learners’ English Attitude and Subscription of English Magazine at Home as well as English Speaking Family. Likewise, 154 significant difference is also identified between learners’ PMR English Score and Subscription of English Magazine at Home as well as English Proficiency. Pearson Chi-square confirms that there is no correlation between learners’ PMR English Score and Gender as well as School. Findings further confirm that there is no significant difference between learners’ Gender and Language Attitude including Anxiety which corroborated with research done elsewhere. 91.33 percent of the students (N=137) show interest and perceive learning English as a joy and pride. Only 19.33 percent of the students (N=29) believe good language learners are more intelligent and a meager 8 percent (N=12) will give up learning English while 92 percent (N=138) will try other means, such as going for tuition or surfing online for assistance when their English teacher is not a good one. REFERENCES Agheyisi, R. & Fishman, J. A. (1970). Language attitude studies: A brief survey of methodological approaches. Anthropological Linguistics, 12, 137-157. Asmah Omar. 1979. Language for Unity and Efficiency. Kuala Lumpur: University Malaya Press. Bokhorst-Heng, W. D. et al. 2009. The language attitudes of bilingual youth in multilingual Singapore. Journal of Multilingual and Multicultural Development, 30 (3): 235-251. Dong Zong Internal Document. 2009. Kajang: Dong Zong. Dong Zong Official Website. http://www.dongzong.my. Littlewood, W. & Liu, N. 1996. Hong Kong students and their English. English Centre: The University of Hong Kong. Lyczak, R., Fu, G. S. & Ho, A. 1976. Attitudes of Hong Kong bilinguals towards English and Chinese speakers. Journal of Cross-Cultural Psychology, 7(4): 425-438. Pierson, H. D., Fu, G. S. & Lee S. 1980. An analysis of the relationship between language attitudes and English attainment of secondary students in Hong Kong. Language Learning, 30: 289-316. Rodriguez-Brown, F. V. and Ruesta, M. B. 1987. Attitudes and motivational factors in second language learning. Online ERIC 155 Digest. Yan, A. & Lau, L. 2003. Student attitudes to the learning of English at secondary and tertiary levels. System, 31(1): 107-123. 156 INVESTIGATING THE EXISTING TEXT IN SECONDARY SCHOOL: STUDENTS’ PERCEPTION ABOUT THE NEED OF CRITERIA IN TEXT SELECTION Aryanti Ishak ABSTRACT Thishis paper is looking at the importance of the criteria in literary text selection in order to achieve the aims of teaching and learning literature. The key to have a success program depends on text selection because the right reading material will provide the enlightenment that the students need and motivate the students to achieve the objectives of learning in the target language. Keywords: Literature, Criteria, Text selection INTRODUCTION Literature in Malaysia has been incorporated in schools in year 2000 and the inclusion of literature component according to Soraya (1994), in the first place is to” develop in students a deeper level of understanding and an awareness, and sensitivity to human values and issues” (Centre of Development of Education, 1987). 157 However, according to Vethamani (2009) the decision to have the literature component was also due to the drastic measure to enhance literacy among the students. Therefore, literature component is aimed to empower reading at large by introducing the learners with different genres namely, poem, short stories, novel and drama. It is hoped that the reading of such genres will broaden their cultural outlook and infuse the reading appreciation toward the literary works and self-development Vethamani, 2007, Curriculum Development Centre). Literature is believed is accordance to the National Philosophy of Education in equipping the learners with the survival skills which later prepare the students to become contributing citizens to the nations’ growth. THE OBJECTIVES OF LITERATURE COMPONENT IN THE EDUCATION The move to the literature inclusion was driven by several factors. The major factor was driven by literacy problem faced by the students. The declining standard in the English Language was a big concern to the nation. The previous reading program such as the Class Reader Program (CRP) which aimed at developing reading skills and introducing the elements of literature into language teaching is considered as failed to produce a significant impact due to the text difficulty and was neglected by both teachers and students (Gunakumaran, 2007). Thus, literature component took place with enforcement in reading and taught as part of the English language syllabus and had to be assessed in the centralised examinations. The objective of being tested in the examination is to ensure that reading need to be taken seriously by teachers and especially students. Thus, the objectives of literature component are to help students improve their language skills and gaining experience as well as educational goals through pleasure reading. By doing so, students were expected to show their literary competence in the form of giving their personal responses, understand the 158 relationship of the characters and infer the messages as well as themes. The implementation of the literature component also encourages the students to show their aesthetic appreciation toward the literary work and relate them to one’s life. In general, the aims of literature component reflects the reasons for teaching and using literature in classroom and it is in accordance to what has been mentioned by literature prominent and a continuity from a previous reading program. Other factor that drives the literature component to be integrated in school is to enhance the appreciation values through the understanding of themselves and others. Malaysia known as multiracial and multicultural country, maintain the harmonious in the country through using a book as a unity tool (Melody, 2011). The literary text chosen will encompass moral values which relevant to our lives and it confirms one of the reasons for using literature as a means for cultural enrichment where students will be exposed to certain aspects of target culture. BENEFIT OF LITERARY TEXT Past studies show that literary texts are useful in integrating language skills and it is effective due to the motivational embedded such as cultural, literary and higher-higher order thinking benefits (Erkaya, 2005). On top of that, literary text also benefits the students in terms of the authenticity where students were exposed to language awareness and offer more comprehensible and greater communicative value (Crossley and Louwerse, 2007). Literary texts allow readers to have both, close and pleasure reading. Close reading heightened the attentiveness while pleasure reading contributes to enlightenment. Result from Mar, Oatley and Peterson (2009) show that exposure to literary text confirms positive correlation to social support, empathy and tendency to understand others. In other word, it confirms the means of literature as personal growth (Collie and Slater, 1991). 159 STATEMENT OF PROBLEM The option of selecting just the right material is perceived as an important initial step and very essential in reading literature when it is regarded as a resource or a subject. The materials or texts chosen should be within the range of student’s content knowledge and at the same time help them to improve and acquire the attended lesson with impact. Rosenblatt (1995) indicates that text chosen should be done in prudent way to ensure the benefits gained from the text chosen are achieved or else the impact is in vain. Friese, Alvermann, Parkes and Rezak (2008) report that the most common literary texts found in schools are based on three aspects, namely narrative, award-winning and fictional. The selection is normally made on the basis of what they consider as a fit between their students’ needs and their involvement. However at times, the selection is formed based on curriculum and state necessity. When the choice of text is done based on curriculum and state necessity, it is feared that a mismatch may occur between the learners and the texts selected, which in the long run will result in reading resentment. According to Fauziah, Marziah and Tina (2008), text selection should correspond with the goals and aims of the program and better selection will motivate the students to read. According to Bushman and Bushman (1997), texts that do not fit the students’ level will widen the gap of the students’ understanding. Unfit texts in this context mean texts that do not meet the students’ needs and interest. The mismatch will minimize the students’ involvement and interaction with texts. As a result, the involvements only occur at surface level and due to that the goal of teaching and learning literature is in vain. Bushman also warns that any failure to grasp the plot or meaning making strongly indicates that the text is uninteresting. The students’ plea to make their own selection (Tina et al, 2007) indicates that the text selected may not satisfy their interest and demands. Too (2004) and Gurnam (2003) note that among the students’ drawback in literature learning is the mismatched texts prescribed 160 by the Ministry of Education. More than half of the students felt that the texts were boring. Among the reasons given to describe their boredom include uninteresting texts, slow paced plots, irrelevant themes and that they felt that they were forced to read. Norliana et al. (2008) also report that students feel less enthusiastic in learning literature largely because the language used in the text does not correspond with their language level,hence, they encountered difficulty in comprehending the text. Apparently, they did not enjoy reading lessons because reading was more to prepare for the examination. Due to that, most students preferred to be spoon fed about the text information by their teachers through information-based approach in instruction and language learning (Razuan et al., 2010). Past reports (Hashimah and Che Ton, 2011,; Hashimah, 2012, ; Vethamani and Nair, 2011, ; Tseng, 2010) indicate that selection of textbook is done based on the education policy and requirement determined by the national curriculum. Therefore, conflict arises when students’ needs and preferences were neglected where most students feel that the literary text suggested for them is difficult and demanding ( Hoslt, 1981; Carter, Walker and Brumfit, 1989; Jamaluddin 2009). Nor Hashimah Isa (2012) reveals that despite the benefits gained from learning literature, the students perceived that the reading activity is resulted from school curriculum requirement, and therefore reading is done for the assessment purpose within an exam oriented system. From Thirumalai’s (2002) point of view as cited in Fauziah, Marzilah and Tina (2008), cautious process in text selection is needed if reading skill is emphasized and it is important to choose literary work that is relevant to learner’s life experiences, emotions or dreams because the appropriateness will benefit upon learner’s linguistic and cultural development as stipulated by McKay (1997). 161 CRITERIA FOR SELECTION LITERARY TEXT OR NOVEL The most common criteria to be considered in choosing the text are language, content and length (Chen, 2006). However, since the main aim in teaching literature is to develop the intellectuality in natural understanding, the emphasis is on reasoning and thinking (Langer, 1989). Henceforth, Rosenblatt (1978) sees that the relationship between the text and reader should be reinforced by allowing the personal involvement and growth. The access to text is the key to the success of the literature teaching, and therefore, the text chosen should match with their general background, language level, interest, maturity and age as their reading interest is varied and maybe influenced by their background which can change over time. Hişmanoğlu (2005) mentions that students’ needs and motivation are factors that also need to be considered whilst some believe that factors such as choice, length, culture, emotion, illustration are also important in text selection . The criteria mentioned should be given a great consideration because it allows the connection and engagement which are essential in understanding literature. Many believe (Rosenblatt, 1995; Collie and Slater, 1994; Hadaway, Vardell and Young, 2002,2006; Temple et al., 2006) that texts that are well matched to students’ ability will build up the confidence and promote independent and pleasure reading as well as autonomous learning. On the contrary, the ill- chosen book will impede the reading interest and draw readers to lay off their reading. Since, reading is one of the emphases in the literature curriculum, it is vital for us to find the appropriate and workable text that works and matches cognitively and emotively with the students. THE PURPOSE OF THE STUDY The main purpose of the study is to investigate the existing text that used in school. The intention of this study is find out the 162 students perception about the current text by highlighting the importance of text selection with regards to reading materials. Donelson (1989) agrees that a good literature program will invite the readers to respond, provide the information, develop skills and prepare them to the real world. Text selection is fundamental in developing learners’ growth either in academic and or in personal, hence, this study is also aimed at identifying the criteria that currently practised by the Ministry of Education in selecting the text. RESEARCH OBJECTIVES In order to answer the purpose of the study, several research objectives have been outlined. The objectives are as follows: 1. To find out the students’ perception about the text read. 2. To investigate whether the text chosen are based on the certain criteria and contains the criteria as highlighted by practitioners. 3. To investigate whether the text chosen encourage the students read in terms of aesthetic appreciation of literary works and relate to learners. RESEARCH QUESTIONS The research questions for this study are as follows: 1. What are the criteria that need to be taken into consideration in literary text selection for secondary schools? 2. What are the criteria that are currently used in choosing literary texts for secondary schools? 3. What type of reading stances do learners exhibit when reading literary text? 4. To what extend does literature make a significant 163 contribution to promote/fulfil the intended objectives? PILOT STUDY The pilot study was based on a survey research. A set of questionnaire was distributed in one of the secondary schools in Kuantan. The respondents are form five students. A total of 40 students responded to the questionnaires. The students have already been exposed to the novel entitled “The Curse” by Lee Su Ann. This novel has been selected by the Ministry of Education for form five students who reside within the zone 3 region, covering Kelantan, Terengganu, Pahang and Johor. The questionnaire was divided into two different sections which catered for students’ background and opinion. The questionnaire contains close- ended, open- ended and likert scale questions. It was designed to seek the opinion of the respondents about the literary text chosen and criteria for text selection in schools. Descriptive analysis using percentage and factor analysis are used to describe the finding. FINDINGS AND DISCUSSION Analysis of data was conducted. The following tables demonstrate the findings. Table 1: The importance of Criteria in Selection of Text Criteria N Yes % 1. Needs 40 26 65% 2. Theme 40 28 70% 3. Interest 40 30 75 % 4. Cultural background 40 23 57.5 % 5. Motivation 40 29 72.5 % 164 6. Emotion 40 29 72.5 % 7. Ambition and dreams 40 24 60 % 8. Maturity 40 33 82.5% 9.Age 40 35 87.5 % 10. Related to life 40 15 37.5 & 11. Text length 40 23 57.5 & 12. Content 40 30 75 % Table 1shows the result of the survey on the perception of the criteria needed in fulfilling the objectives in teaching and learning literature. Majority of the respondents ( 65%) agreed that needs is important while 75% of them agreed on interest as the criterion for text selection. Motivation and emotion share the same percentage which is 72.5 %. For cultural background, 57.5 % agreed that it is an important criterion. Majority of respondents (70%) agreed that interesting themes is important criterion in text selection while more than half of the respondents, (60%) claimed that text that matches with their ambition and dreams will be important to be considered when choosing text. 87.5 % respondents claimed that age factor plays a role in choosing the right text. Similarly, 82.5 % also claimed maturity as important factor to be included as one of the criteria. Surprisingly, only 37.5 % agreed that text related to their life is important. About 57.5 % of respondents said that text length should be considered for text selection and 75 % of respondents agreed that content of the story is important in reading selected text. The results above show that the objective in literature teaching is achieved if the text selected is parallel to the students’ needs and interest. To achieve the goals of literacy instruction such as to expand their ability to think broadly, deeply and critically alongside to promote personal responses and satisfy personal needs and interest, the criteria in text selection will help us to make better selection in future that resulted in greater understanding and engagement alongside with reading. In short, most of the students 165 agreed that criteria in text selection is a determinant factor in relation to text selection, hence, the criteria mentioned should be given an emphasis before the decision is made. Result from factor analysis shows that KMO value indicates 8.27 and Bartlett’ test of sphericity with an associated p value of <0.001 indicates that we can proceed. Four components have eigenvalues over 1.00 and these explain over 73.86 % of the total variability in the data. This leads us to the conclusion that a four factor solution would be adequate. The four factors are defined as interesting text, language proficiency, motivation and emotion. KMO and Bartlett's Test Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy. Approx. Chi-Square Bartlett's Test of Sphericity .827 545.939 Df 171 Sig. .000 Communalities Initial Extraction i think novel is interesting 1.000 .748 i like to read this novel 1.000 .841 i feel very engaged 1.000 .507 plot is easy 1.000 .792 theme is well understood 1.000 .845 the language is easy 1.000 .632 the novel is suitable with target' age 1.000 .832 1.000 .673 novel instils my reading habit 1.000 .812 novel enhances my language skill 1.000 .733 novel expands my vocabulary 1.000 .682 novel caters my needs and reading preference 166 novel helps me to understand the culture 1.000 .689 1.000 .688 1.000 .723 1.000 .828 novel relevant to my life 1.000 .788 novel relevant to my dreams 1.000 .847 1.000 .742 1.000 .623 portrayed novel gives me the ide about literature studies novel enhances my language acquisition novel motivates me to read other english novel novel offers insights about past an present 1.8culture novel's length is suitable Rotated Component Matrixa Component 1 2 i think novel is interesting .742 i like to read this novel .781 i feel very engaged .597 3 plot is easy .701 theme is well understood .786 the language is easy .580 the novel is suitable with target' age novel caters my needs and reading preference . .715 .655 . novel instils my reading habit .842 novel enhances my language skill .507 novel expands my vocabulary novel helps me to understand the culture portrayed 4 . . . . .517 .785 167 novel gives me the idea about literature .790 studies novel enhances my language .625 acquisition novel motivates me to read other english novel .730 novel relevant to my life .878 novel relevant to my dreams .897 novel offers insights about past an .621 present culture novel's length is suitable .727 Extraction Method: Principal Component Analysis. Rotation Method: Varimax with Kaiser Normalization. a. Rotation converged in 7 iterations. REFERENCES Ahmad, F., & Aziz, J. (2009). Students' Perception of the Teachers' Teaching of Literature Communicating and Understanding Through the Eyes of the Audience. European Journal of Social Sciences, 7(3), 17-26. Beaumont, R. (2012). An introduction to Principal Component Analysis & Factor Analysis Using SPSS 19 and R (psych package). Chen, Y.-M. (Dec 2006). Using Children's Literature for Reading and Writing Stories. [Journal]. Asian EFL Journal, 8(4), 23. Fauziah Ismail, Marzilah Abdul Aziz, & Abdullah, T. (2008). Research in English Language: A Revisit in the Malaysian Context: Penerbitan UTM. FRIESE, E. E. G., ALVERMANN, D. E., PARKES, A., & REZAK, A. T. (2008). Selecting texts for English Language Arts classrooms: When assessment is not enough. English Teaching: Practice and Critique .7(3), 74-99. Ghazali, S. N. (2008). Learner background and their attitudes towards Studying Literature. Malaysian Journal of ELT Research, 4, 17. 168 Hişmanoğlu, M. (April 2005). Teaching English Through Literature. [Journal]. Journal of Language and Linguistic Studies, 1(No.1), 14. Ismail, F., Aziz, M. A., & Abdullah, T. (2008). Literature in English Language Teaching: A revisit in the Malaysian Context Penerbitan UTM (pp. 53-67): Univision Press. Mukundan, J. (2006). Readings on ELT Materials II: Pearson Longman Malaysia Sdn. Bhd. Rashid, R. A., Vethamani, M. E., & Rahman, S. B. A. (2010). Approaches Employed by Teachers in Teaching Literature to Less Proficient Students in Form 1 and Form 2. [Journal]. English Language Teaching, Canadian Center of Science and Education, 3(4), 13. Rosenblatt, L. M. (1995). Literature as exploration (5th ed.). New York: Modern Language Association of America. Sage, H. (1987). Incorporating Literature in ESL Instructions. New Jersey: Prentice hall. Sidhu, G. K. (2003). Literature in the language classroom: Seeing through the eyes of learners in Gunakumaran Subramaniam (ed). Teaching literature in ESL/EFL contexs. Petaling Jaya: Sasbadi. Sukatan Pelajaran Bahasa Kurikulum Bersepadu Sekolah Menengah, Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia (2000). Tina Abdullah, Mohammad Hassan Zakaria, Mansor, W. F. A. W., & Aziz, M. A. (2007). A New Teaching Model To Teach Literature for the TESL Pre-training Service Programme in Universiti Teknologi Malaysia: Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Vethamani, M. E., & Nair, P. (2009). Literacy Development Through the Incorporation of Literature in Language Education for Malaysia Secondary School Students. Indonesian Journal of English Language Teaching, 5(2), 153-167. 169 THE CORELATION BETWEEN PSYCHOLOGICAL NEEDS AND SOCIAL NETWORK ACTIVITIES Shima Mashayekhi & Mohd Tajudin Md. Ningal ABSTRACT The Internet has introduced major changes in our social and daily life. One type of online application that has grown rapidly in prevalence and popularity in recent years is ―social networking‖ on the Internet. Along with increasing daily problems related to use social networks in current world and negative impacts on mental health of users, it is necessary to study more. Some people spend most of their time in social networks specially Facebook which is involved in some negative relationship or communication in order to fulfill their psychological needs, so we can make people aware how they can choose a better way to satisfy their needs without involving in problems. This study suggest to identify the correlation between Five Basic Needs included (Love and Belonging, Survival, Freedom, Power, and Fun) and Facebook activities. Keywords: About Internet, Social networks, Facebook, Reality therapy, The five basic needs. 170 INTRODUCTION Social Network Activities The growth and popularity of online social networks has created a new world of collaboration and communication. “Communication” is one of the concepts that appear while human beings were existed. It is also the most important activities that can convey information between users and deliver information or data. It is often referred to as synonymous with mass media or news media, but may refer to a single medium used to communicate any data for any purpose. By developing the technology and increasing the population it was switches into several ways. In communications, ―media‖ are the storage and transmission channels or tools now allow for intense long-distance exchanges between larger numbers of people (many-to-many communication via e-mail, Internet forums, and teleportation). On the other hand, many traditional broadcast media and mass media favor (one-to-many communication via television, cinema, radio, newspaper, magazines, and also Facebook). The “internet” is arguably one of the most effective tools in media for communication. It is a worldwide decentralized network of computers that today has a far-reaching influence and may affect almost all aspects of our existence. In fact, the Internet has integrated so well into people’s lives that, for many, it is very difficult to imagine how they lived without it. One type of online application that has grown rapidly in prevalence and popularity in recent years is ―social networking‖ on the Internet. Social networking websites, such as Facebook, MySpace, Fraudster, Live Journal, and Bebo, are member-based Internet communities that allow users to post profile information, such as a username and photograph, and to communicate with others in innovative ways such as sending public or private online messages or sharing photos online. The popularity of the social networking site ―Facebook‖ is 171 unprecedented: It is currently the second most frequently visited website on the Internet and attracts a global audience of over 606 million people. For instance, a number of studies have found that Facebook use is associated with gains in social capital. Furthermore, a recent qualitative study suggests that Facebook may be changing the way individuals communicate and associate with one another. Psychological Needs There are several theories regarding the psychological needs and the theories involved in this study are Human Motivation of Abraham Maslow (1943) and Reality Therapy of William Glasser (1976). In this reviewing we focus more on Reality Therapy that includes Choice Theory. Maslow's hierarchy of needs is often portrayed in the shape of a pyramid, with the largest and most fundamental levels of needs at the bottom, and the need for self-actualization at the top. Maslow believed that these needs are similar to instincts and play a major role in motivating behavior. All these needs are Physiological needs, Security needs, Social needs, Esteem needs, and Selfactualizing needs. Physiological, security, social, and esteem needs are deficiency needs (also known as D-needs), meaning that these needs arise due to deprivation. Satisfying these lower-level needs is important in order to avoid unpleasant feelings or consequences. Maslow termed the highest-level of the pyramid as growth needs (also known as being needs or B-needs). Growth needs do not stem from a lack of something, but rather from a desire to grow as a person. One of the other psychological theories that point to our genetically driven needs is ―choice theory‖ which explains that all we ever do from birth to death is behaved and, with rare exceptions, everything we do is chosen. Every total behavior is our best attempt to get what we want to satisfy our needs. Although we may not be aware of our needs, we know that we want to feel 172 better. According to choice theory all human have five basic needs. The five basic needs are Survival, Love and Belonging, Freedom, Fun, and Power. These needs are innate and have genetic instructions. These needs are universal, and people have the needs in varying degrees. In other words, though all human being have all five basic needs, each of us does not experience the same amount of drive for each need. Choice theory teaches that we do not satisfy our needs directly. What we do, beginning shortly after birth and continuing all our lives, is to keep close track of anything we do that feels very good. We store information inside our minds and build a file of wants, called our quality world, which is at the core of our lives. It is our personal world that we would like to live in if we could. It is completely based on our wants and needs, but unlike the needs, which are general, it is very specific. The quality world consists of specific images of people, activities, events, beliefs, possessions, and situations that fulfill our needs (Wobbolding, 2000). Every person can identify unmet needs and try to satisfy them and Socializing with people is an effective way to meet our need for belonging, and of course social network is an example suitable way to reach this purpose. On the other hand, relationship is one of the most important factors affecting people's life and well-being. Some people spend most of their time in social networks specially Facebook which is involved in some negative relationship or communication in order to fulfill their needs such as love & belonging, so we can make people aware how they can choose a better way to satisfy their needs without involving in problems. REVIEWING PREVIOUS RESEARCH Hamburger and Ben-Artzi (2000) suggested that Internet use is related to personality. They demonstrated that on the Internet ―the poor can get richer,‖ namely, that introverts can compensate 173 themselves for the difficulties they experience in offline social interactions (Amichai-Hamburger et al., 2002). According to Amichai-Hamburger (2002), personality is a leading factor in understanding why people behave the way they do on the Internet. Since the net, by its very nature, is powered by human interaction, it follows that we cannot understand the workings of the Internet without understanding the personalities of those who surf it (Amichai-Hamburger, 2005). According to Amichai-Hamburger (2002), this kind of research is crucial as ―personality is a highly relevant factor in determining behavior on the Internet‖. For example Ross et al. (2009) studied the connection between the personality of the individual users and their behavior on a social network. They based their study on the self-reports of users of Facebook, one of the most popular social networks, and measured five personality factors using the NEO-PIR (Costa & McCrae, 1992) questionnaire. They found that while there was a connection between the personalities of surfers and their behavior on Facebook, it was strong. Ross et al. (2009) and Amichai-Hamburger and Vinitzky (2010) looked specifically at the relationship between the Big Five factors and usage of Facebook. Their results showed that a number of these factors are associated with particular patterns of Facebook use. For example, extraverted individuals generally have more Facebook Friends (Amichai-Hamburger & Vinitzky, 2010), and belong to more Facebook Groups1(Ross et al., 2009), than introverted individuals. Furthermore, individuals who are high in neuroticism are more likely than emotionally stable individuals to prefer using the Wall2 (Ross et al., 2009). As Ross et al. (2009) explain, a possible reason for the latter result is that the Wall offers people with neurotic tendencies the opportunity to take their time formulating messages and responses. As a consequence, the potential for unintentionally revealing personal information to others is reduced. Ross et al. (2009) suggested that Facebook use is related to personality. Using a Five-Factor Model personality questionnaire, they examined behavior on Facebook as reported by users. Their 174 first five predictions pertained to the relationship between behavior and the user’s personality. The results reported by Ross et al. (2009) gave partial support to the link between individual personality and Facebook behavior. The researchers did not find any significant connection between Facebook behavior and the personality factors of agreeableness and openness. However, they did find a partial link between behavior on Facebook and the traits of extroversion, neuroticism, and conscientiousness. Studies have shown a connection between the individual personality of the user and the way he or she behaves on line. Today many millions of people around the world are connected by being members of various Internet social networks. Ross et al. (2009) studied the connection between the personality of the individual users and their behavior on a social network. They based their study on the self-reports of users of Facebook, one of the most popular social networks, and measured five personality factors using the NEO-PI-R (Costa & McCrae, 1992) questionnaire. One of the other useful contents that can be related to psychological need is uses and gratifications. It is a media use paradigm from mass communications research that focuses on individual use and choice of media (Katz, 1959). The main purpose of this paradigm is to explain the reasons that people choose a specific medium over alternative communication media and to elucidate the psychological needs that motivate people to use a particular medium. This paradigm assumes that users are goaldirected in their behavior and are aware of their needs. Purposive value, self-discovery, entertainment value, social enhancement, and maintaining interpersonal connectivity are the key values (or needs) that are widely adopted to determine the use of virtual communities (Cheung & Lee, 2009). As you can see, the majority of research in this area has been based on broad models of personality. But it seems clear that other factors, besides the personality, have an influence on Facebook use. For example, psychological needs can be a category of these factors. 175 CONCLUSION Along with increasing daily problems related to use social networks in current world and its negative impacts on mental health of users, sometimes it can affect on some aspects such as their academic performance or relationship quality. So it has caused the counselors and therapist (especially those who work on families) to provide theories and plans for users who have problems and may be under any negative impacts related to use social networks. Socializing with people is an effective way to meet our need for belonging. So if life is unsatisfactory or we are distressed or in trouble, this approach advocates that one basic thing is to check carefully, whether we are succeeding in meeting our basic psychological needs for power, belonging, freedom and fun. And social networks have a main role to meet our needs, but also can have some negative impact if our needs won’t be satisfied. However it’s clear that any one is a part of many relationships, but just needs a relationship with a more consistently positive emphasis and since Facebook is a unique opportunities to have a lots of relationship, but in many cases, the social network user's problem is the result of a negative relationship with someone and it will be influence to users’ behavior with so many tension or anxiety or stress. As studies show, there is no more research about the relationship between users’ psychological needs and their activities or behaving in Facebook and it’s a academic gap in this area. So it’s not clear why they behave on this way. In spite of the potential implication of Facebook use, there is a distinct lack of empirically derived theory in psychological domains. Since Facebook is a relatively recent social phenomenon, there has been limited opportunity for exploratory research. However, in the last two years, a growing number of researchers have recognized the importance of such research, and are working towards identifying the types of people who use Facebook or why and how users interact on social networking sites. In order to effectively achieve this goal, some researchers have focused on the 176 relationship between Facebook use and various aspects of personality. According to Choice Theory of Reality Therapy, every total behavior is our best attempt to get what we want to satisfy our needs. Although we may not be aware of our needs, we know that we want to feel better. Every person can identify unmet needs and try to satisfy them. These assumption seem to be reasonable because Love and Belonging is the only need that requires more than one person to fulfillment of it, and in the other side online social networking sites, social interaction and connection is the most important objective for users, so the findings of this study maybe show the need of Love and Belonging has an effective role to behave online. In conclusion, we can identify the big gap about the relevance of psychological human needs to Facebook behavior. It may help to explain why some people are heavy users of specific components of Facebook than others are not. It is suggested that different five basic needs degrees may be influential in the decision to use tools such as Facebook. Facebook will be studied more, because we believe that Facebook is appropriate for the current study as it is the most popular online social networking site. REFERENCES Corey, G. (March 10, 2000). Theory and Practice of Counseling and Psychotherapy (Sixth ed.). Texas: Wadsworth Publishing. Craig Ross , Emily S. Orr , Mia Sisic , Jaime M. Arseneault ,Mary G. Simmering ,R. Robert Orr “Personality and motivations associated with Facebook use” Computers in Human Behavior ,Elsevier ,Volume 25, Issue 2, March 2009, Pages 578–586. Yair Amichai-Hamburger , Gideon Vinitzky “Social network use and personality” Computers in Human Behavior , Elsevier , Volume 26, Issue 6, November 2010, Pages 1289–1295. Tiffany A. Pempek,Yevdokiya A. Yermolayeva, Sandra L. Calvert “College students' social networking experiences on Facebook” Journal of Applied Developmental Psychology, 177 Elsevier , Volume 30, Issue 3, May–June 2009, Pages 227– 238. Tracii Ryan, Sophia Xenos “Who uses Facebook? An investigation into the relationship between the Big Five, shyness, narcissism, loneliness, and Facebook usage” 2009 Fifth International Conference on Intelligent Computing — ICIC 2009 , Elsevier,Volume 27, Issue 5, September 2011, Pages 1658–1664. Khe Foon Hew “Students’ and teachers’ use of Facebook” Computers in Human Behavior, Elsevier ,Volume 27, Issue 2, March 2011, Pages 662–676. Shanyang Zhao , Sherri Grasmuck , Jason Martin “Identity construction on Facebook: Digital empowerment in anchored relationships” Computers in Human Behavior , Elsevier, Volume 24, Issue 5, September 2008, Pages 1816–1836. Paul A. Kirschner, Aryn C. Karpinski “Facebook® and academic performance” Computers in Human Behavior , Elsevier, Volume 26, Issue 6, November 2010, Pages 1237–1245. Kaveri Subrahmanyam, Stephanie M. Reich, Natalia Waechter, Guadalupe Espinoza “Online and offline social networks: Use of social networking sites by emerging adults” Journal of Applied Developmental Psychology , Elsevier , Volume 29, Issue 6, November–December 2008, Pages 420–433. Christy M.K. Cheung, Pui-Yee Chiu, Matthew K.O. Lee “Online social networks: Why do students use facebook?” Computers in Human Behavior , Elsevier, Volume 27, Issue 4, July 2011, Pages 1337–1343. 178 PENGETAHUAN TEKNOLOGI GURU CEMERLANG FIZIK Zarirah Abdul Hamid & Fatin Aliah Phang ABSTRACT Technological Pedagogical Content Knowledge (TPCK) is a new teaching model that emphasis on the importance of integration of technology, pedagogy and content knowledge to become seven domains. This research focuses on knowing the Technological Knowledge (TK) of Expert Physics Teacher. Three Expert Physics Teachers from Pasir Gudang and Johor Bahru district were selected. The research was done by entering classroom to observe teaching and learning lessons and carrying out interviews with the respondents. The research findings were analysed using thematic analysis for qualitative research. The findings show that the Technological Knowledge of Expert Physics Teacher is on moderate level. Keywords: TPCK, PTPK, Tecnological Knowledge, Expert Teacher PENGENALAN Menjelang abad ke-21 ini, kebanyakan negara maju dan membangun mula mengorak langkah melakukan perubahan dalam sistem pendidikan negara masing-masing untuk memenuhi 179 tuntutan keperluan abad ke-21. Keperluan abad ke-21 ini merangkumi penguasaan kemahiran abad ke-21 oleh para pelajar sebelum mereka melangkah ke alam pekerjaan. Kemahiran abad ke-21 yang dimaksudkan merangkumi kemahiran 3M (membaca, mengira dan menulis), kemahiran sains dan teknologi, kemahiran interpersonal dan intrapersonal dan kemahiran berkomunikasi. Malaysia tidak ketinggalan untuk bersama-sama melakukan tranformasi dalam bidang pendidikan. Misalannya, Kurikulum Bersepadu Sekolah Rendah (KBSR) telah diganti kepada Kurikulum Standard Sekolah Rendah (KSSR) di mana KSSR memberi penekanan bukan setakat kemahiran 3M tetapi kemahiran 4M (membaca, mengira, menulis dan menaakul) sejajar dengan hasrat menghasilkan individu yang mempunyai aras kemahiran berfikir yang tinggi. Bagi mencapai hasrat negara untuk membangunkan generasi yang berkemahiran abad ke-21, para pendidik mesti menjadi pakar dalam bidangnya supaya tiada miskonsepsi berlaku, mahir dalam pedagogi dan komunikasi supaya PdP berkesan dapat dilaksanakan dan sentiasa mengikuti perkembangan teknologi terkini serta menggunakannya untuk memperkenalkan kepada pelajar tentang kebaikan bidang sains, teknologi dan inovasi. Konsep mengenai penguasaan isi kandungan, pedagogi dan teknologi ini dikenali sebagai Pengetahuan Teknologi Pedagogi dan Kandungan (PTPK). PTPK merupakan satu model yang diperkenalkan oleh Mishra dan Koehler pada tahun 2006 apabila ICT mula memainkan peranan yang besar sebagai alat yang membantu meningkatkan mutu dan kualiti sistem pendidikan dunia. LATAR BELAKANG MASALAH Kebanyakan kursus pendidikan ICT yang ditawarkan kepada golongan guru lebih menumpukan kepada penguasaan kemahiran teknologi secara am dan tidak dikaitkan dengan pedagogi atau kandungan secara langsung (Graham et al., 2004; Hangrave dan Hsu, 2004; Willis dan Mehlinger, 1996). Kemahiran teknologi 180 yang diberi penekanan termasuklah cara mengendalikan perisisan komputer khususnya pemprosesan kata, hamparan data, penyimpanan data dan penggunaan internet. Ini menyebabkan timbulnya masalah di mana guru tidak tahu bagaimana untuk menggunakan teknologi dalam PdP mereka seperti yang direkodkan dalam kajian Morton (1996) dan Graham et al. (2006) Di Malaysia, masalah yang sama turut timbul di kalangan guru. Dalam satu kajian yang dijalankan oleh Mohd. Izham Mohd Hamzah dan Noraini Attan (2007) terhadap 223 orang guru Sains Sekolah Menengah Kebangsaan di daerah Hulu Langat, Selangor telah mendapati bahawa hanya 7.6% iaitu seramai 17 orang guru sahaja yang telah menggunakan teknologi sepenuhnya di dalam bilik darjah manakala 176 orang guru lain tidak yakin dengan kebolehan mereka untuk menggunakan ICT dalam proses PdP walaupun guru-guru tersebut sering menggunakan komputer atas urusan pengurusan seharian sahaja. Preston et al. (2000) menjelaskan bahawa masalah ini berlaku akibat kekurangan kemahiran guru dalam mengintegrasikan ICT dalam PdP. PENYATAAN MASALAH Secara umumnya, kajian ini dijalankan untuk mengkaji tahap penguasaan Pengetahuan Teknologi dalam kalangan Guru Cemerlang Fizik. OBJEKTIF KAJIAN Secara khususnya objektif kajian ini ialah untuk: i) Mengenalpasti pemilihan penggunaan teknologi yang digunakan oleh Guru Cemerlang Fizik bagi menyampaikan topik 3.1:Kesan magnet bagi konduktor pembawa arus. ii) Mengenalpasti sejauh mana Guru Cemerlang Fizik menguasai Pengetahuan Teknologi. 181 PERSOALAN KAJIAN Berdasarkan objektif kajian di atas, soalan-soalan kajian seperti berikut telah dibentuk: i) Apakah jenis teknologi yang dipilih oleh Guru Cemerlang Fizik bagi menyampaikan topik 3.1:Kesan magnet bagi konduktor pembawa arus dengan berkesan? ii) Apakah tahap Pengetahuan Teknologi Guru Cemerlang Fizik? KERANGKA KAJIAN Dalam kajian ini, model PTPK merupakan konsep utama yang mendukung kepada pelaksanaan objektif kajian manakala Guru Cemerlang Fizik menjadi responden dalam kajian ini. Walau bagaimanapun, penyelidik memfokuskan kepada 1 daripada 7 domain PTPK iaitu Pengetahuan Teknologi Guru Cemerlang Fizik. Rajah 1.1: Kerangka konsep kajian 182 METODOLOGI REKA BENTUK KAJIAN Dalam kajian ini, penyelidik memilih untuk menjalankan kajian menggunakan pendekatan kualititatif berbentuk kajian kes. Kajian kes dijalankan untuk mengenalpasti secara intensif tentang tren atau status semasa amalan PTPK dalam kalangan 3 orang responden yang terdiri daripada Guru Cemerlang Fizik. Dalam kajian ini penyelidik memilih pendekatan triangulasi iaitu menggunakan tiga alat pengumpulan data iaitu temubual, pemerhatian dan analisis dokumen. Dengan menggunakan pendekatan triangulasi ini, penyelidik dapat memastikan pengumpulan data daripada teknik pemerhatian dapat diterangkan dengan lebih jelas dalam sesi temubual tanpa membuat kesimpulan awal dan disokong oleh teknik analisis dokumen. Menurut Merriam (2001), penggunaan teknik pemerhatian, temubual dan analisis dokumen akan dapat memantapkan kebolehpercayaan dan kesahihan data dalam satu kajian di samping mengurangkan aspek bias semasa menganalisis data (Gall et al., 1996). Empat jenis instrumen telah dibina iaitu borang nota lapangan, senarai semak untuk pemerhatian berstruktur, protokol temubual dan borang penelitian dokumen dan artifak. Kaedah analisis kajian menggunakan analisis data kualitatif yang dicadangkan oleh Creswel (2009). Jadual 1.1 : Rekod lawatan kajian Responden Tempoh pemerhatian dan / temubual R1 PdP (Pemerhatian/rakaman audio) 80 min (2 masa) x 6 kali = 480 minit Temubual 10 minit x 4 kali = 40 minit Tarikh lawatan sekolah Mac 2014 : 30*, 3 April 2014: 2, 7* 183 R2 PdP (Pemerhatian/rakaman audio) 120 min (2 masa) x 2 kali = 240 minit 80 min (2 masa) x 4 kali = 320 minit Temubual 30 minit x 1 kali = 30 minit 5 minit x 2 kali = 10 minit R3 PdP (Pemerhatian/rakaman audio) 80 min (2 masa) x 6 kali = 480 minit Temubual 20 minit (2 masa) x 2 kali = 40 minit April 2014: 6, 10 17*,20, 24* April 2014 : 21*, 29* *tarikh temubual diadakan DAPATAN DAN PERBINCANGAN Sebanyak 5 sesi pemerhatian telah dijalankan ke atas R1, R2 dan R3 untuk topik 3.1: Kesan magnet bagi konduktor pembawa arus dan 1 sesi pemerhatian untuk topik 3.2 : Daya saling tindak antara konduktor pembawa arus dengan medan magnet. Analisis dilakukan ke atas catatan nota lapangan, transkrip temubual, senarai semak pemerhatian dan dokumen dan artifak yang digunakan dalam PdP. Tujuan analisis ini dilakukan adalah untuk melihat peranan teknologi dalam PdP Guru Cemerlang Fizik bagi topik 3.1 serta tahap penguasaan Pengetahuan Teknologi oleh Guru Cemerlang Fizik. PERANAN TEKNOLOGI DALAM PENGAJARAN DAN PEMBELAJARAN Penggunaan ICT dalam proses pengajaran bermaksud guru menggunakan ICT ketika proses PdP untuk menyampaikan maklumat kepada pelajar samada dalam bentuk persembahan atau demonstrasi manakala penggunaan ICT dalam proses pembelajaran bermaksud pelajar menggunakan ICT ketika proses PdP samada untuk mendapatkan maklumat, memproses maklumat yang telah 184 diterima atau menjalani latihan pengayaan. Teknologi dalam proses pengajaran. Penggunaan teknologi seperti ICT merupakan salah satu inovasi dalam pendidikan. Hasil kajian mendapati R1 tidak mengamalkan penggunaan teknologi secara langsung ketika mengajar topik 3.1. Teknologi hanya digunakan sebagai alat aplikasi iaitu untuk mereka bentuk modul pelajar dan mencetak modul tersebut. R2 dan R3 pula lebih aktif menggunakan teknologi dalam proses pengajaran mereka berbanding R1. Selain sebagai alat aplikasi, R2 dan R3 menggunakan teknologi sebagai alat persembahan dan alat demonstrasi. R2 menggunakan komputer riba dan interactive whiteboard(IW) dalam setiap sesi pengajaran beliau untuk memaparkan modul, nota dan latihan manakala R3 menggunakan komputer riba dan LCD projektor untuk tujuan yang sama. Semasa membuat demonstrasi cara melukis medan magnet dengan betul, R2 menggunakan pen IW dan melukis corak medan magnet menggunakan warna yang berbeza-beza untuk menunjukkan cara melukis yang betul dan kesilapan yang sering dilakukan pelajar. R3 pula menggunakan pad lakaran bersama pen pad lakaran untuk menunjukkan cara melukis corak medan magnet. Pad lakaran ini disambungkan kepada komputer riba dan dipancarkan ke layar putih di hadapan kelas. Penggunaan pad lakaran ini juga membolehkan R3 mempelbagaikan warna untuk melukis corak medan magnet. Selain itu, R2 dan R3 menggunakan animasi untuk menunjukkan aplikasi electromagnet dalam loceng elektrik. R2 dan R3 menunjukkan video ‘scrapmetal’ kepada pelajar dalam pengenalan topik 3.1. Walau bagaimanapun, R2 tidak memperdengarkan audio dalam video tersebut kepada pelajar kerana beliau sendiri yang memberi penerangan tentang video tersebut dalam Bahasa Melayu. R3 pula memperdengarkan audio yang merupakan penerangan kepada video tersebut dalam Bahasa Inggeris kepada pelajar dengan menggunakan speaker yang disambungkan kepada komputer riba beliau. 185 Teknologi dalam proses pembelajaran. Untuk proses pembelajaran, R1 tiada menggunakan apa-apa teknologi dalam membantu proses ini manakala R2 menggunakan teknologi untuk pembelajaran tutorial di mana pelajar dibenarkan mencuba soalan tutorial dalam modul Fizik yang dibekalkan oleh KPM dan menjawabnya pada IW. R2 turut menggunakan teknologi untuk membantu pembelajaran penerokaan iaitu dengan menggunakan IW, pelajar dibenarkan untuk melayari internet dan mencari bahan yang mereka mahukan untuk meningkatkan pemahaman dalam topik yang sedang dipelajari. Kebiasaannya, pelajar beliau lebih gemar mencari video-video di Youtube. R3 turut menggunakan teknologi untuk proses pembelajaran sebagai alat pemudah komunikasi. R3 sangat aktif membina laman web VLE-FROG. Pelajar boleh mengakses laman web ini untuk memuat turun nota untuk bab 3 secara softcopy, bertanyakan soalan melalui ruangan discussion board, menggunakan e-mail untuk berkomunikasi dengan R3 secara tertutup dan mencuba soalan kuiz yang telah disediakan oleh R3. Untuk lebih memudahkan pelajar, R3 menyediakan sekeping kad yang mempunyai kod bar. Pelajar hanya perlu mengimbas kod bar tersebut menggunakan telefon pintar masing-masing untuk terus akses ke laman web beliau tanpa perlu memasukkan nama laman web atau mencari di Google. R3 mengakui telah menjalankan Ujian Penilaian 1 (UP1) sekitar bulan Mac 2014 bagi mata pelajaran Fizik secara atas talian di mana pelajar diberikan tempoh masa untuk log in dalam laman web VLE-FROG dan menjawab soalan UP1. Pelajar menjawab UP1 ini di luar waktu sekolah dan menjawab soalan di bawah pengawasan ibu bapa di rumah. Menurut R3, kesemua pelajar beliau telah menduduki UP1 dengan jayanya dan beliau sangat optimistik untuk menggunakan pembelajaran atas talian ini lagi pada masa akan datang. 186 TAHAP PENGUASAAN PENGETAHUAN TEKNOLOGI (PT) GURU CEMERLANG FIZIK R1 didapati mempunyai tahap penguasaan Pengetahuan Teknologi (PT) yang rendah kerana beliau lebih gemar menggunakan bahan bantuan mengajar (BBM) yang berbentuk maujud berbanding penggunaan bahan multimedia atau teknologi. Sementara itu, R2 dan R3 mempunyai tahap penguasaan PT yang sangat baik lantaran teknologi digunakan secara optimum di dalam kelas masing-masing. Melalui temubual, penyelidik mendapati ketigatiga responden mengetahui kewujudan virtual learning environment (VLE) – FROG yang diperkenalkan oleh KPM dan penggunaan blog untuk berkongsi ilmu dan menjalankan perbincangan. Selain itu, ketiga-tiga responden turut menggunakan komputer menyiapkan tugas-tugas pengurusan guru di luar bilik darjah serta memasukkan markah peperiksaan secara atas talian (SAPS). CADANGAN Di akhir kajian, penyelidik telah mencadangkan satu model PTPK guru cemerlang yang diolah daripada model PTPK yang sedia ada dengan penambahan elemen peranan teknologi dalam PdP sebagai rujukan KPM, BPG, EPRD, JPN, PPD dan guru-guru. RUMUSAN Kajian ini merupakan satu penerokaan dalam bidang PTPK yang masih baru terutamanya dalam mata pelajaran Fizik. Keseluruhan kajian ini adalah bertujuan untuk mencungkil amalan penggunaan teknologi dalam proses PdP yang dikelolakan oleh guru cemerlang Fizik. Kajian ini menggunakan rekabentuk kajian kualitatif iaitu kajian kes di mana penyelidik membuat pemerhatian, temubual dan menganalisis artifak yang digunakan oleh guru cemerlang 187 Fizik dalam PdP mereka. Dapatan kajian menemukan beberapa kekuatan dalam amalan guru cemerlang Fizik yang perlu diberi perhatian dan dicontohi untuk meningkatkan profesionalisme profesion perguruan. Keseluruhannya, tahap pengetahuan PT Guru Cemerlang Fizik berada pada tahap sederhana. RUJUKAN Abd. Ghaffar Md. Din (2003) Prinsip amalan Pengajaran, Kuala Lumpur. Utusan Publications & Distributors Sdn Bhd. Agyei, D. D. & Voogt, J. (2011). Exploring the potential of the will, skill, tool model in Ghana: Predicting prospective and practicing teachers' use of technology.Computers & Education, 56(1), 91100. Chai, C.S., Koh, J.H.L., Tsai,C.C. & Tan, L.W.L. (2011). Modelling primary school pre-service teachers’ Technological Pedagogical Content Knowledge (TPACK) for meaningful learning with information communication technology (ICT). Computers & Education, 57(1), 1184-1193. Cox, S., & Graham, C. R. (2009). Diagramming TPACK in Practice: Using an laborated model of the TPACK framework to analyze and depict teacher knowledge. TechTrends, 53(5), 60-69. Creswell, J. W. (2007). Qualitative inquiry and research design: Choosing among five approaches. (2nd ed). Thousand Oaks, CA : Sage Muhammad Abd Hadi (2011). Pengetahuan Teknologi Pedagogi Kandungan Bakal Guru Fizik Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Tesis Sarjana, UTM. Merriam, S. B. (1998). Qualitative Research and Case Study Application in Education, Revised and Expanded from Case Study Research in Education. California: Jossey- Bass Publisher. Mohd. Izham Mohd Hamzah & Noraini Attan (2007). Tahap Kesediaan Guru Sains Dalam Penggunaan Teknologi Maklumat Berasaskan Komputer Dalam Proses Pengajaran Dan Pembelajaran. Jurnal Teknologi. 46, 45-60. Mok Soon Sang. (2008). Ilmu Pendidikan untuk KPLI (Edisi Ketiga). Kumpulan Budiman Sdn. Bhd. Lilia Halim, T. Subahan, M. Meerah & Zolkepeli Haron (2002). Strategi 188 Pengajaran Fizik Untuk G uru Sains, Selangor: Prentice Hall. Siti Hidayana Nassiri (2012). Kajian Kes Terhadap Amalan Pengetahuan Teknologi Pedagogi dan Kandungan (PTPK) Guru Fizik Johor Bahru. Tesis Sarjana, UTM. Trautmann, N., & MaKinster, J. (2010). Flexibly adaptive professional development in support of teaching science with geospatial technology. Journal of Science Teacher Education. 21(3), 351– 370. Trilling, B., & Fadel, C. (2009). 21st century skills: learning for life in our times. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass. http://www.21stcenturyskillsbook.com/index.php Tsui, A. B. (2005). Expertise in teaching: Perspectives and issues. In K.Johnson (Ed.). Expertise in second language learning and teaching, (pp 167-189). New York: Palgrave Macmillan. 189 PERSEPSI MAJIKAN TERHADAP PEKERJA BAGI INDUSTRI PEMBUATAN Chua Siew Lian & Yusri Kamin ABSTRAK Kajian ini memberi tumpuan kepada majikan dalam melihat komitmen pekerja pada abad ke 21 ini. Kajian yang dijalankan ini adalah untuk melihat persepsi majikan terhadap kriteria-kriteria komitmen pekerja dari segi tanggungjawab, kepuasan kerja, dan persekitaran tempat kerja. Kajian telah dijalankan ke atas syarikat industri perusahaan kecil dan sederhana yang melibatkan 40 orang majikan. Hasil analisis soal selidik ke atas majikan telah dapat mengenal pasti kriteria komitmen kerja yang diutamakan oleh majikan. Pemeringkatan (ranking) kriteria menerusi hasil dapatan kajian mendapati majikan yang muda dan berumur mempunyai persepsi yang berlainan terhadap kriteria komitmen kerja. Hasil dapatan kajian menunjukkan kebanyakan majikan masih tidak berpuas hati dengan komitmen pekerja. Kriteria yang dilihat oleh majikan boleh dijadikan panduan kepada pekerja yang akan memasuki alam pekerjaan. Kata Kunci: Majikan, Kriteria Komitmen Kerja, Industri Perusahaan Kecil Dan Sederhana. 190 PENGENALAN Pertumbuhan industri yang pesat membawa kepada keperluan dan permintaan terhadap pekerja. Industri hari ini telah beralih dari pengeluaran bahan-bahan mentah kepada industri pembuatan. Peralihan industri menjadi cabaran yang besar kepada pihak majikan dan pekerja. Majikan memerlukan pekerja yang profesional dan pakar bagi membina keupayaan industri. Adalah amat sukar untuk mengurus sumber manusia supaya menepati kehendak industri. Hubungan majikan dan pekerja mudah terjejas jika kedua-dua pihak tidak dapat menyesuaikan diri dengan perubahan dan keperluan baru. Dalam dunia yang semakin sempit dan perniagaan tanpa sempadan yang semakin meluas, keadaan ini menjadikan dunia industri dan pekerja semakin komplek. Kertas kerja ini akan membincangkan isu majikan dan pekerja dalam era globalisasi dan cadangan penyelesaiannya. PERNYATAAN MASALAH Pekerja merupakan aset yang penting terhadap sesebuah organisasi. Majikan memainkan peranan yang penting dalam pengekalan atau pelucutan pekerjanya. Bagi memastikan industri berada di landasan yang betul, majikan akan mengekalkan pekerja yang memenuhi jangkaan mereka. Di antara faktor yang memberi cabaran bagi industri termasuklah pengambilan dan pemilihan pekerja yang bersesuaian bagi menjamin industri di negara kita lebih kreatif serta berkemampuan bersaing di peringkat antarabangsa. Ini dijelaskan oleh pengkaji terdahulu bahawa amalan pengambilan dan pemilihan pekerja yang baik akan memberi kesan positif ke atas prestasi organisasi (Huselid, 2005, Stewart dan Knowles, 2000). Menurut Armstrong (2000), mengekalkan pekerja dapat memberikan satu anjakan paradigma kepada modal insan yang terdiri daripada pengetahuan, kemahiran dan kebolehan bagi para pekerja yang bekerja dalam organisasi. Kajian daripada Society for Human Resources Management (2006) mendapati amalan pengurusan 191 sumber manusia boleh mempengaruhi pekerja untuk meninggalkan organisasi, hilang kepuasan kerja serta komitmen kepada organisasi. Kajian daripada Neo (2008) mendapati bahawa pengurusan sumber manusia ialah satu sistem yang boleh mempengaruhi sikap, kelakuan dan juga prestasi pekerja. Oleh yang demikian, adalah wajar satu kajian dijalankan untuk mengenal pasti apakah jangkaan industri terhadap pekerja di sektor pembuatan. Ini kerana pekerja kita gagal memenuhi kehendak industri pembuatan dan industri pula mengalami masalah mendapat pekerja yang bersepadanan. Kajian ini bertujuan untuk mengkaji persepsi majikan terhadap komitmen pekerja di dalam organisasi. OBJEKTIF KAJIAN 1. 2. 3. 4. Objektif kajian ini adalah: Mengenal pasti persepsi majikan terhadap komitmen kerja mengikut demografi. Mengenal pasti persepsi majikan terhadap kriteria tanggungjawab pekerja. Mengenal pasti persepsi majikan terhadap kriteria kepuasan kerja dengan komitmen pekerja. Mengenal pasti persepsi majikan terhadap kriteria persekitaran kerja dengan komitmen kerja. PERSOALAN KAJIAN 1. 2. 3. 4. Persoalan kajian yang dibina bagi kajian ini adalah: Bagaimanakah persepsi majikan terhadap komitmen kerja pekerja mengikut demografi? Bagaimanakah persepsi majikan terhadap kriteria tanggungjawab pekerja? Bagaimanakah persepsi majikan terhadap kriteria kepuasan kerja dengan komitmen pekerja? Bagaimanakah persepsi majikan terhadap kriteria persekitaran 192 kerja dengan komitmen kerja? KAJIAN LITERATUR Kajian literatur ini membincangkan perkara-perkara berkaitan dengan keperluan organisasi bagi sektor pembuatan, jangkaan majikan dan pekerja terhadap organisasi. Menurut Hewitt (2004), keinginan pekerja untuk terus kekal dalam organisasi boleh diukur, untuk terus kekal adalah suatu cerminan yang dapat menggambarkan setiap komitmen yang diberikan oleh pekerja terhadap organisasi. Niat untuk terus kekal dapat memberikan suatu impak yang positif. Menurut Gan Siok Hoy (2011), keinginan untuk terus kekal lebih memberikan kelebihan kepada organisasi berbanding keinginan untuk meninggalkan organisasi. Majikan kurang pelaburan dari segi latihan terhadap pekerja akan membuatkan pekerja cepat berasa bosan lantas meninggalkan organisasi. Menurut Mohamad Nassruddin (2011), pembangunan kerjaya mempunyai hubungan signifikan yang positif terhadap niat pekerja untuk terus kekal. Menurut Site Nora (2011), ganjaran dari segi monetari adalah seperti imbuhan wang yang diberikan kepada pekerja manakala ganjaran bukan monetori merupakan ganjaran dalam bentuk faedah, contohnya kemudahan ataupun kepuasan kerja bagi setiap individu. Manakala Silverman (2004), menyatakan tujuan imbuhan dan ganjaran diberikan adalah untuk meningkatkan motivasi pekerja, mewujudkan suasana kerja yang efektif serta mengekalkan pekerja dalam organisasi. Abd. Rahim et. al (2006) pula mengatakan majikan memilih pekerja yang dapat menyahut cabaran globalisasi serta dapat membawa organisasi ke tahap penghasilan yang tinggi. Pernyataan ini menunjukkan bahawa penyeimbangan jangkaan majikan dan pekerja dari segi ganjaran dan imbuhan dapat memberikan hubungan yang positif kepada niat pekerja untuk kekal di organisasi. Mohd Yusuf (2011) menyatakan pekerja akan lebih memberikan komitmen terhadap kerja mereka sekiranya ganjaran yang diterima sesuai dengan sumbangan mereka. Imbuhan dan 193 ganjaran merupakan amalan yang terpenting dalam pengurusan sumber manusia kerana ia adalah faktor penentu dalam keinginan pekerja untuk terus kekal dalam organisasi ataupun meninggalkan organisasi (Arnolds and Boshoff, 2001). Namun, terdapat perbezaan ketara di antara pekerja yang dilahirkan pada tahun 1970 dengan generasi Y. Generasi Y adalah sifat yang dilabelkan kepada orang-orang yang lahir pada tahun1980an dan awal 1990-an. Menurut Fairhurst dan Shaw (2008), pekerja yang terdiri dari generasi Y sangat sukakan persekitaran yang mencabar, berkembang dengan teknologi dan bergantung kepadanya untuk menjalankan tugas-tugas mereka dengan lebih baik. Generasi Y lebih suka jadual yang fleksibel tetapi untuk generasi-generasi yang lebih tua ramai yang melihat sikap ini sebagai sikap kurang komitmen (Fairhurst & Shaw, 2008). Menurut Martin (2005), generasi Y kurang memberi respons kepada arahan berbentuk tradisional atau arahan berbentuk wujudnya kawalan dari pengurusan. Golemen (1998) menyatakan jurang akan berlaku antara golongan muda dan tua apabila tiada keserasian dari segi keperluan dan kemahuan dua golong ini. Ini sepadan dengan pendapat Devaney dan Chen (2003) yang mengatakan faktor demografi mempunyai kesan ke atas kepuasan kerja, pekerja yang lebih tua lebih cenderung untuk berpuas hati daripada pekerja yang lebih muda. Dole et. al. (2001) mengatakan kepuasan kerja sebagai perasaan dan reaksi individu terhadap lingkungan pekerjaannya. Pekerja memilih persekitaran tempat kerja yang selesa. Menurut Shikdar dan Sawaqed (2003), faktor persekitaran seperti kepanasan, kebisingan, berdebu, dan pencahayaan yang lemah dalam organisasi boleh menyebabkan kelesuan badan dan ketidakpuasan kerja. Pejabat yang inovatif mementingkan aspek akustik dan ransangan visual untuk meminimumkan masalah kesihatan yang berkaitan dengan tubuh badan (DeCroon et. al. , 2005). Leaman (1995) turut memberikan panduan bahawa pereka pejabat perlu meletakkan keutamaan terhadap suhu dan pencahayaan organisasi bagi memastikan kepuasan kerja dan meminimumkan masalah kesihatan pekerjaan. Menurut Coetzer (2006), majikan yang menyediakan persekitaran 194 pembelajaran yang kondusif dapat menyumbang kepada komitmen dan kepuasan pekerja, semakin positif dan kondusif persekitaran pembelajaran di tempat kerja, semakin komited pekerja kepada organisasi. Pembelajaran di tempat kerja merupakan faktor utama yang menyumbang kepada persaingan kompetitif organisasi (Reynolds et al., 2002). METODOLOGI KAJIAN Reka Bentuk Kajian Kajian ini menggunakan kaedah kajian deskriptif kuantitatif yang menggunakan kaedah tinjauan. Instrumen Kajian Menurut Mohamad Najib (1999), instrumen menentukan jenis data yang diperolehi dan mempengaruhi jenis analisis data. Kajian ini menggunakan soal selidik. Soalan-soalan dibahagikan kepada dua bahagian iaitu Bahagian A berkaitan demografi responden, manakala Bahagian B mengandungi 22 soalan soal selidik yang mengandungi 4 item berkaitan dengan objektif kajian. Populasi Dan Sample Kajian Responden kajian merupakan majikan dari perusahaan kecil dan sederhana (PKS) pembuatan yang berdaftar dengan SME Corporation Malaysia (SME Corp) di Johor Bahru. Penentuan jumlah sampel adalah berdasarkan penentuan saiz dan sampel Krejcie dan Morgan. Sebanyak 40 majikan dipilih secara rawak sebagai responden. Analisis Data Analisis data menggunakan peratus dan frekuensi. Perubahan 195 peratusan digunakan untuk membandingkan frekuensi dalam peratusan bagi aktiviti yang berlaku dalam satu masa yang tertentu dengan satu masa lain. DAPATAN DAN PERBINCANGAN Dapatan kajian ini merupakan hasil analisis yang telah dibuat ke atas enam jenis industri pembuatan yang terletak di sekitar Johor Bahru. Hasil kajian yang diperolehi akan dibincangkan berdasarkan persoalan kajian yang dibina dengan mengambil kira aspek demografi responden. Jadual 1: Taburan Dapatan dan Perbincangan Demografi Majikan Umur Jumlah Lelaki Perempuan 30 Tahun Ke bawah 7 orang 5 orang 12 orang 30 Tahun Ke atas 20 orang 8 orang 28 orang Jumlah 27 orang 13 orang 40 orang Berdasarkan jadual 1, pengkaji membuat analisa umur dan jantina majikan yang dikaji. Seramai 40 orang majikan yang memberi respons, di antaranya terdapat 12 orang majikan berumur di bawah 30 tahun, dan 28 orang majikan berumur 30 tahun dan ke atas. Data ini menunjukkan majoriti majikan adalah terdiri daripada mereka yang berpengalaman. Jadual 2: Taburan Persepsi Majikan Terhadap Komitmen Pekerja Majikan Tiada Komitmen Bil % (orang) Tidak Pasti Ada Komitmen Bil (orang) % Bil (orang) % 30 Tahun Ke bawah 9 22.5 2 orang 5.0 1 orang 2.5 30 Tahun Ke atas 8 20.0 0 orang 0 20 orang 50.0 17 42.5 2 5 21 52.5 Jumlah 196 Jadual 2 menunjukkan majikan berumur 30 tahun ke bawah mempunyai pandangan kriteria komitmen kerja yang berbeza dengan majikan yang berumur 30 tahun ke atas. Separuh daripada majikan yang berumur 30 tahun ke atas berpendapat pekerja mereka komited dalam kerja sementara hanya lebih kurang tiga (3%) majikan yang berumur 30 tahun ke bawah mengatakan pekerja mereka ada komitmen kerja. Keadaan ini berlaku kerana majikan yang berumur 30 tahun ke atas, mempunyai pengalaman yang lama di industri tersebut bersama pekerja mereka, komitmen pekerja adalah tinggi berdasarkan kerja yang dijalankan mengikut arahan. Majoriti majikan muda (bawah 30 tahun) menganggap pekerja mereka kurang komitmen. Kemungkinan ini disebabkan oleh sikap majikan generasi Y yang kekurangan intelektual dan emosi. Ini selaras dengan pendapat Golemen (1998) yang menyatakan mengenai jurang tersebut. Jurang akan berlaku antara golongan muda dan tua apabila tiada keserasian dari segi keperluan dan kemahuan dua golong ini. Ini sepadan dengan pendapat Devaney dan Chen (2003) yang mengatakan faktor demografi mempunyai kesan ke atas kepuasan kerja, pekerja yang lebih tua lebih cenderung untuk berpuas hati daripada pekerja yang lebih muda. Jadual 3: Taburan Persepsi Majikan Terhadap Tanggungjawab Pekerja Jadual 3 di atas menunjukkan 67.5 peratus majikan bersetuju bahawa pekerja mereka mencapai piawaian kerja, 57.5 peratus setuju pekerja mereka sedia menerima kerja diluar jangkaan dan dapat menyiapkan tugas dalam masa yang ditetapkan. Kurang separuh majikan (42.5%) menyatakan bahawa pekerja-pekerja menjalankan 197 kerja dengan penuh dedikasi. Ini selaras dengan pendapat Abd. Rahim et. al. (2006), iaitu majikan memilih pekerja yang dapat menyahut cabaran globalisasi serta dapat membawa organisasi ke tahap penghasilan yang tinggi. Walaupun terdapat 42.5 peratus majikan berpendapat pekerja mereka masih tidak dapat menyiapkan tugas dalam masa yang ditetapkan, dan 32.5 peratus daripada majikan masih mendapati pekerja mereka tidak menepati masa bekerja, namun secara keseluruhannya majoriti majikan masih berpuas hati dengan kriteria ketanggungjawaban pekerja mereka. Jadual 4: Taburan Persepsi Majikan Terhadap Kepuasan Kerja Jadual 4 menunjukkan 67.5 peratus daripada majikan bersetuju bahawa pekerja mereka bersemangat melaksanakan tugasan yang diberi, dan 65 peratus pekerja boleh menjalankan tugas mengikut kehendak industri. 57.5 peratus daripada majikan berpendapat pekerja berkebolehan mencapai prestasi yang melebihi jangkaan, mereka boleh menghadapi tekanan kerja, berpuas hati dan gembira dengan pekerjaannya. Ini selaras dengan pendapat Dole et. al. (2001) yang mengatakan kepuasan kerja sebagai perasaan dan reaksi individu terhadap lingkungan pekerjaannya. Walaupun masih terdapat 47.5 peratus pekerja yang tidak berkeyakinan menjalankan tugas yang diberi, pihak majikan tidak menganggap keadaan ini akan mengganggu perjalanan industri mereka kerana kumpulan pekerja ini merupakan pekerja baru. Namun begitu, kebanyakan majikan masih berpuas hati dengan kriteria kepuasan kerja pekerja mereka. 198 Jadual 5: Taburan Persepsi Majikan Terhadap Persekitaran Kerja Berdasarkan Jadual 5 di atas, majoriti majikan bersetuju bahawa faktor seperti persekitaran kerja, kemudahan pejabat yang lengkap, tempat kerja yang dekat dan kemudahan pengangkutan yang disediakan menjadi pilihan pekerja bekerja dengan industri terbabit. Ini selari dengan kajian yang dijalankan oleh Shikdar dan Sawaqed (2003) menunjukkan faktor persekitaran seperti kepanasan dan kebisingan, berdebu, pencahayaan menjadi faktor ketidakpuasan kerja di sektor industri pembuatan. Ini mengukuhkan bahawa faktor dapatan kajian ini menepati apa yang dijelaskan oleh Shikdar dan Sawaqed. Terdapat 92.5 peratus daripada majikan mempunyai kefahaman yang jelas tentang kebolehan pekerjanya di tempat kerja, lebih daripada 77 peratus majikan tahu bahawa pekerja mereka suka tempat kerja yang bersih. Sebanyak 55 peratus daripada majikan memberi pekerja peluang belajar sambil bekerja, ini sejajar dengan pendapat Reynolds et al. (2002) bahawa pembelajaran di tempat kerja merupakan faktor utama yang menyumbang kepada persaingan kompetitif organisasi. Oleh itu daripada analisis yang telah dijalankan jelas menunjukkan majikan memberi perhatian tentang persekitaran tempat kerja. Mereka tahu persekitaran tempat kerja akan mempengaruhi komitmen pekerja dan pembelajaran di tempat kerja merupakan satu modal pelaburan pekerja. 199 KESIMPULAN Secara kesimpulan, didapati bahawa kriteria tanggungjawab, kepuasan kerja, dan persekitaran tempat kerja amat perlu kepada pekerja. Kepuasan kerja akan mendorong pekerja lebih bermotivasi, meningkatkan produktiviti serta mengelakkan perkara-perkara yang negatif seperti malas, ponteng dan sebagainya. Keadaan kerja fizikal seperti kecerahan, suhu, kebisingan boleh mempengaruhi gelagat pekerja. Semakin efektif dan kondusif aspek persekitaran pembelajaran yang disediakan oleh organisasi untuk pembelajaran, semakin tinggi komitmen pekerja kepada organisasi. Ini dijelaskan oleh Coetzer (2006) yang mendapati bahawa persekitaran pembelajaran yang kondusif dapat menyumbang kepada komitmen dan kepuasan pekerja, semakin positif dan kondusif persekitaran pembelajaran di tempat kerja, semakin komited pekerja kepada organisasi. Hasil kajian ini menunjukkan bahawa pekerja yang diambil untuk bekerja semuanya memenuhi kriteria-kriteria permintaan majikan. Sekiranya pekerja yang bekerja tidak dapat memenuhi permintaan majikan, maka sudah tentu pekerja itu akan bertukar kerja. Menurut Gan Siok Hoy (2011), keinginan untuk terus kekal lebih memberikan kelebihan kepada organisasi berbanding keinginan untuk meninggalkan organisasi. Biasanya majikan akan memberi peluang kepada pekerjanya untuk menyesuaikan diri dengan budaya industri. Kajian ini juga menunjukkan terdapat perbezaan pendapat bagi majikan yang berumur lebih 30 tahun dan kurang. Majikan yang berumur di bawah 30 tahun memerlukan pengalaman yang lebih lama dalam industri untuk mencapai kematangan dalam mengurus tadbir pekerja di industri. Oleh yang demikian perkaitan yang kuat di dalam organisasi ini diperlukan dengan mengambil kira semua pandangan yang melibatkan majikan dan pekerja. Dengan memelihara hubungan yang harmoni di antara majikan dan pekerja dalam sesebuah organisasi akan membawa organisasi tersebut ke arah kejayaan. 200 RUJUKAN Abd. Rahim Abd. Rashid, Sufean Hussin, Abd. Jalil Othman (2006). “Hala Tuju Pengurusan Sumber Manusia dan Kerjaya”. Utusan Publication & Distributors Sdn. Bhd., K.L. 2006. Armstrong, M. (2000). Strategic Human Resources Management. A guide to action. Kagon Page Limited. Arnolds, C. A., & Boshoff, C. (2001). The Challenge of Motivating Top Management: A need Satisfaction Perspective. Journal of Industrial Psychology, 27 (1), 39-42. Coetzer, A. (2006). Employee learning in New Zealand small manufacturing firms, Employee Relations, 28 (4), 311-325. DeCroon, E. M., Sluiter, J. K., Kuijer, P. P. F. M., & Frings-Dresen, M. H. W. (2005). The effect of office concepts on worker health and performance: A systematic review of the literature. Ergonomics, 48(2), 119-134. DeVaney SA,Chen ZS (2003). Job Satisfaction of recent graduates in Financial services, US Department of Labour. Bureau of Labour Statistics, Compensation and Working Conditions Online. Dole, Carol and Schroeder, Richard G., (2001). The Impact of Varios Factors on the Personality, Job Satisfaction and Turn Over Intentions of Profesional Accountants. Managerial Auditing Journal, Vol. 16 No.4 pp 234-245 Gan Siok Hoy. (2011). HRM Practices, Job Satisfaction and Intention to Stay: A Study of Private College in Penang. Goleman, Daniel (1998), “What Makes a Leader,” Harvard Business Review, November-December, 93-102. Martin C. A. (2005) "From high maintenance to high productivity: What managers need to know about Generation Y", Industrial and Commercial Training, Vol. 37 Iss:1,pp.39-44 Hewitt Associate. (2004). Strategies for Cost Management of the HR Functions. Timely Topics Survey Result. Krejcie, R.V., & Morgan, D.W. (1970). Determining Sample Size For Research Activities. Educational and Psychological Measurement, 30: 607-610. Leaman, A. (1995). Dissatisfaction and office productivity. Facilities, 13(2), 13-19. Mohamad Najib Abdul Ghafar. (1999). “Penyelidikan Pendidikan”. Skudai: Penerbit Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. 201 Mohamad Nassruddin Ahmad. (2011). The Relationship Between Human Resources Management Practices, Employee Engagement and Intention to Stay Among Manufacturing Technicians. Mohd Yusuf Idris. (2011). The Relationship between Human Resources Practices and Intention to Quit among Executive Employees at MMC OL and Gas Engineering SDN BHD. Moses, K. (2012), Organizational learning and market performance :The interactive effect of market Orientation. Journal of Economics and International Finance, 4 (10), 226-235. Neo, R. A. (2008). Employee Training and Development. McGraw-Hill Irwin. Reynolds, J., Caley, L. and Mason, R. (2002). How Do People Learn ? London : CIPD. Silverman, M. (2004). Non-Financial Reorganization: The Most Effective of Rewards, Institute of Employment Studies. Site Nora binti Isa. (2012). The Relationship between Human Resources Practices and Employee Engagement: A case study in Nichias FGS SDN. BHD. Shikdar, A. A., & Sawaqed, N. M. (2003). Worker productivity, and occupational health and safety issues in selected industries. Computers and Industrial Engineering, 45(4), 563-572. Society for Human Resources Management (2006). 2006 U.S. Job Retention Poll Finding. Alexandria, VA: Sage Publications. Sue Shaw, David Fairhurst, (2008) "Engaging a new generation of graduates", Education+Training, Vol. 50 Iss: 5, pp.366-37 202 PEMBENTUKAN ITEM INSTRUMEN SISTEM KEPERCAYAAN YANG SALAH: SUATU KAJIAN KUALITATIF Mohd Nur Al Sufi Romele & Syed Mohammed Shafeq Syed Mansor ABSTRAK Kajian ini bertujuan membina item instrumen sistem kepercayaan yang salah. Kajian ini adalah berbentuk kualitatif dengan reka bentuk kajian yang digunakan adalah teori dibumikan "Grounded Theory" melalui analisis kandungan "Content Analysis" berdasarkan protokol temubual semi formal. Perisian Nvivo 7 digunakan bagi memudahkan menganalisis data kualitatif. Populasi bagi kajian ini kesemuanya adalah terdapat seramai 24 orang mahasiswa yang berada di tiga institusi pengajian tinggi di Malaysia dan hanya 62 orang menjadi sampel kajian. Hasil bagi kajian ini adalah item-item sistem kepercayaan yang salah yang disahkan oleh pakar. Kata Kunci: Sistem kepercayaan yang salah, Kualitatif PENGENALAN Dalam proses kaunseling, kaedah diagnosis yang terbaik adalah mengenalpasti sistem kepercayaan salah yang menyebabkan pelajar 203 tersebut menjadi tekanan akademik (Beck, 1995). Kaunselor perlu menilai sistem kepercayaan salah dengan tepat dalam membantu pelajar tersebut mendapat kesedaran terhadap sistem kepercayaan tersebut dan seterusnya mengubah sistem kepercayaan tersebut menjadi rasional dan dapat mengurangkan tekanan akademik yang dihadapi oleh pelajar tesebut (Kuyken, Kurzer, Derubeis, Beck, & Brown, 2001; Ellis, 1994). Namun begitu, jika seseorang kaunselor itu mempunyai sistem kepercayaan yang tidak tepat dan tidak rasional. Perkara ini menyebabkan kaunselor lebih cenderung mendiagnosis dan memberi saranan kepada klien berdasarkan sistem kepercayaan kaunselor itu sendiri (Blackburn & Davidson, 1995, 1996). Proses kaunseling tidak dapat dijalankan dengan lancar dan mungkin akan menyebabkan masalah klien menjadi semakin teruk dan membarah (Marof, 2001). Sistem kepercayaan merupakan suatu elemen kognitif yang wujud dalam diri manusia (Robinson & Clore, 2002). Sistem kepercayaan merupakan medium tengah bagi penyebab kecelaruan emosi khususnya masalah tekanan akademik (Eriksen, Murison, Pensgaard, & Ursin, 2005; Ursin & Eriksen, 2004, 2010). Sistem kepercayaan yang salah merupakan asas utama yang menyebabkan tekanan akademik (Chan, 2002; Mcdermut & Waga, 2003; Cook & Peterson, 2000). Asas konseptual bagi sistem kepercayaan ini adalah melalui dua teori yang amat terkenal iaitu Teori Kognitif Beck dan Teori Rasional Emotif Tingkahlaku Ellis. Kedua-dua teori ini membahaskan sistem kepercayaan dengan menggunakan istilah yang berbeza iaitu Teori Kognitif Beck menggunakan istilah “teras kepercayaan bermasalah” manakala Teori Rasional Emotif Tingkahlaku Ellis menggunakan istilah “kepercayaan tidak rasional”. Namun definisi yang diberikan oleh kedua-dua teori ini adalah hampir sama iaitu suatu perkara yang melibatkan komponen kognitif yang mempengaruhi kehidupan individu. Bagi memudahkan kefahaman, pengkaji menggunakan istilah sistem kepercayaan yang salah dalam kajian ini. Sistem kepercayaan ini dipecahkan kepada empat konstruk iaitu nilai, pendidikan, pengalaman dan sosioekonomi status (Brockman, 2003). Mahasiswa merupakan tunjang masa depan negara. 204 mahasiswa perlu kompeten dan mempu mengawal kehidupannya dengan cemerlang. Mahasiswa yang mempunyai masalah khususnya masalah tekanan akademik akan memberi kesan terhadap kehidupannya seterusnya menjejaskan perkembangan positif generasi yang akan datang. Kebanyakan masalah tekanan akademik ini berpunca daripada sistem kepercayaan yang wujud dalam diri mahasiswa itu sendiri. Kebanyakan instrument tekanan akademik sebelum ini diukur melalui faktor-faktor tekanan akademik dan simptom-simptom tekanan akademik, namun berbeza dengan instrument yang mampu mengukur tekanan akademik melalui pengesanan sistem kepercayaan yang bertindak sebagai pengukuran tekanan akademik secara mendalam terhadap diri individu berdasarkan komponen kognitif (Beck et al., 2001; Bhar et al., 2012; Canel-Cinarbas et al., 2011; Alzaeem, Azhar, Sulaiman, & Gillani, 2010; Willem Kuyken et al., 2001; Wenzel et al., 2006). Ini membuktikan bahawa suatu bentuk instrument pengesanan sistem kepercayaan perlu dibangunkan bagi memenuhi kehendak semasa yang menjadi salah satu kaedah yang efektif dalam menyelesaikan masalah tekanan akademik dalam kalangan mahasiswa di IPTA. OBJEKTIF KAJIAN Objektif kualitatif kajian bagi kajian ini adalah: i. Menengenalpasti konstruk-konstruk sistem kepercayaan salah dalam kalangan mahasiswa universiti yang mengalami tekanan akademik berdasarkan temubual dan sorotan kajian. ii. Mengenalpasti item-item yang mengukur sistem kepercayaan salah dalam kalangan mahasiswa universiti yang mengalami tekanan akademik berdasarkan temubual dan sorotan kajian. 205 PERSOALAN KAJIAN Persoalan kualitatif kajian bagi kajian ini adalah: i. Apakah konstruk-konstruk sistem kepercayaan salah dalam kalangan mahasiswa universiti yang mengalami tekanan akademik berdasarkan temubual dan sorotan kajian? ii. Apakah item-item yang mengukur sistem kepercayaan salah dalam kalangan mahasiswa universiti yang mengalami tekanan akademik berdasarkan temubual dan sorotan kajian? KEPENTINGAN KAJIAN Kajian ini adalah suatu kajian yang melibatkan elemen kognitif yang akan menjuruskan kepada masalah emosi dan tingkahlaku: 1. Kajian ini akan mendedahkan kepada masyarakat bahawa perlunya pengawalan kognitif yang positif dan rasional bagi memastikan kehidupan sentiasa dalam keadaan yang bahagia. 2. Kajian ini juga dapat membantu kaunselor atau ahli psikologi bagi mendiagnosis masalah klien dengan melihat kepada elemen kognitif klien yang boleh membawa kepada masalah emosi dan tingkah laku. 3. Pihak universiti juga boleh menggunakan hasil kajian ini untuk membentuk dan mendidik pelajar dengan mengenalpasti sistem kepercayaan yang salah dan seterusnya mengubah sistem kepercayaan tersebut kepada yang lebih rasional. 4. Para pengkaji juga boleh menjadikan kajian ini sebagai asas mengenalpasti sistem kepercayaan yang salah dalam diri manusia. METODOLOGI KAJIAN Kajian ini adalah berbentuk kualitatif dengan reka bentuk kajian yang digunakan adalah teori dibumikan "Grounded Theory" melalui analisis kandungan "Content Analysis" berdasarkan protokol 206 temubual semi formal. Perisian Nvivo 7 digunakan bagi memudahkan menganalisis data kualitatif. Sebanyak 24 responden yang dipilih sebagai sampel daripada 3 kumpulan fokus yang mana setiap kumpulan fokus mempunyai 8 orang mahasiswa. Selepas maklumat kualitatif telah dikumpulkan melalui temubual berdasarkan kumpulan fokus dan jadual spesifikasi telah dilengkapkan bagi menilai item-item yang sepatutnya dikumpulkan menjadi konstruk dalam pembentukan instrumen. Item yang dibentuk oleh pengkaji berdasarkan rujukan sorotan kajian yang bersesuaian dengan dimensi konstruk yang mengalami sedikit pengubahsuaian daripada instrumen yang sedia ada. Item-item ini diperkuatkan melalui temubual kumpulan fokus dan kupasan idea yang terhasil semasa kajian berteraskan teori dan model yang telah dipersetujuan oleh pakar- pakar yang dipilih. Kesahan Kandungan dan Muka dipastikan dengan menyemak isi kandungan item kajian yang dibentuk bersesuaian dan menepati matlamat penyelidikan yang ingin dikaji. Semakan pakar digunakan bagi memastikan ketepatan konstruk dan kejelasan isi kandungan (Kline, 2005; Hulse, 2006; Babbie, 2008). Selepas item dibina, pengkaji membuat semakan semula item melalui nilai pekali Indeks Fleiss Kappa (Cohen, 1960; Fleiss, 1971, 1981; Stemler, 1998) bagi mendapatkan nilai keboleh kepercayaan item. Pengkaji telah memilih empat orang pakar untuk menilai tahap persetujuan bagi setiap item-item yang dibina berdasarkan senarai dimensi konstruk dan item dijelaskan melalui definisi operasi. Kaedah ini merupakan kaedah menentukan kesahan dan kebolehpercayaan (Miles & Hubberman, 1994). Melalui peraturan umum yang digunapakai pada bidang sosial, nilai menunjukkan keakuran yang baik jika Kappa>0.75, manakala keakuran yang lemah adalah <0.40. Namun begitu, tafsiran nilai k juga dijelaskan seperti dibawah oleh (Landis & Koch,1977). Jadual 1: Skala Persetujuan Kappa Nilai Kappa, k Tahap Persetujuan Bawah 0.00 Sangat Lemah 0.00 - 0.20 Lemah 0.21 - 0.40 Sederhana Lemah 207 0.41 - 0.60 0.61 - 0.80 0.81 - 1.00 Sederhana Baik Sangat Baik Setelah instrumen telah disemak dari sudut kebolehpercayaan dan kesahannya, pengkaji akan membetulkan dan memperbaiki item yang tidak sesuai daripada pandangan pakar bagi dijadikan sebagai item bagi kajian seterusnya (Lodico, Spauldingn & Voegtle, 2006). Pengkaji menggunakan pandangan pakar dan nilai pekali Fleis Kappa sebagai rujukan dalam proses memperbaiki item (Yin, 2003). HASIL DAPATAN Bahagian ini membincangkan prosedur yang dilakukan bagi mengumpulkan data daripada sasaran instrumen ini digunakan iaitu mahasiswa universiti dan disahkan oleh pakar-pakar dalam bidang psikologi dan pengukuran instrumen. Peringkat pertama dalam mengumpulkan data ini, pengkaji telah membuat 3 kumpulan fokus yang mempunyai masalah tekanan akademik bagi menggumpulkan maklumat yang terkini dalam membina konstruk dan item serta dibantu oleh teori-teori dan konsep-konsep berdasarkan kajian keperluan yang telah dilakukan. Temu bual adalah salah satu kajian utama dalam kajian ini bagi mengumpulkan data. Secara keseluruhannya responden yang digunakan bagi mengumpulkan data temubual adalah sebanyak 24 orang. Pengkaji memastikan latar belakang responden adalah pelbagai dari sudut jantina, bangsa dan status kewangan keluarga. Setelah data diproses, pengkaji menyediakan set konstruk beserta item yang telah dibina berdasarkan temubual. Konstruk tersebut ialah Nilai, Pengalaman, Pendidikan dan Sosioekonomi Status. Pengkaji akan membentangkan secara terperinci bagi setiap konstruk dan item yang didapati bagi membentuk instrumen dalam kajian ini. Berikut merupakan dapatan bagi Konstruk Nilai, iaitu 10 item 208 Bil 1 2 3 4 Jadual 2: Dapatan Bagi Konstruk Nilai Melalui Temubual Item Asal Hasil Temubual Semua orang "mmm... saya rasa orang lain tak sayang saya" seharusnya (R1,K1,N Baris 10) menyayangi "sepatutnya semua orang mesti sayang saya saya"(R9,K2,N, Baris 11) "saya rasa sedih semua orang tak sayang saya"(R4,K3,N,Baris 9) Semua orang "bila saya nak sesuatu mesti tak mesti dapat"(R3,K1,N,Baris 20) memahami "saya rasa ibu bapa saya tak memahami apa yang kehendak saya saya nak"(R1,K1,N Baris 25) "semua orang tak faham saya"(R10,K3,N,Baris 23) Semua orang "ibu bapa saya selalu marah-marah kat saya, saya nak perlu sentiasa ibubapa saya cakaplah baik-baik"(R5,K1,N,Baris 17) bercakap "saya rasa tertekan bila orang meninggikan suara kat lembut saya"(R2,K2,N,Baris 16) dengan saya Semua orang "saya tidak disayangi oleh mak saya kerana lebihkan perlu perhatian kepada adik saya je"(R17,K2,N,Baris 30) memberikan "Kawan-kawan saya macam tak hiraukan saya perhatian je"(R20,K1,N,Baris 58) kepada saya "Saya nak boyfriend saya sentiasa beri perhatian pada saya"(R12,K3,N,Baris 31) 5 Orang lain seharusnya perlu sentiasa menjaga hati saya 6 Orang lain mesti mengikut apa yang saya inginkan 7 Saya mesti dapatkan apa yang saya "saya je jaga hati orang, orang lain tak jaga pun hati saya"(R14,K1,N,Baris 47) "kalu nak saya dengar kata, jagalah hati saya sikit, bukan cakap sembur je"(R11,K3,N,Baris 63) "keluarga saya lebihkan adik beradik lain berbanding saya, seolah-olah mereka tak jaga hati saya"(R19,K1,N,Baris 46) "saya nak semua orang ikut apa yang saya nak"(R21,K2,N,Baris 27) "mak ayah saya nak saya ikut dia je, kehendak saya langsung tak nak dengar"(R11,K3,N,Baris 69) "susah sangat ke nak ikut kehendak saya, saya bukan buat ape pun saya gunakan kereta ni untuk belajar gak"(R13,K2,N,Baris 19) "Apa yang saya nak, selalu tak dapat"(R23,K1,N,Baris 28) "saya tertekan dengan hidup ini, saya selalu tak dapat 209 inginkan 8 Saya berasa sedih jika orang tidak menghiraukan saya 9 Saya perlu mengelakkan situasi yang saya tidak mahukan walau apa cara sekalipun Jika ada orang saya tak suka saya bermakna saya ada masalah 10 apa yang saya nak(R12,K2,N,Baris 76) "saya dah usaha sungguh-sungguh dah tapi kenapa dak dapat result yang baik gak.(R15,K1N,Baris 41) "saya sedih sangat, saya rasa seolah-olah saya tidak dihiraukan dalam keluarga saya"(R22,K3,N,Baris 6) "saya rasa kawan-kawan saya dah tak hiraukan saya lagi, tu yang buat saya tertekan"(R13,K2,N,Baris 14) "boyfriend saya macam tak nak layan saya je, tu yang saya tak dapat fokus dalam belajar ni."(R16,K1,N,Baris 89) "kalu boleh saya nak keadaan yang berlaku mesti mengikut kehendak saya"(R24,K3,N,Baris 90) "Saya lebih suka tak buat apa-apa daripada buat letihletih tapi tak dapat apa-apa"(R18,K2,N,Baris 75) "Saya suka play safe dalam hidup saya, sebab kalu berlaku perkara yang saya tak nak saya akan cepat tertekan."(R16,K2,N,Baris 39) "saya tak tahulah kenapa orang tak suka saya, saya dah sentiasa ikut apa yang mereka nak"(R1,K2,N,Baris 16) "ramai orang tak nak kawan dengan saya sebab saya ni pendiam, tak pandai cakap dengan orang, saya rasa saya ni teruk lah"(R8,K3,N,Baris 5) Berikut merupakan dapatan bagi Konstruk Pengalaman sebanyak 9 item: Bil 15 16 Jadual 3: Dapatan Bagi Konstruk Pengalaman Melalui Temubual Item Asal Hasil Temubual Saya tidak “saya tidak suka jika saya dibandingkan dengan adik boleh beradik yang lain”(R1,K2,P,Baris 54) dibandingkan “ibu suka membandingkan keputusan ujian saya dengan adik dengan abang yang jauh lebih pandai dari beradik lain saya”(R2,K2,P,Baris 127) “saya tak suka dia tu selalu cerita tentang orang lain”(R1,K1,P,Baris 173) “mengapa ibu dan ayah suka membandingkan keputusan peperiksaan saya dengan akak saya yang pandai tu, saya bencilah”(R21,K2,P,Baris 179) Saya mesti “tidak kira apa yang jadi saya mesti menjadi pandai pandai seperti seperti abang saya”(R24,K1,P,Baris 162) adik beradik “ayah bangga dengan pencapaian saya apabila saya saya mendapat keputusan sebaik keputusan 210 17 18 19 Jika saya dalam kesusahan mesti ada orang membantu saya Saya memerlukan orang yang sayang pada saya untuk membantu saya setiap masa Saya lemah jika saya berseorangan 20 Orang lain tidak mempunyai hak untuk kritik saya 21 Jika ada orang kritik saya, kritikan tersebut adalah betul 22 Saya memerlukan orang lain untuk abang”(R20,K3,P,Baris 55) “saya mesti mendapat keputusan yang baik seperti abang dalam peperiksaan saya”(R23,K3,P,Baris 73) “bila dia susah saya selalu bantu dia, tapi bila saya susah di buat tak tahu je”(R22,K2,P,Baris 29) “saya selalu bantu orang, mesti orang lain juga akan bantu saya”(R23,K1,P,Baris 76) “saya tertekan kerana tiada orang bantu saya bila saya susah”(R24,K1,P,Baris 97) “saya perlukan teman wanita saya untuk memberi semangat pada saya”(R5,K1,P,Baris 126) “ibu saya selalu menjadi penaik semangat saya untuk mendapatkan keputusan yang terbaik dalam peperiksaan”(R10,K2,P,Baris 68) “kawan kawan saya perlu sentiasa bantu saya sebab saya kawan."(R6,K2,P,Baris 71) “hidup saya akan jadi tak tentu hala jika orang yang saya sayangi tidak ada disamping saya”(R4,K1,P,Baris 125) “saya tidak kuat untuk meneruskan hidup jika saya berseorangan”(R12,K2,P,Baris 173) “saya ada cara saya sendiri untuk menyelesaikan masalah saya”(R13,K2,P,Baris 148) “mereka tidak ada hak untuk mengkritik saya”(R15,K2,P,Baris 83) “saya adalah saya, saya ada cara tersendiri”(R8,K2,P,Baris 137) "saya memang tak pandai macam abang saya"(R11,K3,P,Baris 168) "mungkin betul mereka kata saya ni tak boleh buat kerja berkumpulan"(R5,K1,P,Baris 195) "saya terima seadanya apa yang mereka cakap"(R9,K2,P,Baris 27) “kadangkala saya tidak boleh untuk membuat keputusan sendiri jadi saya akan bertanyakan pendapat orang yang rapat dengan saya”(R11,K2,P,Baris 74) 211 membuat keputusan terbaik untuk saya 23 Lebih baik saya tidak melakukan apa-apa daripada melakukan sesuatu yang pasti akan gagal 24 Sesuatu yang berlaku mesti mengikut kehendak saya “saya selalu meminta pendapat ibu untuk membuat segala apa keputusan penting”(R14,K2,P,Baris 37) “saya tidak cukup matang untuk membuat keputusan dalam soal cinta jadi saya menanyakan kepada ibu yang lebih makan garam”(R16,K1,P,Baris 28) “saya memang tak pandai buat assignment tu"(R17,K3,P,Baris 159) “kalau awak tak yakin yang awak boleh lakukannya lebih baik awak jangan cuba kerana mungkin akan mendatangkan bahaya”(R3,K1,P,Baris 64) “saya tidak yakin dengan kemampuan diri saya yang saya mampu lakukannya jadi saya ambil keputusan untuk menangguhkannya”(R2,K2,P,Baris 139) "Saya tak pasti saya boleh buat atau tak, baik tak payah buat"(R10,K1,P,Baris 151) “saya akan berasa sedih jika apa yang berlaku dalam diri saya tidak mengikut kehendak saya”(R4,K3,P,Baris 78) “kenapa saya selalu gagal dalam percintaan”(R18,K1,P,Baris 80) Berikut merupakan dapatan bagi Konstruk Pendidikan sebanyak 9 item: Jadual 4: Dapatan Bagi Konstruk Pendidikan Melalui Temubual Bil Item Asal Hasil Temubual 27 Saya mesti “saya berpesan kepada diri saya bahawa saya akan mendapat mendapat keputusan yang membanggakan sama pencapaian seperti adik beradik yang lain”(R12,K2,PE,Baris yang bagus 132) seperti adik “saya tak pandai macam abang beradik saya saya”(R3,K3,PE,Baris 146) "saya usaha sungguh-sungguh untuk dapat result yang baik macam kakak saya.(R8,K1,PE,Baris 125) 28 Pensyarah “pensyarah saya macam tak pandai mengajar perlu je”(R16,K3,PE,Baris 43) mengajar “ramai orang gagal dalam kelas dengan baik dia”(R20,K2,PE,Baris 127) untuk saya “stres sangat dalam kelas tu, macam mana nak faham mendapat apa yang diajar”(R13,K1,PE,Baris 36) keputusan yang baik 29 Pensyarah “pensyarah saya suka marah-marah dalam perlu kelas”(R14,K3,PE,Baris 168) 212 30 31 32 33 34 35 mengajar dengan menggunakan perkataan yang lembut Saya tidak boleh belajar dengan individu yang garang Keputusan akademik yang lemah adalah punca daripada pengajaran pensyarah yang tidak bagus Pengajaran pensyarah yang tidak bagus menyebabkan keputusan akademik saya rendah Saya tidak boleh keseorangan semasa belajar jika tidak saya tidak dapat belajar dengan baik Saya cemerlang jika sentiasa mendapat keputusan yang cemerlang Pencapaian “pensyarah saya suka bercakap kasar, macam mana nak belajar kalu macam tu”(R22,K1,PE,Baris 35) “saya tak dapat fokus kalu pensyarah cakap macam tu"(R18,K2,PE,Baris 193) “saya tak leh masuk dengan orang yang suka marahmarah ni”(R24,K2,PE,Baris 146) “macam mana nak belajar pensyarah saya garang sangat"(R3,K3,PE,Baris 33) “pensyarah tu ajar tak berapa baguslah sebab tu keputusan saya teruk”(R13,K3,PE,Baris 14) “cara pengajaran pensyarah tu yang kurang bagus menyebabkan keputusan kawan-kawan saya semua dapat keputusan rendah”(R7,K1,PE,Baris 73) “pensyarah tak pandai mengajar, sebab tu susah nak faham tu”(R15,K2,PE,Baris 54) “keputusan akademik saya semakin teruk disebabkan cara pensyarah yang mengajar dengan sambil lewa”(R9,K1,PE,Baris 124) “saya sedih dengan keputusan akademik saya yang semakin menurun, sebab saya rasa pensyarah tak pandai mengajar”(R16,K3,PE,Baris 164) “belajar keseorangan bukan cara saya kerana saya tak boleh tumpukan perhatian jika berseorangan”(R10,K1,PE,Baris 64) " saya selalu study group, kalu belajar seorang tak leh masuk lah"(R21,K2,PE,Baris 87) “saya tidak dapat fokus masa belajar saya sorang"(R8,K1,PE,Baris 32) “saya dah usaha sungguh-sungguh dah, tapi result teruk gak”(R2,K2,PE,Baris 154) “macamman nak dapat kerja kalu result rendah macam ni”(R5,K3,PE,Baris 63) "Saya ni memang tak pandai, sebab tu result rendah je"(R19,K1,PE,Baris 145) “saya dapat masuk ke universiti ni nasib 213 akademik yang rendah membuktikan saya tidak layak belajar di universiti je”(R1,K3,PE,Baris 179) “sebenarnya saya tak layak masuk universiti ni, saya sebenarnya tak pandai”(R4,K1,PE,Baris 162) Berikut merupakan dapatan bagi Konstruk Sosioekonomi Status sebanyak 7 item: Jadual 5: Dapatan Bagi Konstruk Sosioekonomi Status Melalui Temubual Bil Item Asal Hasil Temubual 38 Saya perlu “jika ada wang saya akan dapat belajar dengan mempunyai baik”(R13,K3,SES,Baris 155) wang untuk “kalu tak de duit susah lah nak belajar dengan belajar”(R5,K2,SES,Baris 74) baik "kalu takde duit nak beli buku pun susah, macammana nak belajar"(R8,K1,SES,Baris 31) 39 Saya mesti “ibubapa saya nak saya belajar kat sini saya ikut je, memenuhi sebenarnya saya tak minat pun”(R3,K3,SES,Baris segala 65) perintah ibu “saya perlu belajar dengan baik kerana ibubapa bapa bagi saya”(R4,K1,SES,Baris 54) menunjukkan “saya rasa bersalah dengan ibubapa jika tidak saya anak mendapatkan keputusan yang baik cemerlang”(R9,K2,SES,Baris 141) 40 Saya mesti berkawan dengan orang yang setaraf dengan saya 41 Keputusan cemerlang bukti saya seorang anak berjasa pada keluarga Saya mesti dapat keputusan yang cemerlang 42 “saya rasa macam tak best je kawan dengan dia” (R10,K1,SES,Baris 67) “saya kena cari kawan sekepala dengan saya”(R12,K3,SES,Baris 137) “saya nak belajar kena cari kawan yang betul-betul sesuai dengan saya”(R6,K2,SES,Baris 127) “saya perlu buktikan pada ibubapa saya”(R18,K3,SES,Baris 24) “saya nak balas jasa ibubapa saya, tu saya belajar sungguh-sungguh tu”(R11,K2,SES,Baris 129) “saya nak ubah nasib keluarga saya dengan belajar sungguh-sungguh”(R1,K1,SES,Baris 61) “untuk dapat kerjaya yang baik saya perlu mendapat keputusan yang cemerlang”(R7,K3,SES,Baris 65) “saya perlu dapat keputusan yang cemerlang untuk dapatkan kerjaya impian saya”(R20,K2,SES,Baris 146) 214 43 44 bagi mendapat kerjaya yang baik Pencapaian akademik yang rendah menunjukkan saya seorang pelajar yang teruk Saya bersalah dengan ibubapa saya kerana tidak mendapat keputusan yang cemerlang “saya mempunyai akademik yang rendahn dan ia menunjukkan saya seorang pelajar yang teruk”(R16,K2,SES,Baris 52) “seorang pelajar yang teruk mempunyai pencapaian akademik yang rendah”(R17,K3,SES,Baris 173) “mengapa seorang pelajar yang teruk mempuntai akademik yang rendah ya”(R2,K3,SES,Baris 90 “saya perlu dapat keputusan cemerlang untuk membahagiakan ibubapa saya”(R4,K2,SES,Baris 139) “saya malu dengan ibu bapa saya kerana tak dapat keputusan yang cemerlang”(R21,K2,SES,Baris 15) ‘saya seorang anak tak berguna sebab tak dapat keputusan yang cemerlang”(R23,K2,SES,Baris 5) Setelah data diproses dengan membentuk konstruk dan item, pengkaji telah menyediakan set borang persetujuan pakar terhadap konstruk dan item yang dibina. Empat pakar yang terdiri daripada psikologi dan kaunseling serta pengukuran dan penilaian telah dilantik unruk menjadi interater. Tujuan penilaian ini dilakukan adalah untuk mendapatkan persetujuan dan komentar terhadap konstruk dan item yang telah dibina. Dapatan borang persetujuan pakar telah dianalisis dengan menggunakan analisis Fleiss Kappa bagi menentukan tahap indeks persetujuan (Strauss & Corbin, 1990). Hasilnya ditunjukkan dalam jadual 4 dimana tahap persetujuan Fleiss Kappa terhadap konstruk-konstruk adalah lebihi nilaian 9.0. Jadual 6: Nilai Fleiss Kappa berdasarkan Konstruk Konstruk Nilai Persetujuan Keseluruhan Nilai 0.91 Pengalaman 0.94 Pendidikan 0.97 Sosioekonomi Status 0.92 215 RUMUSAN Berdasarkan hasil dapatan yang dijalankan, pengkaji merumuskan bahawa sistem kepercayaan yang salah sentiasa wujud dalam diri seseorang yang tekanan akademik. Terdapat 35 item melalui empat konstrak dapat dihasilkan melalui kajian ini. Kontruk tersebut mempunyai kesahan kandungan yang tinggi. Konstruk tersebut ialah nilai, pengalaman, pendidikan dan sosioekonomi status. Konstruk ini merupakan hasil sistem kepercayaan yang salah. Sistem kepercayaan yang salah ini dizahirkan dengan perkataanperkataan yang umum diketahui oleh masyarakat. Kajian ini mendedahkan kepada semua bahawa sistem kepercayaan ini perlu dibetulkan dan dikenalpasti bagi membantu pelajar yang mempunyai tekanan akademik dapat diubati dan seterusnya langkah pencegahan boleh dilakukan. RUJUKAN Alzaeem, A. Y., Azhar, S., Sulaiman, S., & Gillani, S. W. (2010). Assessment of the validity and reliability for a newly developed Stres in Academic Life Scale (SALS) for pharmacy undergraduates Assessment of the validity and reliability for a newly developed Stres in Academic Life Scale ( SALS ) for pharmacy underg. International Journal of Collaborative Research on Internal Medicine & Public Health, 2(7), 239–256. Brockman, D. D.(2003). From late adolescence to young adulthood. Madison CT: International Universities Press. Beck, A. T. (1967). Depression: Clinical, ex- perimental, and theoretical aspects. New York: Hoeber. Beck, J. S. (1995). Cognitive therapy: Basics and beyond. New York: The Guilford Press. Blackburn. I. M. dan Davidson. K. (1995) Cognitive Therapy for Depression and Anxiety, 2nd edition. Oxford: Blackwell Scientific Publications. Blackburn. I. M. dan Twaddle. V. (1996) Cognitive Therapy in Action. London: Souvenir Press. 216 Beck, A T., Butler, A C., Brown, G. K., Dahlsgaard, K. K., Newman, C. F., & Beck, J. S. (2001). Dysfunctional beliefs discriminate personality disorders. Behaviour research and therapy, 39(10), 1213– 25. Retrieved from http://www.ncbi.nlm.nih.gov/pubmed/11579990 Bhar, S. S., Beck, A. T., & Butler, A. C. (2012). Beliefs and personality disorders: an overview of the personality beliefs questionnaire. Journal of clinical psychology, 68(1), 88–100. doi:10.1002/jclp.20856 Babbie, E. (2008). The Basic Of Sosial Research. Australia: Thomsom Wads Worth. Cohen, J. (1960). A Coeffisient for agreement for nominal scales. Educational & Psychological Measurement, 37-46. Cohen, P.W. (2002). The Irrational Beliefs Test cognitive behavioral Traits and depression. Journal of rational emotive Therapy,13, 9-27. Cook, N., & Peterson, Canel-Cinarbas, D., Cui, Y., & Lauridsen, E. (2011). Cross-Cultural Validation of the Beck Depression Inventory-II Across U.S. and Turkish Samples. Measurement and Evaluation in Counseling and Development, 44(2), 77–91. doi:10.1177/0748175611400289 Ellis. A. (1994) Reason and Emotion in Psychotherapy, 2nd Edition. New York: Birch Lanae Press Ellis, A. (1994). Reason and emotion in psychotherapy: A comprehensive method of treating human disturbances. New York: Birch Lane Press. Eriksen, Hege R, Murison, R., Pensgaard, A. M., & Ursin, H. (2005). Cognitive activation theory of stres (CATS): from fish brains to the Olympics. Psychoneuroendocrinology, 30(10), 933–8. doi:10.1016/j.psyneuen.2005.04.013 Fleiss, J.L.(1981). Statistical Methods for rates and proportions (2nd Ed.). New York: John Wiley Hulse, S.F. (2006). Test Statistics. Instructional Techniques. 61 (2). Kuyken, W, Fothergill, C., Musa, M., & Chadwick, P. (2005). The reliability and quality of cognitive case formulation. Behaviour Research and Therapy, 43(9), 1187–1201. doi:10.1016/j.brat.2004.08.007 Kuyken, Willem, Kurzer, N., Derubeis, R. J., Beck, A. T., & Brown, G. K. (2001). Response to Cognitive Therapy in Depression The Role of Maladaptive Beliefs and Personality Disorders. Journal of Consulting and Clinical Psychology, 69(3), 560–566. 217 Kline, T. (2005). Psychological Testing: A Practical Approach to Design and Evaluation. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage Publications Inc. Lodico, M. G, Spaulding, D. T. dan Voegtle, K.H. (2006). Methods In Educational Research. From Theory to Practice. San Francisco, California: Jossey-Bass. AWiley Imprint. Lowenthal, K.M. (2001). An Introduction to Psychological Tests and Scales. 2nd ed. University of London: Psychology Press. Landis, J. & Kosh, G.G. (1977). The Measurement of Observer Agreement for Categorical Data. Biometrics,33: 159-174. Mcdermut, J., &Waga D. (2003). Cognitive bias and irrational beliefs in major depression and dyshoria. Journal cognitive therapy and research, 27, 9-470. Miles, M.N.& Hubberman, A.M. (1994). Qualitative Data Analysis. Baverly Hills, C.A.: Sage Publication. Robinson, M.D.,& Clore,G. L. (2002). Belief and feeling: Evidence for an accessibility model of emotional self-report. Psychological Bulletin, 128, 934-960. Ursin, H., & Eriksen, H. R. (2004). The cognitive activation theory of stres. Psychoneuroendocrinology, 29(5), 567–92. doi:10.1016/S0306-4530(03)00091-X Ursin, H., & Eriksen, H. R. (2010). Cognitive activation theory of stres (CATS). Neuroscience and biobehavioral reviews, 34(6), 877–81. doi:10.1016/j.neubiorev.2009.03.001 Wenzel, A., Sharp, I. R., Brown, G. K., Greenberg, R. L., & Beck, A. T. (2006). Dysfunctional beliefs in panic disorder: The Panic Belief Inventory. Behaviour research and therapy, 44(6), 819–33. doi:10.1016/j.brat.2005.06.001 Yin, K.R. (2003). Case Study Research. Design and Method. 2nd Ed. London: SAGE Publications. 218 PENERAPAN NILAI MURNI DALAM MENGATASI MASALAH DISIPLIN DI INSTITUSI PENDIDIKAN BERASASKAN KEMAHIRAN Nor Aishah Abdul Aziz & Mohd Zolkifli Abd Hamid ABSTRACT Disciplinary problems among teenagers is not something strange in the world of education, particularly at the school level. However, these problems will be a major problem to the country in general when it extends to the tertiary level. Attitudes and family background are among the factors that contributed to the disciplinary problems. Moreover, this problem might persist in the working environment which will give negative impact to employers and company as well. Therefore, it is important for educators to take initiatives in implementing good values especially during Teaching and Learning process to students in order to reduce disciplinary problems. What matters is that, students should equip themselves with good values and are able to serve well wherever they are. This paper discusses the disciplinary problems in skill-based educational institutions. A few case studies will be presented to see the real problems that occur in these institutions. Models of inculcation of values will be presented as a guideline for educators to educate students to adopt a better way of 218 219 life, therefore became citizens who can practise good manners and well disciplined to serve the country and also to make their lives even better in all aspects of field. Keywords : Disciplinary Problems, Good Values PENGENALAN Menurut Hashim et al (2008) keruntuhan akhlak dalam kalangan remaja pada hari ini akan memberikan kesan dan impak yang begitu besar dalam masyarakat. Remaja merupakan aset utama negara pada masa akan datang serta memainkan peranan yang sangat penting dalam pembangunan negara. Kesan jangka panjang dan jangka pendek pasti akan berlaku seandainya remaja pada hari ini tidak tahu bagaimana untuk membentuk dan memuliakan akhlak mereka. Akhlak merupakan peribadi dan cermin diri bagi seseorang individu. Kiranya individu itu mempunyai akhlak yang buruk, maka secara automatiknya peribadi individu itu juga akan menjadi buruk. Remaja yang mempunyai akhlak yang buruk boleh memberi kesan kepada diri sendiri, keluarga, masyarakat dan negara. Keruntuhan akhlak berlarutan hingga menyebabkan berlakunya banyak masalah disiplin di pusat-pusat pengajian tinggi seperti ponteng kuliah, tidak menyiapkan tugasan yang diberi, sambil lewa dalam pembelajaran, berhibur sehingga mengabaikan tanggung jawab mereka terhadap pelajaran . DILEMA MASALAH DISIPLIN DI IPT Zainuddin, Zuria dan Salleh (2008) menyatakan ,kehidupan di Institusi Pengajian Tinggi (IPT) dan kolej memberikan peluang kepada pelajar untuk menjadi individu yang berdikari. Pelajarpelajar kolej atau mahasiswa universiti yang berada dalam posisi awal dewasa ini mendapat kebebasan bertindak dan perlu 219 220 bertanggung jawab dalam banyak aspek kehidupan. Antara tanggung jawab ini termasuklah membuat keputusan kerjaya, memilih rakan, membina hubungan intim dengan berlainan jantina, menjaga keselamatan dan kesihatan diri, mengurus masa dan kewangan, serta melakukan inisiatif-inisiatif yang menentukan kejayaan masa depan mereka Zuria, Noria Menurut Zainuddin, Zuria dan Salleh (2008) lagi, kebebasan yang mereka perolehi telah di salah gunakan. Kesibukan melayan pasangan berlainan jantina dan juga perasaan sendiri menyebabkan mereka membuang masa, leka dan tidak menjalankan tanggungjawab sebagai pelajar seperti menumpu perhatian semasa belajar, mengambil bahagian dalam kelas, menyiapkan tugasan, bersedia untuk peperiksaan mahupun berinteraksi dengan pensyarah. Seterusnya menurut Zainal & Mohd. Sharani (2004), selain daripada itu, cinta yang tidak terurus mengakibatkan kebanyakan pelajar mengalami kegagalan dalam pelajaran. Apabila percintaan putus di tengah jalan, mereka akan mengalami gangguan emosi yang hebat sehingga berlaku kemurungan dan merosot pelajaran Seterusnya Zainuddin, Zuria dan Salleh (2008) menyatakan, media tempatan juga sering melaporkan masalah yang ditimbulkan oleh pelajar-pelajar IPT (Berita Harian 18 Ogos 2003; Utusan Malaysia 3 Jun 2002; Utusan Malaysia 18 Januari 2003). Laporan media mengenai peningkatan masalah sosial pelajar IPT seperti kes khalwat sedikit sebanyak telah memberi gambaran buruk kepada institusi berkenaan. Berita Harian (18 Ogos 2003) telah melaporkan Jabatan Agama Islam Selangor (JAIS) telah menangkap pelajar-pelajar IPT seramai 341 orang sepanjang 2002 dan 178 orang sepanjang 2003 kerana kesalahan perbuatan tidak bermoral. Kesalahan-kesalahan ini termasuklah berkhalwat dan berkelakuan tidak sopan di tempat awam. Menurut penulis lagi, pelajar-pelajar yang terlibat ialah dari beberapa institusi pengajian tinggi awam dan swasta. Masalah sosial pelajar IPT yang berkaitan dengan khalwat dan perlakuan tidak sopan di tempat awam merupakan masalah yang dihadapi oleh semua institusi pengajian tinggi awam (IPTA) seluruh negara. 220 221 AKTA MENANGANI SALAH-LAKU PELAJAR Menurut Zaharah (2006), setiap institusi pengajian tinggi dipercayai mempunyai definisi tersendiri mengenai masalah disiplin atau salah laku. Beberapa tingkahlaku tertentu turut dimuatkan dalam AUKU seperti dalam: Kaedah 15: Judi dalam kampus, kaedah 16: mabuk, kaedah17: bahan-bahan lucah, dan kaedah 18:dadah dan racun) Tambahnya lagi, secara umumnya, salah laku (seperti yang dikategorikan oleh Western Michigan University Code of Honour) boleh dibahagikan kepada dua jenis:(i) salah laku akademik (academic misconduct), yang bermaksud pelanggaran peraturan yang membabitkan integriti, polisi, dan prosedur akademik. (ii) salah laku bukan akademik, ialah pelanggaran peraturan yang boleh mengancam kesihatan, keselamatan, dan harta warga universiti. Sesetengah perlakuan adalah salah di dalam kawasan universiti tetapi tidak salah jika dilakukan di luar kampus. Contohnya, kebanyakan IPTA telah mewartakan bahawa kampus adalah kawasan larangan merokok. Perbuatan tersebut walau bagaimanapun tidak salah dilakukan di luar kampus. Sesetengah perlakuan pula berada di luar bidang kuasa kolej/universiti untuk mengambil tindakan seperti kes pelajar terlibat dalam kegiatan haram. Hanya pihak berkuasa yang boleh menahan pelajar terbabit dan bidang kuasa kolej/universiti kebiasaannya terhad kepada mengenakan tindakan tata tertib. Terdapat pula salah laku yang mungkin sukar ditentukan oleh Akta tentang salah dan betulnya tetapi agama dan norma masyarakat telah menentukan salah atau betulnya sesuatu perbuatan tersebut. Contohnya, mahasiswa mengunjugi kelabkelab malam dan berpeleseran mungkin diterima oleh sesetengah golongan tetapi ajaran agama dan majority masyarakat menganggapnya sebagai bertentangan dengan nilai-nilai akhlak dan norma sosial yang boleh mengundang kepada gejala yang lebih tidak sihat, seterusnya meruntuhkan akhlak pelajar terbabit. 221 222 Walau apa sekali akta yang diguna pakai di kolej dan juga universiti, apa yang penting adalah perlaksanaan untuk mendidik pelajar ke arah kebaikan yang perlu diberi perhatian serius oleh para pendidik. Aspek ini sangat penting dalam menentukan hala tuju sebenar hidup pelajar khususnya, serta masyarakat dan Negara amnya, seterusnya dapat melahirkan warga Negara yang bertanggung jawab dalam setiap apa yang mereka lakukan . SENARAI INSTITUSI PENGAJIAN TINGGI BERASASKAN KEMAHIRAN Malaysia yang sedang menuju ke arah negara maju menjelang tahun 2020 tidak dapat mengelak daripada memberikan tumpuan kepada aspek-aspek membekalkan kemahiran fizikal kepada warga negaranya. Antara usaha dinamik yang dilakukan adalah mengadakan pusat-pusat dan institusi-institusi berasaskan kemahiran bagi tujan mendapatkan kemahiran yang lebih sistematik dalam bentuk pendidikan formal. Sehubungan dengan itu, maka wujudlah beberapa institusi yang berkaitan bagi menampung keperluan Negara ini. Antara institusi kemahiran yang terkenal adalah: 1. Pusat Giat MARA 2. Pusat Institut Latihan Perindustrian (ILP) 3. Institut Kemahiran Belia Negara (IKBN) 4. Institut Kemahiran MARA (IKM) 5. Kolej Komuniti Institusi pendidikan berasaskan kemahiran di atas kebanyakannya menawarkan kursus-kursus berbentuk “hands-on” untuk membekalkan kemahiran terutamanya kepada remaja yang tidak dapat melanjutkan pengajian ke IPTA samada di peringkat sijil mahu pun diploma. Walau bagaimana pun,peranan institusi berkenaan haruslah juga selaras dengan matlamat pendidikan Negara iaitu untuk melahirkan warga Negara yang seimbang daripada segi pembangunan jasmani, emosi, ruh, intelek dan social (JERIS). Para pelajar seharusnya dididik bukan sahaja daripada 222 223 segi kemahiran fizikal bahkan mestilah stabil emosi dan rohaninya. Mereka boleh bekerja dalam bidang kemahiran tetapi dalam masa yang sama mengamalkan sifat-sifat terpuji seperti jujur, amanah, rajin, sopan-santun, bersyukur serta menghormati orang lain. Walau bagaimana pun amat besar cabarannya dalam mendidik para remaja yang baru melepasi alam persekolahan. Sikap negatif di sekolah masih terbawa-bawa hingga ke peringkat pengajian yang lebih tinggi. KAJIAN KES MASALAH DISIPLIN DI IPT Sejauh mana pun kita mengejar kemajuan, permasalahan disiplin remaja dan penyelesaiannya tetap menjadi isu-isu yang perlu ditangani oleh pihak-pihak yang terbabit khususnya dalam bidang pendidikan. Berikut adalah beberapa kes yang dikenal pasti melalui kajian-kajian yang dilakukan oleh penyeldidik untuk menghayati masalah disiplin pelajar di isnstitusi-institusi pendidikan berasaskan kemahiran. Kajian berkenaan Faktor-Faktor Yang Mempengaruhi Masalah Ponteng Kelas Dalam Kalangan Pelajar Di Kolej Kemahiran Belia Nasional, Pontian oleh Yahya B. Buntat dan Norainiza Bt Saini, Fakulti Pendidikan, Universiti Teknologi Malaysia Dalam kajian 1.3.1, keputusan menunjukkan bahawa sikap pelajar merupakan faktor utama dalam mempengaruhi masalah ponteng iaitu sebanyak 76.8%, Ini menunjukkan bahawa terdapat sikap negatif yang ada pada diri pelatih tersebut telah mendorong mereka untuk melakukan ponteng. Punca pelajar ini sering lewat ke kelas kerana sikap mereka yang tidak pandai menguruskan masa. Mereka sering lewat bangun pagi dan mengambil masa untuk menyiapkan diri untuk pergi ke kelas. Oleh yang demikian mereka gagal untuk menghadirkan diri pada waktu pertama sesi pembelajaran. Sikap ini adalah tidak wajar bagi pelajar yang menjalankan latihan di pusat kemahiran ini kerana mereka tidak menitikberatkan disiplin dalam diri mereka. Secara keseluruhanya aspek rakan sebaya turut mempengaruhi 223 224 pelajar untuk melakukan peratus yang paling tinggi iaitu sebanyak 89.2% di mana pelajar tidak akan hadir ke kelas kerana sering dibuli oleh pelajar yang lain.Tenaga pengajar yang tidak kreatif dan tanpa bantuan penggunaan bahan yang menarik mengakibatkan pelajar kurang menumpukan perhatian dan sekaligus mengelak untuk menghadiri kelas tersebut. Melalui kajian ini juga, pengkaji mendapati bahawa responden tidak membuat persediaan awal sebelum kelas berlangsung sehingga mereka tidak tahu apa yang perlu dilakukan semasa berada di kelas ataupun di bengkel. Jika mereka tidak dapat menyiapkan tugas yang terdahulu mereka mengambil langkah mudah dengan tidak menghadirkan diri ke kelas tersebut. Pelajar-pelajar di pusat kemahiran ini juga melakukan ponteng apabila dipengaruhi oleh rakan sebaya. Hasil dapatan kajian menunjukkan purata peratus keseluruhan adalah sebanyak 74.3%. Di dapati bahawa terdapat rakan yang selalu mempengaruhi pelajar untuk tidak menghadirkan diri ke dalam kelas dengan alasan ianya tidak menyeronokkan. Kajian Punca, Risiko dan Sumbangan Tabiat Merokok Terhadap Penagihan Bahan-Kajian di Pusat Giat MARA, Terengganu oleh Roslee Ahmad dan Mohamed Sharif Mustaffa, Jabatan Asas Pendidikan, Fakulti Pendidikan, Universiti Teknologi Malaysia, Skudai Responden terdiri daripada 73 orang pelatih dalam kajian ini. Pengkaji menganalisis data dengan menggunakan kaedah deskriptif iaitu peratusan. Dapatan turut menunjukkan 53.43% responden menyatakan punca merokok di sebabkan oleh hubungan sosial. Kajian rintis melalui temu bual ke atas dua orang tenaga penajar di Institut Kemahiran MARA, Johor Bahru oleh Nor Aishah Abdul Aziz, Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Pengajar 1: Beliau mengatakan terdapat banyak contengan di tanggatangga bangunan, tandas sehingga terpaksa dicat semula. 224 225 Walaupun telah beberapa kali diberi amaran tetapi insiden tersebut masih berlaku. Terdapat juga satu kes penyeludupan dadah ke kolej. Pihak kolej berjaya menangkap pelajar terbabit. Ibubapa pelajar dipanggil dan mereka merayu supaya anak mereka tidak dibuang kolej. Walau bagaimanapun, kolej tetap bertindak tegas membuang pelajar tersebut sebagai pengajaran dan peringatan kepada pelajar-pelajar lain. Hampir 50 peratus pelajar mempunyai masalah kedatangan kelas yang lambat membuatkan pengajar sering terpaksa memarahi pelajar. Pengajar 2: Beliau mengatakan masalah menghisap rokok telah menjadi amalan biasa di kolej, di belakang tandas, belakang bilik kuliah, di luar pagar kolej dan seumpamanya. Beliau menasihati pelajar mengikut pengalaman peribadi sahaja tanpa sebarang panduan yang jelas namun ianya kurang berkesan. Berkenaan dengan nilai murni pula, beliau kurang jelas dengan isi kandungannya kerana tiada kursus tertentu berkenaan perkara tersebut. Beliau juga tidak tahu secara spesifik tentang elemen nilai murni serta tidak pernah mendengar berkenaan Falsafah Pendidikan Kebangsaan. Beliau amat mengharapkan agar kursus-kursus tertentu dilaksanakan sebagai garis panduan menangani masalah pelajar. Berdasarkan kepada sesi-sesi temubual yang telah dijalankan oleh penyelidik ke atas responden dalam kajian rintis, jelas sekali krisis nilai sememangnya wujud dalam kalangan pelajar-pelajar yang mengikuti kursus-kursus kemahiran. Kedua-dua responden menyatakan kesukaran mereka untuk mengatasi masalah disiplin pelajar tersebut. Semua responden menyatakan mereka perlu kepada satu kaedah yang berkesan untuk mengubah tingkah-laku pelajar agar lebih bertanggungjawab dan berdisiplin ketika menjalani kursus. Responden juga tidak mengetahui apa maknanya nilai murni dalam pengajaran. Melalui ketiga-tiga kes yang diutarakan, jelas bahawa memang terdapat masalah disiplin yang agak serius di peringkat pengajian tinggi atau lepasan sekolah. Para pendidik menghadapi zaman 225 226 yang serba mencabar untuk menangani pelbagai jenis masalah remaja yang pelbagai ragam. MODEL PENERAPAN NILAI MURNI Model-model serta pendekatan penerapan nilai di Malaysia telah dibangunkan serta disebar luas agar para pendidik mempunyai pelbagai pilihan yang bersesuaian dengan suasana proses Pengajaran dan Pembelajaran Model Edaran Semula-Konsep Pendidikan Bersepadu Rajah 1 Model Edaran Semula – Konsep Pendidikan Bersepadu (Sumber: Tajul Arifin, 1988) Antara model lain yang juga menekankan aspek pendidikan bersepadu adalah Model Edaran Semula oleh Tajul Ariffin (1988). Model tersebut adalah Model Edaran Semula – Konsep Pendidikan Bersepadu oleh Tajul Ariffin (1988) berasaskan keimanan kepada Allah SWT (Rajah 2). Model ini menjadikan pembinaan insan mulia melalui keimanan kepada Allah SWT sebagai teras pembentukan individu berakhlak mulia sehingga terhasilnya masyarakat yang cemerlang melalui pendidikan holistik. Ketigatiga aspek tersebut iaitu pembinaan diri, kesyukuran kepada Allah dan pembinaan tamadun ummah yang gemilang perlulah dihayati 226 227 serta dijadikan satu proses yang berterusan dalam system pendidikan Negara. Selanjutnya, aspek tersebut juga menjadi bahan untuk diterapkan oleh pendidik ke dalam proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran samada di peringkat pendidikan awal sehinggalah ke pendidikan tinggi. Model Kurikulum paradigm Bersepadu Rajah 2: Kurikulum mengikut paradigma bersepadu termasuk unsur spiritual- kesepaduan ilmu agama (teras) dengan ilmu sains kemanusiaan dan sains tabii (Sumber: Tajul Ariffin dan Noraini, 2002) 227 228 Model Konseptual Pendidikan Guru DPM-Kementerian Pelajaran Rajah 3: Model Pendidikan Guru UTM Bakar, et al, 2001). (Sumber: Abu Rajah 3 pula menunjukkan Model Konseptual Pendidikan Guru DPM-Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia yang menekankan dimensi Ketuhanan dalam pendidikan guru adalah usaha membentuk guru dengan akhlak dan budi pekerti mulia, sentiasa mencari ilmu, menghayati tanggungjawab dan akauntabiliti guru. Guru-guru yang ingin dilahirkan adalah mereka yang memiliki dan menguasai aspek rohani dan jasmani yang seimbang serta mampu memikul tanggungjawab untuk melahirkan masyarakat yang bersatu padu, demokratik, progresif serta memiliki akhlak KESIMPULAN Matlamat akhir pendidikan adalah membina insan. Ini bermaksud pendidik haruslah memainkan peranan menerapkan nilai murni berasaskan akhlak mulia kepada pelajar untuk mencapai matlamat tersebut. Para ilmuan barat juga mengakui kepentingan nilai dalam 228 229 pendidikan dan kehidupan. Cuma cara pendekatan mereka adalah berbeza berbanding dengan pendekatan pendidikan Malaysia. Ini kerana pendidikan di Malaysia menekankan falsafah pendidikan berasaskan kepada kepercayaan dan keyakinan kepada Tuhan dan pembangunan insan secara seimbang. Falsafah tersebut perlu difahami dan dipraktikkan oleh seluruh pendidik supaya pendidikan di Malaysia Berjaya menjadi alat perubahan kepada masyarakat yang lebih sejahtera kepada dunia secara global. RUJUKAN Abdul Jalil Aslam (2002). Terjemahan Shahih Muslim. Jilid 1,2,3 dan 4. Terjemahan Al Imam Muslim, Singapura : Darel Fajar Publishing House. Abu Bakar Hashim, Mohd Tajudin Ninggal, Hazil Abd Hamid, Esah Sulaiman, Yusof Boon (2001) Konsep dan Model Pendidikan Guru dalam Horizon Pendidikan. Fakulti Pendidikan,Universiti Teknologi Malaysia: Skudai. Muka surat:13-16 Artikel (1998). Kajian Sistem Pendidikan Kebangsaan (MTT 2353). Tinjauan Mengenai Cabaran-cabaran Pendidikan Vokasional Di Malaysia.diambil 15 Ogos 2012 dari http://sarjana.tripod.com/vokasional1.html Mohd Kamal Hassan (1988). Pendidikan Dan Pembangunan- Satu Perspektif Bersepadu’. Nurin Enterprise: Kuala Lumpur Rosnani Hashim (1998). Kajian Keberkesanan Pengajaran dan Pembelajaran Dalam Penyerapan Nilai-nilai Murni Dalam KBSM. Kuala Lumpur: Embun Muhibbah Sdn Bhd Shahrin Awaludin (2001) Pendidikan Teknikal dan Vokasional Di sekolah-sekolah Agama Di Malaysia. Dalam jurnal Technology And Vocational Technical Education: Globalisation And Future Trends. Edisi 1, Universiti Kebangsaan Malaysia: Bangi Tajul Ariffin Noordin (1988). Konsep Asas Pendidikan Sepadu. Kuala Lumpur : Nurin Enterprise. Tajul Ariffin (1998) “Falsafah Pendidikan Negara: Satu Reformasi Pembangunan Manusia Abad Ke 21. Prosiding Isu-Isu Pendidikan Negara, Universiti Kebangsaan Malaysia: Bangi Tajul Ariffin Noordin dan Nor Aini Dan (2002). “Paradigma Pendidikan 229 230 Bersepadu Perkembangan Dua Dekad”. dalam Prosiding Pendidikan dan Pembangunan Manusia Bangi : Universiti Kebangsaan Malaysia.(muka surat 1-6). Zahid Daim dan Shahnazim Shahar Sistem Pendidikan Kebangsaan (MTT2353) - Peranan Dan Implikasi Institut pengajian Tinggi Swasta (IPTS) Kepada Perkembangan Pendidikan Negara. Diambil 15 Ogos 2010 dari http://sarjana.tripod.com/ipts3.html Hashim bin Haji Bedu, Khairulhelmi bin Katip, Mohd Fahmi bin Mohd Sahid, Syed Mohamed Syafeq Syed Mansor(2008) Keruntuhan Akhlak dan Gejala Sosial Dalam Keluarga; Isu dan Cabaran dalam Seminar Kaunseling Keluarga 2008 file:///D:/BACKUPC/PHD/PROPOSAL/CONTOH TESIS MASALAH DISIPLIN/ABU SIRR KERUNTUHAN AKHLAK DAN GEJALA SOSIAL DALAM KELUARGA ISU DAN CABARAN.html Melati Sumari dan Zaharah Hussin(2006) Cabaran IPT Dalam Menangani Salah Laku dan Kepincangan Akhlak Mahasiswa: Tinjauan dan Cadangan. Fakulti Pendidikan Universiti Malaya. Di NASDEC 2006 Conference Western Michigan University, USA http://r.search.yahoo.com/_ylt=A2oKmJGSPU9U43cAllzjPwx.; _ylu=X3oDMTE0Nm1uNDRjBHNlYwNzcgRwb3MDMQRjb2 xvA3NnMwR2dGlkA01TWU1ZQzFfMQ-/RV=2/RE=1414508050/RO=10/RU=http%3a%2f%2feprints.ut m.my%2f510%2f1%2fMelatiSumari2006_Cabaraniptdalammen anganisalah.PDF/RK=0/RS=Im.5EawVKsmxwDGOXwRNY0R Q1Qw-Dimuat turun pada 28 Oktober 2014 Yahya B. Buntat & Norainiza Bt Saini Faktor-Faktor Yang Mempengaruhi Masalah Ponteng Kelas Di Kalangan Pelajar Di Kolej Kemahiran Belia Nasional, Pontian Fakulti Pendidikan Universiti Teknologi MalaysiaPunca, Risiko dan Sumbangan Tabiat Merokok Terhadap Penagihan bahan: Kajian Pusat Giat MARA. Jabatan Asas Pendidikan, Fakulti Pendidikan,, Universiti Teknologi Malaysia, Skudai https://www.academia.edu/login?cp=/attachments/2694043/dow nload_file&cs=www Dimuat turun pada 26 Oktober 2014 Zainuddin Abu, and Zuria Mahmud, and Salleh Amat, (2008) Pendekatan kaunseling menangani masalah kebebasan dalam kalangan pelajar institut pengajian tinggi: dua kajian kes. Jurnal 230 231 Pendidikan Malaysia, 33 . pp. 107-123. http://journalarticle.ukm.my/206/ Zainal Madon & Mohd Sharani Ahmad. 2004. Panduan mengurus remaja moden. Batu Caves: PTS Publications and Distributors Sdn. Bhd. file:///D:/BACKUP%20C/PHD/PROPOSAL/CONTOH%20TES IS%20MASALAH%20DISIPLIN/Mat%20Yusoff%20Che%20 Mat-.htm Dimuat turun pada 26 Oktober 2014 231 232 GENERIC EMPLOYABILITY SKILLS INTEGRATION IN TECHNICAL AND VOCATIONAL EDUCATION CURRICULUM: A REQUIREMENT FOR THE PREPARATION 21ST CENTURY WORKFORCE Azlan Abdul Latib & Muhammad Muhammad Inti ABSTRACT Traditionally, Technical and Vocational Education is geared towards the development of technical content knowledge and skills. However, due to globalization, emergence of new technologies and shift to knowledge based economy, employers of labour are demanding for graduates that possesses generic employability skills in addition to their traditional content knowledge and skills in order to meet up with the changing needs of the 21st century workplace environment. Today, Technical and Vocational Education is expected to equip graduates with a combination of not only technical content knowledge and skills but also with generic employability skills which are increasingly important in preparing them for employment and work advancement. The paper also highlighted on the effect of skills mismatch (absence or shortage of 232 233 generic employability skills in TVET curricula) on employment of graduates in Nigeria among other developing nations, which justify the need for integrating generic employability skills in Technical and vocational Education curriculum. Keywords: Technical and Vocational Education, Curriculum, Generic Employability Skills, Integration, 21st Century Workforce.Nama Penulis/Authors (Times New Roman, 12pt) INTRODUCTION Technical and vocational education (TVE) graduates require an increasing range of skills to maintain relevance in the 21st century workplace environment (Riemer, 2007). Traditionally, most TVE curricula in both secondary and higher institutions of learning in both developed and developing nations are targeted towards the development of technical knowledge and skills. However, as a result of globalization, emergence of new technologies and the shift to knowledge based economy, employers are currently demanding graduate to possess not only technical skills, but also non-technical skills, which is also referred to as core skills, key skills, generic skills, generic employability skills, employability skills, essential skills, basic skills workplace no how and many more (Naanda, 2010, World Bank, 2010). Recent literature on TVE are increasingly demanding for the reconsideration and review of the traditional curricula (Lappalainen, 2009; Lilliesköld and Östlund, 2008; ABET, 2006; and Platt, 2010). Highlighting the mismatch between the skills emphasized in the tradition curriculum and those related to professional practice, several researchers and organizations are mounting pressure on the need for integrating generic employability skills such as oral and written communication, interpersonal and team working, Problem solving and critical thinking skills, ICT, initiatives and enterprise skills, managerial and leadership as well as other personal quality skills into the existing curriculum (Audu, 233 234 et.al, 2013). For instance, it is advocated that the communicative competencies of TVE students need to be improved, as such competencies have become very crucial in the TVE and other engineering related professions (Jennings and Ferguson, 1995; Sageev, and Romanowski, 2001; Ravesteijn, De Graaff and Kroesen, 2006). Technical and Vocational Education Oni (2007) defined TVE as the type of education that trains individual into different recognized fields of occupation that will fit into gainful employment as technicians, semi-skilled, professionals or sub- professionals. It could be regarded as the type of training that aims at providing the participants with the basic knowledge and psychomotor skills for them to be admitted into the world of work or become self-reliant or self-employed. Dike (2009), described TVE as the type of education designed for the development of occupational skills in order to give individuals the necessary knowledge and skills to learn and live as well as become productive members of the society. However, Olaitan (2007) defines TVE as a form of training which is aimed at acquisition of practical skills through the application of mathematics and scientific knowledge for national development and self-actualization. The present type of education system practiced in Nigeria is 6-3-3-4 system of education which is designed to be job oriented to all graduates of post-primary schools. The program gives more emphasis on the use of tools as well as training individuals to create jobs and also generate wealth. TVE in Nigeria is provided at secondary and tertiary education levels i.e. at the Vocational training centers & Technical colleges (Secondary Education), Polytechnics, Colleges of Education and Universities of Technology (Tertiary Education) (NBTE, 2010). The courses are geared towards preparing technician, semi-skilled, sub-professionals and professional in various occupational trades. The curricula of the courses are geared towards the acquisition of 234 235 technical knowledge and skills in particular areas of specializations. The courses are aimed at preparing youth to further education, gainful employment, or self-employment and a prospective future of good livelihood (NBTE, 2004). However, employers of labour are demanding more than the technical knowledge and skills from the graduates in the 21st century and beyond, they are demanding for generic employability skills in addition to the technical skills provided by the institutions of learning from their prospective employees in order to meet up with the global challenges. Changes in the industrial sector require technical and vocational institutions to provide graduates with employability skills (Maclean and Ordonez, 2007; Khaled Nordin, 2011). Mohd Yusof et.al, (2012) are of the opinion that technical education systems need to plan strategies to improve the qualities of graduates in order to meet the current needs of employers. GENERIC EMPLOYABILITY SKILLS Generic employability skill (GES) are the non-technical skills and knowledge necessary for effective participation in the workforce (DEEWR, 2012). These skills and knowledge can be acquired throughout a person’s lifetime including: paid employment, volunteer work, self-employment, community activities and education. Skills USA (2004) define these skills as essential skills for effective job performance. While Rothwell and Arnold (2007) defined employability skills as the ability to survive in a job, Generic employability skills are the non-technical skills that every prospective employee is expected to possess in order to succeed in the labour market by securing and retaining job as well as for other future endeavours. Employability skills are a set of attributes, skills and knowledge all participants in the labour market should possess to gain employment in their chosen occupation and to be effective and successful in the workplace. The skills are not specific to any particular job or career, but are related to all professions and organizations. It is required from all 235 236 categories of employees from the most junior up to the chief executive (Hamza and Abdullah, 2009). Generic skills contributes to individual’s overall Job readiness by enhancing their capacity to adapt, learn and work independently. The extent to which individuals possess generic skills determines how they communicate, solve problems, and work as members of a team. According to Zakaria Kasa (Rajan, 2010) generic employability skills are: “Those skills which can be used across large numbers of different occupations they include what are defined as key skillscommunication, problem solving, team working, IT skills, application of number and ability to improve personal learning and performance. They also include reasoning skills, scheduling work and diagnosing work problems, work process management skills, visualizing output, working backward for forward planning purposes and sequencing operations”. Generic employability skill is defined as having the skills and abilities to find employment, remain in employment or obtain new employment as, and when, required (Crossman & Clarke, 2010, p. 602). Generic employability skills are skills necessary for the acquisition, keeping and performing well on the job. Robinson (Audu, et. al, 2013). Such skills include; managing resources, communication and interpersonal skills, teamwork and problem solving, and acquiring and maintaining a job. Generic skills are required by every prospective graduate to prepare them to meet up with the requirement and needs of various occupations after graduation. NEED FOR INTEGRATING GENERIC EMPLOYABILITY SKILLS IN TVE The emphasis on integrating generic employability skills in TVE curriculum comes as a result of youth unemployment, which is an issue that affects both developed and developing nations like Nigeria. The global youth unemployment rate stood at 12.6 per 236 237 cent, which is equivalent to 73 million youths in 2013 (ILO, 2013). The result of a study carried out on graduate turnout, skills and graduate unemployment in Nigeria by Akinyemi, and Ofem (2011) shows that Nigerian graduates largely, lack basic employability skills that are needed in the modern workplace. Adeyemo, et al (2010), observed from a survey they carried out on graduate employability in Nigeria, that there was a mismatch between the skills students acquire from higher education and the skills demands in the labor market. Akanmu (2011) noted that high unemployment rate in Nigeria was as result of declining employability among graduates of higher institutions and declining trust by industry in the quality of graduates. The Nigerian Institute of Personnel Management, NIPM (2000) noted that the quality of graduates in Nigeria is on a rapid decline especially in respect of valuable skills including; communication, technical abilities, human interaction, social, conceptual and analytical capacity. To collaborate this, the Nigerian Employers Consultative Associative, NECA (2000) asserted that companies were not recruiting but adopting employment protection strategies due to the very poor quality of graduates that do not meet the demands of industry. It has also been observed that employers in organizations and industries like oil companies, banks, telecommunications, etc., send their newly employed graduates for re-training before utilizing them. Akamu (2011) noted that anyone who sets up a factory or a construction project in Nigeria, imports a group foreign technicians to run the project. Hence, this phenomenon of unemployable graduates contributes immensely to the high rate of graduate unemployment in the country. Students should acquire generic employability skills while they are at TVE institutions. The skills can be learned through classroom instruction, in the field or outside the classroom. These skills are abstract in nature and a long time is required to train students to fully acquire generic employability skills. According to Knight & Yorke (Omar, eta’l., 2012). “Generic employability skills are therefore very essential, and a 237 238 necessity in the preparation of 21st century workforce, in both developed and developing nations across the globe”. Stressing the importance of generic employability skills, a study on the Protocol School of Washington, D.C conducted by Harvard University, the Carnegie Foundation and the Stanford Research Institute has indicated that technical skills and knowledge account for about 15 percent of the reasons an individual gets job, keep jobs and advance in the job (Crosbie, 2005). The remaining 85 percent of individual’s job success is based on individual’s generic employability skills. Therefore, the acquisition of both technical (hard) and generic skills together constitute professional competence of an employee/ graduate (Kauffeld, Grote, & Frieling, 2003). It has therefore become necessary for vocational education and training institutions to equip students with a combination of job specific skills and generic skills required for the future (Espostor and Meagher,2007). Altinson, (1997). Suggest that Technical and vocational Education institutions should equip students with the necessary skills in order to succeed in the workplace environment. Supporting that, Bacino and Zevalkink (2007) also believed that instructors and educators can assist their students develop generic employability skills in addition to their hard core skills by integrating it in course curriculum. Also, Cotton (2001) revealed that out of the 42 studies she reviewed suggest that “Generic employability skills are best learned when they are included among instructional goals and explicitly taught” (2001:7). CONCLUSIONS In the 21st century workplace environment graduates are expected to come to the job with a combination of Job specific knowledge and skills and generic employability skills. To be able realize that, Technical and Vocational Education institution should maximize the time learners spent with class instruction by identifying the essential generic employability skills required in the workplace 238 239 environment and integrating it into the course learning outcomes of the traditional courses, Identify and utilized learning activities, teaching approaches that will promote the acquisition of both technical content knowledge and skills and generic employability skills; and identifying assessment methods/strategies that will assess the generic employability skills . The integration process does not require a new curriculum but largely is a process of taking an existing set of academic competencies and giving them a workplace context. REFENRECES Accreditation Board for Engineering and Technology (2006). Engineering Change: A Study of the Impact of EC2000, http://www.abet.org/engineering-change. Adeyemo, S.A., Ogunleye, A.O., Oke, C.O., and Adenle, S.O. (2010). A survey of factor determining the employability of science and technology graduates of polytechnics and universities in the Nigerian labour market” Journal of Science and Technology Education Research Vol 1(5) pp 99-106, October. Akanmu, O. (2011) “Graduate Employment and Employability Challenges in Nigeria? Being a Paper Presented at the Association of Common Wealth Universities/British Council Regional Policy Dialogue on GraduateEmployability in Africa, th in Accra Ghana on 18 January, 2011. Akinyemi, S. and Ofem, I.B. (2011) “Graduate Turnout and Graduate Employment in Nigeria”. www.pagina-aede.org/malaga2011 Altinson J. S. (1997). The Changing Work Environment and Skills Standards. Delta IPi Epsilon Journal. 39(2), 76-82 Audu, R., Yusri Bin Kamin, Muhammad Sukri Bin Saud (2013). Acquisition of Employability Skills in Technical and Vocational Education: A necessity for 21st century Workforce. Australian Journal of Basic and Applied Sciences, Vol. 7, No. 6, pp. 9-14 Bancino, R., & Zevalkink, C. (2007, May). Generic skills: The New Curriculum for Hard Core Technical Professionals. Techniques, 239 240 20-22. Cotton, K. (2001), “Developing Employability Skills”, School Improvement Research Series: Close-up No.15, http://www.nwrel.org/scpd/sirs/8/c015.html(accessed 4/05/13). Crosbie, R. (2005). Learning the Soft Skill of Leadership. Industrial and commercial Training, 37 (1), 45-51 Crossman, J.E., & Clarke, M. (2010). International Experience and Graduate Employability: Stakeholder Perceptions on the Higher Education (2010) 59:599-613 Department of Education, Employment and Workplace Relations,( 201 2). Employability skills framework Stage 1- Final Report Dike,V. E. (2009). Addressing Youth Unemployment and Poverty in Nigeria: A Call For Action Not Rhetoric’s. Journal of Sustainable Development in Africa:11 (3), 129–151 Espostor, A. and Meagher, G. A (2007). The future Demand of Employability Skills and Implication for VTE System. 10t h Australian Vocational Education and Training research Association Conference. 11-13 April. Victoria University oots Cray Park Melbourne, Victoria: 1-10. Hamzah, M., and Abdullahi, S., (2009). Generic Skills in Personnel Development. European Journal of Social Science, 11(4) 684-689. Available at http://www.euro journals.co m/ejss11414.pdf [Accessed 15 February, 2012] International Labour Organization (2013). Global Employment Trends for Youth 2013: A generation at risk. Geneva: International Labour Office. Jennings, A.and Ferguson, J.D. (1995), Focusing on Communication Skills in Engineering Education, Studies in Higher Education, Vol. 20, No. 3, pp. 305-314. Kauffeld, S., Grote, S., & Frieling, E. (2003). Das Kasseler-KompetenzRaster (KKR). [The Kasseler-Competence Pattern]. In J. Erpenbeck & L.V. Rosenstiel (Eds.), Handbuch Knowledge Economy, Proceedings of UNEVOC, Retrieved from http://www.umanitoba.ca/unevoc/2002conference/text/papers/mun b y.pdf Khaled Nordin. (2011). Meneraju kegemilangan ilmu. PutraJaya: 240 241 Kementerian Pengajian Tinggi. P & Yorke, M. (2003). Assessment, Learning and employability. Open University Press, McGraw- Hill Education: England. Lappalainen, P.(2009), Communication as Part of the Engineering Skills Set, European Journal of Engineering Education, Vol. 34, No. 2, pp. 123-129. Lilliesköld, J. and Östlund, S. (2008), Designing, Implementing and Maintaining a First Year Project Course in Electrical Engineering, European Journal of Engineering Education, Vol. 33, No. 2, pp. 231-242. Knight, Maclean, R., & Ordonez, V. (2007). Work skills development for employability and education for sustainable development. Educ Res Policy Prac. 6, 123-140. Mohd Yusof, H., Ramlee Mustapha, Syed A. Malik Syed Mohamad, Seri Bunian, M (2012). Measurement Model of employability skills using confirmatory factor analyses. International Conference on Teaching and Learning in Higher Education (ICTLHE 2012) in conjunction with RCEE & RHED 2012. Naanda, R. N. (2010). The integration of identified employability skills into the Namibian Vocational Education and training Curriculum. PhD thesis. Department of Curriculum studies, Faculty of Education, Stellen University. NBTE (2004). National Diploma Mechanical Engineering Curriculum. National Board for Technical Education NBTE (2011). Report of the National Steering Committee on the Development of National Vocational Qualifications Framework (NVQF) for Nigeria. Nigerian Employers Consultative Association (2005) in Okebukola, Adedipe, Urah (eds) Ibadan: Heinemann Educational Nig. Plc. Nigerian Institute of Personnel Management (2000), In Okebukola, Adedipe, Urah (eds.) Ibadan: Heinemann Eductional Nig.Plc. Olaitan, S.O. (2007). Review of problems of school guidance in Nigeria. Journal of Education in Developing Areas, 1, 10–11. Omar, M.K., A.R. Bakar & A. Mat Rashid (2012). Employability Skill 241 242 Acquisition among Malaysian Community College Students. Journal of Social Sciences, 8(3): 472-478. Oni, C.S., 2007. Globalization and Its Implications for Vocational Education in Nigeria. Essays in Education: 21(1): 30-34. Platt, J.R. (2010), Survival Skills for Scientific Writing: Webinar explains how members can improve their scientific writing skills for peer-reviewed journals, http://theinstitute.ieee.org/career-and-education/careerguidance/survival-skills-for- scientific-writing512. Rajan, K.M.R (2010). Soft Skill Requirement for Employability in Mechanical Engineering Industry. Journal of Human Capital Development, Vol. 3, No. 2, pp, 41-54. Ravesteijn, W., De Graaff, E., and Kroesen, O. (2006), Engineering in the Future: the Social Necessity of Communicative Engineers, European Journal of Engineering Education, Vol. 31, No. 1, pp. 63-71. Riemer, M. J. (2007). Communication Skills for the 21st Century Engineer. Global Journal of Engineering Education (11)1 Australia: UICEE Published. Rothwell A, & Arnold J. (2007). Self-perceived employability: development and validation of a scale. Emerald personal review, 36(1), 23-41. Secretary's Commission on Achieving Necessary Skills (SCANS). (1991). Skills and Task for Jobs. A SCANS Report for America 2000. Washington, D.C. U.S. Department of Labour. Sageev, P., Romanowski, C.J. (2001), A Message from Recent Engineering Graduates in the Workplace: Results of a Survey on Technical Communication Skills, Journal of Engineering Education, Vol. 90, No. 4, pp. 685-692. Skills USA & NOCTI. (2004). Workplace Readiness. Skills Assessment Study Guide. World Bnk (2010). Stepping up skills for more jobs and higher productivity. Washington, D.C. 242 243 KOMITMEN KERJA PENGETUA DALAM MELAKSANAKAN TUGAS PADA SEKOLAH MENENGAH PERTAMA NEGERI DI BANDAR PADANG Syahril & Khadijah Daud ABSTRAK Komitmen merupakan faktor penentu kejayaan pengetua dalam memimpin suatu sekolah. Kajian ini bertujuan untuk mengenal pasti corak komitmen kerja Pengetua pada Sekolah Menengah Pertama Negeri di Bandar Padang dalam melaksanakan tugas. Kajian ini berbentuk deskriptif. Populasi pada kajian ini adalah Pengetua pada Sekolah Negeri di Bandar Padang yang berjumlah sebanyak 37 orang, kerana populasi kecil atau sedikit, maka semua populasi dijadikan responden pada kajian ini. Instrumen kajian menggunakan Soal Selidik skala lima mata. Keboleh percayaan soal selidik Alfa Cronbanch 0,96. Manakala pengolahan data hanya dilakukan dengan mencari purata. Dapatan pengolahan data pada kajian ini memperolehi bahawa komitmen afektif pengetua sekolah dalam melaksanakan tugas cukup tinggi iaitu 3,83 dari skala 5, ertinya pengetua telah memiliki komitmen afektif dalam melaksanakan tugas. Komitmen berketerusan dengan purata 4,12 ertinya dalam melaksanakan tugas di sekolah pengetua sudah memiliki komitmen berketerusan. Manakala purata komitmen 243 244 normatif pengetua dalam melaksanakan tugas adalah 4,02 ini juga mempunyai erti bahawa pengetua juga sudah memiliki komitmen normatif dalam melaksanakan tugas. Secara amnya boleh disimpulkan bahawa Pengetua pada Sekolah Menengah Pertama Negeri di Bandar Padang telah memiliki komitmen yang cukup tinggi dengan purata 3,99 dalam melaksanakan tugas pada sekolah yang dipimpinnya, namun masih perlu penyempurnaan dan diperingkatkan lagi. Kata Kunci: Komitmen; afektif, Berketerusan, Normatif; pengetua PENGENALAN Banyak hasil kajian menunjukkan bahawa pendidikan merupakan faktor penentu kemajuan suatu bangsa, jika suatu bangsa berjaya membina dasar-dasar pendidikan kebangsaan dengan baik, maka akan memberi kesan kepada kemajuan di bidang lain. Kejayaan di bidang pendidikan ditentukan oleh banyak faktor, salah satunya adalah faktor pengetua. Yukl, 2006 dan Kouzes Posner, 2003 mengemukakan pengetua sebagai pemimpin di sekolah merupakan unsur utama yang amat menentukan kejayaan sekolah. Kualiti sekolah amat bergantung kepada kualiti pengetua pada sekolah tersebut. Hussien, 2007, mengemukakan pengetua merupakan pemangkin kepada kecermelangan sekolah. Hal ini juga disokong oleh Levin dan Lockheed (2001), yang mengatakan bahwa maju dan cemerlangnya sebuah sekolah adalah diterajuni oleh pengetua yang berkesan. Oleh kerana itu, tidak ada sekolah yang menjadi maju dan cemerlang sekiranya kepemimpinan pengetua pada sekolah tersebut adalah lemah (Dessler, 2005). Sebaliknya sekolah yang lemah boleh bertukar menjadi sekolah yang berkesan dan berjaya dengan adanya kepemimpinan pengetua yang berkualiti, (Hussien, 2007). Sebagai pimpinan di sekolah pengetua memiliki beberapa peran dalam melaksanakan tugas iaitu sebagai educator, maneger, administrator, supervisor, lieder, inovator dan motivator (Mulyasa, 244 245 2013). Kejayaan pengetua untuk melaksanakan tugas dan peran tersebut dipengaruhi oleh banyak faktor, satu dari faktor tersebut adalah komitmen kerja pengetua dalam melaksanakan tugas. Komitmen kerja merupakan faktor penentu kejayaan pengetua dalam memimpin sekolah. Newstrom (2007) mentakrifkan komitmen kerja boleh diertikan, sebagai kesetiaan pegawai terhadap sejauh mana fasa atau darjah pengenalan diri pegawai pada pekerjaan dan keinginan-keinginannya untuk meneruskan penyertaan aktifitinya dalam organisasi dimana dia berada. Sedangkan Feldman (2000) menyatakan, bahawa komitmen kerja adalah kecenderungan seseorang untuk melibatkan diri ke dalam apa yang dikerjakan dengan keyakinan bahawa aktiviti yang dikerjakan penting dan bermakna. Kedua-dua pendapat di atas pada asasnya mempunyai pandangan yang sama tentang komitmen yaitu fasa keterikatan pegawai terhadap tugasnya. Sementara itu, Greenberg dan Baron (2009) berpendapat bahawa komitmen organisasi adalah sikap konsisten individu terhadap organisasi di mana mereka bekerja. Sikap tersebut adalah sikap konsisten individu terhadap mana mereka terlibat dengan pekerjaan mereka dan tertarik untuk mempertahankan pekerjaannya. Selari dengan itu Anthony (2009) mengemukakan komitmen kerja adalah adalah penerimaan seseorang terhadap nilai pekerjaan atau bidang pekerjaan yang dipilihnya, dan keinginan nutuk mempertahankan kedudukan dalam tugas tersebut. Komitmen ada ketika manusia mempunyai peluang untuk menentukan apa yang akan dilakukan. Komitmen terhadap pekerjaan dikonseptualisasikan sebagai hubungan psikologi antara orang dan pekerjaan yang terlibat berasaskan pada reaksi afektif terhadap pekerjaan itu. Robbins (2003) mengemukakan orang yang mempunyai komitmen terhadap pekerjaan, akan bekerja secara total dalam organisasi dengan memberikan segenap perhatian, fikiran, tenaga dan masa yang dimilikinya untuk bekerja sehingga mencapai hasil yang optimum. Sebaliknya orang yang tidak mempunyai komitmen, meskipun dia mempunyai kompetensi yang bagus, dia akan bekerja setengah hati. Komitmen mempunyai hubungan dengan kesetiaan, ketaatan dan kepuasan kerja dalam organisasi. Orang yang berkomitmen 245 246 tinggi lebih mementingkan pekerjaan dan tugas dalam memenuhi kemahuan organisasi berbanding keperluan sendiri. Orang yang memiliki komitmen kerja menurut Goleman (1999) mempunyai ciri-ciri sebagai berikut (a) mempunyai inisiatif untuk mengatasi masalah yang muncul, semada yang berhubungan secara langsung dengan dirinya mahupun kumpulannya, (b) bernuansa emosional, iaitu membuat sasaran individu dan sasaran organisasi menjadi satu atau sama sehingga mereka merasakan keterikatan yang kuat terhadap organisasi atau pekerjaan, (c) bersedia melakukan pengorbanan atau berkorban apabila diperlukan, (d) mempunyai visi strategik yang tidak mementingkan diri sendiri, (e) bekerja secara sungguh-sungguh walaupun tanpa ganjaran secara langsung, (f) merasa sebagai pemilik atau memandang diri sebagai pemilik sehingga setiap tugas diselesaikan secepat dan sebaik mungkin, (g) mempunyai rumusan misi dan visi yang jelas sebagai gambaran terhadap apa yang akan dicapai, dan (h) mempunyai kesedaran diri dengan perasaan yang jernih bahawa pekerjaan bukanlah suatu beban, tetapi merupakan kesenangan hobi yang dilakukan. Ciri-ciri di atas merupakan penentu bahawa pada diri seseorang terdapat komitmen dalam melaksanakan pekerjaan. Sementara itu Joseph (2002) mengemukakan beberapa ciri-ciri orang yang mempunyai komitmen kerja dalam organisasi iaitu, (a) mempunyai kepercayaan dan sokongan yang tinggi terhadap nilai dan pekerjaan, (b) mempunyai keinginan berusaha yang sungguh-sungguh untuk melaksanakan pekerjaan dalam organisasi, (c) mempunyai keinginan untuk melaksanakan kerja dengan baik dan memelihara keahlian organisasi, (d) mempunyai keinginan kuat untuk tetap jadi ahli organisasi, (e) kesediaan untuk tetap berusaha sebaik mungkin demi kepentingan organisasi, dan (f) kepercayaan dan penerimaan yang kuat terhadap nilai dan tujuan organisasi. Hasilan kajian Nurliana (2011), mendapati bahawa komitmen kerja pengetua di lingkungan Kementerian Pendidikan dalam melaksanakan tugas masih dalam katagori rendah. Sedangkan Imam Subandi (2012), menyatakan bahawa komitmen kerja pengetua dalam melaksanakan tugas masih jauh dari yang 246 247 diharapkan. Rendahnya komitmen kerja pengatua dalam melaksanakan tugas terlihat dari kurangnya kerjasama pada sekolah yang dipimpinnya, rendahnya tanggungjawab dan kurangnya disiplin pengetua dalam melaksanakan tugas. Seperti kerapnya pengetua meninggalkan sekolah untuk melakukan pekerjaan yang kurang terkait dengan tugasnya di sekolah, kurangnya pengawasan dan pembinaan yang mereka lakukan semada terhadap pelajar mahupun terhadap cikgu sehingga kerap terjadi konflik di sekolah, rendahnya disiplin di sekolah, hasilan belajar siswa masih belum mencapai standard yang diharapkan. Akibat dari permasalahan tersebut (rendahnya komitmen kerja pengetua sekolah) kerap terjadi unjuk perasaan yang dilakukan cikgu dan pelajar, mereka menuntut agar pengetua mundur dari kedudukannya atau berhenti daripada pengetua, (Wahjosumidjo 2013). Hal tersebut jelas akan mengganggu kenyaman kegiatan pembelajaran dan keberhasilan penyelenggaraan pendidikan di sekolah untuk itu komitmen kerja pengetua dalam pengurusan sekolah harus dipertingkatkan. METODOLOGI Kajian ini hanya berbentuk deskriptif, dengan populasi kajian adalah Pengetua pada Sekolah Menengah Pertama (SMP) Negeri di Bandar Padang yang berjumlah sebanyak 37 orang. Kerana populasi tidak begitu banyak atau besar (hanya 37 orang), maka pada kajian ini tidak dilakukan pengambilan sampel, dengan lain kata semua populasi dijadikan responden pada kajian ini. Pengumpulan data dilakukan dengan menggunakan instrumen dalam bentuk soal selidik yang disusun berdasarkan skala lima mata. Jumlah soal selidik untuk mengukur komitmen afektif sebanyak 11 item, soal selidik untuk mengukur komitmen berketerusan sebanyak 11 item dan soal selidik untuk mengukur komitmen normatif sebanyaak 10 item. Hasil kajian rintis terhadap soal selidik didapatkan data bahawa 247 248 soal selidik yang digunakan pada kajian ini memiliki keboleh percayaan yang cukup tinggi dengan Alfa Cronbanch 0,96. Manakala pengolahan data hanya dilakukan dengan mencari purata dari masing-masing aspek yang dikaji (komitmen afektif, komitmen berketerusan dan komitmen normatif). DAPATAN KAJIAN DAN PERBINCANGAN Kajian yang telah dilakukan tentang komitmen kerja Pengetua pada Sekolah Menengah Pertama (SMP) Negeri di Bandar Padang, menunjukkan bahawa komitmen kerja pengetua sekolah sudah cukup tinggi, semada komitmen afektif, komitmen berketerusan, mahupun komitmen normatif. Untuk lebih jelasnya boleh dilihat pada tabel berikut. Jadual 1. Dapatan Kajian tentang Komitmen Kerja Pengetua No Bentuk Komitmen Kerja Purata skor 1 Komitmen afektif 3,83 2 Komitmen berketerusan 4,12 3 Komitmen normatif 4,02 Purata 3,99 Data pada jadual di atas, menunjukkan bahawa komitmen afektif pengetua yang terkait dengan keterikatan emosional, identifikasi dan keterlibatannya untuk melaksanakan pekerjaan dalam organisasi cukup tinggi iaitu 3,83 ertinya pengetua telah memiliki komitmen afektif dalam melaksanakan tugas. Pengetua yang memiliki komitmen afektif yang tinggi dalam melaksanakan pekerjaan akan terus bekerja dalam organisasi, hal ini disebabkan kerana mereka memang ingin (want to) untuk melaksanakan melakukan pekerjaan tersebut, Greenberg dan Baron (2009). Komitmen berketerusan dengan purata 4,12. Hal ini bererti Pengetua pada Sekolah Menengah Pertama Negeri Bandar Padang sudah memiliki komitmen berketerusan dalam melaksanakan 248 249 tugas. Komitmen berketerusan berkaitan dengan pertimbangan untung rugi yang dirasakan atau didapatkan pengetua untuk tetap bekerja atau meninggalkan pekerjaan. Pengetua yang bekerja berasaskan komitmen berketerusan bertahan (kekal) dalam organisasi untuk melaksanakan pekerjaan sebab mereka ingin (need to) untuk melakukan hal tersebut kerana tidak ada pilihan lain. Manakala purata komitmen normatif pengetua dalam melaksanakan tugas adalah 4,02 ini juga mempunyai erti bahawa pengetua juga sudah memiliki komitmen normatif dalam melaksanakan tugas. Komitmen normatif berkaitan dengan perasaan nilai ataupun norma yang ada pada diri pengetua untuk tetap (kekal) menjadi sebahagian daripada pekerjaan kerana kerana bekerja merupakan kewajiban yang harus dilakukan pegawai. Berasaskan dapatan kajian ini boleh disimpulkan bahawa pada amnya Pengetua pada Sekolah Menengah Pertama Negeri di Bandar Padang telah memiliki komitmen yang cukup tinggi dalam melaksanakan pekerjaan. Walaupun pada amnya hasil kajian ini manunjukkan bahawa pengetua pada Sekolah Menengah Pertama (SMP) Negeri Bandar Padang sudah cukup tinggi, namun masih perlu disempurnakan atau dipertingkatkan agar kejayaan pada sekolah yang dipimpinnya boleh dicapai, baik pada aspek komponen komitmen afektif, berketerusan mahupun pada aspek komitmen normatif. KESIMPULAN Berasaskan dapatan pada kajian ini dapat disimpulkan bahawa komitmen kerja pengetua pada Sekolah Menengah Pertama Bandar Padang masih belum memuaskan dan masih perlu diperingkatkan, baik komitmen afektif, berketerusan dan komitmen normatif. Hal ini dilakukan untuk mencapai kejayaan pada sekolah yang dipimpin oleh pengetua. 249 250 RUJUKAN Anthony, Gary Dworkin. (2009). International Handbook of Research on Teachers and Teaching. New York: Springer. Dessler, Garry. (2005). Manajemen Personalian (terjemahan Agus Dharma). Edisi Ketiga. Jakarta: Erlangga. Feldman, Robert S. (2000). Adjustment Applying Psychology in a Complex Word. New York: McGraw-Hill Book Company. Greenberg, Jerald and Robert A. Baron. (2009). Behavior in Organizations. Upper Saddle River. New Jersey: Pearson Education, Inc. Goleman, Daniel. (1999). Kecerdasan Emosi untuk Mencapai Puncak Prestasi. Terjemahan Alex Tri Kantjono Widodo. Jakarta: Gramedia. Hussein Mahmood. (1997). Kepemimpinan dan Keberkesanan Sekolah. Kuala Lumpur: Dewan Bahasa dan Pustaka. Imam Subandi. (2012). Pengaruh Komitmen Tugas, Pemberdayaan dan Motivasi Kerja terhadap Kinerja Pengawas Sekolah. (disertasi). Jakarta: Pasca Sarjana UNJ. Joseph, Linz Susan J. (2002). Job Satisfaction Among Russian Workers. William Davidson Institute Working Paper, Reseacrh Feelow Wlliam Davidson Institute University of Michigan. Kouzes, James M., Barry Z. Posner. (2003). Leadership the Challenge. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass, A Wiley Imprint. Lockheed, ME & Levin HM. (2001). Creating Effective Schools. Edisi. Washington DC: Falmer Press. Mulyasa. (2013). Kepala sekolah yang Profesional. Bandung: Alfabeta. Newstrom, John W. (2007). Organizational Behavior. Human Behavior at Work. New York: McGraw-Hill. Nurliana. (2011). Pengaruh Budaya Organisasi, Kepemimpinan, Kepuasan Kerja dan Motivasi Berprestasi terhadap Komitmen Organisasi Kepala-kepala SDN di Kota Palembang. (disertasi). Jakarta: Pasca sarjana UNJ. Robbins, Stephen P. (2003). Organizational Behavior. New Yersey: Prentice-Hall International, Inc. Wahjosumidjo. (2013). Kepemimpinan Kepala Sekolah. Jakarta: Raja Grafindo Persada. Yukl, G., & Michel, J. (2006). Proactive Influence Tactics and LeaderMember Exchange. In C. A. Schriesheim and L. Neider (Eds.). 250 251 Power and Influence in Organizations: Research in Management. Greenwich, CT: Information Age Publishing. 251 252 ASSESSMENT PRACTICES AND PHYSICS EPISTEMOLOGICAL BELIEFS Lee Ween Shin, Fatin Aliah Phang ABSTRAK Studies have been conducted to compare epistemological beliefs between learners and professionals with the assumption that learners should develop their epistemological beliefs as professionals as an outcome of instructional and assessment practices. However, unaligned assessment practices within instructional practices and learning outcomes had resulted in epistemological beliefs and learning distortion. This study aim to investigate learners’ epistemological beliefs and assessment practices. Questionnaire was used and 55 undergraduates were participated. As a result, learners hold mixed epistemological beliefs towards assessment practices. Although learners hold high epistemological beliefs towards the importance of conceptual understanding in physics learning, problem solving, and the denotation of effort in improving own physics understanding, learners do not believed that assessment practices provide necessary information in helping their conceptual understanding. Furthermore, learners hold high dependency beliefs on course material in order to score better in examination instead of their own ability in knowledge construction. Keywords: Epistemological beliefs, Assessment practices, Physics 252 253 undergraduates INTRODUCTION Notably, promoting learners’ epistemological beliefs development has been a common objective among educational institutions. In order to produce professional graduates, it is essential to prepare students with the epistemological beliefs of professionals (Biggs & Tang, 2007). Various studies have been conducted to compare epistemological beliefs between learners and professionals with the assumption that learners should develop their epistemological beliefs as professionals as an outcome of instructional and assessment practices (Brewe et al., 2009; Elby, 2001; Lindsey et al., 2012; Otero & Gray, 2008; Redish et al, 1998). However, the fact that assessment practices are often not aligned with instructional practices and learning outcomes distorts learning (Biggs, 1996; Elby, 1999). The examination-oriented teaching and learning practices have, sadly, shifted the learning objective from conceptual understanding to merely passing examinations with flying colours (Sharifah Maimunah, 2003). Tests that emphasize on speed, efficiency, persistence, and memory retention are, frankly speaking, not recommended for science learning (Confrey, 2006) because it hinders learners’ critical and reflective thinking and gives a false impression that the ability to conquer test items is all that required to master science knowledge. According to Shay (2008), assessment is essential in supporting teaching and learning, such as provide support for future learning, information about performance, qualification selective information, and information for stakeholders in judging the effectiveness of teaching and learning system (Hornby, 2003). However, Knight (2002) has highlighted 25 reasons of the insufficient use of summative assessment in higher education. One of his concerns is the epistemological assumption behind the measurement. Learners who are exposed to instruction practices that emphasize on sophisticated science epistemological beliefs 253 254 development but are required to answer multiple choice examination with a particular true answer or examination that assess the retrieval of information and/or purely mathematics calculation will cause conflicts between the nature of science knowledge and knowing (Palmer & Marra, 2008). It is expected that the learners’ cognitive level will be negatively influenced as well to fit in the expected mode of assessment (Frederiksen & Collins, 1989). Learners learn what they think will be assessed, which means the kind of assessment drives how they learn (Brown & Knight, 1994). If they were only required to recall, apply, describe, and compare, then they will not unable to effectively engage themselves in learning. Over concentration or dependence on assessment and guidance does not warrant beneficial learning experience. Hence, the purpose of this study is to understand how assessment practices in university influences learners’ epistemological beliefs on knowledge and knowing. ASSESSMENT PRACTICES AND EPISTEMOLOGICAL BELIEFS According to research, good grades often only require rote learning and more time spent on using formula to solve exercises, not deep conceptual understanding (Elby, 1999). Reward for rote learning has been a factor that has contributed to learners’ different physics epistemological beliefs on getting good grades and understanding what is being learnt. Although solving physics problems is better done by adopting deeper learning approach to understand the question first, it can also be done by obtaining, plugging, and chugging relevant solutions obtained from textbooks. Regardless of the effort, the results may be the same. As such, examination problems that can be solved by rote learning only are also debatable because those assessments tasks may lead learners to develop high certainty (absolute truth) and simplicity (accumulation of facts) beliefs towards knowledge, and high authority dependency beliefs towards knowing without own 254 255 justification (knowledge is receiving rather than own construction). Subsequently, Elby (2001) found out that effort based assignment grading and test questions that demand explanations were succeeded in improving learners’ physics epistemological beliefs. Minimum grade was given to learners who had answered their assignment and test questions using the solutions given by the instructor. No plug-and-chug question was included in the test as it would further reinforce the use of rote learning. As a result, learner believed physics learning is more about conceptual understanding than factual accumulation and memorization. Though it was also believed that the improvement was not solely caused by the assessment practices, it has proven that assessment practices do exert sufficient influence on learners’ beliefs about learning. In Hofer’s (2004) case study, although the study was not focused on assessment practices solely, it has also been found that learners’ epistemological beliefs about simplicity of knowledge are related to assessment practices. The case study involved 25 first year chemistry learners; 13 of them were from a conventional general chemistry course while the rest were students of a constructivist organic chemistry course. Both courses had openended questions for tests, but not for the final exam. The final exam for general chemistry course consisted of multiple choice questions while the organic chemistry course maintained its openended questions. The case study was done to elicit learners’ perception about the assessment practices and their perception on their instructor’s choice of assessment. Results indicated that learners with the perception of simple knowledge found openended questions problematic; they preferred replication of facts and adopted memorization as their main learning strategy. On the other hand, learners who perceived knowledge as an interrelation of concepts valued open-ended exam questions since such encouraged them to think creatively and learn more. Therefore, the case study concluded that open-ended assessment practices help learners to develop a more complex view of knowledge. In addition, Hofer (2004) has also discovered that learners’ epistemological beliefs on the simplicity of knowledge worsens 255 256 with instruction practices that emphasize on simple and formulaic view of knowledge and at the same time involve assessment practices that focus on open-ended questions only (Hofer, 2004). The author opined that instruction practices which accentuate on the development of learners’ epistemological beliefs may be backwashed by un-aligned assessment practices. Although it has been hypothesized that assessment practices exert influences on learners’ beliefs about knowledge and knowing (Hofer & Pintrich, 1997, Muis et al., 2006; Palmar & Marra, 2008), there are limited empirical research that solely investigate the impact of assessment practices on learners’ epistemological beliefs, which suggest the need for a study to explore learners’ perspectives on assessment practices in influencing their epistemological beliefs. PHYSICS EPISTEMOLOGICAL BELIEFS As one of the science subject, physics was perceived as the toughest subject by learners (Sands, 2004) because of the numerous theories, laws, and formulae (Ornek et al., 2008). According to research, there are learners who believe that physics consists of symbols, purely algorithm, absolute truth, and unrelated pieces of information. This type of learners also sees the learning and justification of physics as highly depended on authorities such as lecturers and books. Therefore, they often neglect themselves as the knower or learner who have the abilities to construct physics knowledge (Hammer, 1994; Redish et al., 1998; Elby, 1999; Elby, 2001; Lising & Elby, 2005; Adam et al., 2006; Gray et al., 2008). On the other hand, learners tend to adopt different learning strategies in physics learning, though these learning strategies are attached from the beliefs a learner holds about knowledge and knowing (Lising & Elby, 2005; Richter & Schmid, 2009). For learners who believe that physics knowledge is about symbols and is purely algorithms, they tend to learn and solve physics problems by manipulating mathematics equations as well as plug and chug 256 257 algorithm to appropriate formula. As for learners who believe that physics knowledge is made up of concepts which are represented by symbols and algorithms, they prefer learning and solving physics problems through conceptual understanding (Hammer, 1994). In addition, for those who believe that physics is about absolute truth and unrelated pieces of information, they see physics as a subject that requires intense memorization instead of a deep understanding on key basic ideas (Elby, 2001). METHOD Since assessment practices hold the backwash effect on instruction practices and were served as an important aspect in influencing learners’ beliefs and their subsequent learning strategy, this survey study focused on learners’ perspective on assessment practices in influencing their physics epistemological beliefs. A total of 55 physics undergraduates were asked to complete a Likert scale questionnaire, namely Maryland Physics Expectations (MPEX) after a semester of study in university. The questionnaire was developed by Redish et al., (1998) to probe learners’ physics epistemological beliefs about physics courses. Since the questionnaire is focused on learners’ physics epistemological beliefs, item related to assessment had been included. Descriptive statistic was used to analyzed and illustrate the result of this study since ordinal scale was defined. The results obtained were compared to expert scores as provided by the original questionnaire. Learners showed higher physics epistemological beliefs if their responses are similar to expert score, and lower physics epistemological beliefs if their responses are different from expert score. However, the purpose of this study focused on assessment practices, thus, only items related to assessment were analyzed. Table 1 indicates the items from MPEX which reflect the effect of assessment on learners’ physics epistemological beliefs. For example, item 3, 24, and 31, more expert-like responses indicated 257 258 that the learners had made the effort to use information available and tried to make sense of the information. On the other hand, item 13 measures the independent dimension of learners’ epistemological beliefs, i.e., whether the learners have been independent and responsible in their learning and construction of their own understanding. If the learner felt that physics and mathematics were unrelated and isolated knowledge, then they would state in item 20 that they could not derive mathematics equations from physics concept in examinations. Furthermore, item 26 measures the learners’ tendency to rely on memorization and usage of formula in solving questions rather than explicitly ponder on the physics concepts. Item 11 and 33 are unstated to any epistemological belief dimension by Redish et al., (1998); they measure learners’ perception on their grades. These items have been included may due to the possibility that the learners do not see getting grade A as the same as understanding physics, and therefore may have used different strategies for both cases (Elby, 1999). Table 1 also summarized the items regarding assessment practices in MPEX based on responses of expert. Table 1: Item MPEX on assessment practices Item Questions 3 I go over my class note carefully to prepare for tests in this course. A good understanding of physics is necessary for me to achieve my career goals. A good grade in this course is not enough. My grade in this course is primarily determined by how familiar I am with the material. Insight or creativity has little to do with it. If I don’t remember a particular equation needed for a problem in an exam there’s nothing much I can do (legally!) to come up with it. The results of an exam don’t give 11 13 20 24 Expert Responses Agree or Strongly Agree Agree or Strongly Agree Dimension Effort - Disagree Strongly Disagree or Independence Disagree Strongly Disagree or Math Link Disagree or Effort 258 259 26 31 33 me any useful guidance to improve my understanding of the course material. All the learning associated with an exam is in the studying I do before it takes place. When I solve most exam or homework problems, I explicitly think about the concepts that underlie the problem. I use the mistakes I make on homework and on exam problems as clues to what I need to do to understand the material better. It is possible to pass this course (get a “C” or better) without understanding physics very well. Strongly Disagree Agree or Strongly Agree Concepts Agree or Strongly Agree Effort Disagree Strongly Disagree or - RESULT The data collected from respondents were compared to expert responses. Similarity percentage was calculated where respondents’ responses were similar to expert responses. Respondents’ responses showed high percentage of similarity score on item 3 (83.64%), item 11 (80.00%), item 26 (80.00%), and item 31 (87.27%) compared to expert responses. On the other hand, respondents showed low percentage of similarity core on item 13 (14.55%), item 20 (27.27%), item 24 (12.73%), and item 33 (38.18%). Table 2: Respondents’ similarity score percentage at beginning and end of semester Item Questions Expert Responses Similarity percentage compared to expert responses 3 I go over my class note carefully to prepare for tests in this course. Agree or Strongly Agree 83.64% 11 A good understanding of physics is necessary for me to achieve my career goals. A good grade in this course is not enough. Agree or Strongly Agree 80.00% 259 260 13 20 24 26 31 33 My grade in this course is primarily determined by how familiar I am with the material. Insight or creativity has little to do with it. If I don’t remember a particular equation needed for a problem in an exam there’s nothing much I can do (legally!) to come up with it. The results of an exam don’t give me any useful guidance to improve my understanding of the course material. All the learning associated with an exam is in the studying I do before it takes place. When I solve most exam or homework problems, I explicitly think about the concepts that underlie the problem. I use the mistakes I make on homework and on exam problems as clues to what I need to do to understand the material better. It is possible to pass this course (get a “C” or better) without understanding physics very well. Disagree or Strongly Disagree 14.55% Disagree or Strongly Disagree 27.27% Disagree or Strongly Disagree 12.73% Agree or Strongly Agree 80.00% Agree or Strongly Agree 87.27% Disagree or Strongly Disagree 38.18% DISCUSSION The overall result of this study indicated that learners hold mixed physics epistemological beliefs towards physics assessment practices. Although learners hold high physics epistemological beliefs regarding their ability in make use of physics assessment practices in providing information on their misconception and improving their conceptual understanding (item 31- 87.27%), learners does not believed that the result from physics assessment practices in the course was able to provide the said information (item 24 – 12.73%). Learners believed that learning associated with physics examination is regarding the study process conducted before the examination (item 24), where the effort devoted in the studying of course material is necessary in preparing for examination (item 3 – 83.64%), but the circumstances were suggested to lead them to hold high dependence beliefs on the 260 261 course material instead of their own ability and creative thinking in learning (item 13 – 14.55%). A possible explanation for this might be that learners learn what they think will be assessed in the examination (Brown & Knight, 1994). Learners may perceive that the more familiar with the course material is necessary for getting better result in the examination. Besides that, although learners believed that problem solving is in need with the use of concepts (item 26 – 80.00%); they were not believed that they hold the ability to relate or to derive mathematics formula from physics concepts (item 20 – 27.27%). Lastly, learners believed that grade in a course are not necessary to help them in achieving career goal (item 11 – 80.00%). However, they believed that without conceptual understanding, they are still able to pass the assessment needed in the particular course (item 33 – 38.18%). This finding is in agreement with Elby’s (1999) finding which showed that understanding physics and scoring better result in physics course were two significant different activities from learners’ perspective. CONCLUSION As a conclusion, although learners hold high epistemological beliefs towards the importance of conceptual understanding in physics learning, problem solving, and the denotation of effort in improving own physics understanding, learners do not believed that assessment practices provide necessary information in helping their conceptual understanding. Furthermore, learners hold high dependency beliefs on course material in order to score better in examination instead of their own ability in knowledge construction. It is therefore that backwash effect of assessment practices are likely to occur. However, these quantitative data must be interpreted with caution because it provides limited alternative explanation to the circumstances. Hence, further study is needed to understand how and why assessment practices influence learners’ epistemological beliefs and their subsequent learning strategy. 261 262 REFERENCES Adams, W., Perkins, K., Podolefsky, N., Dubson, M., Finkelstein, N., & Wieman, C. (2006). New Instrument for Measuring Student Beliefs about Physics and Learning Physics : The Colorado Learning Attitudes about Science Survey. Physics Education Research(2), 1 - 14. Biggs, J. (1996). Enhancing Teaching Through Constructive Alignment. Higher Education, 32(2), 347 - 364. Biggs, J., & Tang, C. (2007). Teaching for Quality Learning at University. England: McGraw Hill. Brewe, E., Kramer, L., & O'Brian, G. (2009). Modeling instruction: Positive attitudinal shifts in introductory physics measured with CLASS. Physical Review Special Topics - Physics Education Research, 5(1), 1 - 5. Brown, S., & Knight, P. (1994). Assessing learners in higher education. London: Kogan Page. Confrey, J. (2006). The Evolution of Design Studies as Methodology. In R. K. Sawyer, The Cambrige Handbook of the Learning Sciences (pp. 135 - 152). United States of America: Cambridge University Press. Elby, A. (1999). Another reason that physics students learn by rote. American Journal of Physics, 67(7), 52 - 57. Elby, A. (2001). Helping Physics Students Learn how to Learn. American Journal of Physics, 69(7), 54 - 64. Frederiksen, J. R., & Collins, A. (1989). A Systems Approach to Educational Testing. Educational Researcher, 18(9), 27 - 32. Gray, K. E., Adams, W. K., Wieman, C. E., & Perkins, K. K. (2008). Students Know What Physicists Believe, But They Don't Agree: A Study Using the CLASS Survey. Physical Review Special Topics - Physics Education Research, 4, 1 - 9. Hammer, D. (1994). Epistemological Belief's in Introductory Physics. Cognition and Instruction, 12(2), 151 - 183. Hofer, B. K. (2004). Exploring the Dimensions of Personal Epistemology in Differing Classroom Context : Student Interpretations During the First Year of college. Contemporary Educational Psychology, 29, 129 - 163. Hofer, B. K., & Pintrich, P. R. (1997). The Development of Epistemological Theories: Beliefs about Knowledge and 262 263 Knowing and Their Relation to Learning. Review of Educatinal Research, 67(1), 88-140. Hornby, W. (2003). Assessing Using Grade-related Criteria: a single currency for universities? Assessment and Evaluation in Higher Education, 28(4), 435 - 454. Knight, P. T. (2002). The Achilles’ heel of quality: The assessment of student learning. Quality in Higher Education, 8(1), 107 - 115. Lindsey, B. A., Hsu, L., Sadaghiani, H., Taylor, J. W., & Cummings, K. (2012). Positive attitudinal shifts with the Physics by Inquiry curriculum across multiple implementations. Physical Review Special Topics - Physics Education Research, 8(1), 1 - 8. Lising, L., & Elby, A. (2005). The Impact of Epistemology on Learning : A Case Study from Introductory Physics. American Journal of Physics, 73(4), 372 - 382. Muis, K. R., Bendixen, L. D., & Haerle, F. C. (2006). Domain Generality and Domain Specificity in Personal Epistemology Research : Philosophical and Empirical Reflections in the Development of a Theoritical Framework. Educational Psychology Review, 18(1), 3 - 54. Ornek, F., Robinson, W. R., & Haugan, M. P. (2008). What Makes Physics Difficult? International Journal of Environmental & Science Education, 3(1), 30 - 34. Otero, V. K., & Gray, K. E. (2008). Attitudinal gains across multiple universities using the Physics and Everyday Thinking Curriculum. Physice Review Special Topics - Physic Education Research, 4(2), 1 - 7. Palmer, B., & Marra, R. M. (2008). Individual Domain-Specific Epistemologies : Implications for Educational Practice. In M. S. Khine, Knowing, Knowledge and Beliefs : Epistemological Studies (pp. 325 - 350). Springer. Redish, E. F., Saul, J. M., & Steinberg, R. N. (1998). Student Expectations in Introductory Physics. American Journal of Physics, 66(3), 212 - 224. Richter, T., & Schmid, S. (2010). Epistemological Beliefs and Epistemic Strategies in Self-regulated Learning. Metacognition Learning, 5, 47 - 56. Sharifah Maimunah, S. Z. (2003). Reforming the Science and Technology Curriculum : The Smart School Initiative in Malaysia. Prospect, 18(1), 39 - 50. 263 264 Shay, S. (2008). Beyong social constructivist perspectives on assessment : the centring of knowledge. Teaching in Higher Education, 13(5), 595 - 605. 264 265 PENERAPAN STRATEGI PENGUTARAAN MASALAH UNTUK MENINGKATKAN KEMAHIRAN BERFIKIR ARAS TINGGI Vinogharri Muniandy ABSTRAK Kajian tinjauan ini dijalankan bertujuan mengenalpasti tahap Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi (KBAT), strategi pengutaraan masalah dalam kalangan pelajar kimia, dan jenis-jenis pengutaraan masalah yang diaplikasikan oleh pelajar kimia. Kajian ini menentukan hubung kait di antara strategi pengutaraan masalah dan meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi, mengenalpasti proses pengutaraan masalah dalam kalangan pelajar kimia. Oleh itu kajian ini mengkaji penerapan strategi pengutaraan masalah bagi meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi. Sampel kajian terdiri daripada 370 pelajar tingkatan empat aliran sains yang mengambil mata pelajaran kimia di tiga buah sekolah sekitar Bandar Kajang. Data diperoleh melalui Ujian Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi dan Temubual Seapara Berstruktur Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi. Data kajian ini, dianalisis dengan menggunakan Statistical Package for Social Science (SPSS) version 17 dan ditunjukkan dalam frekuensi, peratus dan min. Aspek lain yang masih mefokuskan bagi penerapan startegi 265 266 pengutaraan masalah dalam pembelajaran dan pengajaran agar meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi seperti dalam PPPM. Kata Kunci: Penerapan Strategi Pengutraan Masalah Untuk Meningkatkan Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi PENGENALAN Malaysia adalah sebuah negara yang sedang membangun dan berhasrat untuk menjadi negara maju dalam semua sektor seperti sektor perindustrian, pertanian dan sebagainya. Bagi mencapai hasrat ini, negara kita memerlukan masyarakat saintifik yang dilahirkan melalui sebuah sistem pendidikan sains yang berkualiti yang menekankan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi. Penekanan Kurikulum Sains adalah pada penguasaan kemahiran saintifik dan kemahiran berfikir. Sekiranya pada masa dahulu, Kurikulum Kebangsaan lebih mementingkan pelajar mengulangi fakta yang telah dipelajari, kini salah satu objektif utama dalam kurikulum sains adalah untuk membolehkan pelajar memilih, menganalisis dan menilai maklumat dengan bijak dan berkesan (Bahagian Pembangunan Kurikulum, 2013). Dalam merealisasikan hasrat ini, pendidikan sains dalam Kurikulum Bersepadu Sekolah Rendah (KBSR) dan Kurikulum Bersepadu Sekolah Menengah (KBSM) diwacanakan agar berupaya membentuk rakyat Malaysia yang bersikap saintifik dan nilai murni termasuk perasaan ingin tahu, berfikiran terbuka, tabah dan prihatin. Sehubungan itu, Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia telah menyediakan tambahan sebanyak 500 juta ringgit bagi melaksanakan Pelan Pembangunan Pendidikan Malaysia (PPPM), 2013-2025. Hasrat PPPM adalah membangun transformasi kurikulum pendidikan bagi memastikan masyarakat Malaysia mencapai kesan yang positif dan melahirkan generasi yang mampu bersaing. Kualiti pendidikan sebuah negara ditetapkan dalam indikator pencapaian Trends in International Mathematics and Science Study (TIMSS) dan Programme For International Student 266 267 Assessment (PISA). Pelaksanan PPPM bagi tahun 2013, telah memberi kecemerlangan dalam sistem pendidikan dan mengariskan 25 inisiatif agar agenda progam transformasi memberi impak yang positif dan kepuasan kepada rakyat serta melahirkan masyarakat berfikrah. Antaranya, inisiatif peningkatan kemahiran guru dan murid dalam TIMSS dan PISA serta inisiatif kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi. PENCAPAIAN MALAYSIA DALAM TIMSS DAN PISA Usaha Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia yang meletakkan elemen kemahiran berfikir seperti kritis dan kreatif dalam satu set pengajaran dan pembelajaran bagi membolehkan para pelajar mampu melaksanakan pertimbangan penyelesaian yang wajar. Secara langsung dan tidak langsung, kerajaan telah mengambil langkah awal dengan menyertai bahagian dalam pentaksiran antarabangsa bagi menguji tahap pencapaian berkaitan bidang sains dan matematik agar meningkatkan kualiti pendidikan negara di mana duduk sama rendah dan bertinggi sama tinggi dengan negara maju. Rajah 1.1 Kedudukan sains – Malaysia dalam PISA 267 268 Walaupun pelbagai insiatif telah dilaksanakan, namun kebanyakkan pelajar Malaysia tidak menunjukkan pencapaian PISA dan TIMSS yang memuaskan kerana cepat berputus harapan selepas melihat soalan yang berteks panjang dan berasa bosan ketika membaca soalan sepertinya. Selain itu, pelajar menjawab soalan sewenang sahaja akhirnya menjejaskan imej pendidikan Malaysia di pentas dunia. (Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia, 2013). PISA yang mengukur kefahaman mengenai real-life skills yang berkaitan bacaan, matematik dan sains yang menfokuskan kepada kehidupan harian seperti kesihatan, muka bumi, persekitaran dan sebagaian. Kandungan penilaian bagi meningkatkan maklumat mengenai sikap pelajar dan pendekatan kepada pembelajaran, suasana pembelajaran dan organisasi persekolahan. Rajah 1.1 dan 1.2 menunjukkan tahap kecekapan pelajar dalam sains di dalam PISA. Pencapaian ini amat membimbangkan dan mengejutkan maka kerajaan mengambil langkah yang manfaat menetapkan sasaran di bawah PPPM bagi pencapaian kedudukan Malaysia skor purata 500 di TIMSS pada tahun 2015 dan menjelang tahun 2025 pencapaian Malaysia satu pertiga teratas dalam TIMSS dan PISA. Rajah 1.2 Tahap kecekapan Dalam Sains Rajah 1.3 juga menunjukkan data kajian daripada Trends in 268 269 International Mathematics and Science Study (TIMSS) pada tahun 2011 kurang memberangsangkan dan pencapaian sains semakin merosot iaitu kedudukan Malaysia berada di tangga ke-32 daripada 45 negara peserta berbanding dengan kedudukan ke-21 pada tahun 2007. TIMSS merupakan indikator keberkesanan dalam pendidikan sains dan matematik di peringkat antarabangsa. Oleh itu, inisiatif ke arah meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi dalam kalangan pelajar amat diperlukan. Maka, dua daripada 25 inisiatif PPPM bagi tahun 2013 berkaitan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi berkaitan pendidikan sains dan matematik dan memberi kesedaran kepada masyarakat untuk perubahan set minda serta amalan pendekatan seluruh sekolah. Rajah 1.3 Purata Skor TIMSS 1999, 2003, 2007 dan 2011 Trends in International Mathematics and Science Study (TIMSS) dibangunkan oleh IEA bagi mengukur keupayaan dan kebolehan pelajar dalam bidang sains dan matematik. Pentaskiran global ini berfokus kepada kuantiti, kualiti dan kandungan pembelajaran dan pengajaran. TIMSS membantu mengesan tahap pelajar dalam kategori dan setiap empat tahun sekali pengukuran prestasi antarabangsa dijalankan oleh IEA. Objektif utama indikator adalah penambahbaikan trend pencapaian pelajar dalam mata pelajaran sains dan matematik serta penekanan kepada isi kandungan kurikulum untuk menganalisa faktor-faktor yang 269 270 mendorong pencapaian pelajar di peringkat pentas dunia. Justeru itu, kelemahan yang ditunjukkan oleh pencapaian pelajar dalam kedua-dua PISA dan TIMSS ini terutamanya menujukkan pretasi yang membimbangkan dan memerlukan usaha penambahbaikan dilakukan. PENEKANAN KURIKULUM PEMBELAJARAN Pendidikan sains merangkumi dua kemahiran penting iaitu kemahiran proses sains dan kemahiran berfikir di mana kemahiran berfikir dibahagi kepada kategori seperti pemikiran kritis dan kreatif (Kurikulum Bersepadu Sekolah Menengah, 2012). Pemikiran kritis dan kreatif penting untuk menekankan pembelajaran berfikrah dan meningkatkan daya berkifir dalam kalangan pelajar. Kurikulum sains Malaysia telah membahagi mata pelajaran sains elektif di peringkat menengah atas dan terdiri daripada fizik, kimia, biologi dan sains tambahan. Pada tahun 1972, mata pelajaran kimia telah diperkenalkan di sekolah menengah di negara ini dengan bertujuan untuk membentuk minat pelajar dalam kimia serta menambah pengetahuan dalam mata pelajaran kimia bagi memenuhi prasyarat untuk menceburi bidang kimia dan teknologi di peringkat yang lebih tinggi. Pembelajaran kimia memerlukan gabungan pelbagai elemen penting seperti kemahiran berfikir, kemahiran belajar cara belajar, kemahiran teknologi maklumat dan komunikasi, kajian masa depan, kecerdasan pelbagai, pembelajaran konstruktivisme dan kontekstual (Pusat Perkembangan Kurikulum, 2001). Kajian juga mendapati, kemerosotan kedudukan Malaysia dalam PISA dan TIMSS juga berkaitan dengan peranan guru yang kurang memberi penekanan dan hanya bergiat menghabiskan silibus mata pelajaran sahaja. Guru memberi keutamaan bagi mengejar sukatan pelajaran untuk menyediakan pelajar menghadapi peperiksaan awam. Secara tidak langsung, guru menggunakan laluan pintas untuk proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran dengan melompat terus ke konsep mengaplikasi 270 271 tanpa memahami sesuatu konsep. Pelajar dilatih oleh guru untuk membuat latih tubi dan soalan-soalan tahun lepas dengan membuat persedian untuk menjawab soalan peperiksaan. Sasaran yang ditetapkan di bawah PPPM 2013-2015 akan meningkatkan kedudukan Malaysia ke tangga satu pertiga atas dalam TIMSS dan PISA. Penerapan kemahiran berfikir dalam kurikulum pembelajaran akan memudahkan pelajar membiasakan diri untuk menjawab soalan yang pentakisran antarabangsa dan penambahbaikan kurikulum selaras era dunia akan membantu meningkatkan kualiti pendidikan negara. Terdapat banyak elemen yang digunakan untuk meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi iaitu penggubalan Kurikulum Standard Sekolah Rendah, Kurikulum Standard Sekolah Menengah, pelaksanaan Program i-Think, dan strategi pengutaraan masalah. Tambahan pula, strategi pengutaraan masalah adalah satu strategi yang dicipta oleh pendidik Brazil Paulo Freire pada tahun 1970 dalam buku Pedagogy of the Oppressed Problem untuk memperkenalkan satu keadah mengajar yang menekankan pemikiran kritis dan sebagai alternatif kepada pengajaran tradisional. Strategi ini amat berguna untuk meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi kerana secara tidak langsung ia merangsang pemikiran kreatif dan kritis seseorang pelajar. Pendidikan sains merangkumi dua kemahiran penting iaitu kemahiran proses sains dan kemahiran berfikir di mana kemahiran berfikir dibahagi kepada kategori seperti pemikiran kritis dan kreatif (Kurikulum Bersepadu Sekolah Menengah, 2012). Pemikiran kritis dan kreatif penting untuk menekankan pembelajaran berfikrah dan meningkatkan daya berfikir dalam kalangan pelajar. Kurikulum sains Malaysia telah membahagi mata pelajaran sains elektif di peringkat menengah atas dan terdiri daripada fizik, kimia, biologi dan sains tambahan. Pada tahun 1972, mata pelajaran kimia telah diperkenalkan di sekolah menengah di negara ini dengan bertujuan untuk membentuk minat pelajar dalam kimia serta menambah pengetahuan dalam mata pelajaran kimia bagi memenuhi prasyarat untuk menceburi bidang kimia dan teknologi di peringkat yang lebih tinggi. Pembelajaran 271 272 kimia memerlukan gabungan pelbagai elemen penting seperti kemahiran berfikir, kemahiran belajar cara belajar, kemahiran teknologi maklumat dan komunikasi, kajian masa depan, kecerdasan pelbagai, pembelajaran konstruktivisme dan kontekstual (Pusat Perkembangan Kurikulum, 2001). Tanpa mengetahui konsep, semua pembelajaran adalah menjadi pembelajaran hafalan dan bukan lagi pempelajaran bermakna (Alias, 1998). Pelajar yang hanya mampu memahami dan menghafal tetapi tidak dapat mengaplikasikan pengetahuan mereka akan merendah tahap pencapaian dengan lebih cemerlang. LATAR BELAKANG MASALAH Sistem pendidikan Malaysia dengan jelas menggariskan elemen aspirasi pelajar untuk mencapai alam persekolahan iaitu kemahiran berfikir, pengetahuan, etika, kerohanian, identiti nasional, dwibahasa dan kepimpinan. Ia bertujuan sistem persekolahan bukan sahaja mampu melahirkan murid yang cemerlang tetapi juga berfikir aras tinggi dan mampu mencipta. Oleh itu, transformasi kurikulum pendidikan penting bagi sebuah negara untuk melahirkan generasi yang mampu berfikir aras tinggi selaras dengan negara maju lain. Ia sejajar denga pendapat Rajendran (1998) bahawa kemajuan sebuah negara bergantung kepada tahap ilmu dan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi yang telah dikuasai oleh rakyat sesebuah negara. Konsep KBAT diperkenalkan dalam Pelan Pembangunan Pendidikan Malaysia 2013-2025 bagi memupuk kemahiran berfikir dan menjana daya cipta dalam kalangan pelajar. Transformasi kurikulum pendidikan akan mengubah pengajaran dan pembelajaran supaya pelajar tidak lagi hanya memahami dan menghafal sahaja. Pembelajaran kimia yang berkesan dan efektif memerlukan pelajar menengah atas mefokuskan kepada KBAT (Anderson & Krathwoht, 2001) iaitu mengalpikasi, menganalisa, menilai dan mencipta semasa pembelajaran dan pengajaran. KBAT ini juga sesuai untuk semua jenis tahap pelajar di mana 272 273 bukan tertumpu kepada pelajar pintar dan harus ditingkatkan agar melahirkan insan yang mampu berfikir saintifik. Secara langsung dan tidak lansung ia amat berkait rapat dengan kepentingan KBAT dalam pendidikan kimia. Kepentingan Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi (KBAT) dalam Pendidikan Sains Cabaran mentakrifkan kemahiran berfikir, taakulan, kritikal dan penyelesaian masalah telah dikenali sebagai sebuah konsep dalam kajian. Dalam abad ke-21, pemikiran kritikal amat diititikberatkan yang melibatkan kreatif, kommunikasi, pengetahuan, penyelesaian masalah, bertanggungjawab dan bekerja secara kumpulan. Kemahiran berfikir ini mempunyai peranan yang sangat penting bagi menghasilkan modal insan yang cerdas, kreatif dan inovatif agar kita dapat memenuhi cabaran hidup dalam era yang canggih ini serta mampu bersaing di pentas antarabangsa. Malangnya negara kita, penguasaan kemahiran berfikir aras rendah (KBAR) di tangga teratas dan kebanyakkan pelajar hanya mampu memahami dan menghafal sesuatu fakta dan tidak mencuba aras yang seterusnya ( Selvaratnam, 1983). Ia menimbulkan persolan kenapa pelajar mudah mencapai kemahiran berfikir aras rendah (KBAR)? Ia disebabkan pelajar tidak perlu memberi penjelasan terhadap soalan yang berunsur definisi semata-mata, tidak memerlukan bukti yang munasabah, tiada perbandingan dan pelajar perlu menjawab satu jawapan sahaja. Oleh itu, pelajar tidak perlu untuk mencari jawapanjawapan alternatif dan bergantung kepada satu jawapan tetap. Maka, kita telah mengikat kebolehan pelajar untuk mengajukan soalan atau jawapan yang berasa logik dengan penetapan setiap soalan hanya menperuntukkan satu jawapan. ( Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia, 2013). Sebenarnya KBAT berorentasikan penyelesaian masalah mencabar dan merangsang penggunaan pengetahuan sedia ada, mampu mencabar masalah yang tidak pernah dialami, dan sentiasa 273 274 berfikir penyelesaian bukan satu sahaja. Justeru KBAT amat diperlukan dalam pendidikan negara agar sistem pendidikan dapat duduk sama rendah, berdiri sama tinggi di persada dunia. Walau bagaimanapun, banyak kajian-kajian didapati wujud pelbagai kelemahan dalam penerapan KBAT di sekolah dan tidak seperti yang dihajatkan. Kelemahan Penerapan Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi (KBAT) di sekolah Kajian menunjukkan pelajar Malaysia dalam ujian Trend Pendidikan Sains dan Matematik (TIMSS) dan Program Penilain Murid Antarabangsa (PISA) pada tahap yang kurang memuaskan. Mengikut Taksonomi Bloom, soalan-soalan di dalam TIMMS dan PISA adalah pada aras tinggi tetapi pelajar Malaysia hanya memahami dan mengingat sesuatu fakta serta tidak mampu mengaitkan dengan kehidupan atau mengaplikasikan fakta yang dipelajari sebelum ini. Pelajar mengalami kesukaran mengakodomasikan penbelajara Menurut Gabel (1998), pdp kimia lebih berfokus kepada fakta dan pengetahuan iaitu pelajar hanya berfokus kepada teknik menghafal dan mengingat sahaja. Pelajar hanya bersifat reproduction iaitu menghafal konsep penting dan meluahkan jawapan yang betul dalam peperiksaan (Wenning, 2002). Mageswari, Zurida & Norita (2007) telah menerangkan bahawa kemerosotan kurikulum kimia kerana pelajar kimia kurang memberi penekanan kepada KBAT dan hanya menghafal dan mengingat sahaja. Ia turut disokong oleh Lawson (2002) yang menjelaskan pelajar hanya mefokuskan kepada peperiksaan dan hanya perlu mengetahui jawapan yang betul tetapi pelajar tidak mahu berfikir. Di sekolah, mata pelajaran elektif seperti (biologi, kimia dan fizik) lebih menekankan pembelajaran tradisional iaitu pembelajaran berpusat guru dan pelajar akan menyalin nota ringkas atau latihan (Rajendran, 2001; Yoong Suan & Aminah, 2005). Guru juga salah anggap bahawa KBAT adalah proses 274 275 pembelajaran yang boleh diguna pakai oleh pelajar yang pintar dan tidak sesuai untuk semua jenis pelajar. Maka, guru kurang memberi penekanan kepada KBAT dalam PdP dan kurang mengalakkan pelajar untuk menyoal (Philip, 1992). Selain itu, penglibatan pelajar dalam aktiviti makmal seperi menjalankan eksperimen, menulis laporan, membuat hipotesis adalah amat lemah kerana penggunaan kemahiran berfikir aras rendah (KBAR) berbanding KBAT sebagaimana yang dikemukakan oleh Domain (1999). Menurut Zohar (2004), guru sebagai agen menghantar maklumat atau fakta dan pelajar tidak membina fakta daripada sumber lain unruk meningkatkan KBAT. Shariha (2005) menyatakan kemahiran proses sains adalah pada tahap yang lemah dan penglibatkan dalam KBAT kurang digalakkan. KBAT juga memerlukkan guru mengajar untuk merangsang pelajar berfikir secara eksplisit ketika menjalankan pembelajaran dan pengajaran yang kurang dilaksanakan oleh guruguru. (Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia, 2012). Ia menimbulkan persoalan apakah tahap KBAT di kalangan pelajar di Malaysia sebenarnya? Justeru itu, masalah ini perlu diatasi melalui strategi pengutaraan masalah. Membangunkan Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi (KBAT) melalui Strategi Pengutaraan Masalah Strategi pengutaraan masalah adalah menjana masalah baru atau mencipta semula satu masalah yang sedia ada (Duncker, 1945). Strategi ini memberi peluang kepada pelajar untuk menemui masalah baru dan menyelesaikan dengan yakin. English (1997) menjelaskan bahawa pendekatan strategi pengutaraan masalah dapat membantu pelajar meningkatkan keyakinan dan kesukaan terhadap mata pelajaran matematik. Proses yang mengarahkan pelajar untuk membina soalan daripada kehidupan harian, situasi dan sebagainya. Ia adalah pertukaran tanggungjawab pengutaraan masalah daripada guru kepada pelajar di mana mendorong pelajar untuk pembelajaran kendiri tanpa berpusat guru dan memberi 275 276 peluang kepada pelajar untuk berfikir aras tinggi. Transformasi pendidikan bukan suatu perkara yang mudah dilakukan oleh guru mahupun pelajar sendiri. Namun demikian, kepentingan PPPM 2013 menjadi aspirasi kementerian untuk berupaya bersaing pada peringkat global dan membuat perubahan yang diperlukan harus difahami oleh guru. Guru hendak menyediakan suasana yang mampu merangsang pelajar untuk turut berfikir aras tinggi dengan mendorong pelajar memikirkan tentang aoa yang mereka belajar jauh lebih lama dari masa di kelas. Di sekolah, guru harus giat dan memiliki ilmu pengetahuan agar menyebatikan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi dalam proses penbelajaran dan pengajaran. Dalam Taksonomi Bloom, kemahiran berfikir atas tinggi dirujuk kepada empat aras teratas iaitu mengaplikasi, menganalisa, menilai dan mencipta (Bloom, 1956). Fenomena sekolah kini, guru hanya mengikat daya pemikiran pelajar dalam aras terbawah iaitu memahami dan menghafal. Apabila pelajar mampu menghafal maka tiada peluang untuk daya pemikiran kritikal dan guru mengejar silibus matapelajaran. Sesiapa sahaja boleh menghafal tanpa memahami sesuatu konsep. Selain itu, kebanyakan pihak masih kurang arif dan keliru dengan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi apatah dan cara mempraktikkan kemahiran ini dalam pengajaran dan pembelajaran di sekolah. Pengajaran dan pembelajaran kimia di dalam bilik darjah dimonopoli oleh guru dengan memberi segala fakta dan menjadi pelajar menjadi pasif. Guru harus dilatih untuk menwujudkan suasana di bilik darjah untuk penerapan pemikiran yang meluas dan mendalam semasa pembelajaran dan pengajaran. Soalan yang memerlukan kemahiran yang tinggi bagi membolehkan pelajar mengaplikasi, menganalisa, mensintesis dan menilai suatu maklumat daripada sekadar menyatakan semula fakta. Menurut English (1997) strategi pengutaraan masalah dalam mata pelajaran matematik telah mula diterapkan dapat membantu pelajar mengembangkan keyakinan dan kesukaan terhadap mata pelajaran matematik. Strategi ini meningkatkan pemikiran pelajar ke tahap yang tinggi dan dikembangkan pada mata pelajaran yang 276 277 lain. Pelajar giat mengutarakan soalan mengikut pengetahuan dan menyelesaikan masalah dengan kemampuan pelajar. Dengan ini, pelajar akan mampu berfikir dengan kritikal dan kreatif serta mencari jawapan sendiri tanpa bertanya kepada guru sahaja. Salah satu faktor yang mendorong mencapai KBAT dan mampu menyelesaikan soalan yang memcabar dalam TIMSS dan PISA adalah mengunakan strategi yang tetap untuk mengukur tahap pelajar iaitu strategi pengutaraan masalah. Strategi dalam Pengutaraan Masalah Strategi pengutaraan masalah merupakan pembelajaran dan banyak digunakan dalam bidang matematik. Ia berfungsi untuk mendorong keefektifan belajar secara kendiri dalam kalangan pelajar bukan sekadar menerima namun berusaha dengan gigih untuk mencari dan meningkatkan ilmu pengetahuan. Strategi ini menguji kemampuan pelajar untuk membuat pelbagai jenis soalan mengikut tahap di dalam Taksonomi Bloom secara optimum. Hasil kajian Silver dan Cai (1996) menunjukkan bahawa pengutaraan masalah adalah suatu strategi yang berkolerasi positif dengan kemahiran menyelesaikan masalah dan pengembangan kemampuan pelajar. Strategi pengutaraan masalah dan pengetahuan prosedur adalah suatu pengukuran yang baik untuk mengenal pasti kebolehpercayaan KBAT. Secara tidak langsung, mengembangkan suatu masalah melalui pengubalan soalan, menambahkan data-data baru, menghilangkan beberapa data, mengubah pembolehubah atau membentuk masalah baru berdasarkan pada idea-idea yang sudah ada (NCTM, 2000) Chistou et. al (2005) menyatakan pengutaraan masalah dikategorikan kepada menyunting, memilih, memahami dan menterjemahkan manakala Cruz Ramirez (2006) mencadangkan pengutaraan masalah dalam matematik kepada enam cara iaitu memilih, mengelaskan, mengumpul, mencari, mengubah dan menimbulkan masalah. Pelajar akan membina soalan sendiri dengan menggunakan perkataan, ayat, dan bahasa secara sendiri 277 278 berkaitan masalah yang diberikan (Dickerson, 1999). Strategi pengutaraan masalah akan merangsang pelajar untuk berfikir aras tinggi dan memudahkan proses pembelajaran dan pengajaran. Md. Nor and Ilfi (2012) menjelaskan bahawa pelajar menengah atas mempunyai kebolehan pengutaraan masalah dengan menjana pelbagai soalan. Menyedari potensi kekuatan strategi pengutaraan masalah dalam membangunkan KBAT ini, kajian terhadap strategi pengutaraan masalah pelajar perlu dilakukan. Ia juga dapat menwujudkan hubungan dengan KBAT dalam kalangan pelajar dan akan difokuskan dalam kajian ini. Jenis-jenis pengutaraan masalah Pengutaraan masalah ialah satu bahagian yang penting dalam proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran serta cara memulakan pengutaraan soal dengan pengetahuan sedia ada yang memperkembangkan idea-idea yang baru. Dalam kajian Clasen dan Bonk (1990), ,menjelaskan bagi menransangkan pemikiran pelajar dengan banyak strategi wujud yang boleh memberi impak kepada pelajar dan soalan uang diutarakan oleh guru mempunyai kesan impak yang terbesar. Secara langung dan tidak langsung, tahap pemikiran pelajar akan berkadar langsung dengan tahap persoalan yang diajukan oleh guru. In disebabkan guru harus merancang strategi yang membangunkan setiap tahap dengan pelbagai jenis-jenis pengutaraan soalan. Biasanya, pelajar memerlukan pengalaman yang peringkat tinggi untuk menjawab soalan aras tinggi. Chin, C. (2002) menyiasat sesuatu mesti terlebih dahulu mengemukakan masalah melalui pertanyaan soalan atau pengutaraan masalah tetapi ia menjadi sukar bagi ramai pelajar telah biasa dengan masalah yang diberikan. Kajian Limbach & Waugh (2010), memfokuskan pembelajaran melalui pengutaraan masalah dan teknik ini akan menggalakkan pembangunan pemikiran pelajar daripada satu tahap ke tahap yang lebih tinggi. Salah satu kategori pengutaraan masalah yang ringkas terbahagi kepada dua jenis soalan iaitu soalan tertumpu 278 279 (convergent) dan soalan tercapah (divergent). Soalan-soalan tertumpu bersifat lebih berkhusus dan mengikut Taksonomi Bloom (Benjamin Bloom, 1956) serta semakannya semula oleh Anderson dan Krathwohl (2001), tahap pemikiran pelajar hanya menguji kemahiran berfikir aras rendah iaitu memahami, mengingat dan aplikasi sahaja di mana hanya jawapan yang munasabah ialah satu atau dua jawapan. Ilnu pengetahuan pelajar akan ada pada tahap yang terbatas dan soalan seperti ini gagal untuk mencabar minda yang hanya akan meletakkan pelajar dalam keadan terkurung dalam tempurung. Manakala soalan tercapah (divergent), memerlukan jawapan yang meluas yang merangkumi kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi iaitu analisis, menilai dan mencipta termasuk soalan terbuka yang menggalakan pembelajaran yang berpusat kepada pelajar. (Theijsmeijet, 2009). Seterusnya. Silver (1997) menyatakan pengutaraan masalah terbahagi kepada tiga cara yang berbeza iaitu sebelum penyelesaian, semasa penyelesaian masalah dan akhirnya selepas penyelesaian masalah. Kesemua cara ini mengandungi pelbagai aktiviti misalnya menghasil semula masalah, masalah yang berbeza atau menghasilkan masalah asal daripada masalah yang sedia ada dan membuat taksiran yang baru dengan mengubah matlamat bagi menwujudkan masalah baru. (Silver dan Cai, 1997). Dapatan kajian menunjukkan kejayaan strategi pengutaraan masalah terletak di tangan pelajar dan guru semata-mata kerana strategi merupakan proses yang meluas yang meliputi penyelesaian masalah. Kedua-dua pihak harus berkerjasama dan mencapai maltamat unruk menjayakan meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi. Keberkesaan Strategi Pengutaraan Masalah Strategi perubahan konsep membantu mengenalpasti pengutaraan masalah melalui Rajah 2.3 yang dijelaskan oleh Akay’s (2006). Kajian dengan mefokuskan kepada Situasi Bebas Pengutaraan Masalah (Free Problem Posing Situation), Situasi Semi-Konstruk 279 280 Pengutaraan masalah dan Konstruk Pengutaraan Masalah. Yuan & Sriraman (2010) membincangkan telah situasi bebas pengutaraan masalah bermaskud jika pelajar diminta mereka masalah baru daripada keadaan semuala jadi atau tiruan dan pertanyaan soalan melalui strategi ini tanpa seberapa sekatan. Contohnya, guru sentiasa mengaitkan topik pembelajaran dengan situasi yang sama setiap hari akan memudahkan pelajar pengutaraan masalah atau pengajuan soalan dan strategi ini lebih berkesan. (Akay, 2006). Rajah 2.3 : Skema Pengutaraan masalah Adalah penting, strategi kedua iaitu situasi semi-konstruk pengutaraan masalah yang mendorong pelajar menyatakan pengetahuan sedia ada bagi menyiapkan sesuatu situasi dan struktur situasi berikut. Pelajar membuat pertanyaan yang meliputi berdasarkan gambar atau grafik serta masalah yang serupa. (Pittalis et al, 2004). Manakala situasi konstruk pengutaraan masalah, aktiviti yang bersama beberapa masalah di mana pelajar boleh pengutaraan soalan melalui pengubahan formula telah diselesaikan atau pertukaran keadaan soalan yang diajukan oleh pelajar. Strategi pengutaraan masalah dalam bidang pembelajaran akan mendorong pergerakan kurikulum dan beberapa perubahan dalam kurikulum akan membuahkan hasik yang berkesan (Akay, 2006). Kebanyakan kajian sebelum ini membuktikan keberkesanan strategi pengutaraan masalah bergantung kepada bilangan solan 280 281 yang ditanya oleh pelajar dan menjawab soalan (Dori dan Herscovitz, 1999). Strategi pengutaraan masalah akan membantu pelajar menjana masalah dan mencari jawab yang wajar serta sekaligus meningkatkan daya pemikiran. Kaberman dan Dori (2009) menerangkan bahawa pengelasan soalan mengikut Taksonomi Bloom akan memudahkan pelajar untuk meningkatkan strategi pengutaraan masalah dan penyoal soalan yang cabar serta proses pengutaraan masalah tidak berlaku secara automatik dan pertanyaan soalan. Terdapat pergerakan yang baru berkaitan dengan mengajar serta perubahan tertentu dalam kurikulum pembelajaran. (Yuan & Sriraman, 2010). PERNYATAAN MASALAH Malaysia terlibat dalam TIMSS dan PISA bagi membuktikan tahap pencapaian pelajar dan mutu kurikulum pendidikan dalam beberapa mata pelajaran sa matematik dan sains di peringkat antarabangsa. Merujuk keputusan pentaksiran antarabangsa ini, bilangan skor ’A’ dalam peperiksaan umum Malaysia tidak pasti pelajar tersebut mempunyai pemikiran yang kritis dan kreatif. Pencapaian dalam TIMSS dan PISA yang kurang memuaskan telah membuka mata semua pihak untuk mengkaji kurikulum pendidikan Malaysia dan penekanan terhadap KBAT. Kajian ini menfokuskan kepada empat proses kognitif dalam Taksonomi Bloom iaitu aplikasi, analisis, penilaian dan mencipta dikenali sebagai kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi. Cabaran dalam kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi (KBAT) tidak boleh diketepikan dan pihak yang tidak memahami konsep dengan baik akan keliru. Bagi menjana KBAT secara meluas di seluruh dunia, pelbagai strategi dilaksanakan seperti strategi pengutaraan masalah yang akan membangun KBAT agar melahirkan modal insan berkaliber. Kemahiran ini akan memberi kesan yang baik dalam jangka masa yang panjang dan penerapan strategi pengutaraan masalah akan mengukur kebolehan dan pencapaian pelajar. Namun, kebanyakan kajian yang dijalankan kurang memberi penekanaan 281 282 dalam KBAT. Menurut, Dillon (1990) bahawa soalan-soalan yang harus dituju dalam dua hala iaitu di antara pelajar dan guru. Tetapi fenomena di sekolah pula, guru masih lebih cenderung mengamalkan pembelajaran tradisional iaitu proses sehala di mana guru berada di depan kelas mengajar dan pelajar akan hanya menyalin nota dan menghafal. Penyampian ilmu sehala akan menyebabkan pelajar menjadi pasif dan jika tidak berlaku perubahan yang ketara maka akan gagal hasrat PPPM, 2013. Dapatan analisis kajian menunjukkan, kajian mengenai KBAT tidak mefokuskan kepada penyelesaian yang munasabah seperti strategi pengutaraan masalah dan bersifat umum. Malah kewujudan KBAT menjadi tidak penting kerana tidak dikaitan dengan strategi pengutaraan masalah dan tiada kajian yang dapat melihat dalam Sukatan Pelajaran Kimia Tingkatan Empat. Justeru itu, kajian ini wajarkan penyelidikan terhadap strategi pengutaraan masalah bagi meningkatkan KBAT dalam mata pelajaran Kimia. Ini kerana strategi pengutaraan masalah diterapkan ke dalam KBAT akan membuka peluang yang baik untuk membangunkan suasana pembelajaran dan pengajaran secara efektif. Persekitaran dan aktiviti di dalam kelas yang berkesan akan merangsang pelajar bagi mempunyai KBAT. Pelajar akan berfikir aras tinggi apabila diberi peluang untuk pengutaraan masalah secara sendiri dan pembelajaran dan pengajaran akan terancang dan sistematik (Anderson & Krathwohl, 2001) OBJEKTIF KAJIAN Objektif kajian merangkumi : i. Mengenalpasti tahap kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi (KBAT) dalam kalangan pelajar kimia. ii. Mengenal pasti strategi pengutaraan masalah dalam kalangan pelajar kimia. iii. Menentukan jenis-jenis pengutaraan masalah yang diaplikasikan oleh pelajar kimia. 282 283 iv. v. Menentukan hubung kait di antara startegi pengutaraan masalah dan meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi. Mengenalpasti proses pengutaraan masalah dalam kalangan pelajar kimia. PERSOALAN KAJIAN Persoalan kajian ini adalah yang ingin dikaji ialah i. Apakah tahap kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi dalam kalangan pelajar kimia? ii. Apakah strategi pengutaraan masalah dalam kalangan pelajar kimia? iii. Apakah jenis-jenis pengutaraan masalah yang diaplikasikan oleh pelajar kimia? iv. Bagaimanakah hubungkait di antara strategi pengutaraan masalah dan meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi? v. Apakah proses pengutaraan masalah dalam kalangan pelajar kimia? KERANGKA TEORI KAJIAN Kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi dan strategi pengutaraan masalah merupakan teras asas kepada kajian ini. Kerangka teori ini merangkumi penerapan strategi pengutaraan masalah untuk meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi (KBAT) dalam mata pelajaran kimia. Berdasarkan KBAT oleh Bahagian Pembangunan Kurikulum (2013), konsep utama item KBAT merupakan item yang menguji keupayaan murid untuk mengaplikasi pengetahuan, kemahiran, dan menilai dalam membuat penaakulan dan refleksi agar menyelesaikan masalah, membuat keputusan, inovasi dan berupaya mencipta sesuatu. Kajian ini berteraskan teori konstruktivisme yang percaya pelajar mempunyai idea daripada pengetahuan terdahulu sebelum memasuki bilik darjah (Martin, 2006). Pelajar akan membuat kesinambungan di antara 283 284 pengetahuan sebelum dan pembelajaran yang terbaru bagi mengubahsuai konsep dan mereka menjadi lebih kompleks dan berfikir pada tahap yang lrbih tinggi. Ia juga sejajar dengan pendapat Piaget bahawa skema berkembang menjadi lebih kompleks dalam beradaptasi dengan persekitaraan pelajar. Mengikut pendekatan teori konstruktivisme, guru akan berperanan sebagai fasilitator yang mendorong pelajar untuk mengaktifkan diri ketika menjalankan pembelajaran dan pengajaran seperti sesi soal jawab dan mengalakkan pelajar mencipta dengan merangsang persoalan kepada pelajar. Dalam Taksonomi Bloom, terbahagi kepada dua kategori penting iaitu KBAT dan KBAR seperti ditunjukkan dalam Rajah 1.1 (Bloom, 1956). Newmann (1990) menyatakan bahawa pemikiran aras tinggi mencabar pelajar untuk menginterpretasi, menganalisis atau memanipulasikan maklumat. KBAT adalah kemahiran yang aras paling tinggi dalam hierarki proses kognitif dan pencetusan idea. Pemikiran aras tinggi memerlukan ciri-ciri seperti kreatif, kritis, logik dan metakognitif manakala pemikiran aras rendah hanya kefahaman dan pengetahuan. Rajah 1.4 : Proses kognitif dalam Taksonomi Bloom English (1997) telah memgembangkan model penbelajaran strategi pengutaraan masalah bagi membantu pelajar 284 285 meningkatkan keyakinan dan kesukaan terhadap matematik, sebab idea-idea matematik pelajar akan dicubakan untuk memahami masalah yang sedang diselesaikan serta dapat mencapai penyelesaian masalah. Peringkat awal , strategi pengutaraan masalah hanya diterapkan dalam mata pelajaran matematik dan mula dikembang mata pelajaran lain seperti sains, kimia, fizik, dan biologi. Pembelajaran sains yang baik adalah bergantung kepada bertanya soalan yang betul dan mencari jawapan yang betul dan pertanyaan soalan yang baik adalah elemen penting dalam pembelajaran efektif (Orr, 1999). Silver dan Cai menunjukkan bahawa pengutaraan masalah akan dapat diaplikasi kepada peringkat tiga seperti i. Peringkat awal pengutaraan masalah Pelajar akan hanya membuat pertanyaan asas berdasarkan situasi yang diberikan. ii. Peringkat pertengahan pengutaraan masalah Pelajar mampu merumuskan pelbagai sub persoalan baru dari persoalan yang belum diselesaikan . iii. Peringkat akhir pengutaraan masalah Pelajar akan memodifikasikan persoalan yang telah diselesaikan dan mencipta soalan yang terbaru berdasarkan situasi KERANGKA KONSEP KAJIAN Kerangka konsep kajian ini dibina mengikut beberapa konsep iaitu menggabungkan KBAT dan strategi pengutaraan masalah yang selaras dengan objektif kajian. Pada awal kajian, pengkaji mengenalpasti KBAT dalam kalangan pelajar kimia dengan pelajar berjaya menjawab soalan aras tinggi dan mampu menyelesaikan masalah, mengenalpasti strategi pengutaraan masalah dengan pelajar berjaya boleh menyoal berdasarkan situasi yang diberikan, menentukan jenis-jenis pengutaraan masalah dengan persoalan pelajar yang dijawab mengikut skala Taksonomi Bloom dan akhirnya menentukan hubung kait di antara strategi pengutaraan 285 286 masalah dan KBAT serta proses pengutaraan masalah. Cai (1997) mencadang bahawa alat pengukuran yang paling sesuai untuk menguji tahap kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi dan kebolehan pembelajaran adalah strategi pengutaraan masalah. Rajah 1.5 merujuk kepada perhubungan antara KBAT dan strategi pengutaraan masalah serta penggabungan menjadi satu konsep yang akan membuka pemikiran yang meluas dan mendalam. Secara keseluruhan, kajian ini akan memberi harapan yang baru kepada guru bagi meningkatkan dan mengenalpasti pelajar KBAT dengan mudah. Pelajar bukan lagi akan dilatih untuk menghafal dan memahami sesuatu fakta kimia malah membimbang pelajar untuk mengemukakan soalan-soalan yang mengikut situasi yang diberikan. Secara tidak langsung, proses pengutaraan masalah ini menjadi panduan kepada para guru dan pelajar dan mengalakkan pelajar untuk berfikir dan pengutaraan soalan tanpa mendesak serta menyelesaikan soalan dengan pemikiran yang luas. Rajah 1.5 : Kerangka konsep kajian berdasarkan KBAT dan strategi pengutaraan masalah 286 287 RUJUKAN Adnan Ahmad, Mimi Mohaffyza Mohamad & Kamalularifin Suhari (2006). Aplikasi corak pembelajaran kemahiran berfikir secara kreatif dan kritis di kalangan pelajar dalam subjek pengajian kejuruteraan awam sekolah menengah teknik negeri Johor. Latihan Ilmiah. Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Akay, H., & Boz, N. (2010). The Effect of Problem Posing Oriented Analyses-II Course on the Attitudes Toward Mathematics and Mathematics Self-Efficacy of Elementary Prospective Mathematics Teachers. Australian Journal of Teacher Education. 3(2): 59–75. Alias Baba (1998). Pemetaan Konsep : Satu Strategi Pengajaran Pembelajaran . UKM:Bangi. Anderson, L. W., & Krathwohl, D. R. (Eds.). (2001). A taxonomy for learning, teaching and assessing: A revision of Bloom's Taxonomy of educational outcomes: Complete edition, New York : Longman. Bahagian Pembangunan Kurikulum (2013). Kurikulum Standard Sekolah Rendah : Sains Tahun Satu. Kuala Lumpur: Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia. Bahagian Perancangan dan Penyelidikan Dasar Pendidikan , Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia (2004). TIMSS-2003 Trends in International Mathematics and Science Study-2003. Putrajaya: Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia. Bloom B. S. (1956). Taxonomy of Educational Objectives, Handbook I: The Cognitive Domain. New York: David McKay Co Inc. Cai, J. (1997). Beyond computation and correctness: Contributions of open-ended tasks in examining U.S. and Chinese students’ mathematical performance. Educational Measurement: Issues and Practice, 16(1), 5-11. Christou, C. (2005). An Empirical Taxonomy of Problem Posing Processes. ZDM, 37(3), 149-158. Clasen, D. R. & Bonk, C. (1990). Teachers Tackle Thinking. Madison, WI: Madison Education Extension Program. Chin, C., Goh, N. K., Chia, L. S., Lee, K. W. L. & Soh, K. C. (1994). Pre-service teachers' use of problem-solving in primary science. Research in Science Education, 24,41-50. Cruz Ramirez, M. (2006). A Mathematical Formulating Strategy. International Journal for Mathematics Teaching and Learning, 287 288 ISSM1473-0111, December. Dickerson, V.,M. (1999). The impact of Problem-Posing instruction on the mathematical Problem Solving achievement of seventhgraders. Doctoral Dissertation: Emory University: Umi Microform9931793. Dillon, J.T. (1990). The Practice of Questioning. Routledge, London. Dori, Y. J., & Herscovitz, O. (1999). Question posing capability as an alternative evaluation method: Analysis of an environmental case study. Journal of research in Science Teaching, 36, 411-430. Duncker, K. (1945). On problem solving. Psychological Monographs, 58(5), 270. English, L. D. (1997). The development of fifth-grade children’s problem-posing abilities. Educational Studies in Mathematics, 34, 183-217. English, Lyn D. (1997). Promoting A Problem Posing Classroom. Teaching Children Mathematics, November 1997. p.172-179. Gabel, Dorothy (1999). Improving Teaching and Learning through Chemistry Education Research, a Look to the Future, Journal of Chemical Education 76(4), 548-554. Lawson, A. E. (2003). The Nature and Development of HypotheticoPredictive Argumentation With Implications For Science Teaching. International Journal of Science Education. 25(11): 1387-1408. Limbach & Waugh (2010). Developing Higher Level Thinking. Journal of instructional Pedagogies. http://www.aabri.com/OC09manuscripts/OC09060.pdf Diakses pada 15 Mei 2014. Kaberman, Z & Dori, Y.J. (2009). Metacognition in chemical education : Question posing in the case-based computerized learning environment. Instruction Science, 37, 403-436. Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia (2012). http://web.moe.gov.my/bpk/v2/download/HOTs/Status%20Pencapaian% 20Malaysia%20 Dalam%20TIMSS%20dan%20PISA.pdf Diakses pada 20 September 2013. Kurikulum Standard Sekolah Menengah (KSSM). (2011). http://www.moe.gov.my/bpk/v@/index.php. Diakses pada 9 Ogos 2014. 288 289 Mageswari K, Zurida Ismail dan Norita Mohamed (2007). Reorientasi kurikulum kimia KBSM ke arah kurikulum lestari. Prosiding Seminar Kebangsaan Isu-isu Pendidikan Negara ke-3: Dasar dan Pelaksanaan, 13-14 Februari 2007, UKM. Martin, V. B. (2006). The Postmodern Turn: Shall Classic Grounded Theory Take that Detour? The Grounded Theory Review, 5, 119-128. Md. Nor, B., & Ilfi, N. (2012). The role of metacognitive abilities in posing mathematical problem. Journal of Science and Mathmatical education, 5. National Council of Teachers of Mathematics (NCTM). Commission on Standards for School Mathematics. (2000). Curriculum and evaluation standards for school mathematics. Reston, VA: Author. Newmann, F. M. (1990). Higher order thinking in teaching social studies: A rationale for the assessment of classroom thoughtfulness. Journal of Curricular Studies, 22(3), 53-75. Orr, H. A. (1999). An evolutionary Dead End? Science, 285, 343-344. Pittalis, M., Christou C., Mousoulides, N.& Pitta- Pantazi, D., 2004, A Structural Model For Problem Posıng. Proceedings of the 28th Conference of the International Group for the Physicology of Mathematics Education, 4, 49- 56. Diakses pada 24 November 2013, from http://www.kurims.kyotou.ac.jp/EMIS/proceedings/PME28/RR/RR058_Pittalis.pdf Pusat Perkembangan Kurikulum, (2001). Kemahiran Berfikir Dalam Pengajaran- Pembelajaran. Pusat Perkembangan Kurikulum, Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia. Rajendran.(2001). Pengajaran kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi: kesediaan guru mengendalikan proses pengajaran pembelajaran. Kertas kerja. Seminar/ pameran projek KBKK. Selvaratnam, Mailoo (1983). Student's Mistakes in Problem Solving. Sri Lanka: University of Peradeniya. Silver, E. A. & Cai, J. (1997) An analysis of arithmetic problem posing by middle school students. Journal for Research in Mathematics Education, Vol27(5), pp.521-539. Theijsmeijer, Heather R. (2009). The Art of Questioning. Canadian Astronomy Education. Diakses pada 16 Julai 2014, nfrom http://www.cascaeducation.ca/files/proAstro_questions.html Wenning, C. J. (2005). Implementing Inquiry-Based Instruction in The 289 290 Science Classroom: A New Model for Solving the Improvement of Practice Problem. Journal of Physics Teaching Education Online, 2(4). Yuan, X., & Sriraman, B. (2011). An exploratory study of relationships between students’ creativity and mathematical problem-posing abilities. In B. Sriraman, & K.H. Lee (Eds). The elements of creativity and giftedness in mathematics (pp.5-28). Rotterdam, the Nertherlands: Diakses pada 19 Ogos 2013. http://dx.doi.org/10-1007/978-946091-439-3_2 Yoong Suan & Aminah Ayob (2005). Students’ attitudes toward science, teachnology and environment issues: Malaysian prespective and international comparison. Prosiding Seminar Pendidikan 2005: Pendidikan untuk Pembangunan Lestari, 28-30 Ogos 2005, USM. Zohar, A., & Dori, Y.J. ((2003). Higher order thinking skills and lowachieving students: Are they Mutually exclusive?. The Journal of the Learning Science, 12(2), 145-181. 290 291 PATTERNS OF TEACHING APPROACH ADOPTED BY PRESERVICE TEACHERS IN TEACHING WRITING Sarala @ Thulasi Palpanadan, Fauziah Ismail & Abdul Rahim Salam ABSTRACT Product and process writing approaches are widely used around the world by teachers and students in language learning. The existing literature favours process writing approach due to its practicality and robustness. However, it has been observed that Malaysian schools have a culture where teachers prefer to use product approach in teaching writing. This paper investigates on two different writing approaches: product approach and process approach used by teachers at primary school level in Johor Bahru, Johor, Malaysia. The study aimed to find out the preservice teachers’ preferred writing approaches used for teaching writing at primary level and the effects towards students’ writing orientation. A case study method was chosen to investigate the practices. Classroom observations and students’ written texts provided data for the study. The findings revealed that majority of the preservice teachers used product approach in their teaching and majority of the students were found to follow the product writing approach. The paper suggests that teachers should be encouraged to adopt 292 process approach in teaching writing because it is not widely practiced in the writing classroom. This is because literature has highlighted that process approach can promote students to be independent writers which is one of the aims of the contemporary education. Keywords: Product approach, Process approach, Primary schools, Writing skills INTRODUCTION English is taught as a second language in all national schools at primary and secondary levels in Malaysia. The fact that English acts as one of the most powerful languages in the world is also acknowledged in Malaysia (Akinwamide, 2012). English is categorized as a compulsory subject in Malaysian schools. However, the government is also very concerned about the present low standard of English among Malaysian students (Normazidah, Koo, and Hazita, 2012). Many actions are taken mainly by schools to enhance the command of English. One of the most difficult areas in mastering the language is the writing skills (Nesamalar, Saratha, and Teh, (2001). In addition, writing is also perceived as a more difficult skill to teach compared to its counterparts (Akinwamide, 2012). Product and process approaches are two prevailing approaches that are widely employed in teaching writing in the ESL writing instructions (Badger and White, 2000). However, these writing approaches practised by English as a Second Language (ESL) writing teachers in Malaysian classrooms have gone through several paradigm shifts due to the changes in the practicability of the writing instruction as set by the Ministry of Education (MOE). Teaching writing approaches and the strategies used by the teachers in teaching writing and the way the students comprehend the lesson needs further investigation. This paper reports a part of the full research carried out on writing instructions. It presents the patterns 293 of teaching approaches adopted by preservice teachers in teaching writing during their teaching practicum and how the writing instruction affects the students’ writing. APPROACHES TO TEACHING WRITING THE PRODUCT APPROACH Researchers claim that product approach encourages students to produce an end product which may be identical to a model essay or the essay provided by the teachers. The main focus is on linguistic knowledge (Pincas, 1982a). Students imitate some simple sentences to get familiarized with the content, copy and finally transform the models into a new essay to be as perfect as the one that they have imitated by focusing on the correct language. Then, students submit their essays to the teachers to be marked. After doing the necessary corrections students resubmit their essays. According to Steele (2004:1), product approach comprises four stages (familiarisation, controlled writing, guided writing, and free writing. Before the 1970s, product approach which focuses on the text features of model texts was commonly used as the writing instruction. Rules of grammar governed the nature of this traditional notion of writing instructional discourse (Nystrand, 2006). However, due to abundant critique about this approach which is very model based, the language and education specialists began to take note of individual learning and processes of the mind which are crucial in developing the writing skills. Thus, an alternative teaching approach to product approach is viewed as necessary. THE PROCESS APPROACH In 1970s and 1980s, a concern in the writing process surfaced. The 294 process writing approaches were employed in classroom with the attention to content prior to form (Raimes, 1991). Process approach is cyclical, where students need to move back and forth from one stage to another while participating in the writing activities. The focal point is the writer and the writing process. The emphasis is on the linguistic skills such as planning and drafting prior to linguistic knowledge such as grammar and text structure (Badger and White 2000). The writing development is expected to take place unconsciously as teachers facilitate the activities in various stages. Although there are many models in process writing generally, Steele (2004:1) highlighted “eight stages in the process writing (Brainstorming, planning, mind mapping, first draft, peer feedback, editing, final draft, and evaluation and feedback)”. The central issue about this approach is that it involves several drafts before students produce the final draft. The process approach seems to be time-consuming. Generally, teachers are unable to complete the writing activities within the time allocated to teach writing in a week. In addition, teachers need ample time to read and mark all the drafts prepared by the students which increases their workload. Consequently, teachers give it up at the expense of finishing the syllabus on time as set by their institutions. Research has found that teachers gradually regressed to the product approach in the ESL writing instruction in the 1990s (Foo, 2007). Hence, teachers started practicing the product approach as a way to ease their task in introducing essays of many genres that could help them to cover the syllabus on time. However, some research conducted on teaching writing shows that process approach helps students to do well in improving their writing tasks (Majid, Mohamad Jafre, Cheong, 2012. Hossein and Nasrin, (2012) stated that their study proved a significant differences among learners’ writing ability in terms of product approach and process approach where students who were exposed to process writing approach obtained a better score in the final writing assignments compared to those who were taught writing using the product approach. Tangkiengsirin, (2006) argued that product approach is insufficient to be practiced as a writing 295 instruction due to its constraints and supported process approach as it helped students to develop students’ writing proficiency. Majid, Mohamad Jafre, Cheong, (2012) highlighted that their study on three Form One Students revealed that process writing helped students to improve their pace of writing and quality of writing in terms of ideas, organization, sentence fluency and score. Their study also highlighted the importance of writing instructions in the classroom, where teachers need to guide students to practice process writing while teaching writing. In an earlier study, Tangkiensirin (2006) has already suggested to carry out further research to deeply apprehend about students’ way of approaching writing tasks as well as in knowing the way they learn to write. This paper intends to study the preservice teachers’ teaching patterns of teaching writing and investigates the effects of the approach used by them on students’ writing. This paper hopes to highlight the current practices in writing instruction at primary level and suggests some strategies to be incorporated in writing instruction as a way to improve students’ writing. RESEARCH QUESTIONS The aim of the study is to answer the following research questions below: 1. What teaching approaches are practiced by preservice teachers to teach writing at primary school level in Johor Bahru, Johor, Malaysia? 2. What is the effect of using a process or product approach on students’ writing at primary level in Johor Bahru, Johor, Malaysia METHODOLOGY This study used a case study method. Case study is a useful method in investigating in depth a specific phenomenon. Case is a 296 popularly used qualitative research method (Gay, Mills & Airasian, 2009). For this purpose, five (n=5) out of thirty two preservice teachers (N=32) from a Teacher Training Institute in Johor Bahru, Johor, Malaysia, were selected as participants using purposive sampling method. The participants were Semester Seven preservice teachers who went for their teaching practicum in the national primary schools in a particular district of Johor, Malaysia. It is believed that these preservice teachers can provide the best information on the issue under study (Creswell & Clark, 2007).The preservice teachers were selected based on homogenous factor of those who were teaching English to the same level of Year Three students under the Primary School Standard Curriculum or Kurikulum Standard Sekolah Rendah (KSSR) system. PROCEDURE Classroom observations and students’ written texts provided data for the study. First, the participants were observed when they were teaching writing in their respective classes and field notes were taken. Five preservice teachers were observed three times each, which made a total of fifteen observations with fifteen sets of field notes. This was done to quantify the teaching approaches employed by the participants and to note their preferences on the approach used as writing instruction in the classrooms. The participants were observed when they were teaching writing and field notes were taken to note the features of writing strategies practiced by the participants. The strategies used by the participants based on the teaching strategies of a particular approach were identified and listed. Then, they were quantified to note the preferred approach that is usually used by the preservice teachers in the writing lessons. Second, five students’ written texts were randomly collected at the end of each observation which made a total of 75 written texts. The written work was analyzed according to the features of the approach that students used in preparing the tasks assigned by their 297 respective teachers. The aspects of students’ writing that were studied included vocabularies, phrases and sentences. The students’ writing was quantified based on the product and process approaches. The quantity of sentences recorded in students’ writing was considered as an indicator of the approach selected by students in accomplishing the written tasks. The result was hoped to provide information about the effect of preservice teachers’ pattern of teaching approach in teaching writing. ANALYSIS OF DATA To begin with, the first research question is reviewed: Which teaching approaches are practiced by preservice teachers to teach writing at primary school level in Johor Bahru, Johor, Malaysia? The findings based on the field notes taken during the classroom observations would be discussed based the features of product approach and process approach used by the participants. The strategies applied are identified to suit the approach to teach writing lessons to the students. Five preservice teachers were observed as they conducted their writing lessons. Each lesson lasted approximately for one hour. Most of the teacher trainees assigned almost similar writing tasks to their students as they were following the same syllabus provided by Ministry of Education (MOE). Since the data were collected in the same week and month, most of them were teaching almost the same topics at that time. The strategies used by the participants to teach writing throughout the lessons were noted in the field notes. All participants were noted to follow a similar pattern where they conducted all the writing activities in three stages – presentation, practice and production. They introduced a new teaching item or topic to the students during the presentation stage. This strategy was a feature highlighted in the product approach (the familiarization stage) where a sample is modeled to students. Then, the participants assisted students to carry out some writing 298 activities during the practice stage. Students were given some group, pair or individual activities to work on a writing task mainly to get them to be acquainted with the sentence structures or vocabularies that the teacher trainees intended to teach. This strategy suited the controlled writing stage in the product approach where students are given exercises to practise a certain component of the writing lesson. The final writing activity was done during the production stage. Students were given individual writing tasks which were similar to the activity done during the practice stage. These exercises were collected to be marked at the end of the lesson. All the strategies used by the participants could be categorized as features of the product approach. The next section is the review of the second research question: What is the effect of using a process or product approach on students writing at primary level in Johor Bahru, Johor, Malaysia. A total of 75 written texts were randomly collected from students and were analyzed. Generally, filling in the blanks, matching, answering questions and writing sentences were part of the writing activities. Students’ written work were analyzed whether they were done based on the input provided prior to the writing activity (which portrayed product approach) or students’ own ability to write (which portrayed process approach). The input could be the information that the teachers provided, the exercise that the students did during the practice stage or even some referred texts including their textbooks or the worksheet provided by the teachers. Then, students’ writing was quantified based on the way they produced their written work either by using product approach or process approach. The total number of words (vocabularies), phrases and sentences produced by five students from each observation were analyzed and totaled up. Most of the students wrote their tasks based on the teachers’ instructions. The total number of the written tasks produced by students per observation was converted into percentage to obtain the overall scheming of writing produced using the product and process approach. This is shown in Table 1. 299 Table 1: Percentage of Students’ Writing Based on Approach OBSERVATION / PARTICIPANT PD(%) 1 PC(%) PD(%) 2 PC(%) PD(%) 3 PC(%) 1 2 3 4 5 68 100 91 100 100 32 0 9 0 0 100 100 100 100 100 0 0 0 0 0 100 100 100 100 100 0 0 0 0 0 (PD: Product Approach) (PC: Process Approach) The results showed that students usually repeated the writing that they practised earlier or substituted the new tasks by replacing some information from the earlier tasks or the input provided by the participants to students prior to the final writing activity. All these activities resemble the guided writing stage in product approach. Table 1 shows that most of the written work produced by the students was based on product approach. However, there are a small number of students who employed the process approach by producing their own ideas or sentences in their written work which is a feature of process approach where they did not replicate any example from the previous input prior to the final written work. Thus, majority of the students employed product approach in producing their written work as instructed by the teachers. DISCUSSION As mentioned earlier all five preservice teachers observed employed product approach in conducting writing lessons in their respective classes. The analysis showed that using product approach to teach writing is prominent in the primary classes. The participants were confident in delivering the lessons and the lessons flowed smoothly from stage to stage. The first research question was answered where the preservice teachers used product approach as the preferred teaching practice to teach writing. 300 Subsequently, most of the students’ written texts proved that product approach was employed in executing the writing activities. This evidence provides answer to the second research question. Since, teachers’ practices in their writing instructions may influence students’ way of writing (Sahin, Bullock, & Stables, 2002), the preservice teachers’ way of using product approach in teaching writing had influenced their students’ way of writing, which also indicated the product oriented approach. It was evident from the classroom observation that the preservice teachers had construed their lesson plan towards getting their students to reproduce their input in the final writing activity as a way to show the apprehension of the lesson taught on that day which indicated a product oriented writing. The reason behind this was that it enabled them to conduct the lessons that they intended to teach according to the syllabus without any delay in the teaching plan. The participants took it as part of their teaching objectives to enable the students to reproduce the writing component on their own using all the guidance provided by them prior to the writing activity. Meanwhile, a small percentage of process approach was also evident from the study. Based on the text analysis, there was 32 percent of process oriented written work done by the students of participant 1 (preservice teacher 1) during the first observation. Likewise, nine percent of process oriented approach was evident in the written work prepared by the students of participant 3 (preservice teacher 3) during the first observation. These students did not receive any appraisal or extra score from the teachers who marked the written work. The students who tried writing using process approach did all by themselves out of their own interests. The preservice teachers neither encouraged nor discouraged the use of own ideas to their students. Hence, the production of new ideas or independent writing is least focused. Moreover, the subsequent observations carried out on those participants showed that their students prepared the written work fully based on product oriented writing. This study proved that participants did not emphasis process oriented approach in their writing instruction and 301 their students were not exposed to process approach sufficiently. CONCLUSION The study has uncovered that the preservice teachers preferred to employ product approach in teaching writing and they conveniently practised teaching writing in this way. Meanwhile most of the students also employed product approach to do their written work. This is a common scenario in Malaysia especially, in primary classrooms. There are very few students who want to write more than what is required perhaps by the teacher, or for the fear of making mistakes. This scenario indicates that students would develop a dependent habit where they might practice it throughout their lives and will never try to write independently. The study further concludes that in contrast, the preservice teachers do not seem to favour using the process approach which is favored by the literature in the discipline of teaching writing. Even though teachers are able to conduct writing lessons according to the syllabus, the effects on students’ writing is obvious where they prefer to use product approach in their writing and become dependent writers. The paper suggests that process oriented writing that helps students to become independent writers in future should be considered by teachers as their writing instruction in the classroom. Hence, the paper provides an insight into what teachers should try in the classroom in order to enhance students’ ability to write and produce more than what they have provided. This can inculcate the habit of independent writing so that Malaysian students can be independent writers. REFERENCES Akinwamide, T.K. 2012. The influence of Process Approach on English as Second Language Students’ Performances in Essay Writing. 302 ELT. 5(3), 16-29. Badger, R. and White, G. 2000. A process genre approach to teaching writing. ELT Journal, 52(2): 153-160. Creswell, J. W., & Clark, V. L. P. (2007). Designing and conducting mixed methods research. Foo, T.CH.V. 2007. The Effects of the process-genre approach to writing instruction on the expository essays of ESL students in a Malaysian secondary school. Unpublished doctoral dissertation. Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia. Gay, L. R., Mills, G., & Airasian, P. (2009). Educational research: Competencies for analysis and applications (ed.). Columbus, OH: Pearson. Hossein Hashemnezhad & Nasrin Hashemnezhad. 2012. A Comparative Study of Product, Process, and Post-process Approaches in Iranian EFL Students’ Writing Skill. Journal of Language Teaching and Research, 3(4): 722-729. Majid Pour-Mohammadi, Mohamad Jafre Zainol Abidin, and Cheong, L.F. 2012. The Effect of Process Writing Practice on the Writing Quality of Form One Students:A Case Study. Asian Social Science, 8(3): 88-99. Musa, N.C., Lie, K.Y., & Azman, H. 2012. Exploring English Language Learning And Teaching In Malaysia. GEMA OnlineTM Journal of Language Studies, 12 (1), Special Section: 35-51. Naginder Kaur. 2006. Non-autonomy and low-English proficiency among Malaysian Students: Insights from multiple perspectives. In Kamisah Arifin, Mohd. Rozaidi Ismail, Ngo Kea Leng, & Roslina Abdul Aziz. (Eds.), English in the Malaysian context (21-34). Shah Alam: University Publication Centre (UPENA) UiTM.Nesamalar C., Saratha S. & The. 2001. ELT Methodology: Principles and practice. Selangor: Penerbit Fajar Bakti. Nystrand, M. 2006. The social and historical context for wrong research. In C.Macarthur, S Graham & J. Fitzgerald (Eds.), Handbook of Writing Research.New York: Guilford Press Pincas, A. 1982a. Teaching English Writing. London: Macmillian. Raimes, A. 1991. Out of the woods: Emerging traditions in the teaching of writing. TESOL Quarterly, 25: 407-430. Sahin, C., Bullock, K. & Stables, A. 2002. Teachers’ Beliefs and Practices in relation to their Beliefs about Questioning at Key 303 Stage 2. Educational Studies. 28(4): 371-384. Steele, V. 2004. Product and process writing. Retrieved on 10 Mac 2013 from http://www.teachingenglish.english.org.uk/think/write/approache s.html Tankiengsirin, S. 2006. Approaches to Teaching Second Language Writing. Language Institute Journal, 3: 1-26. 304 STAIL PEMBELAJARAN GURU PELATIH DALAM PRAKTIKUM LATIHAN MENGAJAR Nur’Ain Baharin, Mohd Zolkifl Abd Hamid & Dayana Farzeeha Ali ABSTRAK Latihan Mengajar merupakan program yang bertujuan memberikan pendedahan, pengalaman dan kemahiran mengajar di dalam situasi sebenar. Selain berperanan sebagai fasilitator, pensyarah dan guru pembimbing juga berperanan penting dalam usaha membentuk dan membimbing Guru Pelatih (GP) untuk menjadi seorang guru yang berkebolehan (versatile). Transformasi ini merupakan satu proses dimana mereka harus belajar untuk mengajar (learning to teach) berdasarkan situasi dan pengalaman di sekolah . Proses belajar untuk mengajar ini dilihat sebagai stail pembelajaran dan pola perkembangan guru pelatih sepanjang tempoh praktikum latihan mengajar.Untuk itu, adalah penting untuk melihat pola perkembangan dan stail pembelajaran guru pelatih ini dalam konteks ‘learning to teach’ sepanjang tempoh praktikum latihan mengajar. Oleh itu, kertas ini membincangkan Stail Pembelajaran Situated Learning, Experiential Learning, Blended learning dan Stail Pembelajaran Vermunt dalam konteks pembelajaran untuk mengajar (learning to teach) guru pelatih Jabatan Pendidikan Teknikal dan Vokasional yang dilihat berbeza daripada guru pelatih dari jurusan lain. Setiap stail pembelajaran dikupas 305 mengikut kesesuaian belajar untuk mengajar (learning to teach) GP sepanjang tempoh praktikum. Perbezaan yang dikenalpasti dalam orientasi pembelajaran ini dapat digunakan untuk menghasilkan suatu pola perkembangan GP Pendidikan Teknik dan Vokasional khususnya untuk membantu proses kepenyeliaan dan penilaian diantara guru pelatih, pensyarah dan guru pembimbing bagi melahirkan bakal guru novis yang berkualiti. Kata Kunci: Latihan mengajar, Stail pembelajaran, Guru pelatih, Pensyarah pembimbing PENGENALAN Secara umumnya, stail pembelajaran bagi setiap Guru Pelatih (GP) adalah berbeza. Analisis terhadap kajian yang telah dijalankan oleh Mohd Nor dan Hazwani (2007) mendapati taburan stail pembelajaran yang diamalkan oleh pelajar-pelajar yang sedang mengikuti program pengajian Sarjana Muda Pendidikan Teknik Dan Vokasional di UTHM mengamalkan keempat-empat stail pembelajaran yang dinyatakan oleh Honey dan Mumford (1992) iaitu stail pembelajaran Aktivis, Reflektif, Teoris dan Pragmatis. Dapatan ini selari dengan Kolb (1984) yang menyatakan bahawa setiap manusia mempunyai stail pembelajaran yang tersendiri di mana dalam setiap satu stail pembelajaran tersebut ada kekuatannya yang tersendiri terhadap individu tersebut. Kesedaran pensyarah pembimbing dan guru pembimbing mengenai kewujudan perbezaan stail pembelajaran di kalangan GP adalah sangat penting. Di samping pengamalan stail pembelajaran di kalangan GP, stail pengajaran pensyarah pembimbing dan guru pembimbing juga memainkan peranan yang penting di dalam membantu meningkatkan pencapaian profesionalisma perguruan GP. Oleh yang demikian, dengan adanya kepelbagaian dan persamaan di antara pengajaran pensyarah pembimbing dan pembelajaran GP, maka penyampaian sesuatu ilmu itu dikatakan berkesan dan seterusnya dapat meningkatkan 306 pemahaman GP terhadap apa yang dipelajari. SITUATED LEARNING Lave (1988) berpendapat bahawa pembelajaran biasanya berlaku mengikut fungsi aktiviti, kandungan dan budaya yang terhasil (persekitaran). Interaksi sosial merupakan satu komponen penting dalam situated learning di mana pelajar terlibat dalam ‘community of practice’ yang merangkumi kepercayaan dan tingkah laku tertentu. Lave dan Wanger (1991) menyatakan konteks pembelajaran merangkumi faktor seperti persekitaran belajar secara fizikal dan virtual dengan orang-orang yang terlibat dalam proses pembelajaran seperti pensyarah, penyelia, rakan sekerja, pelajar dan sebagainya. Dalam pendekatan situated learning ini, pengetahuan dan kemahiran yang dipelajari dalam konteks yang menggambarkan bagaimana pengetahuan yang diperolehi dan digunakan dalam situasi harian. Kirshner dan Whitson (1997) menyatakan Situated cognition theory memikirkan pembelajaran sebagai suatu fenomena sosiobudaya daripada tindakan seseorang individu yang memperolehi maklumat umum daripada pengetahuan. Mereka juga mengemukakan satu pandangan menyeluruh mengenai konsep ini yang mengaplikasikan kognitif persekitaran dalam pembelajaran orang dewasa. Pembelajaran pada asasnya merupakan suatu perkara yang memberikan makna dari aktiviti sebenar kehidupan harian. Dengan menerapkan beberapa perkara dalam pengalaman yang berterusan daripada pelajar dan mewujudkan peluang bagi pelajar untuk hidup dalam konteks cabaran dunia sebenar, pengetahuan diperoleh dan pembelajaran di pindahkan daripada bilik darjah ke amalan sebenar. Pembelajaran persekitaran meletakkan pemikiran dan tindakan mengikut tempat dan masa yang tertentu. Persekitaran bermakna penglibatan orang di sekeliling, alam sekitar, dan aktiviti-aktiviti untuk mewujudkan makna. Persekitaran juga merupakan cara untuk mencari suasana yang tertentu bagi proses pemikiran dan digunakan oleh pakar untuk 307 mencapai pengetahuan dan kemahiran (Lave & Wanger,1991). Di dalam pembelajaran orang dewasa, situated learning bermakna mewujudkan keadaan-keadaan di mana partisipan akan mengalami kerumitan dan kekaburan pembelajaran dalam dunia sebenar. Partisipan akan mewujudkan pengetahuan mereka sendiri daripada pengalaman asal, iaitu hubungan dengan peserta lain, aktivitiaktiviti, isyarat alam sekitar, dan organisasi sosial masyarakat tersebut. ‘Situated learning places the learner in the center of an instructional process consisting of content--the facts and processes of the task; context--the situations, values, beliefs, and environmental cues by which the learner gains and masters content; community--the group with which the learner will create and negotiate meaning of the situation; and participation--the process by which learners working together and with experts in a social organization solve problems related to everyday life circumstances’ (Lave,1988) GP terpaksa berdepan dengan berbagai-bagai situasi yang mencabar terutamanya disiplin pelajar dan bebanan kerja. Ini memerlukan GP membuat keputusan dan bertindak mengikut kesesuaian persekitaran dan adakalanya tidak menggunakan secara langsung teori-teori yang dipelajari mereka sewaktu di universiti. Pembelajaran yang diperolehi GP ini merangkumi keseluruhan persekitaran pembelajaran iaitu persekitaran bilik darjah atau bengkel, bilik guru dan kawasan sekolah. Pembelajaran diperolehi hasil interaksi sosial GP dengan orang di sekelilingnya. Situated learning di guna pakai dalam kajian ini kerana ianya bersesuaian dengan kaedah belajar untuk mengajar yang di amalkan GP sepanjang tempoh praktikum latihan mengajar. Allen (2007) mengatakan pembelajaran adalah merangkumi faktor seperti persekitaran belajar dan orang-orang yang terlibat secara langsung dalam proses pembelajaran. Ini bermaksud, proses pembelajaran guru pelatih melibatkan individu seperti pensyarah pembimbing, guru pembimbing, rakan sekerja, pelajar dan orang yang berada di dalam persekitaran pembelajaran GP tersebut. 308 Situated learning mempunyai empat aspek utama dalam bimbingan pembangunan aktiviti bilik darjah (Anderson et al., 1996, 1993): (1) pembelajaran berasaskan tindakan situasi harian (2) pengetahuan yang diperolehi berdasarkan situasi dan dipindahkan hanya kepada situasi yang sama (3) pembelajaran adalah hasil daripada satu proses sosial iaitu cara pemikiran, melihat masalah, penyelesaian, dan berinteraksi di samping pengetahuan dan prosedur (4) pembelajaran tidak dipisahkan dari tindakan (world of action) tetapi wujud teguh, kompleks, persekitaran sosial yang dibuat oleh partisipan, tindakan, dan situasi. EXPERIENTIAL LEARNING Teori ini banyak diguna pakai bagi pembelajaran orang dewasa. Ini adalah kerana orang dewasa lebih cenderung untuk menggunakan ‘learned-centered’. Pendidikan vokasional juga menekankan aspek pengalaman kerja dalam pendidikan orang dewasa. Pembelajaran Kolb (1984) melalui empat peringkat menunjukkan bagaimana pengalaman diterjemahkan melalui cerminan kepada konsep, yang kemudiannya digunakan sebagai panduan untuk uji kaji aktif dan pilihan pengalaman baru. Peringkat pertama, pengalaman konkrit (Concrete Experience, CE), di mana pelajar aktif mengalami satu aktiviti seperti sesi makmal atau kerja lapangan. Peringkat kedua, pemerhatian reflektif (Reflexive Observation, RO), apabila pelajar sedar mencerminkan kembali kepada pengalaman itu. Peringkat ketiga, konseptualisasi abstrak (Abstract Conceptualising, AC), di mana pelajar cuba pengkonsepan teori atau model terhadap apa yang diperhatikan. Peringkat keempat, eksperimen aktif (Active Experimenting, AE), di mana pelajar cuba untuk merancang bagaimana untuk menguji model atau teori atau pelan bagi pengalaman yang akan datang. Persekitaran pembelajaran merujuk kepada keseluruhan 309 pengalaman mengajar yang diperolehi oleh GP. Bengtsson (1995) menekankan penggunaan refleksi dalam pedagogi pengajaran. Beliau menekankan refleksi merupakan kunci konsep dalam latihan dan profession perguruan. Dalam program latihan mengajar, GP di wajibkan membuat catatan reflektif berdasarkan pengalaman konkrit yang diperolehi sepanjang tempoh praktikum latihan mengajar. Refleksi ini diguna pakai untuk membuat penilaian dan membina konsep bagi pembelajaran seterusnya memperbaiki kelemahan mereka. Pengalaman Konkrit (CE) Percubaan dalam situasi yang baru (AE) Kitaran Experiential Learning Kolb’s Pemerhatian dan reflektif (RO) Pembentukan konsep abstrak (AC) Rajah 1: Kitaran Experiential Learning oleh Kolb’s (1984) Pengalaman Konkrit (CE) – pelajar merupakan partisipan aktif Pemerhatian dan reflektif (RO) – pelajar memberikan tindak balas reflex terhadap pengalaman Pembentukan konsep abstrak (AC) - pelajar cuba membuat perkaitan teori atau model berdasarkan pemerhatian. Percubaan dalam situasi yang baru (AE) – pelajar merancang untuk menguji implikasi model dan teori dalam situasi baru. 310 Feiman-Nemser (1983) melaporkan latihan akademik tidak relevan untuk menjadi seorang guru tetapi pengalaman pembelajaran dan pengajaran sebenar di dalam bilik darjah itulah yang merupakan sumber utama dalam kemenjadian seorang guru. Kepercayaan ini dibina berdasarkan pengalaman pendidikan yang diperolehi GP dan pemerhatian mereka terhadap guru mereka yang terdahulu. Pengalaman yang sedia ada ini diguna pakai semasa tempoh praktikum latihan mengajar. BLENDED LEARNING Mengikut Graham (2005), Blended learning merupakan sistem pembelajaran yang menggabungkan pengajaran seperti penggunaan media berasaskan komputer. Pembelajaran campuran merujuk kepada kepelbagaian aktiviti pembelajaran dalam satu persekitaran yang berbeza, melibatkan interaksi dua hala yang lebih efektif. Blended learning dapat menggabungkan pembelajaran face-toface dengan pembelajaran berpaksikan komputer. Pembelajaran dengan pendekatan teknologi pembelajaran dengan kombinasi sumber-sumber belajar face-to-face dengan pengajar seperti yang dimuat dalam media komputer, telefon seperti iPhone, saluran televisi satelit, konferensi video, dan media elektronik yang lain. Pelajar dan pengajar/fasilitator bekerja sama untuk meningkatkan kualiti pembelajaran. Tujuan utama blended learning adalah memberikan kesempatan bagi berbagai konsep pembelajaran agar terjadi pembelajaran kendiri, berterusan dan berkembang sepanjang hayat, sehingga pembelajaran akan menjadi lebih efektif, lebih efisien dan lebih menarik. 311 Face to Face Learning Self Paced Learning Online Collaborative Learning Rajah 2 : Blended Learning (Graham, 2005) Antara ciri-ciri blended learning ialah: 1) Pembelajaran yang menggabungkan berbagai cara penyampaian, model pengajaran, gaya pembelajaran, serta berbagai media berpaksikan teknologi. 2) Sebagai sebuah kombinasi pengajaran langsung (face to face) dan pembelajaran kendiri (self paced learning) 3) Pembelajaran yang disokong oleh kombinasi efektif dari cara penyampaian, cara mengajar dan gaya pembelajaran. 4) Guru dan orang tua pelajar memiliki peranan yang sama penting, guru sebagai fasilitator, dan orang tua sebagai pembimbing. GP mengamalkan blended learning dalam konteks belajar untuk mengajar. Mereka menggunakan berbagai-bagai jenis pembelajaran termasuklah pembelajaran berasaskan pengalaman dan persekitaran. Pelbagai jenis sumber yang di guna pakai bagi mewujudkan pengajaran dan pembelajaran dengan berkesan. Kepelbagaian pembelajaran yang di amalkan dapat memberikan pembelajaran yang bermakna kepada mereka sekaligus meningkatkan tahap keyakinan diri mereka untuk mengurus bilik darjah dengan berkesan. 312 STAIL PEMBELAJARAN VERMUNT (1996,1998) Stail pembelajaran masih tidak mempunyai satu definisi yang tepat lantaran maksudnya yang meluas. Setiap pengkaji mempunyai definisi yang tersendiri mengenai stail pembelajaran. Mengikut Vermunt (1996) stail pembelajaran merupakan satu orientasi, melibatkan satu proses yang strategik, corak aktiviti pembelajaran yang konsisten dan sistematik terhadap kepercayaan pembelajaran dan orientasi motivasi. Stail pembelajaran merupakan satu cara yang tersendiri dalam memperolehi pengetahuan, melibatkan kemahiran dan sikap melalui kajian atau pengalaman seseorang individu. Sebarang teori atau model mengenai stail pembelajaran adalah satu kemudahan dalam memahami kerumitan terhadap bagaimana seseorang itu belajar. Stail pembelajaran adalah merupakan satu faktor untuk menentukan bagaimana pelajarpelajar memahami persekitaran, budaya (diantara pelajar dan institusi), kaedah mengajar dan keperluan kurikulum. Kesedaran mengenai teori-teori stail pembelajaran mungkin membantu GP bagi membangunkan metakognitif dan keupayaan untuk mereka belajar untuk mengajar. Sekurang-kurangnya beberapa aspek mengenai stail pembelajaran dapat dijadikan sebagai bahan rujukan GP. Banyak kajian telah dijalankan mengenai stail pembelajaran (Riding, 1996, 1997 &1998; Kolb, 1999; Honey and Mumford, 1992; Entwistle, 1998; Vermunt, 1996 &1998; Gregorc, 1984). Coffield et. al. (2004) telah menyenaraikan tiga stail pembelajaran teratas yang boleh dipercayai iaitu stail pembelajaran Allinson dan Hayes (1996), Apter’s (2001) dan Vermunt (1996, 1998). Walau bagaimanapun, stail pembelajaran Vermunt lebih menekankan aspek perubahan pelajar dalam pembelajaran dan pengajaran. Stail pembelajaran Vermunt juga sesuai dan selamat digunakan untuk pelajar di institusi pengajian tinggi (Coffield et. al., 2004). Berings dan Poell (2008) di dalam kajiannya mengenai dimensi stail pembelajaran di tempat kerja (on-the-job learning style), berpendapat stail pembelajaran Vermunt lebih sesuai didalam penyediaan kepada pekerjaan dan mengandungi pelbagai aspek 313 yang berbeza justeru itu dikenali sebagai stail pembelajaran multidimensi. Oleh itu, stail pembelajaran Vermunt sangat sesuai bagi GP didalam konteks penyediaan kepada bidang profesionalisma keguruan. Dalam kajian Vermunt (1996, 1998) beliau telah menjumpai empat pendekatan stail pembelajaran iaitu tidak-direktif (undirected), direktif-reproduksi (reproduction-directed), direktifbermakna (meaning-directed) dan direktif-aplikasi (applicationdirected learning). Setiap stail pembelajaran merangkumi lima dimensi iaitu pemprosesan kognitif, orientasi pembelajaran (motivasi), proses afektif (perasaan terhadap pembelajaran), model pembelajaran mental dan peraturan pembelajaran. Kajian beliau melibatkan aspek perubahan dalam pembelajaran dan pengajaran (learning and teaching). GP yang mempunyai stail pembelajaran tidak-direktif menggunakan strategi pembelajaran yang ambivalent manakala direktif-reproduksi lebih kepada mengingati kandungan pembelajaran. Direktif-bermakna pula berkaitan dengan kunci konsep dan direktif-aplikasi berkaitan dengan pengalaman setiap hari. Stail pembelajaran Vermunt juga menekankan aspek pembelajaran terarah diri (self-directed learning) yang mana bersesuaian dengan pembelajaran orang dewasa mengikut teori andragogi oleh Knowles (1984). Oleh kerana GP yang merupakan orang dewasa adalah terarah diri, pensyarah dan guru pembimbing haruslah membenarkan GP melakukan penemuan sendiri, dan memberi bimbingan dan bantuan jika kesilapan berlaku. BELAJAR UNTUK MENGAJAR (LEARNING TO TEACH) GP JPTK Vermunt dan Oosterheert (2001) telah mengkaji perbezaan individu dalam aspek belajar untuk mengajar (learning to teach) terhadap GP yang telah selesai menjalani latihan mengajar selama tiga bulan dan memperolehi pengalaman. Mereka mendapati terdapat perbezaan didalam cara GP belajar dan model stail 314 pembelajaran sangat membantu dalam pendekatan pembelajaran mereka. Perkembangan GP dalam belajar untuk mengajar bersamaan dengan stail pembelajaran Vermunt (1996, 1998). Walaubagaimanapun, untuk melihat perkembangan GP belajar untuk mengajar adalah lebih efektif jika kajian dilakukan sepanjang tempoh GP menjalani praktikum latihan mengajar. Selain itu, disamping mengenalpasti stail pembelajaran GP yang efektif, penyelidik dapat melihat pola perkembangan GP di sepanjang tempoh praktikum latihan mengajar. Coffield et.al. (2004) juga menggalakkan penggunaan stail pembelajaran untuk melihat perkembangan kesedaran diri (self-awareness) pelajar dan kemahiran metakognitif mereka. Seperti yang telah dibincangkan sebelum ini, stail pembelajaran tidak-direktif merupakan peringkat dimana GP mengalami kekeliruan dalam mengenalpasti orientasi pembelajaran yang harus digunakan oleh mereka. Orientasi pembelajaran yang dikatakan ini bermaksud pembelajaran mereka untuk mengajar dan transformasi daripada pelajar kepada seorang guru. Jika dilihat dari perspektif pola perkembangan Furlong dan Maynard (1995), stail pembelajaran ini mempunyai perkaitan dengan peringkat yang pertama iaitu ‘dealism awal’. Guru Pelatih (GP) masih belum mempunyai identiti yang tersendiri dimana mereka hanya meniru cara guru-guru mereka melalui pengalaman yang lepas. Pada ketika ini mereka amat memerlukan sokongan dan bimbingan daripada pensyarah dan guru pembimbing untuk mengenalpasti stail mereka yang tersendiri. Vermunt (1996, 1998) menyatakan stail pembelajaran direktifreproduksi merupakan satu orientasi pembelajaran untuk menguji keupayaan seseorang (self-test oriented). Oleh itu, stail pembelajaran ini sinonim dengan peringkat ‘kelangsunganperibadi’ dimana dengan bimbingan yang telah diberikan oleh pensyarah dan guru pembimbing, GP mula mengenalpasti identiti dan personaliti diri mereka dan cuba menyesuaikannya. Mereka mula membuat penilaian terhadap diri mereka sendiri. Peringkat ini juga dikenali sebagai ‘intake of knowledge’ (Vermunt & Oosterheert, 2001). 315 Stail pembelajaran yang dikenal pasti pada peringkat ketiga dan keempat iaitu ‘menangani kesukaran’ dan ‘mencapai tahap mendatar’ bersesuaian dengan direktif-bermakna. Ini adalah kerana peringkat ini melibatkan aspek pemprosesan yang mendalam (deep processing). Pada ketika ini, GP mula membina pengetahuan sendiri dan mereka perlu berhadapan dengan pelbagai tekanan dan cuba menyelesaikannya sendiri dengan bimbingan mentor. Guru pelatih (GP) perlu dilibatkan dalam perancangan dan penilaian pembimbingnya. Pengalaman (termasuk kesilapan) menjadi asas untuk aktiviti pembelajaran. Pembelajaran GP adalah berpusatkan masalah dan bukan berorientasi isi kandungan. Melalui pengalaman ini, mereka mula mempunyai keyakinan diri untuk menguruskan sendiri kelas mereka. Stail pembelajaran yang bersesuaian pada peringkat pola perkembangan GP yang terakhir iaitu ‘bergerak terus’ adalah direktif-aplikasi. Stail pembelajaran dan pola perkembangan ini menekankan aspek pemprosesan konkrit dan pengaplikasian pengetahuan. Pada tahap ini, GP telah mampu untuk menempuh cabaran sebagai seorang guru dan mampu menggunakan pelbagai kaedah pengajaran dan menyesuaikannya dengan keadaan dan tugas yang diberikan (Vermunt dan Verloop, 1999). Guru pelatih (GP) mampu meningkatkan kualiti diri dan seterusnya kearah profesionalisma keguruan. Setiap stail pembelajaran Vermunt (1996, 1998) yang telah disuaipadankan dengan peringkat pola perkembangan GP mengikut Furlong dan Maynard (1995) berkait rapat dengan pembelajaran melalui pengalaman (experiential learning) Kolb’s (1984). Pembelajaran merupakan proses dimana pembinaan pengetahuan berdasarkan transformasi daripada pengalaman. Ini dapat dilihat melalui perbincangan setiap peringkat perkembangan GP melibatkan pengalaman lepas dan pengalaman setiap hari di sepanjang tempoh praktikum latihan mengajar. Pembelajaran GP juga memberi makna daripada aktiviti dan situasi sebenar yang berlaku dalam tempoh latihan mengajar itu. Mengikut Lave dan Wenger (1991), pengetahuan terhasil daripada proses ‘way in’ dan ‘practice’. Ini menunjukkan ‘Way in’ merujuk 316 kepada konteks pembinaan pengetahuan GP dalam tempoh praktikum latihan mengajar. Manakala, ‘practice’ merujuk kepada penggunaan dan pengaplikasian pengetahuan GP. Smith dan Dalton (2005) di dalam kajiannya mengenai perbezaan stail pembelajaran GP pendidikan teknik dan vokasional mengatakan pembangunan profesional stail pembelajaran GP dalam bidang teknik dan vokasional dapat dicapai melalui praktikal seperti latihan mengajar. PENUTUP Kesimpulannya, untuk mengenalpasti stail pembelajaran dan pola perkembangan GP pendidikan teknik dan vokasional dengan lebih efektif adalah disepanjang tempoh praktikum latihan mengajar. Ini adalah kerana di dalam tempoh ini, GP harus belajar untuk mengajar. RUJUKAN Allen, D. (2007). Improving Language Acquisition Skills for English Language Learners With Music Instruction. An Action Research Project. Shawnee Mission Board of Education. Anderson, J.R.; Reder, L. M.; and Simon, H.A. (1996). "Situated Learning and Education." Educational Researcher 25, no. 4: 511. Bengtsson, J. (1995). What is reflection? On reflection in the teaching profession and teacher education. Teachers and Teaching: Theory and practice, 1(1), 23-32. Berings et. al. (2008). Dimensions of On-the-Job Learning styles. An International review, 57 (3): 417-440. Coffield, F, Moseley, D, Hall, E & Ecclestone, K, (2004). Learning styles and pedagogy in post-16 learning: A systematic and critical review. Learning & Skills Research Centre. Entwistle, N. (1992). The impact of teaching on learning outcomes in higher education - a literature review. Edinburgh: University of 317 Edinburgh, Centre for Research on Learning and Instruction. Feiman-Nemser, S. (1983). Learning to teach. Dalam: Shedman, L. and Sykes, G., Editors, 1983. Handbook of teaching and policy. Longman, New York, p.150-170. Furlong, J., & Maynard, T. (1995). Mentoring Student Teachers: The Growth of Professional Knowledge. London: Routledge. Graham, C. R. (2005). Blended learning systems: Definition, current trends, and future directions. Dalam C. J. Bonk & C. R. Graham (Eds.). Handbook of blended learning: Global perspectives, local designs. San Francisco, CA: Pfeiffer Publishing. Honey, P and Mumford, A (1992), The manual of learning styles, Peter Honey Publications, Maidenhead. Kirschner, D., and Whitson, J., eds.(1997). Situated Cognition: Social, semiotic and psychological perspectives. Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates, Knowles, M. (1984). Andragogy in Action. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass Publishers. Knowles,M. (1984). The Adult Learner: A Neglected Species (3rd Ed.). Houston, TX: Gulf Publishing. Kolb, D A (1999), The Kolb learning styles inventory, Version 3, Hay Group: Boston. Kolb, D. A. (1984). Experiential learning: Experience as the source of learning and development. New Jersey: Prentice-Hall. Lave, J. (1988). Cognition in Practice: Mind, mathematics, and culture in everyday life. Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press. Lave, J., & Wenger, E. (1991). Situated learning: Legitimate peripheral participation. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Mohd. Nor Bin Jaafar (2007). Kajian Stres Guru Pelatih Praktikum Kpli J.QAF. Kertas kerja dibentang dalam Seminar Penyelidikan Pendidikan Institut Perguruan Batu Lintang Tahun 2007. Smith, P.J. & Dalton, J. (2005). Accommodating learning styles: Relevance and good practice in vocational education and training. National Centre for Vocational Educational Research: Adelaide. Vermunt, J. D. (1996). Metacognitive, cognitive and affective aspects of learning styles and strategies: a phenomenographic analysis. Higher Education, 31, 25–50. Vermunt, J. D. (1998). The regulation of constructive learning processes. British Journal of Educational Psychology, 68, 149–171. 318 Vermunt, J. D., & Oosterheert, I.E. (2001). Individual differences in learning to teach: relating cognition, regulation and affect. Learning and Instruction, 11,133-156. 319 THE SOCRATIC METHOD ONLINE TO IMPROVE CRITICAL AND HIGH ORDER THINKING AMONG STUDENTS Salihuddin Md. Suhadi, Hasnah Mohammed, Norasykin Mohd. Zaid, Zaleha Abdullah & Baharuddin Aris ABSTRACT Student ability in mastering higher order thinking skill, relates closely with their critical thinking in solving problem. If the students can improve their critical thinking, indirectly higher level of thinking can be achieved. The method that is suitable to improve the students critical thinking is through the socratic method. This method is based on learning through questioning, whereas through the questioning, students will always think on building their understanding construct on their own. The students can also integrate the new concept with the prior knowledge to come up with a concept with a concept that is flexible in regards to the problems and more innovational. This concept paper will discuss the socratic learning method through the online medium; allow the teaching and learning without boundaries. Keywords: Socratic Learning, Critical Thinking, Technology in Socratic Method, Online learning 320 INTRODUCTION Since the existance of social sites is more widespread nowadays; adolescents ages 13 to 17 are often engaged in it more than studying. These things happen because they are exposed to the use of technology since birth. This can be avoided since technology can be put to good use in daily or everyday life. Various parties, especially parents and teacher should monitor their children’s addiction to technology can be deflected to thing that can be beneficial. For example, the use of online learning is an ideal medium for students who often use the computer while studying. The use of online technology for learning can help student to share ideas with other students and socialize at the same time (Liao et al., 2014). Apart from that, there are also studies that state the online learning can stimulate the student’s use of critical thinking as they challenged each other to express their views (Kalelioğlu dan Gülbahar, 2014). To futher improve the online discussion, the use of socratic method which is a method that can make students always think. This due to the fact that this method uses questioning techniques to encourage students to think for acquiry answers, thus construct their own concept of the answers given and received from their peers in the forum (Yang et al., 2005). SOCRATIC METHOD OF LEARNING The Socratic Method originated from Socrates, a Greek philosopher who lived circa 470 – 300 BC and was well known for his thinking through questioning and always providing a reason with his answers. The main concept in learning via Socratic Method is that teachers put forth multiple questions whereby with those questions, students are driven to think thoroughly before answering them. The one aspect that is emphasized in the Socratic Method of learning is to motivate students to think and build constructs upon learning something. When a student repeatedly thinks, it will indirectly mould them into becoming inquisitive, or 321 to be more precise, have a high level of curiosity (Tikva, 2010). One method that is often used in Socratic learning is the dialogue. The purpose of a dialogue is to discuss a problem to find a variety of solutions whereby this of learning is more towards independent learning (Birnbacher et al., 2004). Often the dialogue is an interaction between two individuals, but when there is learning in the classroom, the teacher changes the dialogue to a group interaction. The role of the teacher is to facilitate the group and ensure that the group is always in a dialogue with one another until all concerns are resolved (Clay, 1990). All the arguments raised will be synthesized constructively to achieve an optimal solution. The same concept is also available in a Socratic seminar, whereby a series of questioning techniques with logical answers are given to construct an argument and conclusions. This technique will stimulate the mind to think more critically (Shea et al,. 2006). By using the dialogue, each member in the dialogue would feel compelled to either give an opinion or to ask a question. This activity will ignite critical thinking as question after question would arise and stimulate students' brains to think.. Socratic Method is not a just a matter of asking question and having the answer given by the teacher, but it is a method that requires the review of reading, thinking and reasoning that can lead to answering the questions given (Landis et al., 2007). There is a significant difference between dialogue and debate because both go through different processes. Dialogue is a process of knowledge sharing whereas debate is championing one’s personal opinion. Socratic Method of learning is not a common method in class discussions; where by eventually the teachers will provide answers after the students get stuck, but it is a process of interaction between teachers and students that allows students to be more involved than teachers. Once you reach a point where students cannot respond, the teacher will help by providing questions that can open the minds of students to think (Imison, 2004). Socratic Method can also make students more active, which is in line with the student-centred Active Learning concept (Peterson, 2011). Peterson also adds that there are a few important roles of teachers 322 when conducting this Socratic learning method. Among them are: i. Asking students to provide answers by giving relevant examples ii. Gain support or acquiescence of the members of the group with an opinion or answer from a student iii. Propose an example similar to the actual situation iv. Giving an analogy in explaining a concept CRITICAL THINKING There are many aspects in higher order thinking when viewed as a whole and one of them is critical thinking. Critical thinking is introduced to mean an attitude and skill to apply logic in problem solving (Glaser, 1942). Further opinion states that critical thinking means that students develop a logical concept based on the phenomenon that they have experienced (Brookfield, 1987 ; Ennis, 1989 ; Paul, 1992), however, critical thinking can actually be learned, or it can be built from the motivations and natural preferences of a person. Critical thinking requires a person to apply suppositions, knowledge, competencies and abilities in their thinking. When critical thinking skills are used, the individual should be able to make a reflection of the quality of the thinking that has been made (Courtney, 2002). According to Banning (2006), the process of critical thinking involves scrutiny, comparison and evaluation of information to make a reflection and subsequently forming the right conclusions. Critical thinking also takes into account the arguments given in depth when presented with the conclusions (Fahim and Pezeshki, 2012). 323 Figure 1: Level of Thought, revised by (Ball and Garton, 2005) According to figure 1, Ball and Garton, (2005), there are three levels of thinking which are Lower, Middle and Higher order. Higher-order thinking described here involves three main elements, namely (i) analysing, (ii) evaluating, and (iii) creating. Two of these three elements will be the main basis for the critical thinking which are analysing and creating. Therefore critical thinking is very closely related to higher-order thinking skills. Figure 2: Core Critical Thinking Skills (Youens et al., 2014) Referring to Figure 2 which shows the basic elements of critical thinking, there are six elements and two of which are closely related to higher-order thinking skills. According to Youens, thinking critically is vital for the future of the student as they will constantly reflect on their thinking when making a decision which will indirectly strengthen the comprehension of a 324 concept deeply. Students will also be able to evaluate all the decisions that they have made in the past. In fact, according to Faturohman (2012), students who think critically can be deemed responsible as they are used to thinking thoroughly, openly and imaginatively before making a decision. The ability to think critically is vital because in our daily life, all of us, not just students, will face a situation whereby we have to make a thoughtful decision that can determine whether the outcome is favourable or otherwise. USING TECHNOLOGY IN A SOCRATIC METHOD LEARNING ENVIRONMENT CAN BUILD CRITICAL AND HINGHER ORDER THINKING The rationale for using Socratic Method of learning is to achieve the aim to develop critical thinking skills in students. There are several elements that are important in shaping critical thinking which includes an interpretation of the concept, analysis, evaluation and inference from a context or observation (Boghossian, 2006). Opinion Shea (2006), says that critical thinking is more focused on using logic to explain or to answer a problem as well as providing relevant evidence as a reference. Socratic Method makes an effective process of managing class discussions and students can get valuable experience when they participate in the discussion. According to a study by (Polite dan Adams, 1996), they say that the Socratic Method, students are able be tolerant in the reflective activities such as the dialogue activities. Reflective in the Socratic aspects mean active thinking, beliefs and assumptions that could lead fellow students to master problematic issues (Griffith and Frieden, 2000). Reflective activities such as dialogue indirectly encourage students to think critically where students initially were forcing themselves to think. In addition, students' confidence in answering questions will encourage other students to be more motivated to think critically because peer influences often provide students with an indirect 325 boost. The Socratic Method Learning Environment may involve the use of technology as the present era of technology is booming. The purpose of technology is to make the students more motivated to engage in learning (Granito, 2012). Involvement of students in the teaching and learning process is a very important matter to be taken into account. If student engagement is not satisfactory, indirectly teacing and learning objectives will not be successfully achieved. Therefore, when the online Socratic Method Learning Environment can be implemented, students can participate simultaneously (together) compared to routine learning environment which is implemented on a rotational basis. Learning environment will become even more attractive and will also encourage students to give opinions without restraint. CONCLUSION Based on the description above, it clearly shows the presence of technology in education has become a priority to encourage, stimulate and motivate students while learning. With the use of technology, previous studies concluded that the learning process can be done more easily by teachers, particularly to monitor, respond and communicate any information to students. According to the study, when critical thinking can be learned then it will be extended to students who have problems in creating thought because not everyone has the same level of thinking and it can be developed through Socratic Method of learning as discussed. However, a dominant part of learning is in presenting a concept, while technology is a medium that helps to ensure the success of such learning. Compared with previous studies where Socratic Method was applied in person, this study aims to combine the Socratic Method of learning with technology which can be implemented online. 326 REFERENCES Ball, A. L., & Garton, B. L. (2005). Modeling Higher Order Thinking: The Alignment Between Objectives, Classroom Discourse, And Assessments. Journal of Agricultural Education, 46(2), 58–69. Banning M., Measures that can be used to Instill Critical Thinking in Nurse Prescribers. Nurse Education in Practice, 6, 98-105, 2006. Birnbacher, D. and Krohn, D., Socratic Dialogue and Self-directed Learning. In R. Saran, and B. Neisser (Eds.), Enquiring minds: Socratic dialogue in education. (pp. 9–15). Stoke-on-Trent, UK: Trentham Books, 2004. Brookfield, S., Developing Critical Thinkers: Challenging Adults to Explore Alternative Ways of Thinking and Acting. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass, 1987. Boghossian, P., Socratic Pedagogy, Critical Thinking, and Inmate Education. Journal of Correctional Education, 57(1), 42-63, 2006. Clay, D., The Origins of the Socratic Dialogue. Duke University Program in Political Economy, 1990. Courtney, M. and Simpson E., Critical thinking in Nursing Education: Literature Review. International Journal of Nursing Practice, 8(2), 89-98, 2002. Ennis, R. H., Critical thinking and subject specificity: Clarification and needed research. Educational Researcher, 18(3), 4-10, 1989. Fahim, M., & Pezeshki, M. (2012). Manipulating Critical Thinking Skills in Test Taking. International Journal of Education. Faturohman, Deni Ramdan. Pengembangan Model Bahan Ajar Strategi Pembelajaran Konflik Kognitif untuk Meningkatkan Kemampuan Berpikir Kritis Matematik Siswa SMP. Skripsi FPMIPA UPI Bandung, 2012. Glaser, E. M., An experiment in the development of critical thinking. Teachers College Record,43(5), 409-410. Retrieved from http://www.tcrecord.org, 1942. Granito, M. (2012). The Effect of Technology on a Student ’ s Motivation and Knowledge Retention. Griffith, B. A., and Frieden, G., Facilitating Reflective Thinking in Counselor Education. Counselor Education and Supervision, 40(2), 82-93, 2000. Imison, T., The Challenge of Socratic Dialogue in Education. In R. Saran, and B. Neisser (Eds.), Enquiring Minds (pp. 25e28). Stoke on 327 Trent: Trentham Books, 2004. Kalelioğlu, F., & Gülbahar, Y. (2014). The Effect of Instructional Techniques on Critical Thinking and Critical Thinking Dispositions in Online Discussion. Educational Technology & Society, 17, 248– 258. Liao, J., Wang, M., Ran, W., & Yang, S. J. H. (2014). Collaborative cloud: a new model for e-learning. Innovations in Education and Teaching International, 51(3), 338–351. Paul R. C., Critical thinking: What every person needs to survive in a rapidly changing world. Santa Rosa, CA: Foundation for Critical Thinking, 1992. Peterson, E. (2011). Teaching To Think : Applying The Socratic Method Outside The Law School Setting. Journal of College Teaching & Learning (TLC), 6(5), 83–88. Polite, V. C., & Adams, A. H. (1996). Improving Critical Thinking Through Socratic Seminars. Spotlight on Student Success , No. 110. Shea, P., Li, C. S., and Pickett, A., A Study of Teaching Presence and Student Sense of Learning Community in Fully Online and WebEnhanced College Courses. Internet and Higher Education, 9(3), 175-190, 2006. Landis, M., Swain, K D, Friehe, M J, & Coufal, K L (2007). Evaluating critical thinking in class and online: comparison of the Newman Method and the Facione rubric.(Report). Communication Disorders Quarterly. , 28, 3. p.135(9). Tikva, J. B. (2010). Socratic teaching is not teaching, but direct transmission is: Notes from 13 to 15-year olds’ conceptions of teaching. Teaching and Teacher Education, 26(3), 656–664. Yang, Y.-T. C., Newby, T. J., & Bill, R. L. (2005). Using Socratic Questioning to Promote Critical Thinking Skills Through Asynchronous Discussion Forums in Distance Learning Environments. American Journal of Distance Education, 19(3), 163–181. Youens, B., Smethem, L., & Sullivan, S. (2014). Promoting collaborative practice and reciprocity in initial teacher education: realising a “dialogic space” through video capture analysis. Journal of Education for Teaching, 40(2), 101–113. 328 DIFFICULTIES OF IMPLEMENTING COMMUNICATIVE LANGUAGE TEACHING (CLT) IN MALAYSIA Samira Nikian & Faizah Mohammad Nor ABSTRAK Earlier method such as The Grammar-Translation Method (GTM) and Audio-lingual Method (ALM) only put the focus on set of linguistic system, structures and forms and learners’ ability to use language correctly (Hung, 2009; Ahn, 2009). However, they did not take consider the need of communication for learners (Chang, 2009). A change of focus in language teaching from linguistic structures to learners' needs of communication happened by introducing Communicative Language Teaching (CLT) based on a functional model of language (Halliday, 1973. Since the CLT is against traditional language teaching methods by putting focus on communication in language learning classrooms, applying it as a western method in Asian countries face with some difficulties and challenges. Keywords: Implementing CLT, Malaysia, Difficulties 329 INTRODUCTION Earlier method such as The Grammar-Translation Method (GTM) and Audio-lingual Method (ALM) only put the focus on set of linguistic system, structures and forms and learners’ ability to use language correctly (Hung, 2009; Ahn, 2009). However, they did not take consider the need of communication for learners (Chang, 2009). A change of focus in language teaching from linguistic structures to learners' needs of communication happened by introducing Communicative Language Teaching (CLT) based on a functional model of language (Halliday, 1973) and a concept of communicative competence as a major innovation in language teaching in England in the 1970s (Habermas, 1970; Hymes, 1971; Jakobovits, 1970; Savignon, 1972 cited in Nikian, 2011) . Since the CLT is against traditional language teaching methods by putting focus on communication in language learning classrooms, introducing CLT was considered a revolution in language teaching methodology and rapidly gained extensive acceptance in the western countries especially in Britain, North America, and Australasia, a region consisting of New Zealand, Australia, New Guinea and other smaller surrounding islands in the South Pacific Ocean (Holliday, 1994). In a while textbooks and curricula in most EFL and ESL countries changed to Communicative Language Teaching (CLT) but according to the research teachers, especially in EFL countries, did not implement CLT in their classrooms. Some researchers such as Sara Pe’er, et. al (2007) considered lack of training for teachers is the most important reason of teachers ‘failure. Ho-Yan Mak (2011) states when English Foreign Language (EFL) teachers adapt the Western-based approaches such as CLT to Asian contexts, tensions between attitudes about the different traditions of language teaching effects on their attitudes and practice of new teaching methodology. Embarks et al (2011) believe “introducing Western educational innovations into nonWestern contexts can be a great challenge due to the disinterest or resistance of those teachers who hold strong attitudes about the efficacy of traditional teaching approaches especially when the 330 implementation of the proposed innovations requires a change in teachers’ attitudes about teaching and learning and involves a shift in their classroom instructional approaches from teacher-centred into learner-centred” (Embarks et al, 2011). “The image of teaching that they tend to bring with them from years observing teachers “a teacher . . . standing at the blackboard demonstrating lessons"--appears to be transformed (Feiman-Nemser, 1987; p. 17). Teachers have different attitudes towards the role of teachers in the classroom. Some of them believe language teaching is a process of information transmission while some teachers may regard the role of a teacher as facilitator of language learning. Peacock (2001) found that student teachers frequently start professional training with views of teaching as telling and learning as remembering, which poses difficulties when they are encouraged to conduct communicative language teaching. Although there are some factors to inhibit implementing CLT in Asian countries, many researchers believe “teachers’ instructional approaches are guided by the conceptions of teaching and learning so if they bear in their minds some misconception or poor understanding of innovations, these factors can significantly affect the way of their practice in classrooms” (Bruner, 1996; Marton and Booth, 1997; Peterson and Irving, 2008). BACKGROUND OF STUDY Intense British colonialization initialized the English language in Malaysia in the 1800's for the first time (Pandian, 2002). Malaysia has gone through vast changes in various fields since it attained independence from Britain in 1957. After independence of Malaysia, many changes happened in the education policy to provide national unity by developing a national language (Watson, 1983 cited by Ting, 2007). “In the decades following independence, the nationalization of the education system has gone through a period of turbulence, documenting growth, decline and eventual stabilization of its role and function in the system” 331 (Pandian, 2002; p.35). According to the changes in language teaching, language syllabus in secondary schools in Malaysia also changed. “The Razak Report (1956: No. 20: p.14) recommended a number of positive and negative sanctions which were later adopted by the Ministry of Education and other government departments of independent Malaysia. Briefly, these sanctions included: Making the Malay language a qualification at the various levels of entry into the government service; Using the Malay language as a factor for selection for secondary education; Making the Malay language compulsory in all government departments; Making the Malay language a requirement for anyone aspiring to a scholarship from public funds; Providing bonuses in government service to encourage a more rapid acquisition of the language; Varying grants to schools depending in part on the successful learning of Malay as and when adequate facilities could be provided; Making the Malay language a compulsory part of teacher training courses and examinations; Not charging fees to pupils in adult education classes formed to study the Malay language” (Gaudart, 1987, p.1). The next educational report was announced by Rahman Talib in 1960 to offer inducements to qualified teachers already in school to study the Malay language or the National Language to teach through the medium of the National Language. The reason for putting focus on the learning of Malay was that Malay is the national language of the newly independent country and a common language would create a common culture and so create a new national identity (Gaudart, 1987). LITERATURE REVIEW After announcing of Razak and Talib’s reports, “the National Language and National Educational policies were implemented gradually from 1970 until 1983 in primary and secondary levels of education. Certain problems were overlooked in the teaching of English in this scenario such as finding the best approach to 332 teaching English to multilingual students” (Darus, 2009). In this situation, adhoc committees and the Curriculum Development Centre developed 3 different approaches in the English syllabus for the primary/secondary and upper secondary school. Hence, based on the report of Ministry of Education (1973,1975,1976) the Structural Syllabus was applied for Forms 1, 2 and the Communicative Syllabus for Forms 4 and 5. Azian (2011) believes “the success of national language policy had an adverse effect on Malaysians’ ability to speak and write in English” (p.5). Hence Nunan(2003) and Nur salawati believe English is Malaysia is more of foreign language rather than second language. The structional-situational syllabus was adopted in primary schools. According to Abraham, (1987 cited by Pandian, 2002), the structural approach usually provides a list of language structures and words as learning objectives. Structural syllabus emphasized on discrete learning of grammar. It aims to produce the list of language structures in context or situation. Teaching reading and writing in the structural syllabus led to teachercentered classroom. In addition sentences were learned in isolation and students have to learn too many skills related to examination and could not use language in a meaningful situation (Tang, 2007). Introducing Communicative syllabus for form 4 and 5 gives secondary school learners the opportunities to use the language for various functions, such as relaying messages and giving instructions, with the assumption that they have acquired adequate grammatical knowledge to use it (Tang, 2007) but students and teachers could not adopt themselves with the new syllabus which required them to put less focus on grammar (Pandian, 2002). Even after the communicative syllabus was adopted for education in Malaysia, Pandian (2004) and Chan and Tan (2006) feel that Malaysian students are still not equipped with communicative competence. Radzi et al (2007) also found Malaysian students’ fluency in oral English is comparatively low compared to their performance in writing. Noor Hashimah Abdul Aziz (2007) explains most English language students in higher education face 333 many difficulties in speaking English. In addition, Radzi et al (2007) discussed after a number of years learning English in school, the low performance of Malaysian learners still remains a problem to be solved. Moreover, Mustafa and Yahya (2012) state “the problem of students having low proficiency level in English still exists in community colleges throughout the country. Despite the strength of CLT as a potential approach in enhancing oral communication skills among learners, community colleges constantly receive feedbacks from employers about students’ poor communication skills, especially in English” (p. 789). This fact is also discussed by Subermaniam in 2013. He states Malaysian learners cannot communicate in English fluently even after 11 years of formal English language education. Lack of communicative competence among Malaysian students may be related to practicing the teacher-dominated educational model for centuries as in many Asian contexts. According to Koo Yew Lie (2008) producing autonomous and independent student learning in the Malaysian education system is difficult. Teachercentred approaches and chalk and talk drill method have been for decades used in English classes in Malaysia (Ministry of Education, 2003). Naginder (2006) cited in Musa (2012) also believes teachers in Malaysia have the authority in teaching the lessons while Wong-fillmore (1985, cited in Al-Mekhlafi, 2013) claimed teacher-centred classes are far more effective than studentcentred ones. Saleh and Aziz (2012) believe “in general, most of the teaching practices applied in Malaysian schools still take place in a condition whereby the teacher still dominates over the students. This shows that teaching method at schools is still bounded by traditional methods” (p.4). Pandian (2004) believes examination-based system at schools is one of several reasons for the teacher-centred teaching method in Malaysia. Pandian (2002), after analysing KBSM syllabus found that many grammatical skills are tested in examination and students have to learn them during the class time to pass exams and obtain good grades. Moreover, Musa (2012) declares English language learning in Malaysia is based on a “set of language 334 mechanics with fixed ways of using the language; isolated from its communicative use. It is presented as a neutral set of language systems, to be learned and mastered for specific classroom situation” (p.5). So in this situation Musa et al., (2012) believe, teachers in Malaysia have to put focus on teaching grammar and ignore sociocultural elements of language learning and the importance of communicative competence in their teaching and students have to put the focus on scoring good grade in the exam by memorizing and regurgitating in the discourse of assessment (Siong et al, 2010). Therefore, it can be concluded that although English language teaching has shifted toward CLT in Malaysia, teachers are still applying traditional methods such as the grammar-translation and audio-lingual methods (Abd. Razak et al., 1996; Jemaah Nazir Sekolah Persekutuan, 1996; Voo, 1996; Wan Mohd Rani, 1999 cited in Saleh and Aziz; 2012). Apart from examination-based system at schools, Musa et al (2012) state the lack of communicative competence among Malaysian learners is due to teachers’ negative attitudes of learnercentred methods of teaching English which influence the teaching and learning of English. In addition, Al-Mekhlafi (2012) posits learner centred approaches such as CLT may not be consistent with the attitudes of teachers about teaching and learning. Bax (2003) also asserts that the language teaching profession has been negatively influenced by “an almost unconscious set of attitudes” (p. 280) which he labels, the CLT attitude. The effect of teachers’ negative attitudes on inhibiting practicing CLT was also found by Hiep (2007). He found that one of the factors that prevents implementing CLT in Vietnam is teachers’ negative attitudes towards CLT. In this regard, Bybee (1993) contends that teachers’ attitudes and their teaching practice are the most essential components of educational change to occur. So it is clear that teachers’ attitudes are crucial if substantial changes are needed because they have a great deal of authority in making decisions regarding the planning of day-to-day instruction (Judson, 2006). Hence, teachers’ ways of thinking and attitude are vital components of their practice in the classroom (Kagan, 1992; 335 Burnaby and Sun, 1989; Ellis, 1994; Fox, 1993; Gamal and Debra, 2001 ; Karavas-Doukas, 1996; Li, 1998; Mustafa, 2001 ; Penner, 1995; Rollman, 1994; Sato and Kleinsasser, 1999; Thompson, 1996). While the majority of the research about attitudes and practices have been conducted with teachers, recently researchers have shifted their focus and demonstrated an unprecedented interest in examining pre-service teachers’ attitudes, thinking, planning and decision-making (Fang, 1996; Fives and Buehl, 2010). Epler (2011) recommends that teacher educators attempt to identify the attitudes of pre-service teachers and modify those attitudes if modifications of attitudes are needed. Similarly, Joram and Gabriele (1998) state targeting incorrect attitudes about teaching of pre-service teachers during their training will be effective to help trainees become aware of their attitudes and try to put them in practice in the best way in their classroom. Ellis (1994) calls this awareness “Raising” (pp.184). CONCLUSION Consequently, as Wallin (2003) believes political leaders in developing nations would like to upgrade their educational systems in order to improve the quality of education to meet the challenges of globalization. Hence, the most important factor in improving education in Malaysia should be on teacher performance and certain instructional methods that produce higher student achievement than other methods. In the history of Malaysia, it is evident that the education policy over the past years has been consistent and in line with Vision 2020. However, since the goal of Vision 2020 in is to gain the status of "a developed country" for Malaysia by the year 2020, one of the important factors that play a significant role in new vision of Malaysia in 2020 will be raising education in to world standards. 336 REFERENCES Al-Mekhlafi, A. (2012). From Firm Ground to Shifting Sands: Issues in adopting learner-centred ESL/EFL Pedagogy. The English Teacing, XLI(1 August 2012), 18. Azian, A. B. (2011). Oral instructional language features of science teacher traininees in teaching science in English in school.PHD thesis. Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Bax, S. (2003). The end of CLT: a context approach to language teaching. ELT Journal, 57(3), 278 87. Bruner, J. (1996). The culture of education. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Burnaby, B., and Sun, Y. (1989). Chinese teachers’ views of western language teaching: context informs paradigm. TESOL Quarterly, 23(2), 219-238. Bybee, R. W. (1993). Reforming Science Education. New York: NY: Teachers College Press. Chang, M (2009). Taiwanese college English teachers’ attitudes toward Communicative Language Teaching. Unpublished M.A. Thesis, Queen’s University Kingston, Ontario, Canada. Texas University-Kingsville. Darus, S. (2009). The Current Situation and Issues of the Teaching of English in Malaysia. 21-27. Ellis, G. (1994). The appropriateness of the communicative approach in Vietnam: An interview study in intercultural communication (Master’s thesis). La Trobe University, Victoria, Australia. ERIC E-Journal. Document No. ED 378 839. (Access date: February 12, 2010). Epler, C. M. (2011). The Relationship Between Implicit Theories of Intelligence, Epistemological Attitudes, and the Teaching Practices of In-service Teachers: A Mixed Methods Study. Doctor of Philosophy, Blacksburg, VA. Fang, Z. (1996). A review of research on teacher attitudes and practices. Educational Research, 38(1), 47-65. Fives, H., and Buehl, M. M. (2010). Teachers‘ articulation of attitudes about teaching. In L. D. Bendixen and F. C. Fuecht (Eds.), Personal epistemology in the classroom: Theory, research, and implications for practice (pp. 470-515). New York, NY: Cambridge. 337 Fox, C.A. (1993). Communicative competence and attitudes about language among Graduate Teaching Assistants in French. The Modern Language Journal, 77 (3),3 13-324. Feiman-Nemser, Sh. McDiarmid, G.W. Melnick, S. L. And Parker, M. (1987). Changing Beginning Teachers' Conceptions: A Description Of An Introductory Teacher Education Course. Gaudart, H., (1987). English language teaching in Malaysia: A historical account. The English Teacher Vol XVI. Gamal, G., and Debra, M. (2001). The communicative approach in Egypt: Exploring the secrets of Pyramids. TEFL Web Journal, 1 (2). Unpublished MA Thesis, http:/Iwww.teflweb-i .orand 1 n2lGahin MvhilLhtml (Access date: July 10,2003). Halliday, M.A.K. (1975). Learning how to mean. London: Edward Arnold Hiep, P. H. (2007). Communicative Language Teaching: Unity within Diversity. ELT Journal 61 No. 3 p193-201. Holliday, A. (1997). Six lessons: Cultural continuity in communicative language teaching. Language Teaching Research, 1(3), 212-238. Ho-Yan Mak, S. (2011). Tensions between conflicting attitudes of an EFL teacher in Teaching Practice, RELC, 42:53. Hung, Y.-j. (2009). Linking Theory To Practice: Implementation Of Clt By Taiwanese University Teachers Of English. Doctor of Philosophy, Indiana University, in the Department of Department of Literacy, Culture, and Language Education. (3390275). Joram, E., and Gabriele, A. J. (1998). Pre-service teachers’ prior attitudes: Transforming obstacles into opportunities. Teaching and Teacher Education, 14, 175–191. doi:10.1016/S0742051X(97)00035-8. Judson, E. (2006). How Teachers Integrate Technology and Their Attitudes About Learning: Is There a Connection? Jl. of Technology and Teacher Education, 14(3), 581-597. Kagan, D. M. (1992). Implications of research on teacher attitude. Educational Psychologist, 27, 65}90. Karavas-Doukas, E. (1996). Using attitude scales to investigate teachers' attitudes to the communicative approach. ELT Journal, 50(3), 187-196. Li, D. (1998). "It's always more difficult than you plan and imagine": Teachers' perceived difficulties in introducing the 338 communicative approach in South Korea. TESOL Quarterly, 32 (4), 677-703. Marton, F., 1981. Phenomenography – describing conceptions of the world around us. Instructional Science 10, p. 177-200. Ministry of Education of Malaysia, 1973. The Teacher’s Handbook for the English Syllabus for Forms I-III of Secondary Schools in Malaysia: Part One. Kuala Lumpur: Dewan Bahasa dan Pustaka. Ministry of Education of Malaysia, 1975a. The Teacher’s Handbook for the English Syllabus for Forms I-III of Secondary Schools in Malaysia: Part Three. Kuala Lumpur: Dewan Bahasa dan Pustaka. Ministry of Education of Malaysia. 1975b.English Language Syllabus in Malaysian Schools, Forms 4-5. Kuala Lumpur: Author. Ministry of Education of Malaysia, 1976. The Teacher’s Handbook for the English Syllabus for Forms I-III of Secondary Schools in Malaysia: Part Two. Kuala Lumpur: Dewan Bahasa dan Pustaka. Musa, C.A, Lie, k.w, Azman, H. (2012). Exploring English Language Learning and Teaching in Malaysia. GEMA online Journal of Language Studies. 12(1). Mustafa, B. (2001). Communicative language teaching in Indonesia: Issues of theoretical assumptions and challenges in the classroom practice. Journal of Southeast Asian Education, 2 (2). Accessed from ERIC E*-Journal. No. ED 462 833. (Access date: June 5,2003). Mustafa, S. M. and Yahya, R. A. (2012). Social and Behavioral Sciences 90 ( 2013 ) 788 – 794. Nikian, S. (2014). The importance of investigating Iranian teachers’ attitudes towards Communicative Language Teaching [CLT] approach. Educational practice and Innovation. 1-7. Nikian, S. (2014). A Case Study of Iranian EFL Teachers' Perceptions of Communicative Language Teaching Approach. European Academic Research. 1 (10).p.3438-3470. Noor Hashimah Abdul Aziz. (2007). ESL students’ perspectives on language anxiety. Unpublished Ph.D. thesis, Universiti Putra Malaysia: Serdang. Nunan, D. (2004). Task-Based Language Teaching. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. 339 Pandian, A. (2004). What Works in the Classroom? Promoting Literacy Practices in English. 3L Journal of Language Teaching, Lingustics and Literature, 11, 25. Peacock, M. (2001). Pre-service teachers ESL teachers' attitudes about second language learning: A longitudinal study. System, 29(2), 177-195. Penner, J. (1995). Change and conflict: Introduction of the communicative approach in China. TESL Canada Journal, 12(2), 1-17. Rollman, M. (1994). The Communicative language teaching “ revolution” tested: A comparison of two classroom studies; 1976 and 1993. Foreign Language Annals. 27.(2), 221239. Saleh, S and Aziz, A. (2012). Teaching Practices Among Secondary School Teachers in Malaysia. School of Educational Studies, Universiti Sains Malaysia, 47(14), 5. Sato, K., and Kleinsasser, R. (1999). Communicative language teaching (CLT): Practical attitude. The Modern Language Journal, 83(4), 494-517. Subramaniam, G. (2013). Question about English Language Education in Malaysia. Malaysian English Language Teaching Association, 2. Thompson, G. (1996). Some misconceptions about communicative language teaching. ELT Journal, 50(1), 9-15. Ting, S.H. (2007). Is Teacher Education Making An Impact On Tesl Teacher Trainees’ Beliefs And Practices Of Grammar Teaching?. Vol (10). PP: 42-62. 340 A FRAMEWORK OF SCENARIOEPISTEMIC GAME FOR PROFESSIONAL SKILLS AND HIGHER ORDER THINKING SKILLS Kho Pui Wun & Jamalludin Harun ABSTRACT This paper addressed the looming crisis of education to produce effective workers in the 21st century. Epistemic games are claimed to have the potential to solve the educational crisis. In this research study, the purpose was to identify a framework of scenarioepistemic game which centered on inducing professional skills and Higher Order Thinking Skills(HOTs). The framework of the scenario-epistemic game allowed epistemic game designer to create an epistemic frame of professions and construct the scenarios of the game. This approach engendered students towards mastery of professional skills and HOTs. Therefore, this study regarded as a new dedication to the game-based learning in 21st century. Keywords: 21st century, Game-based learning, Scenario-epistemic game, Professional skills, Higher order thinking skills 341 INTRODUCTION In the era of globalisation, there is a competition for innovative work. The world is racing ahead to produce innovative and creative workers who have professional skills to solve the complex problems (Friedman, 2005). Dede (2007) also agreed that the world will be dominated by innovation and knowledge. Employers have higher expectation on their workers. Bennett and Robinson (2000) have listed the three skills that must possessed by the most valuable worker are basic academic skills, higher order thinking skills and certain personal qualities. Wagner (2008) designated that these are the vital survival skills that must be possessed by every individual. Apart from that, previous study reported that the graduated students who have inadequate knowledge and skills have caused the problems in industry (Yampinij and Chaijaroen, 2012). Office of Accreditation Standard and Educational Quality Assessment (2007) found that they are lacking of systematic skill, analytical skill and synthesis skill. They could not analyse and solve the realworld problems effectively (Rajendran, 2001). Therefore, effective and valuable worker can be produced through nurturing students with Higher Order Thinking Skills (HOTs) in school. A study conducted by Wenglinsky (1998) to investigate the relationship between learning through computer games and students’ HOTs. He found that computer games will enhance students HOTs and conventional drill and practice will lead students to have lower order thinking skills. In this study, the instructional technology used in educational practices is educational game. Prensky (2001) also claimed that many researchers predicted that game-based learning (GBL) will serve the education world as the rapid advancement of technology. Students learn the content of knowledge indirectly and achieve learning objective at the same time while playing the digital game (Garris, et al., 2002). This can bring the enjoyment and excitement in learning process. In this paper, the literature of GBL will be reviewed and a 342 framework of game which focuses professional practices will be introduced. LITERATURE REVIEW This section will briefly review the literature of game-based learning and one suitable types of GBL will be selected to solve the looming crisis in education. Furthermore, the best instructional strategy used in the game will be further identified. Game-Based Learning Cicchino (2013) suggested GBL as an effective strategy to nurture students’ HOTs and promote content learning. Game-based learning can be regarded as cognitive tools that arouse student’s motivation and engagement in learning (Burguillo, 2010; Lee & Probert, 2010). It can be used to teach in some subjects, such as mathematics, science, history, and language learning (Zin, Jaafar, & Yue, 2009). There are many studies showing that the GBL increases the motivation and performance in learning process (Burguillo, 2010; Ebner & Holzinger, 2007; Papastergiou, 2009; Wang & Chen, 2010). This is because educational games provide interesting learning environment that allow students to acquire deeper and longer-lasting knowledge of the content (Cicchino, 2013; Sung and Hwang, 2012). Koenig (2008) indicated that the environment of instructional games is also able to develop HOTs such as critical thinking skills. However, there are studies argued that the inadequacies of the GBL. Apostol, Zaharescu and Alexe (2013) also pointed out that the possibility of using game-like learning may devalue the subject to be learned. Cankaya and Kuzu (2010) indicated that children learn by playing and having fun. Yet, it is a challenge to keep balance between learning and gaming (Kickmeier-Rust and Albert, 343 2010). Students might focus on the enjoyment of the game. Barzilai and Blau (2014) found that one of the core challenges in GBL is to assist students to relate between the knowledge learned in game and disciplinary content. Therefore, the learning tasks in the game can be designed ground on the learning objectives. Then the students will not drift away from content learning. Furthermore, games alone could not significantly improve students’ performance (Apostol, Zaharescu and Alexe, 2013). They explained that some of the students may encounter problems in solving the task due to the lack of knowledge and understanding. Their ability is not enough to cope with the complicated situation and thus make them feel frustrated or demotivated. Therefore, teachers’ facilitation is vital to the GBL. Nonetheless, it is very clear that challenges occurred hinder the adoption of the games in the classroom. Watson, et al. (2011) listed out the issues faced by teachers who conducted game-like learning in school. They claimed that problem with technology, fixed class schedule and the concern of parents and administration about the effects of gaming. Thus, Extra instructional support and good implementation strategies will ensure the effectiveness of game learning (Watson, et al., 2011). Sung and Hwang (2012) also urged that the importance of providing the learning support or guidance in GBL. All in all, GBL is able to promote learning engagement, induce students’ cognitive growth and potentially foster students’ HOTs. Thus, it is important to indicate and introduce a suitable game that focuses on professional practice and induces students’ HOTs Epistemic Game There are many popular games which enhance students’ cognitive development such as role-playing games, simulation game, realtime strategy games, adventure games, action games, puzzle games, and chess games (Zhi and Zhenhong , 2008). However, there is a demand of the mastery of complex thinking, technical 344 language and problem solving skills even in elementary schools (Gee, 2003; Johnson, 2005). Shaffer (2007) introduced a computer-supported games based on real world practices known as epistemic games. The main objective of epistemic games is to stimulate experiences of professional practices and help students to cope with the real world situation effectively (Nash, Bagley and Shaffer, 2012). Shaffer and Gee (2005) claimed that the epistemic games provide an opportunity for students to construct knowledge, apply knowledge and share knowledge while dealing with the games. They also urged that the epistemic games can solve the coming crisis in education. This is because the epistemic game allows the students to engender the experiences of the professional practices. One of the great promises of the epistemic game is that students could develop their epistemic frame in the context of professional action. This enables the mastery of knowledge and skills (Shaffer, 2006). Students are engaged in making knowledge, applying knowledge and sharing knowledge via playing the epistemic game (Shaffer and Gee, 2005). Shaffer (2007) proposed that the epistemic frame is formed by the combination of skills, knowledge, identity, value and epistemology (SKIVE). The SKIVE elements form the epistemic frame of community and have the base structure as below: 1. Skills (S): the things that people within the community do. 2. Knowledge (K): the understandings that people in the community share. 3. Identity (I): the way that members of the community see themselves. 4. Values (V): the beliefs that members of the community hold. 5. Epistemology (E): the warrants that justify actions or claims as legitimate within the community. (Shaffer, 2006) 345 Figure 1 The SKIVE elements are interrelated. Figure 1 shows the combination of these frame elements characterise the professional ensemble and thus develop the professional way of thinking (Rupp, et al., 2010). They further accentuate the elements of the frame are interconnected and linked in practice. This helps students develop the professional patterns of acting and thinking that are driven by their epistemic frame. Thus, the epistemic game is able to engender students’ knowledge and apply it in ways that HOTs. However, the learning support or guidance provided in game increase the learning potential. Therefore, it is vital to examine a suitable instructional strategy to enrich the epistemic game and yet helping the students in accomplishing the task. Suitable Instructional Strategy used in Epistemic game In order to maximise the learning experience through the epistemic game, a good learning strategy can immerged into the game design. Scenario based learning (SBL), problem-based learning (PBL) and case-based learning (CBL) are the strategies that can be used to design the activities in games. Although Mery and Blakiston (2010) explained that SBL can be considered as PBL and CBL. However, they are different in between. Thus, the 346 differences must be well notified and an appropriate strategy needs to be carefully chosen in order to select the best approach to create learning activities. Table 1: The differences of scenario based learning, problem based learning and case based learning. Approach Scenario based learning Problem based learning (PBL) Case based learning (CBL) Details Students are put in a context and allowed them to explore the learning issues, and challenges. They are required to apply knowledge and practice skills relevant to the situation (Muhamad et al., 2012). Students visualise and experience a practical scenario of what they learn in coursework (Siddiqui,et al., 2008) They have basic knowledge of the topics. PBL allows students to apply their knowledge and skills in the new situation to solve the problem or to achieve definite goals (Williams and Beattie, 2008). Students do not have basic knowledge of the topics. They must discover new methods by using the previous knowledge or principles (Williams and Beattie, 2008). CBL helps students to develop their perspective field via using case studies which are based upon real life problem in practice (Kaddoura, 2011). CBL focuses on resolving a problem or case with wellorganised teamwork (Rosenbaum, et al., 2005) CBL engenders knowledge acquisition, skills and attitudes (Cender, et al., 2011) By referring to the table 1, SBL is selected as a strategy to create a real world context in game-based learning. Students will be presented the epistemic game after they have gone through the topic in order to strengthen their understanding and thus enhance their HOTs. It has been widely used to teach the students in different professions such as engineering problem, corporate trainings and vocational educational program (Chu, 2007; Clark, 2009; Dahl, 2010; Naidu, et al., 2007). Siddiqui,et al. (2008) added that this approach of learning allows students to apply knowledge to the situation and practice the skills relevant to critical thinking and decision-making. Kindley (2002) claimed that scenario based learning is 347 effective when presents with game-like appearance. The epistemic games emulate real life situations and enable students to solve problems based on their real experiences. The decisions of the actions and strategies used in such learning context will enhance their learning experiences and increase the mastery of knowledge and skills. The integration of SBL into the game will be a good and promising tool to induce and foster students’ knowledge and skills needed in the specific domain. Clark (2009) introduced Ruth Clark’s scenario-based model that simulates the real world situation as shown in Figure 2. Figure 2 Ruth Clark’s Scenario-Based Model Ruth Clark’s Scenario-Based Model (Clark, 2009) explained that Task Deliverable as learning objectives must be set before designing the learning activity. Every scenario includes trigger event, case data, feedback, reflection and guidance that reflects the learning objectives. The learning tasks that grounded on learning objectives will prevent students to trivialize the subject learned. Apart from that, Trigger Event provides the script of the learning activity is launched based on specification for the scenario in the task deliverable. This can arouse students’ interest and engage them in dealing with the epistemic game. Case Data provides players with all the details. Moreover, Guidance such as relevant models, tutorials and references is embedded in the game to guide the students who need assistance. This could improve students’ 348 learning capacity. Feedback is also a significant component to be considered as it expands students’ learning experience with insights. Case data, Guidance and Feedback are the best learning supports while students encounter problem to solve the tasks. The students then can play the epistemic game at home independently without teacher’s facilitation. Thus, this will not deter the fixed class schedule. Last but not least, students are given chances to think and reflect. Reflection allows them to recall and reflect what they learned throughout the game. FRAMEWORK PROPOSED FOR SCENARIO-EPISTEMIC GAME Shaffer (2007) believes that the epistemic frame is generated when there is a linkage between knowledge and practice (Shaffer, 2007). Dewey (1958) supports this by stating that knowing and doing is highly related. Each of the scenarios in the epistemic game is centered on learning objectives with the aim to optimise the learning outcome by developing a better learning environment in the epistemic game. Figure 3 Integration of Ruth Clark’s Scenario-Based Model into SKIVE elements. The SKIVE elements are used to build students’ epistemic frame of professional practices and Ruth Clark’s Scenario-Based 349 Model will be used to create the scenario of the problem-solving situations. For instances, the epistemic game provides chances for the students to generate an epistemic frame of chemist to work in laboratory. The students will then take the role as a chemist to solve the problem and accomplish the goal by overcoming the obstacles in the learning task. Therefore, the students are trained to think like an expert in their professional domain and solve problem in real world context created based on scenario-based learning. The integration of the SKIVE elements and Ruth Clark’s ScenarioBased Model can thus generate the application of HOTs in the epistemic game. CONCLUSION The scenario-epistemic game is authentic, real and reflective. Students are allowed to construct their own knowledge and skills by critically solved the problems in the complex and meaningful ways. This could stimulate students’ HOTs, develop a better content understanding and enhance their professional skills via game playing. The framework of the scenario-epistemic game focuses on professional practices and it is applicable to any professional domain such as chemist, lawyer and engineer. Thus, the education crisis can be solved and effective worker who meet the requirement in the 21 st century will be hence produced. REFERENCES Apostol, S., Zaharescu, L., and Alexe, I. (2013). Gamification of Learning and Educational Games. The 9th Internaltional Scientific Conference Elearning and Software for Education Bucharest, April 25-26,2013. Bucharest Romani, 67-72. Bae, Y. M. (2006). Fostering Higher Order Thinking in a Technologyrich Classroom Environment: Learning from an Exemplary Middle School Social Studies Teacher. Doctor of Philosophy, 350 The University of Texas, Austin. Barzilai, S. and Blau, I. (2014). Scaffolding game-based learning: Impact on learning achievement, perceived learning and game experiences. Computer & Education. 70, 65-79. Bennett, R. J., & Robinson, S. L. (2000). Development of workplace deviance. Journal of Applied Psychology, 85(3), 349-360. Retrieved from http://psycnet.apa.org/journals/apl/85/3/349.pdf. doi: 10.I037//0021-9010.85.3.349 Burguillo, J. C. (2010). Using game theory and Competition-based Learning to stimulate student motivation and performance. Computers & Education, 55(2), 566–575. Cankaya, S., & Kuzu, A. (2010). Investigating the characteristics of educational computer games developed for children with autism: a project proposal. Procedia - Social and Behavioral Sciences, 9, 825-830. Cagiltay, N. E. (2007). Teaching software engineering by means of computer-game development: challenges and opportunities. British Journal of Educational Technology, 38(3), 405–415. Cendan J. C, Silver M, Ben-David K. Changing the student clerkship from traditional lectures to small group: case-based sessions benefits the student and the faculty. J Surg Educ 2011; 68(2): 117-120. Cicchino, M. (2013). Using game-based learning to foster critical thinking in student discourse. Doctor of education. The state University of New Jersey, New Brunswick. Chu, K.C. (2007). Using scenario based learning for e-learning in vocational education. In R. C. Sharma and S. Mirsha (Eds.) Cases on globa; e-learning practices: Successes and pitfalls. Hershey, PA: IGI Global. Clark, R. (2009). Accelerating expertise with scenario-based learning, Training & Development , 63 (1), 84-85. Dahl, C. (2004). Scenario based active learning in a low tech environment. College and Under graduate Libraries, 11(2) 1227. Dede, C. (2007). Reinventing the role of information and communication technologies in education. In L. Smolin, K. Lawless, & N. C. Burbules (Eds.), Information and communication technologies: Considerations of current practices for teachers and teacher educators: 106th Yearbook of the National Society for the Study 351 of Education (Part 2, pp. 11–38). Malden, MA: Blackwell. Retrieved from http://files.pressible.org/10/files/2010/01/Dede.pdf Dewey, J. (1958). Art as experience. New York: Capricorn Books. Ebner, M., & Holzinger, A. (2007). Successful implementation of usercentred game based learning in higher education: an example from civil engineering. Computers and Education, 49(3), 873– 890. Friedman, T. (2005). The world is flat: A brief history of the twenty-first century. New York: Farrar, Straus & Giroux. Gee, J. P. (2003). What video games have to teach us about learning and literacy. New York: Palgrave Macmillan. Johnson, S. (2005). Everything bad is good for you: How today’s popular culture is actually making us smarter. New York: Riverhead Books. Kaddoura, M.A. 2011. Critical thinking skills of nursing students in lecture-based teaching and case-based learning. International Journal for the Scholarship of Teaching and Learning 5 (2), 1– 18. Koenig, A. D. (2008). Exploring Effective Educational Video Game Design: The Interplay Between Narrative and Game-Schema Construction. Doctor of Philosophy, Arizona State University, United State. Kickmeier-Rust, M. D., & Albert, D. (2010). Micro-adaptivity: protecting immersion in didactically adaptive digital educational games. Journal of Computer Assisted Learning, 26, 95–105. Kindley, R.W. (2002). Scenario-based e-learning: A step beyond traditional e-learning. ASDT online magazine LearningCircuits,3(5) Lee, J. K. & Probert, J. (2010). Civilization III and whole-class play in high school social studies. The Journal of Social Studies Research, 34, 1-28 Mery, Y. and Blakiston, R. (2010). Scenario-Based E-Learning: Putting the student in the Driver’s Seat. 26th Annual Conference on Distance Teaching and Learning. 4-6 August, 2010. 1-5 Muhamad, M., Zaman, H. B., & Ahmad, A. (2012). Virtual Biology Laboratory (VLab-Bio): Scenario-based Learning Approach. International Conference on Education and Educational Psychology. Procedia- Social and Behavioral Sciences 69 pp.162 352 – 168 Nash, P., Bagley, E.A.S, & Shaffer, D.W. (2012). Playing for Public Interest: Epistemic Games as civic engagement activities. Paper presented at the American Educational Research Association (AERA) annual meeting, Vancouver, BC. Naidu, S., Menon, M., Gunawardena, C., LEkamge, D., and Karunnanayaka, S. (2007). How scenario based learning can engender reflective practice in distance education. In M. Spector (Ed.), Finding your voice online: Stories told by experienced online educators. Mahwah, NJ: Lawrence Erlbaum Associates. Nash, P., & Shaffer, D. W. (2010). Mentor modeling: The internalization of modeled professional thinking in an epistemic game. Paper presented at the International Conference of the Learning Sciences (ICLS), Chicago, Illinois Nash, P., Bagley, E.A.S, & Shaffer, D.W. (2012). Playing for Public Interest: Epistemic Games as civic engagement activities. Paper presented at the American Educational Research Association (AERA) annual meeting, Vancouver, BCOffice of Accreditation Standard and Educational Quality Assessment. (2007). Community of Educational Quality Assurance. Bangkok: Office of Accreditation Standard and Educational Quality Assessment. Papastergiou, M. (2009). Digital Game-Based Learning in high school Computer Science education:Impact on educational effectiveness and student motivation. Computers & Education, 52, 1–12. Prensky, M. (2001). Digital game-based learning. New York: McGrawHill. Rajendran, N.S. (2001). Teaching Thinking Skills at Institutions of Higher Learning: Lessons Learned. Pertanika Journal Social Science & Humanities, 18(S), 1-1410. Universiti Putra Malaysia Press. Rakes, G. C., Fields,V. S., & Cox, K. E. (2006). The influence of teachers’ technology use on instructional practices. Journal of Research on Technology in Education, (38)4, 409-424. Rosenbaum, M.E., Lobas, J., Ferguson, K. (2005). Using reflection activities to enhance teaching about end-of-life care. J Palliat Med, 8(6), 1186 Rupp, A.A., Choi, Y., Gushta, M., Mislevy, R. J., Bagley, E., Nash, P., Hatfield, D., Svarowski, G., & Shaffer, D. (2009). Modeling learning progressions in epistemic games with epistemic network analysis: Principles for data analysis and generation. Proceedings 353 from the Learning Progressions in Science Conference held in Iowa City, IA, June 24–26. Rupp, A.A., Gushta, M., Mislevy, R.J., & Shaffer, D.W. (2010). Evidence-centered Design of Epistemic Games: Measurement Principles for Complex Learning Environments. Journal of Technology, Learning, and Assessment, 8(4). Retrieved [3 rd march 2013] from http://www.jtla.org. Shaffer, D. W. (2004a). Epistemic frames and islands of expertise: Learning from infusion experiences. Paper presented at the International Conference of the Learning Sciences (ICLS), Santa Monica, CA. Shaffer, D. W. (2004b). Pedagogical praxis: The professions as models for post-industrial education. Teachers College Record, 106(7). Siti Noridah, A. (2012). Malaysian polytechnic lecturers’ teaching practices with ICT utilization to promote higher-order thinking skills. Doctoral of philosophy. Iowa State University Ames, Iowa. Shaffer, D. W., & Gee, J. P. (2005). Before every child is left behind: How epistemic games can solve the coming crisis in education (WCER Working Paper No. 2005-7): University of WisconsinMadison, Wisconsin Center for Education Research. Shaffer, D.W. (2006). Epistemic frames for epistemic games. Computers & Education. 46(3): p. 223-234 Shaffer, D. W. (2007). How Computer Games Help Children Learn. New York, NY: Palgrave. Siddiqui, A., Khan, M., Akhtar, S. (2008). Supply chain simulator: A scenario-based educational tool to enhance student learning. Computers & Education 51, 252–26 Siti Noridah, A. (2012). Malaysian polytechnic lecturers’ teaching practices with ICT utilization to promote higher-order thinking skills. Doctoral of philosophy. Iowa State University Ames, Iowa. Sung, H. Y., and Hwnag, G. J. (2013). A collaborative game-based learning approach to improving students’ learning performance in science courses. Computers & Education, 63, 43–51. Wagner, C., & Bolloju, N. (2005). Supporting knowledge management in organizations with conversational technologies: Discussion forums, weblogs, and wikis. Journal of Database Management, 16, i–viii. 354 Watson, W. R., Mong, C. J., and Harris, C. A. (2011). A case study of the in-class use of a video game for teaching high school history. Computers & Education, 56, 466–474 Wenglinsky, H. (1998). Does it compute? The relationship between educational technology and student achievement in mathematics. Princeton, NJ: Educational Testing Service. Retrieved from http://www.ets.org/Media/Research/pdf/PICTECHNOLOG.pdf Williams, S.M., Beattie, H.J., 2008. Problem based learning in the clinical setting—a systematic review. Nurse Education Today 28 (2), 146–154 Yampinij, S. and Chaijaroen, S. (2012). The validation of knowledge construction model based on constructivist approach to support ILL-structured problems solving process for industrial education and technology students. Procedia - Social and Behavioral Sciences 46, 5153 – 5157 Zhi, H., & Zhenhong, Z. (2008). Integration of game elements with role play in collaborative learning-a case study of quasi-GBL in Chinese higher education. Edutainment, 427-435. Zin, N. A. M., Jaafar, A., & Yue, W. S. (2009). Digital game-based learning (DGBL) model and development methodology for teaching history. Wseas Transactions on Computers, 2(8), 322333. 355 CONCEPTUAL FRAMEWORK OF VIDEO LEARNING BASED ON POPBL AND CBE Khairul Anuar Abdul Rahman, Muhammad Sukri Daud, Yusri Kamin & Norazrena Abu Samah ABSTRACT Demonstration method is often used in technical and vocational teaching. This has led to a longer period of teaching and learning (T&L) and is difficult to be repeated if the student missed it. In addition, the diversity of students' backgrounds affects how they think, insofar; influence their thinking skills and the knowledge exhibited. Therefore, the use of video in T&L is the latest alternative to allow students to see the process involved in practical and stimulate students' ability to engage in T&L. This should be added to the Competency-based Education (CBE) and Project Oriented Problem Based Learning (POPBL) because the concept of learning is appropriate for compentecy-based education as well as to establish the characteristics of the competencies required by employers. Therefore, this study was undertaken to identify the conceptual framework of video learning based on POPBL and CBE. This conceptual framework was built based on the analysis results of previous study and will be tested by experts for further research. Keywords: POPBL, CBE, Video, Conceptual framework 356 INTRODUCTION Technical and vocational education (TVE) without a doubt is the catalyst for national development (Asnul Dahar, et al., 2013). Teaching and learning process in TVE should not only focus on chalk and talk method, but should also emphasize competencies (Marina & Jamil, 2013). Utilization of various teaching aids is very important to ensure that students can master a task in a specific competency before moving to a new task. Therefore, competencybased education in teaching skills has become a necessity in education (Asnul Dahar, et al., 2013; Drive & Asnul Dahar, 2006; Lokman, Nurul Qistin, and Mohd Hanafi, 2009; Marina & Jamil, 2013). Competency-based Education (CBE) is very effective to be used in education as it aims in training individuals of the skills related to workplace (Asnul Dahar, et al., 2013; Marina & Jamil, 2013). Competencies and learning outcomes are the main models and keys to solution of problems in technical and vocational education at present time such as problems in technological changes and the gap between education and employment needs (Edwards, Sánchez-Ruiz, & Sánchez-Díaz, 2009; Ennis 2008; Gasperini, 2009). This problem has also been highlighted in the Ninth Malaysia Plan (RMK-9), where there is a need to use strategic approach of CBE in producing skillful and knowledgeable human capital of (Asnul Dahar, et al., 2013). In achieving developed nation status in 2020, employers are becoming more critical in the selection of new employees (Rasul, et al., 2009). This is due to the quality of graduates produced by local universities who did not exhibit the required competencies according to job sector and low capability of graduates to master social skills and manners effectively in the society (Othman et al., 2008). This finding is in line with the technological changes which is constantly improving and advancing from time to time (Hamzah & Musta'mal, 2012). This goes along with the government's desire to create and strengthen human capital skills and knowledge contained in the second core of RMK-9 that is to increase the 357 capacity for knowledge and innovation (Asnul Dahar, et al., 2013). Therefore, POPBL should be applied in T&L to produce workers who are innovative, creative, and able to solve problems, work in teams and manage projects. Studies conducted by Hernández-Ramos (2007) and Sampson and Fytros (2008) proved that the use of technology in education offers huge potential as it introduces an innovative teaching and learning modalities among students with different backgrounds. It also provides learning experiences that are similar to student life experience (Potter, 2005) and also provides support, extend or change in pedagogy and curriculum output (Kearney & Schuck, 2004). Technology and pedagogy are often seen from the perspective of constructivist (Jonassen, et al., 2003). In line with the development of technology in the country, the application of video learning is highly encouraged to be used as one of the teaching methods, especially in TVE. It aims to produce students who are skillful and knowledgeable. This is to fulfill the government's efforts to produce highly competent human capital (Shiung & Ling, 2005). The use of the video too has shown that it has helped educators in T&L process, helped students improve their understanding in mastering a subject (Ismail et al., 2006; Jurich, 1999; Zurina & Zaidatun, 2006) and prepared the students to be equipped with lifelong learning and be proactive when entering the workforce (Gasperini, 2009). In addition, the use of video also encourages students to take greater responsibility towards their learning by enriching learning experiences (Kearney & Schuck, 2006). This is also supported by Norton (1985), who found that the experience of using learning resources such as video materials can enhance learning and selfdirection. Quality video production following the national curriculum can contribute to the success of nation education in the future (Ismail et al., 2006). The use of video technology in learning can also bridge the gap between the artificial environments of the school to the realities of the classroom (Jurich, 1999). The use of video in T&L gave a huge impact and is effective in influencing and attracting students’ interests and motivation as well as 358 encouraging students to yield more efforts. In all, it can make learning to be more meaningful in achieving the learning objectives (Jiar & Fakhri, 2010; Waters & Jones, 2011). Nonetheless, the use of video in TVE was something new and underused (Hamdan Mohd Yasin, 2010). According to him, if learning to be done using video, it is expected that teachers to be ready to integrate information and communication technologies in the T&L process. In addition, preliminary studies conducted in a vocational training center previously has shown that students did participat in T&L that used video, but the T&L has failed to implement the desired skills and failed to build problem-solving skills. This is because the video that they used was not carefully developed. Therefore, this study was undertaken to identify the conceptual framework of video learning based on POPBL and CBE in TVE. COMPETENCY-BASED EDUCATION (CBE) CBE is a practical approach that is based on the student's ability and society’s competency requirements (Frank, et al., 2010). According to Frank et al. (2010) CBE did not emphasize on timebased training and it promises accountability, flexibility and is student-centered. CBE was first introduced in 1992 in Australian Vocational Education and Training (VET). Its objective is to achieve demonstration skills according to the industry standards (Mulcahy, 2000). These skills and knowledge required of the individual are needed to meet the expectations of the workplace rather than relying on the learning process solely (Shellabear, 2002). Through CBE, engineering and community members can show the behavior, knowledge, skills and necessary abilities to perform their duties at the highest level of efficiency through a mix of experience, training and education (Dallosta, 2011). According to The National Council on Technical and Vocational Education and Training (2006), CBE elements include tasks for students that are recognized by industry experts, provide 359 opportunities for students to enhance their competencies and assessment of knowledge as well as attitudes and competencies. The competencies to be assessed are informed beforehand to students. This is to ensure that the teaching is in line with the objectives set and the students would be able to show their competencies during T&L process. Besides that, according to Norton (1985) and Asnul and Kandar (2006), the application of the CBE involves a variety of methods and teaching materials. CBE is advantageous as it is more training oriented and is able to shape a future worker amongst students as they need to undergo employee training program or focused-competency program. These programs focuses on the knowledge and skills of the job specifications based on industry and employers competency standards (Hall & Jones, 1996; Mansfield, 1989; Mulcahy, 2000; Tuxworth, 2005; Williams, 1997). CBE also stated that prerequisite information and directions need to be provided together with the module (Asnul Dahar, et al., 2013; Hall & Jones, 1996; Norton, 1985; Stanley Elam, 1971; The National Council on Technical and Vocational Education and Training, 2006). In addition, CBE offers courses that are relevant and balanced to the needs of consumers and society (Mulder, 2012; Stanley Elam, 1971). Furthermore, CBE is an alternative to meet current needs and not just looking at individual result-driven achievements only. (Kandar & Asnul, 2006). Assessments involved in CBE are pre assessment and post assessment (Asnul Dahar, et al., 2013; Hall & Jones, 1996; Marina & Jamil, 2013; Norton, 1985; Stanley Elam, 1971; The National Council on Technical and Vocational Education and Training, 2006). CBE programs in T&L is more focused as it follows the syllabus and systematic teaching where teaching facilitates the development and assessment of competence-oriented coach, teacher as fasilatator and promote lifelong learning (Asnul Dahar, et al., 2013; Marina & James, 2013; Stanly Elam, 1971; Williams, 1997). In addition, this program also provides sufficient and complete equipment to provide experience to students (Norton, 1985; The National Council on Technical and Vocational 360 Education and Training, 2006). Through CBE, the student will be informed of the criteria of competence and attitude needed in the workplace and the role given before students follow the modules. Requisite information and directions provided together with the module and the competence that need to be achieved first are identified, validated and disseminated (Asnul Dahar, et al., 2013; Norton, 1985; Stanley Elam, 1971; The National Council on Technical and Vocational Education and Training, 2006). According to Kyobe and Rugumayo (2005), CBE is an approach to technical education and vocational training which emphasizes the development of skills and abilities that are actually needed in the working world. The instructor will provide a learning environment that resembles the work environment (Mansfield, 1989; The National Council on Technical and Vocational Education and Training, 2006; Williams, 1997). Through CBE, the focus shifted from input in the training to required training at workplace or industry standards (Hall & Jones, 1996; Mulcahy, 2000; Tuxworth, 2005; Williams, 1997). The study conducted by Hall and Jones (1996) and Williams (1997) found that CBE is a mastery learning where there is no provision in the learning time in achieving different competencies and values. Instructor will provide a complete and easy instructions to help students to master competencies that are being determined (Norton, 1985), as well as providing tasks in the real world of workplace to be completed by students before being given the next task (Williams, 1997). Learning activities are also graded to help some of the students to have at least a minimum level of competencies (Hall & Jones, 1996). Additionally, the knowledge and understanding were gained through certain experiences that enable students to master quickly with respect to the objectives (Norton, 1985; Wolf, 2005). If students make a mistake during the T&L process, teachers promptly correct students’ errors and provide immediate feedback on tasks and tests given (Norton, 1985; Stanley Elam, 1971; The National Council on Technical and Vocational Education and Training, 2006). 361 PROJECT ORIENTED PROBLEM BASED LEARNING (POPBL) POPBL is an educational discipline by nature where it can be divided into two themes, namely, project-based and problem-based learning that involves daily lives issues (Krüger-Basener & Kosuch, 2009; Uziak, et al., 2010). Problem-based learning requires students to develop and build the foundation for the synthesis of knowledge from various disciplines (knowledge) while project-based learning requires a wide range of theories and related knowledge (know-why) (Moesby, 2005; Ruhizan, et al., 2011; Uziak et al., 2010). POPBL approach encourages students to engage in more complex scenarios or complex problems given to them. They need to identify the information they have learned and the skills they need to have to solve the problem (Ruhizan, et al., 2011). In POPBL structured methods, in the early stages of the course, students carried out simple projects in the beginning through selfstudy followed by critical and complex questions (Moesby, 2005; Uziak, et al., 2010). Many of the early projects were done through self-study that helps students to revise or develop the necessary basic concepts, learn how to use the design tools, develop problem solving and critical thinking skills and develop independent learning skills (Ruhizan, et al. 2011; Uziak, et al., 2010). The results of the study done by Ruhizan, Saemah and Kamaruzaman (2011) for trainers in 12 polytechnics in Malaysia showed that the use of technology in the implementation of POPBL can have a positive impact on students' knowledge and technical skills. The key features of POPBL are student-centered, providing instruction through skills required, process-centered, group-based, experience-based and problems are treated as the core issue in learning (Ruhizan, et al., 2011; Uziak, et al., 2010). POPBL application in design and craftsmanship requires special attention because there is evidence that it improves the design thinking, the skills and experience (Ruhizan, et al., 2011). It also promotes and supports the work of the team and improves the 362 retention of knowledge in valid multi-disciplinary design scenarios, as well as crossing geographical boundaries and cultures. POPBL approach can also help students to learn design thinking effectively because it encourages creativity and enhance a comprehensive approach to solving problems (Uziak, et al., 2010). According to Krüger-Basener & Kosuch (2009), POPBL able to attract female students to study science and technical subjects. According to Moesby (2005), the characteristics of the application of POPBL is to state the problem according to level, strong group planning which is led by individuals who are experienced in every level and validated discussions are the keywords used in categorizing individual skills and talents. In addition, through POPBL, students’ personal efficiency is very significant and higher when compared with conventional techniques. POPBL is also seen to be having the potential to foster the ability of students to learn actively, think critically and solve problems through teaching process that focuses on practical tasks (Aziz, Sicard, & Dhia, 2010; Othman et al., 2008). It also encourages students to conduct group discussions. Moreover, POPBL can create independent learning, improve soft skills, develop first class human capital and form an active, constructive and creative learning (Othman et al., 2008). According to Dolog et al., (2010), POPBL have different perspectives among students, teachers or trainers and educational institutions. From the students’ perspective, POPBL involves problems related to everyday life, which attract students’ interests and increase students’ motivation. Meanwhile, lecturers or teachers believe that POPBL promotes mutual learning among their students. Finally, from the perspective of educational institutions, POPBL is viewed to able to motivate students, produce graduates who are competent and enhance collaboration between institutions and industry. 363 CONCEPTUAL FRAMEWORK OF RESEARCH CBE model has certain characteristics which are; predetermined training, results of assessment, involvement of industry in determining the success of a training program and training program that follows the industry standard competencies (Mulcahy, 2000). It is also training-oriented where learning objectives are clearly stated and correlated and the course elements are appropriate and proportionate, suitable with the needs of customers and society (Mulder, 2012). From the results of the documents analysis carried out by researchers, there are 17 characteristics of CBE that will be highlighted in this study. POPBL is a suitable approach in teaching engineering subjects (Moesby, 2005). Therefore, POPBL will also be referred in this study. From the results of the documents analysis carried out by researchers, there are nine characteristics of POPBL. Through POPBL, students will be actively involved in stimulating learning experience through teaching that emphasize skills and process centered, encourage them to think critically and innovatively, solve problem and also encourage group discussion amongst them (Aziz, et al., 2010). Therefore, the 17 features characteristics of CBE and nine characteristics of POPBL will be the fundamental in the construction of the conceptual framework of video learning based on CBE and POPBL in PTV (see Figure 1.0). 364 Figure 1.1: Conceptual Framework of video learning based on CBE and POPBL in PTV 365 CONCLUSION Realizing that these learning problems have yet to have solid solutions, researchers have conducted studies on the elements that are necessary in the production of video-based learning in TVE based on CBE and POPBL. Researchers have chosen video as the medium to develop students' competencies as it have been proven by other resaerchers that the use of multimedia is effective in attracting students’ interests and motivation in learning. Unfortunately, existing medium did not help much in shaping students to be competent and it is not very suitable to be used in TVE. Therefore, the conceptual framework of video-based learning based on CBE and POPBL was built and will be tested by experts for further research. REFERENCES Asnul Dahar, M., Ruhizan, M. Y., Kamalularifin, S., & Muhammad Khair, N. (2013). Strategi Kelasterian Pembangunan Pendidikan Teknikal dan Vokasional (PTV). Paper presented at the 2nd International Seminar on Quality and Affordable Education, Malaysia. Aziz, S. M., Sicard, E., & Dhia, S. B. (2010). Effective Teaching of the Physical Design of Integrated Circuit Using Educational Tools. IEEE Transactions On Education 53(4), 517-531. Dallosta, P. M. (2011, 24-27 Jan. 2011). Developing Competency-Based Engineering Curriculum and Certifications. Paper presented at the Reliability and Maintainability Symposium (RAMS), 2011 Proceedings - Annual. Dolog, P., Thomsen, L. L., Thomsen, B., & Stage, J. (2010). Competence Centered Specialization in Web Engineering Topics in a Software Engineering Masters Degree Programme. Paper presented at the 1st International Educators' Day on Web 366 Engineering Curricula Vienna, Austria. Edwards, M., Sánchez-Ruiz, L. M., & Sánchez-Díaz, C. (2009). Achieving competence-based curriculum in Engineering Education in Spain. Paper presented at the Proceedings of the IEEE 97 (10). Ennis, M. R. (2008). A Review of the Literature and the Role of the Employment and Training Administration (ETA). Frank, J., Mungroo, R., Ahmad, Y., Wang, M., de Rossi, S., & Horsley, T. (2010). Toward a definition of competency-based education in medicine: a systematic review of published definitions. Med Teacher, 32, 631-637. Gasperini, L. (2009). Technical and Vocational Education and Training and Rural Development International Handbook of Education for the Changing World of Work (pp. 721-734). Hall, G. E., & Jones, H. L. (1996). Competency Based Education A Process For The Improvement Of Education. New Jersey: Prentice Hall. Hamdan, A. R., & Mohd Yasin, H. (2010). Penggunaan Alat Bantu Mengajar (ABM) Di Kalangan Guru-Guru Teknikal Di Sekolah Menengah Teknik Daerah Johor Bahru, Johor (pp. 1-8). Hamzah, R., & Musta’mal, A. H. (2012). The role of technical and vocational education in career development. Journal of Technical, Vocational & Engineering Education, 5, 28-34. Hernández-Ramos, P. (2007). Aim, shoot, ready! Future teachers learn to ‘do’ video. British Journal of Educational Technology, 38(1), 33-41. Ismail, Megat, Rosni, & Khata, M. (2006). Rekabentuk Dan Pembangunan Perisian Multimedia (PBK) Bagi Mata Pelajaran Teknologi Ekektrik Tingkatan 4 Topik Komponen Elektronik (Kapasitor). Paper presented at the Seminar Kebangsaan Pendidikan Teknik Dan Vokasional. Jiar, Y. K., & Fakhri, A. (2010). Pembangunan Perisian Teknologi Kejuruteraan Unit Teras Perhubungan Elektronik Tingkatan Empat. 1-7. 367 Jonassen, D. H., Howland, J., Moore, J., & Marra, R. M. (2003). Learning to Solve Problems with Technology: A Constructivist Perspective (2 ed.): Upper Saddle River, N.J: Merrill. Jurich, S. (1999). The Impact of Video Technology in Education: From Here to Where. International Journal of Technologies for the Advancement of Knowlwedge and Learning, 1(1). Kearney, M., & Schuck, S. (2006). Spotlight on authentic learning: Student developed digital video projects. Australasian Journal of Educational Technology, 22(2), 189-208. Krüger-Basener, M., & Kosuch, R. (2009). School Science Teaching by Project Orientation –Does it Foster Girls? Paper presented at the Proceedings of the 37th Sefi Conference Rotterdem. Kyobe, E., & Rugumayo, A. (2005). Competency based education and training (CBET): A Case Study in Uganda. Paper presented at the 31st WEDC International Conference. Lokman, M. T., Nurul Qistin, M., & Mohd Hanafi, M. Y. (2009). Pendidikan Teknik Dan Vokasional Untuk Pelajar Berkeperluan Khas. Jurnal Pendidik dan Pendidikan(Jil. 24), 73–87. Mansfield, B. (1989). Competence and standards. In J. Burke (Ed.), Competency Base Education and Training London: Taylor & Francis. Marina, I. M., & Jamil, A. (2013). Kesahan Dan Kebolehpercayaan Instrumen Penilaian Pelaksanaan Pentaksiran Kompetensi Persijilan Modular (PKPM). Paper presented at the Proceeding of the International Conference on Social Science Research, ICSSR 2013. Moesby, E. (2005). Curriculum Development for Project-Oriented and Problem-Based Learning (POPBL) with Emphasis on Personal Skills and Abilities. Global Journal of Engineering Education, 9(2). Mulcahy, D. (2000). Turning the contradictions of competence: competency-based training and beyond Journal of Vocational Education & Training, 52(2), 259-280. Mulder, M. (2012). Competence-based Education and Training. The 368 Journal of Agricultural Education and Extension, 18(3), 305314. Norton, R. E. (1985). DACUM handbook: National Center for Research in Vocational Education, Ohio State University. Othman, H., Mohd Salleh, B., Syed Abdullah, S. M. D. a.-E., & Sulaiman, A. (2008). Perlaksanaan pendekatan pembelajaran berasaskan pengalaman (PBL dan POPBL) bagi meningkatkan kemahiran insaniah pelajar. Paper presented at the Seminar Kebangsaan Kemahiran Insaniah dan Kesejahteraan Sosial (SKIKS), Hotel Mahkota, Melaka. Potter, J. (2005). “This brings back a lot of memories” - A case study in the analysis of digital video production by young learners. Education, Communication and Information, 5(1), 5-23. Rasul, M. S., Ismail, M. Y., Ismail, N., Rajuddin, R., & Rauf, R. A. (2009). Aspek Kemahiran ‘Employability’ yang Dikehendaki Majikan Industri Pembuatan Masa Kini. Jurnal Pendidikan Malaysia, 34(2), 67-79. Ruhizan, Y. M., Rahman, S., Jusoff, K., Melor, Y. M., & Minghat, D. A. (2011). Harnessing Technological-Creativity for Economic Development: A Problem-Oriented Project-Based Learning Approach World Applied Sciences Journal, 13(638-644). Selamat, K., & Minghat, A. D. (2006). Memenuhi Keperluan Modal Insan Melalui Latihan Berasaskan Ketrampilan (LBK). Paper presented at the Seminar TVE06. Shellabear, S. (2002). Competency profiling: definition and implementation. Training Journal, 16-18. Shiung, T. K., & Ling, W. Y. (2005). Penggunaan ICT Dalam Proses Pengajaran Dan Pembelajaran Di Kalangan Guru Sekolah Menengah Teknik Dan Vokasional: Sikap Guru, Peranan ICT Dan Kekangan / Cabaran Penggunaan ICT. Paper presented at the Seminar Isu Pendidikan 2005. Stanly Elam. (1971). Performance-Based Teacher Education: What is the State of the Art? : Taylor & Francis. The National Council on Technical and Vocational Education and 369 Training. (2006). Assessment in Competency-Based Education. Tuxworth, E. (2005). Competence based education and training: background and origins. In J. Burke (Ed.), Competency Base Education and Training London: Taylor & Francis. Uziak, J., Oladiran, M. T., Eisenberg, M., & Scheffer, C. (2010). International team approach to Project-Oriented Problem-Based Learning in design. World Transactions on Engineering and Technology Education, 8(2), 137-144. Waters, R. D., & Jones, P. M. (2011). Using Video to Build an Organization's Identity and Brand: A Content Analysis of Nonprofit Organizations' YouTube Videos. Journal of Nonprofit & Public Sector Marketing 23(3). William, B. E. (1997). Handbook For Developing Competency Based Training Program. Englewood Cliff, New Jersey: Prantice Hall. Wolf, A. (2005). Can competence and knowledge mix? In J. Burke (Ed.), Competency Base Education and Training London: Taylor & Francis. Zurina & Zaidatun. (2006). Cara Pelajar Pendidikan Teknik Dan Vokasional Mempelajari Kemahiran Teknikal Dengan Menggunakan Laman Web (SWEB-TECH). Paper presented at the Seminar Kebangsaan Pendidikan Dan Vokasional. 370 PERSEPSI PELAJAR SEKOLAH BERASRAMA PENUH (SBP) TERHADAP MATA PELAJARAN FIZIK Nur Hazwani Zakaria & Fatin Aliah Phang ABSTRAK Kajian ini bertujuan untuk mengetahui persepsi pelajar tingkatan empat sekolah berasrama penuh (SBP). Dua aspek yang dikaji iaitu tahap motivasi pelajar dan strategi pembelajaran Fizik yang diamalkan. Responden kajian terdiri daripada 40 orang pelajar SBP di Kedah. Kajian ini menggunakan soal selidik sebagai instrumen kajian. Data maklumat yang diperoleh dianalisa dengan huraian peratus dan min. Purata taburan menggunakan tiga bahagian iaitu tinggi, rendah dan sederhana. Keputusan kajian menunjukkan tahap motivasi adalah tinggi dan strategi pembelajaran yang diamalkan juga tinggi. Di samping itu terdapat beberapa cadangan dan item yang memerlukan perhatian untuk kajian seterusnya seperti kurang keyakinan untuk belajar sendiri dan mencari penyelesaian Fizik melalui internet. Kesimpulannya, kebergantungan kepada guru dan rakan adalah sangat tinggi di kalangan pelajar SBP. Kata Kunci: Persepsi pelajar, Motivasi, Strategi pembelajaran, penilaian,Ppencapaian, KBAT, Fizik, Pembelajaran pengalaman 371 PENGENALAN Penurunan bilangan pelajar dalam bidang sains di universiti memberi impak yang besar kepada pembangunan negara (Mujtaba & Reiss, 2012). Banyak negara memperkasa bidang sains yang memfokuskan Science, Technology, Engineering and Mathematics (STEM) untuk memastikan kelangsungan modal insan berkualiti dalam sains (Divine & Williams, 2013). Fizik merupakan satu mata pelajaran yang menjadi disiplin ilmu sains. Bilangan pelajar yang memasuki aliran sains tulen juga rendah dan dasar pendidikan negara yang mensasarkan 60 % pelajar aliran sains dan 40 % pelajar aliran sastera pada peringkat menegah atas belum dicapai (Mohd Saleh, Fatin, Mohamad Bilal, & Salmiza, 2012). Maka, kerajaan mewujudkan sekolah berasrama penuh (SBP) sebagai satu langkah untuk memenuhi dasar tersebut. Pelajar cemerlang dari kawasan luar bandar diberi peluang untuk meneruskan pelajaran di SBP melalui saringan Ujian Penilaian Sekolah Rendah (UPSR) dan Penilaian Menengah Rendah (PMR) (Ministry of Malaysia Education, 2013b). Penilaian antarabangsa seperti Trends in Mathematics and Science Study (TIMMS) dan Programme for International Student Assessment (PISA) memberi kesan kepada sistem pendidikan negara. Hasrat pendidikan negara dan pencapaian didapati tidak selari. Ini dapat dibuktikan dengan peruntukan belanjawan terhadap pendidikan adalah besar iaitu RM 36 Billion pada tahun 2012 melebihi 8.7 % lebih dari purata Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD)(Ministry of Malaysia Education, 2013b). Berdasarkan keputusan TIMMS tahun 2011, Malaysia berada di kedudukan ke 26 daripada keseluruhan 42 buah negara yang mengambil bahagian. Malaysia berada di kedudukan ke-7 dikalangan negara Asia dan kedudukan ke-2 antara empat buah negara Asia Tenggara yang menyertai TIMSS tahun 2011, iaitu selepas Singapura. Kedua-dua kajian ini menjadi penanda 372 aras sistem pendidikan negara pada tahap antarabangsa (Ministry of Malaysia Education, 2013a). Persamaan kedua – dua penilaian antarabangsa ini adalah faktor-faktor yang mempengaruhi pelajar, kebolehan mengaplikasi pelajaran yang diajar di sekolah kepada situasi harian, tahap motivasi pelajar, kepercayaan diri, strategi pembelajaran, literasi sains dan pencapaian dalam Sains dan Matematik. Kajian tersebut melibatkan faktor guru, sekolah dan dasar yang dilaksanakan oleh sistem pendidikan. Keputusan yang rendah dalam penilaian TIMMS adalah rendah dalam kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi seperti konsep mengaplikasi dan penaakulan. Peratus soalan yang disediakan adalah kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi sebanyak 75% iaitu konsep mengaplikasi dan penaakulan. Begitu juga dengan penilaian PISA, pelajar dinilai kemahiran aras tinggi seperti menyelesaikan masalah. KAJIAN LITERATUR Pelajar SBP merupakan pelajar yang mempunyai tahap pencapaian yang tinggi dalam akademik (Ministry of Malaysia Education, 2014). Jadi, pelajar SBP dijangka mempunyai pengetahuan subject-matter seimbang dengan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi (KBAT). Bagi menguasai KBAT, pelajar perlu menguasai kemahiran berfikir aras rendah (KBAR) dengan baik. Ia menyediakan asas yang baik untuk pembelajaran KBAT. Menurut Krathwohl (2002) menerusi Revised Bloom’s Taxonomy menyatakan pemahaman dan aplikasi menyediakan pelajar untuk menguasai pengetahuan yang abstrak, menggunakan formula untuk situasai yang baru. Jadi, pelajar boleh menganalisis, mensintesis dan membuat penilaian pada situasi baru. Melalui KBAT, pelajar didapati boleh membuat hubungan antara pengetahuan sedia ada dengan pengetahuan baru secara kreatif dan kritikal. Interaksi KBAR dan KBAT melibatkan kemahiran psikomotor, afektif dan 373 kognitif (Bolte, Holbrook, & Rauch, 2012). Teori pembelajaran pengalaman oleh Kolb (1984) menekankan pembelajaran berasaskan pengalaman dan pengamatan. Pembelajaran pengalaman didefinasikan perspektif pembelajaran yang holistik melibatkan pengalaman berterusan, pengetahuan dan tingkah laku. Ia juga melibatkan penguasaan dan menukarkan pengalaman kepada pembelajaran bermakna. Terdapat empat fasa dalam kitaran yang dicadangkan oleh Kolb (1984) iaitu pengalaman konkrit, refleksi pemerhatian, mengkonsepsi abstrak dan mengeksperimen secara aktif. Refleksi adalah pemikiran akhir yang menjadikan ia relevan dengan situasi sedia ada (Akella, 2010). Fizik merupakan satu disiplin ilmu STEM yang diberi pelbagai persepsi oleh pelajar sebagai subjek yang membosankan (Williams, Stanisstreet, Spall, Boyes, & Dickson, 2003) dan tidak relevan (Trumper, 2006), abstrak (Norlidah & Siraj, 2012; Semela, 2010), sukar (Richardson, 2013) dan susah (Carlone, 2003). Hal ini mewujudkan penguasaan kognitif yang rendah, kurang minat terhadap Fizik seterusnya motivasi dan pencapaian yang rendah. Pelbagai kajian dijalankan untuk meningkatkan minat pelajar dari segi strategi pembelajaran secara kontekstual, konstruktivisme, inquiry-discovery, pembelajaran masteri dan science-tecnologysociety (STS). Begitu juga dengan kaedah pengajaran dan pembelajaran yang digunakan seperti eksperimen, perbincangan, simulasi, projek, lawatan dan penggunaan teknologi. Dalam mengukuhkan penguasaan psikomotor dan kognitif pelajar, eksperimen dicadangkan sebagai kaedah yang sesuai dengan strategi pembelajaran inqury-discovery (Bolte et al., 2012). Kajian Chambers (2014) mendapati eksperimen dalam makmal berpanduan (guided labs) menunjukkan penguasaan lebih baik dalam penilaian konsepsual dan eksperimen makmal terbuka (open labs) menghasilkan pelajar yang lebih baik dalam tugasan eksperimen berbanding makmal tradisional (traditional labs). 374 Eksperimen merupakan elemen penting supaya pelajat dapat menguasai konsep Fizik dengan kukuh (Ministry of Malaysia Education, 2008) dan menguasai kemahiran proses sains (SPS) (Ministry of Malaysia Education, 2010). Eksperimen membolehkan pelajar berinteraksi dengan peralatan makmal melalui aktiviti dan eksperimen dapat mengukuhkan pemahaman pembelajaran (Dziabenko, Ordufia & Garcia-zubia, 2013). Melalui eksperimen, penyiasatan keadaan suatu bahan dijalankan, mengesahkan teori dan mengukuhkan kemahiran mengeksperimen (Ojediran et al., 2014; Sin, 2014) dan menghubungkan pemerhatian eksperimen dengan konsep teori, memahami konsep abstrak dan sikap kritikal terhadap Fizik (Ojediran, Oludipe, & Ehindero, 2014). Pendekatan inquiry-discovery memberikan kesan inkuiri unggul apabila pelajar mencari jawapan kepada soalan dengan pelbagai cara kaedah yang mereka patut gunakan. Inkuiri memberikan motivasi berbeza tetapi kaedah inkuri terbuka perlu dibimbing oleh guru supaya bersesuaian dengan kekangan kurikulum dan sistem penilaian. Inkuiri didapati membolehkan pelajar lebih memahami idea atau konsep, keupayaan prakikal merentasi aras intelek tetapi ia mengambil lebih masa berbanding kaedah tradisional (Bolte et al., 2012). Secara rumusan, inquirydiscovery yang dijalankan dengan kaedah eksperimen adalah bertujuan untuk membolehkan pelajar menjalankan eksperimen dengan kemahiran SPS yang bersesuaian dan ini dibuktikan pelajar belajar secara aktif. Kajian Salmiza & Afiq (2012) membuktikan 58.33 % responden kajian yang merupakan 12 orang guru dari Sekolah Berprestasi Tinggi (SBT), Sekolah Kecemerlangan Kluster, Sekolah Sukan dan SMK harian, menjalankan komunikasi sehala yang menyebabkan keadaan pembelajaran menjadi pasif. Kajian ini juga menyatakan 91.67 % responden bersetuju dengan penyataan guru sebagai sumber maklumat utama kepada pelajar. Hasil kajian juga menunjukkan 91.67 % responden menggunakan 375 kaedah formula untuk kemahiran menyelesaikan masalah berbanding hanya 8.33 % responden menggunakan kaedah penyelesaian masalah secara kreatif bersama penggunaan formula. Motivasi mempengaruhi tindakan seseorang yang dicetuskan oleh motivasi intrinsik dan pembentukan motivasi ekstrinsik (Ryan & Deci, 2000). Kajian menunjukkan motivasi dan sifat kepunyaan semasa melibatkan diri dalam pembelajaran sains memberi potensi untuk mereka meneruskan kerjaya dalam bidang sains di masa hadapan (Loukomies et al., 2013). Motivasi berhubung kait dengan kombinasi pengetahuan pelajar dan pencapaian akademik. Kepercayaan diri yang positif mempengaruhi pencapaian akademik dan pengetahuan pelajar. Jadi, pelajar yang menggunakan pelbagai strategi dalam memperoleh pengetahuan, pelajar akan lebih menggunakan metakognitif. Pelajar akan terus mempunyai motivasi sedemikian walaupun menghadapi saat susah dan cabaran akademik yang tidak menarik (Pintrich & de Groot, 1990). OBJEKTIF KAJIAN Objektif kajian ini adalah untuk mengenalpasti tahap motivasi terhadap Fizik dan mengenalpasti strategi pembelajaran Fizik dikalangan pelajar tingkatan empat di SBP. TEKNIK PERSAMPELAN Kajian ini dijalankan terhadap 40 orang pelajar tingkatan empat di sebuah SBP di Daerah Kubang Pasu, Kedah. Sampel rawak mudah digunakan kerana pelajar tetap dalam kelas yang mempelajari sains tulen dan latar belakang akademik yang homogen. 376 INSTRUMEN Instrumen kajian diadaptasi dari Motivated Strategies for Learning Questionnaire (MSLQ) (Liu & Lin, 2010; Pintrich & de Groot, 1990). Soal selidik ini menggunakan Skala Likert 1 hingga 5, bermula dengan sangat tidak setuju, tidak setuju, tidak pasti, setuju dan sangat setuju. Soal selidik telah disahkan oleh dua orang guru fizik dan seorang pensyarah fakulti pendidikan dalan bidang pendidikan sains (Mohd Ali, 2003). Ujian rintis dijalankan dua minggu sebelum soal selidik kajian dijalankan. Didapati indeks kebolehpercayaan alpha Cronbach selidik motivasi dalam pembelajaran fizik adalah 0.868 dan nilai ini boleh diterima untuk kajian penyelidikan. Motivasi dibahagikan kepada tiga sub skala: nilai, harapan dan pengaruh. Manakala strategi pembelajaran dikelaskan kepada strategi kognitif, strategi meta-kognitif, pengurusan sumber tidak-berinformasi, dan pengurusan sumber berinformasi. Kajian ini menggunakan dua konstruk iaitu nilai dan harapan bagi mengetahui tahap motivasi pelajar. Bagi mengetahui strategi pembelajaran Fizik yang dijalankan oleh pelajar, satu sub skala digunakan iaitu pengurusan sumber tidak-berinformasi iaitu satu konstruk bantuan (help-seeking). Jadual 1 menunjukkan sub skala motivasi Fizik, konstruk dan item yang digunakan motivasi dan strategi pembelajaran Fizik. Melalui kajian ini, pengkaji memilih konstruk bantuan (help-seeking) kerana ia strategi yang semakin digunakan oleh guru dan pelajar. Hal ini disokong oleh kajian Liu & Lin (2010), strategi pembelajaran yang selalu dilaksanakan oleh pelajar adalah bantuan. 377 Jadual 1 : Sub skala motivasi Fizik, konstruk dan item dalam instrumen Motivasi dan Strategi pembelajaran Fizik Motivasi Fizik Sub skala Konstruk Item asal Nilai Orientasi Matlamat Intrinsik Orientasi Matlamat Ekstrinsik Keberkesa nan diri Bantuan 13, 18, 24, 30 Item Kajian 1, 2, 3, 4 2, 8, 25. 31 5, 6, 7, 8 11, 22, 28, 34 9, 10, 11, 12 13, 14, 15, 16 Harapan Strategi Pembelajaran Fizik Pengurusan sumber tidakberinformasi 19, 30, 52, 63 ANALISIS Data yang diperoleh dianalisa menggunakan analisa deskriptif min dan peratus. KEPUTUSAN Peratus pelajar yang bersetuju dengan penyataan yang diberikan dinyatakan pada ruangan skala 1 hingga 5. Min ditunjukkan untuk merujuk kepada tahap yang dicapai seperti rendah, sederhana dan tinggi. Min yang diperoleh adalah tahap sederhana 3.36 hingga tahap tinggi 4.78. Berdasarkan Jadual 2 di bawah, keputusan soal selidik adalah seperti berikut. 378 Jadual 2 : Keputusan Soal Selidik Bil 1 2 3 4 5 2.5% - 2.5% 12.5 % 82.5 % 4.73 5% 2.5% 30% 47.5 % 15% 3.65 - 2.5% 5% 42.5 % 50% 4.40 - - 2.5% 17.5 % 75% 4.70 - - 2.5% 17.5 % 80% 4.78 - - 22.5 % 40% 37.5 % 4.15 5% 10% 45% 25% 15% 3.35 2.5% 17.5 % 10% 37.5 % 32.5 % 3.80 5% 10% 27.5 % 40% 17.5 % 3.55 2.5% - 27.5 % 47.5 % 22.5 % 3.88 Saya layak mengajar rakan sekelas saya subjek Fizik 7.5% 12.5 % 20% 47.5 % 12.5 % 3.45 Bagi saya Fizik tidak sukar 2.5% 7.5% 42.5 % 37.5 % 10% 3.45 Komponen dan Penyataan Orientasi Matlamat Intrinsik 1 Harapan saya adalah untuk memahami isi kandungan bahan pembelajaran dalam kelas Fizik 2 Saya suka menjalankan banyak projek dan kerja rumah kerana ia membantu saya lebih memahami Fizik walaupun ia tidak meningkatkan pencapaian saya 3 Pembelajaran Fizik meningkatkan pemikiran logik saya. 4 Saya akan belajar lebih kuat untuk mendapatkan pencapaian lebih baik dalam Fizik Orientasi Matlamat Ekstrinsik 5 Saya mahu mendapat pencapaian terbaik dalam kelas Fizik 6 Bagi saya, kelas Fizik boleh meningkatkan pencapaian keseluruhan akademik saya 7 Harapan besar saya adalah untuk memasuki universiti melalui pembelajaran Fizik 8 Saya mahu markah Fizik yang tinggi supaya orang menghargai saya. Keberkesanan Diri (Self-efficacy) 9 Saya yakin bahawa saya boleh memahami bahagian Fizik yang sukar dalam bahan pembelajaran Fizik dengan cara saya sendiri 10 Saya yakin boleh mahir dalam setiap topik dalam Fizik 11 12 Bantuan (Help-seeking) Min 379 13 14 15 16 Saya akan bertanya kepada guru untuk menjelaskan bahagian Fizik yang kurang jelas Jika saya tidak memahami bahan pembelajaran, saya akan meminta rakan sekelas membantu Jika saya tidak memahami bahan pembelajaran, saya akan mencari penyelesaian di laman sesawang internet Saya akan terus bertanya kepada guru bahagian yang kurang jelas semasa di dalam kelas - 5% - 50% 45% 4.35 2.5% - 2.5% 32.5 % 62.5 % 4.53 5% 5% 42.5 % 30% 17.5 % 3.50 2.5% 5% 17.5 % 52.5 % 22.5 % 3.88 Berdasarkan Jadual 2, item yang mempunyai peratus tertinggi adalah “saya mahu mendapatkan pencapaian terbaik dalam kelas Fizik” dengan 97.5 % dan peratus yang rendah adalah “harapan memasuki universiti melalui pembelajaran Fizik” dengan 40 %. Dua pernyataan yang mempunyai peratusan bawah tahap purata iaitu persepsi Fizik sebagai subjek yang tidak sukar sebanyak 47.5 % dan strategi pembelajaran Fizik yang diamalkan oleh pelajar SBP, iaitu mencari penyelesaian di laman sesawang di internet sebanyak 47.5 %. Hal ini mungkin disebabkan pelajar banyak bertanya kepada guru dan kawan dalam menjelaskan bahagian Fizik yang sukar difahami. Jadual 3 menunjukkan analisis peratus motivasi pelajar SBP terhadap Fizik adalah tinggi dan strategi pembelajaran Fizik yang diamalkan juga tinggi. Jadual 3 : Analisis Peratus motivasi dan Strategi Pembelajaran Fizik Persoalan Motivasi Strategi pembelajaran Fizik Peratus (%) Tidak Setuju Setuju 28.12 71.88 21.87 78.13 Tahap penilaian Tinggi (positif) Tinggi (positif) 380 Kesimpulannya, objektif kajian pertama iaitu tahap motivasi pelajar adalah tinggi. Obkejtif kajian kedua iaitu strategi pembelajaran Fizik yang diamalkan juga tinggi. PERBINCANGAN Berpandukan Jadual 2 dan Jadual 3, item yang perlu dibincangkan adalah tahap yang sederhana iaitu 62.5 % pada pernyataan “pelajar suka menjalankan banyak projek dan kerja rumah kerana ia membantu saya lebih memahami Fizik walaupun ia tidak meningkatkan pencapaian akademik saya”. Pelajar mungkin kurang berminat dengan aktiviti projek sains, dan kerja rumah. Hal ini mungkin disebabkan kurang pendedahan tentang kebaikan dan keseronokan dalam menjalankan projek sains mahupun aktiviti dalam dan luar makmal Fizik. “Fizik tidak sukar” menunjukkan peratusan sebanyak 47.5%. Maka, masih terdapat persepsi bahawa subjek Fizik adalah sukar. Kesimpulannya, Fizik masih dianggap satu subjek yang sukar seperti kajian yang dijalankan Richardson (2013); Carlone (2003). Pernyataan “harapan besar saya adalah untuk memasuki universiti melalui pembelajaran Fizik” sebanyak 40 %. Hal ini mungkin disebabkan pelajar berminat dengan subjek sains yang lain seperti Kimia dan Biologi. Pembelajaran Fizik merupakan satu cara untuk menunjukkan sikap pelajar yang berminat dengan penerokaan bidang Fizik secara khusus. Pernyataan “saya layak mengajar rakan sekelas saya subjek Fizik” menunjukkan peratusan 60 %. Hal ini mungkin disebabkan oleh keyakinan yang sederhana dalam proses pembelajaran dan perkongsian pengetahuan dengan rakan sebaya. Pernyataan “saya yakin bahawa saya boleh memahami bahagian Fizik yang sukar dalam bahan pembelajaran Fizik dengan cara saya sendiri” dengan peratusan 57.5 %. Hal ini mungkin disebabkan pelajar banyak bertanya kepada rakan dan guru mengenai bahagian Fizik yang 381 sukar. Pernyataan “jika saya tidak memahami bahan pembelajaran, saya akan mencari penyelesaian di laman sesawang internet” menunjukkan peratusan yang rendah iaitu 47.5 %. Pelajar lebih menumpukan pertanyaan kepada guru dan kawan berbanding mencuba mencari bahan pembelajaran alternatif dari internet. Pelbagai kemudahan seperti portal pendidikan yang menyediakan bahan pembelajaran, video dan simulasi yang boleh diperoleh melalui internet. Jadi, skop strategi pembelajaran dikalangan pelajar masih menggunakan bahan yang disediakan guru dan guru menjadi tumpuan dalam pengesahan dan jawapan penyelesaian masalah. Hal ini bertepatan dengan kajian Salmiza & Afiq (2012) yang menunjukkan guru adalah sumber informasi utama pelajar. Konstruk keberkesanan diri (self-efficacy) menunjukkan purata peratus yang rendah berbanding konstruk yang lain iaitu 58.75 %, konstruk orientasi matlamat ekstrinsik sebanyak 71.25 %, konstruk bantuan sebanyak 78.13 % dan orientasi matlamat intrinsik sebanyak 85.63 %. Jadi, pelajar perlu mempunyai keberkesanan diri yang tinggi untuk menguasai kognitif dan kebolehan mengaplikasi Fizik memberi persepsi positif terhadap Fizik. Maka, dicadangkan pembelajaran Fizik menggunakan komputer dalam menjalankan eksperimen. Eksperimen berasaskan komputer menyediakan pembelajaran yang menarik (Siew Wei Tho & Baseri Hussain, 2011) dan menjimatkan masa (Makan, Kopasz, & Gingl, 2014). Radas yang digunakan juga lebih moden berbanding radas makmal tradisional (Siew Wei Tho & Baseri Hussain, 2011). Eksperimen merupakan aktiviti makmal yang mampu meningkatkan motivasi, menjana kemahiran berfikir secara kritikal, mengelak miskonsepsi dan penguasaan kognitif pelajar (Tomshaw, 2006). Kajian Venables (2008) juga membuktikan pencapaian pelajar meningkat dengan menggunakan eksperimen berasakan komputer. 382 RUJUKAN Akella, D. (2010). Learning together: Kolb’s experiential theory and its application. Journal of Management & Organization. doi:10.5172/jmo.16.1.100 Bolte, C., Holbrook, J., & Rauch, F. (2012). Inquiry-based Science Education in Europe : Reflections from the PROFILES Project. Carlone, H. B. (2003). Innovative Science Within and Against a Culture of “Achievement.” Science Education, 87(3), 307–328. doi:10.1002/sce.10071 Chambers, T. (2014). THREE PEDAGOGICAL APPROACHES TO INTRODUCTORY PHYSICS LABS AND THEIR EFFECTS ON STUDENT by In the Graduate College. University of Arizona. Divine, L., & Williams, R. (2013). STEM collaboration in virtual world academy. 2013 International Conference on Collaboration Technologies and Systems (CTS), 569–575. doi:10.1109/CTS.2013.6567288 Dziabenko, O., Ordufia, P., & Garcia-zubia, J. (2013). Remote Experiments in Secondary School Education. Kolb, D. A. (1984). Experiential learning : experience as the source of learning and development. Prentice-Hall. Liu, E. Z. F., & Lin, C. H. (2010). THE SURVEY STUDY OF MATHEMATICS MOTIVATED STRATEGIES FOR LEARNING QUESTIONNAIRE ( MMSLQ ) FOR GRADE 10 – 12 TAIWANESE, 9(2), 221–234. Loukomies, A., Pnevmatikos, D., Lavonen, J., Spyrtou, A., Byman, R., Kariotoglou, P., & Juuti, K. (2013). Promoting Students’ Interest and Motivation Towards Science Learning: the Role of Personal Needs and Motivation Orientations. Research in Science Education, 43(6), 2517–2539. doi:10.1007/s11165-013-9370-1 Makan, G., Kopasz, K., & Gingl, Z. (2014). Real-time analysis of mechanical and electrical resonances with open-source sound card software. European Journal of Physics, 35(1), 015009. doi:10.1088/0143-0807/35/1/015009 Ministry of Malaysia Education. (2008). Kupasan Mutu Jawapan SPM Fizik 2 4531/2. Ministry of Malaysia Education. (2010). Kupasan Mutu Jawapan SPM Fizik 2 4531/2 (pp. 1–12). Ministry of Malaysia Education. (2013a). LAPORAN KEBANGSAAN 383 TIMSS 2011. Ministry of Malaysia Education. (2013b). Malaysia Education Blueprint 2013 - 2025. Ministry of Malaysia Education. (2014). Boarding School. Mohd Ali Samsudin. (2003). Kesan Pembelajaran Kontekstual Terhadap Pemcapaian Pelajar dan Motivasi Pelajar Dalam Mata Pelajaran Fizik Tingkatan Empat. Tesis Ijazah Sarjana. Pulau Pinang: Universiti Sains Malaysia Mohd Saleh Abu, Fatin Aliah Phang, Mohamad Bilal Ali, & Salmiza Saleh. (2012). Science education policy in Malaysia. In L. M. T. & H. Said (Ed.), Educational Issues, Research Policies (pp. 113–127). Johor: Penerbit UTM PRESS. Mujtaba, T., & Reiss, M. J. (2012). Factors Affecting whether Students in England Choose to Study Physics once the Subject is Optional, (March), 1–13. Norlidah, A., & Siraj, S. (2012). Design and Development of Physics Module Based on The Learning Style and Appropriate Technology by Employing ISMAN, 11(4), 84–93. Ojediran, I. A., Oludipe, D. I., & Ehindero, O. J. (2014). Impact of Laboratory-Based Instructional Intervention on the Learning Outcomes of Low Performing Senior Secondary Students in Physics, (March), 197–206. Pintrich, P. R., & de Groot, E. V. (1990). Motivational and self-regulated learning components of classroom academic performance. Journal of Educational Psychology, 82(1), 33–40. doi:10.1037//00220663.82.1.33 Richardson, T. D. (2013). Exploring Ontario Grade Ten Students’ Decisions To Select Or Reject School Physics. University of Toronto. Ryan, R., & Deci, E. (2000). Intrinsic and Extrinsic Motivations: Classic Definitions and New Directions. Contemporary Educational Psychology, 25(1), 54–67. doi:10.1006/ceps.1999.1020 Salmiza Saleh, & Afiq Aziz. (2012). Teaching Practices Among Secondary School Teachers in Malaysia, 1997, 63–67. doi:10.7763/IPEDR. Semela, T. (2010). Who is joining physics and why ? Factors influencing the choice of physics among Ethiopian university students, 5(3), 319–340. Siew Wei Tho, & Baseri Hussain. (2011). The development of a 384 Microcomputer-Based Laboratory ( MBL ) system for gas pressure law experiment via open source software. International Journal of Education and Development Using Information and Communication Technology, 7(1), 42–55. Sin, C. (2014). Epistemology, Sociology, and Learning and Teaching in Physics. Science Education, 98(2), 342–365. doi:10.1002/sce.21100 Stephen G. Tomshaw. (2006). An Investigation of the Use of Microcomputer-Based Laboratory Simulations in Promoting Conceptual in Secondary Physics Instruction. Drexel University. Trumper, R. (2006). Factors Affecting Junior High School Students’ Interest in Physics. Journal of Science Education and Technology, 15(1), 47–58. doi:10.1007/s10956-006-0355-6 Venables, J. (2008). Quasi-Experimental Nonequivalent (Prestest and Posttest) Control Group Study of the Effects of MicrocomputerBased Laboratory Systems on Academic Achievement in High School Chemistry Students at Two South Carolina High Schools. Walden University. Williams, C., Stanisstreet, M., Spall, K., Boyes, E., & Dickson, D. (2003). Why aren ’ t secondary students interested in physics ? 385 MENGENALPASTI KESAN PENDIDIKAN KEUSAHAWANAN PADA PELAJAR KEJURUTERAAN : satu kajian literatur Ahmad Firdaus Abd Hadi, Mohd. Khata Jabor & Dayana Farzeha Ali ABSTRAK Perubahan dalam ekonomi dan keperluan tenaga kerja telah membawa banyak Institut Kejuruteraan mempertimbangkan untuk menawarkan pendidikan keusahawanan kepada pelajar-pelajar mereka. Kajian literatur ini adalah untuk mengenalpasti tahap kecenderungan keusahawanan pelajar kejuruteraan bagi membuat perbandingan kesan antara pelajar yang telah mengambil kursus keusahawanan dan pelajar yang tidak mengambil kursus keusahawanan di universiti terhadap niat keusahawanan berdasarkan kepada beberapa kajian yang telah di lakukan sebelum ini. Hasil kajian literatur adalah berdasarkan kepada tiga pembolehubah untuk mengenalpasti kecenderungan keusahawanan iaitu jantina, pendedahan kursus keusahawanan dan pendedahan dari keluaraga usahawan. Kata Kunci: Pendidikan keusahawanan 386 PENGENALAN Keusahawanan sering dikaitkan dengan merangsang pertumbuhan ekonomi, inovasi dan pekerjaan dan usaha ciptaan. Kajian empirikal juga menyokong pautan positif antara aktiviti keusahawanan dan kesan ekonomi (Van Praag & Versloot, 2007). Bidang keusahawanan ini juga telah menjadi topik yang diutamakan dalam dasar peningkatan taraf hidup masyarakat (Luthje & Franke, 2003). Oleh yang demikian, pelbagai program dan perkhidmatan telah dilaksanakan untuk memberikan infrastruktur yang lebih baik untuk menggalakkan usahawan. Satu elemen penting dalam aktiviti-aktiviti ini adalah mensasarkan pelajar sains dan kejuruteraan sebagai usahawan masa depan. Pelajar dalam bidang kejuruteraan adalah dijangka untuk menjana ekonomi secara signifikan dan merangsang pekerjaan (Luthje & Franke, 2003). Fakta ini disokong oleh Hisrich (2000) bahawa pelajar dalam bidang kejuruteraan dipercayai sangat kuat dalam menjalankan aktiviti keusahawanan. Kesedaran tentang nilai potensi pendidikan keusahawanan kepada pelajar-pelajar kejuruteraan telah meningkat dengan ketara dalam tahun-tahun kebelakangan ini berasaskan kepada trend ekonomi dan didorong dengan permintaan kerja yang tinggi. Secara umum, peranan jurutera telah berkembang bebas, berkeyakinan yang tinggi, pencipta dan bermotivasi tinggi dari bergantung kepada dunia korporat, kecil atau besar (Yurtseven, 2002). Untuk menyediakan pelajar menghadapi realiti yang baru, universiti semakin sedar bahawa mereka bukan sahaja mampu untuk mencipta produk baru, tetapi juga mempunyai keupayaan untuk mengenal pasti peluang, memahami kuasa pasaran, mengkomersialkan teknologi baru, dan penyokong untuk mereka. Trend ini telah mendorong meningkatkan dalam penyampaian pendidikan keusahawanan kepada pelajar-pelajar kejuruteraan melalui kursus, program, dan pembelajaran pengalaman yang ditawarkan oleh pihak pihak universititi. Sokongan ini untuk 387 mewujudkan kursus keusahawanan telahpun di berikan oleh pihak kerajaan sendiri yang memberikan galakkan kepada pelajar untuk menceburi bidang keusahawanan. Kerajaan telah menggalakkan rakyat Malaysia terutama pelajar-pelajar lepasan universiti untuk menjadi usahawan selepas tamat pengajian dan tidak terlalu bergantung kepada kerja makan gaji semata-mata. Untuk merangsang minat pelajar universiti dalam bidang keusahawanan, bermula dari ambilan Julai 2007 dan seterusnya, Kementerian Pengajian Tinggi telah mewajibkan semua pelajar yang melanjutkan pengajian di institusi pengajian tinggi awam (IPTA) mengambil mata pelajaran keusahawanan sebagai satu mata pelajaran wajib (Utusan Malaysia, 2007). Walaupun jumlah pelajar kejuruteraan yang didedahkan kepada pendidikan keusahawanan telah meningkat, penyelidikan berkenaan sikap pelajar kejuruteraan ke arah keusahawanan, atau kesannya ke atas pembelajaran mereka, tingkah laku, kecekapan profesional, atau matlamat kerjaya adalah kurang. Walaubagaimanapun terdapat beberapa kajian telah dilakukan dalam bidang keusahawanan, tetapi tidak fokus kepada pelajar kejuruteraan secara khusus. Antara sebab-sebab utama bagi kurangnya kajian dalam bidang ini termasuk: 1) integrasi pendidikan keusahawanan ke dalam kurikulum kejuruteraan adalah satu usaha yang agak baru, 2) terdapat kekurangan yang konsisten pada model program, dan pendekatan pedagogi pengajaran di institut pengajaran (Standish-Kuon & Beras 2002), dan 3) mendefinisikan sebuah ilmu pengetahuan keusahawanan untuk jurutera adalah satu proses yang berterusan (Shartrand et al. 2008). Beliau telah menerangkan mendapati banyak daripada kajian yang telah dibuat oleh fakulti kejuruteraan merupakan kajian kes deskriptif antaranya ialah mengenalpasti minat pelajar terhadap keusahawanan, mengkaji berkenaan kandungan kurikulum keusahawanan, pendekatan pedagogi yang digunakan, cabaran pelaksanaan, dan penilaian merancang. Manakala Ohland (2004) menyatakan terdapat banyak kajian yang telah menghasilkan berkenan kurikulum keusahawana dan dari kajian tersebut terdapat banyak kajian menunjukkan kejayaan program yang dilakukan 388 oleh mereka. Kajian literatur ini adalah untuk mengenalpasti kesan pendidikan keusahawanan terhadap pelajar kejuruteraan. Penyelidikan ini adalah berdasarkan dari bahan bacaan yang telah dibuat terhadap beberapa kertas penyelidikan yang memberi fokus kepada kesan pendidikan keusahawanan terhadap pelajar kejuruteraan. Penyelidikan terhadap sikap pelajar kejuruteraan berhubung dengan pendidikan keusahawanan telah tertumpu kepada faktor-faktor yang mempengaruhi niat untuk menjadi usahawan. Terdapat beberapa bukti bahawa faktor-faktor kontekstual seperti program pendidikan boleh meningkatkan niat keusahawanan. OBJEKTIF DAN PERSOALAN KAJIAN Kajian literatur ini akan mengenalpasti hasil daripada pendidikan keusahawanan pelajar kejuruteraan. Ianya menjelaskan hubungan antara ciri-ciri pencapai pelajar kejuruteraan yang mengambil program keusahawanan di universiti. Ianya memberi fokus kepada tiga ciri-ciri iaitu jantina, pendedahan keusahawanan dari keluarga usahawan dan pendedahan pendidikan keusahawanan. Persoalan kajian yang diberi tumpuan adalah : Apakah kesan pendidikan keusahawanan terhadap niat keusahawanan pelajar kejuruteraan berdasarkan jantina, pendedahan kursus keusahawanan dan pendedahan dari keluarga usahawan ? KAEDAH KAJIAN Kajian literatur ini dihasilkan melalui hasil dari bacaan yang telah dilakukan terhadap beberapa kajian lepas dan journal di internet antaranya di IEEE Journal, Journal of Engineering Education dan beberapa yang lain lagi. 389 MODEL KECENDERUNGAN KEUSAHAWANAN Niat keusahawanan menggambarkan keadaan fikiran yang memulakan orang ramai untuk memilih daripada bekerja sendiri dan bukannya memilih pekerjaan makan gaji. Menurut Krueger (1993) niat keusahawanan adalah komitmen untuk melaksanakan tingkah laku yang perlu untuk fizikal memulakan usaha perniagaan. Oleh yang demikian, niat keusahawanan adalah fenomena yang penting dan salah satu yang telah menarik penyelidikan kognitif yang besar. Penyelidikan menyokong keperluan untuk mengkaji fenomena keusahawanan sebelum ia berlaku (Pruett et al, 2009). Niat keusahawanan sering dikaji dengan penggunaan model niat. Model Niat menawarkan koheren dan rangka kerja yang kukuh untuk mengikuti pemahaman yang lebih baik tentang proses keusahawanan (Krueger, 1993). Walaupun terdapat beberapa model niat keusahawanan dalam teori keusahawanan (Bird, 1988; Boyd & Vozikis, 1994; Krueger dan Brazeal, 1994), kedua-dua model yang dinamakan niat adalah Teori Ajzen (1991) tingkah laku yang dirancang dan Sokol (1982) teori program keusahawanan. Menurut kajian, teori Ajzen iaitu tingkah laku yang dirancang dan Shapero dan Model Shokol mengenai bidang-bidang keusahawanan adalah selari dan serasi. Rangka Kerja Kajian Kedua-dua teori-teori tingkah laku terancang dan model acara keusahawanan menekankan latar belakang motivasi kepada niat keusahawanan. Mereka tidak termasuk pembolehubah eksogen / demografi yang boleh mempengaruhi niat. Krueger et al. (2000) berhujah bahawa kerana pembolehubah eksogen atau demografi beroperasi secara tidak langsung kepada niat, mereka tidak termasuk dalam model niat. Tetapi beberapa penyelidik menekankan keperluan untuk menggabungkan pembolehubah lain memahami niat keusahawanan yang lebih baik. Seperti yang dinyatakan oleh Gelderen et al. (2008), pembolehubah tambahan seperti jantina, pengalaman kerja, peranan ibu bapa model dan 390 personaliti yang sebenarnya meningkatkan pemahaman kita tentang niat keusahawanan. Kepentingan faktor-faktor demografi adalah biasa dalam penyelidikan niat. Oleh yang demikian dalam kajian ini, kesan demografi keusahawanan menjadi pembolehubah pendidikan keusahawanan (seperti jantina, pendedahan kepada pendidikan dan pendedahan kepada keusahawanan) ditunjukkan sebagai pengaruh tidak langsung berkaitan niat seperti yang ditunjukkan dalam Rajah 1. Rajah 1 Kerangka kajian kecenderungan keusahawanan pembolehubah terhadap 391 Pendedahan Pendidikan Keusahawanan Melalui beberapa penyelidikan yang telah dijalankan mendapati bahawa pendidikan keusahawanan boleh memberikan kesan niat pelajar terhadap keusahawanan. Kajian yang dijalankan oleh Webb et al. (1982) mendapati bahawa pelajar-pelajar yang telah mengambil bahagian dalam program-program keusahawanan lebih cenderung untuk memulakan perniagaan mereka sendiri daripada pelajar-pelajar lain. Grubb et al. (2006) juga telah membuat kesimpulan bahawa pelajar universiti dalam bidang pengurusan perniagaan lebih cenderung kearah kerjaya dalam arena perniagaan kecil. Peterman (2000) mendedahkan bahawa penyertaan dalam program keusahawanan dengan ketara meningkat pengaruh memulakan perniagaan. Noel (2001) juga mengesahkan bahawa graduan keusahawanan lebih cenderung untuk memulakan perniagaan. Katz (2007) juga mencadangkan bahawa latihan keusahawanan boleh menambah nilai sebenar dengan meningkatkan kejayaan kebarangkalian untuk memulakan perniagaan. Sejajar dengan itu, Franke dan Luthje (2004) mendapati bahawa pendidikan keusahawanan mempunyai kesan positif kepada niat keusahawanan dan juga mencadangkan bahawa kekurangan pendidikan keusahawanan membawa kepada tahap yang rendah terhadap niat keusahawanan pelajar. Program pendidikan keusahawanan adalah faktor sikap keusahawanan dan niat keseluruhan untuk menjadi usahawan masa depan (Souitaris et al., 2007). Jantina Menurut beberapa penyelidik, tidak ada perbezaan dalam niat keusahawanan berdasarkan pelajar lelaki dan perempuan (Pruett et al, 2009;. Indarti dan Kristiansen, 2003), penyelidikan mencadangkan bahawa niat keusahawanan banyak berbeza dengan ketara dengan jantina (Mazzarol et al, 1999;. Kolvereid, 1996; Harris dan Gibson, 2008; Shay dan Terjesen, 2005; Wilson et al, 392 2004.; Ramayah dan Harun, 2005). Menurut Mazzarol et al. (1999) perempuan kurang mempunyai niat keusahawanan. Penemuan ini telah diperkukuhkan oleh Kolvereid (1996) yang merumuskan bahawa lelaki mempunyai lebih tinggi niat keusahawanan daripada perempuan. Keputusan yang sama telah dirumuskan oleh Ede et al. (1998) yang mendedahkan bahawa pelajar lelaki mempunyai lebih positif terhadap sikap keusahawanan daripada rakan-rakan wanita mereka. Wilson et al. (2007) juga mendapati skor yang ketara lebih rendah untuk wanita pada niat keusahawanan. Pada masa yang sama, Zhao et al. (2005) mendapati jantina mempunyai kesan yang ketara dalam niat keusahawanan. Veciana et al. (2005) juga mengesahkan bahawa wanita mempunyai niat keusahawanan yang lebih rendah daripada lelaki. Pendedahan Dari Perniagaan Keluarga Pendedahan kepada keusahawanan, seperti perniagaan keluarga, telah diintegrasikan ke dalam keusahawanan-niat model (Krueger, 1993; Shapero dan Sokol, 1982) yang meletakkan mengemukakan pendedahan itu untuk perniagaan keluarga secara tidak langsung mempengaruhi keusahawanan niat melalui kebaikan dilihat dan kemungkinan. Reitan (1996) menunjukkan bahawa pengalaman kerja dengan perniagaan keluarga boleh mempunyai kesan positif kepada persepsi baru kemungkinan usaha dan keinginan. Drennan et al. (2005) mendapati bahawa mereka yang melaporkan pandangan positif pengalaman perniagaan keluarga mereka dianggap memulakan perniagaan kerana kedua-dua wajar dan boleh dilaksanakan. Harris dan Gibson (2008) juga menunjukkan bahawa pelajar-pelajar perniagaan yang dilaporkan mempunyai pendedahan keusahawanan sebelum ini melalui keluarga perniagaan kecil seseorangmempunyai sikap keusahawanan yang tinggi. Krueger (1993) juga menyatakan bahawa anak-anak muda keluarga yang memiliki perniagaan sendiri lebih cenderung untuk berhasrat untuk memulakan mereka sendiri perniagaan. 393 KESIMPULAN Berdasarkan kajian-kajian yang telah dilakukan menunjukkan bahawa pelajar-pelajar yang didedahkan dengan pendidikan keusahawanan di universiti secara umum, dilaporkan mempunyai niat lebih kepada keusahawanan berbanding pelajar kejuruteraan yang tidak mengambil kursus keusahawanan. Secara khusus, pelajar yang telah terdedah kepadan pendidikan keusahawanan menunjukkan daya tarikan yang lebih peribadi ke arah keusahawanan. Dilaporkan juga lokus kawalan dalaman telah meningkatkan keberkesanan diri dan norma subjektif dilihat kuat daripada pelajar kejuruteraan yang tidak mengambil pendidikan keusahawanan. Pada masa yang sama, melalui pendidikan keusahawanan akan dapat mempengaruhi orang lain (seperti sikap rakan-rakan rapat dan keluarga) terhadap pelajar yang menjadikan keusahawanan sebagai pilihan kerjaya. Penemuan ini adalah dengan kerja-kerja kajian sebelumnya (Pruett et al, 2009; Souitaris et al, 2007; Wilson et al, 2007;. Hollenbeck dan Hall, 2004; Noel, 2001). Berhubung dengan kesan jantina dalam niat keusahawanan pelajar universiti, kajian ini menunjukkan bahawa pelajar lelaki yang telah mengambil kursus keusahawanan menyuarakan hasrat yang lebih tinggi ke arah keusahawanan berbanding pelajar perempuan yang telah mengambil kursus keusahawanan dan juga pelajar kejuruteraan lelaki dan perempuan yang tidak mengambil kursus keusahawanan. Apabila perbandingan dibuat dalam kumpulan yang (antara lelaki dan perempuan dalam jabatan yang sama), pelajar lelaki yang telah mengambil kursus keusahawanan dilaporkan lebih tinggi niat keusahawanan daripada pelajar perempuan di jabatan yang sama. Kajian ini selaras dengan penemuan kajian Harris dan Gibson (2008), Shay dan Terjesen (2005), Wilson et al. (2004) dan Ramayah dan Harun (2005) tetapi ia adalah berbeza daripada dapatan yang diperolehi Olomi dan Sinyamule (2009), Pruett et al. (2009), Indarti and Kristiansen (2003) yang menunjukkan tiada perbezaan yang bermakna antara 394 lelaki dan perempuan dari segi niat untuk memulakan perniagaan. Oleh itu, daripada dapatan kajian ini, ia adalah mungkin untuk membuat kesimpulan bahawa pelajar perempuan adalah mungkin lebih berminat untuk mendapatkan pekerjaan bergaji dan bukannya mencari kerjaya keusahawanan. Dilihat kesan latar belakang keusahawanan keluarga pada pelajar niat keusahawanan pula, kajian menunjukkan pembolehubah ini gagal untuk menyokong idea bahawa pelajar yang mempunyai keluarga keusahawanan mempunyai niat keusahawanan lebih daripada pelajar-pelajar yang ahli keluarganya bukan usahawan. Oleh itu, walaupun pelajar yang keluarga mempunyai perniagaan perusahaan biasanya cenderung kepada niat keusahawanan, mereka adalah sangat kritikal ke arah keusahawanan sebagai kerjaya. RUJUKAN Ajzen, I. (1991). The theory of planned behaviour. Organizational Behavior and Human Decision Processes. Charney, Alberta, and Gary Libecap (2003). The contribution of entrepreneurship education: An analysis of the Berger program. International Journal of Entrepreneurship Education Chen, Chao, Patricia Greene, and Ann Crick (1998). Does entrepreneurial self-efficacy distinguish entrepreneurs from managers? Journal of Business Venturing De Noble, Alex, Dong Jung, and Sanford Erlich (1999). Entrepreneurial Self-Efficacy: The Development of a Measure and Its Relationship to Entrepreneurial Action. In Frontiers of Entrepreneurship Research. Wellesley, MA: Babson College. Duval-Couetil, Nathalie, Teri Reed-Rhoads, and Shiva Haghighi (2010). Development of an Assessment Instrument to Examine Outcomes of Entrepreneurship Education on Engineering Students. Paper presented at the 40th ASEE/IEEE Frontiers in Education Conference, Washington, DC. Drennan, J., Kennedy, J. and Renfrow, P. (2005). Impact of childhood experiences on the development of entrepreneurial intentions. International Journal of Entrepreneurship & Innovation. 395 Ede, F.O., Panigrahi, B. and Calcich, S.E. (1998), African American students attitudes toward entrepreneurship education. Journal of Education for Business. Franke, N. and Luthje, C. (2004). Entrepreneurial intentions of business students: a benchmarking study. International Journal of Innovation and Technology Management. Gelderen, M., Brand, M., Praag, M., Bodewes, W., Poutsma, E. and Gils, A. (2008). Explaining entrepreneurial intentions by means of the theory of planned behaviour. Career Development International. Harris, M.L. and Gibson, S.G. (2008). Examining the entrepreneurial attitudes of US business students. EducationþTraining. Hisrich, R.D. (2000). Can psychological approaches be used effectively: an overview. European Journal of Work and Organizational Psychology. Indarti, N. and Kristiansen, S. (2003). Determinants of entrepreneurial intention: the case ofnorwegian student, Gadjah Mada”. International Journal of Business. Krueger, N. (1993). The impact of prior entrepreneurial exposure on perceptions of new venture feasibility and desirability. Entrepreneurship Theory & Practice. McGhee, Jeffrey E., Mark Peterson, Stephen L. Mueller, and Jennifer M. Sequiera. (2009). Entrepreneurial self-efficacy: Refining the measure. Entrepreneurship: Theory & Practice 33. Noel, T.W. (2001). Effects of entrepreneurial educations on intention to open a business:frontiers of entrepreneurship research. Paper presented at the Babson ConferenceProceedings, Boston, MA. Ohland, Matthew, Sherry Frillman, and Thomas Miller (2004). NC State’s Engineering Entrepreneurs Program in the Context of US Entrepreneurship Programs. Paper presented at Education that Works: The NCIIA 8th Annual Meeting. Peterman, N.E. (2000). Entrepreneurship and enterprise education: influencing students’ attitudes towards entrepreneurship. Honours thesis, Department of Management, University of Queensland, Brisbane. Pruett, M., Shinnar, R., Toney, B., Llopis, F. and Fox, J. (2009). Explaining entrepreneurialintentions of university students: a cross-cultural study. International Journal of Entrepreneurial Behavior & Research. Shartrand, Angela, Phil Weilerstein, Mary Besterfield-Sacre, and 396 Barbara M. Olds. (2008). Assessing Student Learning in Technology Entrepreneurship. Paper presented at the 38th ASEE/IEEE Frontiers in Education Conference, Saratoga Springs, NY. Souitaris, V., Zerbinati, S. and Andreas, A. (2007). Do entrepreneurship programmes raiseentrepreneurial intention of science and engineering students? The effect of learning, inspiration and resources. Journal of Business Venturing. Standish-Kuon, Terri, and Mark P. Rice. (2002). Introducing engineering and science students to entrepreneurship: Models and influential factors at six American universities. Journal of Engineering Education. Veciana, J.M., Aponte, M. and Urbano, D. (2005), “University attitudes to entrepreneurship: a two countries comparison”. International Journal of Entrepreneurship and Management Wang, Eric L., and John A. Kleppe. (2001). Teaching invention, innovation and entrepreneurship in engineering. Journal of Engineering Education. Webb, T., Quince, T. and Wathers, D. (1982). Small Business Research: The Development ofEntrepreneurs. Gower, Aldershot. Yurtseven, Ho. (2002). How does the image of engineering affect student recruitment and retention? A perspective from the USA. Global Journal of Engineering Education. Zhao, H., Seibert, S.E. and Hills, G.E. (2005). The mediating role of selfefficacy in the development of entrepreneurial intentions. Journal of Applied Psychology. 397 PERSONALITY TRAITS AND LIFE SATISFACTION: A STUDY AMONG STUDENTS IN A PUBLIC UNIVERSITY Seyedeh Maryam Geramian & Mohd Tajudin Ninggal ABSTRACT The current study explored the relationships between personality traits and life satisfaction among university students in Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. (N = 53) students were asked to complete self-report measures of global life satisfaction (SWLS) and personality traits based on Five Factor Model (i.e., extraversion, neuroticism, openness to experience, conscientiousness, and agreeableness). Neuroticism appeared to be the strongest predictor. Moreover, three other traits of Big Five (agreeableness, conscientiousness, and extraversion) were also found to have significant correlation with life satisfaction where as openness showed small correlation. Findings support the importance of including all Big Five personality factors in exploratory models of life satisfaction. Keywords: Personality Traits, Life satisfaction, Five Factor Model of Big Five. 398 INTRODUCTION All students entering university for the first time will go through a transition phase that will vary from student to student. For some, the experience will be exciting. These students will tackle the challenges thrown up by new learning and social experiences. For others, the experience will be far less enjoyable and may even be traumatic, leading to an early end to their tertiary education. Others will leave university because they come to the realization that university is not for them at that point in time. Thus, for many students the transition experience can have a profound effect on their life satisfaction and particularly life satisfaction during their study period at university. (McKenzie and Schweitzer, 2001, McKenzie et al., 2004). Personality, comprising the psychological aspect of a person that is carried from one situation to another is one of the strongest and most consistent predictors of subjective well-being (Diener et al., 1999,FerreriCarbonell and Frijters, 2004, Lykken and Tellegen, 1996). Veenhoven (1996), divides the search for the determinants of happiness into two categories; external conditions and inner psychological processes. He stated by identifying external circumstances that lead people to satisfaction they could potentially try to create such conditions for everybody. In other words, having knowledge of the mental processes involved in obtaining high levels of life satisfaction would be helpful theoretically to assist others to acquire them (Veenhoven, 1996). A large body of research studies reveals the importance of life satisfaction to individual’s psychological, educational, social, and physical well-being(Suldo et al., 2009). Personality traits are viewed as a relatively stable factor over time and extraversion and neuroticism are found to have consistent correlations with life satisfaction (Heaven, 1989, Huebner et al., 2006, McKnight et al., 2002). However relatively little knowledge has been gained about the relationship between life satisfaction and three less studied personality traits; agreeableness, openness to experience, and conscientiousness. In this respect, a more thorough investigation of Big Five personality traits as predictors of life satisfaction is 399 needed.The current study intended to determine the overall contribution of personality traits to life satisfaction and the unique relationship of each five trait (extraversion, neuroticism, conscientiousness, openness to experience, agreeableness) to life satisfaction among students in UniversitiTeknologi Malaysia. LITERATURE REVIEW Life Satisfaction A key construct enfolded within the positive psychology movement is Subjective well-being (Seligman and Csikszentmihalyi, 2000). It refers to the frequency with which one experiences positive emotions relative to negative emotions, as well as how highly they appraise the quality of their lives. Life satisfaction is considered a more stable indicator of SWB as emotions can change often and quickly (Diener et al., 1999). Life satisfaction as one of the three components of subjective wellbeing (positive affect, negative affect, life satisfaction), is the ability of an individual to develop a subjective point of view about his or her life quality under his or her own criterion. It refers to cognitive judgments of a person’s life as a whole, in addition to one’s satisfaction with different domains of life such as family, self, and school (Huebner et al., 2006). As suggested by Frisch (1998) evaluations of life satisfaction are based on a number of factors including to what extent people’s needs, goals, and wishes have been achieved in important areas of life. Similarly, qualitative research with youth concluded that adolescents reflect on a variety of factors ranging from external conditions (family quality, schooling), to internal aspects of oneself as well as their extracurricular activity involvement when formulating their global appraisals of life satisfaction (Suldo and Shaunessy-Dedrick, 2013) 400 Five Factor Model (Big Five) Personality can be defined as a dynamic and organized set of characteristics possessed by a person that uniquely influences his or her cognitions, motivations, and behaviors in various situations (Ryckman, 2004). The Five Factor Model ( FFM) is one of the most widely accepted models for conceptualizing personality (Costa Jr and McCrae, 1992, Digman, 1990). The five basic dimensions of personality that have been identified include neuroticism, extraversion, openness, agreeableness, and conscientiousness. Neuroticism refers to emotional instability. Extraversion is a social and active dimension. Openness to experience refers to willingness to try new things and ideas. Conscientiousness is the dutiful and deliberate dimension. Agreeableness is the ‘nice’ dimension (Costa Jr and McCrae, 1992). Life Satisfaction and Personality Researchers and mental health professionals are working to towards identifying factors correlated with life satisfaction by determining the degree to which how much variance in life satisfaction can be attributed to relatively stable conditions (e.g., demographic characteristics, personality) as opposed to malleable situations (e.g., social relationships, extracurricular activities). It is essential to reach a full understanding of the correlates of life satisfaction; it would enable, in part, the identification of which factors are most likely to place students at risk for low life satisfaction. Research with students consistently points to extraversion and neuroticism as the personality traits most related to life satisfaction (Diener et al., 1999, Emmons and Diener, 1986, Pavot et al., 1997). In a recent investigation of 235 Iranian Muslim students (M age=20.56), Joshanloo and Afshari (2011) demonstrated that the Big Five personality factors predicted 25.4 % of the variance in life satisfaction. In their multiple regression 401 analysis, neuroticism (b= -.38) and extraversion (b=.20) emerged as the only unique predictors, but at the bivariate level, both agreeableness and conscientiousness demonstrated small, significant associations with life satisfaction (r =.23 and .24, respectively).Among a sample of 249 American university students (ages 18–30), Fagley (2012) found that neuroticism (b= -.26), extraversion (b=.24), and conscientiousness (b=.20) were significant predictors of life satisfaction, and that taken together all Big Five factors accounted for 31 % of the variance in life satisfaction. In a similar investigation, Lounsbury et al. (2005) studied 552 American undergraduates (mostly aged18 and 19) and found that the significant factors from the FFM (agreeableness plus the three unique predictors identified by Fagley) accounted for 45 % of the variance in students’ life satisfaction. METHOD This research is conducted at UniversitiTeknologi Malaysia, and it was designed to measure the overall contribution of personality traits to life satisfaction and the unique relationship of each five trait (extraversion, neuroticism, conscientiousness, openness to experience, agreeableness) to life satisfaction among university students. This research is categorized as a correlation study as the researcher described the relationships between scientific variables (Fraenkel and Wallen, 2006). Participants Participants were 53university students who were studying at Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Fifty-two percent of the samples were male and forty-eight percent were female with an average age of 30-32years. In this study, the researcher used systematic random sampling. In this study, the researcher used Pearson correlation to see the overall contribution of personality traits to life satisfaction 402 and the unique relationship of each five trait (extraversion, neuroticism, conscientiousness, openness to experience, agreeableness) to life satisfaction among students at UniversitiTeknologi Malaysia. Measures In this study, one set of a 44 item Big Five inventory developed by John and Srivastava (1999) along with, Satisfaction with Life Scale (SWLS) Diener et al. (1985) were distributed among 53 university students who were currently students at Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. SWL scale was used to assess global life satisfaction. This scale consists of five items. Each item is rated on a 7-point scale ranging from strongly disagree (1) to strongly agree (7).was distributed. Data Analysis This study investigated the overall contribution of personality traits to life satisfaction and the unique relationship of each five trait: extraversion, neuroticism, conscientiousness, and openness to experience and agreeableness to life satisfaction among university students at Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. SPSS software version 16.0 was used to analyze the results. To satisfy the objectives of the study. In this study, Pearson correlation is used in order to describe the relationships between five facets of the Big five and life satisfaction. The Pearson correlation coefficient ‘r’ is used to measure linear relationship between variables (AziziYahya et al., 2007). In order to identify the level of relationship, the researcher was used the concept of ‘Guilford’s Rule of Thumbs’ which can be seen in Table 1. 403 Table 1.Guilford Rules of Thumbs Guidelines Value of Correlation Coefficient (r) Level of Relation >0.90 0.90-0.70 0.70-0.40 40-0.20 <0.20 Very high High Medium Low Very low RESULT Inferential analysis was done to exhibit the overall contribution of personality traits to life satisfaction and the relationship of each of five traits including extraversion, neuroticism, conscientiousness, openness to experience, agreeableness to life satisfaction. Correlations between each of the five personality factors and life satisfaction were statistically significant (p<.001). Neuroticism demonstrated the strongest and only inverse relationship(r = -.27) with life satisfaction. Significant relationships were found between life satisfaction and three personality factors- agreeableness, conscientiousness, and extraversion. The positive relationship between life satisfaction and openness to experience was small (r = .29) (Table 2). DISCUSSION The present study investigated the relationship between life satisfaction and Five Factor Model (FFM).Findings of this study regarding the relation between personality traits and life satisfaction are also consistent with those of previous studies (DeNeve and Cooper, 1998). The finding that nearly half of the variance in life satisfaction was explained by differences in 404 personality elucidates the importance of including all five factors in studies of personality in relation to life satisfaction. Neuroticism depicted inverse relationship with life satisfaction, suggesting that adolescents who display higher levels of neuroticism are quite likely to experience lower levels of life satisfaction. The strong, negative relationship between neuroticism and life satisfaction is likely related to psychopathological symptoms (e.g., anxiety, anger/hostility, depression, self-consciousness, impulsivity and vulnerability) associated with neuroticism, as psychopathology is inversely associated with life satisfaction (Huebner et al., 2000). Table 2.Correlation Coefficient Category Overall Personality Extraversion Agreeableness Conscientiousness Neuroticism Openness to experience Value Pearson Correlation .667** Sig. (2-tailed) .000 Pearson Correlation .549** Sig. (2-tailed) .000 Pearson Correlation .801** Sig. (2-tailed) .000 Pearson Correlation .713** Sig. (2-tailed) .000 Pearson Correlation -.270 Sig. (2-tailed) .050 Pearson Correlation .294* Sig. (2-tailed) .033 **. Correlation is significant at the 0.01 level (2-tailed). *. Correlation is significant at the 0.05 level (2-tailed). The influence of extraversion on life satisfaction may occur via increased adolescent participation in social activities (Argyle and 405 Lu, 1990b), and/or because extraversion co-occurs with a number of positive traits (i.e., positive affect), attributes, and skills (i.e., social competence, assertiveness, empathy) which positively influence SWB (Argyle and Lu, 1990a). Earlier research examining conscientiousness in relation to life satisfaction found a similarly sized correlation (Joshanloo and Afshari, 2011).Hayes and Joseph (2003), identified a comparable empirical link between these constructs among students, and suggested the role of conscientiousness in relation to life satisfaction has been understated. Hayes and Joseph posited ‘‘individuals high on conscientiousness are more likely to be able to function effectively in society and to achieve their goals; in turn, goal efficacy leads to greater SWB’’ (p. 726).Openness to experience explained a small proportion of variance in life satisfaction. These results suggest that students who report more openness to experience also experience greater life satisfaction, which is consistent with previous literature (Barbaranelli et al., 2008, Mervielde et al., 1995). The moderate, bivariate correlation between agreeableness and life satisfaction suggested that higher levels of agreeableness co-occurred with higher life satisfaction. Results of bivariate correlation analysis showed that four of the Big Five traits (extraversion, neuroticism, agreeableness and conscientiousness) were significantly correlated with life satisfaction. Openness to new experiences showed a small correlation with life satisfaction. REFERENCES Argyle, M. andLu, L. 1990a. Happiness and social skills. Personality and Individual Differences, 11, 1255-1261. Argyle, M. andLu, L. 1990b. The happiness of extraverts. Personality and individual differences, 11, 1011-1017. Barbaranelli, C., et al. 2008. Assessing personality in early adolescence through self-report and other-ratings a multitrait-multimethod analysis of the BFQ-C. Personality and Individual differences, 44, 876-886. 406 Costa Jr, P. T. andMccrae, R. R. 1992. Four ways five factors are basic. Personality and Individual differences, 13, 653-665. Deneve, K. M. andCooper, H. 1998. The happy personality: a metaanalysis of 137 personality traits and subjective well-being. Psychological bulletin, 124, 197. Diener, E., et al. 1985. The satisfaction with life scale. Journal of personality assessment, 49, 71-75. Diener, E., et al. 1999. Subjective well-being: Three decades of progress. Psychological bulletin, 125, 276. Digman, J. M. 1990. Personality structure: Emergence of the five-factor model. Annual review of psychology, 41, 417-440. Emmons, R. A. andDiener, E. 1986. An interactional approach to the study of personality and emotion. Journal of Personality, 54, 371384. Fagley, N. 2012. Appreciation uniquely predicts life satisfaction above demographics, the Big 5 personality factors, and gratitude. Personality and Individual Differences, 53, 59-63. Ferrer‐I‐Carbonell, A. andFrijters, P. 2004. How Important is Methodology for the estimates of the determinants of Happiness?*. The Economic Journal, 114, 641-659. Fraenkel, J. andWallen, N. 2006. How to design and evaluate research in education Mc Grawall Hill. Frisch, M. B. 1998. Quality of life therapy and assessment in health care. Clinical Psychology: Science and Practice, 5, 19-40. Hayes, N. andJoseph, S. 2003. Big 5 correlates of three measures of subjective well-being. Personality and Individual Differences, 34, 723-727. Heaven, P. C. 1989. Extraversion, neuroticism and satisfaction with life among adolescents. Personality and Individual Differences, 10, 489-492. Huebner, E. S., et al. 2000. Cross-sectional and longitudinal psychosocial correlates of adolescent life satisfaction reports. Canadian Journal of School Psychology, 16, 53-64. Huebner, E. S., et al. 2006. Life Satisfaction. John, O. P. andSrivastava, S. 1999. The Big Five trait taxonomy: History, measurement, and theoretical perspectives. Handbook of personality: Theory and research, 2, 102-138. Joshanloo, M. andAfshari, S. 2011. Big five personality traits and selfesteem as predictors of life satisfaction in Iranian Muslim 407 University students. Journal of Happiness Studies, 12, 105-113. Lounsbury, J. W., et al. 2005. An investigation of broad and narrow personality traits in relation to general and domain-specific life satisfaction of college students. Research in Higher Education, 46, 707-729. Lykken, D. andTellegen, A. 1996. Happiness is a stochastic phenomenon. Psychological science, 7, 186-189. Mckenzie, K., et al. 2004. Exploring first‐year academic achievement through structural equation modelling. Higher Education Research & Development, 23, 95-112. Mckenzie, K. andSchweitzer, R. 2001. Who succeeds at university? Factors predicting academic performance in first year Australian university students. Higher education research and development, 20, 21-33. Mcknight, C. G., et al. 2002. Relationships among stressful life events, temperament, problem behavior, and global life satisfaction in adolescents. Psychology in the Schools, 39, 677-687. Mervielde, I., et al. 1995. The validity of the Big-Five as a model for teachers' ratings of individual differences among children aged 4– 12 years. Personality and Individual Differences, 18, 525-534. Pavot, W., et al. 1997. The relation between self-aspect congruence, personality and subjective well-being. Personality and Individual Differences, 22, 183-191. Ryckman, R. 2004. Theories of personality. . Thomson/Wadsworth, Belmont, CA. Seligman, M. E. andCsikszentmihalyi, M. 2000. Positive psychology: An introduction, American Psychological Association. Suldo, S., et al. 2009. Life satisfaction. Handbook of positive psychology in the schools, 27-35. Suldo, S. M. andShaunessy‐Dedrick, E. 2013. The psychosocial functioning of high school students in academically rigorous programs. Psychology in the Schools, 50, 823-843. Veenhoven, R. 1996. Developments in satisfaction-research. Social Indicators Research, 37, 1-46. 408 TASK INDUCED INVOLVEMENT: THE ISSUE OF REACTIVITY ON THE DEVELOPMENT OF VOCABULARY: A REVIEW PAPER Halah Abdulelah Mohammed, Norazman Abdul Majid & Tina Abdullah ABSTRACT It has been widely recognized that learning and developing meaning of new words is dependent on the nature of linguistic input, memory, cognitive abilities as well as phonological, morphological and syntactic links formed by the learner. The interrelationship between language use and the construction of meaning of words is fundamental to language learning and language development. Reading comprehension tasks insufficient to promote the development of new vocabulary, as using complex cognitive processes need to be used in the development of new words. This paper demonstrates the use of verbalization of thought through think-aloud while engaging in language based tasks such as in reading comprehension as a way to encourage awareness of language cognitive processes, promote increased attention on meaning (micro and macro) and enhance the level of awareness which lead to these activities when given proper guidance may result in deeper processing and induce reactivity effect on the 409 development of new vocabulary through reading. Through a deep review of literature on leaning and development of vocabulary based on the involvement load hypothesis. The paper proposes a particular focus on the issue related to the three components of the involvement load hypothesis (need, search, and evaluation) such as reading comprehension task that have related to the learning and development of vocabulary which have attracted the most attention in the issue of reactivity of think aloud on vocabulary development. Keywords: Vocabulary development, Involvement hypothesis, Reading task, Think-aloud, Reactivity load INTRODUCTION Research in first language (L1) and second language (L2) in psychology and cognitive process believed that most of vocabulary knowledge is acquired incidentally in the sense as a natural byproduct of learners performing linguistics activities and tasks or when learners’ attention are focused on an on-going task such as reading tasks other than word learning itself (Paribakht, and Wesche, 1999). Reading comprehension is expected to play a crucial role and the most common task to expand L1 and L2 learners’ vocabulary knowledge (Anderson et al., 1988; Nagy, 1988). SLA Research supposes the fundamental role of reading in vocabulary learning (Krashen, 1989; Hulstijn, 1992; Hulstijn et al., 1996; Ellis, 1997; Gass, 1999, Swanborn and De-Glopper, 2002). Reading is considered the significant source for the acquisition of vocabulary in L2/FL context (Ponniah, 2011; Naser and Amir, 2010). However, not all studies in the same boat with respect to whether more of L2 and FL lexical knowledge and word meaning could be learnt incidentally via reading (Mohammad and Mousa, 2014). Reading as input task is insufficient to pick up the meaning of the new vocabulary (Laufer and Hill, 2000). Complex cognitive 410 processes, which involve at least mental effort of considering the semantic aspects of a word, need to be used in learning and developing the meaning of new words. The involvement load hypothesis of Laufer and Hulstijn (2001) propose that indirect task which motivate the learners’ attention to explore, search, and estimate the meaning of new words may lead to better learning the meaning of new vocabulary. The question arises of whether all language tasks, specifically reading comprehension tasks which have higher degree of involvement load in deep processing of lexical information lead to better learning of vocabulary incidentally, even the task is input or output. Research in SLA need to be investigate whether performing of think aloud as additional input task while engaging in reading comprehension task induce higher degree of involvement load; arise learners’ awareness to be aware of their own learning when given proper guidance may result in deep processing and changes their cognitive process, induce reactivity may effect on vocabulary development. The paper proposes a particular focus on issues in the realm of L2 learning vocabulary via reading comprehension task; focusing on issues related to the three components of the involvement load hypothesis (need, search, and evaluation) such as reading comprehension task and level of awareness which have attracted the most attention in the issue of reactivity on vocabulary development. INCIDENTAL VOCABULARY LEARNING AND TASK OF VOCABULARY LEARNING The conviction that much second language vocabulary learning occurs incidentally while the learner is engaged in reading process has been held by numerous researchers involved in the study of the relationship between reading and vocabulary (Paribakht & Wesche, 1997). However, incidental vocabulary learning through reading could not always be considered as effective particularly for 411 ESL/EFL learners (Laufer, 2001). Frequently, L2 vocabulary obtained from reading are approximately limited and not necessarily efficient (Hulstijn, 1992). Such limited achievements of words learned just by reading could be related to different issues: the first ones can be attributed to lack of processing; incidental vocabulary learning failed to create a memory trace for each word through reading. The second and the major is attributed to the lack of noticing. According to Schmidt (1995), conscious attention is fundamental for learning to occur, and noticing is generally the first stage of learning. However, it is highly possible that learners usually fail to notice the unfamiliar words when they engaged in reading process; particularly, they can comprehend and construct the meaning of the message without knowing those words. One way to view vocabulary learning is to see it as a process of related sub-tasks. When learners encounter unfamiliar word, they may guess its meaning and usage from available clues. Evidence suggests more systematic approaches are needed in learning vocabulary rather than leaving learners to acquire vocabulary incidentally through reading (Nation, 2001; Schmitt, 2008). Various methods of elaborative processing may help learners to consolidate specific target words (Nation, 2001). Most learners might proceed to look up the meaning of the new words in the dictionary. Others might take down notes along the margins, between the lines, or on separate vocabulary notebooks. Some would even try to apply the word actively. Each of these task stages demands metacognitive judgment, choice, and arrangement of cognitive strategies for vocabulary learning. Therefore, each strategy that a learner uses will determine largely how and how well a new word is learned (Mohammad and Mosa, 2014). As Laufer and Hulstijn, 2001; Rott, 2005; Kim, 2008; Sayyed et al., 2011; Ayman, 2012, contend the usefulness of various method and different tasks to support incidental learning vocabulary and development via reading comprehension. 412 INVOLVEMENT LOAD HYPOTHESIS INDUCED INVOLVEMENT AND TASK Laufer and Hulstijn (2001) proposed the notion of the involvement as an operationalization for the construct of depth of processing in SLA. Involvement Load Hypothesis based on the notion that incidental task which induce higher involvement is conducive to the type of processing that is deemed crucial for vocabulary retention. The notion of involvement includes three task-specific components: a motivational component, ‘need’, and two cognitive components, ‘search’ and ‘evaluation’ Most scholars seem to agree that incidental vocabulary learning environment, with high input task is more effective than a low-input tasks regardless of receptive vocabulary knowledge, or the acquisition of productive vocabulary knowledge (Laufer and Hulstijn, 2001; Kim, 2008; Keating, 2008; Sayyed, et al., 2011; Zargham, et al., 2012. However, not all studies have validated the involvement load hypothesis. Contrary to Laufer and Hulstijn (2001), Martínez-Fernández (2008) and Yaqubi, et al., (2010) paint a different picture to the notion of the involvement load hypothesis. They found that in intentional learning conditions of reading task, fill-in-blanks and writing a composition tasks triggered better learning of vocabulary than multiple-choice question, even though fill-in-blanks task has lower degree of involvement load. A question arises of whether type of task either input or output has a crucial role for the best learning of vocabulary or the motivational and cognitive components may contribute to better learning of vocabulary. Involvement load hypothesis is standing on task which lead to higher degree of motivational and cognitive components (need, search, and evaluation) correspondingly induce better learning and retention of recalling word meaning of unfamiliar words, even the task either input or output. Yaqubi, et al., (2010) and Martínez-Fernández (2008) revealed that output-oriented tasks are more conducive to learning 413 and developing of vocabulary than input-oriented tasks and they are compatible parallel with the output hypothesis in SLA (Swain,2000), according to which language production facilitates learning through provision of extra input and development of awareness. In a comprehensive review of research on the involvement load hypothesis, the evaluation cognitive components of a learner’s involvement in processing words play a significant part to be more effective than other components. The component of evaluation has two degrees of prominence based on the involvement load hypothesis (Laufer and Hulstijn, 2001): moderate and strong. When evaluation requires the use of a new word within a given sentence it is moderate, but when the learners are required to produce an original sentence, evaluation is strong because learners should judge how to combine words and produce a sentence. The evaluation components make the learners to engage in deep processing of memory performance that may lead to induce higher awareness and lead to think, analyze, compare, infer, and act or produce the word and write connect discourse which demand deeper cognitive effort and contribute to the better learning of vocabulary and word meaning. A question of whether higher degree of involvement in cognitive components (search and evaluation) and motivational components (need) may lead the learners to pay attention to higher level of awareness in deep processing, promote them to develop the meaning of new vocabulary when engaging in reading task. In fact, when encountering unfamiliar words in L2 or FL text, the language learner can do one of the two things. Learner can either ignore the unknown words (i.e. avoidance strategy), or may attempt to infer its meaning, using linguistic and non-linguistic resources available in or outside the text. According to Laufer and Hulstijn’s (2001) involvement load hypothesis, incidental vocabulary learning is dependent upon the motivational variable of ‘need’; words that are significant for comprehending L2 text are more likely to be learnt and accessed for longer time periods. 414 The motivational component ‘need’ listed by Laufer and Hulstijn can predict whether the language learner decides to ignore the word or to guess its meaning, a proposition which has implicitly mentioned by Laufer and Hulstijn: if the learner is reading a text and unknown words is necessary for comprehension, s/he will experience the need to understand it. The learner has decided to embark on inferring the meaning of an unknown word. The need, search, and evaluation components in reading task guide the learner to use some strategies to know the meaning of unfamiliar word and comprehend the meaning of the text. Such strategies, either cognitive or metacognitive strategies, may be more effective in inducing high level of awareness to learn and develop new vocabulary. In fact, learners have to think while they are engaged in completing certain language tasks (reading comprehension task). Thus, using some strategies may stimulate learners’ thoughts and thinking process, help them to construct the meaning of the text. Such strategies might lead the students to involve in deep processing, induce higher level of awareness, attention, which increases the learners’ cognitive load, and eventually reflect on their final performance (Jourdenais, 2001). Using model of think aloud as a method to enhance awareness of language cognitive process, promote increased attention on meaning by thinking, analyzing, reflecting their prior thoughts; induced changes of learning process, called reactivity, of reading processing which lead to raise of new questions that lead to change the original purpose of the cognitive process (Snow, 2002). THINK ALOUD PROTOCOL AND THE ISSUE OF REACTIVITY SLA research report the useful methodological tool of think aloud to examine L2 students’ cognitive processes and to operationalize awareness in second language learning and second language 415 learners' cognitive processes while they interacted with second language task (Sachs and Suh, 2007; Leow and Morgan-Short, 2004; Leow, 2006; Rott, 2005; Leow et al., 2008; MartinezFernandez,2008). Although think-aloud protocols have proved to be a successful tool to operationlize awareness, their potential reactivity might affect learners’ performance in some cases. SLA research has found negative reactivity and reactivity on time on task but not on learners’ performance (Leow and Morgan-Short, 2004; Bowles and Leow, 2005; Yoshida, 2008; Bowles, 2008; Goo, 2010). However, so far a limited research in SLA has addressed the issue of reactivity effect on vocabulary development when learners engaged in reading comprehension task based on the Involvement Load Hypothesis in relation to the type of reading task and level of awareness. The issue of reactivity may play a significant role to improve the notion of the involvement load hypothesis (Laufer and Hulstijn, 2001) in cognitive components (search and evaluation). When performing of verbal report of think aloud while engaging in reading task might create extra learning opportunities, promote increased attention, and lead to deeper processing (Jourdenais, 2001). Verbal report of think aloud may enhance the development of vocabulary through giving learners the opportunity to reflect their insights and try to improve strategy via using metacognitive strategies through metalinguistic awareness or generate a new once in order to know the meaning of new words to understand reading text. Such types of strategies may play an essential role to change the primary cognitive process in order to learn the meaning of new vocabulary when learners encounter new vocabulary and this new vocabulary is needed to construct the meaning of the passage and eventually complete the reading comprehension task. 416 CONCLUSION This paper present a review of research on incidental vocabulary learning via reading comprehension task based on the involvement load hypothesis (Laufer and Hulstijn, 2001). It was indicated that stable conclusions cannot be made from studied that have been carried out so far since there have been many disagreements findings regarding the issues that surrounded the involvement load hypothesis. Therefore, many more need to investigate to improve the issues on the realm vocabulary development of involvement load hypothesis. The paper lies its ability to raise the significance of performing thinking aloud as an additional input task while the students engaged in reading comprehension tasks to arise learners’ attention to be aware of their own learning and address the issue of reactivity and its role effect on the development of vocabulary. REFERENCES Anderson, R. C., Wilson, P., & Fielding, L. 1988. Growth in reading and how children spend their time out of school. Reading Research Quarterly, (23): 285-303. Ayman Mohamed. 2012. Investigating Incidental Learning vocabulary in Conversation Classes : A Qualitative and Quantitative Analysis. MSU Working Papers in SLS. (3): 30–48. Bowles, M. A. 2008. Task type and reactivity of verbal reports in SLA. A first look at a L2 task other than reading. Studies in Second Language Acquisition, 30, 359-387. USA. Bowles, M., and Leow, R. P. 2005. Reactivity and Type of Verbal Report in SLA Research Methodology: Expanding the Scope of Investigation. Studies in Second Language Acquisition. (27): 415440. Ellis, R. 1997. Second Language Acquisition. (1st ed.). Oxford New York, Oxford University Press. Gass, S. 1999. Discussion: Incidental Vocabulary Learning. Studies in Second Language Acquisition. (21): 319–333. Goo, J. 2010. Working Memory and Reactivity. Language Learning: A Journal of Research in language Studies. 60(4): 712–752. 417 Hulstijn, J. H. 1992. Retention of inferred and given word meanings: Experiments in incidental vocabulary learning. In Arnaud, P. J. L. and Bejoint, H. (Eds) Vocabulary and Applied Linguistics:113–124. London: Macmillan. Hulstijn,J.H., Hollander,M., and Greidanus, T. 1996. Incidental Learning vocabulary by Advanced Foreign Language Students: The Influence of Marginal Glosses, Dictionary Use, and Reoccurrence of Unknown Words. The Modern Language Journal. 80 (3): 327– 339. Jourdenais, R. 2001. Cognition, instruction, and protocol analysis. In P. Robinson (Ed.), Cognition and second language instruction: 354– 375. Cambridge: Cambridge University Press. Kim, Y. 2008. The Role of Task-Induced Involvement and Learner Proficiency in L2 Vocabulary Acquisition. Language Learning. 58(2): 285–325. Keating, G. D. 2008. Task effectiveness and word learning in a second language: The involvement load hypothesis on trial. Language Teaching Research. 12 (3): 365–386 Krashen, S. 1989. We acquire Vocabulary and spelling by Reading : Additional Input Hypothesis. The Modern Language Journal. 73 (4):440–464. Laufer, B. 2001. Reading, Word-Focused Activities and Incidental Vocabulary Acquisition in a Second Language. Prospect, (16): 4454. Laufer, B. and Hill, M. 2000. What lexical information do L2 learners select in a CALL dictionary and how does it affect word retention? Language Learning and Technology. 3 (2): 58–76. Laufer, B. and Hulstijn, J.A.N. 2001. Incidental Vocabulary Acquisition in a Second Language : The Construct of Task-Induced Involvement. Applied Linguistics. 22(1): 1–26. Leow, R. P., Hsieh, H.-C., and Moreno, N. 2008. Attention to Form and Meaning Revisited. Language Learning, 58(3): 665–695. Leow, R.P. and Morgan-Short, K. 2004. To Think Aloud or Not To Think Aloud: The Issue of Reactivity in SLA Research Methodology. Studies in Second Language Acquisition. (26):35–57. Martínez-Fernández. 2008. Revisiting the Involvement Load Hypothesis: Awareness, Type of Task and Type of Item. In Bowles, M., Foote, R., Perpiñán, S., and Bhatt, R. (Ed.). Selected Proceedings of the 2007 Second Language Research Forum:210-228. USA: Cascadilla 418 Proceedings. Mohammad Zohrabi and Mousa Faramarzzadeh. 2014. The Impact of Task-Induced Involvement On EFL Learners’ Vocabulary Retention: The Case for Intentional Context.3 (1):187-199. Nagy, W. E. 1988. Teaching vocabulary to improve reading comprehension. Newark, Delaware: International Reading Association. Naser Rashidi and Amir Ganbari Adivi. 2010. Incidental Learning vocabularyThrough Comprehension- Focused Reading of Short Stories. Journal of English Language Teaching and Learning. 53(217): 112–129. Nation, I. S. P. 2001. Learning Vocabulary in Another Language: 1–477. United Kingdom (UK): Cambridge University Press. Paribakht, T. S., and Wesche, M. 1997. Vocabulary enhancement activities and reading for meaning in second language vocabulary development. In Coady, J. and Huckin, T. (Eds.). Second Language Vocabulary Acquisition: A rationale for Pedagogy:174–200). New York: Cambridge University Press. Paribakht, T.S. and Wesche, M. 1999. Reading and “Incidental” L2 Vocabulary Acquisition: An Introspective Study of Lexical Inferencing. Studies in Second Language Acquisition. (21): 195– 224. Ponniah, R. J. (2011). Incidental Acquisition of Vocabulary by Reading. The Reading Matrix. 11 (2), 135–139. Rott, S. 2005. Processing Glosses: A Qualitative Exploration of How Form-Meaning Connections are Established and Strengthened. Reading in a Foreign Language. 17(2). Sachs, R., and Suh, B.R. 2007. Textually Enhanced Recasts, Learner Awareness, and L2 Outcomes in Synchronous Computer-Mediated Interaction. In Mackey, A. (Ed.), Conversational Interaction in Second Language Acquisition: A Collection of Empirical Studies: 197–227. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Sayyed Mohammad Karimi Behbahani, Natasha Pourdana1, Mitra Maleki and Zabihollah Javanbakht. 2011. EFL Task-induced Involvement and Incidental Vocabulary Learning : Succeeded or Surrounded ? International Conference on Languages, Literature and Linguistics. (26): 323–325. Schmidt, R. (1995). Consciousness and foreign language learning: A tutorial on the role of attention and awareness in learning. In R. 419 Schmidt (Ed.), Attention and awareness in foreign language learning and teaching:1-63. Honolulu, Ha: University of Honolulu. Schmidt, R. 2001. Attention. In Robinson, P. (Ed.). Cognition and second instruction:3-32. Cambridge University Press. Snow, C. 2002. Reading for Understanding Toward a Research and Development Program in Reading Comprehension. USA: RAND Education for Reading Study Group. Swanborn, M. S. L. and De-Glopper, K. 2002. Impact of Reading Purpose on Incidental Word Learning From Context. Language Learning, 52(1): 95–117. Swain, M. 2000. The output hypothesis and Beyond: Mediating Acquisition through Collaborative Dialogue. In Lantolf, J. (Ed.). Sociocultural Theory and Second Language Learning: 97–114. Oxford: Oxford University Press. Yaqubi, B., Rayati, R. A., and Gorgi, N. A. 2010. The Involvement Load Hypothesis and Vocabulary Learning: The Effect of Task Types and Involvement Index on L2 Vocabulary Acquisition1. The Journal of Teaching Language Skills (JTLS). 2(1): 145–163. Yoshida, M. 2008. Think-Aloud Protocols and Type of Reading Task : The Issue of Reactivity in L2 Reading Research. In Bowles, M., Foote, R., Perpiñán, S., and Bhatt, R. (Ed.) Selected Proceedings of the 2007 Second Language Research Forum:199–209. USA: Cascadilla Proceedings Project, Somerville, MA. Zargham, Z., Davoudi, M., and Eskandari, Z. 2012. Vocabulary Learning Through Input and Output Tasks: Investigating the Involvement Load Hypothesis. California Linguistic Notes. 37(1): 1–18. 420 THE STUDY OF ARGUMENTATIVE KNOWLEDGE CONSTRUCTION IN WEB 2.0 LEARNING ENVIRONMENT TOWARDS STUDENTS’ CRITICAL THINKING SKILLS Siti Nur Khadijah Aishah & Jamalludin Harun ABSTRACT In this era of rapid development of Information and Communication Technology (ICT), online collaborative and social learning has been seen as one of the ways to encourage students’ critical thinking skills. Past studies have proven that students’ critical thinking skills were shown significantly when it is done socially and collaboratively amongst peers. Previous researches also stated that cooperative teams achieve at higher levels of thought and preserve information longer than learners who work quietly as individuals. In addition, working in a collaborative environment also involves processes of evidence and argumentation. Therefore, this research study addresses the area of social learning environment mainly in Web 2.0 learning environment to facilitate argumentative knowledge construction, a subject which is relevant for both Higher Education and lifelong learning in order to improve students' critical thinking skills. 421 Keywords: Argumentation, Knowledge construction, Web 2.0, Social learning environment, Critical thinking skills INTRODUCTION In recent years, the Malaysian education system has come under increased public enquiry and debate, as parents’ expectations rise and employers expressed their concern regarding the system’s ability to adequately prepare young Malaysians for the challenges of the 21st century. In order to properly address the needs of all Malaysians, and to prepare the nation to perform at an international level, it is important to first expect what a highly-successful education system must accomplish, particularly in the Malaysian context; (1) what kinds of students are best-prepared to meet the challenges of a 21st century economy? (2) what kind of education prepares them for this rapidly globalizing world? Currently, in a knowledge-based economy, it is important to create new knowledge in order to be able to connect to different pieces of knowledge and learn how to continue acquiring knowledge throughout their lives which encouraging an interest for inquiry and lifelong learning. Each student will learn a range of important cognitive skills, including problem-solving, reasoning, critical and creative thinking, and innovation. However, this is an area where the system has historically fallen short, with students being less able than they should be in applying knowledge and thinking critically outside familiar academic contexts (Malaysia Education Blueprint, 2012). Thus, in this era of rapid development of Information and Communication Technology (ICT), online collaborative and social learning has been seen as one of the ways to encourage students’ critical thinking skills. Past studies have proven that students’ critical thinking skills were shown significantly when it is done socially and collaboratively amongst peers (Gokhale, 1995; Dillenbourg, 1999; Veerman, Andriessen & Kanselaar, 2002; Chou 422 & Chen, 2008; Noroozi et. al, 2012). Previous researches also stated that cooperative teams achieve at higher levels of thought and preserve information longer than learners who work quietly as individuals. In addition, working in a collaborative environment also involves processes of evidence and argumentation (Rosen & Rimor, 2009). In order to deal with collaboration and argumentation, Web 2.0 technology has makes it an easy and popular way to communicate information to either a select group of people or to a much wider audience. The University can make use of these tools to communicate with students, staff and the wider academic community. It can also be an effective way to communicate and interact with students and research colleagues. Hence, this research study addresses the area of social learning environment to facilitate argumentative knowledge construction, a subject which is relevant for both Higher Education and lifelong learning in order to improve students’ critical thinking skills mainly in the Web 2.0 learning environment. COMPUTER SUPPORTED SOCIAL-COLLABORATIVE LEARNING ENVIRONMENT If paired with a wide-ranging methodology of use, ICT, and in particular social technology, has a good potential to support learning and knowledge building in higher education (Hamid, 2009; Hemmi et al., 2009; Hughes, 2009; Scardamalia & Bereiter, 2002). As concerns the topic of interest for this study, Steinberg (1992) points out that the key feature of ICT with respect to practicing argumentation and critical thinking is its potential support to the focused discussion of alternative points of views between participants. Students in social digital environments are not affected by some factors typical of face-to-face settings that may inhibit discussion (such as gender, age, ethnicity, performance skills). Besides, studying through ICT consists mainly of text-based contributions to the topics under consideration. Henri (1992) 423 indicated that a written text demands exactness, careful consideration, and explicit expression of thoughts. These qualities are important in argumentative dialogues and debates in which the goal is to assess the strengths and weaknesses of others’ contributions. Several studies such as (Littlefield, 1995; Marttunen, 1999) also suggest that learning environments in which students are engaged in active interaction and debates with each other are beneficial when the aim is to promote argumentation skills. CSCL and Social Collaborative Learning Environment Recently, a variety of new tools and technologies nurturing computer-supported collaborative learning (CSCL) and computersupported cooperative working (CSCW) appeared and established themselves on the Internet (Beldarrain 2006; Bryant 2006). This development is frequently referred to as Web 2.0 (Bridsall 2007; Murugesan 2007). On the one hand, the term Web 2.0 describes a set of new interactive technologies and services on the internet (Richardson 2006). As an alternative, it refers to a modified utilization of information (Tredinnick 2006). The social network services (SNS) provides opportunities for the individual learner to create sound and practical knowledge syntheses from broken and immature information. The generation of practical ideas, sharing of common classes of problems and the common pursuit of solutions enables individuals to aim toward a common goal of knowledge creation (Owen, Grant, Sayers & Facer, 2006). Currently, a second generation of web-based communities and hosted services such as social networking sites, wikis and folksonomies provided account for a significant serving of web traffic and content generation. The term Web 2.0 has been invented to embrace such collaborative applications and also to indicate a social approach to generating and distributing Web content, characterized by open communication, decentralization of authority, and freedom to share and re-use. Implicit and explicit in 424 many Web 2.0 applications are social networks, through which users share and filter content, collaborate, seek information, and interact socially on the Web. One of the key features of Web 2.0 application is collaboration, not only between machine and user, but also among users. These social applications have the capacity to function as ‘intellectual partners’ to promote critical thinking and facilitate cognitive processing (Voithofer et al., 2007). Text, voice, music, graphics, photos, animation and video are combined to promote users’ thinking and creativity when undertaking high-level tasks. They offer a wide range of resources that can be used for problem solving, critical thinking collaboration and so on (Dillenbourg, 1999), in both physical classrooms and virtual learning environments. In addition, Web 2.0 technologies, with their interactivity potential, foster active participation and studentcentered learning. Collaboration among students is a defining feature of constructivist classrooms (Jonassen et al., 1993), and Web 2.0 has wide-ranging potential for social interactivity and the promotion of collaboration and collective learning. Virtual communities of students can be organized on the Internet, allowing them to work in small groups to attain shared objectives and to strengthen their commitment to the values inherent to collaborative working. The more or less diverse grouping of students for the purpose of undertaking tasks may favor the creation of ‘zones of proximal development’ (Vygotsky, 1978) and provide students with opportunities to construct shared meaning for their practices (Dillon, 2004). Facebook for Collaborative Argumentation The impact of Web 2.0 and social networking tools on education has been much commented on. In order to support knowledge construction, learning environments should allow for selforganizing system of interactions among participants and their ideas (Scardamalia & Bereiter, 2006). Computer mediated 425 communication environments have provided multiple ways to interact and exchange information among groups of users in the form of messages or files: emails, forums, discussion boards, blogs, instant messaging, social spaces, learning management systems. Today, Facebook (www.facebook.com) is probably the most tangible example of environments known as social networks or Web 2.0. Besides, Facebook is one of the services are freely available online. There are a number of unique features that make it suitable in education. Facebook is equipped with discussion forums, instant messaging, email, and the ability to post videos and pictures. Most notably, Group feature on Facebook seems to be a powerful tool for collaborative learning. Students can use this Group feature on Facebook to perform various tasks and share resources at the same time. Students create a ‘Group’ to pertain to their interests. Basically, social networking sites are platforms that facilitate information sharing, interaction and collaboration among their users. However, Facebook’s success is not only dependent on its capacity to connect people, although this was its initial orientation. The platform’s power for sharing resources and linking content on the Internet to user profiles, as well as its evolution towards life streaming and micro blogging, enable it provide support for complex, continuous interaction experiences and, consequently, to structure collaborative-learning processes. The platform’s communication tools, combined with the option to enhance its potential by installing third-party modules and applications, allow members of a community or work team to carry out very diverse activities. Facebook is an example of a Web 2.0 social networking site, which has enormous potential in the field of education despite the fact that it was not designed as an environment for constructing and managing learning experiences. It operates as an open platform, unlike other systems organized around courses or formally structured content. In fact, while Facebook is not a learning environment, either in its underlying concept or the design of its tools, it can serve as a very valuable support for the new social 426 orientations now dominant in approaches to educational processes. According to Garrison et al. (2005), learning communities represent a fusion between the individual realm (subjective) and the shared realm (objective). In this context, Facebook represents a great opportunity to generate knowledge and inter-group cohesion. A number of high-level thinking skills and socially rich activities could result from the use and management of Facebook. A few educators are already exploiting the potential of Facebook to transform the learning experience into one in which student centered learning can be facilitated. Facebook may become a focal point of interest for developing communities of practice, within which they can store their treasure house of knowledge about their specific interests and learning. In the other hand, for example in the classroom learning, teachers will need to encourage all members to contribute thereby fostering a sense of community, but it is inevitable that some students will contribute more content than others. Moreover, social loafing is sometimes observed where the contribution rate for some students is unequal to others. However, providing all members are deemed to have contributed something within a defined period, teachers might adopt a laissez-faire attitude. Previous studies also shown that some students learn even when they do not directly contribute to a message board, which has been termed ‘lurking’ (Beaudoin, 2002). KNOWLEDGE CONSTRUCTION Knowledge construction starts with the learner articulating an intention to build knowledge. That may be stimulated by a question or problem, a failure to achieve something, a general curiosity, an argument or anything that perturbs a person’s understanding enough to want to make sense out of it (Jonassen, 1999). SNS, such as Facebook, are an increasingly important platform for CSCL. However, little is known about whether and how academic opinion change and argumentative knowledge construction can be facilitated in SNS. Existing argumentation 427 practice in informal SNS discussions typically lacks elaboration and argumentative quality (Tsovaltzi et. al, 2012). Argumentative knowledge construction (AKC) is the deliberate practice of elaborating learning material by constructing formally and semantically sound arguments with the goal of gaining argumentative and domain knowledge. Argument structure provided through individual argument diagramming is among the most prominent approaches to foster AKC in CSCL environments (Scheuer et al, 2010). However, there is little known about the extent these approaches can be applied to learning in SNS (McLoughin, & Lee, 2010; Tsovaltzi et al, 2012). Research results learning suggest that argumentative elaboration can promote individual knowledge construction, and can greatly benefit from additional support through scripting, i.e. socio-cognitive structures that specify what learners are to do in collaborative learning scenarios (e.g. Baker & Lund, 1997; Weinberger, Stegmann & Fischer, 2010). Learners, for instance, can be prompted to provide support or counterarguments for their claims. This can help them elaborate the task, gain argumentative knowledge, understand multiple perspectives, and promote knowledge convergence (Weinberger et al., 2010). An alternative way to script learners is to let them first work on a task individually and then compare and combine their individual solutions (e.g., Weinberger, 2011; Asterhan & Schwarz, 2007). Such approaches may prevent process losses of simultaneously following diverse instructions, also characterized as over-scripting (Dillenbourg, 2002), which can hinder AKC. Moreover, learners in online discussions often dismiss conflicting opinions and inconsistencies rather than try to resolve them. Raising awareness of opinion conflict is one way to foster critical argumentative elaboration during collaboration and take advantage of the dialogic potential of SNS (Bodemer, 2011). 428 Argumentation Argument can be defined as the reason(s) a person gives in support of a claim. Basically, argument is not just a matter of presenting information but rather is a matter of presenting a conclusion based on information or reasons. Argument consists of evidence presented in support of an assertion or claim that is either stated or implied (Seyler 1994). This paper defines arguments as a set of claims, one of which is supposed to be supported by the rest as used by Toulmin (1958). In educational studies, the social function of argumentation has been similarly emphasized, both with regard to its role in building disciplinary knowledge and its role in facilitating students’ learning and understanding of disciplinary knowledge (Mitchell & Andrews, 2000). In particular (Mitchell, 1994) asserts that argument is about ‘bringing difference into existence’ and that from a students’ point of view, this can be a difficult task. Not only do students have to acquire the discourse of the discipline and ‘to manage the actual voices and meanings of others in the forms of citations and references to existing writers in the field’ but in addition they have to go ‘beyond this, to construct an argument out of and in response to these voices’ (Mitchell, 1994). The result of this process can be the suppression of the student’s voice whereby the writing may contain arguments of others but not present itself a strong argumentative line. Argumentative Knowledge Construction (AKC) In AKC, learners acquire knowledge through the elaboration of learning material by constructing arguments (Weinberger et. al, 2007). AKC is based on the assumption that learners engage in specific discourse activities and that the frequency of these discourse activities is related to knowledge acquisition (Weinberger & Fisher, 2006). The importance of AKC in higher education pedagogy lies in 429 its very nature: the study of subjects and disciplines at higher education level implies students’ ability to research complex connections among knowledge. Indeed, exploring connections among knowledge, together with acquiring discipline-specific knowledge and inquiry methods can be defined as three distinctive characteristics of higher education pedagogy. These characteristics can also be seen as three forms of argumentative knowledge construction. Therefore, fostering advancements in higher education pedagogy necessarily implies offering students more opportunities to master the argumentative discourse structure. Argumentation is therefore of interest of the educational research for being a conceptual tool that suitable to promote learning, knowledge building and cognitive growth. Although argumentation skills appear to be so much necessary, university students seldom know how to argue effectively, as documented by several research studies: not only have they difficulties producing relevant evidence to support their positions (Kuhn, 1991), but also they are often guided by beliefs and bias when evaluating arguments. Moreover, Stein and Albro (2001) demonstrate that the affective dimension has a strong influence on students’ effective engagement in argumentation: college students tend to avoid getting involved in argumentative discussions for the fear that this might disrupt interpersonal relations with their peers. A further difficulty is introduced by the fact that only generic skills can be used across fields, as argumentation skills are mostly subjectdependent. Hence, it is important for university students to practice argumentation on all subjects of their interest, on which they have command of discipline-specific knowledge and discourse (Mitchell & Andrews, 2000), as well as to be introduced to effective argumentation by means of suitable methods and tools. DISCUSSION & CONCLUSION The significance of this study lies broadly in its addressing the important of how Web 2.0 can be used in meaningful ways in the 430 classroom learning and constructing student’s knowledge through their critical thinking skills and how it can be used to sustain tied and valued practices in teaching and learning such as argumentation. Due to the availability of such a large literature base in the area of critical thinking and argumentation (Walton, 2005; Walton et. al, 2008) and its importance in knowledge construction, it could be cautiously contended that there is a need to look at the possible benefits of shifting the underlying pedagogical theories to other domains. However, with the importance of using asynchronous discussions, such as discussion forum, as precedence for research in the area of knowledge construction there is an urgent need to study the use of argument in other domains using online discussion. REFERENCES Asterhan, C.S.C. & Schwarz, B.B. 2007. The effects of monological and dialogical argumentation on concept learning in evolutionary theory. Journal of Educational Psychology 99(3), 626–639. Baker, M. & Lund, K., 1997. Promoting reflective interactions in a CSCL environment. Journal of Computer Assisted Learning, 13(3), p.175-192. Available at: http://doi.wiley.com/10.1046/j.13652729.1997.00019.x\nhttp://www.scopus.com/inward/record.url?e id=2-s2.00031516256&partnerID=40&md5=46f7356d809a31b6e0fc2308 b00b3086. Beldarrain, Y. 2006. Distance education trends: Integrating new technologies to foster student interaction and collaboration. Distance Education, 27, 139–153. Bodemer, D., 2011. Tacit guidance for collaborative multimedia learning. Computers in Human Behavior, 27(3), p.1079-1086. Bridsall, W. F. 2007. Web 2.0 as a social movement. Webology, 4(2). Bryant, T. 2006. Social software in academia. Educause Quarterly, 29, 61–64. 431 Chou, P.-nan & Chen, H.-huan, 2008. Engagement in Online Collaborative Learning: A Case Study Using a Web 2.0 Tool. Journal of Online Learning and Teaching, 4, p.574-582. Dillenbourg, P., 1999. Collaborative Learning: Cognitive and Computational Approaches. Advances in Learning and Instruction Series. P. Dillenbourg, ed., Elsevier Science, Inc.,. Available at: http://eric.ed.gov/ERICWebPortal/recordDetail?accno=ED43792 8. Dillenbourg, P. 2002. Over-scripting CSCL: The risks of blending collaborative learning with instructional design. In P.A. Kirschner (Ed.), Three worlds of CSCL: Can we support CSCL? (pp. 61–91). Heerlen: Open Universiteit Nederland. Dillon , P. 2004. Trajectories and tensions in the theory of information and communication technology in education. British Journal of Educational Studies. Vol. 52, No 2, pages 138-150. Garrison, D.R. & Cleveland-Innes, M. 2005. Facilitating cognitive presence in online learning: interaction is not enough. The American Journal of Distance Education. 19(3). 133-148. Gokhale, Anuradha a. 1995. Collaborative Learning Enhances Critical Thinking. Journal of Technology Education 7: 22-30. http://citeseerx.ist.psu.edu/viewdoc/download?doi=10.1.1.77.133 8&rep=rep1&type=pdf#page=23. Hamby, B.W. (2007). The philosophy of anything: Critical thinking in context, Dubuque, IA: Kendell Hunt, Publishing, Co. Hamid, S., Chang, S. & Kurnia, S. 2009. Identifying the use of online social networking in higher education. Proceedings ASCILITE In Same places, different spaces, Auckland 2009. Hemmi, A., Bayne, S., Land, R. 2009. The appropriation and repurposing of social technologies in higher education. Journal of Computer Assisted Learning, 25 (1), 19-30. Henri, F. (1992). Computer conferencing and content analysis. In A. Kaye, ed, Collaborative Learning Through Computer Conferencing (pp. 117–136). Berlin: Springer-Verlag. Hughes, A. 2009. Higher Education in a Web 2.0 World. JISC report. Available at: http://www.jisc.ac.uk/publications/documents/heweb2.aspx Jonassen, D. H.; Mayes , J. T.; McAleese, R. 1993. “A manifesto for a constructivist approach to technology in higher education”. In: T. 432 DUFFY, D. JONASSEN, J. LOWYCK (eds.). Designing constructivist learning environments. Heidelberg, FRG: SpringerVerlag. Jonassen, D. H., Peck, K. L. & Wilson, B. G. 1999. Learning with technology: a constructivist perspective. Upper Saddle River, NJ: Merrill. Kuhn, D. 1991. The skills of argument. Cambridge, England: Cambridge University Press. Littlefield, R.S. 1995. Teaching argumentation and debate skills to young children: Bridging theory and practice. In F.H. van Eemeren, R. Grootendorst, J.A. Blair & References 169 C.A. Willard, eds, Proceedings of the Third ISSA Conference on Argumentation. Reconstruction and Application. Vol. III (pp. 287–296). Amsterdam: International Centre for the Study of Argumentation. Malaysia Education Blueprint 2013-2025. Available at : http://www.moe.gov.my/en/pelan-pembangunan-pendidikanmalaysia-2013-2025. Retrieved on September 2014. Marttunen, M. & Laurinen, L. 1999. Learning of argumentation in faceto-face and email environments. In F.H. Van Eemeren, R. Grootendorst, J.A. Blair & C.A.Willard, eds, Proceedings of the Fourth International Conference of the International Society for the Study of Argumentation (pp. 552–558). Amsterdam: Sic Sat, International Centre for the Study of argumentation. Mitchell, S. 1994. The Teaching and Learning of Argument in Sixth Forms and Higher Education: Final Report, Centre for Studies in Rhetoric, University of Hull. Mitchell, S., Andrews, R., 2000. Learning to Argue in Higher Education. Heinemann Publication. Murugesan, San. 2007. Understanding Web 2.0. IT Professional 9, no. 4: 34-41. Noroozi, O. et al., 2012. Argumentation-Based Computer Supported Collaborative Learning (ABCSCL): A synthesis of 15 years of research. Educational Research Review, 7(2), p.79-106. Owen, M., Grant, L., Sayers, S. & Facer, K. (2006). Social software and learning. Futurelab, HAL, 1, 1-36. Richardson, W. 2006. Blogs, wikis, procasts, and other powerful web tools for classrooms. Thousand Oaks: Corwin. Rosen, Y. & Rimor, R., 2009. Using a Collaborative Database to Enhance Students’ Knowledge Construction. Interdisciplinary 433 Journal of E-Learning and Learning Objects, 5(1), p.187-195. Available at: http://www.editlib.org/p/44830. Scardamalia, M., & Bereiter, C. 2006. Knowledge building: Theory, pedagogy, and technology. In K. Sawyer (Ed.), Cambridge Handbook of the Learning Sciences (pp. 97-118). New York: Cambridge University Press. Seyler, Dorothy U., 1994. Understanding argument: a text with readings. New York - McGraw-Hill. Stein, N. L., & Albro, E. 2001. The origins and nature of arguments: Studies in conflict understanding, emotion, and negotiation. Discourse Processes, 32, 113–133. Steinberg, E.R. 1992. The potential of computer-based telecommunications for instruction. Journal of Computer-Based Instruction 19: 42–46. Tredinnick, L. 2006. Web 2.0 and Business A pointer to the intranets of the future?. Business information review, 23(4), 228234. Toulmin, S. 1958. The Uses of Argument. Ethics. Vol. 70. Cambridge University Press. http://www.amazon.ca/exec/obidos/redirect?tag=citeulike0920&path=ASIN/0521534836. Tsovaltzi, D., Weinberger, A., Scheuer, O., Dragon, T., & McLaren, B. 2012. Argument Diagrams in Facebook: Facilitating the Formation of Scientifically Sound Opinions. In A. Ravenscroft, S. Lindstaedt, C. Delgado Kloos, & D. HernandézLeo (Eds.), 21st Century Learning for 21st Century Skills, Proceedings of EC-TEL 2012, LNCS 7563 (p. 540). Berlin: Springer. Veerman, A., Andriessen, J. & Kanselaar, G., 2002. Collaborative argumentation in academic education. Instructional Science, 30(3), p.155-186. Voithofer, R. J.; Foley, A. 2007. “Digital dissonances: Structuring absences in national discourses on equity and educational technologies”. Equity and Excellence in Education. Vol. 40, No 1, pages 14-25. Vygotsky, L. S. 1978. Mind in Society. Cambridge: Harvard University Press. Walton, D.N., 2005. Fundamentals of critical argumentation, 434 Cambridge University Press. Available at: \url{http://www.loc.gov/catdir/toc/ecip056/2005000190.htmlhttp ://www.loc.gov/catdir/enhancements/fy0632/2005000190d.html}. Walton, D., Reed, C. & Macagno, F., 2008. Argumentation Schemes, Cambridge University Press. Available at: http://www.amazon.com/dp/0521723744. Weinberger, A., & Fischer, F. 2006. A framework to analyze argumentative knowledge construction in computer-supported collaborative learning. Computers & Education, 46, 71-95. SSCI: 0,968. Weinberger, A., Stegmann, K., & Fischer, F. 2010. Learning to argue online: Scripted groups surpass individuals (unscripted groups do not). Computers in Human Behavior, 26(4), 506–515. Weinberger, A. 2011. Principles of transactive computersupported collaboration scripts. Nordic Journal of Digital Literacy, 6(3), 189–202. 435 436 PENDIDIKAN TEKNIKAL DAN LATIHAN VOKASIONAL KE ARAH PEMUPUKAN KEMAHIRAN GENERIK HIJAU Nadia Hartini Mohd Adzmi , Mohd Zolkifli Abd Hamid & Yusri Kamin ABSTRAK Kemajuan ekonomi negara haruslah diimbangi dengan pemeliharaan dan pemuliharaan alam sekitar. Justeru itu dalam menyokong pertumbuhan ekonomi hijau, negara memerlukan sumber manusia yang dilengkapi dengan kemahiran bukan teknikal atau kemahiran generik. Ini kerana negara amat bergantung kepada keupayaan generasi muda yang berkebolehan bagi memenuhi kehendak industri yang memerlukan tenaga kerja mahir, berpendidikan dan berkualiti (Siti Nur Rohazrien, 2013). Dalam konteks kelestarian alam sekitar, kemahiran ini disebut sebagai kemahiran generik hijau yang merupakan value added kepada kemahiran generik sedia ada. Pendidikan teknikal dan latihan vokasional (PTLV) merupakan platform yang mampu mendorong sumber manusia ke arah kelestarian. Semakin banyak seseorang pekerja itu mendapat pendedahan berkenaan konsep kelestarian, maka semakin banyak kesedaran yang mereka peroleh untuk melakukan perubahan sikap dan tingkah laku di tempat kerja yang dapat menyokong kepada pertumbuhan ekonomi hijau. Kertas kerja ini membincangkan secara terperinci mengenai peranan 437 pendidikan teknikal dan latihan vokasional dalam menjayakan pembangunan lestari dan kepentingan komponen kemahiran generik hijau dalam sukatan kurikulum PTLV. Kata Kunci: Kemahiran Generik Hijau, Kelestarian Alam Sekitar, Pendidikan Teknikal Dan Latihan Vokasional PENGENALAN Kemajuan teknologi dan peningkatan taraf hidup yang semakin tinggi telah mendorong permintaan penggunaan tenaga dan sumber asli dari semasa ke semasa. Sedarkah kita bahawa pembangunan yang tidak terkawal telah mengakibatkan berlakunya pemanasan global dan penyusutan sumber asli dan ini telah mencetuskan kebimbangan di seluruh dunia. Di Malaysia, data yang dikeluarkan oleh Pertubuhan Bangsa-Bangsa Bersatu (PBB) berhubung emisi karbon dianggarkan telah mencecah sehingga 187 juta tan di mana puratanya merangkumi sebanyak 7.2 tan bagi setiap individu pada tahun 2006 (Md Azizul et. al 2012). Lebih membimbangkan apabila berlakunya penyusutan sumber asli di mana dunia dianggarkan bakal menghadapi kekurangan sumber asli dalam tempoh enam puluh tahun lagi (Syahrul Hisham, 2012). Serentak dengan itu, penekanan untuk memelihara dan memulihara alam sekitar perlu diberi perhatian yang serius di peringkat local. Bagi merealisasikan agenda pembangunan nasional, sumber manusia yang berkemahiran tinggi menjadi teras utama perlaksanaannya. Sehubungan itu dalam menyokong pertumbuhan ekonomi hijau dan seterusnya mengekalkan kualiti alam sekitar, sumber tenaga kerja negara sewajarnya dilengkapi dengan kemahiran bukan teknikal atau kemahiran generik. Dalam konteks kelestarian alam sekitar, kemahiran ini disebut sebagai kemahiran generik hijau. Sepertimana yang dirumuskan oleh Watch (2010), pendidikan merupakan wasilah yang dapat menimbulkan kesedaran dan amalan terhadap kepentingan untuk memelihara dan memulihara 438 alam sekitar. Selain itu, menerusi pendidikan juga akan muncullah golongan pekerja yang menjadi tonggak pertumbuhan ekonomi di samping menitikberatkan sikap dan impak pembangunan terhadap komuniti setempat. Ini bertepatan dengan pandangan yang dilontarkan oleh Subahan et al. (2005) berkenaan konsep pembangunan lestari yang menggabungjalinkan komponen alam sekitar, masyarakat dan ekonomi yang dilihat saling bergantung antara satu sama lain. KEMAHIRAN GENERIK HIJAU Kebelakangan ini, konsep hijau mula mendapat perhatian yang meluas dan dipandang serius. Jika diteliti dengan lebih mendalam, konsep ini telah diperkatakan melewati sekitar tahun enam puluhan dan tujuh puluhan lagi (Laupa Junus, 2009a). Perkembangan ini telah membawa kepada pembangunan ekonomi hijau yang turut mendorong tercetusnya kemahiran generik hijau. Mohd Zolkifli (2014) menyatakan kemahiran ini adalah kemahiran bukan teknikal yang diperlukan oleh setiap pekerja sebagai pelengkap kepada pertumbuhan ekonomi rendah karbon. Faktor ini bertujuan untuk mengekalkan kestabilan ekosistem melalui penggunaan teknologi dan segala aktiviti pembuatan mesra alam yang berupaya meminimakan penggunaan tenaga dan sumber semula jadi. Ini bertepatan dengan laporan yang dikeluarkan oleh Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD, 2010) bahawa kemahiran generik hijau begitu penting dan diperlukan dalam sektor pekerjaan agar produk, perkhidmatan dan aktiviti pengeluaran mengambilkira kesannya terhadap alam sekitar. Seterusnya, Pavlova (2011) telah menyenaraikan enam aspek bagi kemahiran generik hijau di tempat kerja: I. Kesedaran dan tingkah laku terhadap alam sekitar serta kesanggupan untuk melakukan penjelajahan fikiran berkenaan isu/cabaran pembangunan lestari. II. Kemahiran mengurus dan mentadbir secara holistik dan 439 merentas disiplin untuk mencari penyelesaian bagi memenuhi objektif ekonomi, sosial dan ekologi. III. Kemahiran keusahawanan bagi memanfaatkan peluang daripada pembangunan teknologi rendah karbon. IV. Kemahiran inovasi dalam merebut peluang dan seterusnya merangka strategi baru dalam mendepani cabaran ekonomi hijau. V. Kemahiran-kemahiran STEM: Pemahaman umum sumbangan sains, teknologi, kejuruteraan dan matematik dalam merealisasikan masyarakat dan ekonomi hijau. VI. Kemahiran berfikir secara analitik: Memahami pemikiran di sebalik close-loop ekonomi dan bagaimana ianya berbeza daripada model-model linear pertumbuhan ekonomi sedia ada ekoran perniagaan dan industri kian beralih kepada model kelestarian asli. Sementara itu, Rebecca (2010) menyebut kemahiran ini sebagai green skills, green job dan green career. Beliau mengklasifikasikan kemahiran ini sebagai kemahiran employability sedia ada yang diintegrasikan dengan kemahiran-kemahiran hijau yang spesifik dengan menerapkan pengunaan teknologi hijau. Dalam konteks ini, kemahiran ini bukanlah kemahiran baru tetapi menjurus kepada penambahbaikan kemahiran generik sedia ada bagi mewujudkan persekitaran yang sihat bagi semua hidupan. PENDIDIKAN TEKNIKAL DAN LATIHAN VOKASIONAL UNTUK PEMBANGUNAN LESTARI Hussin Sarju (2010) merumuskan pendidikan merupakan proses untuk membangunkan potensi akal, tingkah laku dan spiritual manusia ke arah kelestarian hidup. Bertepatan dengan konsep pembangunan lestari, pendidikan teknikal dan latihan vokasional (PTLV) memiliki hubungan yang sangat erat dengan agenda pembangunan nasional. PTLV menjadi peneraju dalam membekalkan sumber tenaga kerja mahir dan separuh mahir yang diperlukan negara dalam pelbagai sektor pekerjaan. Justeru itu, 440 PTLV berperanan besar melahirkan golongan pekerja yang memiliki kesedaran terhadap kepentingan melestarikan alam sekitar. Namun begitu, persoalan yang kerap kali berlegar adalah bagaimanakah kesedaran ini dapat diterapkan ke dalam diri pekerja dan sejauhmanakah mereka benar-benar memahami lantas mempraktikkan kemahiran generik hijau di tempat kerja. Lantaran itu, pendidikan dan latihan merupakan platform yang mampu mendorong masyarakat ke arah kelestarian. Ini kerana melaluinya pelbagai masalah dapat ditangani malah pendidikan juga mampu menyuburkan pelbagai peluang (Watch, 2010). Chen et al. (2011) menyatakan pendidikan dan latihan merupakan instrumen yang penting untuk membangunkan sumber manusia yang berupaya menjayakan pembangunan yang bersifat mesra alam dan lestari. Pernyataan ini turut disokong oleh Ki-Moon (2012): Without education, there can be no sustainable development. Education empowers people with the knowledge, skills and confidence they need to shape a more stable and peaceful future. It is thus the key to building greener societies (ms2). Berikutan itu, pembangunan lestari tidak dapat dicapai menerusi kemajuan teknologi dan sokongan kewangan sematamata. Bahkan ianya menuntut perubahan cara berfikir dan bertindak bagi seseorang individu. Berdasarkan laporan yang dikeluarkan oleh UNESCO (2012), perubahan ini merangkumi: I. II. Pendidikan untuk pembangunan lestari diintegrasikan secara sistematik ke atas semua peringkat/settings pendidikan dan latihan bermula daripada asas persekolahan sehingga ke pengajian tinggi dan seterusnya diperluaskan lagi di persekitaran tempat kerja. Memajukan dan menghijaukan PTLV sebagai wasilah dalam menyediakan pekerja yang memiliki pengetahuan, kemahiran dan komitmen kepada kelestarian. Ini sebagai usaha memastikan ekonomi semasa yang bergantung kepada sumber 441 tenaga yang tidak boleh diperbaharui beralih kepada penggunaan teknologi dan segala aktiviti pengeluaran yang bersifat mesra alam. Justeru itu, menghijaukan PTLV menjadi pra-syarat menjayakan pembangunan berteraskan kelestarian alam sekitar. Menghijaukan PTLV merangkumi beberapa aspek seperti memperuntukkan pendidikan dan latihan berkonsepkan prapekerjaan, memberikan pendedahan berkenaan pembelajaran di tempat kerja dan menjana latihan secara berterusan dengan mempertimbangkan faktor alam sekitar, ekonomi dan sosial. Menghijaukan PTLV juga merujuk kepada usaha mempersiapkan pekerja ‘kolar hijau’ yang menyumbang ke arah persekitaran yang sihat demi keadilan dan kesejahteraan sejagat. Pasek (2010) menyatakan dalam ruang lingkup latihan dan latihan semula, program latihan hijau dalam komponen kemahiran bukan teknikal sewajarnya merangkumi pengajaran berkaitan perancangan kerjaya hijau, tingkah laku hijau di tempat kerja dan kemahiran-kemahiran hijau yang meliputi satu pertiga keseluruhan program latihan. Sejajar dengan itu, UN’s International Center for Technical and Vocational Education and Training (UNEVOC, 2006) telah menekankan kepentingan PTLV digabungkan dengan pendidikan dan kemahiran yang berteraskan kelestarian alam sekitar. Ini kerana fenomena dunia pekerjaan pada hari ini seringkali mengalami perubahan impak daripada globalisasi dan perkembangan teknologi. Hal ini menuntut PTLV membangunkan sumber tenaga manusia yang bukan sahaja berkemahiran tetapi juga komited dan bermotivasi tinggi. Di samping itu, mereka juga sewajarnya memahami kesan perubahan global ke atas industri dan sektor perniagaan tempatan serta bagaimana kesan perubahan ini mempengaruhi kualiti sosial, ekonomi dan alam sekitar (UNESCO-UNEVOC 2009). 442 KEPENTINGAN KOMPONEN KEMAHIRAN GENERIK HIJAU DALAM SUKATAN KURIKULUM PTLV Suatu hakikat yang tidak boleh dikesampingkan ialah pemahaman umum berkenaan konsep kemahiran generik pada realitinya lebih tertumpu kepada kemahiran personal dan interpersonal. Hubungan dan interaksi dengan alam sekitar kurang diberi penekanan dan perhatian yang serius (Mohd Zolkifli, 2014). Hal ini berbeza dengan kemahiran generik hijau yang tidak hanya terbatas kepada hubungan antara individu tetapi turut mengambil kira bagaimana komuniti berinteraksi dengan alam tabii di persekitarannya (Mohd Yusof, 2010). Ini kerana sekiranya konsep pembangunan berteraskan kelestarian alam sekitar tidak dipraktiskan, negara bakal menghadapi risiko melahirkan golongan pekerja yang mungkin berkemahiran tetapi mengabaikan kesan tindakan terhadap alam sekitar serta keperluan penjimatan tenaga dan sumber asli. Oleh hal yang demikian, keperluan bagi kemahiran generik hijau diintegrasikan dalam kurikulum khususnya bagi aliran kemahiran-kemahiran teknikal dan vokasional dilihat kian mendesak (Siti Nor Syazwani, 2012). Faktor ini ekoran pada masa hadapan setiap lapangan pekerjaan dijangka menuju ke arah pekerjaan-pekerjaan yang berorientasikan teknologi hijau yang menjadi pemacu pertumbuhan ekonomi baru (CEDEFOP, 2010). Dalam pada itu, kurikulum PTLV yang sedia ada memperlihatkan topik-topik hijau tidak diintegrasikan secara menyeluruh bahkan sumber rujukan mahupun kajian berkenaan kemahiran generik hijau di Malaysia masih lagi kurang (Mohd Zolkifli, 2014). Malah, analisis sukatan dan kurikulum berkaitan Teknologi Hijau yang dijalankan oleh Kementerian Tenaga, Teknologi Hijau dan Air (KeTTHA) pada tahun 2011 di peringkat pra-sekolah, sekolah rendah dan sekolah menengah mendapati topik-topik ini bersifat tidak menyeluruh dan perlu dikemaskini. Seterusnya, kajian yang dilakukan oleh Yahya Buntat et al. (2013) mendapati majoriti guru tidak mempunyai kefahaman yang lengkap dan menyeluruh mengenai apa itu kemahiran generik hijau 443 sungguhpun menyedari kemahiran ini sangat diperlukan dalam industri berteknologi hijau. Faktor ini merangkumi beberapa aspek seperti tidak mengetahui tanda aras/guideline untuk mengimplementasikan kemahiran generik hijau, tiada deskripsi yang spesifik berkenaan kandungan/syllabus malah syllabus juga bersifat tidak menyeluruh dan tidak memberi penekanan yang menjurus kepada pengaplikasian kemahiran generik hijau (Yahya Buntat et al., 2013). Lebih merumitkan lagi keadaan apabila kaedah penerapan dan bentuk penilaiannya juga masih lagi kabur dan tidak diketahui (Yahya Buntat et al., 2013). Lantaran itu, topik-topik hijau perlu dikemaskini dalam sistem pendidikan selaras dengan tahap pemahaman dan peringkat pemikiran pelajar (Siti Nor Syazwani, 2012). Ini disokong oleh Pavlova (2012) di mana beliau berpandangan bahawa pendidikan dan latihan hendaklah seiiring dengan perubahan dan perkembangan ekonomi. Menyedari hakikat ini, adalah penting untuk mengenalpasti set-set kemahiran bukan teknikal yang diperlukan ke arah merealisasikan agenda pembangunan lestari (Pavlova, 2012). Hal ini adalah sejajar dengan penyataan yang dikeluarkan oleh Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD, 2009) iaitu: Education and training programmes are critical for developing the human capital needed for eco-innovation and a potential labour force for “green jobs”. A number of countries have taken measures to mainstream environmental education in the school curricula or vocational training, but further focus is needed. KESIMPULAN Sebagai kesimpulan, adalah amat penting pengetahuan berkenaan amalan hijau diperoleh dan diterapkan ke dalam diri seseorang pekerja sebelum mereka menceburi profesyen pekerjaan dan 444 seterusnya memastikan latihan yang berterusan sentiasa ditambah dari semasa ke semasa di tempat kerja. Ini kerana pendidikan dan latihan merupakan key aspect atau kunci yang mengarah kepada kelestarian (McKeown, 2002). Berdasarkan kajian literatur yang dilakukan, didapati penyelidikan mahupun sumber rujukan mengenai kemahiran generik hijau di Malaysia masih lagi berada pada tahap awal. Terdapat begitu banyak persoalan-persoalan yang belum terjawab dan menjadi tanda tanya berkenaan kemahiran-kemahiran generik yang seharusnya ada pada diri setiap pekerja ‘kolar hijau’ (Mohd Zolkifli, 2014). Fenomena ini membuka ruang kepada penyelidikpenyelidik tempatan untuk mengkaji perkembangan kemahiran generik hijau di negara ini. Ini bertepatan dengan seruan yang diketengahkan oleh pihak UNESCO-UNEVOC pada tahun 2006 di mana bidang PTLV pada masa hadapan seharusnya tidak hanya mempersiapkan seseorang individu kepada dunia pekerjaan tetapi juga melatih mereka menjadi komuniti yang bertanggungjawab dan berintegriti terhadap keperluan melindungi dan memelihara alam sekitar. RUJUKAN CEDEFOP, (2010). Skills for Green Job: Developing a Low-Carbon Economy Depends on Improving Existing Skills Rather Than Specialised Green Skills. Briefing Note-9024 EN. Thessaloniki, Greece. Kementerian Sumber Manusia, (2011). Occupational Structure: Green Technology Industry, Jabatan Pembangunan Kemahiran, Bandar Baru Bangi, Selangor. Kerjasama Pintar, (2011). Kementerian Tenaga, Teknologi Hijau dan Air (KeTTHA). (http://www.kettha.gov.my). Dicapai pada 10 Oktober 2014. Laupa Junus (2009a). Teknologi Hijau: Apa dan Kenapa? Estidotmy (edisi 20), Utusan Malaysia. (6-7) Laupa Junus (2009b). Pelancaran Dasar Teknologi Hijau Buka Lembaran Baru. Estidotmy (edisi 20), Utusan Malaysia (4-5). 445 McKeown, R. (2002). The Education for Sustainable Toolkit. (http://www.esdtoolkit/org). Dicapai pada 5 September 2014. Mohd Zolkifli Abdul Hamid (2014). Kemahiran Generik Hijau: Eksplorasi Kajian Perpustakaan. Fakulti Pendidikan, Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Pavlova, M. (2009). Technology and Vocational Education for Sustainable Development: Empowering Individuals for the Future. Bonn: UNEVOC-Springer. Pavlova, M (2012). Generic Green Skills: Can They Be Addressed Through Technology Education? Proceeding of the 7th Biennial International Conference on Technology Education. 5-8 Dis. 2012. The Crowne Plaza Surfers Paradise, Australia. 49-57. Pasek, S. J., (2010). Training for Green Jobs. Federal Reserve Bank Of Boston: Communities and Banking, Spring. 21(2). Siti Nur Syazwani Saibani, Mohd. Safarin Nordin dan Muhammad Sukri Saud (2012). Integrasi Teknologi Hijau Dalam Kurikulum Pendidikan Teknik dan Vokasional (PTV). Journal of Technical, Vocational and Engineering Education, Vol. 5. (11-19) Siti Nur Rohazrien Juhari (2013). Elemen Kemahiran Employability dan Pemilihan Pekerja Dalam Industri Pembuatan di Negeri Johor. Tesis Sarjana. Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. (Tidak Diterbitkan). Subahan Mohd. Meerah, Lilia Hanim, Norasmah Othman dan Zahara Aziz (2005). Pembangunan Lestari Melalui Pendidikan Guru. Prosiding Seminar Pendidikan JPPG 2005, 28-30 Ogos. Hotel Shangri-La, Pulau Pinang. 8-13. Watch, D. D. (2010). Research for the Global Good. Supporting a Better World for All. Victoria, Australia: The Images Publishing Group Pty Ltd. Yahya Buntat, Mustafa Othman, Muhammad Sukri Saud, Mohamed Sharif Mustaffa dan Syed Mohamed Shafeq Mansor (2013). Integration of Green Soft Skills in Malaysian Technical Education. Advanced Science Letters, 19 (12), 3718-3720. 446 EMPLOYING WRITTEN CORRECTIVE FEEDBACK IN TEACHING WRITING Ng Siew Fong, Wan Fara Adlina Wan Mansor &Abdul Rahim Salam ABSTRACT Written corrective feedback is paramount because it triggers students’ awareness on the writing errors and mistakes made. Students' awareness on errors and mistakes can eventually lead to the learning of accurate structure or knowledge. In this paper, different types of written corrective feedback are explicated, namely direct feedback, indirect feedback, text-specific, directives, and positive feedback. Keywords: Written corrective feedback, Teaching and Learning, writing INTRODUCTION In teaching writing, corrective feedback given by the teachers usually necessitates the students to produce multiple drafts. The production of multiple writing drafts is proved to be able to culminate in positive writing developments among students from all level of proficiency (Peterson and McClay, 2010; Chien, 2011). In producing writing drafts, it is reported that students tend to completely rely on teacher feedback when revising their written work (McMartin-Miller, 2014). Moreover, previous study also 447 reports that feedback is significant for students’ self-esteem (Peterson and McClay, 2010). A reason that may account to this is that the students perceive that the amount of corrective feedback correlates with their writing errors. Thus, few corrective feedback indicates few writing errors. In the subsections that follow, written corrective feedback is discussed in more detail. UNDERPINNING THEORIES In the context of language learning, providing corrective feedback is essential in order to enable the students to notice and rectify their error. Theorists endorse the use of corrective feedback and they point out two theories in justifying the use of corrective feedback, namely cognitive theories (Piaget, 1974) and sociocultural theory (Vygotsky, 1978). According to cognitive theories, written corrective feedback facilitates language acquisition. Piaget (1974) espouses that it is the interaction with the environment that stimulates the students’ internal thought or action patterns that lead to acquisition. Piaget highlights two key concepts in explicating cognitive theory, namely assimilation and accommodation. Assimilation occurs when the students’ internal thought interacts with the environment and process what is gained from the environment. Accommodation occurs when the students adjust their action patterns in accordance to what is gained from the environment. In relation to learning, Ellis (2012) stipulates that when the students have their attention on the contextual meaning of the text and completely understand the meaning of the text, they might produce structural errors as they write. At this time, the teacher provides corrective feedback and this enables the students to compare their errors with the provided accurate structure. Since the students completely understand the meaning of the structure, it is believed that uptake, or the acquisition of the accurate language structure, can effectively take place. Another theory that supports the provision of corrective feedback is sociocultural theory. In the words of Vygotsky (1978), 448 “Every function in the child's cultural development appears twice: first, on the social level, and later, on the individual level; first, between people (interpsychological) and then inside the child (intrapsychological),” (p. 78). Vygotsky emphasizes the notion of social interaction in stimulating the students’ cognitive change. Moreover, learning takes place when the students experience social interaction and that learning do not take place in the mind of the students (Vygotsky, 1978; Ellis, 2012). Sociocultural theorists argued that each student is different and what applies to one student does not apply to another. As such, the teacher has to build a zone of proximal development for a particular student when the student is unable to rectify error on his own. When building the zone of proximal development, the teacher performs scaffolding or provides corrective feedback in enabling the student to practice accurate structure independently. NATURE OF WRITTEN CORRECTIVE FEEDBACK There are myriads of studies foregrounding the nature of written feedback. It is noteworthy that there are a lot of categories of written feedback. Zhao (2010) emphasized on the source of feedback as she argued that feedback can be in the form of peer feedback or teacher feedback. It is self-explanatory that peer feedback is given by peers whilst teacher feedback is given by teachers. Apart from focusing on the source of feedback, feedback can be categorized into two levels, namely surface level and deep level. For the surface level, feedback is directed towards the grammatical and linguistic aspects (Ferris et al., 1997) such as direct corrective feedback and indirect corrective feedback (Chandler, 2003; Bitchener, Young, and Cameron, 2005; Bitchener, 2008; Bitchener and Knoch, 2009; Sheen, Wright, and Moldawa, 2009; Sampson, 2012) and mixed feedback (Yilmaz, 2013). For the deep level, feedback is directed towards the content aspect such as text-specific (Goldstein, 2004); as well as directives (Ferris et al. 1997). Interestingly, a type of feedback overlaps both 449 surface level and deep level, which is positive feedback (Ferris et al. 1997; Hyland and Hyland, 2001). When providing surface and deep levels of feedback, syntactic and pragmatic feedback can be provided (Conrad and Goldstein, 1999). Direct corrective feedback denotes providing the accurate linguistic term or structure beside or near the linguistic error (Chandler, 2003; Bitchener Young, and Cameron, 2005; Bitchener, 2008; Bitchener and Knoch, 2009). Alternative terms for this type of feedback are uncoded correction (as the accurate answer to the error is provided rather than the provision of codes where the students have to decode the code provided) (Sampson, 2012) and focused feedback (as the feedback is focused to a specific error and accurate answer is provided to that error) (Sheen, Wright, and Moldawa, 2009). Also, this kind of feedback also refers to act of crossing off inappropriate lexis, phrase or morpheme; inserting missing lexis, phrase or morpheme; or providing accurate structure. Moreover, direct corrective feedback also encompasses written metalinguistic explanation, which is the inclusion of grammar rules and illustrations at the end of the students’ paper with the emphasis of the exact line where the error occurs. Alternatively, direct feedback can also be practiced using oral meta-linguistic explanation, where a mini-lesson imparting grammar rules and illustrations is provided. Oral meta-linguistic explanation can also be utilized by conducting one-on-one meetings between teacher and student or meetings between a teacher and a few students. Indirect corrective feedback, as the term suggests, denotes providing feedback in an indirect manner where the error is pointed out but the accurate answer is not included (Bitchener, Young, and Cameron, 2005; Bitchener, 2008; Bitchener and Knoch, 2009). In doing so, the students have to think of the accurate way to correct their error (Chandler, 2003). There are four ways of practicing this type of feedback, and they are underlining or circling the error; writing the frequency of error occurrence at the corner of the paper; or applying a code in demonstrating the place where the error occurs and in eliciting the type of error. The 450 utilization of code in providing indirect corrective feedback is also known as coded annotations (Sampson, 2012). Yilmaz (2013) augments that mixed feedback can be given as well. In her study, she employed mixed feedback treatment, where direct corrective feedback is provided first, and subsequently followed by implicit feedback. Apart from that, feedback can be text-specific (Goldstein, 2004). Text-specific feedback is conveyed when the comment is direct enough that can lead to students’ action but not to the extent of providing the accurate answer to the particular writing deficiency. For example, a comment is text-specific when it requires the students to “elaborate more on this point/your unpleasant experience, give more details of your experience and how it affects your perceptions”. When a comment is not textspecific, it requires the students to “expand this point”. Other than that, feedback can also be expressed in a directive manner (Ferris et al., 1997). There are three ways of practicing directive manner when commenting, which are asking for information, making a suggestion or a request and giving information. The asking for information can be motivated by three factors. One of the factors is to get students’ clarification on aspects which is unknown to the teacher such as the students’ experiences or intentions. The second factor is to get students’ detailed description of the point mentioned in writing and the last factor is to provide food for thoughts for students by providing rhetorical questions. Another way of practicing directive feedback is by making a suggestion such as asking the students, “Maybe you can make this point more concise by eliminating one of these examples.” Another way of expressing directive feedback is by giving information. When giving information, the teacher can either act like a reader responding to the text or provide information regarding other writers’ work, which is pertinent to the students’ writing. Besides, feedback can be positive (Ferris et al. 1997; Hyland and Hyland, 2001). Feedback is usually conveyed in a negative way where the teacher criticizes students’ weaknesses, be it in the 451 surface or deep level. Too much criticism may overwhelm the students and demotivate them and thus, impede their effort in improving their writing skill. Providing positive feedback occasionally will make the students feel that their effort is appreciated and this may encourage them to work harder in polishing their writing skill. Lastly, according to Conrad and Goldstein (1999), when feedback is viewed in a syntactic manner, it is whether a question, declarative or imperative. On the other hand, when feedback is viewed in a pragmatic manner, it is whether suggestive or directive. CONCLUSION Succinctly, written corrective feedback can be given in the form of peer feedback or teacher feedback; surface level or deep level; direct feedback, indirect feedback or mixed feedback; text-specific feedback or directives; positive feedback; syntactic or pragmatic feedback can be provided. Regardless of the types of corrective feedback, caution should be practiced when giving feedback such as not giving too much criticism especially to weak students or avoid providing vague feedback in ensuring the students make the most of the feedback and improve their writing skill. REFERENCES Bitchener, J. 2008. Evidence in support of written corrective feedback. Journal of Second Language Writing, 17(2): 102-118. Bitchener, J. and Knoch, U. 2009. The relative effectiveness of different types of direct written corrective feedback. System, 37(2): 322329. Bitchener, J., Young, S. and Cameron, D. 2005. The effect of different types of corrective feedback on ESL student writing. Journal of Second Language Writing, 14(3): 191-205. Chandler, J. 2003. The efficacy of various kinds of error feedback for improvement in the accuracy and fluency of L2 student writing. 452 Journal of Second Language Writing, 12(3): 267-296. Chien, C. 2011. Analysis of EFL university students’ written revisions towards peer feedback and teacher written comments in Taiwan. International Journal of Arts & Sciences, 4(10): 23-52. Conrad, S. M. and Goldstein, L. M. 1999. ESL student revision after teacher-written comments: Text, contexts, and individuals. Journal of Second Language Writing, 8(2): 147-179. Ellis, R. 2012. Language Teaching Research and Language Pedagogy. UK: Wiley-Blackwell. Ferris, D. R., Pezone, S., Tade, C. R., and Tinti, S. 1997. Teacher commentary on student writing: Descriptions and implications. Journal of Second Language Writing, 6(2): 155-182. Goldstein, L. M. 2004. Questions and answers about teacher written commentary and student revision: teachers and students working together. Journal of Second Language Writing, 13(1): 63-80. Hyland, F. and Hyland, K. 2001. Sugaring the pill: Praise and criticism in written feedback. Journal of Second Language Writing, 10(3): 185-212. McMartin-Miller, C. 2014. How much feedback is enough?: Instructor practices and student attitudes toward error treatment in second language writing. Assessing Writing, 19: 24-35. Peterson, S. S. and J. McClay 2010. Assessing and providing feedback for student writing in Canadian classrooms. Assessing Writing, 15(2): 86-99. Piaget, J. 1974. Need and significance of cross-cultural studies in genetic psychology. In J. W. Berry and P. R. Dasen (eds.), Culture and cognition: Readings in cross-cultural psychology, (pp. 299–309). London: Methuen. Sampson, A. 2012. Coded and uncoded error feedback: Effects on error frequencies in adult Colombian EFL learners' writing. System, 40(4): 494-504. Sheen, Y., Wright, D., and Moldawa, A. 2009. Differential effects of focused and unfocused written correction on the accurate use of grammatical forms by adult ESL learners. System, 37(4): 556569. Vygotsky, L. S. (1978). Interaction between learning and development (M. Lopez-Morillas, Trans.). In M. Cole, V. John-Steiner, S. Scribner, & E. Souberman (Eds.), Mind in society: The 453 development of higher psychological processes (pp. 79-91). Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press. Yilmaz, Y. 2013. The relative effectiveness of mixed, explicit and implicit feedback in the acquisition of English articles. System, 41(3): 691-705. Zhao, H. 2010. Investigating learners’ use and understanding of peer and teacher feedback on writing: A comparative study in a Chinese English writing classroom. Assessing Writing, 15(1): 3-17. 454 AMALAN KEPIMPINAN TRANFORMASI GURU BESAR DAN IMPAKNYA TERHADAP KOMITMEN GURU SEKOLAH RENDAH DI NEGERI SABAH Faridah Mat Noor & Khadijah Daud ABSTRAK Kajian ini dijalankan oleh penyelidik bertujuan mengenalpasti amalan kepimpinan guru besar dan impaknya terhadap komitmen guru di sekolah rendah di Negeri Sabah. Kajian ini adalah berdasarkan kepada teori kepimpinan yang diasaskan oleh Leithwood (1992) dan teori komitmen yang diasaskan oleh Allen dan Meyer (1990). Sebanyak tujuh dimensi teori kepimpinan yang dikaji iaitu kepimpinan iaitu membina visi dan matlamat sekolah, menyediakan rangsangan intelek, menawarkan sokongan secara individu, menjadi teladan terhadap nilai-nilai penting organisasi, menunjukkan prestasi kerja yang tinggi, membina budaya sekolah yang kreatif, membangunkan struktur dan mengalakkan penglibatan dalam proses membuat keputusan. Tiga komponen teori komitmen yang dikaji iaitu oleh Allen dan Meyer (1990) dengan tiga komponen organisasi iaitu komitmen afektif, komitmen berterusan dan komitmen normatif. Seramai 540 responden daripada1071 buah sekolah rendah di negeri Sabah yang 455 terlibat dalam kajian ini. Instrumen yang digunakan ialah soal selidik dan temubual. Data mentah yang dikumpulkan akan dianalisis menggunakan SPSS Version 14.0. Analisis data di buat secata deskriftif iaitu dalam bentuk kekerapan, peratus, min , anova dan regrasi. Kata Kunci: Guru besar, Kepimpinan tranformasi, Komitmen guru PENGENALAN Guru besar sebagai pengurus dan pemimpin pendidikan di sekolah, bukan sahaja kejayaan sekolah menjadi faktor utama tetapi dengan kepimpinan dan pengurusannnya serta visi dan misinya boleh menentukan hala tuju institusi pendidikan nasional yang diamanahkan kepadanya (Day el. al. 2000). Oleh itu kepimpinan sekolah yang berprestasi tinggi perlu dipupuk bagi meningkatkan prestasi sekolah. Dokumen Rancangan Malaysia Ke 10: 2011-2015 (RMK10) menyatakan dengan jelas harapan negara terhadap kepimpinan sekolah melalui pernyataan berikut: “ Membuat pelaburan bagi membangun kepimpinan unggul di setiap sekolah. Membuat pelaburan yang besar bagi meningkatkan prestasi kepimpinan sekolah sebagai pemangkin utama perubahan menerusi kreteria pemilihan yang ketat, latihan dan pengurusan prestasi yang mantap berdasarkan prestasi pelajar” (Rancangan Malaysia kesepuluh: 2010) Merujuk kepada pernyataan diatas, kepimpinan transformasi dianggap sebagai salah satu corak kepimpinan yang sesuai dan relevan digunakan masa kini bersesuaian dan berpotensi untuk membina komitmen yang tinggi dalam kalangan guru dengan cabaran penstrukturan semula sekolah dan persekitaran yang tidak menentu dalam bidang pendidikan menyebabkan perubahan kepimpinan sekolah daripada kepimpinan pengajaran kepada kepimpinan transformasi. (Leithwood , 1992, 1994; Leithwood & Janzi, 1999) . 456 Walau bagaimanapun keberkesanan sesebuah sekolah dan komitmen guru banyak bergantung kepada kualiti kepimpinan guru besar kerana keberkesanan kepimpinan kini diukur berdasarkan kemampuan pemimpin untuk mengubah tingkahlaku kepimpinan dan pengurus sekolah dalam pelbagai konteks dan situasi (Bolman (1999). LATAR BELAKANG MASALAH Lokman. (2007) menwajarkan kupasan terperinci tentang kepimpinan guru besar dalam usaha melahirkan pengetua yang berwawasan, berwibawa dan sekali gus menjadikan kualiti kepimpinan sekolah bertaraf dunia. Malangnya kajian-kajian yang dilakukan oleh Ariffin (2001) dan Vishalache (2005) melaporkan bahawa guru besar di Malaysia masih mengamalkan komunikasi sehala, kurang interaksi dengan guru, tidak melaksanakan autonomi guru malah jarang melaksanakan pengurusan pengupayaan dianggap menjadi punca penurunan tahap komitmen guru terhadap sekolah (Hasrat & Mansor, 2001). Seringkali masyarakat umum hingga ke peringkat nasional memperkatakan topik isu kepimpinan antaranya adalah isu berkaitan pembentukan visi dan matlamat sekolah yang pada dasarnya sangat mudah, mudah difahami, memberi manfaat dan mendorong kreativiti di dalam organisasi itu. Gambaran yang diberikan menonjolkan imej yang menarik, realistik dan boleh dicapai pada masa akan datang. Tetapi ada guru besar yang masih mentadbir dengan kaedah lama atau “one man show”. Menjadikan sekolah tidak berkesan dan tidak dinamik untuk berdaya saing dan kurang potensi besar kerana kurang keterlibatan warga sekolah. Isu seterusnya berkaitan pembentukan struktur pemuafakatan dalam membuat keputusan. Ada pengurusan berpusatkan pemimpin yang memberi arahan, desakan dan tekanan terhadap kakitangan bawahan. Maison (1990, Sonia 2007) menyimpulkan gaya kepimpinan terbuka, “penglibatan guru” adalah penting dalam menubuhkan sekolah berkesan iaitu perubahan budaya 457 mengurus sekolah dari model hierarki “atas ke bawah” kepada struktur yang lebih mendatar yang melibatkan majoriti staf memimpin sekolah. Selaku pemimpin di sekolah hendaklah bertindak sebagai agen perubahan yang mampu merangsang guru-guru menunjukkan prestasi kerja yang tinggi, berubah dengan mengilap bakat mereka, mengembangkan potensi dan menyegarkan nilai-nilai murni yang mereka miliki. (Abd. Aziz Yusof, 2000). Guru besar dianggap sebagai “role model” dan diambil contoh teladan kepada guru-guru. Menganggap kepimpinan sebagai satu tanggung jawab yang mempunyai matlamat yang unggul, tahu erti dan fungsi kepimpinan dan tidak menganggap kepimpinan sebagai hak mutlak seseorang dalam kedudukan yang tinggi dalam hieraki organisasi sahaja ( Syed Ismail Syed Mustapa & Ahmad Subki Miskon, 2010) Kajian Dr. Warren Bennis, professor di Universiti Southern California mendapati tidak lebih 20% pemimpin sekolah gagal untuk memanfaatkan kakitangan mereka. Hal ini akan menjadi lebih serius jika pemimpin sendiri tidak mempunyai kemahiran bekerja dengan guru-guru yang mempunyai keperluan yang pelbagai dan masalah sahsiah yang tersendiri kerana pemimpin sebegini lebih mengutamakan kepakaran dalam hal-hal teknikal sahaja (Ainon, 2005). Guru besar yang kurang keupayaan memimpin cenderung bersikap autokratik dan kurang memberatkan isu-isu guru sebagai manusia akan menimbulkan pelbagai masalah kerana kejayaan hanya akan dapat dicapai jika sumber manusianya terutama pemimpin sekolah dibangunkan secara bersepadu (Syed Ismail & Ahmad Subki, 2010). Menurut Chan (2000), aspirasi pendidikan negara tidak akan mencapai matlamat jika kepimpinan terlalu tertumpu kepada tugas pentadbiran sahaja sedangkan bidang kepimpinan hal ini bersifat dinamik, kompeks malah menuntut sesuatu yang lebih tinggi. (Herbert, 2006: Speck, 1999). Maka guru besar adalah dituntut membuka ruang sebagai pemacu ke arah pendidikan yang berkualiti. 458 PERNYATAAN MASALAH Masih terdapat beberapa kelemahan kepimpinan guru besar dalam memimpin sekolah (Abdul Sukor. 2004). Amalan kepimpinan guru besar masih merujuk kepada model birokratik menyebabkan mereka masih kabur tentang peranan merka sebagai pemimpin yang perlu menjana komitmen guru di sekolah. (Hishamuddin Shah, Mohd Rizal & Supian Hashim, 2013). Guru yang mempunyai tahap komitmen rendah didapati melakukan tingkahlaku yang mengurangkan produktiviti seperti melambatkan kerja, tiada di tempat kerja, mementingkan hal peribadi dan tidak mahu bekerja lebih masa (Patvin, 1991) Oleh itu kajian ini akan menghuraikan mengenai amalan kepimpinan transformasi guru besar dan komitmen guru. Mengenal pasti sejauhmana terdapat perbezaan amalan kepimpinan guru besar berdasarkan faktor demografi iaitu umur, jantina, tahap pendidikan, pengalaman pentadbiran dan lokasi sekolah. Seterusnya meneliti perkaitan antara kepimpinan transformasi guru besar dengan komitmen guru terhadap sekolah bandar dan luar bandar. OBJEKTIF KAJIAN Penyelidikan ini bertujuan untuk : 1.4.1 Mengenal pasti dimensi kepimpinan tranformasi yang paling dominan diamalkan oleh guru besar. 1.4.2 Mengkaji amalan guru besar dalam setiap demensi kepimpinan transformasi. 1.4.3 Mengkaji perbezaan amalan kepimpinan guru besar berdasarkan faktor demografi iaitu umur, jantina, tahap pendidikan, pengalaman pentadbiran dan lokasi sekolah. 1.4.5 Mengkaji peramal komitmen guru terhadap sekolah yang terdiri daripada amalan kepimpinan tranformasi guru besar di sekolah rendah bandar dan luar Bandar. 459 KEPENTINGAN KAJIAN Hasil kajian dan maklumat yang diperoleh penting untuk rujukan pihak-pihak tertentu yang terlibat secara langsung atau tidak langsung seperti guru besar, pengetua sekolah, penolong kanan, ketua bidang, ketua panitia, guru-guru dan sebagainya. DEFINISI OPERASIONAL Amalan Kepimpinan Tranformasi Guru Besar Mengikut Bass dan Avalio (1990) kepemimpin transformasi melakukan tiga perkara penting ia itu menyedarkan pengikut kepentingan menjayakan satu tugasan, memberi sokongan berterusan kepada pengikut untuk membuktikan kesediaan untuk bersama dalam mencapai matlamat organisasi menekankan kepada proses pembangunan dan meningkatkan kekuatan komitmen pengikut ke arah pencapaian matlamat organisasi. Dalam konteks kajian ini kepimpinan berdasarkan model kepimpinan transformasi Leithwood (1993) yang terdiri tujuh demensi kepimpinan iaitu membina visi dan matlamat sekolah, menyediakan rangsangan intelek, menawarkan sokongan secara individu, mejadi teladan terhadap nilai-nilai penting organisasi, menunjukkan prestasi kerja yang tinggi, membina budaya sekolah yang kreatif, membangunkan struktur dan mengalakkan penglibatan dalam proses membuat keputusan., Komitmen Terhadap Sekolah Menurut (Kamus Dewan, 2002) komitmen didefinisikan sebagai sikap atau perbuatan memberikan sepenuh tenaga dan perhatian dan sebagainya atau menunjukkan sokongan dan azam yang sepenuhnya kepada sesuatu iltizam iaitu keterlibatan secara bersungguh-sungguh dan penuh tanggungjawab dalam 460 melaksanakan sesuatu. Mengikut (Meyer & Allen, 1997) komitmen adalah interpretasi awal gambaran penerimaan pekerja terhadap organisasi melalui tingkah laku pekerja. . Dalam konteks kajian ini, komitmen guru terhadap sekolah merujuk kepada model komitmen organisasi oleh Allen dan Meyer (1990) dengan tiga komponen organisasi iaitu: komitmen afektif, komitmen berterusan dan komitmen normatif. Konsep Kepimpinan Kepimpinan merujuk kepada kebolehan untuk mempengaruhi manusia ke arah pencapaian malamat organisassi (Daft. 1997). Kepimpinan adalah satu konsep yang sukar dan kompleks kerana ia tidak terikat dengan penghasilan dan pengekalan arahan tetapi ia menghasilkan perubahan (Abdul Ghani el. al. (2010). Ini disebabkan pemimpin tidak mampu melakukan semua perkara secara bersendirian dan memerlukan pengikut untuk berkongsi kuasa dan memperkasakan pengikut bagi mencapai malamat dan menangani kekangan yang bakal dihadapi. Sebagaimana (Jamaliah & Norashimah, 2008) meyatakan kepimpinan adalah daya mempengaruhi tingkah laku seseorang itu sehingga menyebabkan ia sanggup memberi kerjasama untuk mencapai sesuatu matlamat yang dipersetujui. Oleh itu untuk memastikan seseorang pemimpin itu dapat melakukan sesuatu dalam pekerjaannya, seseorang pemimpin harus memiliki kemampuan dalam bentuk pengetahuan, sikap dan kemahiran yang sesuai dengan bidang pekerjaannya. KONSEP KOMITMEN Komitmen dalam organisasi merujuk kepada individu yang mempunyai kepercayaan yang kuat dan penerimaan terhadap matlamat dan nilai organisasi, kesanggupan anggotanya di dalam organisasi. Komitmen merupakan sikap dan kelakuan pekerja 461 yang amat penting dan ia menjadi tumpuan penyelidik dalam bidang pengurusan, gelagat organisasi dan pengurusan sumber manusia (A. Sukor, Noran & Rosna, 2004) kerana menurut Ghemawat (1991), komitmen adalah sebagai salah satu faktor fomula kejayaaan prestasi organisasi. Sebagaimana menurut Firestone & Pannell (1993) juga mengatakan komitmen guru juga mempunyai hubungan dengan pencapaian pelajar kerana dalam bidang pendidikan prestasi sekolah sebagai sebuah organisasi pendidikan amat bergantung kepada komitmen guru sebagai pendidik dan pengurus. SOROTAN KAJIAN Kajian Lepas Tentang Kepimpinan Transformasi M. Al-Muz-Zammil B. Yasin & Nazri Bin Mahmood telah menjalankan kajian mengenai amalan kepimpinan transformasi guru besar dan pengetua. Hasil kajian menunjukkan tahap amalan kepimpinan transformasi berada pada tahap yang tinggi dalam kepimpinan yang diamalkan oleh guru besar. Hasil kajian (Zainal Abidin & Khalid Ashaari, 1997) terhadap pengetua juga mengukuhkan kenyataan di atas bahawa pengamalan gaya kepimpinan tranformasi oleh pemimpin berkeupayaan meningkatkan prestasi guru dalam perlakuan warga organisasi dan sikap guru iaitu komitmen mereka terhadap kerja. Walau bagaimanapun, kajian Abd. Razak Hashim (1995) mendapati tiada hubungan yang signifikan antara gaya kepimpinan dengan komitmen guru. Hal ini berbeza dengan dapatan kajian Abdul Ghani Abdullah (2005) iaitu pengamalan gaya kepimpinan transformasi oleh pengetua dapat meningkatkan prestasi dan komitmen guru di sekolah. Kajian Lokman Mohd. Tahir, M. Al–Muzammil Yassin (2008) terhadap impak psikologi guru hasil kepimpinan pengetua mendapati bahawa tahap kepercayaan guru terhadap pengetua adalah pada tahap sederhana walaupun tahap komitmen guru 462 dicatatkan pada tahap yang tinggi. Dapatan ini membuktikan bahawa pengetua dianggap sebagai individu yang berkelayakan untuk mentadbir sekolah. Melalui kajian ini juga mampu dibuktikan bahawa kepemimpinan pengetua adalah pengaruh utama pembentukan tahap komitmen terhadap sekolah dan kepercayaan guru kepada sekolah. Kajian-kajian mengenai kepimpinan transformasi juga banyak dilakukan di luar Negara. Antaranya adalah kajian dalam bidang pendidikan oleh Leithwood (1993) mendapati bahawa pemimpin tranformasi di sekolah memberi penekanan untuk mencapai tiga matlamat utama iaitu membantu guru membentuk, memperkembangkan dan juga mengekalkan budaya kerja profesional dan semangat bekerjasama, memupuk perkembangan profesional guru dan membantu menyelesaikan masalah secara efektif. Leithwood, Tomlinson & Genge (1997) dalam kajiannya juga mendapati gaya kepimpinan transformasi pengetua mempunyai kesan yang positif ke atas kepuasan kerja, komitmen terhadap organisasi dan prestasi kerja guru. Kajian Lepas Tentang Komitmen Kajian Mohd Safar Ahmad (2003) mengenai komitmen guru terhadap organisasi dan profesion perguruan mendapati tahap komitmen guru terhadap organisasi adalah sederhana begitu juga dengan tahap komitmen guru terhadap profesion perguruan. Walaupun tahap komitmen mereka adalah sederhana tetapi didapati guru lebih komited terhadap profesion keguruan daripada organisasi. Dapatan kajian juga mendapati terdapat hubungan yang signifikan diantara komitmen terhadap organisasi dan profesion perguruan di tahap yang sederhana. Kajian Lepas Kepimpinan Transformasi Dan Komitmen Manakala kajian (Lokman Mohd Tahir, M. Al-Muzzamil (2008) 463 pula mendapati peranan pengetua dalam meningkatkan tahap psikologi guru terutamanya komitmen dan kepercayaan dianggap penting dalam menjamin persekitaran sekolah yang berkualiti dan berkesan. Rosnah dan A. Sukor, Noran & Rosna (2004) pula telah menjalankan kajian ke atas 370 orang guru dari 108 buah sekolahsekolah menengah di negeri Kedah. Dapatan kajian dari segi hubungan komitmen terhadap profesion dan prestasi kerja mengikut penilaian pentadbir menunjukkan semakin tinggi tahap komitmen terhadap profesion semakin tinggi prestasi kerja guru. Keputusan kajian yang diperolehi oleh Leithwood (1993) telah menunjukkan bahawa peningkatan komitmen guru-guru terhadap sekolah adalah dipengaruhi oleh tingkah laku kepimpinan transformasi yang diamalkan oleh pengetua. Satu lagi keputusan kajian yang menyokong keputusan ini telah diperolehi oleh Otto (1993). Beliau telah menemui keputusan kajian yang menunjukkan bahawa amalan tingkah laku kepimpinan transformasi oleh penyelia ada kaitannya dengan peningkatan komitmen pekerja terhadap pekerjaan. Kesimpulannnya adalah amalan kepimpinan transformasi oleh pemimpin sekolah mampu meningkatkan komitmen guru-guru terhadap organisasi. REKA BENTUK KAJIAN Reka bentuk kajian yang digunakan adalah reka bentuk deskriptif. Reka bentuk deskriptif ini dijalankan dengan tujuan untuk memberi penerangan yang sistematik mengenai fakta dan ciri-ciri sesuatu populasi secara fakta dan tepat (Sidek. 2002). Soal selidik dipilih kerana soal selidik adalah kaedah termudah dan berkesan dalam memperolehi data piawai daripada saiz sampel kajian yang besar dan menyeluruh (Barbie, 2000: Frankel & Wallen 2003). Kaedah tinjuan digunakan bagi menentukan pemboleh ubah yang mana mempunyai perkaitan dengan subjek yang dikaji atau pun bagi melakukan ujian pada hipotesis berhubung dengan perkaitan yang dijangkakan. (Azizi Yahya, Shahrin Hashim, Yusof Boon. 2007). Pemboleh ubah bersandar dalam kajian ini ialah tahap 464 amalan kepimpinan tranformasi guru besar, manakala pemboleh ubah tidak bersandar pula ialah komitmen guru. SAMPEL DAN TEMPAT KAJIAN Populasi kajian meliputi 25394 orang guru yang berkhidmat di 1071 buah sekolah rendah di negeri Sabah. Guru dipilih sebagai responden kerana guru adalah golongan yang dapat memberi gambaran yang tetap tentang rutin pengurusan dan gelagat kepimpinan guru besar di sekolah (McNulty et. Al. 2005). Pemilihan sampel adalah kaedah persampelan berstrata kerana populasi kajian tidak seragam dari segi jantina, kategori perkhidmatan dan pengalaman pentadbiran. Menurut Brymann dan Cramer (2005) persampelan berstrata mampu memberikan kesahan sampel yang lebih tepat kerana agihan saiz sampel yang agak sama untuk setiap strata. Saiz dan bilangan sampel adalah mengikut Sekaran (2003) iaitu saiz sampel antara 30 sehingga 500 responden adalah mencukupi untuk kajian tinjauan. Kajian ini akan melibatkan sekolah rendah kebangsaan dalam empat zon di negeri Sabah. INSTRUMEN KAJIAN Secara khusus, kajian ini menggunakan dua kaedah utama iaitu soal selidik dan temu bual. Soal selidik adalah alat kajian utama untuk mengumpul data tentang kepimpinan transformasi guru besar dan komitmen guru terhadap sekolah. Satu set borang soal selidik untuk guru-guru akan diedarkan dan mengandungi tiga bahagian iaitu bahagian A, B, dan C. Keputusan kajian ini akan dianalisa menggunakan Statictical Package For Social Science (SPSS ) Version 15.0. Bahagian A : Demografi Guru terdapat lima item yang perlu ditanda oleh responden iaitu umur, jantina, tahap pendidikan, pengalaman 465 pentadbiran dan lokasi sekolah. Bahagian B : Kepimpinan Transformasi diukur menggunakan soal selidik Multifactor Leadership Questionare (MLQ) oleh (Bass & Avalio. 2004) terdiri daripada soalan berkaitan persoalan kajian yang telah ditetapkan. Bahagian C : Komitmen Organisasi diukur menggunakan Organization Commitment Questionare (OCQ) oleh (Mowday et. Al, 1982) terdiri daripada soalan berkaitan persoalan kajian yang ditetapkan. Setiap item mempunyai pilihan jawapan yang diukur dengan menggunakan skala Likert. Responden hanya perlu menyemak kategori respon yang difikirkan paling sesuai. Skala yang digunakan adalah skala 5 mata iaitu (5 – Sangat Setuju, 4 – Setuju 3 – Tidak Pasti, 2 – Tidak Setuju, 1 – Sangat Tidak setuju). Melalui kaedah temu bual, protokol temu bual yang mengandungi soalan terbuka telah dibina untuk mendapatkan maklum balas tentang pelaksanaan setiap ciri dalam kepimpinan guru besar. Soalan susulan turut dikemukakan berdasarkan jawapan subjek kajian untuk memahami fenomena kajian dengan lebih jelas dan terperinci. (Merriam. 2001 : Taylor & Bogman 1998). Justeru, penyelidik merasakan perlu gabungan kaedah kuantitatif dan kualitatif dilakukan untuk menguji kerangka kajian ini dalam konteks kajian kepimpinan guru besar di Malaysia. RUJUKAN Ab. Aziz Yusof. ( 2000). Perubahan dan Kepimpinan. Penerbit Universiti Utara Malaysia. Abdul Ghani Abdullah, Abd, Rahman Abd, Aziz & Mohammed Zahir Ahmad. (2010). Gaya-Gaya Kepimpinan dalam Pendidikan. PTS Profesional. Kuala Lumpur Abdul Sukor Shaari, Noran Fauziah Yaakub & Rosnah Awang Hashim (2004). Peranan Pengalaman Mengajar Dalam Hubungan Antara Komitmen Terhadap Profesion Dengan Prestasi Kerja. Universiti Utara Malaysia. IJMS (Special Issue) 466 Abdul Razak Hashim. (1995). Kepimpinan Pendidikan: Persepsi Guru‐Guru Terhadap Kepimpinan Guru Besar Sekolah‐Sekolah Rendah Negeri Perlis. Tesis Sarjana, Universiti Utara Malaysia. Arrifin Ba’ada.(2001). Komunikasi Dalam Kepimpinan Pengetua Dan Kesannya Kepada Kepuasan Kerja Guru. Tesis Dr. Falsafah. Universiti Kebangsaan Malaysia. Bangi. Ainon Mohd. (2005) Teori Dan Teknik Kepimpinan Panduan Aplikasi Di Tempat Kerja. Kuala Lumpur . PTS Professional Publishing Sdn. Bhd. Allen, N.J., & Meyer, J.P. (1990). The Measurement And Antecedents Of Affective, Continuance, And Normative Commitment To Organization. Journal Of Occupational Psychology, 63, 1–18. Azizi Yahya, Sahrin Hashim, Jamaluddin Ramli, Yusuf Boon, Abdul Rahim Hamdan. (2007). Penyelidikan Menguasai Dalam Pendidikan: Teori Analisis Dan Interpretasi Data. Kuala Lumpur. PTS Profesional Publishing. Bass, B.M & Avalio. (1990) . The Implications For Transaksional And Tranformational, Team and Organization Development, 4 p. 231-273 Barbie., E. (2000). Survey Research Methods. California: Wordsworth. Bolman, L., Bloch., H., & Granell, E. (1999). Versatile Leadership: A Comparative Analysis Of Reframing In Venezuelan Managers. Kertas kerja ini dibantangkan di Persidangan World Wide Bilingual Di Universiti Madrid Spanyol. http: www.bloch.ukmc.edu/classes/bolman.html (19 Oktober 2004) Bryman, J. & Cramer, D. (2005). Quantitative Data Analysis With SPSS 12 And 13: A Guide For Social Scientist. Hove. Routledge. Buletin SI Partners+ . (2014). Kepimpinan Transformational: Matlamat, Strategi Dan Impak Dalam Pembangunan Organisasi Sekolah. Pejabat Pendidikan Daerah Kulaijaya. Johor. Chan Yuen Fook (2000). Apakah Aspek Penting Dalam Latihan Kepengetuaan Dalam Abad Ke 21. Kertas Kerja Seminar Nasional Pengurusan & Kepimpinan Pendidikan Ke 9. Anjuran Institut Aminuddin Baki. Genting Highland, 1-3 Ogos. Daft, Richard. L. (1997). Management. 4th. ed. Orlando : The Dryden Press Day, C., Harris. A., Hadfield, M., Trolley, H., & Beresford, J. 2000. Leading Schools In Times To Change. Milton Keynes: Open 467 University Press. Frankel, J., & Wallen, N. (2003). How To Design And Evaluate Research In Education. Ed. Ke -6. New York: Mc Graw Hill. Firestone,W. & Pennell, J. (1993). Teacher Commitment, Working Conditions and Differential Incentive Policies. Review Of Educational Research 63(4): 489-525. Ghemawat, P. (1991). Commitment: The Dynamic Of Strategy. New York: Free Press. Hasrat Abdul Rahman (2001). Proses Pengupayaan Dan Hubungannnya Dengan Kepuasan Kerja Guru Sekolah Menengah Daerah Pontian, Johor, Tesis Sarjana Pendidikan. Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Herbert, E. (2006). The Boss Of The School. Effective Leadership In Actions. New York: Teachers Chollage Press. Jamaliah Abdul Hamid & Norashimah Ismail ( 2008). Pengurusan Dan Kepimpinan Pendidikan. Teori , Polisi Dan Pelaksanaan. Penerbit Universiti Putra Malaysia. Serdang. Kamus Dewan. (2002). Kuala Lumpur . Dewan Bahasa Dan Pustaka. Khalid Ashaari. ( 1997). Hubungan Gaya Kepimpinan Dan Kepimpinan Transformasi Pengetua Dengan Kepuasan Dan Motivasi. Tesis Sarjana. Universiti Sains Malaysia. Pulau Pinang. Lambert, L. (1998). Building Leadership Capacity . Alexanderia. VA. ASDC Lokman Mohd. Tahir & M. Al-Muzzamil Yassin (2008). Impak Psikologi Guru Hasil Kepimpinan Pengetua. Jurnal Teknologi E. 48: 129-139. Lokman Mohd. Tahir. (2007). Orientasi Kepimpinan Pengetua dan perkaitannya dengan Komitmen Guru: Kajian Di SekolahSekolah Menengah di Johor. Tesis Dr. Falsafah. Universiti Kebangsaan Malaysia. Bangi. Lokman Mohd. Tahir; Khadijah Daud & Rozita Rahmat (2007). Perkaitan Antara Kepimpinan Pengajaran Guru Besar Denagn Kepercayaan Dan Komitmen Guru. Jabatan AsasPendidikan. Fakulti Pendidikan., Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Leithwood, K. Tomlinson, D. Genge, M (1997). Tranformatonal School Leadership dalam Leithwood, K. et. Al. (ed) International Handbook Of Educational Leadership And Administration. Netherland: Kluwer Academic Publishers. Leithwood, K. (1993). Contribution of Transformational Leadership to 468 School Restructuring. Journal of Personnel Evolution in Education. 7: 31-377 Leithwood, Kenneth A. (1992). The Move Toword Transformation Leadership. “ Education Leadership 49, 5 : 8-12. EJ 439 275. Leithwood, Kenneth, and Doris Jantzi. (1999). Tranformation Leadership Effect: A Replication. School Effectiveness and School Improvement, 4(10): 451-479. Moisan C. (1990). Local Management Of Schools Dalam Gilbeli C (Led) Local Management Of Schools A Guide For Govenors And Teachers. London . Kogen Page Mansor Abd. Aziz (2001). Persepsi Pengetua Dan Guru Penolong Terhadap Pengupayaan Dalam Pengurusan Sekolah. Tesis Sarjana Pendidikan. Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. McNulty, B., Waters, T., & Marzano, R. (2005). School Leadership That Works: From Research To Result. Viginia: Association for Supervision and Curicullum Develpoment. Merriam, S. (2001). Qualitative Research And Case Studies In Education: Revised And Expanded From Case Study Research In Education. San Francisco: Jossey Bass. Meyer, J.P. & Allen, N.J. (1997). Commitment in the workplace: Theory, Research, and Application. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage Publication, Inc. Mohd. Safar Ahmad (2003). Komitmen Guru Terhadap Organisasi Dan Profesion Perguruan . Satu Tinjauan Di Sekolah Menengah Teknik, Kota Tinggi Johor, Fakulti Pendidikan . Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Johor. Mowday, R., Steers, R., & Porter, L. (1982). Employee_Organization Linkages. Dalam P. Warr (Pnyt), Organizational And Occupational Psychology, hlm 71-98. New York: Academic Press. Otto, C.A. (1993). Employee Loyalty, Employee Commitment, dan Employee Perception of Organizational Justice. Ph d Dissertation Abstract. Department of Business Administration Michigan State University. 47. Patvin, T. C (1991). Employee Organizational Commitment: An Examinatian Of It Relationship To Communication Satisfaction And Evaluation Of Questionnaries Designed To Measure the Cobstucts. Unpublished Doctoral Dissertation. University Of Kansas, Lawrence. KS. 469 Sekaran, U. (2003). Research Methods For Business: A Skill Building Approach. Ed. Ke- 4. New York: John & Wiley. Sidek Mohd Noah ( 2002). Reka bentuk Penyelidikan, Falsafah, Teori dan Praktis. Universiti Putra Malaysia. Serdang. Syed Ismail Syed Mustapa & Ahmad Subki Miskun. ( 2010) Asas Kepimpinan & Pembangan Profesional. Selangor. Penerbitan Multimedia Sdn. Bhd. Speck, M. (1999). The Principalship: A Building Community. New Jersey: Prencite-Hall. Sonia Blandford . (2007) Panduan Pengurus Peringkat Pertengahan Di Sekolah. . Institut Terjemahan Negara Malaysia. Penterjemah Bahariah Yusuf. Kuala Lumpur. Taylor, S. & Bogdan, R. (1998). Introduction To Qualitative Research Methods. Ed. Ke-3. Ney York: John Wiley& Sons. Vishalache Balakrishnan. (2005). Work Ethnics And Empowerment Within Malaysian Schools. Kertas Kerja 2nd Asia Pacific Business Conference. Anjuran Universiti Teknologi Mara. Putra Jaya, 1-3 September. Zainal Abidin Che Omar . (1997). Pengaruh Kepimpinan Transformasi Pengetua Ke Atas Komitmen Kerja Guru. Tesis Sarjana. Universiti Kebangsaan Malaysia. 470 PENDEKATAN KONTEKS PENGGUNA DALAM REKABENTUK PERSEKITARAN PEMBELAJARAN SECARA TALIAN TERUS Nur Syamimi Mohd Razali & Noraffandy Yahaya ABSTRAK Persekitaran pembelajaran secara talian terus dilaksanakan sebagai platform pembelajaran secara maya bertujuan untuk menyampaikan sumber pembelajaran bagi mencapai objektif pembelajaran. Oleh sebab itu, e-pembelajaran seperti ini direkabentuk supaya ia dapat membantu pengajar dan pelajar yang menggunakannya dapat mencapai matlamat tersebut. Kertas kerja ini akan membincangkan serba sedikit tentang konteks pengguna dalam proses rekabentuk persekitaran pembelajaran, kepentingan dan kelebihannya. Kata kunci: konteks; e-pembelajaran; konteks pengguna PENGENALAN Persekitaran pembelajaran secara talian terus adalah menjadi salah satu medium pembelajaran yang mendapat tempat pada masa kini. 471 Integrasi teknologi seperti komputer dan internet dalam situasi pembelajaran adalah tepat dan bersesuaian dengan zaman teknologi berada dihujung jari. Persekitaran pembelajaran secara talian terus menyediakan platform pembelajaran yang fleksibel dan autonomi kepada pelajar untuk menggunakannya untuk mengakses sumber pembelajaran dan tidak kurang juga terlibat dalam komuniti maya seterusnya mencapai objektif pembelajaran. Oleh sebab itu, persekitaran pembelajaran secara talian terus tersebut hendaklah direkabentuk supaya matlamat pembelajaran boleh dicapai (McAlpine & Allen, 2007). Hunaiyyan et al. (2008) menyatakan bahawa adalah amat penting untuk menyediakan pelajar satu persekitaran pembelajaran yang boleh memberikan keselesaan kepada pelajar. Oleh sebab itu, bagi tujuan tersebut, beberapa penyelidik mencadangkan supaya mengenali karakteristik dan konteks pelajar semasa proses rekabentuk (Hunaiyyan et al., 2008; Benson & Samarawickrema; 2009 & Sheinberg, 2001) KONTEKS PENGGUNA DALAM REKABENTUK Salah satu matlamat rekabentuk sesuatu sistem adalah untuk memberi kemudahan dan kepuasan kepada pengguna. Oleh sebab itu, sistem tersebut hendaklah direkabentuk secara berkesan dan sistematik untuk mencapai matlamat tersebut. Dan dalam masa yang sama, situasi ini akan memberikan cabaran kepada pendidik dan perekabentuk untuk memastikan matlamat ini tercapai. Dalam rekabentuk e-pembelajaran dan persekitaran pembelajaran atas talian, Brown & Voltz (2005) mengatakan bahawa untuk merekabentuk persekitaran pembelajaran yang berkesan, salah satu elemen yang perlu ditekankan ialah konteks. Memahami konteks pelajar adalah penting kerana sistem yang direkabentuk berasaskan kepada konteks pengguna dikatakan mampu meningkatkan kepuasan pengguna (Vredenburg et al., 2002). Tambahan pula, mengenalpasti dan mengaplikasi konteks pengguna dalam rekabentuk juga dipercayai boleh meminimakan 472 masalah yang dihadapi oleh pelajar semasa pembelajaran secara talian terus (Noraffandy, 2008) Menurut Fischer & Baird (2005), sejauh mana penglibatan pelajar dalam persekitaran pembelajaran secara talian terus adalah ditentukan oleh struktur kursus. Contohnya, jika rekabentuk persekitaran pembelajaran tersebut mampu menyediakan persekitaran yang bersesuaian dengan keperluan dan konteks mereka, pelajar menjadi lebih puas menggunakannya dan seterusnya dapat memotivasikan mereka untuk terus menggunakannya (Fischer & Baird; 2005). Hujah ini disokong oleh kajian yang dilakukan oleh Al-Hunaiyyan et al. (2008) yang meyatakan karakteristik mesti diambil kira dalam rekabentuk pembelajaran. Perkara ini penting kerana pelajar hendaklah disediakan satu persekitaran pembelajaran yang boleh menjadikan mereka selesa untuk menggunakannya dan mampu memenuhi keperluan mereka (Hunaiyyan et al., 2008; Noraffandy, 2008) REKABENTUK BERASASKAN PENGGUNA Rekabentuk berasaskan pengguna merupakan satu pendekatan yang melibatkan pengguna sebenar secara aktif dalam proses merekabentuk suatu sistem (Mao et al., 2005; Sripathi & Sandru, 2013). Abras et al. (2004) mendefinisikan rekabentuk berasaskan pengguna adalah satu proses yang membantu rekabentuk perisian yang memenuhi kehendak pengguna dengan melibatkan pengguna sebenar secara aktif dalam proses rekabentuk.Pendekatan sebegini banyak digunapakai dalam proses rekabentuk contohnya seperti perisian ()dan laman web (De Troyer & Leune, 1998). Menurut Wallach & Scholz (2012) rekabentuk berasaskan pengguna adalah penting kerana tingkahlaku pengguna sebenar atau pengguna-akhir (end user) adalah mungkin berbeza daripada tingkahlaku yang diimaginasi oleh perekabentuk atau pemilik produk. Keadaan ini menyebabkan pengguna tidak dapat mengguna sesuatu produk dengan berkesan. Dalam konteks pendidikan, pelajar adalah merupakan 473 pengguna akhir kepada produk contohnya, persekitaran pembelajaran yang direkabentuk bagi tujuan pengajaran dan pembelajaran. Jika sebelum ini persekitaran pembelajaran direkabentuk berasaskan kepada model pembelajaran (), pedagogi dan teori rekabentuk (), rekabentuk berasaskan kepada pelajar (learner-centered) menumpukan kepada kehendak dan keperluan pelajar dalam konteks mereka.Untuk tujuan ini, pengajar atau perekabentuk perlu mengambil kira kehendak, keperluan dan pandangan mereka sebagai asas rekabentuk. Dalam erti kata lain, rekabentuk berasaskan pelajar ini mampu memenuhi keperluan pelajar seterusnya dapat menyediakan persekitaran pembelajaran yang sesuai bagi mereka. Mengambil kira konteks pelajar membolehkan perekabentuk memahami pengguna iaitu pelajar tentang cirri-ciri keperluan, kehendak, persepsi pengalaman lepas dan sekarang serta mungkin juga harapan pelajar terhadap aktiviti pembelajaran mereka. Ini turut disokong oleh Sanders (2002) yang menyatakan bahawa daripada pengalaman pengguna, perekabentuk dapat mengenalpasti dan merungkai beberapa perkara seperti apa kata pengguna, membuat inferens daripada fikiran, apa mereka guna, apa mereka tahu, memahami perasaan mereka dan juga harapan mereka. Proses seperti ini memerlukan perekabentuk memahami pengguna terlebih dahulu sebelum ciri-ciri tersebut diadaptasi kepada teknologi komputer. Kepentingan dan kelebihan rekabentuk berasaskan pengguna banyak dibincangkan dalam literatur. Dengan mengambil kira konteks pengguna, pengguna sebagai pengguna akhir boleh mendapat kepuasan dan dapat menggunakan produk atau sistem dengan lebih baik. Tinjauan yang dilakukan oleh Vredenburg et al. (2002) yang melibatkan 103 orang responden terhadap kelebihan menggunakan pendekatan rekabentuk berasaskan pengguna adalah positif. Hasil dapatan kajian mendapati bahawa secara keseluruhannya, produk yang direkabentuk berasaskan pengguna meningkatkan kegunaan dan kebolehgunaan. Dapatan kajian ini turut disokong oleh Mao et al. (2005) yang mendapati bahawa responden mereka mengakui bahawa rekabentuk berasaskan 474 pengguna mampu meningkatkan kegunaan dan kebolehgunaan kepada pengguna akhir. Memahami konteks pengguna membolehkan perekabentuk dan pendidik mendapat maklumat yang lebih mendalam tentang keperluan dan pandangan pelajar. Sebagai contoh, Chakraborty & Nafukho (2014) mengelaskan kepada lima ciri yang pelajar perlukan semasa menggunakan persekitaran pembelajaran secara talian terus. Lima perkara tersebut ialah: a) Mewujudkan dan memastikan persekitaran pembelajaran terjamin positif b) Membina komuniti secara talian terus c) Memberi maklumbalas yang yang konsisten pada masa yang tepat d) Menggunakan teknologi yang betul untuk sebaran kandungan yang betul e) Menyediakan sistem sokongan yang bersesuian (Chakraborty & Nafukho, 2014) Dalam masa yang sama, pelbagai kaedah telah dilakukan untuk mendapatkan maklumat berkaitan keperluan pengguna dalam proses rekabentuk berasaskan pengguna. Dalam rekabentuk persekitaran maya (Virual Environment, VE), Gabbard et al. (1999) memperkenalkan empat langkah bermula daripada pengumpulan maklumat pengguna sehinggalah kepada penilaian. Empat langkah tersebut ialah: a) Analisis tugas pengguna (user task analysis) b) Penilaian berdasarkan panduan pakar (expert guidelines-based evaluation) c) Penilaian formatif berpusatkan pengguna (formartive usercentered evaluation) d) Penilaian perbandingan sumatif (Summative comparative evaluations) Namun begitu, usaha ini memerlukan pendekatan atau kaedah yang sistematik untuk mengumpul keperluan pelajar. Ia sudah tentulah melibatkan isu seperti penglibatan pakar, keadaan masa dan juga status kewangan (Kallio & Kekäläinen, 2004). Mao et al. (2005) juga melaporkan sedemikian. Mereka mendapati responden 475 kajian mereka yang mendakwa rekabentuk berasakan pengguna tidaklan menjimatkan masa sekiranya ia memerlukan proses rekabentuk semula diperlukan dan sekali gus akan meningkatkan kos. Oleh sebab itu, Noraffandy (2008) menekankan supaya perlunya kepada pendekatan rekabentuk yang sistematik dan mudah untuk dikendalikan serta memfokuskan kepada konteks pengguna dan keperluan selain daripada mengurangkan masa pembangungan dan kos. Dalam konteks menyediakan persekitaran pembelajaran kepada pelajar, rekabentuk persekitaran pembelajaran haruslah bersesuaian dan memenuhi keperluan pelajar (Noraffandy, 2008). Persekitaran pembelajaran hendaklah fleksibel dengan menyediakan alat serta sokongan yang bersesuaian dalam usaha untuk menggalakkan pembelajaran pelajar. Situasi ini menjadi cabaran kepada pendidik atau perekabentuk untuk memilih pendekatan rekabentuk yang berasaskan pengguna yang bersesuaian dan boleh mengenalpasti keperluan konteks pelajar. Sheinberg (2001) & Benson & Samarawickrema (2009) menambah, keperluan pelajar hendaklah diberi penekanan dan diambil kira dalam pembelajaran berasaskan e-pembelajaran di samping kandungan dan objektif pembelajaran yang juga penting berbanding pembelajaran tradisional. Oleh sebab itu, adalah penting untuk mengambil kira konteks pengguna khususnya pelajar dalam proses rekabentuk persekitaran pembelajaran secara talian terus. Secara keseluruhan, kertas kerja ini membincangkan tentang pendekatan konteks pengguna dalam proses rekabentuk. Selain itu, ia turut membincangkan tentang kepentingan dan kelebihan konteks pengguna dalam rekabentuk. RUJUKAN Abras, C., Maloney-Krichmar, D. & Preece, J. (2004). User-Centered Design. In Bainbridge, W. Encyclopedia of Human Computer Interaction, Thousand Oaks: Sage Publication. Al-Hunaiyyan, A., Al-Huwail, N. & Al-Sharhan, S. (2008). Blended E- 476 Learning Design: Discussion of Cultural Issues. International Journal of Cyber Society and Education, Vol. 1, No. 1, March 2008, pp. 17-32. Benson, R. & Samarawickrema, G. (2009). Addressing the context of elearning: using transactional distance theory to inform design. Distance Education Vol. 30, No. 1, May 2009, pp. 5–21 Chakraborty, M. & Nafukho, F.M. (2014). "Strengthening student engagement: What do students want in online courses?", European Journal of Training and Development, Vol. 38, Issue 9. De Troyer, O.M.F. & Leune, C.J. (1998). WSDM: a user centered design method for Web site, Computer Networks and ISDn Systems, 30, pp. 85-94. Fisher, M. & Baird D. E., (2005)."Online learning design that fosters student support, Self-regulation, and retention", Campus-Wide Information Systems, Vol. 22, Issue 2, pp. 88 – 107 Gabbard, J. L., Hix, D. & Swan II, J. E. (1999). User-Centered Design and Evaluation of Virtual Environments, Virtual Reality, IEEE Computer Graphics and Applications, pp. 51-59. Kallio, T. & Kekäläinen, A. (2004). Improving the effectiveness of Mobile Application. In S. Brewster and M. Dunlop (Eds): MobileHCI 2004, 315-319. Lai, J., Honda, T. and Yang, M. C. (2010). A study of the role of usercentered design methods in design team projects. AI EDAM, 24(3): 303–316. Noraffandy, Y. (2008). Designing for learning and support: The usercentred construction and evaluation of an on-line environment for Malaysian teachers learning about digital graphics. Tesis PhD. University of Leeds. Mao, J.-Y., Vredenburg, K., Smith, P.W. & Carey, T. (2005). The State of User-Centered Design Practice. Communication of the ACM, Volume 48, No 3, pp. 105-109. McAlpine, I. & Allen, B. (2007). Designing for active learning online with learning design templates. In ICT: Providing choices for learners and learning. Proceedings ascilite Singapore 2007. http://www.ascilite.org.au/conferences/singapore07/procs/mcalpine.pdf Sanders, E.B.-N. (2002). From user-centred to participatory design approaches. In J. Frascara (Ed.), Design and the Social Sciences, Taylor and Francis Books, New York (2002), pp. 1–8. Sheinberg, M. (2001). Know Thy Learner: The Importance of Context in 477 E-Learning Design. Learning Circuits. Dipetik daripada http://www.learningcircuits.org/2001/oct2001/elearn.html pada Ogos 2014. Sripathi, V. & Sandru, V. (2013). Effective Usability Testing – Knowledge of User Centered Design is a Key Requirement. International Journal of Emerging Technology and Advanced Engineering, Volume 3, Issue 1,pp. 627-635. Vredenburg, K., Mao, J.-Y., Smith, P.W. & Carey, T. (2002). A Survey of User-Centered Design Practice. In Proc. of CHI 2002, pp. 471– 478. ACM Press, 2002. Wallach, D., & Scholz, S. (2012). User-centered design: Why and how to put users first in software development. In A. Maedche, A. Botzenhardt, & L. Neer (Eds.), Software for people— Fundamentals, trends and best practices (pp. 11–38). Berlin: Springer. 478 KOMPETENSI PENGETUA DAN PENGURUSAN PERUBAHAN DI SEKOLAH Kalithasan A/L Muniandy & M.Al-muzzammil Yasin ABSTRACT This research aims to investigate the competency of school leaders to bring change to the organization. The rapid changes in the Malaysian education system make headmasters claim to be leaders in the school to be sensitive to change. Headmasters also need to look at the needs of the school and plan changes appropriately. The ability of headmasters in bringing about change in schools provides an overview of the school’s ability to meet the challenges in the world of education today and meet the desire of the Ministry of Education. In addition, this article also suggests that the study will investigate the aspects of competence and change management using quantitative and qualitative approaches. The proposed study also expected to explain about some of the main things such as understanding of the principals on changes, challenges, and change strategies used by schools that have been successful. PENGENALAN Perubahan adalah realiti yang besar dalam kehidupan kontemporari yang berlaku pada kadar yang pantas (Westover, 2010). Perubahan 479 menjadikan sesuatu kelihatan baru dan mengubah sesuatu dari bentuk yang lama ke bentuk yang baru (Harris, 2007 dalam Ghavifekr, Afshari, Siraj, Zabidi & Razak 2012). Mengikut Sufean(2004) dalam Izham dan Norzaini (2009), perubahan mempunyai takrifan peralihan, anjakan, transformasi, inovasi, adaptasi, atau reformasi. Perubahan juga adalah tindakan mencipta sesuatu yang berbeza dari masa lalu (Rezvani, Dehkordi & Shamsollahi, 2012). Mengikut Lewis, Romanaggi dan Chapple (2010) perubahan adalah kemampuan menggerakkan warga sesebuah organisasi ke arah matlamat baru dengan kaedah baru melaksanakan perubahan. Mengikut Hall dan Hord (2001) dalam Evelyn dan Johnson (2007), perubahan adalah satu proses di mana individu dan organisasi bergerak secara beransur-ansur dalam memahami, menjadi mahir dan cekap dalam penggunaan kaedah baru. Daripada beberapa definisi di atas boleh dirumuskan bahawa perubahan merupakan keadaan yang lebih baik dan maju daripada keadaan sebelumnya. Dalam dunia dinamik hari ini, perubahan adalah komponen penting yang tidak boleh dielak dalam proses sosial masyarakat (Erlandson, 1980). Menurut Ghavifekr et al. (2012), sesebuah organisasi membangun dan mengembangkan budaya perubahan dan inovasi agar dapat meletakkan mereka dalam posisi yang dinamik dan berdaya saing. Kebanyakan program perubahan yang dirancang dan dilaksanakan membantu sesebuah organisasi menyesuaikannya secara signifikan dan memantapkan posisinya dalam dunia persaingan yang menjanjikan masa depan yang cerah (Kotter, 1996). Menurut Andreeva (2008), semua organisasi akan menghadapi keperluan akut untuk melakukan perubahan dalam organisasi dan ianya menjadi lebih topikal untuk organisasi yang sentiasa dicabar oleh persekitaran yang berubah dengan cepat dan dramatik. Mengikut Macfarland dan Goldsworthy (2014), perubahan memerlukan kesungguhan dan ianya penting untuk mencapai objektif perubahan. Kejayaan program perubahan bergantung pada usaha mengurus semua peringkat (Gokce, 2009) iaitu komitmen tinggi pihak pengurusan, budaya kerja sepasukan dan penglibatan 480 menyeluruh semua staf organisasi dalam proses perubahan dengan berkesan. Fisher (2005) menyatakan bahawa sesebuah organisasi hanya akan berubah apabila individu dalam organisasi berubah. Keinginan dan komitmen pihak yang terlibat dalam perubahan juga amat diperlukan agar dapat mencapai matlamat yang ditetapkan (Preston, 1999 dalam Mulinge& Munyae,2008). Cabaran pengurus organisasi hari ini adalah untuk belajar menangani perubahan dengan cara yang berkesan (Westover, 2010) dan mempunyai berkompetensi yang perlu dalam mengembangkan pemahaman dan apresiasi ahli dalam menggalakkan sokongan pekerja terhadap perubahan (Mulinge dan Munyae, 2008). Dalam dunia pendidikan perubahan membantu sekolah mencapai matlamat dengan efektif dengan menggantikan struktur program sedia ada dengan suatu yang lebih baik daripada sebelumnya(Izham, Hamzah & Norzaini, 2009). Ini sesuai dengan peranan sekolah sebagai organisasi pendidikan yang merealisasikan dasar-dasar negara. Pendidikan perlu bertindak balas kepada keadaan dan peristiwa yang berlaku dalam masyarakat dengan berkembang mantap dan menyesuaikan keadaannya kepada perubahan dalaman dan luaran (Blanford, 2010). Dalam konteks organisasi sekolah, apa sahaja perubahan yang dirancang akan memberi kesan kepada pihak yang terlibat termasuklah pihak pengurusan, guru, staf sokongan, pelajar dan masyarakat. Oleh itu perubahan dan inovasi yang hendak dilaksanakan perlulah dilakukan dengan bijaksana, melalui kerjasama antara pemimpin dengan rakan sejawatan atau stafnya (Hall &Hord, 1986). Pengurus perubahan dalam konteks sekolah iaitu pengetua berperanan besar dalam mengurus perubahan di sesebuah organisasi sekolah. Pengetua memiliki kedudukan yang sangat penting dalam sistem pendidikan sebagai pengurus perubahan (Gokce, 2009). Pengetua hendaklah bersedia membincangkan perubahan dari aspek kelebihan, kebaikan, keperluan dan pengetahuan yang harus dimiliki untuk membudayakan perubahan di sekolah (Jameela dan Jainabee, 2013). Pengetua sebagai pengurus atau pemimpin sekolah hendaklah memantapkan diri 481 dengan pengetahuan dan kompetensi menghadapi cabaran dunia pendidikan. Menurut Amin (2008), terdapat kompetensi khusus yang perlu dipunyai oleh pengetua dalam memastikan kecemerlangan pemimpin dalam melakukan perubahan. Kompetensi adalah pengetahuan dan kemahiran yang diperlukan oleh seseorang individu dalam menjalankan tugas dengan jayanya dalam konteks tertentu (Conger & Kanungo, 1988) dan kompetensi penting dalam memastikan proses tranformasi tidak ke luar kawalan (Kotter, 1996). Standard Kompetensi Kepengetuaan Sekolah Malaysia(SKKSM) adalah panduan piawaian kompetensi yang ditetapkan yang perlu ada pada pentadbir sekolah (Institut Aminuddin Baki, 2005). SKKSM diharapkan dapat membantu pemimpin sekolah dalam melaksanakan perubahan agar mencapai status Sekolah Berprestasi Tinggi (SBT). SKKSM menekankan penyediaan kepimpinan pendidikan bagi meningkatkan prestasi sekolah secara keseluruhan berlandaskan sembilan bidang utama yang telah dikenalpasti. SKKSM diharapkan mampu meningkatkan kompetensi pengetua sekolah sebagai pengurus perubahan yang berhadapan dengan pelbagai perubahan dalam bidang pendidikan terutamanya selepas pengenalan Bidang Keberhasilan Utama Nasional (NKRA) pada tahun 2009.Dalam Enam Bidang Keberhasilan Negara (NKRA) yang diperkenalkan perkara utama berkaitan pendidikan yang dinyatakan ialah tentang memperluaskan akses pendidikan yang berkualiti dan berkemampuan (NKRA, 2012). Selaras dengan keperluan untuk mencapai NKRA, Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia telah melancarkan Pelan Pembangunan Pendidikan (PPPM) 2013-2015 untuk memastikan keberkesanan transformasi sistem pendidikan Negara (KPM, 2012). Dengan adanya dokumen ini, peranan sekolah menjadi lebih mencabar. Banyak agenda penting perlu dibawa dan direalisasikan dalam pengurusan sekolah. Pengetua harus bersedia dan bertanggungjawab membudayakan perubahan supaya sekolah sama-sama dapat bergerak seiring dengan globalisasi dunia (Jamelaa & Jainabee, 2013) termasuklah dalam mendepani hasrat PPPM yang telah ada. 482 PERNYATAAN MASALAH Halangan perubahan dianggap suatu isu yang kerap berlaku dalam pengurusan perubahan (Cummings & Worley, 2005; Senior & Swailes, 2010). Halangan perubahan tidak dapat dielakkan di mana ia ditunjukkan secara langsung atau tidak langsung (Marshall & Conner, 2000). Halangan untuk berubah kerap menjadi cabaran utama sesebuah organisasi menjadi tidak efektif dan menjejaskan peluang untuk bertahan dalam persaingan (Pierce, Gardner &Dunham, 2002). Kebanyakan program perubahan yang diumumkan di peringkat sekolah menemui kegagalan (Metwally, 2012)kerana wujud pelbagai halangan yang mengakibatkan pengurusan perubahan mengalami disrupsi atau gangguan yang tidak diduga. Menurut Blanford (2010), sesetengah staf berasa ghairah apabila program perubahan diumumkan sementara yang lain melihatnya sebagai ancaman. Perubahan adalah faktor yang menjadi perkara yang ditentang kuat oleh individu dalam organisasi (Heera Singh, 2013), kerana individu dalam organisasi sekolah berasa takut kehilangan kuasa, autonomi, kedudukan, kebebasan dan keselesaan yang sedia ada yang dimiliki (Yue, 2008). Tidak semua warga organisasi menginginkan perubahan kerana dianggap ia akan mengundang ketidakpuasan. Mengikut Sweet dan Heritage (2010), kebanyakan pekerja berwaspada dan berasa curiga akan perubahan yang dilakukan oleh pemimpin. Prospek perubahan menakutkan kebanyakan orang dalam organisasi sama ada ia realistik atau tidak dan ia kerap menyebabkan gangguan dalam organisasi apabila sesuatu perubahan diumumkan (Westover, 2010). Ketiadaan komitmen daripada pasukan kerja menjadi cabaran atau halangan utama dalam pengurusan perubahan. Menurut Metwally (2012), salah satu faktor signifikan menyebabkan program perubahan gagal adalah kerana tiada komitmen daripada pasukan kerja. Rezwani (2012) dan Kotter (1996) mengutarakan isu bahawa sesebuah organisasi akan menghadapi pelbagai masalah dalam mengurus perubahan apabila berlakunya kelemahan dalam pasukan kerja. Menurut Roger Gill (2002) pula, cabaran 483 yang paling sukar dihadapi oleh pemimpin hari ini adalah untuk memastikan bahawa warga organisasi boleh menyesuaikan diri dengan perubahan. Warga sekolah tidak ingin berubah mungkin kerana tidak suka, tidak yakin, tidak mempercayai atau tidak menghormati pihak yang membawa perubahan (Kotter & Schlesinger, 2010). Isu ini dihebatkan dengan norma kumpulan yang teguh atau strong group norm yang selalunya menggalakkan rintangan atau halangan untuk berubah (Pierce, Gardner & Dunham, 2002). Menurut Isett, Glied, Sparer dan Brown (2012), salah satu cara melaksanakan perubahan dalam organisasi adalah menyuburkan sokongan terhadap perubahan yang dapat diwujudkan dengan adanya pasukan kerja yang mempromosikan perubahan dan merekrut pekerja bawahan yang lain. Kegagalan membentuk kumpulan pekerja atau pasukan kerja yang efisien dalam proses perubahan menyebabkan sesuatu organisasi kurang berjaya (Kotter, 2007). Kegagalan pengurusan perubahan mungkin disebabkan oleh tindakan pengetua yang terlalu menumpukan kandungan perubahan berbanding proses atau komponen perubahan yang harus dikaji dan dirancang teliti sebelum diaplikasikan dan isu ini dapat dibuktikan dengan kewujudan banyak penyelidikan yang cenderung menekankan kandungan perubahan berbanding proses yang dilalui di mana perubahan dilakukan di sesebuah organisasi (Kuipers dalam Van der, 2013). Ahli teori pula beranggapan langkah pengurusan perubahan yang dikemukakan oleh mereka bagi semua organisasi dalam semua keadaan menyebabkan program perubahan gagal (Burns, 1996; Beer, Eisentat & Spector, 1990 dalam Andreeva, 2008). Langkah perubahan yang tidak sistematik menyebabkan program perubahan yang dibawa menemui kegagalan. Langkah-langkah perubahan yang digunakan di dalam sesebuah organisasi perlu dikenalpasti, dikaji dan diperbaiki agar dapat membawa hasil perubahan yang memberangsangkan. Mengikut Miranda (2014), kegagalan perubahan juga disebabkan oleh kelemahan komunikasi, masalah ego dalam organisasi, tiada keyakinan serta kurang kemahiran atau latihan 484 dan sebagainya. Komunikasi merupakan salah satu komponen penting dalam pengurusan perubahan (Kotter, 1996). Perbincangan Harkness (2010) dalam kajiannya menyebut bahawa komunikasi dalaman memainkan peranan penting dalam membantu seseorang pekerja menghadapi sesuatu perubahan. Beliau juga mendakwa kebanyakan komunikasi dalaman tidak dilaksanakan ketika pengurusan perubahan dijalankan. Kesannya, ketiadaan maklumat yang memuaskan dan ketidakfahaman terhadap perubahan, lalu menyebabkan ianya disalah tafsir dan bermacam-macam tingkah laku ke arah halangan perubahan akan wujud (Yue, 2008). Mengikut Kotter (1996), kebanyakan pengurus organisasi samada tidak membuat komunikasi, atau membuat komunikasi yang tidak efektif ketika menjalankan program perubahan dan kesalahan ini menyukarkan usaha memikat minda dan hati pekerjanya. Kesannya, mereka tidak mempercayai pengurus perubahan, maka segala perubahan yang dibawa akan diterima dengan negatif (Pierce, Gardner & Dunham, 2002). CADANGAN KAJIAN KOMPETENSI PENGETUA DAN PENGURUSAN PERUBAHAN DI SEKOLAH Berdasarkan perbincangan dan isu di atas penulis telah mengenalpasti beberapa persoalan kajian yang bersesuaian untuk kajian ini. Persoalan kajian tersebut adalah seperti yang di bawah: 1. Sejauhmanakah pengurus sekolah memahami kehendak NKRA dan PPPM? 2. Sejauhmanakah SKKSM membantu pengetua sekolah dalam membawa perubahan? 3. Apakah strategi pengetua sekolah dalam membawa perubahan? 4. Apakah halangan perubahan yang dihadapi oleh pengetua sekolah? 5. Bagaimanakah pengetua sekolah berprestasi tinggi berupaya menangani cabaran perubahan? 485 6. Adakah satu model perubahan yang bersesuaian dalam konteks pendidikan di Malaysia boleh dibangunkan untuk dijadikan rujukan kepada pemimpin di sekolah? Kajian dicadangkan untuk dilaksanakan di sekolah menengah termasuk yang sedang bergelut dalam perubahan dan juga sekolah yang telah berjaya melonjakkan ditahap yang disasarkan. Adalah dicadangkan pensampelan secara berperingkat (multi-stage) dan rawak kluster (cluster sampling) digunakan bagi memastikan perwakilan dalam data yang dikumpul. Kajian akan menggunakan kedua-dua pendekatan kualitatif dan kuantitatif memandangkan terdapat persoalan kajian (persoalan 3,4,5) yang memerlukan pendekatan kualitatif manakala yang lainnya (persoalan kajian 1,2,6) boleh dijawab melalui data kuantitatif. Antara cabaran yang mungkin dihadapi ialah untuk menerbitkan soalselidik yang sesuai bagi menguji kefahaman pengetua sekolah dalam memahami NKRA. Ini adalah kerana soal selidik tersebut berperanan sebagai ujian yang boleh mengukur kefahaman yang betul dan tidak betul dalam kalangan pemimpin sekolah. Soalselidik tersebut tentunya mempunyai item-item yang sukar diteka, bagi memastikan jawapan yang diterima adalah benar dan bukan tekaan (by chance). Selain itu dijangkakan pendekatan kualitatif yang pelbagai (temubual, dokumen analisis, pemerhatian dll) perlu digunakan untuk mengenalpasti strategi, halangan perubahan, dan cara pengetua menangani perubahan di sekolah. Penggunaan perisian seperi en-Vivo adalah dijangkakan dapat membantu pengkaji dalam menguruskan data yang banyak dan kaya. Data kuantitatif yang diperoleh akan diproses menggunakan IBM SPSS-AMOS Versi 21. Selain itu, cabaran seterusnya adalah untuk menggunakan dapatan kuantitatif dan kualitatif yang ada dalam mencadangkan model perubahan yang bersesuaian untuk digunakan dalam konteks sekolah di Malaysia. Adalah diharapkan model ini boleh mengambilkira lokasi, pencapaian, kekuatan sedia ada, dan tahap pencapaian perubahan sedia ada di sekolah. 486 KESIMPULAN Perubahan merupakan konsep yang penting dalam pengurusan organisasi kontemporari. Para pengetua memiliki tanggungjawab yang lebih siginifikan dalam melaksanakan perubahan di peringkat sekolah agar setiap sekolah di Malaysia diiktiraf sebagai sekolah berprestasi tinggi.Daripada kajian ini diharapkan pengkaji dapat mengenalpasti kefahaman dan cabaran yang dihadapi oleh pemimpin sekolah. Selain itu diharapkan model perubahan yang dapat terbaik dapat dihasilkan untuk digunakan oleh sekolah yang pelbagai latar belakang bagi memastikan perubahan dapat dilaksanakan dengan dengan jayanya bagi menggalas hasrat perubahan dalam pendidikan Negara. RUJUKAN Amin Senin, (2008). Kajian Kompetensi Berimpak Tinggi Bagi Pemimpin Sekolah.Kertas kerja dibentangkan di Seminar Pengurusan dan Kepimpinan Pendidikan Nasional ke 15, Institut Aminuddin Baki (IAB). Andreeva,T.E (2008). Can organizational change be planned and controlled? Evidence from Russian companies. Human Resource Development International, (11) 2, pp.119-34. Blandford , S. (2010). Panduan pengurus peringkat pertengahan di sekolah. Institut Terjemahan Negara Malaysia. Kuala Lumpur. Conger, J. & Kanungo, R.,(1988). The Empowerment Process: Integrating Theory and Practice. Academy of Management Review, (13) 3, pp.471-482. Cummings, T.G & Worley, C.G. (2005), Organization Development and Change, Thomson, Mason, OH. Erlandson, D.,A.(1980).An Organizing Strategy for Managing Change in the School. NASSP Bulletin. SAGE Publications. Evelyn ,M. & Johnson, M. (2007). Managing Organizational Change in an Educational Environment. VDM Verlag Publication. Fisher, J.M (2005). A Time For Change?. Human Resource Development International, 8:2, 257-263. 487 Ghavifekr,S., Afshari,M., Siraj,S., Ahmad Zabidi Bin Abdul Razak. (2013). Managing Change in Educational Organization. Malaysian Online Journal of Educational Management (MOJEM). Volume 1 (1): 10-23. Gokce,F.(2009). Behaviour of Turkish Elementary School Principals in the Change Process: An Analysis of the Perceptions of Both Teachers and School Principals. Educational Management Administration & Leadership, 37:198. Hall, G. E. & S. M. Hord. (1986). Change in Schools: Facilitating the Process. Albany, N.Y.:State University of New York Press. Harkness, J. (2010) Measuring the effectiveness of change – The role of internal communication in change management, Journal of Change Management, 1:1, 66-73. Heera Singh, (2013). Simple Steps to Leadership Excellence. Kuala Lumpur,Malaysia: HEERA Training and Management Consultancy Publication. Institut Aminuddin Baki, Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia. 2005. Amalan-amalan terbaik pengurusan dan kepimpinan sekolah menengah Malaysia. Genting Highlands: Institut Aminuddin Baki. Jamelaa Bibi Abdullah & Jainabee Md Kasim. (2013). Sikap terhadap perubahan dalam kalangan pengetua sekolah negeri Pahang dalam Prosiding Seminar Nasional Pengurusan dan Kepimpinan Pendidikan Ke-20, 2013, Institut Aminuddin Baki, Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia. Kimberly R. Isett, Sherry A.M. Glied, Michael S. Sparer & Lawrence D. Brown (2013) When Change Becomes Transformation , Public Management Review, 15:1, pp. 1-17. Kotter,J.P.(1996). Leading Change. Boston: Harvard Business School. Kotter,J.P.(2007). Leading Change: Why Transformation Efforts Fail, Harvard Business Review.pp. 96-103. Kotter,J.P. & Schlesinger L.A (2008). Choosing Strategies for Change, Harvard Business Review. pp. 1-11. Kuipers,B.S., Higgs, M.J., Kickert, W.J.M., Tummers, L.G., Grandia, J., Van der Voet, J. (2013). The management of change in public organizations: A literature review. Public Administration. Lewis,E., Romanaggi, D., & Chapple,A., (2010). Successfully 488 managing change during uncertain times, Strategic HR Review, Vol. 9 Iss: 2, pp.12 – 18. Marshall, J., & Conner, D.R. (2000). Another reason why companies resist change. Strategy and Business, 1, pp. 1-4. McFarland, W. & Goldsworthy,S. (2014). Choosing change: How leaders and organizations drive results one person at a time. New York: McGraw-Hill Education. Metwally.D (2012). Leadership and Managing Change Does Gender Make a Real Difference in Egypt? : The Business Review,Cambridge, Volume 19(2). Mohd Izham, Norzaini Azman (2009). Pandangan Pentadbir terhadap Implementasi Proses Perubahan Terancang pada sekolah Bestari di Malaysia. Sosiohumanika. Volume 2(1). Mulinge, M. M. & Munyae M. M. (2008). Managing Organizational Change in Higher Education: Lessons from the University of Botswana. Journal of African Business, 9 (1): 167190. Pelan Pembangunan Pendidikan Malaysia 2013-2025. (2012). Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia. Pierce, J.L., Gardner, D.G., and Dunham, R.B. (2002). Managing organizational change and development. Management and Organizational Behavior: An Integrated Perspective. Chapter 18: pp. 627-654. Cincinnati, OH: South-Western College Publishing. Rezvani,S., Dehkordi G.J., and Shamsollahi,A.(2012). Managing Strategic Change For Organizations. International Journal of Academic Research in Economics and Management Sciences.Volume 1(3). Roger Gill (2002). Change management - - or change leadership?, Journal of Change Management, 3:4, 307-318. Senior, B. & Swailes, S. (2010). Organizational Change, Pearson Education, Harlow. Sweet,T., Heritage,V. (2000). How managers gain commitment to change: Using a simple cultural questionnaire to involve people, Journal of Change Management, 1:2, 164-178. Westover J. H (2010). Managing Organizational Change: Change Agent Strategies and Techniques to Successfully Managing the Dynamics of Stability and Change in Organizations: The International Journal of Management and Innovation. 2(1), 45- 489 50. Yue,W. (2008). Resistance, Echo of Change: International Journal of Business and Management. Vol. 3, (2) pp.84-89. 490 MENGKAJI KEMAHIRAN BERFIKIR KRITIS DAN PENCAPAIAN PELAJAR MENERUSI PERSEKITARAN PEMBELAJARAN KOLABORATIF BERBANTUKAN KOMPUTER BAGI SUBJEK BAHASA PENGATURCARAAN Siti Mastura Baharudin & Jamalludin Harun ABSTRAK Pelajar yang mengikuti subjek bahasa pengaturcaraan didapati tidak memahami bagaimana untuk mengaplikasikan pembelajaran yang diperolehi kepada permasalahan dunia sebenar. Masalah ini adalah disebabkan oleh tahap kemahiran berfikir pelajar yang dilaporkan masih rendah terutamanya kemahiran berfikir kritis dikalangan pelajar. Malah, kemahiran berfikir kritis pelajar didapati akan lebih tinggi apabila pelajar bersikap aktif semasa pembelajaran dan berinteraksi sesama ahli kumpulan. Oleh itu, kajian ini adalah bertujuan untuk mengkaji tahap pencapaian dan tahap kemahiran berfikir kritis pelajar bagi subjek bahasa pengaturcaraan melalui persekitaran pembelajaran kolaboratif 491 berbantukan komputer yang dibina berdasarkan ciri-ciri pembelajaran kolaboratif dan interaksi berkesan. Malah, strategi pembelajaran berasaskan masalah digunakan sebagai prinsip pembangunan aktiviti pembelajaran memandangkan ciri utama strategi pembelajaran berasaskan masalah adalah aktiviti pembelajaran yang menggunakan dan dimulakan dengan permasalahan dunia sebenar. Kajian ini dibangunkan berdasarkan lima tahap di dalam model ADDIE dan disusun mengikut tiga peringkat kajian dimana pengkaji mendapatkan ciri-ciri persekitaran pembelajaran yang digemari oleh pelajar berdasarkan ciri-ciri pembelajaran kolaboratif dan interaksi berkesan. Seterusnya, persekitaran pembelajaran dibangunkan berdasarkan ciri-ciri kolaboratif berbantukan komputer dan pembelajaran berasaskan masalah. Akhirnya, persekitaran pembelajaran digunakan oleh pelajar bagi menguji kesannya terhadap pencapaian pelajar dan kemahiran berfikir kritis mereka. Hasil dapatan daripada kajian ini akan menentukan kesan daripada persekitaran pembelajaran yang dibina terhadap pencapaian pembelajaran dan kemahiran berfikir kritis mereka. Kata Kunci: Pembelajaran Berasaskan Masalah; Pembelajaran Kolaboratif Berbantukan Komputer; Interaksi; Bahasa Pengaturcaraan PENGENALAN Ciri-ciri sistem pendidikan konvensional adalah lebih berorientasikan guru dan isi kandungan. Para pelajar pula hanya menerima maklumat daripada guru secara teori dan kemudiannya mengaplikasikan pengetahuan yang diperolehi semasa menjawab soalan peperiksaan (Ryan, Carlton & Ali, 1999).Dengan kaedah pengajaran dan pembelajaran (P & P) konvensional sebegini, pelajar tidak berpeluang untuk mengaplikasikan pengetahuan yang dipelajari di dalam bilik darjah terhadap situasi dunia pekerjaan sebenar (de Villiers & Queiro, 2003). Hal ini merupakan satu 492 masalah yang harus ditangani terutamanya apabila melibatkan pelajaran atau kursus yang memerlukan pelajar untuk melakukan aktiviti amali dimana ia memerlukan mereka untuk mempraktikkan pengetahuan yang mereka pelajari semasa di universiti ke dalam alam pekerjaan. Malah pelajar akan terbiasa dengan sistem pendidikan berorientasikan guru yang akhirnya menjadikan mereka malas mencari maklumat dan pengetahuan sendiri dan asyik mengharapkan pengetahuan yang diberikan oleh guru. Situasi ini akhirnya menghasilkan graduan yang kurang berdaya saing dan malas (Pucel & Stertz, 2005 dan Regueras et. al, 2009). Malah tanpa disedari, akibat daripada P&P konvensional yang berorientasikan isi kandungan dan peperiksaan ini juga akan menghasilkan para graduan yang kurang kemahiran generik yang amat diperlukan dalam pasaran kerja masa kini. Tanpa kita sedari graduan yang terhasil daripada P&P konvensional adalah lebih bersifat tertumpu kepada isi kandungan dan peperiksaan. Keadaan ini seterusnya akan menyebabkan proses pembelajaran yang membentuk kemahiran berinteraksi dan berkolaborasi di antara pelajar terabai walaupun ia seharusnya diberi penekanan (Lee & Tsai, 2011). Akhirnya ini akan membentuk pelajar yang mementingkan diri sendiri dan kurang berkolaborasi bagi berkongsi ilmu pengetahuan. Oleh itu, seharusnya dalam P&P terdapat suntikan proses yang mampu mengasah kemahiran pelajar dalam berinteraksi dan berkolaborasi sesama mereka bagi menjana pengetahuan mereka sendiri. Menurut Kreijns, Kirschner & Jochems (2003), telah terbukti kemahiran berinteraksi dan berkolaborasi sesama pelajar mampu meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir pelajar semasa proses pembelajaran berlangsung. Oleh itu, dengan terdapatnya kemudahan teknologi yang semakin berkembang dengan pantas ia mampu merubah situasi P&P konvensional. Perubahan teknologi yang pesat juga menandakan akan terdapatnya perubahan terhadap proses P&P. Menurut Abraham (2007), teknologi mampu mengubah cara penyampaian pengetahuan kepada pelajar malah mampu mengubah bentuk interaksi sesama pelajar dan guru semasa proses P&P berlangsung. Malah ia membuka ruang yang lebih luas bagi 493 pelajar berinteraksi dan berkolaborasi dalam berkongsi pengetahuan seterusnya memberi peluang kepada pelajar bagi meneroka kebolehan mereka sendiri dalam menyelesaikan setiap permasalahan yang timbul semasa proses P&P tersebut. Dengan ini, pelajar mampu mendidik diri mereka untuk lebih berdaya saing dan mampu berdikari dalam mencari penyelesaian kepada setiap permasalahan yang diberikan dengan bantuan yang minimum daripada guru (Abraham, 2007 dan Klaus, 2002). MASALAH PEMBELAJARAN BAGI KURSUS BAHASA PENGATURCARAAN Mengikut laporan kajian yang lepas, pelajar yang mengikuti pembelajaran bahasa pengaturcaraan tidak benar-benar memahami bagaimana untuk mengaplikasikan apa yang mereka pelajari di dalam kelas kepada permasalahan dunia sebenar (Moura & van Hattum-Janssen, 2011). Oleh itu, adalah menjadi kebiasaan sekiranya terdapat pelajar yang gagal melihat kegunaan apa yang mereka pelajari semasa di dalam kelas seterusnya mengakibatkan pelajar kurang berminat dengan kursus ini. Situasi ini akhirnya mengakibatkan peningkatan peratusan kegagalan bagi kursus ini. Barak et. al., (2007) menyatakan bahawa kebanyakan pelajar di institusi pengajian tinggi yang mengikuti kursus bahasa pengaturcaraan kebanyakkannya sekadar menghadiri pembelajaran di dalam kelas dan menduduki peperiksaan hanya untuk lulus dan tidak benar-benar berminat untuk mendalami kursus tersebut. Seharusnya kaedah P&P bagi kursus bahasa pengaturcaraan menekankan hubungkait di antara teori dan amali seterusnya mengaplikasikan kepada permasalahan yang lebih kompleks (Kay et. al., 2000). Aplikasi kepada permasalahan dunia sebenar adalah penting bagi pelajar memahami hubungkait pembelajaran yang di pelajari dalam kelas dengan dunia sebenar (Nuutila, Torma & Malmi, 2005). Oleh itu, penyelidik mula melihat potensi teori pembelajaran konstruktivisme yang menggalakkan pembelajaran aktif sebagai 494 satu potensi besar dalam membantu P & P bagi kursus bahasa pengaturcaraan. Pelajar didapati belajar dengan lebih baik apabila mereka terlibat secara aktif dalam mengeksplorasi, menterjemah dan membina pengetahuan daripada pelbagai sumber yang diperolehi. Malah, peranan laman web dalam membantu pembelajaran aktif pelajar juga turut menyumbang kepada pembangunan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi mereka (Koohang, 2004 dan Kirkwood, 2000). Oleh itu, laman web yang dibina bagi menyokong pembelajaran mereka seharusnya mambantu pelajar dalam meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi. KEMAHIRAN BERFIKIR KRITIS Kemahiran berfikir kritis telah menjadi fokus dikalangan ahli falsafah, penyelidik dan pendidik sejak dahulu lagi. Hager et. al., (2003) menyatakan bahawa untuk berfikir secara kritis dalam semua bidang bermakna seseorang harus mengambil keputusan dan apa yang harus dipercaya dan lakukan menggunakan pemikiran reflektif bagi menunjukkan kebolehan dan ciri-ciri kemahiran berfikir kritis. Para pengkaji dalam bidang pendidikan lebih mendalam dalam mendefinisikan kemahiran berfikir kritis, dimana mereka membenarkan guru membuat keputusan bila masanya dan kenapa untuk mengajar dan menekankan kemahiran tertentu. Terdapat dua fahaman dalam mengajarkan dan menekankan kemahiran berfikir kritis yang terdapat dalam kajian lepas di dalam bidang pendidikan. Fahaman yang pertama ialah apabila kemahiran berfikir kritis dianggap sebagai kemahiran generic dimana ia bermula oleh Ennis (1996), Davidson & Dunham (1997)yang mengatakan bahawa kemahiran berfikir kritis adalah sesuatu konsep yang boleh diuji secara eksperimen dan diajar di sekolah. Manakala fahaman yang kedua pula menganggap kemahiran berfikir kritis sebagai subject specific dimana ia bermula daripada Atkinson (1997) dimana beliau menganggap kemahiran berfikir kritis adalah konsep yang kurang jelas dan lebih 495 spesifik kepada subjek tanpa melibatkan pengujian secara eksperimen yang wujud secara terselindung semasa perlakuan sosial. Walaupun terdapat kurang persamaan di dalam mendefinisikan kemahiran berfikir kritis, kajian kini menunjukkan bahawa kemahiran berfikir kritis boleh diuji dan dan diukur. Penyelidik telah mencadangkan pelbagai senarai aspek kemahiran berfikir kritis yang mencapai satu tahap persamaan kemahiran di antara kesemua definisi iaitu: mencari sebab, menganalisa hujah dan menilai kebenaran sesuatu sumber. Semua kemahiran ini adalah sangat penting bagi pelajar untuk berjaya pada peringkat pengajian tinggi. Hasil kajian Garrison, Anderson & Archer (2001) pula telah membangunkan satu instrument bagi mengukur ciri-ciri dan kualiti perbualan yang kritikal dalam talian. Fokus kajian ini adalah bagi mengkaji ciri-ciri interaktif bagi kemahiran berfikir kritis melalui model Practical Induiry yang dibangunkan. Model Practical Inquiry ini mempunyai empat fasa iaitu: pencetusan peristiwa, eksplorasi, integrasi dan resolusi. Pada fasa pertama iaitu pencetusan peristiwa dilemma atau timbulnya isu yang dikenalpasti atau dikenali melalui pengalaman. Fasa kedua adalah fasa eksplorasi dimana ia menggalakkan perubahan daripada ruang privasi dan perkongsian dimana di antara refleksi kritikal dan perbualan. Fasa ketiga adalah fasa inteagrasi yang melibatkan proses memahami maklumat. Fasa terakhir adalah fasa resolusi dimana dalam fasa ini terjadinya aplikasi penyelesaian kepada masalah. Namun, untuk memastikan pelajar menguasai kemahiran berfikir kritis, sesuatu persekitaran pembelajaran haruslah dilengkapi dengan aktiviti pembelajaran dan kemudahan pembelajaran yang bersesuaian dan terbukti berkesan. Oleh itu, bagi kajian ini, penyelidik akan menggabungkan beberapa strategi pembelajaran seperti pembelajaran berasaskan masalah dan pembelajaran kolaboratif. Kedua-dua strategi pembelajaran ini, menekankan pembelajaran aktif seperti yang dicadangkan oleh teori konstruktivisme. 496 PEMBELAJARAN BERASASKAN MASALAH Pembelajaran berasaskan masalah adalah strategi pembelajaran yang bermaksud untuk pelajar bekerja dalam kumpulan kecil dan bekerjasama untuk menyelesaikan masalah. Mereka akan membincangkan punca masalah tersebut, membina hipotesis dan strategi, mencari maklumat untuk menyelesaikan masalah, mengkaji penyelesaian dan mencapai kesimpulan. Semasa proses menyelesaikan masalah, pelajar akan membina kemahiran seperti kemahiran berfikir kritis, kemahiran menyelesaikan masalah, kemahiran membuat keputusan, kemahiran berkomunikasi dan seterusnya membina pengetahuan yang ingin dicapai Hmelo-Silver & Barrows (2006). Pembelajaran berasaskan masalah merupakan salah satu strategi pembelajaran yang menjurus ke arah pendidikan profesional.Ia telah diperkenalkan oleh penyelidik dalam bidang profesional termasuk perubatan, kejururawatan, pergigian, kerja sosial, pengurusan, kejuruteraan dan senibina. Pembelajaran berasaskan masalah adalah pendekatan pembelajaran di bawah teori konstruktivisme (Harper-Marinick, 2001) yang menekankan kepada proses penyelesaian masalah bagi konteks dunia sebenar. Terdapat peningkatan dalam bilangan institusi dan program yang mengadaptasikan strategi pembelajaran berasaskan masalah.Namun Hmelo-Silver & Barrows (2006) menyatakan, dalam pendekatan pembelajaran berasaskan masalah, dimana pembelajaran kendiri diutamakan, pelajar dilatih untuk mencari sendiri penyelesaian bagi sesuatu masalah. Proses penyelesaian masalah ini akan menggalakkan pelajar untuk berfikir cara untuk menyelesaikan masalah tersebut pada masa yang sama mereka juga akan memperolehi pengetahuan ketika proses mencari maklumat itu berlaku (Alvarstein & Johannesen, 2001). Pembangunan strategi pembelajaran berasaskan masalah didapati memberikan impak yang besar kepada penyelidikan berkaitan sains kognitif (Herrington & Herrington, 1998). Tetapi apabila strategi pembelajaran berasaskan masalah diadaptasikan kepada bidang lain, strategi pembelajaran berasaskan masalah telah 497 dikembangkan untuk di gabungkan dengan teori yang menekankan kepada aspek pengajaran dan pembelajaran. Dolmans and Schmidt (2000) menyatakan bahawa pembelajaran berasaskan masalah dapat membantu pelajar untuk membina model kognitif yang berkesan dimana permasalahan dikemukakan kepada mereka. Engel (1991) pula berpendapat bahawa strategi pembelajaran berasaskan masalah yang diadaptasi kedalam pendidikan profesional bermatlamat bagi membantu pelajar membina kemahiran tertentu yang berguna bagi membantu mereka bagi pekerjaan mereka.Oleh itu, strategi pembelajaran ini perlu digabungkan dengan beberapa ciri instruksi bagi meningkatkan keberkesanannya. PEMBELAJARAN KOMPUTER KOLABORATIF BERBANTUKAN Persoalan tentang cara untuk mengaplikasikan kemudahan teknologi dalam menambahbaik proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran masih menjadi isu yang kritikal dalam kajian berkenaan bidang teknologi pendidikan. Asalnya, banyak kajian ini bertujuan menambahbaik proses pembelajaran oleh setiap pelajar secara mengaplikasikan ilmu pengetahuan yang diperoleh melalui kaedah latih tubi dan melalui penggunaan perisian komputer. Pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer merupakan model pembelajaran yang berasaskan pembelajaran pembentukan dan sosial) yang mana kaedah pembelajaran dipermudahkan dengan menggunakan teknologi sebagai medium. Secara umumnya, pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer boleh didefinisikan sebagai satu modul pembelajaran baru yang terhasil daripada kombinasi aplikasi kemudahan teknologi dan modul pembelajaran kolabroratif yang menyediakan persekitaran pembelajaran yang memberi galakan kepada para pelajar untuk bergaul dan berinteraksi sesama mereka dan secara tidak langsung dapat membantu perkembangan yang baik dalam proses pembelajaran. Teknologi juga boleh digunakan sebagai perantara 498 komunikasi secara synchronous dan asynchronous bagi menyokong modul ini dengan menyediakan satu ruang perkongsian di mana setiap kegiatan dan minat pelajar dapat dipantau. Pada masa yang sama juga, ia digunakan sebagai tapak untuk membentangkan perbincangan kepada penyelesaian berkenaan permasalahan yang timbul. Malah, ia turut berfungsi sebagai medium untuk menyalurkan maklumat yang baru kepada pelajar (Koschmann, 1999). INTERAKSI BERKESAN DALAM PEMBELAJARAN Pembelajaran dalam kumpulan kecil telah dikaji dengan mendalam dan faktor interaksi telah menjadi isu utama dalam pembelajaran secara berkumpulan yang melibatkan aspek sosial.Pendekatan untuk mengkaji bagaimana keberkesanan interaksi dalam meningkatkan pencapaian dan kemahiran berfikir pelajar dibina dan sering ditingkatkan terutamanya dalam pembelajaran kolaboratif dan pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer. Walaubagaimanapun, fokus utama kajian yang terdapat sehingga kini lebih tertumpu kepada kualiti produk pembelajaran dan pencapaian individu, namun sangat sedikit kajian yang menumpukan kepada proses dan aktiviti pembelajaran kolaboratif dan interaksi yang berkesan. Strijbos, Martens & Jochems (2004) telah menjalankan kajian untuk meningkatkan keberkesanan terhadap pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer yang melihat dari sudut proses interaksi dalam pembelajaran itu sendiri. Telah diketahui bahawa pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer tidak menjanjikan keberkesanan terhadap semua ahli kumpulan namun, ia merupakan persekitaran yang mampu menyokong penyertaan dan interaksi antara pelajar dengan pelajar dan di laporkan merupakan mampu meningkatkan kemahiran pelajar. Fokus kajian ini adalah merupakan pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer yang memberi tumpuan kepada faktor interaksi di antara pelajar dengan pelajar dalam meningkatkan keberkesanan pembelajaran dan kemahiran berfikir 499 kritis pelajar. Pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer memberi maklumat yang banyak terhadap sosio-psikologi pelajar yang bekerja secara berkumpulan, strategi pembelajaran yang digunakan dan kemahiran yang diperolehi melalui persekitaran ini. Namun malangnya, kesemua kebaikan ini tidak diperolehi oleh medium pembelajaran lain (Henri, 1992). Pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer walaubagaimanapun menetapkan bahawa pencapaian seseorang pelajar bergantung juga kepada pencapaian pelajar lain dalam kumpulan yang sama. Dalam kajian ini pula mengkaji bentuk interaksi antara pelajar dengan pelajar dalam meningkatkan kemahiran berfikir kritis dan pencapaian pelajar dalam pembelajaran. Menurut Gunawardena, Lowe & Anderson (1997), interaksi adalah proses dimana perbincangan makna dan pembinaan pengetahuan berlaku. Menurut mereka interaksi berlaku apabila terdapat mesej yang mendapat maklum balas dan berhubung di antara satu sama lain. Mereka berpendapat bahawa interaksi adalah apabila setiap ahli kumpulan menyumbangkan sesuatu maklumat, dan kemudiannya kesemua maklumat tersebut di gabungkan dan akan menghasilkan pembelajaran itu sendiri (contoh: kemahiran berfikir kritis, pencapaian pelajar, kemahiran menulis dan sebagainya). KERANGKA KAJIAN Kerangka kajian ini telah memadankan beberapa idea bagi membentuk keseluruhan kajian. Kerangka kajian ini adalah mengikut susunan peringkat kajian ini yang mana dibahagikan kepada tiga peringkat kajian. Peringkat Kajian Pertama Sebelum membangunkan persekitaran pembelajaran ini, penyelidik perlu mendapatkan ciri-ciri kolaboratif dan interaksi berkesan bagi 500 proses merekabentuk dan membangunkan persekitaran pembelajaran tersebut. Tiga ciri-ciri pembelajaran kolaboratif yang ditekankan dalam persekitaran pembelajaran ini adalah yang telah dicadangkan oleh Kirschner (2001) iaitu: pelajar bertanggungjawab terhadap proses pembelajaran mereka sendiri, pelajar dirangsang untuk membuat refleksi kendiri dan pelajar adalah bersifat aktif semasa pembelajaran dan dua ciri-ciri pembelajaran kolaboratif yang dicadangkan oleh Johnson & Johnson (1994) iaitu: pelajar belajar dalam kumpulan kecil dan pelajar bekerjasama dan membantu antara satu sama lain untuk mencapai satu tujuan yang sama. Bagi meningkatkan keberkesanan pembelajaran kolaboratif, aspek interaksi berkesan juga harus diberi penekanan dan tiga ciriciri interaksi berkesan untuk diaplikasikan ke dalam kajian ini dicadangkan oleh Johnson & Johnson (1996) iaitu: pelajar memberi maklum balas antara satu sama lain, pelajar bertukartukar sumber seperti maklumat dan bahan-bahan kepada antara satu sama lain dan pelajar memberi bantuan dan tunjuk ajar kepada antara satu sama lain. Peringkat Kajian Kedua Strategi pembelajaran pembelajaran berasaskan masalah ini digunakan sebagai prinsip kepada aktiviti pembelajaran semasa proses pembelajaran dijalankan. Oleh itu, penyelidik akan mengaplikasikan lima prinsip pembelajaran pembelajaran berasaskan masalah yang dicadangkan oleh de Graaff & Kolmos (2003) iaitu: masalah merupakan titik tolak dalam proses pembelajaran, pembelajaran adalah berpusatkan pelajar dan guru hanya memberi panduan untuk menyelesaikan masalah yang diberikan, guru harus kreatif dalam memberi masalah yang bersesuaian dengan topik yang di ajar, pelajar menggunakan pengalaman yang sedia ada semasa proses pembelajaran dan aktiviti-aktiviti semasa pembelajaran merupakan asas kepada proses pembelajaran. 501 Kemudian, seperti yang dinyatakan oleh Gress & Hadwin (2010) pembelajaran dalam talian dapat membantu meningkatkan keberkesanan pembelajaran kolaboratif. Oleh itu, setelah menggabungkan kesemua ciri-ciri dan prinsip di atas, penyelidik akan mengaplikasikan pula ciri-ciri kontekstual yang meningkatkan keberkesanan persekitaran pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer seperti yang telah dicadangkan oleh kajian lepas. Ciri-ciri persekitaran pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer yang diaplikasikan oleh kajian ini adalah daripada Lee (2010): saiz kumpulan ditetapkan kepada empat orang satu kumpulan, peranan instruktor dimana pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer memerlukan instruktor bagi memantau perjalanan pembelajaran pelajar (Garrison, Anderson & Archer, 2001), ciri-ciri tugasan yang berbentuk aplikasi, menggunakan penilaian semasa pembelajaran memberikan kesan positif terhadap penyertaan pelajar dalam pembelajaran kolaboratif. Oliver & Shaw (2004), bahawa ciri-ciri yang digemari pelajar dalam suasana pembelajaran mempengaruhi penyertaan mereka semasa pembelajaran (Ragoonaden & Bordeleau, 2000) dan pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer, penyertaan pelajar adalah dibantu dengan teknologi yang dibawa oleh komputer (Heckman & Annabi, 2003). Peringkat Kajian Ketiga Bagi menguji keberkesanan persekitaran pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer yang telah dibangunkan ini, penyelidik akan menguji melalui dua kaedah. Kaedah pertama ialah dengan memberi ujian pra dan ujian pasca kepada pelajar. Kaedah kedua ialah dengan mengukur tahap kemahiran berfikir kritis pelajar. Terdapat beberapa model berfikir secara kritis dalam kajian lepas dan Model Practical Inquiry oleh Garrison, Anderson & Archer (2001) telah dipilih bagi kajian ini. Model ini dipilih kerana ianya menumpukan kepada menguji kemahiran berfikir atas talian di dalam suasana pembelajaran berkumpulan. Oleh kerana kajian 502 ini menumpukan kepada pembelajan kolaboratif, maka model ini amat bersesuaian. Kerangka bagi kajian ini disertakan dalam Rajah 1. Rajah 1: Kerangka Kajian IMPLIKASI Dapatan daripada kajian ini akan membantu instruktor melaksanakan pengajaran dan pembelajaran kursus bahasa pengaturcaraan yang lebih berkesan melalui pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer yang digabungkan dengan ciriciri pembelajaran berasaskan masalah, pembelajaran kolaboratif dan interaksi berkesan. Malah, kajian ini akan menyediakan 503 panduan kepada instruktor dalam mereka bentuk pembelajaran yang lebih efektif dalam meningkatkan lagi keberkesanan pembelajaran. Pada masa yang sama, instruktor boleh memantau penyertaan pelajar sepanjang pembelajaran berlangsung dan membantu mereka dalam peningkatan kemahiran berfikir kritis mereka. Dengan ini, persekitaran pembelajaran yang dibangunkan akan lebih dimanfaatkan bagi membantu pencapaian pelajar dan juga kemahiran berfikir kritis mereka. KESIMPULAN Walaupun terdapat banyak kajian berkaitan kemahiran berfikir pelajar terutamanya kemahiran berfikir kritis.Namun, pembelajaran dalam talian merupakan medium yang terbaik dalam mengendalikan pembelajaran bagi bahasa pengaturcaraan. Interaksi berkesan diantara pelajar dan juga persekiataran pembelajaran yang disediakan akan membantu pembelajaran pelajar. Oleh itu, kajian ini memfokuskan kepada ciri pembelajaran kolaboratif berbantukan komputer yang disokong oleh ciri pembelajaran berasaskan masalah dan ciri kolaboratif dan interaksi berkesan. RUJUKAN Abraham, A. (2007). Adopting a student-centred pedagogy in the teaching of accounting to engineering students: Comparing a blended learning approach with a traditional approach. In ICT: Providingchoices for learners and learning. Proceedings ascilite Singapore2007. http://www.ascilite.org.au/conferences/singapore07/procs/abraha m.pdf. Alvarstein, V., & Johannesen, L. K. (2001).Problem-Based Learning Approach in Teaching Lower Level Logistics and Transportation.International Journal of Physical Distribution & Logistics Management, 31(7/8), 557-573. 504 Atkinson, D. (1997). A Critical Approach to Critical Thinking.TESOL Quarterly, 31 (1), 71-94. Barak, M., Harward, J., Kocur, G., & Lerman, S. (2007). Transforming an introductory programming course: from lectures to active learning via wireless laptops.Journal of Science Education and Technology, 16 (4), 325–336. Davidson, B., & Dunham, R. (1997). Assessing EFL student progress in critical thinking with the Ennis-Weir Critical Thinking Essay Test. JALT Journal, 19(1), 43-57. de Graaff, E. & Kolmos, A. (2003). Characteristics of Problem-Based Learning.International Journal of Engineering Education. 19 (5), 657-662. de Villiers, M. R. & Queiro, Q. R. (2003). Real-world problem-based learning: a case study evaluated. South African Journal of Higher Education.Vol. 17 (No. 1). Pg 112-122. Dolmans, D. and Schmidt, H. (2000) What directs self-directed learning in a problem based curriculum? In Evenson, D. and Hmelo, C. (eds) Problem Based Learning: A research perspective on learning Interactions. Mahwah, New Jersey: Lawrence Earlbaum Associates, 251–262. Ennis, R. H. (1996). Critical thinking dispositions: Their nature and assessability. Informal Logic, 18, 2 & 3, 165-182. Garrison, D. R., Anderson, T. and Archer, W. (2001). Critical thinking, cognitive presence, and computer conferencing in distance education. American Journal of Distance Education.(15:1) pp. 723. Gress, C. L. Z., & Hadwin, A. F. (2010). Advancing educational research on collaboration through the use of gStudy computer-supported collaborative learning (CSCL) tools: Introduction to special issue. Computers in Human Behavior, 26, 785-786. Gunawardena, C., Lowe, C., and Anderson, T. (1997).Analysis of a global online debate and the development of an interaction analysis model for examining social construction of knowledge in computer conferencing.Journal of Educational Computing Research 17(4), 395 – 429. Hager, P., Sleet, R., Logan, P. & Hooper, M. (2003).Teaching critical thinking in undergraduate science courses.Science and Education, 12(3), 303-313. Harper-Marinick, M. (2001).Engaging students in Problem-Based 505 Learning.Maricopa Center for Learning and instruction. http://www.mcli.dist.maricopa.edu/forum/spr01/t11.html Heckman, R. and Annabi, H. (2003) A Content Analytic Comparison of FTF and ALN Case-Study Discussions. Proceedings of the 36th Hawaii International Conference on System Science. Available from http://citeseerx.ist.psu.edu Henri, F. (1992).Computer conferencing and content analysis.In A.R. Kaye (Ed).Collaborative learning through computer conferencing: The Najaden papers, 117-136. Berlin: SpringerVerlag. Herrington, J., & Herrington, A. (1998). Authentic assessment and multimedia: How university students respond to a model of authentic assessment. Higher Education Research and Development, 17 (3), 305-22. Hmelo-Silver, C. E., & Barrows, H. S. (2006).Goals and strategies of a problem-based learning facilitator.The Interdisciplinary Journal of Problem-based Learning, 1(1), 21-39. Johnson, D. W., & Johnson, R. T. (1994).Learning together and alone: Cooperative, competitive, andindividualistic learning (4th ed.). Boston: Allyn & Bacon. Johnson, D. W., Johnson, R. T. (1996). Cooperation and the use of technology.In D. H. Jonassen, (Ed.), Handbook of research in educational communications and technology(pp. 1017–1044). New York: MacMillan. Kay, J., Barg, M., Fekete, A., Greening, T., Hollands, O., Kingston, J.H., & Crawford, K. (2000).Problem-based learning for foundation computer science courses.Computer Science Education, 10(2), 109 – 128. Kirkwood, M. (2000). Infusing higher-order thinking and learning to learn into content instruction: A case study of secondary computing studies in Scotland. Journal of Curriculum Studies, 32(4), 509–535. Kirschner, P. A. (2001). Using integrated electronic environments for collaborative teaching/learning. Learning and Instruction, 10(1), 1-9. Klaus, B. (2002).The Integration of Internet-Based Reading Materials into the Foreign Language Curriculum: From Teacher- to Student-Centered Approaches. Language Learning & 506 Technology. Vol. 6 (No.3) Pg 87-107. Koohang, A. (2004). Creating learning objects in collaborative e-learning settings.Issues in Information Systems, 4(2), 584–590. Koschmann, T. (1999) Computer support for collaboration and learning. Journal of the learning sciences, 8: 495-497. Kreijns, K., Kirschner, P. A. & Jochems. (2003). Identifying the pitfalls for social interaction in computer-supported collaborative learning environments: a review of the research. Computers in Human Behavior.Vol. 19 (No. 3),Pg 335–353. Lee, B. H. (2010). Conditions affecting Computer Supported Collaborative Learning in Higher Education in the UK and South Korea. Doctor of Philosophy Thesis, University of Birmingham. Moura, I., & van Hattum-Janssen, N. (2011).Teaching a CS introductory course: an active approach.Computers & Education, Vol. 56, (No.2), Pg 475–483. Nuutila, E., Torma, S. & Malmi, L. (2005) PBL and Computer Programming The Seven Steps Method with Adaptations.Computer Science Education.15 (2), 123-142. Oliver, M. and Shaw, G. P. (2003) Asychronous discussion in support of medical education. JALN. 7(1), 56-67. Pucel, D. J. & Sterz, T. F. (2005) Effectiveness of and Student Satisfaction with Web-Based Compared to Traditional InService Teacher Education Courses. Journal of Industrial Teacher Education.Vol. 42 (No. 1). Pg 7-23. Ragoonaden, K. and Bordeleau, P. (2000) Collaborative Learning via the Internet, Educational Technology & Society. 3(3), 361–369. Ryan, M., Carlton, K. H. & Ali, N. S. (1999).Evaluation of traditional classroom teaching methods versus course delivery via the World Wide Web.The Journal of Nursing Education,38(6).Pg 272-7. Strijbos, J.W., Martens, R. L. & Jochems, W. M. G. (2004).Designing for interaction: Six steps to designing computer-supported group-based learning.Computers & Education, 42(4), 403–424. 507 FOSTERING PROBLEM SOLVING IN CHEMISTRY: THE IMPORTANCE, DIFFICULTIES AND THE NEEDS OF SCIENTIFIC CREATIVITY Siti Salbiah Omar, Noor Dayana Abdul Halim, Johari Surif, Jamalludin Harun ABSTRACT The development of Higher Order Thinking Skill (HOTS) in teaching and learning Science in schools is one of the desired goals by many countries. HOTS will produce better lifelong learning and will provide more opportunities for students to succeed in the future. But teaching and learning especially in Chemistry particularly emphasis on facts, vocabulary, definitions, algorithms and rote learning which is not geared towards the development of HOTS. In fact, students are still unable to solve open ended problems and high level questions. What is more worrying, the type of open ended problems in teaching and learning is still rare and less emphasized and there are teachers in Malaysia that unable to apply thinking skills fully in their learning strategies. Therefore, this paper discuss about the importance of problem solving, student difficulties in solving open ended problem and the need of scientific creativity in problem solving. All this issues will be discussed based on the literature from previous finding and at the 508 end further work will also suggested. Keywords : Open Ended Problem Solving,Scientific Creativity INTRODUCTION Higher Order Thinking Skills (HOTS) is a thinking skill that occurs when an individual is facing a remarkable, uncertainty, question or dilemma (Goodson, Rohani, & King, 1998). HOTS enable students to better understand what they have learned (Heong et.al, 2011) and prepare themselves to undergo changes in the 21st century (Geersten, 2003 & Kenney, 2013). According to Zoller (2001) HOTS in the context of chemical education refers to the questioning, problem solving, decision making and critical thinking. HOTS especially problem solving primarily provide individual to meet the challenges in the world of work and everyday life to have enough skills to operate effectively in society and the workplace (Cooper, 2006; Ramos, Dolipas & Villamor, 2013). PROBLEM SOLVING AND ITS IMPORTANCE Hayer (1981) states that if you're having a problem if there are a gap between the present you with what you want to accomplish, and you do not know how to bridge the gap. According to Mayer (2003), the problem occurs when in any case, the goal to be achieved, but there is no routine method for achieving these goals. Each individual cannot escape from the problem, as it occurs in various aspects of life (Reid & Yang, 2002; Overton & Potter, 2007). Each of the problems must to be solved, especially problems that occur in learning, because the failure to solve the problem would be reduced motivation (Sarbiyik, et.al, 2004) and the students will less interested in pursuing education as a result of the lack of problem solving skills (Teichert & Stacy, 2002; Bodner, 509 2003). Problem solving is also very effective in improving student achievement in education (Aka, Guven & Aydogdu, 2010; Gok, 2010) because when they managed to solve the problem, their motivation will increase and eventually they will be eager to learn (Hamza & Griffith, 2006). Problem solving also indirectly enhance the skills to argue, social skills and decision-making (Kim & Tan, 2013). This is because when solving problems, students learn how to exchange ideas and integrate the nature and level of knowledge and communication in an effort to find a solution. Mustafa (2008) states that problem-solving skills also allow individuals adapt to the environment, making the person more flexible and able to control what happens around him. In terms of education, particularly science education, providing students with problemsolving skills, will help them improve scientific thinking (Aka et.al, 2010). It is also very helpful in the development of science process skills in which are very important in solving daily problems (Aktamis & Ergin, 2008). Other than that, problem solving is a method of studentcentred, active learning and knowledge development (Aka et.al, 2010) and more recently it was used as the primary domain of large-scale assessment systems around the world such as PISA (Greiff et.al, 2013). Osman (2010) also noted that the key in determining the competency of a person at the moment are based on their level of problem solving. Because of that an effort to increase the level of problem solving in students need to be addressed in order to help countries create communities that are able to compete with the global world. According to Johnstone (1993) there are three types of problems that is algorithm, conceptual and open-ended. Algorithm are problems involving low-level thinking skills and more to the form of exercise (Zoller & Pushkin, 2007) .While conceptual problem usually involve non routine chemical phenomenon among students and students should use the concepts that have learned to solve Johari Surif et al., 2014). The open ended problem requires the application of high level thinking skills, not just knowledge 510 consumption. (Overton et.al, 2013). Gotwals and Songer (2013) states teaching and learning that is able to produce students with a scientific attitude should be to foster something more than just rote learning and normal or, more accurately it should be applied with more open ended and high level questions (Zoller & Pushkin, 2007 ) . The ability to solve open ended problem has also been shown to increase the confidence of students to solve real life (Overton & Potter, 2007; Mourtos, 2010). This is because the real life problem is usually very open and lack of information (Douglas et al., 2012). Besides, the use of the open ended problem can enhance creative and analytical thinking (Scottish Qualification Authority (SQA), 2010). On the other hand, the use of open ended problem are also able to avoid the bias that may arise from the proposed solution is given and hence it can enhance the discussion of a topic (Johari Surif, et. al., 2014) Based on previous studies, most of the problems that are used in chemical education in particular are in algorithm (Bennett, 2008; Overton & Potter, 2007; Pappa & Tsaparlis, 2011, Reid & Yang, 2002). The learning are also more emphasis on the facts, vocabulary, definitions, and algorithms (Aksela, 2005). In Malaysia, application of open problems in the teaching and learning is still rare and less emphasized (Johari Surif et al., 2014) .This is not a good thing because the problem or question of low and medium level do not help develop problem-solving skills in real life (Mourtos, 2010). Even though the goals of chemistry curriculum are indirectly help students to develop problem-solving skills (Tsarparlis, 2005; Taasoobshirazi & Glyn, 2009), but if this continues, it will produce the students that can only solve the low level of problem. To compete globally and career needs to come, of course students should be able to solve the high level problem (Overton & Potter, 2007). The fact is that students are still not able to solve an open ended and high level problem (Zohar & Dori, 2003) .Therefore, there is a need to improve problem-solving skills, especially those involving HOTS among students (Alhusaini & 511 Maker, 2011; Altuncekic et.al., 2005; Zoller & Pushkin, 2007) .In order to improve problem-solving skills on higher level, we certainly need to know the difficulties faced by students and then find a way out to overcome these difficulties. STUDENT DIFFICULTIES IN SOLVING OPEN ENDED PROBLEM Mourtos (2010) found that students failed to use information from previous learning and not be able to apply these principles in a new context. There is also students do not want to allocate enough time for each problem. This thing leads failure to managing time effectively. The students also do not want to write or sketch ideas during the process of solving the problem, and this is one of the reasons students fail to solve open ended problem. Douglas et al. (2012) found that the difficulties face by students is failed to see the problem as a whole. They could not get into a problem or in other words, they only look at one task to the extreme and less focus on other tasks. Lack of confidence in own ability to solve open ended problem also become a constraint. When they failed in making the right choice of materials, they stopped there and did not see others aspect. There is also a students who use the concept of irrelevant and does not assess the suitability of the selected concept, they just write what they know related to the question. Several other difficulties faced by the students are their failure to identify the problem in detail (Overton et.al, 2013). This is more geared to a less rigorous attitude and lack of knowledge about the problem. There are also students who use approach that does not help to solve the problem or in other words they did not use a scientific approach when solving problems. What's more concerns are those that solve open ended problem but using algorithmic approach (Overton et.al, 2013). This is not surprising because the students experience in solving the algorithm structured problem (Bennett, 2008; Overton et.al, 2013; Pappa & Tsaparlis, 512 2011). Reid & Yang (2002) states that students are not able to make a planning that can help identify a logical step for a solution. They also do not use the information solely and also do not try to find material from another source that make them unable to manage the available information to find solutions for the problems studied (Johari Surif et al., 2014). It can be concluded that the students ' difficulties in solving open- ended problems can be divided into two parts , cognitive and affective aspects of the difficulties. The students who find difficulty in cognitive is failed to use the principles they have learned to use the settlement , unable to extract the information in the limited data , and failed to use the right concept and the approach is not suitable in solving open- ended problems . In affective aspects, students are not able to manage time well, often in despair because of the lack of knowledge and do not make a plan so that they can get the appropriate steps to solve the problem. It can be said that all these difficulties occurred because of lack of chances to solve open ended problem and the students did not know the appropriate method in solving open ended problem. Thus, an effort to help overcome these difficulties need to be done. Clearly, the difficulties of students to solve problems in an open ended and HOTS need to be corrected as soon as possible so that they can be shifted from low level solver to the higher (Overton et.al, 2013). THE NEEDS OF SCIENTIFIC CREATIVITY IN PROBLEM SOLVING According to Hu & Adey (2002) in solving a problem, the students have to be creative with imagination of the ways of solutions, and build coalitions of knowledge or technique to get this solution and thus improve their problem solving skills (Pekmez et.al, 2009). Khairul (2011) stated that creativity is becoming a necessity because of the creativity helps individuals to analyze the various possibilities, creating a strong problem solving, constructive and 513 effective. But the question is what is meant by creativity, how it is viewed from science viewpoint? Torrance (1988), defines creativity as a process of formulating, reviewing, evaluating hypotheses in an effort to solve a problem is not known. But according to Lin et al. (2003) general creativity should be separated from the creativity from a scientific viewpoint. This is supported by Liang (2002), which states that "a person who is creative in chemistry is not necessarily creative in the arts". This means that the creative person in life not necessarily creative in terms of science. Creativity in science education or accuracy of the so-called scientific creativity is a stand-alone field (Mukhopadhyay, 2013). Hu & Adey (2002) defines scientific creativity as intellectual abilities to produce certain products are original and have the personal or social, is designed with a specific purpose in mind using the information provided. Hu & Adey (2002) also describe the first structure of scientific creativity is different from the creativity of others because it involves the creative science experiment, involving science-based problems. Second, scientific creativity is one involving intellectual abilities. Third, scientific creativity is based on scientific knowledge and science process skills. Fourth, creativity and analytical intelligence are two different factors that come from the mental. Based on the statement, it can be concluded that scientific creativity is a kind of creativity that measured scientifically, involves data and science-related issues. Overton et.al, (2013) categorize the types of problem solvers based on the approach used to solve the problem. Categories of problem solvers are expert, non-expert and transitional. Expert problem solvers referring to students who use scientific approach in which the properties are to understand the problem, logic, making the estimates, and be able to manage the situation even though the data is reduced. The second is a nonexpert problem solver, refers to a student who is not use a scientific approach. Problem solvers in this category cannot understand what the problem is, cannot adapt to the problem because of lack of data and lack of knowledge related to a given 514 problem. They also not evaluate the selected solution. They also prefer to find a solution in form of algorithm. The third category is transitional problem solvers. Transitional problem solver refers to solver who uses both a scientific and non-scientific approach. Sometimes they use scientific approach, but on the other part they use non-scientific approach. They usually evaluate a solution, but at the same time using an algorithm approach. Problem solvers in this category are called transitional because they are in transition phase from non-expert to expert problem solvers. Based on the above explanation and detail can be concluded to be good problem solvers, students must use a scientific approach (Cartrette & Bordner, 2010; Overton et.al, 2013). Here, the role of scientific creativity is needed. When the student creative scientifically, then the idea that issued is based on science and not just by logic or other views that may not correspond to a given problem situation and this will lead to more relevant solution (Overton et.al, 2013). SUGGESTION OF FURTHER WORK Apart from promoting the use of open- ended problem in the classroom, some of the learning strategies that are appropriate and can help to improve problem-solving skills and scientific creativity will be examined. Learning activities based on the selected learning strategies will be develop and the impact of this activity will then be evaluated on students' performance, the level of problem solving and the level of scientific creativity of students. Next, research will be study on how the learning activities promote the development of scientific creativity and problem solving. The process of construction of scientific creativity and problem solving occurs also will be examined. All of these findings will be used to develop a framework that can be used as a reference to help teachers and students improve problem-solving skills as well as scientific creativity. Even though there is already a framework related to 515 problem solving and framework that linking problem solving and creativity, but there is no such a model that specifically linking on open -ended problem solving and scientific creativity. Therefore, a flexible structure of the framework that can be used to improve the quality of problem solving and indirectly enhancing scientific creativity will be further explored. It will be such an effort to increase the level of problem solving among students in order to help countries create communities that are able to operate effectively in society and compete with the global world. CONCLUSION In order to help improve problem-solving skills, teachers have to develop problem solving culture in classroom. Students must be in a student-centered learning environment in which they are involved actively in the learning process, but should also be given counseling if they have difficulty in solving a problem. Teachers should always be willing to take risks to change strategy (Hamza & Griffith, 2006) and not just tied to a learning strategy in order to increase problem solving skills (Zoller et al., 2007). Through this study is expected to help provide a framework that can be used to improve problem solving skills as well as scientific creativity among students so that they can participate effectively in society and work environment (Cooper, 2006; Ramos, Dolipas & Villamor, 2013). REFERENCES Aksela, M. (2005). Supporting Meaningful Chemistry Learning and Higher Order Thinking through Computer-Assisted Inquiry: A Design Research Approach. Academic Dissertation, University of Helsinki. Aktamis, H. & Ergin, O. (2008). The Effect of Scientific Process Skills Education on Students’ Scientific Creativity, Science Attitudes and Academic Achievements. 516 Alhusaini, A.A, & Maker, C.J (2011). The Uses of Open-ended Problem Solving in Regular Academic Subjects to Develop Students’ Creativity: An Analytical Review. Turkish Journal of Giftedness and Education. 1(1), 1-43. Altuncekik, A., Yaman, S. & Koray, O. (2005). A Study on Levels of Self-efficacy Beliefs and Problem Solving Skills of Teacher Candidates. Kastamonu Education Journal. 13(1), 93-102.AsiaPacific Forum on Science Learning and Teaching. 9(1), 1-21. Bennett S.W. (2008). Problem Solving: Can Anybody Do It? Chemistry Education Research and Practice. 9, 60-64. Bodner G.M, (2003), Problem Solving: The Difference Between What We Do and What We Tell Students To Do, Chemistry Education, 7 ,37-45. Cartrette P.D. & Bodner, G.M. (2010). Non-mathematical Problem Solving in Organic Chemistry. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 47(6), 643-660. Douglas E.P., Ljungberg, K.L, McNeill, N.J., Malcolm, Z.T., & Therriault, D.J. Moving Beyond Formulas and Fixations: Solving Open- Ended Engineering Problems. European Journal of Engineering Education. 37(6), 627-651. Funke, J. (2013). Human Problem Solving in 2012. The Journal of Problem Solving. 6(1), 2-19. Geersten, H.R (2003). Rethinking Thinking about Higher-Level Thinking. Teaching Sociology. 31(1), 1-19. Gok, T. (2010). The General Assessment of Problem Solving Processes and Metacognition in Physics Education. Eurasian Journal of Physics and Chemistry Education. 2(2), 100-122. Gotwals A. W. & Songer N.B., (2013). Using Assessment to Gather Validity Evidence for a Learning Progression on Evidence-based Explanations with Core Ecological Content. Journal of Research in Science Teaching.40 (5). 597-626. Greiff, S., Holt, D.V., & Funke, J. (2013). Perspectives on Problem Solving in Educational Assessment: Analytical, Interactive, and Collaborative Problem Solving. The Journal of Problem Solving. 5(2), 71-91. Hamza, M.K, & Griffith, K.G, (2006).Fostering Problem Solving & Creative Thinking in the Classroom: Cultivating a Creative Mind. National Forum of Applied Educational Research Journal-Electronic, 19(3), 1-29. 517 Hayer, J.R. (1981). The Complete Problem Solver – Philadelpia, PA:The Franklin Institute Press. Heong, Y.M, Othman, W., Md Yunos, J., Kiong, T.T., Hassan, R., & Mohamad, M.M (2011). The Level of Marzano Higher Thinking Skills among Technical Education Students. International Journal of Social Science and Humanity, 1(2), 121-125. Hu W. & Adey, P. (2002). A Scientific Creativity Test for Secondary School Students. International Journal of Science Education. 24(4), 389-403. Johnstone, A.H. (1993). “Introduction”. In: Wood, C. & Sleet, R. (Eds). Creative Problem Solving in Chemistry. London, The Royal Society of Chemistry. Khairul, A.I. (2011). “Kreativiti, Kecerdasan & Kesihatan Mental”. In: Sobian S. (Ed), Islam, Kreativiti dan Inovasi. Kuala Lumpur, Institut Kefahaman Islam Malaysia. Kenney,J.(2013).Fostering Critical Thinking Skills: Strategies for Use with Intermediate Gifted Readers. Illionis Reading Council Journal, 41(2), 29-37. Kim, M. & Tan H.T (2013).A Collaborative Problem-Solving Process through Environmental Field Studies. International Journal of Science Education. 35(3), 357-387. Liang, J.C (2002). Exploring Scientific Creativity of Eleventh Grade Students in Taiwan. Unpublished PHD thesis, The University of Texas. Lin, C., Hu, W. & Adey, P. (2003). The Influence of CASE on Scientific Creativity. Research in Science Education. 33(2), 143-162. Mayer, R.E. (2003). Learning and Instruction. Upper Sadle River, NJ: Prentice Hall. Mourtos, N.J (2010) Challenges Students Face in Solving Open-Ended Problems, International Journal for Engineering Education. Mukhopadhyay, R. (2013). Measurement of Creativity in Physics – A Brief Review on Related Tools. Journal of Humanities and Social Science. 6(5), 45-50. Mustafa, D. (2008). The Application of Problem Solving Method on Science Teacher Trainees on the Solution of the Environmental Problems. Journal of Environmental & Science Education, 3(1), 9-18. Osman, M. (2010). Controlling Uncertainty: A Review of Human Behavior in Complex Dynamic Environments. Psychological 518 Bulletin, 136(1), 65-86. Overton, T. & Potter, N. (2007). Solving Open-ended Problems, and the Influence of Cognitive Factors on Student Success. Chemistry Education Research and Practice. 9, 65-69. Overton, T., & Potter, N. (2011), Investigating Students’ Success in Solving and Attitudes towards Context-Rich Open-ended Problems in Chemistry. Chemistry Education Research and Practice. 12, 294-302. Overton, T., Potter, N., & Leng, C. (2013). A Study of Approaches to Solving Open-ended Problems in Chemistry. Chemistry Education Reseacrh and Practice, 14, 468-475. Pappa E.T. & Tsarparlis, G., (2011). Evaluation of Questions in General Chemistry Textbooks According to the form of the Questions and the Question-Answer Relationship (QUA): the Case of intra and intermolecular chemical bonding. Chemistry Education Research and Practice. 12, 262-270. Ramos, J. L. S., Dolipas, B. B., & Villamor, B. B. (2013). Higher Order Thinking Skills and Academic Performance in Physics of College Students : A Regression Analysis. International Journal of Innovative Interdisciplinary Research, (4), 48–60. Reid, N. & Yang, M.J, (2002) The Solving of Problems in Chemistry: the More Open-ended Problems. Research in Science & Technological Education, 20(1), 83-98. Scottish Qualification Authority (2010). Chemistry Open-Ended Questions Support Materials.Scotland: Learning and Teaching Scotland. Taasoobshirazi G. & Glyn S.M. (2009). College Students Solving Chemistry Problems: a Theoritical Model of Experience. Journal of Research in Science Teaching.46 (10), 1070-1089. Teichert M.A & Stacy, A.M., (2002). Promoting Understanding of Chemical Bonding and Spontaneity through Students Explanation and Integration of Ideas. Journal of Research in Science Teaching. 39, 464-496. Torrance E.P. (1988). “The Nature of Creativity as Manifest in its Testing”. In: R.J Stenberg (Ed), The Nature of Creativity: Contemporary Psychological Perspectives (43-75).New York: Cambridge University Press. Tsaparlis G., (2005). Non-algorithmic Quantitative Problem Solving in University Physical Chemistry: a Correlation Study of the Role 519 of Selective Cognitive Factors. Research in Science & Technological Education, 23, 125-148. Zohar, A., & Dori, Y. J. (2003). Higher Order Thinking Skills and LowAchieving Students: Are They Mutually Exclusive? Journal of the Learning Sciences, 12, 145–181. Zoller, U. & Pushkin, D. (2007).Matching Higher-Order Cognitive Skills (HOCS) Promotion Goals with Problem-based Laboratory Practice in a Freshman Organic Chemistry Course. Educational Research. 8(2), 153-171. Zoller, U. (2001). Alternative Assessment as (Critical) Means of Facilitating HOCS-Promoting Teaching and Learning in Chemistry Education. Chemistry Education: Research and Practice in Europe.2 (1), 9-17 520 PENGHASILAN VIDEO INTERAKTIF BAGI PENGUJIAN KETANGKASAN REAKTIF KHUSUS UNTUK PERMAINAN BOLA JARING *Nur Ezzaini Mohd Nor, Halijah Ibrahim ABSTRAK Pelbagai ujian ketangkasan telah dilaksanakan bagi menguji ketangkasan pemain bola jaring. Ujian yang sedia ada seperti ujian ketangkasan zig-zag (Barrow, 1953), ujian ketangkasan 505 (Sheppard & Young, 2006) dan ujian ketangkasan T (Semenick, 1990) telah digunakan untuk menguji tahap ketangkasan dalam sukan bola jaring. Ketangkasan reaktif merupakan komponen penting dalam menilai kemahiran atlet yang menggabungkan ciriciri fizikal iaitu kelajuan, kuasa, dan koordinasi (Chelladurai, Yuhasz & Sipura, 1977) dan kemahiran persepsi. Objektif kajian ini bertujuan untuk menghasilkan instrumen pengujian ketangkasan reaktif khusus untuk pemain bola jaring universiti yang mewakili Malaysia. Seramai 25 orang pemain bola jaring universiti dibawah Program Kecemerlangan Sukan (PKS) terlibat dalam ujian ketangkasan reaktif. Penyelidik telah memilih rekabentuk kajian iaitu model ADDIE sebagai model pembangunan video interaktif dan setiap komponen mempunyai fungsi yang tersendiri. Penghasilan Instrumen Ketangkasan Reaktif dapat membantu menilai ketangkasan dan aspek membuat 521 keputusan bagi permainan bola jaring kerana ia melibatkan kemahiran sesuatu sukan, pergerakan pihak lawan ataupun bola. Kata kunci : Ketangkasan; Ketangkasan Reaktif; Video Interaktif PENGENALAN Pelbagai ujian ketangkasan telah dilaksanakan bagi menguji ketangkasan pemain bola jaring seperti kajian Farrow et al., (2005) dan Bock-Jonathan et al., (2007). Ujian yang sedia ada seperti ujian ketangkasan zig-zag (Barrow, 1953), ujian ketangkasan 505 (Sheppard & Young, 2006) dan ujian ketangkasan T (Semenick, 1990) telah digunakan untuk menguji tahap ketangkasan dalam sukan bola jaring. Namun ujian ini hanya menguji kemahiran ketangkasan berfokus kepada perubahan arah kelajuan kerana semua pergerakan boleh dirancang dan tidak memerlukan respon kepada rangsangan (Sheppard et al., 2006). Ketangkasan reaktif merupakan komponen penting dalam menilai kemahiran atlet yang menggabungkan ciri-ciri fizikal iaitu kelajuan, kuasa, dan koordinasi (Chelladurai, Yuhasz & Sipura, 1977) dan kemahiran persepsi iaitu membuat keputusan dan bertindak terhadap rangsangan untuk kejayaan dan pelaksanaan dalam sukan berpasukan (Farrow et al., 2005; Gabbett, Kelly, & Sheppard, 2008; Young & Willey, 2010). Objektif kajian ini bertujuan untuk menghasilkan instrumen pengujian ketangkasan reaktif khusus untuk pemain bola jaring universiti yang mewakili Malaysia. Kajian ini menggunakan kaedah persampelan bertujuan dimana pemilihan subjek berdasarkan kepada kriteria seperti :a) Pemain merupakan pemain universiti yang mewakili Malaysia sama ada kategori remaja ataupun senior. b) Pemain memperoleh program latihan yang sama yang telah dirancang di bawah Program Kecemerlangan Sukan (PKS). c) Pemain juga menyertai pertandingan anjuran kebangsaan sebagai siri latihan dan pertandingan secara berterusan. 522 d) Pemain yang tidak mengalami sebarang kecederaan yang menghalang perlaksanaan pengujian ketangkasan reaktif. Seramai 25 orang pemain bola jaring universiti dibawah Program Kecemerlangan Sukan (PKS) terlibat dalam ujian ketangkasan reaktif. Kajian ini dilakukan di Dewan Serbaguna, Pusat Sukan Universiti Malaya, Kuala Lumpur (UM). Lokasi ini menjadi lokasi pengujian ujian ketangkasan reaktif kerana lokasi ini merupakan lokasi utama penganjuran kejohanan bola jaring di peringkat universiti seperti Majlis Sukan Universiti Malaysia (MASUM) pada setiap tahun. Selain itu, lantai gelanggang yang digunakan di dalam Dewan Serbaguna adalah bersesuaian sebagai tempat lokasi kajian yang dijalankan. Instrumen pengujian Ujian Ketangkasan Reaktif yang dihasilkan akan melibatkan penggunaan komputer, kamera video SVHS (NV-MS5), bola, borang maklumat diri, projektor, dual beam timing gate, kon dan skrin putih. Fasa Penghasilan Instrumen Ujian Ketangkasan Reaktif Fasa penghasilan instrumen Ujian Ketangkasan Reaktif ini merangkumi tiga fasa. Pada fasa pertama, penyelidik menghasilkan instrumen pengujian ketangkasan reaktif khusus untuk pemain bola jaring dimana instrumen pengujian mengandungi video interaktif mengenai kemahiran hantaran bola jaring. Tiga kemahiran hantaran telah dipilih iaitu hantaran aras dada, aras bahu dan hantaran lantun. Terdapat pelbagai model pembangunan untuk menjalankan rekabentuk kajian dan penyelidik telah memilih model ADDIE sebagai model pembangunan video interaktif. Model ini dibangunkan oleh Branson, Rayner, Cox, Furman, King dan Hannum (1975) dan dicipta untuk Center for Educational Technology di Florida State University bagi askar Amerika Syarikat. Model ini merupakan antara model pengajaran yang sering menjadi asas kepada model-model rekabentuk pembangunan yang lain. Model ini terdiri daripada lima fasa iaitu :- 523 Fasa Analisis (Analysis) Setiap komponen mempunyai fungsi yang tersendiri. Di peringkat ini, ia melibatkan beberapa proses penentuan serta mengenalpasti masalah yang ingin diselesaikan. Setelah sesuatu masalah dapat dikenalpasti, proses analisis akan dilaksanakan bagi mencari punca atau faktor yang berkaitan atau yang menimbulkan masalah tersebut. Dalam fasa ini, penyelidik melaksanakan proses menganalisis terhadap keperluan video interaktif pengujian ketangkasan reaktif bagi memastikan pembangunan tersebut lebih terancang dan sistematik. Sebagai contoh, penyelidik memastikan instrumen yang digunakan untuk menghasilkan video interaktif dapat dilaksanakan dengan baik. Fasa Rekabentuk (Design) Peringkat ini dilaksanakan selepas proses analisis selesai. Ia menjelaskan pandangan keseluruhan mengenai rupabentuk, struktur, pendekatan teori, jenis media dan teknologi yang digunakan. Ia juga melibatkan proses :- 524 i. ii. iii. Pembentukan objektif yang khusus untuk pengajaran. Pembinaan item-item mengenai pengujian Pemilihan strategi pembangunan Media yang digunakan adalah kamera digital yang bertujuan untuk merakam tiga kemahiran hantaran dalam permainan bola jaring iaitu kemahiran hantaran aras dada, aras bahu dan hantaran lantun. Fasa Pembangunan (Development ) Pada peringkat ini, ia melibatkan pembinaan sistem sebenar dengan menggunakan semua elemen media dan teknologi yang terpilih berdasarkan keperluan. Penghasilan video interaktif melibatkan rakaman kemahiran hantaran dan diubahsuai mengunakan perisian Movie Maker. Ia juga menggunakan perisian sokongan yang telah diformatkan iaitu perisian AIS React. Fasa Perlaksanaan (Implementation) Diperingkat ini, video interaktif yang telah dihasilkan akan digunakan atau dilaksanakan dalam situasi sebenar kepada jurulatih pasukan bola jaring kebangsaan. Jurulatih akan menggunakan video interaktif ini untuk menguji keberkesanannya serta mengkaji kelancaran video interaktif tersebut. Dengan ini, penyelidik dapat mengenal pasti masalah-masalah yang tidak disedari sewaktu fasa rekabentuk serta pembangunan dan seterusnya, memperbaiki aspek-aspek kelemahan yang telah dikenalpasti melalui proses pemulihan. Fasa Penilaian (Evaluation) Penilaian terbahagi kepada dua komponen iaitu penilaian formatif dan penilaian sumatif. Penilaian formatif perlu dilakukan terhadap 525 semua peringkat untuk memastikan keberkesanannya. Penyelidik memilih penilaian formatif kerana ia dapat memperbaiki kelemahan bagi setiap fasa penghasilan video interaktif. KESAHAN Setelah video interaktif selesai dihasilkan, video tersebut akan diberikan kepada jurulatih yang terlibat dalam pasukan Malaysia serta pakar akademik berkaitan dengan sukan bola jaring untuk menilai kesahan instrumen. Kesahan (validity) merupakan elemen yang penting bagi mempertahankan kejituan instrumen daripada terdedah kepada kecacatan. Semakin tinggi nilai dan tahap kesahan dan kebolehpercayaan instrumen maka semakin jitu data yang akan diperoleh bagi menghasilkan kajian yang baik dan berkualiti (Fraenkel dan Wallen, 1996). Penyelidik menggunakan kesahan kandungan (content validity) untuk menilai isi kandungan video interaktif dapat mengukur domain pengetahuan dan kemahiran yang hendak diukur oleh instrumen tersebut. Kandungan video merangkumi jenis hantaran dan arah pergerakan bola, kesesuaian video yang perlu ditayangkan di skrin,tempoh tayangan video apabila subjek bersedia serta jarak larian yang digunakan. Sebanyak tiga jenis hantaran yang digunak.an iaitu hantaran aras dada, hantaran lantun dan hantaran aras bahu. KEBOLEHPERCAYAAN Setelah kesahan kandungan dipersetujui, video interaktif tersebut diperkenalkan dan digunakan untuk menguji tahap ujian ketangkasan reaktif kepada pemain bola jaring UTM. Data yang diperolehi akan digunakan untuk menilai kebolehpercayaan instrumen kajian yang dijalankan. Kebolehpercayaan atau reliability ialah satu konsep yang merujuk kepada ketekalan (consistency) dan kestabilan (stability) sesuatu pengukuran, alat kajian atau soal selidik. Ia bertujuan untuk mengetahui sama ada pengukuran yang dijalankan mendapat hasil catatan yang sama 526 apabila ia digunakan terhadap responden yang sama pada waktu yang berlainan (Gale & Thomas, 1982). Terdapat beberapa jenis kebolehpercayaan dan penyelidik menggunakan kebolehpercayaan uji ulang uji untuk mengukur kebolehpercayaan instrumen video interaktif yang akan digunakan sebagai alat pengujian ketangkasan reaktif. Kebolehpercayaan uji ulang uji (test - retest) merupakan skor ke atas ujian yang sama dan konsisten pada masa tertentu. Skor yang diperoleh pada ujian yang pertama menghampiri skor untuk ujian yang diuji sekali lagi. Semakin sama skor pada ujian yang dijalankan pada masa tertentu, semakin stabil skor ujian tersebut (Rosenthal and Rosnow, 1991). Empat prosedur kebolehpercayaan uji ulang uji merangkumi :i. Menjalankan ujian terhadap kumpulan tertentu ii. Selepas dua minggu, ujian yang sama dijalankan ke atas kumpulan yang sama iii. Hitungkan pekali korelasi antara skor ujian yang pertama dengan skor ujian kedua. iv. Menilai keputusan yang diperolehi 527 UJIAN KETANGKASAN REAKTIF Rajah 1 : Arah pergerakan larian bagi Instrumen Ketangkasan Reaktif • Ujian ketangkasan dilakukan dimana subjek berada di Gate A untuk memulakan larian. • Subjek memulakan larian dengan membuat pecutan sepanjang 3 meter. Catatan masa diambil apabila subjek melintasi Gate A sehingga Gate B. Catatan masa yang diambil diantara Gate A sehingga Gate B merupakan masa catatan untuk menguji tahap ketangkasan (Movement Time) subjek tersebut. • Apabila tiba di kawasan bulatan subjek perlu membuat perubahan arah kelajuan ke arah kanan atau kiri dengan jarak 4 meter sehingga ke penamat iaitu Gate C dan Gate D. Catatan masa yang diambil diantara Gate B sehingga Gate C dan Gate D merupakan masa catatan untuk menilai tahap ketangkasan reaktif ataupun dikenali sebagai Decision Time subjek tersebut. • Setelah subjek melepasi Gate C dan Gate D, masa catatan keseluruhan iaitu Total Time direkodkan. • Setiap subjek melakukan lima percubaan ujian ketangkasan reaktif dan mengambil masa selama 20 minit untuk menyelesaikannya. 528 Rajah 2 : Lakaran Pengujian Ketangkasan Reaktif Rajah 2 merupakan lakaran pengujian ketangkasan reaktif yang lebih jelas dimana subjek perlu membuat keputusan berdasarkan paparan video interaktif yang ditayangkan di skrin putih. Decision Time juga diambil untuk menilai catatan masa yang dilakukan oleh subjek. Kemudian subjek perlu berlari ke garisan penamat yang telah ditetapkan. KESIMPULAN Penghasilan Instrumen Ketangkasan Reaktif dapat membantu menilai ketangkasan dan aspek membuat keputusan bagi permainan bola jaring kerana ia melibatkan kemahiran sesuatu sukan, pergerakan pihak lawan ataupun bola. Malah, ujian-ujian baru yang menggabungkan ketangkasan fizikal dan kemahiran kognitif adalah digalakkan kerana ia dapat meningkatkan prestasi atlet dan pasukan tersebut untuk mencapai kejayaan. RUJUKAN Barrow, H. M. (1953). Test Of Motor Ability for College Men. Research 529 Quarterly for Exercise and Sport, 25, 326–332. Bock-jonathan, B. B., Venter, R. E., & Bressan, E., S. (2007). A comparison between skill and decision-making ability of netball players at club level : pilot study. South African Journal For Research in Sport, Physical Education and Recreation, 29(1), 29– 38. Chelladurai, P., Yuhasz, M., Sipura, R. (1977). The reactive agility test. Perceptual and Motor Skills, (44), 1319–1324. Farrow, D., Young, W., & Bruce, L. (2005). The development of a test of reactive agility for netball: a new methodology. Journal of Science and Medicine in Sport, 8(1), 52–60. Fraenkel, J.R., and Wallen, N.E., (1996). How to Design and Evaluate Research. USA : Mc. Fraw-Hill Inc. Gabbett, T. J., Kelly, J. N., Sheppard, J. M. (2008). Speed , change of direction speed, and reactive agility of rugby leaque players. Journal of Strength and Conditioning Research, 1533-4287/, 174– 181. Gale H. Roid and Thomas M. Haladyna (1982). A Technology for TestItem Writing. New York : Harcourt Brace Jovonavich Publishers. Rosenthal, R. and Rosnow, R. L. (1991). Essentials of Behavioral Research: Methods and Data Analysis. Second Edition. Semenick, D. (1990). Test and Measurement. Journal of National Strength and Conditioning Association, 12(1), 36–37. Sheppard, J .M., & Young, W. B. (2006). Agility literature review: classifications, training and testing. Journal of Sports Sciences, 24(9), 919–932. doi:10.1080/02640410500457109 Young, W. B., & Willey, B. (2010). Analysis of a reactive agility field test. Journal of Science and Medicine in Sport, 13(3), 376–378. doi:10.1016/j.jsams.2009.05.006 530 ROBOTIK DALAM PENDIDIKAN DI MALAYSIA Hafzan Ibrahim, Mohammad Bilal Ali, Fatin Aliah Phang Abdullah, Norazrena Abu Samah ABSTRAK Berdasarkan Gelombang 1 dalam Pelan Pembangunan Pendidikan Malaysia (PPPM) 2013-2025, Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia akan memberikan tumpuan pada peningkatan prestasi sistem pendidikan negara. Ini berdasarkan penurunan peratusan markah dalam Trends in International Mathematics and Science Study (TIMSS) dan Programme for International Student Assessment (PISA). Dalam usaha merealisasikan hasrat PPPM, bahan sumber Pengajaran dan Pembelajaran (PdP) Sains dan Matematik dibangunkan dengan berteraskan pembentukan kemahiran berfikir aras tinggi (KBAT). Dapatan TIMSS dan PISA jelas menunjukkan murid di Malaysia lemah dalam domain kognitif yang melibatkan KBAT seperti menaakul, mengaplikasi, menganalisis, menilai dan mencipta. Berdasarkan kajian-kajian lepas di peringkat antarabangsa, robotik digunakan dalam pendidikan dapat meningkatkan penguasaan pelajar dari domain kognitif, afektif dan psikomotor. Oleh itu, kertas konsep ini membincangkan tentang potensi robotik dalam pendidikan sebagai bahan sumber di Malaysia dalam membantu meningkatkan KBAT pelajar. Kata Kunci : Robotik 531 PENGENALAN Falsafah Pendidikan Kebangsaan menyatakan bahawa matlamat dan tujuan sistem pendidikan, adalah untuk melengkapkan pelajarpelajar kita secara menyeluruh untuk membolehkan mereka berjaya terutama dalam abad ke-21. Menerusi Rancangan Malaysia Kesepuluh (Razak, 2010), Negara berhasrat menghasilkan modal insan bertaraf dunia menjelang tahun 2020 di mana pelajar mempunyai kelayakan pendidikan yang tinggi yang bercirikan pengetahuan dan inovasi serta memiliki tahap kemahiran yang tinggi dalam bidang teknikal. Berdasarkan keputusan pentaksiran peringkat antarabangsa Trends in International Mathematics and Science Study (TIMSS) dan Programme for International Student Assessment (PISA) pada tahun 2011, pelajar Malaysia jauh ketinggalan dengan berada pada kelompok satu pertiga ke bawah (Bahagian Perancangan dan Penyelidikan Dasar Pendidikan, 2013). TIMSS dan PISA ini merupakan alat kajian yang digunakan sebagai penanda aras kualiti pendidikan Sains, Matematik dan Bacaan. Soalan yang dibina melibatkan domain kognitif yang menekankan Kemahiran Berfikir Aras Tinggi (KBAT) iaitu menaakul, mengaplikasi, menganalisis, menilai dan mencipta. Dapatan keputusan menunjukkan salah satu faktor penyumbang adalah pelajar Malaysia tidak mampu menjawab dengan baik soalan-soalan yang memerlukan mereka berfikir pada aras tinggi (Darus, 2012). Justeru, kesan daripada penurunan keputusan ini, Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia (KPM) telah bertindak proaktif dengan mengambil tindakan susulan antaranya mentransformasikan kurikulum lama kepada yang baru iaitu Kurikulum Standard Sekolah Rendah (KSSR) dan Kurikulum Standard Sekolah Menengah (KSSM) serta melaksanakan Pelan Pembangunan Pendidikan Malaysia 2013-2015 (Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia, 2012b). Menerusinya, Pendidikan Sains dan Matematik di Malaysia dimartabatkan dengan berfokuskan kepada melahirkan pelajar yang menguasai KBAT. Menerusi KSSR dan KSSM, satu program pendidikan 532 berasaskan robotik telah dilaksanakan oleh KPM bersama agensi kerajaan lain seperti Kementerian Sains, Teknologi dan Inovasi (MOSTI), Pusat Sains Negara, sektor swasta dan badan bukan kerajaan (NGO) (Bahagian Perancangan dan Penyelidikan Dasar Pendidikan, 2013). Program robotik ini dijalankan pada peringkat sekolah rendah, sekolah menengah, matrikulasi, pra-universiti malahan di peringkat universti. Kajian-kajian lepas menunjukkan penggunaan robotik member impak positif dari aspek kognitif, afektif dan juga psikomotor pelajar. Oleh itu, kertas kerja ini membincangkan potensi program pendidikan robotik di Malaysia dalam merealisasikan hasrat kerajaan untuk melahirkan modal insan berkualiti dalam bidang sains dan inovasi. DEFINISI ROBOTIK Pengunaan robotik adalah meluas terutamanya dalam bidang pengindustrian, perubatan, pertanian. Namun pengunaan robotik dalam pendidikan masih belum diperluas lagi. Robot menurut Kamus Pelajar Edisi Keempat (Dewan Bahasa dan Pustaka, 2005) adalah mesin yang dapat melakukan atau membuat berbagai-bagai pekerjaan manusia. Robot merupakan satu sistem mekanikal yang mempunyai sensors (input), actuators (output) dan dikawal oleh komputer (processor/brain) (Anderson & Bracken, 2010). Maka, robot dapat ditakrifkan sebagai pengendali pelbagai kegunaan yang boleh diaturcara dan mempunyai ciri-ciri kepandaian dan kebolehsesuaian. Robotik pula dalam Kamus Dewan Edisi Keempat (Dewan Bahasa dan Pustaka, 2005) merujuk kepada bidang sains yang berkaitan dengan reka bentuk, pembuatan dan penggunaan. Robotik berasal daripada perkataan robot yang membawa maksud peralatan elektrik dan mekanikal (mekatronik) yang boleh dikendalikan secara automotik. Robotik juga boleh disimpulkan sebagai ilmu tentang robot. 533 PROGRAM PENDIDIKAN ANTARABANGSA ROBOTIK PERINGKAT Program pendidikan robotik pada peringkat antarabangsa telah bermula sejak 1990-an lagi. Ia dikukuhkan lagi dengan kewujudan teori pembelajaran yang baru iaitu teori constructionism yang diterapkan semasa sesi pengajaran dan pembelajaran menggunakan robotik oleh Profesor Seymour Papert (Papert & Harel, 1991). Natijahnya, pelbagai program pendidikan berteraskan robotik telah dilaksanakan dalam pelbagai bentuk sama ada dilakukan di dalam kelas mahupun luar kelas sebagai aktiviti kokurikulum mahupun pertandingan. Perubahan secara drastik dalam bidang pendidikan ini dapat dilihat selepas tahun 2000. Ia berikutan pembaharuan pembangunan kaedah pengajaran dan pembelajaran menggunakan robotik yang cuba diterapkan bagi meningkatkan interaksi antara guru dan pelajar serta teknik penyampaian agar seberapa banyak maklumat yang ada dapat diberikan secara menyeluruh (Alejos et al., 2012). Di Sepanyol, satu projek yang dinamakan sebagai ENXENO yang berbentuk kokurikulum dibangunkan dengan tujuan memperkenalkan bidang robotik pada peringkat K-12 sebagai cara yang kreatif untuk mendekati Sains dan Teknologi di peringkat pra-universiti (Alejos et al., 2012). Negara-negara di Eropah juga adalah antara negara yang giat melaksanakan program pendidikan robotik dalam bentuk kurikulum sehingga mereka mewujudkan program Teacher Education Enhanced Constructivist Pedagogical Methods yang dikenali sebagai TERECoP (Alimisis et al., 2010). Selain itu, terdapat juga program yang melibatkan pertandingan pendidikan robotik seperti World Robotic Olympiad (WRO). Hampir seluruh negara telah menyertai pertandingan tersebut seperti Amerika Syarikat, Negara-negara Eropah, Negara Asia Timur, Negara Asean (WRO Advisory Council, 2014). Penyelidikan ilmiah dalam bidang robotik pendidikan sejak dua puluh tahun kebelakangan ini memberi penekanan terhadap 534 kesan pendidikan robotik ke atas pelajar dalam pelbagai aspek. Salah satunya adalah hubungan interaksi antara penciptaan teknologi baru dan pembangunan cara-cara inovatif pembelajaran (Martin et al 2000). Menurut Alimisis (2010), projek dan aktiviti robotik dalam persekitaran sekolah dikelaskan dalam dua kategori berasingan iaitu robotik sebagai objek pembelajaran dan alat pembelajaran (Alimisis et al., 2010). Pertama robotik sebagai objek pembelajaran bermaksud robotik sedang dikaji sebagai mata pelajaran dengan sendiri. Ia termasuk aktiviti-aktiviti pendidikan yang bertujuan untuk mengkonfigurasi persekitaran pembelajaran yang aktif (Barker & Ansorge, 2007), dan melibatkan pelajar dalam penyelesaian masalah (Altin & Pedaste, 2013) Kedua robotik sebagai alat pembelajaran di mana robotik sebagai alat untuk pengajaran dan pembelajaran dalam mata pelajaran di pelbagai peringkat sekolah (Alejos et al., 2012). Robotik sebagai alat pembelajaran biasanya dilihat sebagai aktiviti pembelajaran berasaskan projek dan bermakna (Caci, Chiazzese, & D’Amico, 2013). Sesetengah pendidik mendakwa bahawa, pendidikan robotik membantu pelajar mengubah ilmu Sains, Kejuruteraan dan Teknologi daripada abstrak kepada konkrit melalui aktiviti handson yang membawa pemahaman dunia sebenar (Mathers, Goktogen, Rankin, & Anderson, 2012). Pendidikan robotik juga berpotensi mempromosikan matapelajaran Sains, Teknologi, Kejuruteraan dan Matematik (STEM) yang bertujuan melahirkan tenaga kerja yang berkemahiran tinggi bagi memenuhi permintaan abad ke-21 (Loh, Loo, Loh, & Lim, 2013). PROGRAM PENDIDIKAN ROBOTIK DI MALAYSIA Robotik telah mula diterapkan pada peringkat sekolah menerusi Kelab Rekacipta dan Robotik dalam aktiviti kokurikulum dari tahun 2005. Kemudian, ia diperluaskan menerusi Pertandingan Robotik antara sekolah-sekolah. Terdapat pelbagai jenis 535 pertandingan robotik di Malaysia antaranya Pertandingan Robotik Kebangsaan (NRC) untuk semua jenis sekolah, Robofair untuk Maktab Rendah Sains Mara dan Malaysia Robot Contest (ROBOCON) untuk pelajar universiti, kolej dan politeknik. Terdapat pelbagi jenis kit robot yang digunakan dalam pertandingan robotik antaranya Lego Mindstorm dan Arduino. NRC merupakan salah satu inisiatif kementerian dalam usaha mencapai misi menyediakan platform pembelajaran yang dapat membentuk pelajar berkemahiran untuk berjaya pada abad ke-21 (Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia, 2012a). Program NRC ini merupakan anjuran bersama antara KPM, Pusat Sains Negara (PSN), Bahagian Kesenian dan Kokurikulum (BKK), dan Sasbadi Sdn. Bhd. Sambutan terhadap NRC dapat dilihat melalui peningkatan penyertaan sekolah-sekolah dari tahun ke tahun. Hal ini dapat dilihat di mana pada tahun 2005 hanya 300 buah sekolah meningkat kepada 3000 buah sekolah pada tahun 2013. Pasukan yang berjaya dalam NRC pada peringkat kebangsaan ini akan bertanding di peringkat antarabangsa World Robotic Olympiad (WRO). Amat membanggakan apabila pasukan Negara telah beberapa kali menang dengan menjadi johan keseluruhan dan menggondol beberapa jenis pingat utntuk setiap kategori. Jadual 1 menunjukkan statistik pencapaian pasukan pelajar Malaysia di peringkat antarabangsa. Justeru, dengan statistik ini menunjukkan pelajar Malaysia mampu menguasai ilmu robotik ini Jadual 1: Statistik Pencapaian Kotinjen Malaysia di World Robot Olympiad (WRO), (Sasbadi, 2014) Year Venue 2009 Pohang, South Korea 2010 Manila, Philippines Participant Malaysia’s Achievement country 32 2 Golds Countries 1 Award of Excellence 2 Special Awards 22 2 Golds, 3 Silvers Countries 2 Awards of Excellence 1 Special Award 536 2011 Abu Dhabi, United Arab Emirates 34 Countries 2012 Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia 30 Countries 1 Gold, 1 Silver & 1 Bronze 6 Awards of Excellence 1 Special Award 2 Golds, 2 Silvers & 8 Bronzes Objektif penganjuran Pertandingan Robotik ini adalah merangsang pelajar yang menyertai program untuk menyelesaikan masalah melalui pemikiran kreatif, logik dan di luar sempadan. Selain itu, membantu pelajar membina asas kukuh dalam mata pelajaran Matematik, Sains, Teknologi, Rekacipta dan ICT, merangsang kreativiti murid menyelesaikan masalah dan mengalakkan inovasi. Pada masa yang sama ia member juga penekanan terhadap KBAT dan kemahiran sosial selari dengan kehendak pasaran industri sains dan teknologi. Hal demikian, dapat diperincikan lagi yang mana menerusi pertandingan robotik ini pelajar dapat meningkatkan kepakaran menggunakan peralatan berteknologi seperti memprogramkan komputer, membina dan merekacipta robotik, dan menguasai seni dan bahasa. Pertandingan secara berkumpulan ini dapat menyemai semangat berpasukan, meningkatkan kebolehan berkomunikasi dan mengasah bakat kepimpinan. Secara tidak langsung kebolehan menyelesaikan masalah dan motivasi diri setiap pelajar dapat diterapkan. Melalui program yang diperkenalkan, kementerian yakin untuk membangun dan mengukuhkan pemikiran kreatif dan kritis serta ke-mahiran sosial pelajar bagi mencapai kejayaan dalam pelajaran juga masa depan. Para pelajar turut akan didedahkan dengan kemahiran-kemahiran insaniah seperti kemahiran penyelesaian masalah, pemikiran kreatif, komunikasi interpersonal dan kerjasama berkumpulan yang begitu penting untuk mereka kuasai di peringkat ini. 537 KESIMPULAN Kertas konsep ini membentangkan tentang kebaikan penggunaan robotik dalam pendidikan. Oleh demikian, diharapkan agar robotik dapat digunakan sebagai bahan sumber dalam kurikulum sekolah terutamanya dalam mata pelajaran Sains Teknologi, Kejuruteraan dan Matematik (STEM). RUJUKAN Alejos, A. V., Rio, V. S., Isasa, M. V., Lorenzo, E. De, Cuinas, I., & Sanchez, M. G. (2012). ENXENO : LEGO © Robots from University Lab to K-12 Classroom. Electronics and Electrical Engineering, 2(2), 103–108. Alimisis, D., Arlegui, J., Fava, N., Frangou, S., Ionita, S., Menegatti, E., … Pina, A. (2010). Introducing robotics to teachers and schools : experiences from the TERECoP project Theoretical background and methodology of the TERECoP, 1–13. Altin, H. &, & Pedaste, M. (2013). Learning Approaches to Applying Robotics in Science Education. Journal of Baltic Science Education, 12, 365–378. Anderson, T. R., & Bracken, C. (2010). Robotics in Education eJournal Contents :, 2(March), 1–18. Bahagian Perancangan dan Penyelidikan Dasar Pendidikan. (2013). Perangkaan Pendidikan Malaysia. Putrajaya, Malaysia: Bahagian Perancangan dan Penyelidikan Dasar Pendidikan. Barker, B. S., & Ansorge, J. (2007). Robotics as Means to Increase Achievement Scores in an Informal Learning Environment. Journal of Research on Technology in Education, 39(3), 229–243. doi:10.1080/15391523.2007.10782481 Bilotta, E., Gabriele, L., Servidio, R., & Tavernise, A. (2009). Edutainment Robotics as Learning Tool. In Z. Pan, M. Chang, A. D. Cheok, & W. Muller (Eds.), Transactions on Edutainment 111 (pp. 25–35). Germany: Springer-Verlag Berlin Heidelberg. Caci, B., Chiazzese, G., & D’Amico, A. (2013). Robotic and virtual World Programming labs to Stimulate Reasoning and visualspatial Abilities. Procedia - Social and Behavioral Sciences, 93, 538 1493–1497. doi:10.1016/j.sbspro.2013.10.070 Darus, Z. (2012). Status Pencapaian Malaysia TIMSS dan PISA : (p. 34). Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia. Dewan Bahasa dan Pustaka. (2005). Pusat Rujukan Persuratan Melayu @ DBP. Dewan Bahasa dan Pustaka. Retrieved from http://prpm.dbp.gov.my/Search.aspx?k=robot Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia. (2012a). Buletin Rasmi Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia. Unit Komunikasi Korporat. Retrieved from http://buletinkpm.blogspot.com/2012/02/malaysia-tuan-rumahworld-robotic.html Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia. (2012b). Preliminary ReportExecutive Summary: Malaysia Education Blueprint 2013-2025. Putrajaya, Malaysia. Loh, S. C., Loo, C. K., Loh, H. C., & Lim, Y. K. (2013). Transformative Robotic Education for the Realization of Malaysia National Philosophy of Education. In K. Omar, M. J. Nordin, P. Vadakkepat, A. S. Prabuwono, S. N. H. S. Abdullah, J. Baltes, … M. F. Nasrudin (Eds.), Intelligent Robotic Systems: Inspiring The NEXT (pp. 416–426). Kuala Lumpur, Malaysia: Springer Berlin Heidelberg. doi:10.1007/978-3-642-40409-2_35 Mathers, N., Goktogen, A., Rankin, J., & Anderson, M. (2012). Robotic Mission to Mars: Hands-on, minds-on, web-based learning. Acta Astronautica, 80, 124–131. doi:10.1016/j.actaastro.2012.06.003 Papert, S., & Harel, I. (1991). Situating Constructionism. In Ablex Publishing Corporation (Ed.), Constructionism (p. 518). Westport, Amerika Syarikat. Razak, N. A. (2010). Rancangan Malaysia Kesepuluh 2011-2015 (p. 444). Putrajaya, Malaysia: Unit Perancangan Ekonomi, Jabatan Perdana Menteri. WRO Advisory Council. (2014). World Robot Olympiad. World Robot Olympiad Association Ltd. 539 CONCEPTUAL CHANGES IN SCIENTIFIC ARGUMENTATION THROUGH GUIDED GROUP SETTINGS Lee Ling Heng, Johari Surif, Cher Hau Seng ABSTRACT The main goal of scientific argumentation is to foster students’ understanding of scientific concepts and to eliminate alternative frameworks. Conceptual changes during argumentation are likely to occur when deeper cognitive processing is required, especially when students are asked to clarify, explain, and to defend their own ideas. This study examines conceptual changes in scientific argumentation, based on the three levels of representations, through a guided group argumentation setting. After several lessons on acids and bases, students first answered an Open-ended Scientific Argumentation Test 1 (OSAT 1). Based on the answers provided, 32 students are then selected using purposive sampling and are asked to complete the OSAT 2 in a guided group argumentation setting. Discussions during the guided group argumentation are also recorded, and the process of conceptual changes is also identified. The results show that students change their existing alternative frameworks to the correct scientific concepts after being guided through the group argumentation. Students are also able to construct arguments that 540 link between the three levels of representations: macroscopic, sub microscopic and symbolic levels. It is observed that the process of deep thinking about two alternative concepts led to conceptual changes. Therefore, the teaching and learning of science need to focus on group argumentations and incorporate the linkage between the macroscopic, sub microscopic and symbolic representations to promote conceptual changes, which improve students’ understanding and learning. Keywords : Acids And Bases, Alternative Frameworks, Conceptual Change, Guided Group Argumentation, Three Levels Of Representation INTRODUCTION The main goal of scientific argumentation is to foster students’ understanding of scientific concepts (von Aufschnaiters et al., 2008; Nussbaum, 2011; Sadler, 2004; Zohar and Nemet, 2002) and to eliminate alternative frameworks (Cross et al., 2008). The involvement of students in argumentative activities also enhances their scientific reasoning skills (Osborne et al., 2004). In order to induce conceptual changes through collaboration, instructional intervention are usually conducted following the socio-cognitive conflict design (Amigues, 1988). This design is based on the idea whereby the pairing of students with different initial conceptions will lead to their cognitive conflict. As a result, they will then seek for equilibrium to accommodate their naive concepts as scientific concepts. According to Kendeou and Broek (2007), when students’ existing concepts are activated and integrated with a scientific explanation, this will lead to an imbalance. The identification of this imbalance will trigger deeper information processing that causes conceptual changes. Mason (1996) stressed that conceptual change is likely to occur when students are asked to clarify, explain, and defend their own ideas. This is consistent 541 with Schwarz et al. (2000), whom suggested that the knowledge construction tasks will be more effective if students engaged in peer argumentation. According to Nussbaum and Sinatra (2003), while constructing a scientific argument, individuals need to consider both sides of the argument, explain aspects of the problem that are anomalous to their existing conceptions, and confront with the discrepancies between their points of views. These actions will allow students to engage in the process of deep thinking about the alternative concepts, and subsequently rebut the alternative frameworks and change their conception. Furthermore, by considering the three levels of scientific representation, students will form a better understanding of the concepts (Beall et al., 1994; Bucat and Mocerino, 2009; Johnstone, 1991), which assists the process of conceptual change. As stated by Bucat and Mocerino (2009), the sub microscopic level should be knitted into the observable macroscopic and symbolic levels of representation to enhance the understanding of chemistry concepts. However, are our students able to link all the three levels of representation in order to achieve conceptual change? Thus, this study examines conceptual changes in scientific argumentation through guided group settings. METHODOLOGY This descriptive study involved fourth form science students in the district of Pasir Gudang, Johor, Malaysia. Two instruments, the Open-ended Scientific Argumentation Test 1 and 2 (OSAT 1 & 2) were first developed based on the fourth form chemistry syllabus. Both instruments consisted of similar questions related to neutralization and the properties of acids and bases. In the instrument, information about the phenomenon being studied and diagrams were provided to assist students in answering the questions. After seven lessons of acids and bases, students were 542 first asked to answer the OSAT 1 in the time allocated. The arguments constructed in the answers were assessed based on their accuracy and the three levels of representation in chemistry. If the argument consisted of alternative framework in any of the argumentation elements, that argument will be considered as non-scientific. On the other hand, any argument with the correct concepts and without any alternative framework will be classified as scientific argument. Thirty two (32) students who have constructed different arguments were then selected by using purposive sampling to go through a guided group argumentation. Guided by a researcher (McNeil et al., 2006), each group consisted of two students who mastered the scientific concepts and two students with alternative frameworks (Webb, 1985). According to Osborne et al. (2004), the characteristic of this combination is essential to create cognitive conflict among group members, which will trigger scientific argumentation. In groups, students were guided and encouraged to explain their arguments constructed, and to relate them to the three levels of representation. The argumentation processes were also recorded, transcribed and analyzed. Students were then asked to answer the OSAT 2 and the arguments constructed were re-assessed to compare the mastery of scientific argumentation before and after the guided group argumentation. RESULTS AND DISCUSSION Mastery of Scientific Argumentation The findings show that almost all of the students involved have changed their existing alternative frameworks to the correct scientific concepts after following guided group argumentation. As shown in Figure 1, only 7.14% of arguments constructed by students have alternative frameworks. Besides, content analysis shows that these students experienced alternative frameworks at the sub microscopic level but provided appropriate scientific 543 concepts at the macroscopic level. This indicates that scientific argumentation especially in guided group setting promotes conceptual change (Aydeniz et al., 2012; Nussbaum and Sinatra, 2003; Nussbaum, 2011). 100.0 92.86 100 80 60 Scientific 40 20 7.14 0.0 Non Scientific 0 Before After Figure 1 Comparison of students’ mastery of scientific argumentation before and after guided group argumentation Construction of Scientific Arguments at Macroscopic, Sub microscopic and Symbolic Level Table 1 shows that all students involved in guided group argumentation could construct claim and evidence with correct scientific concepts. The element of reasoning constructed is mostly at macroscopic and sub microscopic level (57.15%). Furthermore, the arguments constructed did consist of the element rebuttal although the percentage is lower that other elements. The results suggest that guided group argumentation not only changed students’ alternative frameworks to appropriate concepts, it also improved the quality of the arguments that are constructed (Aydeniz et al, 2012; Nussbaum, 2011). These findings corroborate with Cross et al. (2008) that involved in scientific argumentation help students to reflect on their existing ideas and eventually eliminate the alternative frameworks that 544 exist. Content analysis also shows that the scientific arguments constructed were accurate in terms of the scientific concepts and complex in terms of the argumentation structure. Moreover, there are also arguments which showed the link between the three levels of representation. This suggests that students possessed deep and holistic scientific knowledge in the concepts being studied (Beall et al., 1994; Bucat and Mocerino, 2009). Table 1 Comparison of students’ mastery of argumentation elements before and after guided group argumentation (%) 56.25 50.00 Before Non Scientific (%) 43.75 50.00 0.00 0.00 12.5 71.88 0.00 9.37 0.00 0.00 12.50 18.75 3.12 0.00 84.38 81.25 60.71 53.57 0.00 0.00 39.29 46.43 3.12 0.00 0.00 18.75 0.00 0.00 78.13 14.29 21.43 32.14 0.00 0.00 0.00 28.57 0.00 0.00 3.57 0.00 Scientific Element Claim Evidence Reasoning: Macro only Sub micro only Macro and sub micro Macro, sub micro and symbol Rebuttal: Alternatif claim Alternatif evidence Alternatif reasoning: Macro only Submicroonly Macro and sub micro Macro, sub micro and symbol No answer (%) 0.00 0.00 Scientific (%) 100.00 100.00 After Non Scientific (%) 0.00 0.00 6.25 7.14 3.57 57.15 0.00 0.00 7.14 25.00 0.00 No answer (%) 0.00 0.00 0.00 Based on Table 1, more than half of the arguments constructed did include the element rebuttal. Thus, the arguments presented are considered complex and with high quality since rebuttal is seen as a quality indicator (Erduran, 2007; Osborne et al., 2004; von Aufschnaiter et al., 2008). However, a few students constructed simple arguments with mostly macroscopic level, but sub microscopic level with alternative frameworks, and without the element rebuttal. These results align with the findings by Dindar and Geban (2011) which reported that alternative frameworks are difficult to eliminate. Thus, it is clear that 545 scientific argumentation could promote conceptual change which is driven by the efforts of students to construct evidence, reasoning and rebuttal at the macroscopic, sub microscopic and symbolic levels. Hence, it requires in-depth explanation of the thinking process that occurs in students’ scientific argumentation scheme. Conceptual Change in Scientific Argumentation Scheme Figure 2 shows the conceptual change in scientific argumentation scheme of students involved in guided group argumentation. 1. Construct claims with supporting evidence / explanation (Constructing initial claim) 2. Support claim with reasoning at macro, sub micro and symbolic levels (Deep thinking) 7. Restructuring claim with reasoning at three levels of representation (Changing alternative framework to scientific concept) 3. Consider alternative claim with explanations (Challenges alternative claim) 6. Present condition and criteria for the claim to be valid (Presenting additional information) 4. Evaluate alternative claim at three levels of representation (Deep thinking) 5. Compare initial claim with alternative claim (Awareness of alternative frameworks) Figure 2 Conceptual change in scientific argumentation scheme Based on Figure 2, students involved in comparing and evaluating the two alternative concepts at the macroscopic, sub microscopic and symbolic levels which led to cognitive conflicts. Through the process of deep thinking, students aware of their alternative frameworks and replaced it with appropriate scientific concepts. This conceptual change enables students to understand the scientific concepts completely and subsequently 546 enhance their mastery of related concepts. These findings are in line with several studies which reported that argumentation in group setting can be used as a tool for conceptual change (Asterhan et al., 2009; Aydeniz et al., 2012; Nussbaum, 2011; von Aufschnaiters et al., 2008) and to eliminate alternative frameworks (Cross et al., 2008). CONCLUSION This study showed that conceptual changes occur when students construct scientific arguments that link between the macroscopic, sub microscopic, and symbolic levels of representations. While constructing arguments in a group setting, students tended to elaborate their pre-existing ideas in a social context, thus providing opportunities to their peers to evaluate the rationality and accuracy of the ideas, as well as to provide feedback (Aydeniz et al., 2012). The study also showed that the process of deep thinking about the two alternative concepts at the three levels of representation helped with conceptual changes. It was observed that students tend to restructure and accommodate these conceptions to discover and accept the alternative conception, if it is intelligible, plausible and fruitful (Posner et al., 1982). Hence, the teaching and learning of science need to focus on group argumentation and incorporate the linkage between the macroscopic, sub microscopic, and symbolic representations (Tsai, 1999; Wu, 2003) to promote meaningful learning and to ensure students’ understanding of scientific concepts (Jaber and BouJaoude, 2012). REFERENCE Amigues, R. 1988. Peer interaction in solving physics problems: Sociocognitive confrontation and metacognitive aspects. Journal of Experimental Child Psychology, 45(1): 141-158. 547 Asterhan, C. S. C. and Schwarz, B. B. 2009. Argumentation and explanation in conceptual change: Indications from protocol analyses of peer-to-peer dialog. Cognitive Science, 33: 374400. Aydeniz, M., Pabuccu, A., Cetin, P. S. and Kaya, E. 2012. Argumentation and students’ conceptual understanding of properties and behaviors of gases. International Journal of Science and Mathematics Education, 19:1303-1324. Beall, H., Trimbur, J., and Weininger, S. J. 1994. Mastery insight and the teaching of chemistry. Journal of Science Education and Technology, 3(2): 99-105. Bucat, B., and Mocerino, M. 2009. Learning at the sub-micro level: Structural representations. In J. K. Gilbert and D. Treagust (Eds.), Multiple representations in chemical education (pp.1129). Dordrecht, the Netherlands: Springer. Cross, D., Taasoobshirazi, D., Hendricks, S. and Hickey, D. T. 2008. Argumentation: A strategy for improving achievement and revealing scientific identities. International Journal of Science Education, 30(6): 837–861. Dindar A. C. and Geban, O. 2011. Development of a three-tier test to assess high school students’ understanding of acids and bases. Procedia Social and Behavioral Sciences,15: 600-604. Erduran, S. 2007. Methodological foundations in the study of argumentation in science classrooms. In S. Erduran and M. P. Jiménez-Aleixandre (Eds.), Argumentation in science education: Perspectives from classroom-based research (pp. 47-70). Dordrecht, the Netherlands: Springer. Jaber, L. Z., and BouJaoude, S. 2012. A macro-micro-symbolic teaching to promote relational understanding of chemical reactions. International Journal of Science Education, 34(7), 973-998. Johnstone, A. H. 1991. Why is science difficult to learn? Things are seldom what they seem. Journal of Computer Assisted Learning, 7(2): 75-83. Kendeou, P. and Broeck, P.V. 2007. The effects of prior knowledge and text structure on comprehension processes during reading of scientific texts. Memory and Cognition, 35(7): 1567. Mason, L. 1996. An analysis of children’s construction of new knowledge through their use of reasoning and arguing in 548 classroom discussions. Qualitative Studies in Education, 9(4): 411-433. McNeill, K. L., Lizotte, D. J., Krajcik, J. and Marx, R. W. 2006. Supporting students’ construction of scientific explanations by fading scaffolds in instructional materials. The Journal of the Learning Sciences, 15(2): 153–191. Nussbaum, E. M and Sinatra, G. M. 2003. Argument and conceptual engagement. Contemporary Educational Psychology, 28(3): 384-395. Nussbaum, E. M. 2011. Argumentation, dialogue theory, and probability modeling: Alternative frameworks for argumentation research in education. Educational Psychologist, 46(2): 84-106. Osborne, J., Erduran, S. and Simon, S. 2004. Enhancing the quality of argumentation in school science. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 41(10): 994-1020. Posner, G. J., Strike, K. A., Hewson, P. W. and Gertzog, W. A. 1982. Accommodation of a scientific conception: Toward a theory of conceptual change. Science Education, 66: 221-227. Sadler, T. D. 2004. Informal reasoning regarding socio scientific issues: A critical review of research. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 41(5): 513-536. Schwarz, B. B., Neuman, Y., and Biezuner, S. 2000. Two wrongs may make a right…if they argue together! Cognition & Instruction, 18: 461-494. Tsai, C. C. 1999. Overcoming junior high school students’ misconceptions about microscopic views of phase change: A study of an analogy activity. Journal of Science Education and Technology, 8 (1): 83-91. von Aufschnaiter, C, Erduran, S., Osborne, J and Simon, S. 2008. Arguing to learn and learning to argue: Case studies of how students’ argumentation relates to their scientific knowledge. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 45(1): 101-131. Webb, N. M. 1985. Verbal interaction and learning in peer-directed groups. Theory into Practice, 24 (1): 32-39. Wu, H. K. 2003. Linking the microscopic view of chemistry to reallife experiences: Inter textuality in a high-school science classroom. Science Education, 87: 868-891. Zohar, A. and Nemet, F. 2002. Fostering students' knowledge and 549 argumentation skills through dilemmas in human genetics. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 39(1): 35-62. 550 CONCEPT MAP AS AN ALTERNATIVE ASSESSMENT IN LABORATORY ACTIVITIES Intan Baizura A Ghani, Noraffandy Yahaya, Nor Hasniza Ibrahim, Mohamed Noor Hasan ABSTRACT Transformation of 21st century education emphasized in-depth knowledge and improve students' higher-order thinking skills. The main purpose of doing laboratory activities in Chemistry is for the students to gain deep understanding and is one of the activities that can stimulate higher cognitive skills. In addition, assessment is also one of the key elements that essential in stimulating higherorder thinking skills of students. Accordingly, the Malaysian Educational Development Plan 2013-2025 also emphasizes the importance of a holistic assessment to be conducted on the process of teaching and learning as an effort to help students improve their thinking on a higher level. However, students are always found not able to integrate the laboratory activities performed with the concepts and theories that should be mastered from the activity. Furthermore, the traditional assessment tool such as laboratory reports only provide students with low level thinking skills. Therefore, an alternative assessment strategy namely concept map is selected to be used in this study. This is because the concept map has been reported in previous studies serve as a metacognitive tool which are able to generate a better understanding of the concepts 551 and can stimulate higher-order thinking skills of the students. Keywords : Laboratory Activities, Alternative Assessment, Concept Map, High Order Thinking Skills, Understanding INTRODUCTION The rapid development of the world's technological advances, economy competition, scientific innovation generally have claim to the transformation of the educational system as a whole (Koh, Tan, Ng, 2012). The transformation done in science, math, technology and engineering in the 21st century is emphasized to the formation of students who can demonstrate higher thinking skills with confidence, such as critical thinking and creative, innovative thinking and problem solving (Evren, Bati & Yilmaz, 2012). This is of concern not only to provide a workforce that is ready to compete at the global level, but more importantly for the development of self as individuals more successful (Ministry of education, 2012). Extensive changes in terms of curriculum, pedagogy and assessment system is needed to ensure that the education transformation was successful (Koh, Tan, Ng, 2012). In this regard, through the Malaysian educational development plan 20132025, the Ministry will undertake implementation of integrated curriculum and conducting a holistic assessment with an emphasis on in-depth knowledge and higher-order thinking skills of students in the assessment system and in particular (Ministry of education, 2012). THE IMPORTANCE OF ASSESSMENT ACTIVITIES OF TEACHING AND LEARNING PROCESS Assessment of students' ideas and conceptual understanding is the core of the curriculum, as well as learning and teaching 552 environment activities (Ruiz Primo et al, 2001; Kaya, 2008; Bak Kibar, Yemen & Ayas, 2013). The role of assessment for teaching and learning activities is not only to determine the marks or grades of students, but rather to improve the quality of teaching and learning activities itself (Kumaran & Sankar, 2013). Many experts in the field of education assessment and learning theories agree that evaluation is part of the process of teaching, and assessment activities should be used to support and assist students ' learning in the classroom teaching and learning process from day to day (Shepard 2000; Koh, Tan, Ng, 2012). Appropriate assessment activities should be done to acquire high-level thinking skills process than just the basic skills and knowledge. In addition, the assessment is important in identifying problems of students’ science and mathematics learning, helping to overcome the problem in making the learning and teaching process more appropriate (İngeç, 2009). If the teacher does not build the test according to the procedures for the correct measurement, information about students ' level of mastery of a concept is likely to be less accurate. Such things can not be the result of an assessment used for the purpose of improving teaching and learning in the classroom (Phang, Abu Ali & Ali, 2012). The issue is, does the practice of teaching, learning and assessment strategies of science laboratory activities nowadays provide in-depth understanding to encourage high-level thinking skills of students? In reality, assessment and evaluation in science laboratory has been continuously carried out using traditional methods such as laboratory reports and quizzes (Hofstein & Lunetta, 2004; Kaya, 2008; Dogan & Kaya, 2009; Özmen, DemİrcİoĞlu, & Coll, 2007; Bak Kibar et al., 2013). The traditional method has been questioned because of the less favorable active participation of students in the assessment process and provide students with low-level thinking skills (Zoller & Pushkin, 2007; Dochy, Segers, Van den Bossche, & Gijbels, 2003; Dogan & Kaya, 2009). Traditional or conventional assessments of student learning outcomes are generally focused on the production of knowledge of facts and skills of a student alone (Koh, Tan, & 553 Ng, 2012). One of the assessment strategy that have the potential to measure the level of understanding of the students and be able to stimulate higher-order thinking skills of students is a concept map (Ruiz-primo & Shavelson, 2001; Kaya, 2008) CONCEPT MAP AS AN ALTERNATIVE ASSESSMENT A variety of alternative assessment tools that have been used in many science education studies include posters, portfolio, concept map, vee map, and integration of ICT (Aksela, 2005). However, one alternative assessment tool that has been widely recognized in improving students' conceptual understanding is the use of concept maps (Bak Kibar et al., 2013; Ruiz-primo & Shavelson, 2010; Kaya, 2008; Moni & Moni, 2008; Harris & Zha, 2013). Previous studies also have linked the concept map with the higher-order thinking skills (Moni & Moni, 2008; Kumaran & Sankar, 2013; Bramwor-lalaor et al, 2014). In addition, many previous research have also discussed about the importance of concept map in chemistry education (eg Markow & Lonning, 1998; Aksela, 2005; Kaya, 2008, Theodoros vachliotis, Katerina Salta, Petroula Vasiliou, 2011; Correia, 2012; Bak Kibar et al., 2013). Concept map is a visual thinking tool that was developed by Joseph Novak and his colleagues at Cornell University in 1979. The development of a concept map requires students to organize their thoughts on the concepts learned by writing or labelling the relationship between these concepts. This visual graphic can represent students with a deep conceptual understanding thus helps students to critically evaluate their own ideas and to compare their ideas with other students. It also provides opportunities for teachers to assess understanding, conceptions and misconceptions of students on the topic of learning (Novak, 2010). Students who are experiencing deep learning will produce a concept map that has more new concepts, more links and branches compared to students who experience rote learning This is in line with the findings made by Hilbert & Renkl (2008) in which more 554 accurate labelled links can be generated, more effective knowledge can be integrated. Martin (2011) emphasizes the importance of the relationship between the maximum concepts that can be produced during the construction of the concept map because it gives the best impression of a deep understanding. Three types of concept maps that ‘spoke’, ‘chain’ and ‘net’ have been identified by Kinchin, Hay, and Adams (2000) in his study, where he concluded that the concept map in the form of net (with the most level of the hierarchy than the others) is more representative of the presence of meaningful learning. In addition, the construction of a concept map is also regarded as a strategy to facilitate the students to develop critical and creative thinking (Harris & Zha, 2013), as well as promoting higher level of cognitive process if its construction is done correctly (Novak, 2010). Concept map allows the assessment of high-level cognitive development (Kinchin et al., 2000) in Bloom's taxonomy, especially when students have to pick and choose the most appropriate linking phrase during its construction (Kumaran & Sankar, 2013). The use of linking phrases to describe the relationship between the concepts has made concept map better than the other visual graphics techniques to translate knowledge and information (Correia, 2012). According to Hilbert & Renkl (2008), the cognitive processes that occur during concept maps’ construction related to the effective learning is through two processes, namely, the process of labelling the relationship between the two concepts (construction of the linking phrase) and the process of planning and controlling the process of construction. Students will express difficulty to label the line that connects the two concepts if they don't understand the relationship that exists between the two concepts as well as the correct word to characterize the relationship between these concepts. . If students have already started to focus on producing words that can characterize the relationship between the two concepts, they will begin to see the relationship between all the concepts to determine the most appropriate cross link. This process involves a high cognitive level (Bloom, 1956), known as 555 evaluation and synthesis of knowledge (Novak, 2010). Many studies have diversified the concept mapping technique that can be used to show students ' cognitive structure. According to Ruiz Primo (1996), assessment using concept maps can be categorized based on how much information can be given to a student by a teacher who refers to the degree of directedness. Figure 1 shows the degree of directedness involved in the construction of the concept map-based assessment. Degree of directedness Element of a concept map High Low Provided by Concept Assessor/Teacher Student Linking line Assessor/Teacher Student Linking phrase Assessor/Teacher Student Map structure Assessor/Teacher Student Table 1: Degree of directedness involved in the construction of a concept map by Ruiz Primo et al. (1996) Type of concept map can be classified into a continuous range of map that has a high degree of directedness to a low degree of directedness. Concept map that has the highest degree of directedness means the students have been provided with the concept, connecting lines, phrases and structure maps relationships while concept map that has a low degree of directedness allows students to decide for themselves how many of the concepts that should be used and how these concepts are related. Low degree of directedness of a concept map is said to be able to foster and evaluate the higher level of students thinking (Yin, Vanides, RuizPrimo, Ayala & Shavelson, 2005). Giving those elements to students only will prevent the spread of knowledge and understanding of the student, thus contributing to low cognitive skills (Kaya, 2008). Concept map is a good assessment tool, able to give an 556 overview of a students' prior knowledge before studying a unit or topic, as well as formative assessment that occurs during learning activities (Kumaran & Sankar, 2013). When students are creating or translating a concept map, the new knowledge will exist and then assimilated into the students' prior knowledge. It can also provide a clearer picture of the structure of knowledge which is built in the mind of a student than traditional assessment tools (Soika, Reiska, & Mikser, 2010). According to Stoddart, Abrams, Gasper, & Canaday (2000), concept map has been chosen as an alternative assessment tool because it can be used in a wide scope of fields and at all levels of students. Therefore, it is appropriate to use concept maps as an assessment tool for teaching and learning (Novak,1990; Slotte & Lonka, 1999; Kinchin et. al., 2000; Kaya, 2008; Özmen et al., 2009; Bramwell lalor et al., 2014). In addition, the concept map has also been reported to improve students ' abilities in problem solving, and help for collaborative learning (Moni Moni, 2008), making this strategy is very suitable to use in laboratory activities, which often involve group activities. Furthermore, the characteristics of concept maps as a very suitable strategy to promote students' conceptual understanding in science and chemistry in particular (Bunce, Francisco, Nakhleh, Nurrenbern, & Miller, 2002; Aydin, Aydemir, Boz, Cetin-Dindar, & Bektas, 2009) can help students make conceptual connections during learning activities conducted in laboratory (Markow & Lonning, 1998; Özmen et al., 2009) CONCLUSION The discussion above leads to the selection of concept map as a potential strategy to assess and promote the exploration of deep understanding thus helps in stimulating higher-order thinking skills of students in laboratory activities. Therefore, it is appropriate for this study to be conducted in order to contribute in the search for alternative learning strategies and assessments that can be applied in the transformation of the curriculum of the 21st century. This is 557 important to produce individuals who are knowledgeable in depth and have the skills of higher order thinking to be competitive in an era of a more challenging world. RUJUKAN Aksela, M. (2005). Supporting Meaningful Chemistry Learning and Higher-order Thinking through Computer-Assisted Inquiry : A Design Research Approach. Aydin, S., Aydemir, N., Boz, Y., Cetin-Dindar, A., & Bektas, O. (2009). The Contribution of Constructivist Instruction Accompanied by Concept Mapping in Enhancing Pre-service Chemistry Teachers’ Conceptual Understanding of Chemistry in the Laboratory Course. Journal of Science Education and Technology, 18(6), 518–534. Bak Kibar, Z., Yaman, F., & Ayas, A. (2013). Assessing prospective chemistry teachers’ understanding of gases through qualitative and quantitative analyses of their concept maps. Chemistry Education Research and Practice, 14(4), 542. Bloom, B. S., & Krathwohl, D. R. (1956). Taxonomy of educational objectives: The classification of educational goals. Handbook I: Cognitive domain. Bramwell-Lalor, S., & Rainford, M. (2014). The Effects of Using Concept Mapping for Improving Advanced Level Biology Students’ Lower- and Higher-Order Cognitive Skills. International Journal of Science Education, 36(5), 839–864. Bunce, D. M., Francisco, J. S., Nakhleh, M. B., Nurrenbern, S. C., & Miller, M. L. (2002). Assessing Student Understanding of General Chemistry with Concept Mapping, 79(2). Correia, P. R. M. (2012). The use of concept maps for knowledge management: from classrooms to research labs. Analytical and Bioanalytical Chemistry, 402(6), 1979–86. Dochy, F., Segers, M., Van den Bossche, P., & Gijbels, D. (2003). Effects of problem-based learning: A meta-analysis. Learning and instruction, 13(5), 533-568 Doğan, A., & Kaya, O. N. (2009). Poster sessions as an authentic assessment approach in an open-Ended University general chemistry laboratory. Procedia-Social and Behavioral Sciences, 1(1), 829-833 558 Evren, A., Bati, K., & Yilmaz, S. (2012). The effect of using v-diagrams in science and technology laboratory, 46, 2267–2272. Harris, C. M., & Zha, S. (2013). Concept Mapping: A Critical Thinking Technique. Education, 134(2), 207-211 Hilbert, T. S., & Renkl, Æ. A. (2008). Concept mapping as a follow-up strategy to learning from texts : what characterizes good and poor mappers ?, 53–73. İngeç, Ş. K. (2009). Analysing Concept Maps as an Assessment Tool in Teaching Physics and Comparison with the Achievement Tests. International Journal of Science Education, 31(14), 1897–1915. Kaya, O. N. (2008). A Student-centred Approach: Assessing the Changes in Prospective Science Teachers’ Conceptual Understanding by Concept Mapping in a General Chemistry Laboratory. Research in Science Education, 38(1), 91–110. Kinchin, I. M., Hay, D. B., & Adams, A. (2000). How a qualitative approach to concept map analysis can be used to aid learning by illustrating patterns of conceptual development. Educational Research, 42(1), 43–57. Koh, K. H., Tan, C., & Ng, P. T. (2012). Creating thinking schools through authentic assessment: the case in Singapore. Educational Assessment, Evaluation and Accountability, 24(2), 135–149. Kumaran, V. S., & Sankar, A. (2013). An Automated Assessment of Students ’ Learning in e-Learning Using Concept Map and Ontology. Springer, 274–283. Markow, P. G., & Lonning, R. A. (1998). Usefulness of Concept Maps in College Chemistry Laboratories : Students ’ Perceptions and Effects on Achievement. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 35(9), 1015–1029. Martin, D. (2011). Elementary science methods: A constructivist approach. Cengage Learning. Ministry of Education. (2012). Malaysian educational development plan 2013-2025. Ministry of education (pp. 1–268). Moni, R. W., & Moni, K. B. (2008). Student perceptions and use of an assessment rubric for a group concept map in physiology, 47–54. Novak, J. D. (1990). Concept maps and Vee diagrams: Two metacognitive tools to facilitate meaningful learning. Instructional science, 19(1), 29-52 Novak, J. D. (2010). Learning, creating, and using knowledge: Concept maps as facilitative tools in schools and corporations. Routledge 559 Özmen, H., DemİrcİoĞlu, Gö., & Coll, R. K. (2009). A comparative study of the effects of a concept mapping enhanced laboratory experience on Turkish high school students’ understanding of acidbase chemistry. International Journal of Science and Mathematics Education, 7(1), 1–24. Phang, F. A., Abu, M. S., Ali, M. B., & Salleh, S. (2012). Faktor penyumbang kepada kemerosostan pelajar dalam aliran sains: satu analisis sorotan tesis. In eprints utm (p. 17). Retrieved from http://www.medc.com.my/medc/seminar_medc/fromCD/pd... Ruiz-primo, M. A., & Shavelson, R. J. (2010). On the Validity of Cognitive Interpretations of Scores From Alternative ConceptMapping Techniques, (May 2014), 37–41. Ruiz‐Primo, M. A., Schultz, S. E., Li, M., & Shavelson, R. J. (2001). Comparison of the reliability and validity of scores from two concept‐mapping techniques*. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 38(2), 260-278. Ruiz-Primo, M. A., Shavelson, R. J., & Schultz, S. E. (1997). On The Validity Of Concept Map-Base Assessment Interpretations: An Experiment Testing The Assumption Of Hierarchical Concept Maps In Science (Vol. 6511). Shepard, L. A., & Sheppard, L. A. (2000). The role of classroom assessment in teaching and learning. Slotte, V., & Lonka, K. (1999). Spontaneous concept maps aiding the understanding of scientific concepts. International Journal of Science Education, 21(5), 515–531. Soika, K., Reiska, P., & Mikser, R. (2010). The importance of animation as a visual method in learning chemistry. Stoddart, T., Abrams, R., Gasper, E., & Canaday, D. (2000). Concept maps as assessment in science inquiry learning - a report of methodology. International Journal of Science Education, 22(12), 1221–1246. Theodoros vachliotis, Katerina Salta, Petroula Vasiliou, C. T. (2011). Exploring Novel Tools for Assessing High School Students’ Meaningful Understanding of Organic Reactions. Chemical Education, 88(3), 337–345. Yin, Y., Vanides, J., Ruiz-Primo, M. A., Ayala, C. C., & Shavelson, R. J. (2005). Comparison of two concept-mapping techniques: Implications for scoring, interpretation, and use. Journal of Research in Science Teaching, 42(2), 166–184. 560 Zoller, U., & Pushkin, D. (2007). Matching Higher-Order Cognitive Skills (HOCS) promotion goals with problem-based laboratory practice in a freshman organic chemistry course. Chemistry Education Research and Practice, 8(2), 153. 561 QUANTITATIVE RESEARCH ON EDUCATION FOR SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT (ESD) PRACTICES AMONG MALAYSIAN POLYTECHNICS Crystal Joan Peter, Wilfredo Herrera Libunao ABSTRACT This study was conducted to determine how far ESD is being implemented in Malaysian TVET system. The instrument selected was based on the Sustainability Assessment Questionnaire (SAQ) developed by University Leaders for a Sustainable Future (ULSF). The respondents for this study were 115 lecturers of 11 polytechnics in Malaysia. Data was collected using a Likert-type ordinal scale, some nominal, and yes-no questions, then analysed using descriptive statistics using Statistical Package for the Social Sciences (SPSS). Research finding shows that polytechnics in Malaysia are still not fully committed to ESD. The inclusion of sustainability in polytechnics curriculum is still in its initial stage. Sustainability is only incorporated on programmes/courses that are directly related to sustainability such as: Civil Engineering; Mechanical Engineering and Hospitality and Tourism. The participation of faculty, staff and students in research and scholarship in sustainability areas are not notable. In the area of operations, polytechnics do not have high commitment to 562 sustainability. Faculty and staff in polytechnics are not being given the opportunities to enhance their understanding, research and teaching in sustainability. Polytechnics’ involvement in sustainability related issues are low, and there is no student group directly involved in sustainability initiatives. However, the polytechnics’ commitment to promote SD at the institutional mission level can be seen with the existence of positions and committees related to sustainability in the institutions. Keywords : Education For Sustainability, Polytechnic, TVET Sustainable Development, INTRODUCTION Education for Sustainable Development (ESD) is a contentious concept that has been present in many official agendas at higher education institutions (HEI) for more than a decade. Many higher education institutions have already recognized that they must play a role in creating a more sustainable future. However, because there is a general lack of adequate conditions, the progress on campuses has not been as fast as expected (Velazquez, Munguia & Sanchez, 2005). ESD can be defined as ‘the use of education as a tool to achieve sustainability’ (McKeown, Hopkins, Rizi, 2002). Sustainable development according to Gustavo (2000) occurs when we acknowledge the relationship between human needs and the natural environment. Thus, sustainable development (SD) can be best described as ‘a development that meets the needs of the present without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs’ (Brundtland Report, 1987). ESD was first described in Chapter 36 of Agenda 21. Adopted by the 1992 Earth Summit, Agenda 21 emphasizes that human population; consumption and technology are the primary driving forces of environmental change. Agenda 21 states that ‘education is critical for promoting sustainable development and 563 improving the capacity of all people to address environment and development issues’. The impact of sustainable development in higher education institutions is greatly bigger than the impact of any other single sector of society. This is because universities and polytechnics are the place where they educate the next generation of decisionmakers and influencers, and also the centres of research and development activities. Studies about ESD in Higher Education have been done in developed countries like Russia, USA, United Kingdom, Sweden, and Germany for years. Garcia (2010) stated that studies assessing the status of ESD in HEI have been performed by private and public organizations in developed countries. Unfortunately, in developing countries, this type of studies is limited. In Malaysia for example, there has been no recorded study to determine the implementation of ESD in the polytechnics. This study therefore was conducted to know whether if ESD is being practiced in Malaysian TVET system, especially in polytechnics. TVET AND SUSTAINABLE DEVELOPMENT TVET is an effective education and training system that provide skills training and produce competitive human capital worldwide. Being a major supplier of workforce for the industries, TVET plays a significant role in implementing and promoting sustainable development. In achieving the sustainable development, TVET can be a leading education and training by creating awareness and promoting sustainable development in its daily practices. Sustainable development consists of three pillars; economic, socio-cultural, and environmental development. Paryono (2010) explained that to incorporate the three pillars, there are many roles TVET institutions can play, for example; create a new green technology that not only economically feasible but also at the same time environmentally-friendly. 564 HIGHER EDUCATION DEVELOPMENT AND SUSTAINABLE Universities and other higher education institutes create bridges between knowledge generation and application of this knowledge in society through the process of education, outreach and service to community and region. There are several ways for universities and higher education institutes can contribute to sustainable development: (i) By giving sustainable development a place in all university curricular and educational and research program. (ii) By playing an important role as a local knowledge centers for sustainable development in order to help society meet the challenge of sustainable development at the local level. (iii) By making sustainable development a leading principle in their own logistics and managerial processes. However, according to Calder and Clugston (2003), there are seven critical dimensions in universities activities that need to be addressed when considering sustainability issues, as follows: 1. Curriculum 2. Research and Scholarship 3. Operation 4. Faculty and Staff Hiring, Development & Rewards 5. Outreach and Service 6. Student Opportunities 7. Institutional Mission, Structure and Planning METHODOLOGY This research was pursued using quantitative research design using survey questionnaire. A total of 20 polytechnics were involved in this study, and using the sample size formula published by the National Education Association (Krejcie & Morgan, 1970), 361 respondents were drawn from the 20 polytechnics. Lecturers of polytechnics in Malaysia were chosen as 565 respondents because they meet the criteria to answer the Sustainability Assessment Questionnaire (SAQ) which is about the seven dimensions of ESD (Curriculum; Research and Scholarship; Operations; Faculty and Staff Development and Rewards; Outreach and Service; Student Opportunities; and Institutional Mission and Planning). Nasir A.R (2002) reported in his study that the job scope of polytechnic lecturers are not only teaching, but also includes clerical duties, managing, doing research and other common duties of lecturers. The instrument used for this study was based on The Sustainability Assessment Questionnaire (SAQ) designed by the University Leaders for a Sustainable Future (ULSF). The questionnaire was further modified under Malaysian context and pretested to ascertain its validity and reliability. The modified research instrument has undergone an expert validation process. The research instrument was reviewed /checked and approved by three lecturers from the Department of Technical and Engineering, Faculty of Education, Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. After experts approved the research instrument, a pilot study was conducted at Polytechnic Melaka with 15 respondents that are not involved with the actual study. To test the level of reliability of the instrument, the Internal Consistency Method was used. This process was done by using the statistic test Alpha-Cronbach in SPSS software. The Cronbach’s Alpha value for the questionnaire is 0.873. RESULTS AND DISCUSSION The study was initially designed to involve 20 polytechnics, however nine polytechnics did not participate. Moreover, out of 361 questionnaires distributed, only 115 were returned, accounting for a return rate of 31.85%. This return rate is still acceptable for online and mail administered survey research according to International Assessment Resources (2007) of the University of Texas. The relatively low return or participation rate could be due 566 to: a) research fatigue among polytechnic lecturers; b) the time allotted (three weeks) for them to accomplish and return the questionnaires may not be enough; and c) low level of respondents’ familiarity with the research topic (ESD and sustainable development) as could be gleaned from their responses to the survey questions. Research fatigue can be said to occur when individuals and groups become tired of engaging with research and it can be identified by a demonstration of reluctance toward continuing engagement with an existing project, or a refusal to engage with any further research (Clark, 2008). Implementation of Seven Dimension of ESD This section will present the integration of ESD in seven higher education sustainability education. Curriculum Assessment The area for curriculum assessment measured the extent to which the polytechnics address the topic of ESD in their curriculum. The individual item mean scores were first transformed into total mean scores and later categorized into five levels, which formed as basis for interpreting the data in Table 5.1: Don’t know (mean score 0.51-1.5), not included (mean score 1.51-2.5), in few courses (mean score 2.51-3.5), in a number of courses (mean score 3.514.5) and in almost all courses (mean score 4.51-5.5). Table 1 shows that the overall mean value is 2.83 which indicate that ESD are included in polytechnics curriculum but only in few courses. Table 1: Inclusion of Sustainability in Curriculum No Item Mean Equivalent Adjectival Rating* SD 567 6. Institution offer courses 3.01 related to sustainability 7. Faculty offers programme/courses related to 2.99 sustainability 8. Sustainability concepts 2.46 embedded in existing courses Overall mean 2.83 *Extent of sustainability inclusion in curriculum In few courses 1.03 In few courses 0.96 Not included 0.99 In few courses The findings indicate that polytechnics in Malaysia barely addressed the topic of ESD in their curriculum. This further affirms McKeown’s (2002) observation regarding structuring and placing ESD in the curriculum. She pointed out that in some communities, ESD will be ignored and in others, it will be barely addressed. Although they are trying to teach their students about the basic values and core assumptions that shape the content and methods of the academic disciplines, it is still not enough. Research and Scholarship This area of assessment measured the participation of faculty, staff and students in research and scholarship in areas of sustainability. The individual item mean scores were first transformed into total mean scores and later categorized into five levels, which formed as basis for interpreting the data in Table 2: Don’t know (mean score 0.51-1.5), not taught and researched (mean score 1.51-2.5), taught and researched a little bit (mean score 2.51-3.5), taught and researched quite a bit (mean score 3.51-4.5) and fully taught and researched (mean score 4.51-5.5). Table 2: Teaching and Research in Sustainability Areas No. Item Mean 11. Research being done by staff in the area of sustainability Students research in 2.5 12. 2.2 Equivalent Adjectival Rating* Not taught and researched Not taught and SD 1.02 0.98 568 sustainability area Faculty members teach or do research on sustainability 13. 14. Faculty members interested in teaching and research on sustainability area Overall mean 2.8 3.0 2.67 researched Taught and researched a little bit Taught and researched a little bit Taught and researched a bit 1.90 1.80 * Extent to which sustainability is taught and researched Table 2 presents the teaching and research efforts in the area of sustainability. The overall mean of 2.67 indicates that there is little effort being done by the polytechnics in integrating sustainability in teaching and research. Table 3: Weaknesses of polytechnics for implementing ESD Weaknesses Lack of promotion Lack of sustainability knowledge among staff Lack of resources Lack of institutional support Too little research Total Frequency 8 4 3 1 1 17 Research and scholarship in sustainability areas are not so popular in polytechnics in Malaysia. The results also show that there are no research being done by staff and students in the area of sustainability. Results also revealed that only few faculty members teach sustainability. This may be due to lack of knowledge in sustainability area, lack of resources and lack of institutional support (see table 3). Operations This area of assessment aimed to measure the extent to which the institution has implemented the operational practices emphasized 569 by institution moving toward sustainability. The individual item mean scores were first transformed into total mean scores and later categorized into five levels, which formed as basis for interpreting the data in Table 4: Don’t know (mean score 0.51-1.5), not practiced (mean score 1.51-2.5), practiced a little bit (mean score 2.51-3.5), practiced quite a bit (mean score 3.51-4.5) and practiced fully (mean score 4.51-5.5). Table 4: Sustainability Practices Implemented in Institution No. Item Mean 18 19 20 21 Water conservation Recycling of solid waste Green purchasing Building construction and renovation Energy conservation practices Overall mean 22 2.3 2.7 2.0 2.1 Equivalent Adjectival Rating* Not practiced Practiced a little bit Not practiced Not practiced SD 1.06 1.04 1.13 1.56 3.0 Practiced a little bit 1.08 3.06 Practiced a little bit *Extent to which sustainability is practiced Table 4 shows the sustainability practices that are being implemented in polytechnics. The overall mean value of 3.06 indicates that polytechnics are not fully practicing sustainability in their institutions. In the Brundtland report-Our Common Future; it was stated that sustainable development requires that the adverse impacts on the quality of air, water and other natural elements are minimized so as to sustain the ecosystem’s overall integrity. Based on the findings, polytechnics in Malaysia are not implementing water conservation, green purchasing, green building construction, renovation practices and other major ‘green’ practices in their institutions. Faculty and Staff Development and Rewards This area aimed to measure practices in polytechnic to promote 570 sustainable development in faculty and staff, through staff activities, recognition, research and development. The individual item mean scores were first transformed into total mean scores and later categorized into five levels, which formed as basis for interpreting the data in Table 5.5: Don’t know (mean score 0.511.5), not promoted (mean score 1.51-2.5), promoted a little bit (mean score 2.51-3.5), promoted quite a bit (mean score 3.51-4.5) and promoted fully (mean score 4.51-5.5). Based on table 5, the overall mean of 2.49 indicates that polytechnics have no efforts to promote sustainable development among its staff. In Agenda 21, chapter 36, one of the objectives in reorienting education towards sustainable development is to achieve environmental and development awareness in all sectors of society on a world-wide scale as soon as possible. Unfortunately, results revealed that polytechnics in Malaysia have no efforts in promoting sustainable development among its staff. This finding shows that the objectives of polytechnics in SD are not in sync with the objectives of Agenda 21 in SD. Table 5: Promoting SD in Faculty and Staff No. Item Mean 23 Faculty staff and student involved with improving campus or local sustainability Faculty members teaching or doing research on sustainability issues Opportunities to enhance understanding, research and teaching in sustainability Overall mean 2.7 24 25 Equivalent Adjectival Rating* Promoted a little bit SD 1.07 2.3 Not promoted 1.05 2.4 Not promoted 1.08 2.49 Not promoted Outreach and Service This area of assessment measured the Polytechnics’ involvements 571 in issues related to ESD in its local area and the surrounding region through partnership with schools; relationships with local governments and business, or with international organizations. The individual item mean scores were first transformed into total mean scores and later categorized into five levels, which formed as basis for interpreting the data in Table 6: Don’t know (mean score 0.511.5), not involved (mean score 1.51-2.5), involved a little bit (mean score 2.51-3.5), involved quite a bit (mean score 3.51-4.5) and fully involved (mean score 4.51-5.5). Table 6: Polytechnics’ Involvement in Sustainability Related Issues No. Item 26 Institution involved in sustainable community work at local, regional, national or international levels Faculty involved in community projects related to sustainability Overall mean 27 Mean 2.52 2.59 2.56 Equivalent Adjectival Rating* Involved a little bit Involved a little bit Involved a little bit SD 1.11 1.06 *Extent of polytechnics’ involvement in sustainability related issues It can be deduced from the results in Table 6 that the polytechnics have little involvement in sustainable community work at local, regional, national or international levels as indicated by the mean value of 2.52. The mean value of 2.59 indicates that the faculty has little involvement in community projects related to sustainability. To support this result, table 7 presents the significant statement extracted from the response of item 29 of the questionnaire regarding the local sustainability related programme in institutions. Table 7: Local sustainability related programme in institutions Sustainability Related Programme Seminar on environment Community service - oil spill beach cleaning Frequency 1 2 572 Go green campaign Programme 1Malaysia (1Malaysia green, 1Malaysia clean) Recycling project Total No answer 4 5 8 20 95 Getting involved in programs and projects that contribute to sustainable development is one of many ways that can be used by universities and colleges to connect with their surrounding communities and beyond (Calder & Clugston, 2003). However, based on the study, polytechnics in Malaysia are not contributing much on issues related to ESD in its local area and the surrounding region. Student Opportunities This area aimed to measure the practices in the institute of higher education to provide students with opportunities to participate in sustainable development (SD) initiatives. The results are presented in table 8. Table 8: Opportunities Provided to Students to Participate in SD Initiatives Opportunities for students Orientation programs with sustainability focus Student groups with an environmental or sustainability focus Student environment centre Ecology house or sustainable dormitory Others Total Frequency 42 35 28 3 7 115 The findings of this study show that there are several organizations for student opportunities in SD initiatives that exist in polytechnics in Malaysia. Student groups with an environmental or sustainability focus and student environment centre, with orientation programs on sustainability are the student organizations that exist in most polytechnics. 573 Agenda 21 has proposed activities that will help students to get involve in SD initiatives at their institutions. According to Agenda 21 relevant authorities should ensure that every school is assisted in designing environmental activity work plans with the participation of students and staff. Based on the findings, results show that although organizations for students exist in polytechnics, there are no records of student group directly involved in sustainability initiatives. Institutional Mission, Structure and Planning This area aimed to measure the commitment of Polytechnics to promote SD at the institutional mission level. The polytechnics’ extent of formal written commitment to sustainability is presented in Table 9. Result shows that there are no formal written statements describing the purpose and objectives of institutions reflecting a commitment to sustainability (mean value of 2.5). Table 9: Polytechnics’ extent of formal written commitment to sustainability No. Item Mean Equivalent Adjectival Rating* Formal written statements describing the purposes and 2.5 None objectives of institution reflect a commitment to sustainability * Presence or absence of formal written commitment to sustainability SD 34 0.85 Table 10 presents the sustainability related positions and committees that were created by the different polytechnics. The results show that the polytechnics created seven different types of positions/committees with sustainability-related focus and/or responsibilities. It was noted that despite the lack of formal written statements describing the purposes and objectives of institution reflecting a commitment to sustainability, sustainable development positions like Head of Environmental Programs or Head of 574 Sustainability Programs, Environmental Coordinator Environmental council do exist in a number of polytechnics. and Table 10: Positions and committees related to sustainability in polytechnics Positions and committees Head of Environmental Programs or Head of Sustainability Programs Environmental Coordinator Environmental Council or Task Force Energy Officer Institutional Declaration of Commitment to Sustainability/Environmental Responsibility Orientation programs on sustainability for faculty and staff Green Purchasing Coordinator Socially responsible investment practices and policies Others Total Frequency 53 19 15 11 7 6 0 0 4 115 An institution’s mission statement expresses its fundamental vision and commitment (Calder & Clugston, 2003). As the results of this study indicates, Malaysian polytechnics’ mission statement does not reflect sustainability, which may make the sustainability offices/committees work doubly hard to promote and/or integrate sustainable development in any or all of the seven dimension of higher education. CONCLUSIONS Based on the results of the study, the following conclusions can be drawn: i) There is very little indication that the seven ESD dimensions are being operationalised in the polytechnics under study. ii) Sustainability practices (i.e., go green campaign, implementation of the 3R practices) are still in its infancy stage. iii) There are no formal written statements describing the purposes 575 and objectives of institution reflecting a commitment to sustainability. REFERENCES Brundtland Report. (1987). Our common future, Chapter 2: Towards Sustainable Development. Retrieved from http://scholar.google.com/scholar?hl=en&btnG=Search&q=intitle: Our+Common+Future#0 Clark, T. (2008). Exploring Accounts of Research Fatigue within Qualitative Research Engagements. Retrieved from http://soc.sagepub.com/content/42/5/953 Calder, W., & Clugston, R.M. (2003). International Efforts to Promote Higher Education for Sustainable Development. Planning for Higher Education. 31(3). 34-48. Earth Summit (1992). Agenda 21- Chapter 36 Promoting Education, Public Awareness and Training. Retrieved on 9 March 2012 from www.un-documents.net/a21-36.htm Garcia, J. (2010). Assessment of Education for Sustainable Development in Universities in Costa Rica: Implications for Latin America and the Caribbean. Retrieved on 14 February 2011 from http://www.earthcharterinaction.org/invent/images/uploads/HESD -CostaRica-Garcia.pdf Gustavo, L.O. (2000). Prospects; Education for Sustainable Development: A local and International Challenge, Vol. XXX, no.1, March 2000. Krejcie, R.V. & Morgan, D.W. (1970) Determining sample size for research activities. Educational and Psychological Measurements, 30, 607-610. McKeown Rosalyn (2002). Education for Sustainable Development Toolkit. Version 2. http://www.esdtoolkit.org McKeown, R., Hopkins, C., Rizi, R., & Chrystalbridge, M. (2002). Education for sustainable development toolkit. Retrieved from http://www.cdpc.ie/storage/devedresources/navigation/Resources/strand-7Sustainability/Resources/esd_toolkit_v2.pdf Nasir, A.R. (2002). Faktor-faktor Stress Pekerjaan Pensyarah di Politeknik: Satu kajian Kes di Politeknik Sultan Abdul Halim 576 Mu’Adzam Shah. Universiti Utara Malaysia: Tesis Sarjana University of Texas (2007). Response Rate. Retrieved on June 2 from http://www.utexas.edu/academic/ctl/assessment/iar/teaching/gather/ method/survey-Response.php Paryono (2010). TVET for Sustainable Development in SEAMOE Member Countries: Issues, Challenges and Selected Best Practices. Education for Sustainable Development in Technical and Vocational Education and Training. November 3-5, 2010. Manila, Philippines, 221-226. Velazquez, L., Munguia, N., & Sanchez, M. (2005). Deterring sustainability in higher education institutions: An appraisal of the factors which influence sustainability in higher education institutions. International Journal of Sustainability in Higher Education, 6(4), 383–391. doi:10.1108/14676370510623865 577 PARENTAL MONITORING ON THE ADOLESCENCE DEVELOPMENT Normalis Bazid, Zainudin bin Abu Bakar ABSTRACT The role of parents is very important in children upbringing. Parents are the closest individuals who influence their children emotional, cognitive and behavioral aspects of their self-development. Along with the passage of time, the children will go through adolescent stage. As the children step into educational institution and spend their school years, other influences on the students’ self-development also increased through their peers and environment. Thus, parents are getting more responsibilities, including monitoring their children activities. Any shortcomings of parental monitoring would lead to negative implications to the students. Hence, the researchers felt that the topic studied is a critical aspect to be further analyzed in identifying weakness issues of parental monitoring which may lead to fatal consequences to the adolescents. Researchers find that focuses in such issues are still scarce and insufficient in our local studies. In fact, the constraint on scope of the study and issues in vulnerability of parental monitoring are not clearly refined as compared to researches from other countries. With regard to results from findings of this work, the researchers used resources from selected literatures in supporting the completion of this study. At the end of this research, it is with great hope that there will be more in-depth studies to address the issues across the board in the future and studies to change ways of 578 parental monitoring. Additionally, there should also be intervention studies in order to overcome implications among adolescents in schools. Keywords : Issues; Parental Monitoring; Weaknesses; Implications; Adolescent Students INTRODUCTION The role of parents is crucial in fostering their child development whether it is healthy or otherwise on the socialization of children (Haris, 2004). Parental role also gives impact and influence their children. While adolescence is in school, there are more internal and external influences exposed to teenagers as they grow and develop their emotional, cognitive and behavioral aspects. However, researchers have noted that parents are a major factor that shapes the personality of a child (Azizi et. al., 2012). Researchers observed that parental monitoring of their adolescents should be given a priority in building a healthy self-development. This aspect is also seen in line with disciplinary problems among adolescents in Malaysia who are often absent from school. Even in the matter of discipline in schools, the biggest issue, and the highest in terms of frequency occurring among adolescents is truancy problem (Mok, 2012; Azizah, 2002). In fact, this aspect would definitely bring negative implications to adolescent students. It is common, that infancy and childhood stages require more attention, care, love and upbringing. In fact, kids are very close to their parents compared with their kids during teenage years who love freedom and excitement (Azizi et. al., 2012). Teenage years between 13 and 17 are the most challenging stages for them, the way they think and respond in behavior as adolescents. In fact, according to Azlina (2005), the main task of adolescence is to resolve their identity conflict and becoming an adult is unique in their selflearning process of becoming a mature individual. Teenagers are open to many things for their self-learning process. Furthermore, 579 adolescents are also trying to prove themselves as individuals who are independent and responsible for their own affairs. However, the fact is they still need guidance, support and control of their life aspects. Therefore, the parental role in monitoring is very important, even better if their monitoring of children, are balanced and equal regardless of their kids gender. However, in monitoring their daily activities, parents are more geared to monitor their teenage girls compared with their teenage boys. Thus, parents’ inclination in monitoring more on their girls rather than the boys served as an early indicator of problems that will arise later is more towards the boys than the girls. Generally, parental monitoring of their teens that is not consistent may cause problems not only to the parents but also to their teenagers and their surroundings. Shader (2009) states that among the factors that cause a teenager guilty of misconduct and problematic is not being monitored by their parents. Furthermore, family system will also be affected by weakness of the parents in monitoring their children daily activities and we concern that the numbers of indiscipline problems in the country is on the rise. According to the Ministry of Education (M.O.E.) (2008), for school session in 2006 there were 66, 526 records of disciplinary problems and the number is increasing in 2010, a total of 111, 484 students were involved in disciplinary problems (Loo, 2010). Of these students, more than 60% were from high school, while about 35% were from primary schools and without parental monitoring, students, peers, parents, schools and society may be adversely affected. Adolescent students, during school year would normally spent most of their time attending educational institution. They spend about 7 hours a day at school. However, supposing there were students who play truant, they are likely to be suspended or expelled from school. Whether students played truant, suspended or expelled from school, all the three cases show limitation of school inspection and unawareness of teachers and school on the student’s misconducts. Findings on present disciplinary problems show that there are a total of 10 high frequency analyses being conducted and truancy problem 580 becomes the highest in number (Mok, 2012; Yusfarina, M.Y. and Mohammed, K. K., 2000). Thus it is not surprising to find from the analyses conducted that the most recent disciplinary problems is truancy because they were absent or they could not simply wander around the school. Moreover, other problems such as stealing was ranked the second highest, followed by threatening students at school, bullying, using abusive language, coming late to school or late to class, making noise and disrupting lessons, damaging school property, missing from co-curricular activities (Mok, 2012). Therefore, if the students were outside the school, the problem of parental monitoring becomes more dominant and critical. Reasonably, as long as their parents are at home, they are the ones who are always present with their kids. If the parents to monitor activities, their children disciplinary and social problems can be positively handled. Otherwise negative implications will certainly bring impact to teenagers. Apart from that, Unruh et. al., (2009) in his study found that the students view emotional support from family as very important for them to reduce their constant negative behaviors. As teens identify their families’ involvement in unhealthy activities such as crime, they feel the need to have a stable home to support positive development in their lives. Without a stable environment, they will turn to peers that may lead to negative behavior and unhealthy activities. Poverty and lower socio-economic status are among the causes of students who succeed in their academic and having disciplinary problems (Burney & Beilke, 2008). Children who are raised in poverty are relatively getting less stimulation in their formative years in school compared with their peers who are wealthy living in luxurious surroundings. (Jensen, 2009). Therefore, researchers in this study have selected relevant literatures from previous studies to identify issues on weakness of parental monitoring and also to identify their implications for adolescent students. At this early stage, researchers will study the definition on research operational terms. This paper will then explore the issues of parental monitoring weaknesses and look into the implications to adolescent students. Researchers found that issues or 581 subject matter that causes shortcomings of parental monitoring is that less attention are given on this topic in our local studies compared with studies from other countries. At the end of this paper, the researchers propose that there will be more comprehensive study in the future to address issues that arise on parental monitoring of adolescents student and studies of interventions that could bring positive impact to the students. DEFINITION Weaknesses Issues Of Parental Monitoring Kamus Dewan, Fourth Edition (2013) stated that issues refer to subject matter that is important in a discussion. While the term weakness means lacking. The term monitoring means to observe a behavior in order to avoid something bad happens, the act of monitoring, maintenance, inspection or can be defined as paying attention by supervising that everything goes well. Parents are elders also synonymous with mother and father. In addition, parental monitoring can also be defined as; “A set of correlated parenting behaviors involving attention to and tracking of the child’s whereabouts, activities, and adaptations” (Dishion & McMahon, 1998, p. 61). Therefore, parental monitoring has been studied as a subject matter or issue, which led to lack of parenting behaviors associated with child development and behavior problems in adolescence. In a preliminary study of parental monitoring derived from clinical observations pointed out that parents of children with behavior problems often fail to monitor, track and set the rules about behavior and activities of their children (Sampson and Laub, 1994; Weintraub and Gold, 1991; Wilson, 1980). The study also showed that parental monitoring decreased over time, especially when children enter adolescence (Kerr and Statt, 2003; Laird et. al., 2009; Smetana, 2008). These findings support the importance of continuous 582 monitoring as a way to prevent teens from behavioral problems. In a study conducted by Laird et. al., (2008) from the aspect of parental monitoring knowledge is seen to undermine the relationship between peers of anti-social and negative behavior of adolescents. He and his colleagues have selected a sample of 504 students in the age group between 12 to 16 years. The empirical research results have shown that knowledge and awareness of parents to monitor their children can affect and reduce negative behaviors among students and also negative influence from their peers. Parents have also shown that girls are more likely to be protected from negative peers through parent’s selection and awareness compared with parent’s lower protection and awareness with their boys. This observation indicates that female students were closely monitored on their circle of friends compared to male students. Previous researchers have found that girls were monitored more than boys, and parents are more aware about social activities of their daughters than sons (Willoughby and Hamza, 2011). This finding may reflect the concerns of parents on high exposure of social activities for girls to engage in problem behavior and negative behavior (Pettit et. al., 2007). Therefore, it can be concluded that between boys and girls, parents are more conscious and have higher awareness on girls' outdoor activities compared with male students. Implication To Students According to Kamus Dewan (2013), implication can be defined as effect of a problem, and in this research, refers to adolescents. Adolescent refers to individuals who attend secondary schools in the country and from the age group 13 to 17 years. Adolescent students also refer to male and female students in school. 583 ISSUES Poverty Poverty often limits the level of family involvement that gives impact to student achievement and risk for potential delinquency (Burney & Beilke, 2008). Family with low incomes often struggle to overcome obstacles such as lack of health benefits, constraints on family time such as family members who are doing shift works, parent’s inability to hire tutor to help with their children's academics and parent’s nature of work that is also seen as being less safe (Burney and Beilke, 2008). For parents who meet the criteria for poverty status based on per capita household income is provided in the Poverty Line Income (PLI), 2007, is to look at households with income less than RM1, 000.00 per month in rural areas and RM1, 500.00 in city areas (http://www.webjabatan.kedah.gov.my). In addition, children who are raised in poverty, also deal with their parents who are cognitively less stimulated in their formative years, compared with parents of their peers who are more capable, or with higher income (Jensen, 2009). Parents are always busy and work hard most of the time for their children sake. Increase in their financial income is only to serve the needs of their children, such as food, clothes, school expenses and others (Wan Norasiah, 2003), may result to neglect of parental supervision. Thus, for the causes involving poverty, researchers saw that it could also be associated with busy parents who are seeking for an increase of their family income tend to overlook their responsibility to supervise their children. While there are issues of parental supervision in terms of high-income earners, poverty cause however is the dominant aspect on issue related to parental monitoring of adolescent students. In fact, there is also a study by Azizi et. al., (2012) stated that due to low-income parents, children often feels inferior at school because they could not pay the school fees. 584 Communication Parents who are lacking in monitor and control over their children will affect communication and increase gap between them. The distant relationship will cause teenagers feeling as if they are neglected. As a result, they do not feel the importance of informing their whereabouts or sharing their daily routines with their parents. Apart from that, the lack of understanding between parents and children would lead to conflict, quarrel and fight (Arieff and Wardah, 2006). The communication problem between parents and children not only cause other problems to their teachers, peers and school but also cause social problems among teenagers. Teenagers mostly do not like to share their problems with their parents, especially those of personal nature due to lack of communication and less monitoring from their parents. They also claimed that parents are more formal in their communication and rigid in their approach (Wan Norasiah, 2003) and such ways of communication certainly would further aggravate their relationship, thus affecting parental monitoring and attention to their kids. In addition, ineffective communication would result to parents neglect and being less affectionate to the kids. There are also parents who give total freedom to their children without parental monitoring and supervision with their understanding that the kids are matured enough to think and to act accordingly (Wan Norasiah, 2003). In reality although adolescents seem to be growing as adults physically, the real fact is that they still need support, guidance and ongoing monitoring of their life affairs. This is supported by Wan Norasiah (2003) who states that parents who are not paying attention and not being affectionate enough for their children will result to their kids turning their attention to their peers and making them as consultants instead of their parents for their problem-solving and decisionmaking. Local researchers in their studies have proven that relationship between the parents and their teenage children with communication problems are facing relationship problem among them. Azlina et. al., (2005), based on a survey that was conducted jointly with colleagues 585 entitled "Kebimbangan Akademik dan Kerjaya Serta Hubungan Kekeluargaan : Satu Tinjauan Terhadap Golongan Remaja di Luar Bandar," shows that teenagers who are growing up are having communication problem in their family relationships. About 76% of adolescents in their study found that teenagers never told their secret to their parents, while 54% of respondents indicated that teenagers need love and 51% are looking for more freedom at home. Parents who are unaware of activities carried out by their children or do not monitor their activities could lead to behavior misconducts among adolescents and involvement to social problems such as drug abuse and promiscuity. Parental Status Single parents monitoring also seems to be one of the causes that lead to parents and child relationship problems and weakness in parental monitoring. Parents who are living together are seen as less problematic in their monitoring compared with monitoring from single parents. There are studies that show parents who look after their children together could minimize the risk of behavioral problems among adolescents compared with single parents. According to Griffin et. al., (2000) reported that due to divorce and being raised by a single parent, resulted that boys engaged in the highest rates of problem behavior. Furthermore, the economic deprivation and the lack of relationship can provide a more accurate description for why adolescents student from single-father families do poorly in school (Downey, 1995). Anti-social Parents Parents who are stucked with criminal cases are typically weak parents in monitoring their children's activities (Shader, 2009). As their teens find out that their parents involved in unhealthy activities such as crime, they feel the need to have a stable home to support 586 positive development in their lives. Without a stable environment, they will turn to peers that may lead to negative behavior that could lead adolescents’ students to unhealthy activities. IMPLICATIONS In general, the researchers found that there were previous studies that look at the result of weakness on parental monitoring that affect several aspects of adolescents. There have been reports of previous researches that show the impact on adolescents could lead to symptoms of depression, lower self-esteem and lower academic achievement. Adolescents student who are not controlled and monitored by parents may be experiencing emotional problems when they are in need of emotional support from their parents (Shader, 2009). In fact, there are also researchers in their clinical studies reported the need for intervention research in changing the way parents control their children (Crouter et al, 1990; Gil-Rivas et al, 2003). Furthermore, weakness in parental monitoring could also lead to students experiencing social problems through their negative lifestyle and social practices such as truancy among adolescents (Smelser, 1976). In addition, a survey conducted by Haris (2004) entitled, " Masalah Sosial di Bandar Semenanjung Malaysia: Tinjauan Daripada Perspektif Masyarakat Malaysia," reported that one of the social behaviors among adolescent male students across a southern zone city in Malaysia shows that smoking is the first highest of misconducts among male teenagers, followed by drug abuse and loitering as the third highest. For female adolescents, their highest misconduct is concerned with disciplinary problems at school, followed by loitering. Some findings of this data show how crucial the parental role is in monitoring their children activities while the teenagers are being away from home and socializing with their circle of friends. In fact, the problems caused by adolescents’ student are simply because of their teenage unfulfilled desires. The lack of monitoring even with the support of parents may 587 lead to increased symptoms of bullying among adolescents at school (Bourke and Burgman, 2010). A number of previous studies state that in order to prevent bullying among students we need the support of parents and helping the socio-emotional aspect of adolescents’ student. (Bronfenbrenner, 1977). CONCLUSION Therefore, researchers of this study hope that there will be more comprehensive studies conducted in the future as an effort to change ways of parental monitoring. Additionally, there should also be intervention studies in order to overcome implications among adolescents in schools. REFERENCES Arieff, S. R. dan Wardah. M. 2006. Membentuk Jati Diri Remaja. Bentong.: PTS Professional Publishing Sdn Bhd. Azlina. A. N. 2005. Psikologi Personaliti Individu. Shah Alam.: Karisma Publishing. Azlina. A.M., Raja, Z. A dan Siti A. S. 2007. Kebimbangan Akademik dan Kerjaya Serta Hubungan Kekeluargaan : Satu Tinjauan Terhadap Golongan Remaja di Luar Bandar. Malaysia Journal of Social Administration, 4, 77-86. Azizah L. N. 2002. Masalah Disiplin di Kalangan Remaja Tingkatan Empat di Kuala Lumpur. Ph.D. Tesis, University Malaya, Kuala Lumpur. Azizi, Y., Shahrin H., Yusof B., Jamaludin, R. and Nurul, E. A. (2012). Penyelewengan Tingkah Laku Remaja Punca dan Rawatan. Johor. Skudai.: Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Burney, V. H. and Beilke, J. R. (2008). The Constraints of Poverty on High Achievement. Journal for the Education of the Gifted, 31 (3), 171197. Bronfenbrenner, U. (1977). Toward an Experimental Ecology of Human Development. American Psychologist, 32, 513-531. Crouter, A. C., MacDermid, S. M., McHale, S. M. and Perry-Jenkins, M. (1990). Parental Monitoring and Perceptions of Children’s School 588 Performance and Conduct in Dual and Single Earner Families. Development Psychology, 26 (4), 649-657. Dishion, T. J., and McMahon, R. J. (1998). Parental Monitoring and the Prevention of Child and Adolescent Problem Behavior: A Conceptual and Empirical Formulation. Clinical Child and Family Psychology Review, 1, 61-75. Downey, D. B. 1994. The School Performance of Children from SingleMother and Single-Father Families: Economic or Interpersonal Deprivation?. Journal of Family Issues, 15 (1), 129-147. Gil-Rivas, V., Greenberger, E., Chen. C. and Lopez-Lena, M. M. Y. 2003. Understanding Depressed Mood in the Context of a FamilyOriented Culture. Adolescence, 38 (149), 93-109. Griffin, K. W., Botvin, G. J., Scheider, L. M., Diaz, T. and Miller. N. L. 2000. Parenting Practices as Predictors of Substance Use, Delinquency and Agression Among Urban Minority Youth: Moderating Effects of Family Structure and Gender. Psychology of Addictive Behaviors, 14 (2), 174. Haris A. W. 2004. Masalah Sosial di Bandar Semenanjung Malaysia: Tinjauan Daripada Perspektif Masyarakat Malaysia. Jati, 9, 55-74. http://webjabatan.kedah.gov.my/home4/new.php?jab=jkmk&isi=content5& id2=1722. Jensen, E. 2009. Teaching With Poverty in Mind. What Being Poor Does to Kids’ Brains and What Schools Can Do About It. Alexandria, V.A.: A.S.C.D. Kamus Dewan 2013. Edisi Keempat. Kuala Lumpur.: Dewan Bahasa dan Pustaka. Kerr, M., and Stattin, H. Parenting of Adolescents: Action or Reaction? In A. C. Crouter & A. Booth (Eds.). Children’s Influence on Family Dynamics. Mahwah. N.J Erlbaum. 121-151; 2003. Laird, R. D., Criss, M. M., Pettit, G.S., Bates, J. E and Dodge, K. A. 2009. Development Trajectories and Antecedents of Distral Parental Supervision. Journal of Early Adolescence, 29, 258-284. Laird, R. D., Criss, M. M., Pettit, G.S., Dodge, K. A. and Bates, J. E, 2008. Parents’ Monitoring Knowledge Attenuates the Link Between Antisocial Friends and Adolescent Delinquent Behavior. Journal of Abnormal Child Psychology, 36 (3), 299-310. Loo, T. E. 2010, December 28. Wee: Don’t Cover Up for Students Who Play Truant. Retrieved from Star website: http://thestar.com.my/news/story.asp?file=/2010/12/28/nation/7694 589 546&sec=nation. Malaysia Ministry of Education. 2008, Kad Laporan: Pelan Induk Pembangunan Pendidikan 2006-2010. Retrieved 5 September 2008,from http://www.moe.gov.my/galeri_awam/selidik/2008 /2008_BTMK_8_2023_7331.pdf. Mok, S. S. 2012. Pedagogi Untuk Pengajaran dan Pembelajaran. Selangor.:Multi Media Sdn. Bhd. Pettit, G. S., Keiley. M. S., Laird, R. D., Bates, J. E. and Dodge, K. A. 2007. Predicting the Development Course of Mother-Reported Monitoring Across Childhood and Adolescence from Early Proactive Parenting, Child Temperament and Parents’ Worries. Journal of Family Psychology, 21, 206-217. Sampson, R. J. and Laub, J. H. 1994. Urban Poverty and The Family Context of Delinquency: A New Look at Structure and Process in a Classic Study. Child Development, 65, 523-540. Shader, M. 2009. Risk Factors for Delinquency: An Overview. U. S. Department of Justice. Retrieved from htpp://www.ncjrs. Gov/ pdffiles1/ ojjdp/ frd030127. pdf. Smelser, N. J. 1976. Comparative Methods in The Social Sciences. Englewood Cliff. N. J.: Prentice-Hall. Smetana, J. G. (2008). “It’s 10 o’clock : DoYou Know Where Your Children Are?” Recent Advances in Understanding Parental Monitoring and Adolescents’. Information Management. Child Development Perspectives, 2, 19-25. Unruh, D., Povenmire-Kirk, T. and Yamamoto, S. 2009. Perceived Barriers and Protective Factors of Juvenile Offenders on Their Development Pathway to Adulthood. Journal of Correctional Education, 60 (3), 201-224. Wan Norasiah, W. I. 2003. Akhlak Remaja di Felda Ulu Belitong. Disertasi Master Usuludin, Akademi Pengajian Islam, Universiti Malaya, Kuala Lumpur. Weintraub, K. J. and Gold, M. 1991. Monitoring and Delinquency. Criminal Behaviour and Mental Health, 1, 268-281. Willoughby, T. and Hamza, C. A. 2011. A Longitunal Examination of the Bidirectional Associations Among Perceived Parenting Behaviors, Adolescent Disclosure and Problem Behavior Across the High School Years. Journal of Youth and Adolescence, 40, 463-478. Wilson, H. 1980. Parental Supervision: A Neglected Aspect of Delinquency. British Journal of Criminology, 20, 203-235. 590 Yusfarina. M. Y. and Muhammad K. K. A. 2000. Strategi Menangani Masalah Ponteng Sekolah. Satu Model Kajian Tindakan dan Penilaian Strategi. Kertas Kerja, Seminar Kebangsaan Hubungan Sekolah dengan Komuniti: Strategi Menangani Masalah Pelajar, Universiti Malaya, Kuala Lumpur, 13-14 Oktober. 591 KERANGKA KONSEPTUAL KESEDIAAN GURU DALAM MELAKSANAKAN PENTAKSIRAN BERASASKAN SEKOLAH (PBS) DI SEKOLAH MENENGAH SEMENANJUNG MALAYSIA Sivakkumar A/L Balakrishnan, Muhammad Sukri Saud ABSTRAK Artikel ini membincangkan tentang Kerangka Konseptual Kesediaan Guru Dalam Melaksanakan Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah (PBS) di Sekolah Menengah Semenanjung Malaysia. Dalam konteks Pendidikan Malaysia, perubahan dalam Pendidikan Malaysia membuatkan guru perlu peka terhadap perubahan yang berlaku. Guru perlu melengkapkan diri secara holistik dalam melaksanakan PBS di sekolah. Kajian ini berpontensi untuk dilaksanakan bagi mengkaji aspek kesediaan guru dalam melaksanakan PBS berdasarkan domain Kognitif, domain Afektif dan domain Psikomotor melalui tiga bahagian iaitu input, proses dan output. Kajian ini adalah bersifat mix-method yang menggunakan dua kaedah iaitu pendekatan penyelidikan kualitatif dan kaedah kuantitatif. Adalah diharapkan dapatan daripada 592 kajian dapat diperjelaskan tentang tahap kesediaan guru dalam melaksanakan Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah. Kata Kunci : Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah, Kesediaan Guru, Kognitif, Afektif, Psikomotor PENGENALAN Pendidikan berperanan sebagai pembentuk bangsa dengan mengeluarkan tenaga manusia mahir, melahirkan insan harmonis, warga negara yang cekap, beretika, berilmu dan beriman, berkebolehan, berfikiran terbuka, kreatif dan inovatif, bijak mencari dan menggunakan maklumat yang diperoleh dan boleh buat kerja sendiri. Pendidikan di Malaysia digubal berdasarkan Falsafah Pendidikan Kebangsaan yang menekankan kesepaduan antara ilmu pengetahuan, kemahiran, sikap dan nilai murni (Pusat Perkembangan Kurikulum,1992) Menurut Abdul Rahim (2007), proses pengesanan kurikulum perlu dilakukan untuk mengesan perkara-perkara yang boleh dibaiki dan meningkatkan aspek kualiti kurikulum yang sedia ada. Pengenalan kepada kurikulum baru adalah bertujuan untuk mengalihkan sistem pendidikan yang berorientasikan peperiksaan kepada kurikulum yang lebih dinamik dan progresif pada masa akan datang. ( Ngui,1993). Pada masa era globalisasi ini, organisasi pendidikan hendaklah bergerak seiring dengan perubahan-perubahan yang diperlukan oleh masyarakat abad ke-21 bagi tujuan mencapai aspirasi negara untuk mendapat taraf negara maju bertonggakkan kepada Falsafah Pendidikan Negara dan Wawasan 2020. Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah merupakan satu usaha untuk membangunkan modal insan secara holistik melalui penekanan terhadap pengusaan ilmu pengetahuan, kemahiran, pengamalan nilai dan pembudayaan sikap progresif seperti yang terkandung Pelan Induk Pembangunan Pendidikan (PIPP) 2006-2010. Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah dilaksanakan mulai 1 Februari 2012 di sekolah menengah melalui surat pekeliling lembaga 593 peperiksaan No rujukan KP/LP/003.07.14 (2). Surat pekeliling ini dikeluarkan dengan tujuan memaklumkan tentang penambahbaikan PBS bagi penilaian menengah rendah mulai tahun 2012. Bagi memantapkan sistem pentaksiran dan penilaian supaya lebih holistik. Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah diperkenalkan dalam bidang pendidikan dimana komponen pentaksiran dikendalikan oleh pihak sekolah dan pentaksiran dilaksanakan oleh guru-guru matapelajaran secara berterusan dalam proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran (Lembaga Peperiksaan, 2011). Pengajaran dan pembelajaran di peringkat sekolah menengah menggunakan Kurikulum Standard Sekolah Menengah (KSSM), ( Lembaga Peperiksaan 2011). Pentaksiran ini diyakini dapat melahirkan modal insan yang holistik serta seimbang dari segi jasmani, emosi, intelek dan rohani (JERI) seperti yang diaspirasikan dalam Falsafah Pendidikan Negara.( Lembaga peperiksaan 2011). Pada tahun-tahun kebelakangan ini cara penilaian baru mula muncul di beberapa negara. Ini adalah hasil daripada perdebatan yang bertindan berkenaan tujuan dan kaedah penilaian, Messick (1994) dan impak terhadap pengajaran dan pembelajaran. Dalam penyelidikan berkenaan bagaimana guru-guru menguatkuasakan inisiatif baru dalam kurikulum (McRobbie & Tobin,1995; Tobin & LaMaster,1995) adalah didapati bahawa falsafah tentang inovasi kurikulum adalah banyak berbeza daripada teori dan kepercayaan guru. Cabaran ini memerlukan guru-guru menstruktur semula sistem kepercayaan mereka. Dalam konteks hari ini, suatu perubahan perlu dalam proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran yang lebih kreatif dan inovatif. Guru perlu bebaskan diri daripada pemikiran lama yang membelenggu mereka dalam kaedah pengajaran seperti kaedah chalk and talk sudah tidak relevan lagi buat masa kini,( Mahasan Mahmood 2003). Perlu diakui bahawa perubahan yang dihasratkan bukanlah suatu perkara yang mudah dilakukan oleh guru-guru. Guru-guru telah menerima orientasi yang sungguh berbeza daripada apa yang mereka sendiri dikehendaki lakukan di kelas-kelas sebagai pendidik (Lortie,1975). Kajian-kajian lepas melaporkan tentang kepentingan 594 Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah dalam membantu proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran (Rohaya 2009). Namun keberkesanannya bergantung kepada tahap kesediaan guru, pengetahuan dan kemahiran guru serta nilai yang diperlukan oleh guru dalam bidang pentaksiran. Pentaksiran guru dalam Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah merupakan kriteria penting kearah memperluaskan pengalaman pembelajaran dan mencapai pendidikan berkualiti. ( Black dan William (1998). Pada masa ini kebanyakkan guru masih menggunakan kaedah pengajaran yang berpusatkan kepada guru ( Yeung 2009, Shumba,1999, Lee & Lin 2005). Kebanyakkan guru berpendapat bahawa kaedah pengajaran tradisional adalah mudah dan selamat, bersifat semulajadi serta senang digunakan dalam bilik darjah. Menurut kajian Sharifah (2003) sebahagian besar guru-guru masih mengunakan kaedah pengajaran tradisional. Mereka mengarah pelajar mengikut prosedur yang telah dituliskan dalam buku teks dan ini menyebabkan pelajar menjalankan aktiviti menghafal dengan sendiri. Pentaksiran dalam pendidikan merupakan proses yang dinamik dan sentiasa berubah. Terdapat banyak kajian mengetengahkan pelbagai isu peperiksaan seperti peperiksaan adalah pengalaman yang menakutkan pelajar dan memberi tekanan kepada mereka. Kurikulum disusun berdasarkan kepada subjek. Subjek pula disusun dari tahap rendah kepada tahap tinggi yang mana guru harus menguasai kaedah pengajaran berpusatkan aktiviti verbal. Guru pula adalah sebagai fokus dalam kelas dan merupakan seorang yang berpengetahuan dan pemberi ilmu. Buku teks adalah sumber utama dan penghafalan adalah cara pembelajaran yang ditonjolkan. Guru membuat penilaian perkembangan pelajar melalui ujian dan dilaporkan melalui rekod yang menunjukkan gred pencapaian pelajar. Guru perlu mengenal pasti masalah dan keperluan mereka sendiri berdasarkan pengalaman mereka dalam proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran serta merancang bagi menyelesaikan masalah yang sedang di hadapi. (Omar Mohd. Hashin,1993). Selain itu menurut Sabri Ahmad (1997) masalah yang di 595 hadapi guru ialah pelajar tidak menumpukan perhatian ketika pengajaran dan pembelajaran yang menyebabkan mereka suka ponteng kelas. Ini akan memberi kesan kepada aktiviti amali seperti tidak melakukan kerja amali, meniru hasil kerja pelajar lain dan tidak mempunyai disiplin yang tinggi terhadap ketetapan masa untuk tugasan mereka dan mendatangkan masalah kepada guru. Sistem pendidikan yang berorientasikan pencapaian akademik telah mengorak langkah kepada satu perubahan dalam sistem pendidikan iaitu amalan pentaksiran dalam pengajaran dan pembelajaran. Guru-guru juga, selain dari memiliki ilmu, kemahiran dan sikap yang sesuai, harus mempunyai kemampuan menangani pelbagai cabaran yang mungkin timbul dalam proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran. Terdapat banyak faktor yang menghalang berlakunya perubahan yang signifikin cara guru mengajar dalam kelas. Satu daripada sebab yang menyebabkan berlakunya keadaan ini ialah secara sedar mahupun tidak sedar, guru-guru mempunyai monopoli dalam bilik darjah. Ini bermakna guru yang menguasai kebanyakkan wacana dalam kelas yang secara langsungnya menyebabkan pelajar menjadi pelajar yang pasif. Guru haruslah menerima penglibatan pelajar yang aktif supaya pelajar menerima pengalaman yang bermakna dan mendorong pelajar memikirkan apa yang mereka belajar semasa berada dalam kelas. Guru harus berusaha menukarkan amalan pengajaran di kelas mereka supaya amalan tersebut benar-benar berbeza dari amalan kelas konvensional (Bereiter & Scardamalia,1987). Inilah tuntutan setiap perubahan yang dibawa ke dalam sistem pendidikan. Sekiranya guru-guru gagal melakukan perubahan ini, maka akan gagal perubahan yang dibawa itu. PELAKSANAAN PBS DI SEKOLAH-SEKOLAH MENENGAH SEMENANJUNG MALAYSIA Penyelidik membuat sorotan dari kajian-kajian yang lepas yang telah dibuat berkaitan dengan Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah. 596 Kajian-kajian lepas yang berkaitan dengan tajuk dibincangkan satu persatu mengikut faktor yang dikaji. PENTAKSIRAN BERASASKAN SEKOLAH Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah (PBS) di mulai pada pelajar tingkatan satu tahun 2012 dan tingkatan dua pada tahun 2013 diyakini dapat melahirkan modal insan yang holistik serta seimbang dari segi jasmani, emosi, rohani dan intelek seperti yang diaspirasikan dalam Falsafah Pendidikan Kebangsaan. Ketika ini, sistem pendidikan yang berorientasikan peperiksaan dan terlalu mengiktiraf pencapaian akademik menyebabkan penglibatan pelajar kurang dalam kokurikulum serta memberi tekanan kepada guru, ibu bapa dan pelajar berkenaan. Tekanan ke atas guru-guru untuk menghabiskan sukatan pelajaran menyebabkan fokus kepada produk akhir dan bukannya proses pembelajaran. Tambahan pula, di sesetengah negara maju, sistem pentaksirannya telah banyak berubah dan ada yang langsung tidak mempunyai peperiksaan awam sama ada di peringkat sekolah rendah mahupun menengah. KESEDIAAN GURU DALAM MELAKSANAKAN PENTAKSIRAN BERASASKAN SEKOLAH Di dalam setiap peringkat pengajaran dan pembelajaran guru dikehendaki sentiasa menjalankan penilaian untuk menentukan sama ada objektif pengajaran dan pembelajaran yang telah ditetapkan itu dapat dicapai atau tidak. Menurut Brookhard,S.M. (2002) pengetahuan guru tentang penilaian secara besar-besaran adalah terhad terutama dalam bidang berkomunikasi. Ini menunjukkan bahawa guru mempunyai kemahiran terhad dalam mengumpul dan menggunakan maklumat penilaian kelas untuk meningkatkan pembelajaran murid. Oleh itu perlulah menerima hakikat bahawa jika guru mempunyai pengetahuan yang rendah dalam membuat pentaksiran hasil kerja pelajar, mereka mungkin 597 tidak dapat meningkatkan pembelajaran pelajar. Guru-guru ini mungkin berasa terbeban, kecewa dan akibatnya menunjukkan etika kerja yang tidak diingini (Gullickson 1993). Menurut Caroll (1963), pengajaran yang berkesan di pengaruhi oleh lima faktor, iaitu sikap (attitude), kebolehan untuk memahami pengajaran (ability to understand), ketekunan (perseverance), peluang (opportunity) dan pengajaran yang berkualiti (Quality of instruction). Sikap pelajar terhadap pelajaran adalah tinggi dan mudah untuk memahami pengajaran yang disampaikan oleh guru. Sikap ini akan menyenangkan pelajar untuk memahami sesuatu konsep dan kemahiran. Begitu juga jika pengajaran dan pentaksiran guru terhadap hasil pelajar itu baik maka pelajar akan belajar dengan mudah. Menurut Slavin (1994) terdapat empat faktor yang mempengaruhi pengajaran yang berkesan, iaitu kualiti pengajaran (quality of instruction), kesesuaian aras pengajaran (appropriate level of instruction), insentif ( incentive) dan masa (time). Kualiti pengajaran bermaksud keupayaan pengajar untuk menyampaikan pengajaran atau kemahiran yang mudah difahami oleh pelajar dan pelajar boleh buat kerja dengan sendiri. Oleh itu, guru perlu menyampaikan kandungan pengajaran secara tersusun dan sistematik (Kallison,1986); menggunakan bahasa yang jelas dan mudah (Land,1987), penerangannya yang jelas, dan memberi panduan dan contoh yang berkaitan; penekanan kepada kandungan mengikut sukatan pelajaran (King & 0222Menke,1992); dan menggunakan alat bantu mengajar (ABM) bagi membantu menerangkan sesuatu konsep (Hiebert,Wearne & Taber, 1991; Kazna 1991. Satu daripada andaian yang memberi peranan kepada tranformasi pendidikan berpusat ialah guru apabila di perlukan sanggup dan boleh menyesuaikan pengajaran kearah yang sesuai berdasarkan Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah. 598 Keperluan Pengetahuan dalam melaksanakan PBS. Guru berperanan menyampaikan ilmu, mendidik dan mendisiplin pelajar serta menilai prestasi dan kemampauan pelajar serta meransang dan membimbing pelajar dalam pembelajaran mereka. Menurut Saedah (2005), menyatakan bahawa guru seharusnya dapat menguasai pengetahuan dalam mata pelajaran yang diajar untuk menjadikan pengajaran berkesan. Strategik pengajaran guru adalah penting bagi memastikan pengajaran guru tercapai. Seorang guru itu sendiri mesti tahu bagaimana mahu mengurus,mentadbir serta mengawal pelajar di dalam kelas bagi memastikan isi kandungan pelajaran dapat difahami oleh semua pelajar. Selaras dengan hasrat Kurikulum Standard Sekolah Menengah (KSSM) dan Falsafah Pendidikan Negara (FPN), strategi pengajaran dan pembelajaran hendaklah memberi penekanan kepada pengetahuan, penguasaan kemahiran saintifik dan pemupukan nilai murni yang dilakukan secara terancang, sama ada secara langsung atau tidak langsung. (Laporan Jawatankuasa Kabinet, KPM,1979). Guru disarankan menjadi tenaga pengajar yang kreatif dalam menggabung jalin antara pengetahuan, kemahiran saintifik dan nilai murni dalam pengajaran mereka. Guru seharusnya sentiasa berjaya dalam mewujudkan suasana pembelajaran aktif di dalam kelas untuk mengelakkan kebosanan dalam kalangan pelajarnya. Keperluan Kemahiran dalam melaksanakan PBS. Guru perlulah melengkapkan diri dengan pelbagai kemahiran yang sewajarnya. Kemahiran yang sedia ada pada guru di sekolah mungkin tidak mencukupi. Oleh itu kemahiran perlu dipertingkatkan dan dikemaskini supaya pendidikan yang disampaikan bersesuaian dengan keperluan masa kini dan masa akan datang (Pusat Perkembangan Kurikulum,1990). 599 Keperluan kemahiran nilai dalam melaksanakan PBS. Kamaruddin (2010), menyatakan sikap mempunyai pengaruh yang kuat terhadap tingkah laku dan boleh dilihat berdasarkan kepada tingkah laku iaitu sama ada melalui percakapan atau pelakuan. Sikap ialah satu kecederungan atau perasaan secara percakapan atau gerak balas bagi memenuhi kepuasan dan nilai seseorang iaitu sama ada suka ataupun tidak terhadap sesuatu perkara untuk dibuat atau dilaksanakan. Guru memainkan peranan penting dalam pelaksanaan Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah kerana mereka terlibat secara langsung dalam pentaksiran hasil pelajar. Tanggungjawab guru merancang dan menyediakan kemudahan semasa pengajaran dapat menghasilkan mutu kerja yang baik. Sebagai penilai guru hendaklah bersikap adil dan tidak pilih kasih bagi mengelakkan kebolehpercayaan penilaian yang dibuat. Menurut Sulaiman (1996), yang berpendapat bahawa sekiranya seorang mempunyai minat yang tinggi terhadap kerja yang dilakukan, sudah pasti kerja tersebut akan dapat diselesaikan dengan memuaskan, tetapi jika seseorang itu tidak berminat melakukan sesuatu kerja, sebaliknya ia dilakukan atas dorongan yang lain sudah pasti kerja tersebut tidak akan memuaskan walaupun ia dapat diselesaikan. Sharifah Alwiah (1984), mentafsirkan minat adalah penggerak atau kecenderungan seseorang untuk memberi perhatian kepada seseorang, kegiatan atau benda. Ini menunjukkan sekiranya seseorang guru mempunyai minat yang mendalam dalam melaksanakan Pentaksiran maka guru itu akan terus memberi tumpuan yang sepenuhnya kepada penilaian yang dibuat. PEMASALAHAN YANG PELAKSANAAN PBS DIHADAPI DALAM Menurut Mohd Salleh (1998), beban tugas guru pada masa sekarang boleh dikatakan begitu banyak. Kerjanya bukan setakat mengajar sahaja malah terpaksa merangkumi perkara-perkara yang 600 lain seperti membantu pihak pentadbir, berhubung dengan masyarakat, mengambil kedatangan pelajar, memeriksa buku, memunggut yuran dan juga melibatkan diri dalam kegiatan persatuan dan gerak kerja ko-kurikulum. Pelbagaian dalam tanggungjawab tersebut menyebabkan tumpuan guru dalam profesionnya khasnya dalam menyampaikan ilmu pengajaran agak ditumpukan terhadap persediaan pengajaran tidak mencukupi. KERANGKA KONSEPTUAL PBS Berdasarkan Kerangka Konseptual kajian ini menjadi panduan kepada pengkaji untuk memfokuskan penyelidikan yang dijalankan. Dalam kajian ini pengkaji akan menerangkan kerangka konseptual kajian yang telah dibentuk bagi memastikan objektif kajian yang telah dibuat dapat dicapai setelah kajian dijalankan. Kerangka Konseptual ini menjelaskan kesediaan guru dalam melaksanakan PBS berdasarkan domain Kognitif, domain Afektif dan domain Psikomotor melalui tiga bahagian iaitu input, proses dan output. 601 Input Strategi PBS Konsep PBS Kepentingan PBS Proses Output Kaedah Pelaksanaan PBS FASA 1 Kajian Delphi 10 orang Pakar (Jones 1979) Kajian Delphi 3 pusingan Pelaksanaan PBS FASA II Kajian Tinjauan (Guru PBS) KESIMPULAN Reka bentuk dan kaedah kajian memberi panduan kepada pengkaji mengenalpasti kesediaan guru dalam melaksanakan PBS di sekolah. Selain itu diharap Model Konseptual Kesediaan Guru dalam melaksanakan PBS dapat dihasilkan untuk digunakan oleh guru di sekolah-sekolah Semenanjung Malaysia dengan jayanya. RUJUKAN Abdul Rahim Hamdan. (2007). Pengajian Kurikulum. Skudai.Penerbit Universiti Teknologi Malaysia. Anderson, L. &Krathwohl, D. A. (2001) Taxonomy for Learning, Teaching and Assessing: A Revision of Bloom's Taxonomy of Educational Objectives New York: Longman Bereiter, C, & Scardamalia, M (1987) An attainable version of high literacy: Approaches to teaching high-order skill in reading and writing, Curriculum Inquiry, 17;1,9-30. Bloom B. S. dan Krathwohl (1956). Taxonomy of Educational Objectives, Handbook I: The Cognitive Domain. New York: David McKay Co Inc. Black, P., & Wiliam, D. (1998). Assessment and classroom learning. Assessment in Education: Principles, Policy and Practice, 5(1), 7- 602 74.Brookhart, S.M. (2002). What will teachers know about assessment, and how will thatimprove instruction? In Assessment in educational reform: Both means and end,ed. R.W. Lissitz., & W.D. Schafer, pp. 2-17. Boston: Allyn and Bacon. Black P. and Wiliam, D. (1998) “Inside the Black Box: Raising Standards Through Classroom Assessment”, Phi Delta Kappan, October, pp. 139-148. Carroll, J. (1963). A model of school learning. Teacher College Record, 64, 723-73. Gullickson, A.R.(1993) Matching measurement instruction to classroombased evaluation: Hiebert, J. et al. (1991). Fourth graders gradual constructions of decimal fractions. Helmer, O. 1968. Analysis of the future: The Delphi Method. Dlm Bright J.R. (pnyt.). Technological forecasting for industry and government: Method and applications. New Jersey: Prentice-Hall Inc. Helmer,O. 1983, A Guide to Future Research Olaf Helmer, New Jersey: Sage Publication, Inc. Kallison, (1986). Effect of lesson organization achievement . American Educational. Kamarudin Hj. Husin. Siti Hajar (2003) Pedagogi Untuk Asas Pendidikan, Kumpulan Budiman Sdn Bhd. Krathwohl, D. R., Bloom, B. S., & Masia, B. B. (1973). Taxonomy of Educational Objectives, the Classification of Educational Goals. Handbook II: Affective Domain. New York: David McKay Co., Inc. Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia (2002). Laporan Pembangunan Pendidikan 2013-2025 Kuala Lumpur : Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia. Kamarudin Md Tahir. 2010. Penilaian Pembangunan Kemahiran generik dalam kalangan pelajar Kolej Komuniti Kementerian Pengajian Tinggi Malaysia. Tesis Dr. Falsafah, Universiti Kebangsaan Malaysia. King, D. & Menke, J. (1992). Providing the instructors note: An effective additional. Land, M. L. (1987), Vagueness and clarity. Dalam Dunkin (Ed.), International. Laporan Jawatankuasa Kabinet, 1979. Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia. 603 Lembaga Peperiksaan Malaysia (LPM) 2011. PBS.. Kementerian Pelajaran Malaysia. Lortie, D.(1975). School teacher. Chicago: University of Chicago Press. Ngui,K.S.(1993). The New Social Science Curriculum in Malaysia Schools: Some Similarities with the American Experience. Pendidikan Di Malaysia: Arah dan cabaran, Kuala Lumpur: Universiti Malaya. Omar Mohd Hashim (1993), Pendidikan : Persoalan, Penyelesaian dan Harapan Kuala Lumpur: Dewan Bahasa dan Pustaka. Mahasan Mahmood(2003) Kaedah Nemonik dalam pengajaran dan pembelajaran Matematik. SMK Yaacob Latif Jalan Peel Kuala Lumpur. Messick,S.(1994) The interplay of evidence and consequences in the validation of performance assessment, Educational Researcher,23(3),pp.13-23. McRobbie, C.J. & Tobin, K. (1995) Restraints to reform : the congruence ofteacher and student actions in a chemistry classroom, Journal of research inscience education, 32 (4), pp. 373-385. Pusat Perkembangan Kurikulum (1989). “Draf Kemahiran Hidup Program Peralihan”.Kuala Lumpur: Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia. Rohaya Talib (2009). Kajian Pembinaan dan Pengesahan Instrumen bagi mengukur tahap literasi Pentaksiran guru sekolah menengah di Malaysia. Dalam Http://eprints.utm.my/13641/7/Rohaya Talib PDF 2009. Pindaan Surat Pekeliling Lembaga Peperiksaan Bil. 2 Tahun 2011: Penambahbaikan Sistem Pentaksiran Kebangsaan Bagi Penilaian Menengah Rendah (PMR) Mulai Tahun 2012 - KP.LP.003.07.14 (2) bertarikh 14 Februari 2011. Saedah Siraj. 2005. Kurikulum Masa Depan. Kuala Lumpur: Penerbit Universiti Malaya. Syarifah Alwiah Alsagoff (1984). Teknologi Pengajaran. Kuala Lumpur : Dewan Bahasa Dan Pustaka. Sabri Ahmad (1997), Menuju Kecemerlangan Belajar Selangor: Masterpiece Pucblication Sdn Bhd. Siti Aloyah Alias. (2002) Penilaian Pelaksanaan Program PEKA Biologi. Projek Penyelidikan Sarjana Pendidikan. Universiti Kebangsaan Malaysia. Slavin, R. (1987). A theory of school and classroom organization. 604 Eduational Psychologist, 22, 89-108. Yeung, S.Y.S.(2009). Is Student-Centered Pedagogy Impossible in Hong Kong? The Case of Inquiry in Classrooms. Asia Pacific Educations Review, London: Springer Verlag 605 TINJAUAN MASALAH PENGURUSAN PROSES PBS DAN CIRI-CIRI ELEMEN PENTAKSIRAN YANG PERLU ADA DALAM SATU SISTEM PENGURUSAN EPORTFOLIO PBS Suhaizal Hashim, Jamalludin Harun ABSTRAK Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah (PBS) ialah satu proses untuk memantau pertumbuhan, kebolehan, kemajuan dan pencapaian pelajar secara keseluruhan berdasarkan objektif kurikulum baru yang bersepadu dan juga berdasarkan Falsafah Pendidikan Negara. Matlamat utama PBS ini adalah untuk mempertingkatkan kualiti pembelajaran, pengajaran dan penilaian. Kajian ini dijalankan bagi mengenalpasti masalah pengurusan proses PBS dan ciri-ciri elemen pentaksiran yang perlu ada dalam satu sistem pengurusan eportfolio PBS. Kajian yang menggunakan pendekatan rekabentuk kualitatif dan disokong juga oleh data kualitatif ini melibatkan sampel sebanyak 28 orang guru dan 3 orang guru ketua panitia yang terlibat dalam matapelajaran Sejarah tingkatan satu dari sekolah-sekolah sekitar Skudai, Johor Bahru. Berdasarkan kajian, beberapa tema masalah utama pengurusan proses PBS secara umum yang dikenalpasti adalah berpunca daripada pelajar itu 606 sendiri, masalah pengurusan evidens, masalah pengurusan masa dan masalah penggunaan sistem pengurusan PBS. Selain itu, dapatan bagi ciri-ciri yang akan diaplikasikan dalam satu sistem pembelajaran berasaskan eportfolio yang akan dibangunkan pula ialah sistem ini mampu untuk menyimpan eviden secara automatik, pengguna dapat mengakses markah dan evidens dan pihak bertanggungjawab dapat melihat paparan tugasan yang telah dilaksanakan. Kata Kunci : Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah; Masalah PBS; Sistem Pembelajaran Berasaskan eportfolio PENGENALAN Pelan Induk Pembangunan Pendidikan (PIPP) menyatakan bahawa cabaran utama yang dihadapi Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia (KPM) ialah mengurangkan pembelajaran berorientasikan peperiksaan di sekolah. Untuk mencapai matlamat ini, pelan ini mencadangkan supaya penilaian di sekolah ditukarkan kepada sistem Pentaksiran Berasaskan Sekolah (PBS) berdasarkan kepada penilaian tugasan. Matlamat utama PBS ini adalah untuk mempertingkatkan kualiti pembelajaran, pengajaran dan penilaian. Berdasarkan pentaksiran ini, guru-guru akan diberikan lebih tanggungjawab dalam membangunkan penilaian dan mengaitkannnya dalam pengajaran (Hwa, 2008). Keupayaan pelajar pula akan diukur berdasarkan kriteria dan piawai tertentu berdasarkan silibus subjek dan dipantau oleh panel terdiri daripada pakar-pakar subjek berkenaan (Dudley dan Luxton, 2008). Proses pentaksiran ini memberi kesan terhadap pelajar melalui motivasi intrinsik iaitu keinginan yang timbul kerana matlamat itu sendiri menyebabkan pelajar ingin berusaha atau ekstrinsik iaitu dorongan yang diberikan oleh guru atau persekitaran (Mokhtar, 2009). Pentaksiran adalah kaedah siasatan untuk menentukan tahap pembelajaran, kaedah untuk memperoleh dan mengumpul maklum balas penting, proses menilai pelajar 607 dalam konteks pendidikan, proses mendokumentasi pengetahuan, kemahiran, sikap dan kepercayaan, satu pendekatan pengajaran dan teknik yang penting, proses kitaran dan berterusan untuk menilai pengajaran dan pembelajaran, satu kaedah untuk menentukan bagaimana pengajaran dan pembelajaran yang terbaik secara berterusan dan sebagai alat diagnostik dan penilaian (Rayment, 2006). Sistem pentaksiran di Malaysia boleh dibahagikan kepada dua bentuk utama. Pertama, pentaksiran secara berpusat yang dikendalikan secara langsung oleh Lembaga Peperiksaan Malaysia (LPM). Kedua, pentaksiran secara dalaman yang dikendalikan secara berterusan melalui proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran di bilik darjah dan dikendalikan oleh guru mata pelajaran berkenaan (Mohd Isha, 2011). Kedua‐dua bentuk pentaksiran yang diamalkan ini selari sebagai mana yang dikelaskan oleh Shepard (2000) iaitu pentaksiran berpusat dan pentaksiran dalaman. Semasa menjalankan proses pentaksiran ini, pelajar-pelajar dihendaki untuk menduduki Peperiksaan Penilaian Tingkatan 3 yang akan melibatkan lapan subjek, dengan tiga jenis kaedah pentaksiran iaitu pelbagai instrumen, ujian bertulis dan ujian lisan yang melibatkan proses mendengar dan bertutur (KPM, 2014). Bagi subjek Sejarah pula, kaedah pelbagai instrumen digunakan. Pelbagai instrumen yang dimaksudkan adalah boleh diadakan dalam bentuk tugasan bertulis, ujian amali, projek, kajian lapangan, kajian kes, demonstrasi dan persembahan (KPM, 2014). Sebelum ini, penekanan kepada peperiksaan menyebabkan proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran lebih menjurus kepada menyediakan murid untuk boleh menjawab soalan peperiksaan sahaja. Malah, sistem pentaksiran murid sedia ada juga lebih mengarah kepada pentaksiran aspek intelek sahaja tanpa memberi banyak tumpuan kepada penilaian pertumbuhan dan perkembangan potensi-potensi lain (Ali, 2008). Aspek pentaksiran adalah salah satu teras utama bagi pihak sekolah, namun guru-guru menghadapi pelbagai masalah untuk melaksanakannya (Azhar dan Shahrir, 2008). 608 ISU DAN CABARAN PENTAKSIRAN DALAM MENJALANKAN PBS ialah satu proses untuk memantau pertumbuhan, kebolehan, kemajuan dan pencapaian pelajar secara keseluruhan berdasarkan objektif kurikulum baru yang bersepadu dan juga berdasarkan Falsafah Pendidikan Negara (Mokhtar, 2009). Pentaksiran dalam bidang pendidikan ialah satu proses pembelajaran yang merangkumi aktiviti menghurai, mengumpul, merekod, memberi skor dan menterjemah maklumat tentang pembelajaran seseorang murid bagi sesuatu tujuan tertentu (Azizi, 2010). Proses pentaksiran yang dijalankan sekarang ini melibatkan penggunaan Modul Perekodan Perkembangan Pembelajaran Murid bagi membantu guru merekod perkembangan penguasaan pembelajaran murid dalam Pentaksiran Sekolah berpandukan Panduan Perkembangan Pembelajaran Murid yang dibekalkan oleh Kementerian Pendidikan Malaysia. Melalui Modul Perekodan ini, setiap guru mata pelajaran hanya perlu menanda pada band yang telah dikuasai oleh murid sepanjang proses pentaksiran dalam bilik darjah atau setelah selesai sesuatu tajuk atau tema yang ditaksir (KPM, 2014). Dalam satu kajian untuk mengenalpasti apakah masalah utama, apakah punca kepada masalah tersebut dan bagaimanakah guru menyelesaikan masalah tersebut dalam amalan pentaksiran di sekolah menengah mendapati bahawa masalah yang kerap dihadapi oleh guru ialah pelajar sering tidak menyiapkan tugasan, guru tidak sempat menjalankan aktiviti pentaksiran, masa pengajaran guru sering terganggu oleh pelbagai aktiviti sekolah dan pelajar tidak berminat untuk menjawab soalan yang dibina sendiri oleh guru. Antara punca masalah ini ialah pelajar tidak berminat untuk belajar, guru kekurangan masa untuk merancang aktiviti pentaksiran, kesinambungan proses pengajaran dan pembelajaran sering terganggu dan kemunculan terlalu banyak buku panduan peperiksaan di pasaran (Azhar dan Shahrir, 2008). Graham (2008) menyatakan komponen utama untuk pelaksanaan PBS yang berkesan ialah keupayaan guru dalam 609 melaksanakan PBS itu sendiri melalui dua cara iaitu mendapatkan maklumat mengenai prestasi pembelajaran pelajar dan keupayaan guru itu membuat penilaian yang baik. Guru adalah pelaksana bagi PBS di sekolah, maka guru perlu mengenalpasti tahap pencapaian murid dari segi pengetahuan dan kemahiran yang diperolehi. Guru yang akan menerima maklumbalas sama ada pembelajaran dan pengajaran perlu diubah mengikut kesesuaian dan kefahaman murid. Namun tidak ramai guru yang benar-benar bersedia untuk menjalankan PBS kerana mereka tidak berpeluang untuk mempelajari teknik-teknik dan amalan pentaksiran yang betul. Ini meyebabkan guru melaksanakan pentaksiran sebagai satu produk dan bukan sebagai satu proses untuk membantu pembelajaran dan pengajaran (Salmiah et al, 2011). Menurut kajian Shafinaz (2010) juga, sistem pengurusan PBS di sekolah setakat ini menggunakan sistem fail secara manual atau portfolio dan menimbulkan masalah dari segi kehilangan maklumat, rosak dan dicuri pelajar. Selain itu, kebolehcapaian portfolio tersebut juga terhad kepada guru dan pelajar yang terlibat sahaja. Ini menyukarkan pihak pengurusan atau ibu bapa untuk memantau perkembangan pelajar. Pengurusan fail secara manual ini juga memerlukan ruang yang luas seperti bilik-bilik khas untuk meletakkan fail-fail pelajar. Sekiranya terdapat satu sistem khusus bagi menguruskan portfolio ini, masalah-masalah tersebut boleh diatasi. Berdasarkan kajian-kajian ini, satu kajian perlu dijalankan untuk menyelesaikan masalah pengurusan proses pentaksiran itu sendiri dan dapat membantu menerapkan pentaksiran dalam proses pembelajaran dan pengajaran guru melalui sistem pembelajaran yang akan dibangunkan nanti. Semasa menjalankan proses pentaksiran, teknologi maklumat dan komunikasi boleh membantu dalam koleksi, rakaman dan pembentangan data penting. Di samping menyimpan maklumat, guru boleh menggunakan teknologi maklumat dan komunikasi untuk membantu merancang dan menganjurkan, merekabentuk dan menyimpan sumber dan mencipta alat pentaksiran interaktif dalam usaha membantu proses pentaksiran (Rayment, 2006). 610 Eportfolio dilihat sebagai satu penyelesaian terbaik yang dilihat fleksibel untuk pengajaran, pembelajaran dan penilaian. Melaksanakan eportfolio dalam proses pembelajaran dan pengajaran memerlukan perancangan, prosedur baru, cara pemikiran baru, sumber tambahan dan latihan kedua-dua pihak iaitu guru dan pelajar. Keupayaan untuk berkongsi sumber, pelaksanaan proses, implementasi wawasan dalam latihan dan kaedah untuk bekerjasama antara pelajar telah memberikan perbezaan yang besar kepada Connecticut Institute yang terlibat dalam projek pelaksanaaan eportfolio. Kaedah yang digunakan ini memerlukan pelajar memahami kemahira
Similar documents
Bahasa Inggeris - upm : pusat jaminan kualiti
Guidelines to Good Practices: Curriculum Design and Delivery (GGP: CDD) is produced to help the HEP in the preparation of a curriculum, consistent with COPPA and COPIA, to be presented to and accep...
More information